Disclaimer
All
of the für
following
PDF document for
this sich
vehicle
model
Daslanguage
folgende versions
PDF-Dokument
dieses Fahrzeugmodell
bezieht
in allen
relate
solely toversion
vehicles
intended
for sale
on the
German
which
Sprachversionen
nur aufofdie
die für
den
deutschen
Marktand
bestimmt
The
following
theFahrzeuge,
Owner‘s
Manual
describes
allmarket
models,
series
and
correspond
to German
regulations.
sind undequipment
die den
deutschen
Vorschriften
entsprechen. Bitte
wenden
Sie sich an
special
of your
vehicle. Country-specific
language
variations
are
Ihren autorisierten
Mercedes-Benz
Servicestützpunkt,
um equipped
ein gedrucktes
possible.
Please note
that your vehicle
might not be
withExemplar
all the
Please
contact
your authorised
Mercedes-Benz
Service
Centreand
to obtain
für andere
Fahrzeugmodelle
und affects
Fahrzeugmodelljahre
zu erhalten.
described
functions.
This also
safety-relevant
systems
functions.
a printed
version
forauthorised
other vehicle
models and vehicle
model
years.
Thislike
PDF
Please
contact
your
Mercedes-Benz
dealership
if you
would
document
the latest
version.
Possible
variations
to your
vehicle
mayzu
not
Dieses
PDF-Dokument
stellt
die Manual
aktuelle
Version
dar.
Mögliche
Abweichungen
to
receive
aisprinted
Owner‘s
for other
vehicle
models
and vehicle
be
taken
into account
askönnten
Mercedes-Benz
constantlysein,
updates
their vehicles to
Ihrem
konkreten
Fahrzeug
nicht berücksichtigt
da Mercedes-Benz
model
years.
the
state
of the art
and introduces
changes
design
andanpasst,
equipment.
seine
Fahrzeuge
ständig
dem neuesten
Standinder
Technik
sowiePlease
therefore
that this
PDF is
document
in no
way
replaces
the
version
Änderungen
in Form
und
Ausstattung
vornimmt.
Bitte
beachten
Sie
daher,
dass
The
onlinenote
Owner‘s
Manual
the current
and
valid
version.
Itprinted
is
possible
that
which
was affecting
deliveredyour
with
yourFall
vehicle.
dieses PDF-Dokument
in keinem
das gedruckte
ersetzt,
mit
deviations
specific
vehicle
could Exemplar
not be taken
intodas
account
dem
Fahrzeug ausgeliefert
wurde.
as
Mercedes-Benz
constantly
adapts its vehicles according to the latest
technology and makes changes to the form and the equipment.
Please also read the printed Owner‘s Manual, supplementary documents and
the digital Owner‘s Manual in the vehicle.
Copyright
All rights reserved. All texts, images and graphics are subject to copyright
and other laws for the protection of intellectual property. They may not be
copied or changed for any commercial use or for the purpose of being passed
on nor used on other webistes.
Internal use only
Thank you for buying Mercedes-Benz
Before you first drive off, read this Owner's
Manual carefully and familiarise yourself with
your vehicle. For your own safety and a longer
vehicle life, follow the instructions and warning notices in this manual. Disregarding them
may lead to damage to the vehicle or personal
injury.
The equipment or model designation of your
vehicle may vary according to:
The technical documentation team at
Daimler AG wishes you safe and pleasant
motoring.
Rmodel
Rorder
Rcountry
variant
Ravailability
The illustrations in this manual show a lefthand-drive vehicle. On right-hand-drive vehicles, the layout of components and controls
differs accordingly.
Mercedes-Benz is constantly updating its
vehicles to the state of the art.
Mercedes-Benz therefore reserves the right
to introduce changes in the following areas:
Rdesign
Requipment
Rtechnical
features
The equipment in your vehicle may therefore
differ from that shown in the descriptions and
illustrations.
The following are integral components of the
vehicle:
ROwner's
Manual
Booklet
REquipment-dependent supplements
Keep these documents in the vehicle at all
times. If you sell the vehicle, always pass all
documents on to the new owner.
RService
i You can get to know the important fea-
tures of your vehicle in the interactive Owner's Manual on the Internet at:
http://www.mercedes-benz.de/
betriebsanleitung
2315842500Z102 É2315842500Z102bËÍ
Contents
Index ....................................................... 4
At a glance ........................................... 37
Introduction ......................................... 31
Safety ................................................... 49
Opening and closing ........................... 83
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors .. 111
Lights and windscreen wipers ......... 125
Climate control ................................. 139
Driving and parking .......................... 153
On-board computer and displays .... 227
COMAND Online ................................ 285
Stowing and features ....................... 543
Maintenance and care ...................... 561
Breakdown assistance ..................... 575
Wheels and tyres .............................. 595
Technical data ................................... 619
3
4
Index
1, 2, 3 ...
12 V socket
see Sockets
A
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Display message ............................ 248
Function/notes ................................ 71
Important safety notes .................... 71
Warning lamp ................................. 275
Access data of the mobile phone
network provider ...... 435, 437, 439, 440
Deleting ......................................... 440
Editing ........................................... 439
Making entries ............................... 437
Selecting ........................................ 435
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode .................................... 148
Activating/deactivating cooling
with air dehumidification ................. 142
Activating/deactivating Night
View Assist Plus
With spotlight function ................... 219
Active Blind Spot Assist
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 238
Display message ............................ 263
Function/notes ............................. 220
Active Body Control (AMG vehicles)
Display message ............................ 260
Driving conditions menu in the
COMAND display (AMG vehicles) ... 204
Function/notes ............................. 202
Active Body Control (except AMG
vehicles)
Display message ............................ 260
Driving conditions menu in the
COMAND display ........................... 201
Function/notes ............................. 199
Active Driving Assistance package .. 220
Active Lane Keeping Assist
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 238
Display message ............................ 263
Function/notes ............................. 223
Active light function ......................... 131
Active Parking Assist
Display message ............................ 264
Function/notes ............................. 207
Important safety notes .................. 207
Active partition (USB mass storage
devices only)
Selecting ........................................ 478
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ................................. 77
Adaptive brake lights .......................... 73
Adaptive Damping System
Function/notes ............................. 199
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
Display message ............................ 257
Function/notes ............................. 132
Switching on/off ........................... 133
Additives (engine oil) ........................ 626
Address book .................... 412, 416, 417
Browsing ........................................ 412
Calling up ....................................... 412
Changing an entry .......................... 414
Connecting a call ........................... 415
Creating an entry ........................... 413
Deleting an entry ........................... 413
Deleting contacts ........................... 418
Details about an entry ................... 414
Entering characters ....................... 303
Entry as a home address ............... 368
Hiding contact details .................... 419
Importing contacts ........................ 417
Introduction ................................... 411
Receiving vCards ........................... 418
Searching for an entry ................... 413
Starting route guidance ................. 415
Voice tag ....................................... 416
Address entry menu .......................... 326
...................................................... 326
Adjusting the balance ....................... 300
Adjusting the bass ............................ 300
Adjusting the brightness (TV,
video) .................................................. 502
Adjusting the colour (TV, video) ...... 502
Adjusting the contrast (TV, video) ... 502
Adjusting the sound settings
Balance .......................................... 300
Treble and bass ............................. 300
Adjusting the treble (sound) ............ 300
Index
Adjusting the vehicle height
Active Body Control (AMG vehicles) ............................................... 202
Active Body Control (except AMG
vehicles) ........................................ 199
Adjusting the volume
COMAND ....................................... 299
Navigation messages ..................... 299
Traffic announcements .................. 299
AIR FLOW ........................................... 144
Air pressure
see Tyre pressure
Air vents
Glove compartment ....................... 150
Important safety notes .................. 150
Setting ........................................... 150
Setting the blower output of the
AIRSCARF vents ............................. 151
Setting the centre air vents ........... 150
Setting the side air vents ............... 150
Switching AIRSCARF on/off .......... 117
Air-conditioning system
see Climate control
Airbag
Headbag .......................................... 55
Airbags
Front airbag (driver, front
passenger) ....................................... 54
Important safety guidelines ............. 52
Sidebag ............................................ 54
Triggering ......................................... 51
AIRSCARF
Switching on/off ........................... 117
AIRSCARF vents
Setting the blower output .............. 151
Alarm
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 79
Switching off (ATA) .......................... 79
Switching the function on/off
(ATA) ................................................ 79
Alarm system
see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Alternate route .................................. 357
Ambient lighting
Setting the brightness (on-board
computer) ...................................... 241
Setting the colour (on-board computer) ............................................. 241
AMG
Button for AMG menu .................... 168
SETUP ............................................ 168
AMG menu (on-board computer) ..... 244
Anti-glare film .................................... 559
Anti-lock braking system
see ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Anti-Theft Alarm system
see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Aquaplaning ....................................... 181
Ashtray ............................................... 549
Assistance display (on-board computer) .................................................. 237
Assistance menu (on-board computer) .................................................. 237
ASSYST PLUS
Displaying a service message ........ 567
Hiding a service message .............. 567
Resetting the service interval display ................................................ 567
Service message ............................ 566
Special service requirements ......... 567
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Activating/deactivating ................... 79
Function ........................................... 79
Interior motion sensor ..................... 80
Switching off the alarm .................... 79
Tow-away protection ........................ 80
ATTENTION ASSIST
Activating/deactivating ................. 238
Display message ............................ 261
Function/notes ............................. 214
Audio
Radio mode ................................... 462
Audio CD/DVD or MP3 mode
Switching to (Rear Seat Entertainment System) ................................ 528
Audio DVD
Pause function ............................... 474
Playback options ........................... 478
Safety notes .................................. 468
Setting the audio format ................ 478
Stop function ................................. 474
Switching to ................................... 472
Audio menu (COMAND Online) ......... 463
Audio menu (on-board computer) .... 234
5
6
Index
Authorised workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
AUTO lights
Display message ............................
see Lights
Automatic engine start (ECO start/
stop function) ....................................
Automatic engine switch-off (ECO
start/stop function) ..........................
Automatic headlamp mode ..............
Automatic transmission
Accelerator pedal position .............
Automatic drive program ...............
Changing gear ...............................
Display message ............................
Driving tips ....................................
Emergency running mode ..............
Engaging the park position ............
Kickdown .......................................
Manual drive program ....................
Manual drive program (vehicles
with Sports package AMG) ............
Overview ........................................
Problem (fault) ...............................
Program selector button ................
Pulling away ...................................
Selector lever ................................
Starting the engine ........................
Steering wheel gearshift paddles ...
Transmission position display ........
Transmission positions ..................
Automatic transmission emergency running mode .........................
AUX (audio)
Notes/socket ................................
Switching to ...................................
AUX (video)
Connecting an external video
source ............................................
Setting the volume and sound .......
Showing/hiding the menu .............
Switching to ...................................
AUX jacks ...........................................
CD/DVD drive ...............................
Avoiding an area ................................
B
257
159
159
127
167
169
167
269
167
173
164
167
169
170
163
173
167
158
163
157
169
165
166
173
500
500
516
517
517
517
521
521
379
Back button ....................................... 296
BAS (Brake Assist System) ................. 71
BAS PLUS (Brake Assist System
PLUS) .................................................... 72
Battery (key)
Checking .......................................... 87
Important safety notes .................... 87
Replacing ......................................... 88
Battery (vehicle)
Charging ........................................ 584
Display message ............................ 259
Important safety notes .................. 582
Jump starting ................................. 586
Overview ........................................ 582
Belt
see Seat belts
Belt force limiter
Activation ......................................... 60
Function ........................................... 60
Belt tensioner
Activation ......................................... 51
Function ........................................... 60
Bird's-eye view (navigation) ............. 374
Blind Spot Assist
see Active Blind Spot Assist
Bluetooth®
Activating audio mode ................... 491
Activating/deactivating ................. 313
Conditions (telephone) .................. 389
Connecting another mobile
phone ............................................ 393
Connecting audio devices .............. 488
Device list ...................................... 489
Entering the passcode ................... 391
External authorisation .................... 392
General information ....................... 313
Interface ........................................ 388
Introduction ................................... 388
Reconnecting an audio device ....... 490
Searching for a mobile phone ........ 390
Settings ......................................... 313
Telephone basic menu ................... 394
Telephony ...................................... 389
Telephony notes ............................ 387
Bluetooth® audio basic display ....... 491
Index
Bonnet
Active bonnet (pedestrian protection) ............................................... 562
Closing ........................................... 563
Display message ............................ 270
Important safety notes .................. 562
Opening ......................................... 563
Boot
Emergency release .......................... 99
Important safety notes .................... 94
Locking separately ........................... 98
Opening/closing (automatically
from inside) ...................................... 98
Opening/closing (automatically
from outside) ................................... 95
Opening/closing (from the outside, HANDS-FREE ACCESS) ............ 96
Opening/closing (manually from
outside) ............................................ 95
Overview .......................................... 94
Power closing .................................. 93
Boot lid
Display message ............................ 270
Opening dimensions ...................... 629
Opening/closing .............................. 94
Boot load (maximum) ........................ 629
Boot separator
Display message ............................ 271
Fitting ............................................ 106
General notes ................................ 105
Opening/closing ............................ 106
Removing ....................................... 106
Bottle holders .................................... 549
Brake Assist
see BAS (Brake Assist System)
Brake fluid
Display message ............................ 253
Notes ............................................. 627
Brake lamps
Adaptive ........................................... 73
Display message ............................ 256
Brakes
ABS .................................................. 71
BAS .................................................. 71
BAS PLUS ........................................ 72
Brake fluid (notes) ......................... 627
Display message ............................ 248
Driving tips .................................... 179
High-performance brake system ....
Important safety notes ..................
Parking brake ................................
Warning lamp .................................
Breakdown
see Flat tyre
see Towing away
Buttons on the COMAND controller ........................................................
180
179
176
275
296
C
Call ......................................................
Accepting/ending/rejecting ..........
Connecting ....................................
see Telephone
Call list
Display details ...............................
Call lists
Deleting .........................................
Opening and selecting an entry .....
Saving an entry in the address
book ..............................................
Calling up a fault
see Display messages
Capacities (technical data) ...............
Car
see Vehicle
Car key
see Key
Car wash (care) .................................
Care
Automatic car wash .......................
Carpets ..........................................
Display ...........................................
Exhaust pipe ..................................
Exterior lighting .............................
Gear or selector lever ....................
High-pressure cleaner ....................
Interior ...........................................
Matt paintwork ..............................
Night View Assist Plus ...................
Notes .............................................
Paint ..............................................
Plastic trim ....................................
Reversing camera ..........................
Roof lining ......................................
Seat belt ........................................
397
396
397
406
407
405
406
622
568
568
574
572
572
571
573
569
572
570
572
568
570
573
572
574
574
7
8
Index
Seat cover ..................................... 573
Sensors ......................................... 571
Steering wheel ............................... 573
Trim pieces .................................... 573
Washing by hand ........................... 569
Wheels ........................................... 570
Windows ........................................ 570
Wiper blades .................................. 571
Wooden trim .................................. 573
Category list (music search) ............ 481
CD
Copy protection ............................. 480
Fast forward/fast rewind ............... 476
General information ....................... 480
Inserting ........................................ 469
Inserting/loading (Rear Seat
Entertainment System) .................. 528
Multisession .................................. 479
Notes on compact discs ................ 480
Pause function ............................... 474
Player/changer operation
(COMAND) ..................................... 469
Removing/ejecting (Rear Seat
Entertainment System) .................. 528
Safety notes .................................. 468
Selecting a media type .................. 474
Selecting a track ............................ 475
Sound settings (balance, bass,
treble) ............................................ 299
Switching to ................................... 472
CD mode
Playback options ........................... 478
CD player/CD changer(on-board
computer) .......................................... 234
CD/DVD ..................................... 469, 470
Ejecting (DVD drive) ....................... 470
Ejecting (DVD single drive) ............ 469
Inserting (DVD changer) ................ 469
Inserting (DVD single drive) ........... 469
Central locking
Automatic locking (on-board computer) ............................................. 242
Locking/unlocking (key) .................. 85
Centre console
Lower section .................................. 45
Lower section (AMG vehicles) .......... 46
Upper section .................................. 44
Changing direction ............................ 352
Announcement phase .................... 352
Change of direction phase ............. 352
Preparation phase ......................... 352
Changing the character set .............. 307
Changing the picture format (TV,
video) .................................................. 502
Character ........................................... 305
Changing the character set ............ 305
Changing the language .................. 304
Deleting ......................................... 305
Moving the cursor .......................... 305
Switching to letters ........................ 304
Characters ......................................... 305
Entering ......................................... 305
Entering (address book, phone
book) ............................................. 303
Entering (navigation) ...................... 305
Charge maintenance socket ............ 552
Child seat
Automatic recognition ..................... 63
ISOFIX .............................................. 64
On the front-passenger seat ............ 62
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 70
Recommendations ........................... 67
Suitable positions ............................ 65
Children
In the vehicle ................................... 61
Restraint systems ............................ 61
Cigarette lighter ................................ 550
Cleaning
Mirror turn signal ........................... 571
Climate control
Adjusting airflow (AIR FLOW) ......... 144
Controlling automatically ............... 144
Convenience opening/closing
(air-recirculation mode) ................. 148
Cooling with air dehumidification .. 142
Demisting the windows .................. 147
Demisting the windscreen ............. 146
Important safety notes .................. 140
Indicator lamp ................................ 144
Information on using
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control .................................. 141
Overview of systems ...................... 140
Index
Problem with the rear window
heating .......................................... 148
Problems with cooling with air
dehumidification ............................ 144
Setting the air distribution ............. 145
Setting the air vents ...................... 150
Setting the airflow ......................... 146
Setting the temperature ................ 145
Switching air-recirculation mode
on/off ............................................ 148
Switching on/off ........................... 142
Switching residual heat on/off ...... 149
Switching the rear window heating on/off ...................................... 147
Switching the ZONE function on/
off .................................................. 146
THERMOTRONIC (2-zone) automatic climate control ..................... 141
Cockpit
Overview .......................................... 38
see Instrument cluster
Collapsible emergency spare
wheel
see Emergency spare wheel
COMAND control panel ..................... 294
...................................................... 294
COMAND controller ........................... 296
COMAND display ............................... 293
Cleaning ......................................... 572
Cleaning instructions ..................... 293
Driving conditions menu (AMG
vehicles) ........................................ 204
Driving conditions menu (except
AMG vehicles) ................................ 201
Setting ........................................... 310
Switching on/off ........................... 293
COMAND Online ........................ 446, 461
Active multicontour seat ................ 319
Basic functions .............................. 298
Calling up drive status regulator
(ABC) ............................................. 318
Display ........................................... 289
Emergency call system displays .... 432
Examples of operation ................... 296
Importing POIs ............................... 446
Menu overview .............................. 291
Multicontour seat .......................... 319
Seat functions ............................... 318
Settings .........................................
Switching on/off ...........................
COMAND Online and Internet
see Online and Internet functions
Combination switch ..........................
Compass function .............................
Connecting a USB device .................
Consumption statistics (on-board
computer) ..........................................
Contacts
Deleting .........................................
Importing .......................................
Convenience closing feature ............
Convenience opening feature
see Side windows
Convenience opening/closing (airrecirculation mode) ...........................
Coolant (engine)
Checking the level .........................
Display message ............................
Important safety notes ..................
Temperature (on-board computer) .............................................
Temperature gauge ........................
Warning lamp .................................
Cooling
see Climate control
Copy protection (CD/DVD) ...............
Copyright .............................................
Cornering light function
Display message ............................
Function/notes .............................
Country-specific information (navigation) ...............................................
Crash-responsive emergency lighting .......................................................
Cruise control
Cruise control lever .......................
Deactivating ...................................
Display message ............................
Driving system ...............................
Important safety notes ..................
LIM indicator lamp .........................
Selecting ........................................
Setting a speed ..............................
Storing and maintaining current
speed .............................................
461
298
129
381
472
231
418
417
101
148
565
258
627
244
228
281
480
36
255
131
382
135
182
184
265
182
182
182
183
184
183
9
10
Index
Cup holder
Centre console .............................. 548
Important safety notes .................. 548
D
DAB radio (Digital Audio Broadcasting)
Selecting a station ......................... 464
see Radio
Dashboard lighting
see Instrument cluster lighting
Data
see Technical data
Data carrier ................................ 479, 484
Audio DVD ..................................... 479
MUSIC REGISTER ........................... 484
Data modem mode
Telephone with Bluetooth® (SAP
profile) ........................................... 423
Data roaming
Telephone module with Bluetooth® (SAP profile) ...................... 424
Daytime driving lights
Display message ............................ 257
Function/notes ............................. 127
Switching on/off (on-board computer) ............................................. 239
Declarations of conformity ................. 33
Delayed switch-off
Exterior lighting (on-board computer) ............................................. 241
Interior lighting .............................. 241
Delete button ..................................... 297
Destination ........................................ 370
Assigning a destination to an
address book entry ........................ 370
Destination (navigation)
Displaying information ................... 358
Entering a destination by address .. 326
Entering a destination using the
map ............................................... 333
Entering a POI ................................ 338
Entering using geo-coordinates ..... 334
Entering using Mercedes-Benz
Apps .............................................. 335
Saving ............................................ 369
Selecting from the destination
memory ......................................... 332
Selecting from the list of last destinations ......................................... 333
Selecting storage options .............. 370
Storing after destination entry ....... 369
Storing during route guidance ....... 369
Destination memory (navigation)
Deleting an entry ........................... 371
Entering/saving your home
address .......................................... 330
Previous destinations .................... 372
Diagnostics connection ...................... 33
Dialling a number (telephone) .......... 397
Digital speedometer ......................... 232
Digital teletext (MHEG-5) .................. 508
Digital TV channels ........................... 506
Programme preview ....................... 506
Dipped-beam headlamps
Display message ............................ 255
Setting for driving abroad (symmetrical) ........................................ 126
Setting for driving on the right/
left ................................................. 240
Switching on/off ........................... 127
Disc
CD/DVD ........................................ 480
MP3 ............................................... 479
DISC button
Activating audio CD/DVD or MP3
mode ............................................. 472
Activating Bluetooth® Audio ......... 492
Switching on the Media Interface .. 495
Switching to the MUSIC REGISTER ................................................ 484
Display
Selecting the design ...................... 310
Display message
Driving systems ............................. 260
KEYLESS-GO .................................. 272
Display messages
ASSYST PLUS ................................ 566
Calling up (on-board computer) ..... 247
Engine ............................................ 258
General information ....................... 247
Hiding (on-board computer) ........... 247
Key ................................................ 272
Index
Lights ............................................. 255
Safety systems .............................. 248
Tyres .............................................. 267
Vehicle ........................................... 269
Displaying the arrival time ............... 358
Displaying the distance to the destination ............................................... 358
Displaying the track and album ....... 478
Distance recorder
see Trip meter
Distance warning signal (warning
lamp) .................................................. 283
DISTRONIC PLUS
Cruise control lever ....................... 186
Deactivating ................................... 192
Display message ............................ 264
Displays in the multifunction display ................................................ 191
Driving tips .................................... 192
Function/notes ............................. 185
Important safety notes .................. 185
Selecting ........................................ 187
Setting the specified minimum
distance ......................................... 190
Warning lamp ................................. 283
Dolby® Digital ................................... 300
Door
Automatic locking (on-board computer) ............................................. 242
Automatic locking (switch) ............... 92
Central locking/unlocking (key) ...... 85
Control panel ................................... 48
Display message ............................ 270
Emergency locking ........................... 93
Emergency unlocking ....................... 93
Important safety notes .................... 90
Opening (from the inside) ................ 91
Power closing .................................. 93
Doors
Overview .......................................... 90
Draught stop
Electrical draught stop ................... 108
Manual draught stop ...................... 107
Drive program
Automatic ...................................... 169
Display ........................................... 165
Manual ........................................... 169
Manual (vehicles with Sports
package AMG) ............................... 170
Drive program selector ..................... 168
Driver's door
see Door
Driving abroad
Mercedes-Benz Service ................. 568
Symmetrical dipped beam ............. 126
Driving on flooded roads .................. 181
Driving safety system
BAS PLUS (Brake Assist System
PLUS) ............................................... 72
Driving safety systems
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) ....... 71
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ............................. 77
Adaptive brake lights ....................... 73
BAS (Brake Assist System) .............. 71
Electronic Brake-force Distribution .................................................. 76
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) ............................................... 73
ETS (Electronic Traction System) ..... 73
Important safety guidelines ............. 70
Overview .......................................... 70
PRE-SAFE® Brake ............................ 77
STEER CONTROL ............................. 78
Driving system
Active Body Control (AMG vehicles) ............................................... 202
Active Body Control (except AMG
vehicles) ........................................ 199
Adaptive Damping System ............. 199
Driving systems
Active Blind Spot Assist ................. 220
Active Driving Assistance package ................................................. 220
Active Lane Keeping Assist ............ 223
Active Parking Assist ..................... 207
ATTENTION ASSIST ........................ 214
Cruise control ................................ 182
Display message ............................ 260
Distronic Plus ................................ 185
HOLD function ............................... 196
Night View Assist Plus ................... 217
PARKTRONIC ................................. 204
RACE START (AMG vehicles) .......... 198
Reversing camera .......................... 211
Speed Limit Assist ......................... 215
11
12
Index
SPEEDTRONIC ...............................
Driving tips
AMG ceramic brakes .....................
Aquaplaning ...................................
Automatic transmission .................
Brakes ...........................................
DISTRONIC PLUS ...........................
Downhill gradient ...........................
Driving abroad ...............................
Driving in winter .............................
Driving on flooded roads ................
Driving on wet roads ......................
Fuel ................................................
General ..........................................
Icy road surfaces ...........................
Limited braking efficiency on salted roads .......................................
New brake pads/linings ................
Running-in tips ...............................
Snow chains ..................................
Symmetrical dipped beam .............
Wet road surface ...........................
DTMF tone transmission ..................
DVD
Copy protection .............................
Fast forward/fast rewind ...............
Inserting ........................................
Inserting/loading (Rear Seat
Entertainment System) ..................
Notes on discs ...............................
Removing/ejecting (Rear Seat
Entertainment System) ..................
Selecting a media type ..................
Selecting a track ............................
Sound settings (balance, bass,
treble) ............................................
DVD audio
Operating (on-board computer) .....
DVD video
Operating (on-board computer) .....
Rear Seat Entertainment System ...
Dynamic route guidance/TMC
Displaying traffic reports ...............
Displays on the map ......................
Introduction ...................................
Switching on/off ...........................
193
180
181
167
179
192
179
126
181
181
181
178
178
181
180
180
154
599
126
180
398
480
476
469
528
480
528
474
475
299
234
235
535
365
365
364
364
E
EASY-ENTRY feature
Activating/deactivating ................. 243
Function/notes ............................. 118
EASY-EXIT feature
Crash-responsive ........................... 119
Function/notes ............................. 118
Switching on/off ........................... 243
EBD (electronic brake force distribution)
Display message ............................ 250
Function/notes ................................ 76
ECO display
Function/notes ............................. 178
On-board computer ....................... 232
ECO start/stop function
Automatic engine start .................. 159
Automatic engine switch-off .......... 159
Deactivating/activating ................. 160
General information ....................... 159
Important safety notes .................. 158
Introduction ................................... 158
Electrical fuses
see Fuses
Electromagnetic compatibility
Declaration of conformity ................ 33
Electronic Stability Program
see ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
Emergency call 999 or 112 .............. 389
Emergency key
Unlocking the driver's door .............. 93
Emergency key element
Function/notes ................................ 86
Locking vehicle ................................ 93
Emergency release
Driver's door .................................... 93
Emergency spare wheel
General notes ................................ 614
Important safety notes .................. 614
Inflating the collapsible spare
wheel ............................................. 615
Removing ....................................... 615
Technical data ............................... 617
Emergency unlocking
Vehicle ............................................. 93
Engine
Display message ............................ 258
Index
ECO start/stop function ................ 158
Engine number ............................... 622
Jump-starting ................................. 586
Running irregularly ......................... 162
Starting problems .......................... 162
Starting the engine with the key .... 157
Starting with KEYLESS GO ............. 157
Stopping ........................................ 176
Tow-starting (vehicle) ..................... 591
Warning lamp (engine diagnostics) ............................................... 280
Engine electronics
Notes ............................................. 620
Problem (fault) ............................... 162
Engine jump starting
see Jump starting (engine)
Engine oil
Additives ........................................ 626
Checking the oil level ..................... 564
Checking the oil level using the
dipstick .......................................... 564
Display message ............................ 259
Filling capacity ............................... 626
Notes about oil grades ................... 626
Notes on oil level/consumption .... 564
Temperature (on-board computer) ............................................. 244
Topping up ..................................... 564
Viscosity ........................................ 626
Entering a junction name ................. 330
Entering a street name ..................... 327
Entering an address (example) ........ 326
Entering the house number .............. 327
Entering the town .............................. 327
Entry ........................................... 304, 307
Deleting ......................................... 307
Saving ............................................ 304
Environmental protection
Returning an end-of-life vehicle ....... 31
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
AMG menu (on-board computer) ... 244
Characteristics ................................. 74
Deactivating/activating (AMG
vehicles) .......................................... 75
Deactivating/activating (notes;
except AMG vehicles) ...................... 74
Display message ............................ 248
ETS .................................................. 73
Function/notes ................................ 73
General notes .................................. 73
Important safety guidelines ............. 74
Warning lamp ................................. 277
ETS (Electronic Traction System) ....... 73
Example display ........................ 473, 484
Audio CD mode .............................. 473
MUSIC REGISTER ........................... 484
Exhaust pipe (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 572
Exterior lighting
Settings options ............................. 126
see Lights
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting ....................................... 120
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic) ........ 121
Folding in when locking (on-board
computer) ...................................... 243
Folding in/out (automatically) ....... 121
Folding in/out (electrically) ........... 121
Out of position (troubleshooting) ... 121
Parking position ............................. 122
Resetting ....................................... 121
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 123
F
Factory setting (reset function) .......
Fast forward
Audio mode (CD, DVD, MP3) .........
Video DVD .....................................
Fast rewind
Audio mode (CD, DVD, MP3) .........
Video DVD .....................................
Fault message
see Display messages
Favourites (Internet) .........................
Favourites button ..............................
Filler cap
see Fuel filler flap
Fire extinguisher ...............................
First-aid kit .........................................
Fitting a wheel
Fitting a wheel ...............................
Lowering the vehicle ......................
316
476
513
476
513
459
313
577
576
609
609
13
14
Index
Preparing the vehicle ..................... 606
Raising the vehicle ......................... 607
Removing a wheel .......................... 608
Securing the vehicle against rolling away ........................................ 606
Flat tyre
MOExtended tyres ......................... 578
Preparing the vehicle ..................... 578
TIREFIT kit ...................................... 579
see Emergency spare wheel
Floormat ............................................. 558
Foglamps
Extended range .............................. 132
Frequencies
Garage door opener ....................... 555
Mobile phone ................................. 620
Two-way radio ................................ 620
Frequency
Adjusting for radio stations ............ 466
Front-passenger seat
Adjusting from the driver's seat ..... 114
Fuel
Additives ........................................ 625
Consumption information .............. 625
Consumption statistics .................. 231
Displaying consumption ................. 317
Displaying the current consumption ................................................ 232
Displaying the range ...................... 232
Driving tips .................................... 178
E10 ................................................ 624
Fuel gauge ....................................... 40
Grade (petrol) ................................ 624
Important safety notes .................. 623
Notes for AMG vehicles ................. 624
Problem (malfunction) ................... 175
Refuelling ....................................... 173
Tank content/reserve fuel ............. 623
Fuel filler flap
Opening ......................................... 174
Fuel level
Calling up the range (on-board
computer) ...................................... 232
Gauge .............................................. 40
Fuel reserve
see Fuel
Fuel tank
Capacity ........................................ 623
Problem (malfunction) ...................
Fuse allocation chart (vehicle tool
kit) ......................................................
Fuses
Allocation chart .............................
Before changing .............................
Dashboard fuse box .......................
Fuse box in the engine compartment ..............................................
Fuse box in the rear compartment ..
Important safety notes ..................
175
577
592
592
592
593
593
592
G
Garage door opener
Clearing the memory ..................... 555
Frequencies ................................... 555
General notes ................................ 553
Important safety notes .................. 553
Opening/closing the garage door .. 555
Programming (button in the rearview mirror) ................................... 553
Gear indicator (on-board computer) .................................................. 244
Gearshift program
SETUP (on-board computer) .......... 244
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts ........... 31
Glass roof (sunblind) ......................... 109
Glove compartment .......................... 544
Google™ local search
Importing a destination/route ....... 443
Popular searches ........................... 444
Search ........................................... 442
Search history ............................... 444
Selecting a search position ............ 442
Using as the destination ................ 443
GPS reception .................................... 323
Gracenote® Media Database ........... 476
H
Handbrake
see Parking brake
HANDS-FREE ACCESS .......................... 96
Hands-free microphone, switching
on/off ................................................. 398
Index
Harman/kardon® Logic 7® surround sound system
see Surround sound (harman/
kardon® surround sound system)
Hazard warning lamps
Display message ............................ 272
Switching on/off ........................... 130
Head level heating (AIRSCARF) ........ 117
Head restraints
Adjusting ....................................... 115
see NECK-PRO head restraints
Headbag
Display message ............................ 255
Operation ......................................... 55
Heading up (navigation) ................... 374
Headlamp
Cleaning system (function) ............ 131
Cleaning system (notes) ................ 628
Headlamps
Misting up ...................................... 133
Topping up the cleaning system .... 566
see Automatic headlamp mode
Headphones
Changing batteries ........................ 523
Heating
see Climate control
High-pressure cleaners .................... 569
Hill start assist .................................. 158
HOLD function
Activating ....................................... 197
Deactivating ................................... 197
Display message ............................ 262
Function/notes ............................. 196
Home address ........................... 330, 332
Entering and saving ....................... 330
Selecting from the destination
memory ......................................... 332
I
Ignition lock
see Key positions
Immobiliser .......................................... 79
Indicator and warning lamps
Coolant .......................................... 281
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 283
Engine diagnostics ......................... 280
SPORT handling mode ................... 278
Indicator lamp ................................... 523
Remote control .............................. 523
Indicator lamps
Display message ............................ 256
see Warning and indicator lamps
Indicators
see Turn signals
Inspection
see ASSYST PLUS
Instrument cluster
Overview .......................................... 40
Warning and indicator lamps ........... 42
Instrument cluster lighting .............. 228
Intelligent Light System
Activating/deactivating ................. 240
Display message ............................ 257
Overview ........................................ 131
Setting the dipped-beam headlamps for driving on the right/left .. 240
Interface (USB, iPod®)
see Media Interface
Interior lighting ................................. 134
Automatic control system .............. 134
Delayed switch-off (on-board
computer) ...................................... 241
Emergency lighting ........................ 135
Manual control ............................... 135
Overview ........................................ 134
Reading lamp ................................. 134
Setting the ambient lighting
brightness (on-board computer) .... 241
Setting the ambient lighting colour (on-board computer) ................ 241
Interior motion sensor
Deactivating ..................................... 81
Function ........................................... 80
Priming ............................................ 80
Switching off .................................... 81
Internet ...................... 454, 457, 458, 459, 460
Calling up the carousel view .......... 454
Conditions for access .................... 432
Creating a favourite ....................... 459
Entering the URL ............................ 454
Favourites manager ....................... 459
Favourites menu ............................ 460
Menu functions .............................. 457
Opening favourites ......................... 458
15
16
Index
Selecting favourites ....................... 455
Selecting/setting access data ....... 434
Internet radio
Calling up ....................................... 454
Searching for stations .................... 454
iPod® ................................. 494, 497, 498
Alphabetic track selection ............. 498
Connecting to Media Interface ...... 494
Selecting a category/playlist ......... 497
ISOFIX child seat securing system .... 64
iTunes® .............................................. 498
J
Jack
Storage location ............................ 577
Using ............................................. 607
Jump starting (engine) ...................... 586
K
Key
Changing the battery ....................... 88
Checking the battery ....................... 87
Convenience opening feature ........ 101
Display message ............................ 272
Door central locking/unlocking ....... 85
Emergency key element ................... 86
Important safety notes .................... 84
Loss ................................................. 89
Modifying the programming ............. 86
Opening/closing the roof .............. 105
Overview .......................................... 84
Positions (ignition lock) ................. 155
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 89
Starting the engine ........................ 157
Key positions
Key ................................................ 155
KEYLESS GO .................................. 155
KEYLESS-GO
Convenience closing ...................... 101
Display message ............................ 272
Locking ............................................ 85
Removing the Start/Stop button ... 156
Start/Stop button .......................... 155
Starting the engine ........................ 157
Unlocking ......................................... 85
Kickdown
Driving tips .................................... 167
Manual drive program .................... 171
L
Lamps
see Warning and indicator lamps
Lane Keeping Assist
see Active Lane Keeping Assist
Lane recommendations ....................
Explanation ....................................
Presentation ..................................
Lap time (RACETIMER) ......................
Licence plate lamp (display message) ...................................................
Light sensor (display message) .......
Lights
Activating/deactivating the Intelligent Light System ........................
Activating/deactivating the interior lighting delayed switch-off .......
Active light function .......................
Automatic headlamp mode ............
Cornering light function .................
Dipped-beam headlamps ...............
Driving abroad ...............................
Foglamps (extended range) ...........
Hazard warning lamps ...................
Headlamp flasher ...........................
Light switch ...................................
Main-beam headlamps ...................
Misted up headlamps ....................
Motorway mode .............................
Parking lamps ................................
Rear foglamp .................................
Setting the ambient lighting
brightness (on-board computer) ....
Setting the ambient lighting colour (on-board computer) ................
Side lamps .....................................
Switching the daytime driving
lights on/off (on-board computer) .............................................
Switching the exterior lighting
delayed switch-off on/off (onboard computer) ............................
Switching the spotlight on/off .......
353
353
353
245
256
257
240
241
131
127
131
127
126
132
130
130
126
130
133
132
129
128
241
241
128
239
241
240
Index
Switching the surround lighting
on/off (on-board computer) .......... 241
Turn signals ................................... 129
see Interior lighting
see Replacing bulbs
LIM indicator lamp
Cruise control ................................ 182
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 186
Variable SPEEDTRONIC ................. 194
Limiting the speed
see SPEEDTRONIC
LINGUATRONIC .................................. 312
Settings ......................................... 312
List of access data ............................ 437
New provider ................................. 437
List of mobile phone network providers ......................................... 434, 435
Calling up ....................................... 434
Empty ............................................ 434
With the selected provider ............. 435
Load/eject button ............................. 469
Loading aid (boot)
Raising/lowering the roof .............. 546
Locking
see Central locking
Locking (doors)
Automatic ........................................ 92
Emergency locking ........................... 93
From inside (central locking button) .................................................. 92
Locking centrally
see Central locking
Locking verification signal (onboard computer) ............................... 242
Luggage cover
see Boot separator
Lumbar support
Adjusting (COMAND Online) .......... 319
M
M+S tyres ...........................................
MAGIC SKY CONTROL .......................
Main-beam headlamps
Display message ............................
Switching on/off ...........................
Map (navigation)
Adjusting the scale ........................
598
109
256
130
372
Arrival time/distance to the destination .......................................... 375
City model ..................................... 376
Geo-coordinate display .................. 375
Heading ......................................... 374
Information in the display .............. 375
Map settings .................................. 373
Moving ........................................... 373
North orientation ........................... 374
Notes ............................................. 372
POI symbols ................................... 374
RDS-TMC displays ......................... 365
Road display .................................. 375
Saving the crosshair position ......... 373
Showing the map data version ....... 382
Topographical map ........................ 376
Updating ........................................ 382
Updating process ........................... 383
Matt finish (cleaning instructions) .. 570
Media Interfac
e ........................... 494, 495, 496, 497, 499
Alphabetical track selection .......... 498
Basic menu .................................... 495
Connecting an external audio
source ............................................ 494
Connecting an external video
source ............................................ 516
Connection options ....................... 494
iPod® ............................................ 494
Mode ............................................. 494
MP3 player .................................... 494
Notes for the MP3 player ............... 499
Playback options ........................... 499
Selecting categories ...................... 497
Selecting folders ............................ 497
Selecting music files ...................... 496
Selecting playlists .......................... 497
Switching on .................................. 495
USB mass storage device .............. 494
see Separate operating instructions
Media list ........................................... 474
Memory card (audio) ......................... 234
Memory function ............................... 123
Mercedes-Benz Contact .................... 427
17
18
Index
Mercedes-Benz emergency call
system
Automatic emergency call ............. 430
Conditions ..................................... 429
Displays in the COMAND display ... 432
Manual emergency call .................. 431
Overview ........................................ 429
Service availability in Europe ......... 429
Transmitted data ........................... 431
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
see Qualified specialist workshop
Message memory (on-board computer) .................................................. 247
Messages
see Display messages
Microphone, switching on/off ......... 398
Mirrors
see Exterior mirrors
see Rear-view mirror
see Vanity mirror (in sun visor)
Mobile phone ............................. 390, 391
Authorising .................................... 391
Connecting (Bluetooth® interface) .............................................. 390
Connecting the telephone module
with Bluetooth® (SAP profile) ........ 421
De-authorising ............................... 393
Disconnecting the telephone
module with Bluetooth® (SAP
profile) ........................................... 426
External authorisation .................... 392
Frequencies ................................... 620
Installation ..................................... 620
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 235
Notes/placing in the bracket ......... 551
Registering (authorising) ................ 391
Transmission output (maximum) .... 620
Modifying the programming (key) ..... 86
MOExtended tyres ............................. 578
Motorway information ...................... 376
Motorway mode ................................ 132
MP3
Bit/sampling rates ......................... 480
Copyright ....................................... 480
Disc ............................................... 479
Fast forward/fast rewind ............... 476
File systems ................................... 479
Formats ......................................... 479
Notes ............................................. 479
Operating ....................................... 234
Pause function ............................... 474
Playback options ........................... 478
Safety notes .................................. 468
Selecting a media type .................. 474
Selecting a track ............................ 475
Sound settings (balance, bass,
treble) ............................................ 299
Switching to ................................... 472
Multifunction display
Function/notes ............................. 230
Permanent display ......................... 239
Multifunction steering wheel
Adjusting the volume ..................... 299
Operating the on-board computer .. 229
Overview .......................................... 43
Selecting a TV channel .................. 504
Multisession CD ................................ 479
MUSIC REGISTER ............................. 484, 485, 486, 487
Copying music data ....................... 485
Deleting all music files ................... 486
Deleting individual music files ....... 487
General notes ................................ 484
Memory space info ........................ 486
Playback options ........................... 487
Switching on .................................. 484
Music search ..................................... 481
My address ........................................ 368
N
Navigation
Adjusting the volume of the navigation announcements ..................
Alternative route ............................
Avoiding an area ............................
Basic settings ................................
Blocking a route section affected
by a traffic jam ...............................
Compass function ..........................
Destination memory ......................
Destination/route download .........
Displaying destination information (arrival time, distance to destination) .........................................
299
357
379
325
357
381
368
444
358
Index
Dynamic route guidance/Live
Traffic Information ......................... 363
Dynamic route guidance/TMC ....... 363
Entering a destination .................... 326
Entering a destination by address .. 326
Entering a destination using the
map ............................................... 333
Entering a POI ................................ 338
Entering characters (character
bar) ................................................ 305
Entering/saving your home
address .......................................... 330
General notes ................................ 323
GPS reception ................................ 323
Important safety notes .................. 323
Lane recommendation ................... 353
List of areas ................................... 380
Map settings .................................. 372
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 233
Motorway information ................... 376
Off-road/off-map (off-road destination) ........................................... 362
Previous destinations .................... 371
Repeating announcements ............ 355
Route guidance .............................. 351
Selecting a destination from the
destination memory ....................... 332
Selecting a destination from the
list of last destinations ................... 333
Selecting your home address ........ 332
Setting options for destination/
route download .............................. 452
Setting route options (avoiding:
motorways, toll roads, tunnels,
ferries) ........................................... 325
Setting the route type (short
route, fast route, dynamic route or
economic route) ............................ 325
Showing/hiding the menu ............. 324
Starting route calculation .............. 329
Switching announcements on/
off .................................................. 355
Switching on .................................. 324
Navigation announcements ............. 299
Switching off .................................. 299
NECK-PRO head restraints
Operation ......................................... 57
Resetting after being triggered ........ 57
Network provider
Telephone module with Bluetooth® (SAP profile) ......................
Night View Assist Plus
Activating/deactivating .................
Cleaning .........................................
Display message ............................
Function/notes .............................
Problem (fault) ...............................
Showing the image on the
COMAND display ...........................
Switching automatic activation
on/off ............................................
North orientation (navigation) .........
Notes on running in a new vehicle ..
424
218
572
262
217
220
322
322
374
154
O
Occupant safety
Airbags ............................................ 52
Important safety notes .................... 50
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant protection) ............................... 56
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) ................................................. 51
Odometer
see Trip meter
Off-map .............................................. 363
Off-road .............................................. 362
Oil
see Engine oil
On-board computer
AMG menu ..................................... 244
Assistance menu ........................... 237
Audio menu ................................... 234
Convenience submenu .................. 243
Display messages .......................... 247
Displaying a service message ........ 567
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 191
Factory setting submenu ............... 244
Important safety notes .................. 228
Instrument cluster submenu .......... 239
Light submenu ............................... 239
Menu overview .............................. 231
Message memory .......................... 247
Navigation menu ............................ 233
Operating the TV ............................ 235
Operating video DVD ..................... 235
19
20
Index
Operation ....................................... 229
RACETIMER ................................... 245
Service menu ................................. 238
Settings menu ............................... 239
Standard display ............................ 231
Telephone menu ............................ 235
Trip menu ...................................... 231
Vehicle submenu ........................... 242
Online and Internet functions
Ending the connection ................... 441
Establishing/ending the connection ................................................ 440
Further Mercedes-Benz Apps ......... 453
Manually setting the access data
of the mobile phone network provider .............................................. 437
Mercedes-Benz Mobile Website ..... 453
Options menu ................................ 450
Resetting adjustments ................... 452
Selecting options for the local
search ............................................ 450
Selecting options for the weather
display ........................................... 451
Selecting the access data of the
mobile phone network provider ..... 435
Setting options for destination/
route download .............................. 452
Specifying the ID for the download ............................................... 452
Operating instructions
Vehicle equipment ........................... 32
Operating safety
Declaration of conformity ................ 33
Important safety note ...................... 32
Operating system
see On-board computer
Outside temperature display ........... 229
Overhead control panel ...................... 47
P
Paint code .......................................... 622
Paintwork (cleaning instructions) ... 570
Panic alarm .......................................... 50
Parking ............................................... 175
Engaging park position .................. 164
Important safety notes .................. 175
Parking brake ................................ 176
Position of exterior mirror, frontpassenger side ............................... 122
Reversing camera .......................... 211
see PARKTRONIC
Parking aid
Active Parking Assist ..................... 207
see Exterior mirrors
see PARKTRONIC
Parking assistance
see PARKTRONIC
Parking brake
Display message ............................ 251
Electric parking brake .................... 176
Warning lamp ................................. 280
Parking lamps
Display message ............................ 257
Switching on/off ........................... 129
PARKTRONIC
Deactivating/activating ................. 206
Driving system ............................... 204
Function/notes ............................. 204
Important safety notes .................. 204
Problem (fault) ............................... 207
Sensor range ................................. 205
Warning display ............................. 205
PASS AIRBAG OFF
see PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF
Indicator lamp .................................. 63
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 70
Pause function
Audio mode (CD, DVD, MP3) ......... 474
Video DVD ..................................... 513
Personal POIs
Acoustic notification ...................... 345
Calling up the menu ....................... 344
Personal special destination ............ 347
Selecting as the destination .......... 347
Personal special destinations ................................... 344, 345, 346
Displaying on the map ................... 344
Managing categories ..................... 345
Saving ............................................ 346
Settings ......................................... 344
Visual information .......................... 344
Petrol .................................................. 624
Index
Phone book ........................................ 402
Adding a number to an address
book entry ..................................... 404
Calling up ....................................... 401
Creating a new entry ..................... 404
Deleting an entry ........................... 403
Entering characters ....................... 303
Searching for an entry ................... 402
Symbol overview ............................ 402
Phone number transmission
Telephone module with Bluetooth® (SAP profile) ...................... 423
Picture settings (TV, video) .............. 502
Picture viewer
Displaying pictures ........................ 518
Introduction ................................... 517
Plastic trim (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 573
Playback options
Audio mode (CD, DVD, MP3) ......... 478
POI (navigation)
Category ........................................ 341
Defining the position for the POI
search ............................................ 340
Entering ......................................... 338
Entering a POI using the map ........ 343
List ................................................. 341
POI icon .............................................. 374
Setting ........................................... 374
POIs (navigation)
see Personal POIs
Power closing ...................................... 93
Power socket
Boot ............................................... 551
Power windows
see Side windows
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant
protection)
Operation ......................................... 56
PRE-SAFE® (preventive occupant
safety system)
Display message ............................ 254
PRE-SAFE® Brake
Activating/deactivating ................. 238
Display message ............................ 254
Function/notes ................................ 77
Warning lamp ................................. 283
Previous destinations (navigation) .. 371
Program selector button .................. 167
Protection of the environment
General notes .................................. 31
Pulling away (automatic transmission) .................................................... 158
Q
Qualified specialist workshop ........... 34
R
RACE START
important safety notes ................... 198
RACETIMER (on-board computer) .... 245
Radar sensor system
Activating/deactivating ................. 242
Display message ............................ 262
Radio
Alphabetical browser ..................... 464
Overview ........................................ 462
RDS (Radio Data System) .............. 467
Selecting a station ......................... 234
Setting a station ............................ 464
Sound settings (balance, bass,
treble) ............................................ 299
Storing stations ............................. 466
Switching on .................................. 462
Switching wavebands .................... 464
Traffic Programme ......................... 467
Radio station ..................................... 466
Storing ........................................... 466
Radio-based vehicle components
Declaration of conformity ................ 33
RDS (Radio Data System)
General notes ................................ 467
Switching on/off ........................... 467
Read-aloud function .......................... 367
Automatic ...................................... 367
Reading lamp ..................................... 134
Rear foglamp
Display message ............................ 256
Switching on/off ........................... 128
Rear lamps
see Lights
Rear Seat Entertainment
Active COMAND source ................. 539
21
22
Index
Adjusting sound settings ............... 525
Adjusting the brightness ................ 526
Adjusting the colour ...................... 526
Adjusting the contrast ................... 526
AUX mode ...................................... 541
CD/DVD audio and MP3 mode ...... 527
Changing the batteries .................. 523
Changing the picture format .......... 526
Cordless headphones .................... 522
Multiple users ................................ 525
Operating with the headphones ..... 525
Picture settings .............................. 526
System settings ............................. 526
TV mode ........................................ 531
Using the main loudspeaker .......... 525
Video DVD mode ........................... 535
Rear window heating
Problem (fault) ............................... 148
Switching on/off ........................... 147
Rear-compartment screens .............. 520
Rear-view mirror
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic) ........ 121
Dipping (manual) ........................... 120
Receiving vCards ............................... 418
Redialling (telephone) ....................... 397
Refuelling
Fuel gauge ....................................... 40
Important safety notes .................. 173
Notes for AMG vehicles ................. 624
Refuelling process ......................... 174
see Fuel
Remote control
Button lighting ............................... 521
Programming (garage door
opener) .......................................... 553
Rear Seat Entertainment System ... 520
Replacing bulbs
General notes ................................ 135
Reserve (fuel tank)
see Fuel
Reserve fuel
Display message ............................ 260
Warning lamp ................................. 280
Reset function ................................... 316
Resetting (factory settings) ............. 316
Residual heat (climate control) ........ 149
Restraint system
see SRS (Supplemental Restraint
System)
Rev counter ........................................ 229
Reverse gear (selector lever) ........... 163
Reversing camera
Cleaning instructions ..................... 572
Displaying the image ..................... 322
Function/notes ............................. 211
Switching on/off ........................... 212
Reversing feature
Side windows ................................... 99
Reversing function
Boot lid ............................................ 94
Reversing lamp (display message) .. 257
Roll bar
Display message ............................ 254
Operation ......................................... 55
Roller sunblind .................................. 109
Roof
Display message ............................ 271
Important safety notes .................. 103
Opening/closing (with key) ........... 105
Opening/closing (with roof
switch) ........................................... 104
Overview ........................................ 103
Problem (malfunction) ................... 110
Relocking ....................................... 105
Roof lining and carpets (cleaning
instructions) ...................................... 574
Roof switch ........................................ 104
Route .................................................. 358
Estimated time of arrival ................ 358
Route (navigation)
Calling up the "Routes" menu ........ 360
Displaying the distance to the destination .......................................... 358
Recording ...................................... 360
Route overview .............................. 359
Selecting an alternative route ........ 357
Setting route options (avoiding:
motorways, toll roads, tunnels,
ferries) ........................................... 325
Setting the route type (short
route, fast route, dynamic route or
economic route) ............................ 325
Starting calculation ........................ 329
Index
Route demonstration ........................
Route guidance ..................................
Cancel ...........................................
Continue ........................................
Destination reached ......................
General information .......................
Lane recommendations .................
Off-road .........................................
359
353
356
356
357
351
353
362
S
Safety
Child restraint systems .................... 61
Safety notes .............................. 468, 511
Audio CD/DVD and MP3 mode ..... 468
Using the telephone ....................... 387
Video DVD mode ........................... 511
Safety system
see Driving safety systems
Saving the crosshair position .......... 373
Screen ................................................ 520
Selecting for remote operation ...... 520
SD memory card
Ejecting .......................................... 472
Inserting ........................................ 472
Seat
Balance (seat heating) ................... 320
Resetting adjustments ................... 322
Seat functions (COMAND Online) .. 318
Selecting for adjustment
(COMAND Online) .......................... 319
Seat belt
Seat belt guide ............................... 115
Switching belt adjustment on/off
(on-board computer) ...................... 243
Seat belts
Adjusting the driver's and frontpassenger seat belt ......................... 59
Belt force limiter .............................. 60
Belt tensioner .................................. 60
Cleaning ......................................... 574
Fastening ......................................... 59
Important safety guidelines ............. 57
Releasing ......................................... 59
Warning lamp ................................. 274
Warning lamp (function) ................... 60
Seats
Active multicontour seat ................ 319
Adjusting (electrically) ...................
Adjusting lumbar support
(COMAND Online) ..........................
Adjusting the head restraint ..........
Belt guide ......................................
Cleaning the cover .........................
Correct driver's seat position ........
Important safety notes ..................
Multicontour seat ..........................
Overview ........................................
Seat heating problem ....................
Seat ventilation problem ................
Sliding forward/back .....................
Storing settings (memory function) ...............................................
Switching AIRSCARF on/off ..........
Switching seat heating on/off .......
Switching the seat ventilation on/
off ..................................................
Selecting channels
TV ..................................................
Selecting the country .......................
Selector lever
Cleaning .........................................
Positions ........................................
Sensors (cleaning instructions) .......
Service
see ASSYST PLUS
Service menu (on-board computer) ..................................................
Service products
Brake fluid .....................................
Coolant (engine) ............................
Engine oil .......................................
Fuel ................................................
Important safety notes ..................
Washer fluid ...................................
Setting the air distribution ...............
Setting the airflow ............................
Setting the audio format
Audio DVD .....................................
Rear Seat Entertainment System ...
Video DVD .....................................
Setting the date format ....................
Setting the day design ......................
Setting the language
COMAND .......................................
114
319
115
115
573
112
113
319
113
117
117
115
123
117
116
117
503
327
573
163
571
238
627
627
626
623
622
628
145
146
478
539
515
311
310
313
23
24
Index
Rear Seat Entertainment System ... 539
Setting the night design ................... 310
Setting the read-aloud speed ........... 312
Setting the reception region (TV)
Rear Seat Entertainment System ... 534
Setting the volume
Telephone calls .............................. 299
Video-AUX ..................................... 517
Settings
Basic TV settings ........................... 507
Factory (on-board computer) ......... 244
Menu overview .............................. 291
On-board computer ....................... 239
Picture (COMAND) ......................... 502
Ringtone telephone module with
Bluetooth® (SAP profile) ............... 423
Sound settings ............................... 299
Telephone module with Bluetooth® (SAP profile) ...................... 423
SETUP (on-board computer) ............. 244
Side lamps
Switching on/off ........................... 128
Side windows
Convenience closing ...................... 101
Important safety notes .................... 99
Opening/closing (front) ................. 100
Opening/closing (rear) .................. 100
Opening/closing all ....................... 100
Overview .......................................... 99
Problem (malfunction) ................... 103
Resetting ....................................... 102
Sidebag ................................................ 54
SIM card
Inserting ........................................ 421
Removing ....................................... 421
SIM card mode
Telephone module with Bluetooth® (SAP profile) ...................... 421
Snow chains ...................................... 599
Socket
Charge maintenance socket .......... 552
Front-passenger footwell ............... 550
Under the armrest ......................... 551
Sockets
General notes ................................ 550
Sound
Switching on/off ........................... 298
Sound menu ....................................... 299
Sound Modus ..................................... 302
Sound settings
Calling up the sound menu ............ 299
Surround sound ............................. 300
Special destination list ..................... 342
With character bar ......................... 342
Specialist workshop ............................ 34
Spectacles compartment ................. 545
Speed dial list .................................... 407
Storing a phone book entry in the
speed dial list ................................ 407
Speed Limit Assist
Activating/deactivating the warning function .................................... 237
Display message ............................ 262
Display message in the multifunction display .................................... 216
Function/notes ............................. 215
Important safety notes .................. 215
Notes (navigation) ......................... 378
Speed limit assistant ........................ 378
Speed, controlling
see Cruise control
Speedometer
Digital ............................................ 232
In the Instrument cluster ................. 40
Segments ...................................... 229
Selecting the unit of measurement .............................................. 239
SPEEDTRONIC
Deactivating variable ..................... 196
Display message ............................ 265
Function/notes ............................. 193
Important safety notes .................. 194
LIM indicator lamp ......................... 194
Permanent ..................................... 196
Selecting ........................................ 195
Storing the current speed .............. 195
Variable ......................................... 194
SPLITVIEW ......................................... 308
SPORT handling mode
Activating/deactivating (AMG
vehicles) .......................................... 75
Warning lamp ................................. 278
Index
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
Display message ............................ 255
Introduction ..................................... 51
Warning lamp ................................. 280
Warning lamp (function) ................... 51
Start/stop function
see ECO start/stop function
Starting (engine) ................................ 157
Station list ......................................... 464
Station pre-sets ................................. 465
Station search ................................... 465
STEER CONTROL .................................. 78
Steering (display message) .............. 271
Steering wheel
Adjusting (electrically) ................... 118
Button overview ............................... 43
Buttons (on-board computer) ......... 229
Cleaning ......................................... 573
Gearshift paddles ........................... 169
Important safety notes .................. 118
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 123
Steering wheel gearshift paddles .... 169
Stop function
Audio DVD ..................................... 474
Video DVD ..................................... 513
Stopwatch (RACETIMER) ................... 245
Storing channels
TV .................................................. 505
Storing stations
Radio ............................................. 466
Stowage areas ................................... 544
Stowage compartments
Armrest (under) ............................. 545
Centre console .............................. 545
Centre console (rear) ..................... 546
Cup holder ..................................... 548
Glove compartment ....................... 544
Important safety information ......... 544
Rear ............................................... 546
Spectacles compartment ............... 545
Stowage net ....................................... 546
Stowage space
Display message ............................ 271
Stowage net ................................... 546
Umbrella holder ............................. 545
Stowage well beneath the boot
floor ....................................................
Street View ........................................
Summer tyres ....................................
Sun visor ............................................
Supplemental Restraint System
see SRS (Supplemental Restraint
System)
Surround lighting (on-board computer) ..................................................
Surround sound .................................
Surround sound (harman/
kardon® surround sound system)
Notes .............................................
Switching on/off ...........................
Suspension tuning
Active Body Control (AMG vehicles) ...............................................
Active Body Control (except AMG
vehicles) ........................................
SETUP (on-board computer) ..........
Switching between summer and
standard time ....................................
Switching wavelength (radio) ..........
System settings
Bluetooth® ....................................
Date ...............................................
Language .......................................
LINGUATRONIC (voice control) ......
Text reader speed ..........................
Time ...............................................
Time zone ......................................
548
335
598
549
241
300
300
301
203
200
244
311
464
313
311
313
312
312
311
311
T
Tail lamps
Display message ............................ 256
see Lights
Tank
see Fuel tank
Technical data
Capacities ...................................... 622
Emergency spare wheel ................. 617
Information .................................... 620
Tyres/wheels ................................. 610
Vehicle data ................................... 629
Telephone .................................. 397, 399
Accepting a call ............................. 236
25
26
Index
Accepting or rejecting a waiting
call .................................................
Accepting/ending call ...................
Adjusting the volume for calls .......
Automatically reconnecting
mobile phone .................................
Calling (outgoing call) ....................
Conference connection ..................
Connecting a Mobile phone (general information) ............................
Deregistering (de-authorising) a
mobile phone .................................
Display message ............................
Ending an active call ......................
Entering a number .........................
Entering phone numbers ................
External authorisation (Bluetooth®) ..........................................
Function restrictions ......................
General notes ................................
Incoming call .................................
Making a call .................................
Making a call via speed dial ...........
Menu (on-board computer) ............
Number from the phone book ........
Operating options ..........................
Overview of functions ....................
Reception and transmission volume ...............................................
Redialling .......................................
Rejecting a call ..............................
Rejecting/ending a call .................
Safety notes ..................................
Sending DTMF tones ......................
Single call ......................................
Switching hands-free microphone
on/off ............................................
Telephone compartment ................
Text message (SMS) ......................
Toggling .........................................
Using the telephone .......................
see Bluetooth®
Telephone basic menu ......................
Bluetooth® interface .....................
Telephone mode
Redialling .......................................
399
396
299
393
397
400
390
393
271
400
397
397
392
388
387
396
399
397
235
236
388
398
396
236
396
236
387
398
398
398
545
409
400
396
394
394
397
Telephone module with Bluetooth® (SAP profile)
Activating the module ....................
Call lists .........................................
Charging a mobile phone ...............
Connecting the mobile phone ........
Data modem mode ........................
Data roaming .................................
Deactivating the module ................
Disconnecting the mobile phone ...
Installing the module .....................
Network provider ...........................
Phone number transmission ..........
Removing the module ....................
Resetting the module .....................
Saving/deleting the PIN for the
SIM card ........................................
Setting the ringtone .......................
Settings .........................................
SIM card mode ..............................
Speed-dial keys .............................
Text messages ...............................
Transferring the phone book ..........
Telephone number
Entering .........................................
Teletext
TV (Rear Seat Entertainment System) ...............................................
Teletext (TV) ......................................
Temperature
Coolant ..........................................
Coolant (on-board computer) .........
Engine oil (on-board computer) ......
Outside temperature ......................
Setting (climate control) ................
TEMPOMAT
Function/notes .............................
Text message (SMS)
Call sender ....................................
Deleting .........................................
Inbox ..............................................
Reading ..........................................
Reading aloud ................................
Storing sender in address book .....
Storing the sender as a new
address book entry ........................
420
425
426
421
423
424
427
426
420
424
423
427
426
423
423
423
421
425
425
424
397
535
508
228
244
244
229
145
182
410
411
409
410
410
411
411
Index
Text messages
Telephone module with Bluetooth® (SAP profile) ...................... 425
Text messages (SMS)
Notes and requirements ................ 409
Theft-deterrent system
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 79
Immobiliser ...................................... 79
Time
Setting ........................................... 312
Setting summer/standard time ..... 311
Setting the format ......................... 311
Setting the time ............................. 311
Setting the time manually .............. 311
Setting the time zone ..................... 311
Setting the time/date format ........ 311
Timing (RACETIMER) ......................... 245
TIREFIT kit .......................................... 579
TMC (Traffic Message Channel)
Displays on the map ...................... 365
Switching dynamic route guidance on/off ................................... 364
Tone settings ..................................... 300
Balance and fader .......................... 300
Total distance recorder .................... 231
Tow-away protection
Activating ......................................... 80
Deactivating ..................................... 80
Function ........................................... 80
Tow-starting
Emergency engine starting ............ 591
Important safety notes .................. 588
Towing
Important safety notes .................. 588
With the rear axle raised ................ 590
Towing away
Fitting the towing eye .................... 589
Removing the towing eye ............... 590
With both axles on the ground ....... 591
Track
Selecting (CD, DVD, MP3) .............. 475
Selecting using the number keypad ................................................ 475
Track information .............................. 530
Traffic Announcement (TA)
Interrupting .................................... 468
Notes ............................................. 467
Switching on/off ........................... 467
Traffic jam function ........................... 357
Traffic jam icon .................................. 365
Showing on route ........................... 365
Traffic jam message .......................... 367
Reading out on route ..................... 367
Traffic jams ........................................ 365
Showing in the map ....................... 365
Traffic Message Channel
see TMC (Traffic Message Channel)
Traffic messages
see Dynamic route guidance/TMC
Traffic Programme (TA)
Switching off .................................. 299
Traffic reports ........................... 365, 367
Reading out on route ..................... 367
Real-time traffic news .................... 366
Showing in the map ....................... 365
Showing on route ........................... 365
Traffic symbol information ............. 365
Transmission
Selector lever ................................ 163
see Automatic transmission
Transporting the vehicle .................. 591
Travel guide
Activating/deactivating data ......... 348
Calling up ....................................... 349
Choosing topics ............................. 350
Exploring a destination or route ..... 350
Selecting a destination or route on
the map ......................................... 350
ViaMichelin .................................... 348
Trim pieces (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 573
Trip computer (on-board computer) .................................................. 231
Trip meter
Calling up ....................................... 231
Resetting (on-board computer) ...... 232
True Image™ ...................................... 302
Turn signals
Switching on/off ........................... 129
TV
Alphabetical browser ..................... 506
Automatic picture shutoff .............. 501
Digital teletext (MHEG-5) ............... 508
Fixing a channel ............................. 507
27
28
Index
Further options ..............................
Information about the current programme .........................................
Operating (on-board computer) .....
Picture settings ..............................
Programme preview .......................
Reception quality ...........................
Selecting channels (COMAND
Online) ...........................................
Selecting channels (Rear Seat
Entertainment System) ..................
Selecting language and subtitles ...
Setting the reception region ..........
Showing/hiding the menu .............
Showing/hiding the navigation
menu .............................................
Sound settings (balance, bass,
treble) ............................................
Storing channels (COMAND
Online) ...........................................
Storing channels (Rear Seat
Entertainment System) ..................
Switching on ..................................
Teletext ..........................................
Two-way radio
Frequencies ...................................
Installation .....................................
Transmission output (maximum) ....
Type identification plate
see Vehicle identification plate
Tyre pressure
Calling up (on-board computer) .....
Display message ............................
Important safety notes ..................
Not reached (TIREFIT) ....................
Reached (TIREFIT) ..........................
Recommended ...............................
Tyre pressure loss warning
General notes ................................
Important safety notes ..................
Restarting ......................................
Tyre pressure monitor
Checking the tyre pressure electronically ........................................
Function/notes .............................
General notes ................................
Important safety notes ..................
509
506
235
502
506
502
503
532
509
507
503
503
299
505
533
502
508
620
620
620
602
267
602
581
581
600
601
601
601
603
602
602
602
Radio type approval for the tyre
pressure monitor ...........................
Restarting ......................................
Warning lamp .................................
Warning message ..........................
Tyres
Changing a wheel ..........................
Checking ........................................
Direction of rotation ......................
Display message ............................
Important safety notes ..................
M+S tyres ......................................
MOExtended tyres .........................
Overview ........................................
Replacing .......................................
Service life .....................................
Storing ...........................................
Summer tyres ................................
Tyre size (data) ..............................
Tyre tread ......................................
Wheel and tyre combinations ........
see Flat tyre
605
604
284
604
605
597
605
267
596
598
598
596
605
597
606
598
610
597
612
U
Umbrella holder ................................. 545
Unlocking
Emergency unlocking ....................... 93
From inside the vehicle (central
unlocking button) ............................. 92
Updating the digital map .................. 382
USB
see Media Interface
V
Vanity mirror (in sun visor) .............. 549
Variable SPEEDTRONIC
see SPEEDTRONIC
Vehicle
Correct use ...................................... 34
Data acquisition ....................... 35, 287
Display message ............................ 269
Electronics ..................................... 620
Equipment ....................................... 32
Implied warranty .............................. 35
Individual settings .......................... 239
Leaving parked up ......................... 178
Index
Locking (in an emergency) ............... 93
Locking (key) ................................... 85
Lowering ........................................ 609
Pulling away ................................... 158
Raising ........................................... 607
Registration ..................................... 34
Securing from rolling away ............ 606
Tow-starting ................................... 588
Towing away .................................. 588
Transporting .................................. 591
Unlocking (in an emergency) ........... 93
Unlocking (key) ................................ 85
Vehicle data ................................... 629
Vehicle battery
see Battery (vehicle)
Vehicle data ....................................... 629
Vehicle dimensions ........................... 629
Vehicle emergency locking ................ 93
Vehicle identification number
see VIN
Vehicle identification plate .............. 622
Vehicle level
Active Body Control (AMG vehicles) ............................................... 202
Active Body Control (except AMG
vehicles) ........................................ 199
Display message ............................ 260
Vehicle tool kit .................................. 577
Video
Operating the DVD ......................... 235
see Video DVD
Video DVD .......................................... 514
Automatic picture shutoff .............. 501
Data carrier .................................... 511
DVD menu ..................................... 514
Fast forward/rewind ...................... 513
Function restrictions ...................... 511
Interactive content ........................ 516
Operation ....................................... 511
Pause function ............................... 513
Playing conditions .......................... 511
Safety notes .................................. 511
Selecting ........................................ 514
Selecting a film/title ...................... 514
Selecting a scene/chapter ............ 513
Setting the audio format ................ 515
Setting the language ...................... 515
Setting the picture .........................
Showing/hiding the menu .............
Showing/hiding the navigation
menu .............................................
Stop function .................................
Subtitles ........................................
Switching on ..................................
Video-AUX
Setting the picture .........................
VIN ......................................................
502
512
512
513
516
512
502
622
W
Warning and indicator lamps
ABS ................................................ 275
Brakes ........................................... 275
Distance warning signal ................. 283
ESP® ............................................. 277
ESP® OFF ...................................... 278
LIM (cruise control) ........................ 182
LIM (DISTRONIC PLUS) .................. 186
LIM (variable SPEEDTRONIC) ......... 194
Overview .......................................... 42
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF ................ 63
Reserve fuel ................................... 280
Seat belt ........................................ 274
SRS ................................................ 280
Tyre pressure monitor ................... 284
Warning triangle ................................ 576
Washer fluid
Display message ............................ 272
Waypoints .......................... 335, 337, 338
Accepting waypoints for the
route .............................................. 338
Creating ......................................... 335
Editing ........................................... 337
Entering ......................................... 335
Searching for a filling station when
the fuel level is low ........................ 338
Weather display (COMAND
Online) ........................................ 447, 448
Calling up the weather map ........... 448
Information chart ........................... 447
Selecting locations in the information chart ....................................... 447
Selecting the location .................... 447
Selecting the location in the
weather map .................................. 448
29
30
Index
Switching off .................................. 447
Switching on .................................. 447
Weather map (COMAND
Online) ........................................ 448, 449
Legend ........................................... 449
Showing/hiding the menu ............. 448
Switching to the weather information display .................................... 449
Website .............................................. 458
Adding to favourites ....................... 458
Wheel and tyre combinations
see Tyres
Wheel bolt tightening torque ........... 609
Wheel chock ...................................... 606
Wheels
Changing a wheel .......................... 605
Changing/replacing ....................... 605
Checking ........................................ 597
Cleaning ......................................... 570
Cleaning (warning) ......................... 606
Emergency spare wheel ................. 614
Fitting a new wheel ........................ 609
Fitting a wheel ............................... 606
Important safety notes .................. 596
Overview ........................................ 596
Removing a wheel .......................... 608
Storing ........................................... 606
Tightening torque ........................... 609
Wheel size/tyre size ...................... 610
Windows
Cleaning ......................................... 570
see Side windows
Windscreen
Demisting ...................................... 146
Windscreen washer fluid
see Windscreen washer system
Windscreen washer system
Notes ............................................. 628
Topping up ..................................... 566
Windscreen wipers
Display message ............................ 272
Problem (malfunction) ................... 138
Replacing the wiper blades ............ 136
Switching on/off ........................... 135
Winter operation
Important safety notes .................. 598
Overview ........................................ 598
Slippery road surfaces ................... 181
Snow chains ..................................
Winter tyres
Limiting the speed (on-board computer) .............................................
M+S tyres ......................................
Wiper blades
Cleaning .........................................
Important safety notes ..................
Replacing .......................................
Wooden trim (cleaning instructions) ..................................................
Workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
599
242
598
571
136
136
573
Z
ZONE function
Switching on/off ........................... 146
Introduction
Protection of the environment
General notes
H Environmental note
Daimler's declared policy is one of comprehensive environmental protection.
Our objectives are to use the natural resources which form the basis of our existence on
this planet sparingly and in a manner which
takes the requirements of both nature and
humanity into consideration.
You too can help to protect the environment
by operating your vehicle in an environmentally-responsible manner.
Fuel consumption and the rate of engine,
transmission, brake and tyre wear depend on
the following factors:
Roperating
conditions of your vehicle
personal driving style
You can influence both factors. Therefore,
please bear the following in mind:
Operating conditions:
Ryour
short trips, as these increase fuel
consumption.
Robserve the correct tyre pressure.
Rdo not carry any unnecessary weight in the
vehicle.
Rremove the roof rack once you no longer
need it.
Ra regularly serviced vehicle will contribute
to environmental protection. You should
therefore adhere to the service intervals.
Rall maintenance work should be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
Personal driving style:
Rchange gear in good time and use each gear
only up to Ô of its maximum engine speed.
off the engine in stationary traffic.
Rmonitor the vehicle's fuel consumption.
Rswitch
Returning an end-of-life vehicle
EU countries only:
Mercedes-Benz will take back your old vehicle
to dispose of it in an environmentally-responsible manner in accordance with the European Union (EU) End of Life Vehicles Directive.
There is a network of return points and disassembly plants available. You can return
your vehicle to these plants free of charge.
This makes a valuable contribution to the
recycling process and the conservation of
resources.
For further information on recycling old vehicles, recovery and the terms of the policy,
visit the Mercedes-Benz homepage.
Ravoid
Rdo not depress the accelerator pedal when
starting the engine.
Rdo not warm up the engine when the vehicle
is stationary.
Rdrive carefully and maintain a safe distance
from the vehicle in front.
Ravoid frequent, sudden acceleration and
braking.
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts
H Environmental note
Daimler AG also supplies reconditioned
assemblies and parts which are of the same
quality as new parts. For these, the same warranty applies as for new parts.
! Airbags and seat belt tensioners, as well
as control units and sensors for these
restraint systems, may be installed in the
following areas of your vehicle:
Rdoors
Rdoor
pillars
sills
Rseats
Rdashboard
Rinstrument cluster
Rcentre console
Rdoor
Z
31
32
Introduction
Do not install accessories such as audio
systems in these areas. Do not carry out
repairs or welding. You could impair the
operating efficiency of the restraint systems.
Have accessories retrofitted at a qualified
specialist workshop.
You could jeopardise the operating safety of
your vehicle if you use parts, tyres and wheels
as well as accessories relevant to safety
which have not been approved by Mercedes.
This could lead to malfunctions in safety-relevant systems, e.g. the brake system. Use
only genuine Mercedes-Benz parts or parts of
equal quality. Only use tyres, wheels and
accessories that have been specifically
approved for your vehicle.
Mercedes-Benz tests genuine parts and conversion parts and accessories that have been
specifically approved for your vehicle for their
reliability, safety and suitability. Despite
ongoing market research, Mercedes-Benz is
unable to assess other parts. Mercedes-Benz
therefore accepts no responsibility for the
use of such parts in Mercedes-Benz vehicles,
even if they have been officially approved or
independently approved by a testing centre.
In Germany, certain parts are only officially
approved for installation or modification if
they comply with legal requirements. This
also applies to some other countries. All genuine Mercedes-Benz parts meet the approval
requirements. The use of non-approved parts
may invalidate the vehicle's general operating
permit.
This is the case:
Rif
they cause a change of the vehicle type
from that for which the vehicle's general
operating permit was granted
Rif other road users could be endangered
Rif the emission or noise levels are adversely
affected
Always specify the vehicle identification number (VIN) when ordering genuine MercedesBenz parts (Y page 622).
Owner's Manual
Vehicle equipment
This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment
available for your vehicle at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Note that your
vehicle may not be fitted with all features
described. This is also the case for systems
and functions relevant to safety. Therefore,
the equipment on your vehicle may differ from
that in the descriptions and illustrations.
The original purchase contract documentation for your vehicle contains a list of all of the
systems in your vehicle.
Should you have any questions concerning
equipment and operation, please consult a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
The Owner's Manual and Service Booklet are
important documents and should kept in the
vehicle.
Operating safety
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you do not have the prescribed service/
maintenance work or necessary repairs carried out, this could result in malfunctions or
system failures. There is a risk of an accident.
Always have the prescribed service/maintenance work as well as necessary repairs carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
Introduction
G WARNING
Flammable material such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact with
hot parts of the exhaust system. There is a risk
of fire.
When driving off road or on unpaved roads,
check the vehicle's underside regularly. In
particular, remove parts of plants or other
flammable materials which have become
trapped. In the case of damage, contact a
qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Modifications to electronic components, their
software as well as wiring could effect their
function and/or the operation of other networked components. This could in particular
also be the case for systems relevant to
safety. They might not function properly any
more and/or jeopardise the operational
safety of the vehicle. There is an increased
risk of an accident and injury.
Do not attempt to modify the wiring as well as
electronic components or their software.
Always have work on electrical and electronic
components carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
If the underbody panelling is damaged,
combustible materials such as leaves,
grass or twigs can gather between the
underbody and the underbody panelling. If
these materials come in contact with hot
parts of the exhaust system, they can catch
fire.
In such situations, have the vehicle
checked and repaired immediately at a
qualified specialist workshop. If, upon continuing your journey, you notice that driving
safety is impaired, pull over and stop the
vehicle immediately, paying attention to
road and traffic conditions. In such cases,
visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Declarations of conformity
Wireless vehicle components
If you make any changes to the vehicle electronics, the general operating permit is rendered invalid.
The following information applies to all components of the vehicle and the information
systems and communication devices integrated into the vehicle which receive and/or
transmit radio waves:
The components of this vehicle that receive
and/or transmit radio waves are compliant
with the basic requirements and all other relevant conditions of Directive 1999/5/EC.
You can obtain further information from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
! There is a risk of damage to the vehicle if:
Electromagnetic compatibility
Rthe vehicle becomes stuck, e.g. on a high
kerb or an unpaved road
Ryou drive too fast over an obstacle, e.g. a
kerb or a pothole in the road
Ra heavy object strikes the underbody or
parts of the chassis
In situations like this, the body, the underbody, chassis parts, wheels or tyres could
be damaged without the damage being visible. Components damaged in this way can
unexpectedly fail or, in the case of an accident, no longer withstand the strain they
are designed for.
The electromagnetic compatibility of the vehicle components has been checked and certified according to the currently valid version of
Regulation ECE-R 10.
Diagnostics connection
The diagnostics connection is only intended
for the connection of diagnostic equipment at
a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
33
34
Introduction
G WARNING
If you connect equipment to a diagnostics
connection in the vehicle, it can affect the
operation of the vehicle systems. This may
affect the operating safety of the vehicle.
There is a risk of an accident.
Do not connect any equipment to a diagnostics connection in the vehicle.
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the operating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as prescribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
! If the engine is switched off and equipment on the diagnostics connection is
used, the starter battery may discharge.
Connecting equipment to the diagnostics
connection can lead to emissions monitoring
information being reset, for example. This
may lead to the vehicle failing to meet the
requirements of the next emissions test during the main inspection.
Qualified specialist workshop
A qualified specialist workshop has the necessary special skills, tools and qualifications
to correctly carry out any necessary work on
your vehicle. This particularly applies to work
relevant to safety.
Observe the notes in the Service Booklet.
Always have the following work carried out at
a qualified specialist workshop:
Rwork
relevant to safety
and maintenance work
Rservice
Rrepair
work
Rmodifications,
installations and conversions
Rwork on electronic components
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Vehicle registration
Mercedes-Benz may ask its Service Centres
to carry out technical inspections on certain
vehicles. The quality or safety of the vehicle is
improved as a result of the inspection.
Mercedes-Benz can only inform you about
vehicle checks if it has your registration data.
It is possible that your vehicle has not yet
been registered in your name in the following
cases:
Rif
your vehicle was not purchased at an
authorised specialist dealer.
Rif your vehicle has not yet been examined at
a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
It is advisable to register your vehicle with a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Inform Mercedes-Benz as soon as possible
about any change in address or vehicle ownership. You can do this at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre, for example.
Correct use
If you remove any warning stickers, you or
others could fail to recognise certain dangers.
Leave warning stickers in position.
Observe the following information when driving your vehicle:
Rthe
safety notes in this manual
technical data in this manual
Rtraffic rules and regulations
Rlaws and safety standards pertaining to
motor vehicles
Rthe
Introduction
Implied warranty
! Follow the instructions in this manual
about the proper operation of your vehicle
as well as about possible vehicle damage.
Damage to your vehicle that arises from
culpable contraventions against these
instructions are not covered either by
Mercedes-Benz implied warranty or by the
New or Used-Vehicle Warranty.
Data stored in the vehicle
A wide range of electronic components in
your vehicle contain data memories.
These data memories temporarily or permanently store technical information about:
Rthe
vehicle's operating state
Revents
Rfaults
In general, this technical information documents the state of a component, a module, a
system or the surroundings.
These include, for example:
Roperating
conditions of system components, e.g. fluid levels
Rthe vehicle's status messages and those of
its individual components, e.g. number of
wheel revolutions/speed, deceleration in
movement, lateral acceleration, accelerator pedal position
Rmalfunctions and defects in important system components, e.g. lights, brakes
Rvehicle reactions and operating conditions
in special driving situations, e.g. airbag
deployment, intervention of stability control systems
Rambient conditions, e.g. outside temperature
This data is of an exclusively technical nature
and can be used to:
Rassist
in recognising and rectifying faults
and defects
Ranalyse vehicle functions, e.g. after an accident
Roptimise vehicle functions
The data cannot be used to trace the vehicle's
movements.
When your vehicle is serviced, technical information can be read from the event data memory and fault data memory.
Services include, for example:
Rrepair
services
processes
Rwarranty events
Rquality assurance
It is read by employees of the service network
(including manufacturers) using special diagnostic testers. More detailed information is
obtained from it, if required.
After a fault has been rectified, the information is deleted from the fault memory or is
continually overwritten.
When operating the vehicle, situations are
conceivable in which this technical data, in
connection with other information (if necessary, under consultation with an authorised
expert), could be traced to a person.
Examples include:
Rservice
Raccident
reports
to the vehicle
Rwitness statements
Further additional functions that have been
contractually agreed upon with the customer
allow certain vehicle data to be conveyed by
the vehicle as well. The additional functions
include, for example, vehicle location in case
of an emergency.
Rdamage
Z
35
36
Introduction
Copyright information
General notes
Information on licences for free and opensource software used in your vehicle and its
electronic components is available on the following website:
http://www.mercedes-benz.com/
opensource
37
Cockpit ................................................. 38
Multifunction steering wheel ............. 43
Centre console .................................... 44
Overhead control panel ...................... 47
Door control panel .............................. 48
At a glance
Instrument cluster .............................. 40
38
Cockpit
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
:
Steering wheel gearshift
paddles
169
;
Combination switch
129
=
Adjusts the steering wheel
electrically
118
?
Horn
A
Instrument cluster
B
PARKTRONIC warning display
C
Overhead control panel
47
D
Climate control systems
140
40
204
Function
Page
E
Ignition lock
Start/Stop button
155
155
F
Cruise control lever
182
G
Activates Night View Assist
Plus
218
H
Electric parking brake
176
I
Light switch
126
J
Opens the bonnet
563
K
Diagnostics connection
33
39
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
:
Overhead control panel
;
PARKTRONIC warning display
204
=
Combination switch
129
?
Adjusts the steering wheel
electrically
118
A
Horn
B
Instrument cluster
C
Steering wheel gearshift
paddles
169
D
Diagnostics connection
33
47
40
Function
Page
E
Opens the bonnet
563
F
Activates Night View Assist
Plus
218
G
Light switch
126
H
Electric parking brake
176
I
Ignition lock
Start/Stop button
155
155
J
Cruise control lever
182
K
Climate control systems
140
40
Instrument cluster
At a glance
Instrument cluster
Displays and controls
i Instrument cluster: kilometres
Function
:
Speedometer with segments
;
Fuel gauge
=
Rev counter
Function
Page
229
229
Page
?
Coolant temperature
228
A
Multifunction display
230
B
Instrument cluster lighting
228
41
At a glance
Instrument cluster
i Instrument cluster: miles
Function
:
Speedometer with segments
;
Fuel gauge
=
Rev counter
Function
Page
229
229
Page
?
Coolant temperature
228
A
Multifunction display
230
B
Instrument cluster lighting
228
42
Instrument cluster
At a glance
Warning and indicator lamps
Function
Page
Function
Page
F
6 SRS
280
G
ü Seat belt
274
H
M SPORT handling
mode (AMG vehicles)
278
I
? Coolant
281
J
R Rear foglamp
128
K
; Engine diagnostics
280
L
8 Reserve fuel
:
L Dipped-beam headlamps
127
;
T Side lamps
128
=
÷ ESP®
277
?
K Main-beam headlamps
130
A
! Electric parking brake
(red)
280
B
! Electric parking brake
(yellow)
280
M
å ESP® OFF
277
C
· Distance warning
283
N
! ABS
275
D
#! Turn signals
129
O
J Brakes
275
E
h Tyre pressure monitor
284
Multifunction steering wheel
43
At a glance
Multifunction steering wheel
Function
Page
:
Multifunction display
230
;
COMAND display
289
=
?
Switches on LINGUATRONIC; see the separate
operating instructions
?
~
Rejects or ends a call
Exits telephone book/
redial memory
6
Makes or accepts a call
Switches to the redial memory
WX
Adjusts the volume
8
Mute
235
Function
A
B
=;
Selects a menu
9:
Selects a submenu or
scrolls through lists
a
Confirms the selection
Hides display messages
%
Back
Switches off LINGUATRONIC; see the separate
operating instructions
Page
229
229
229
247
229
44
Centre console
At a glance
Centre console
Centre console, upper section
Function
Page
:
COMAND Online
294
;
c Seat heating
116
=
s Seat ventilation
117
?
Ò AIRSCARF
117
A
c PARKTRONIC
204
B
£ Hazard warning
lamps
130
Function
C
a PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF indicator lamp
D
å ESP® (except AMG
vehicles)
¤ start/stop function
(AMG vehicles)
Page
63
74
158
Centre console
45
At a glance
Centre console, lower section (except AMG vehicles)
Function
:
Page
Stowage compartment
Cup holders
Ashtray
545
548
549
;
COMAND controller
296
=
Seat adjustment
318
?
Favourites button
313
A
Roof switch
104
B
Opens/closes the side windows
100
C
Extends/retracts the
draught stop
108
D
Stowage compartment with
Media Interface
Cigarette lighter
Power socket
545
550
551
Selects park position
163
E
Function
Page
F
¤ start/stop button
158
G
Shows the driving conditions menu in the COMAND
display (vehicles with
Active Body Control)
201
H
É Sets the vehicle level
199
I
Adjusts the suspension settings
Sets the suspension tuning
(vehicles with Active Body
Control)
J
199
200
Ú Selects the drive program/program selector
button
167
K
Transmission positions
166
L
Selector lever
163
46
Centre console
At a glance
Centre console, lower section (AMG vehicles)
Function
:
Page
Stowage compartment
Cup holders
Ashtray
545
548
549
;
COMAND controller
296
=
Seat adjustment
318
?
Favourites button
313
A
Roof switch
104
B
Opens/closes the side windows
100
C
Extends/retracts the
draught stop
108
D
Stowage compartment with
Media Interface
Cigarette lighter
Power socket
545
550
551
Function
Page
E
Selects park position
163
F
Drive program selector
168
G
ß button (drive program
or calling up/storing suspension tuning)
168
à Adjusts the suspension setting
203
H
I
å
J
Transmission positions
166
K
Selector lever
163
ESP®
74
Overhead control panel
47
At a glance
Overhead control panel
Function
Page
:
p Switches the lefthand reading lamp on/off
134
;
c Switches the interior
lighting on/off
134
=
µ Operates MAGIC SKY
CONTROL
109
?
| Switches the automatic interior lighting control on/off
134
p Switches the righthand reading lamp on/off
134
A
Function
Page
B
ë Deactivates towaway protection
C
Rear-view mirror
120
D
Buttons for the garage door
opener
555
E
ê Deactivates the interior motion sensor
80
F
Spectacles compartment
545
80
48
Door control panel
At a glance
Door control panel
Function
Page
:
Opens the door
91
;
% & Unlocks/locks
the vehicle
92
=
Adjusts the seats
?
r 45 =
Stores settings for the seat,
exterior mirrors and steering wheel (memory function)
w Adjusts the frontpassenger seat from the
driver’s seat
113
Function
A
B
C
123
114
o Opens the boot lid
p Opens/closes the
boot lid
7Zö\
Adjusts and folds the exterior mirrors in/out electrically
W Opens/closes the
side windows
Page
98
98
120
99
49
Useful information .............................. 50
Panic alarm .......................................... 50
Occupant safety .................................. 50
Driving safety systems ....................... 70
Anti-theft systems .............................. 79
Safety
Child restraint systems ...................... 61
Occupant safety
50
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
Safety
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 34).
Panic alarm
To activate: press ! button : for
approximately one second.
An alarm sounds and the exterior lighting
flashes.
X To deactivate: press ! button :
again.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
or
X Press the KEYLESS-GO Start/Stop button.
The KEYLESS-GO key must be in the vehicle.
X
i The panic alarm function is only available
in certain countries.
Occupant safety
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Modifications to the restraint systems could
result in them not functioning properly any
more. The restraint systems could then no
longer protect vehicle occupants as they are
designed to do and could fail in the event of an
accident or activate unexpectedly, for example. There is an increased risk of injury.
Never modify parts of the restraint systems.
Do not attempt to modify the wiring as well as
electronic components or their software.
The airbag system can be adapted for a person with disabilities. For further information,
consult a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
The seat belts, together with SRS (Supplemental Restraint System), are complementary, co-ordinated restraint systems
(Y page 51). They reduce the risk of injury in
specific, pre-defined types of accident situations and thereby increase occupant safety.
However, seat belts and airbags generally do
not protect against objects penetrating the
vehicle from the outside.
To ensure that the restraint systems can
deliver their full potential protection, make
sure that:
Rthe
seat and head restraint are adjusted
properly (Y page 112)
Rthe seat belt has been fastened properly
(Y page 59)
Rthe airbags can inflate without restriction if
deployed (Y page 52)
Rthe steering wheel is adjusted properly
(Y page 118)
Rthe restraint systems have not been modified
An airbag increases the protection of vehicle
occupants wearing a seat belt. However, airbags are only an additional restraint system
that complements, but does not replace, the
seat belt. All vehicle occupants must wear
their seat belts correctly at all times, even if
the vehicle is equipped with airbags. The airbags are not deployed in all types of accidents. For example, if the protective capacity
of correctly fastened seat belts is not
increased by deploying the airbags, the airbags will not deploy.
Airbag deployment only provides increased
protection if the seat belt is worn correctly.
The seat belt helps, firstly, to keep the vehicle
occupant in the best position in relation to the
airbag. Secondly, in a head-on collision, for
example, the seat belt restricts movement of
the vehicle occupant towards the point of
impact.
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
Introduction
SRS consists of:
Rthe
6 SRS warning lamp
Rairbags
Rthe
airbag control unit with crash sensors
tensioners
Rbelt force limiters
SRS reduces the risk of vehicle occupants
coming into contact with parts of the vehicle's interior in the event of an accident. It can
also reduce the forces to which vehicle occupants are subjected during an accident.
Rbelt
SRS warning lamp
G WARNING
If SRS is malfunctioning, restraint system
components may be triggered unintentionally
or might not be triggered at all in the event of
an accident with a high rate of vehicle deceleration. There is an increased risk of injury,
possibly even fatal.
Have SRS checked and repaired immediately
at a qualified specialist workshop.
SRS functions are checked regularly when
you switch on the ignition and when the
engine is running. Therefore, malfunctions
can be detected in good time.
The 6 SRS warning lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the ignition is switched
on. It goes out no later than a few seconds
after the engine is started.
The SRS components are in operational readiness when the 6 SRS warning lamp goes
out while the engine is running.
A malfunction has occurred if:
Rthe
6 SRS warning lamp does not light
up when the ignition is switched on
Rthe engine is running and the 6 SRS
warning lamp does not go out after a few
seconds
Rthe engine is running and the 6 SRS
warning lamp lights up again
Triggering of belt tensioners and airbags
During the first stage of a collision, the airbag
control unit evaluates important physical
data relating to vehicle deceleration or acceleration, such as:
Rduration
Rdirection
Rmagnitude
Based on the evaluation of this data, the airbag control unit triggers the belt tensioners in
the first stage.
If there is an even higher rate of vehicle deceleration or acceleration in a longitudinal direction, the front airbags are also deployed.
Your vehicle has adaptive, two-stage front airbags. The airbag control unit evaluates vehicle deceleration or acceleration in the event
of a collision. In the first deployment stage,
the front airbag is filled with enough propellant gas to reduce the risk of injuries. The
front airbag is fully deployed if a second
deployment threshold is reached within a few
milliseconds.
The belt tensioner and airbag triggering
thresholds are variable and are adapted to the
Z
51
Safety
Occupant safety
Safety
52
Occupant safety
rate of deceleration or acceleration of the
vehicle. This process is pre-emptive in nature.
The triggering process must take place in
good time at the start of the collision.
The rate of vehicle deceleration or acceleration and the direction of the force are essentially determined by:
Rthe
distribution of forces during the collision
Rthe collision angle
Rthe deformation characteristics of the vehicle
Rthe characteristics of the object with which
the vehicle has collided.
Factors which can only be seen and measured
after a collision has occurred do not play a
decisive role in the deployment of an airbag,
nor do they provide an indication of airbag
deployment.
The vehicle may be deformed significantly,
e.g. the bonnet or the wing, without an airbag
being deployed. This is the case if only parts
which are relatively easily deformed are affected and the rate of deceleration is not high.
Conversely, airbags may be deployed even
though the vehicle suffers only minor deformation. This is the case if, for example, very
rigid vehicle parts such as longitudinal body
members are hit, and sufficient deceleration
occurs as a result.
i The belt tensioners can only be triggered
if the seat belt tongues are correctly
engaged in the seat belt buckles.
i Not all airbags are deployed in an acci-
dent. The different airbag systems work
independently of each other.
How the airbag system works is determined by the severity of the collision detected, especially the vehicle deceleration or
acceleration, and the apparent type of accident:
Rfrontal
Rside
collision
impact
Rrear
impact
Roverturn
Airbags
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Airbags provide additional protection; they
are not, however, a substitute for seat belts.
Observe the following notes to reduce the risk
of serious or even fatal injury caused by airbag
deployment:
Rall
vehicle occupants – in particular, pregnant women – must wear their seat belt
correctly at all times and lean back against
the backrest, which should be positioned
as close to the vertical as possible. The
head restraint must support the back of the
head at about eye level.
Ralways secure children less than 1.50 m tall
or under 12 years of age in suitable child
restraint systems.
Rall vehicle occupants must select a seat
position that is as far away from the airbag
as possible. The driver's seat position must
allow the vehicle to be driven safely. The
driver's chest should be as far away from
the centre of the driver's airbag cover as
possible.
Rmove the front-passenger seat as far back
as possible. This is especially important if
you have secured a child in a child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat.
Rvehicle occupants – in particular, children –
must not lean their heads into the area of
the window in which the sidebag/headbag
is deployed.
Rrearward-facing child restraint systems
must not be fitted to the front-passenger
seat unless the front-passenger front airbag has been disabled. The front-passenger
front airbag is disabled if a child restraint
system with transponders for automatic
child seat recognition is fitted to the front-
passenger seat. The 4 PASSENGER
AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp must be continuously lit.
If you secure a forward-facing child
restraint system to the front-passenger
seat, you must move the front-passenger
seat as far back as possible.
Rmake sure there are no heavy or sharpedged objects in the pockets of clothing.
Rdo not lean forwards, e.g. over the cover of
the driver's/front-passenger front airbag,
particularly when the vehicle is in motion.
Rdo not put your feet on the dashboard.
Ronly hold the steering wheel on the outside.
This allows the airbag to be fully deployed.
You could be injured if the airbag is
deployed and you are holding the inside of
the steering wheel.
Rdo not lean on the doors from inside the
vehicle.
Rmake sure that there are no people, animals or objects between the vehicle occupants and the area where the airbags are
deployed.
Rdo not place any objects between the seat
backrest and the door.
Rdo not hang any hard objects, for example,
coat hangers, on the grab handles or coat
hooks.
Rdo not attach accessories, e.g. cup holders,
to the doors.
It is not possible to rule out a risk of injury
being caused by an airbag, due to the high
speed at which the airbag must be deployed.
G WARNING
If you modify the airbag covers or affix
objects, e.g. stickers to them, the airbags may
no longer function as intended. There is an
increased risk of injury.
Never modify the airbag covers and do not
affix any objects to them.
The airbag installation locations are identified
by the AIRBAG symbol.
G WARNING
Unsuitable seat covers may obstruct or even
prevent deployment of the airbags integrated
into the seats. The airbags may then fail to
protect the vehicle occupants as intended.
Operation of the automatic child seat recognition may also be impaired. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Use only seat covers which have been specifically approved for the respective seat by
Mercedes-Benz.
You should only use seat covers that have
been approved for your vehicle by MercedesBenz. The seat covers must have a special
tear seam for sidebags. Otherwise, the sidebags cannot deploy correctly and therefore
cannot provide the intended protection in the
event of an accident.
G WARNING
After the driver's airbag has been deployed,
the airbag parts are hot. There is a risk of
injury.
Do not touch the airbag parts. Have deployed
airbags replaced immediately at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Airbag deployment slows down and restricts
the movement of the vehicle occupants.
If the airbags are deployed, you will hear a
bang, and a small amount of powder may also
be released. Only in rare cases will the bang
affect your hearing. The powder that is
released generally does not constitute a
health hazard and does not indicate that there
is a fire in the vehicle. The powder may cause
short-term breathing difficulties to persons
suffering from asthma or other pulmonary
conditions. In order to prevent potential
breathing difficulties, you should leave the
vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so. You can
also open the window to allow fresh air to
enter the vehicle interior. The 6 SRS warning lamp lights up.
i After an airbag has been deployed, have
the vehicle towed to the nearest qualified
Z
53
Safety
Occupant safety
54
Occupant safety
specialist workshop, even if your vehicle
can still be driven.
Safety
Front airbags
! Do not place heavy objects on the front-
passenger seat. This could cause the system to identify the seat as being occupied.
In the event of an accident, the restraint
systems on the front-passenger side may
be triggered and have to be replaced.
the system determines that the frontpassenger seat is occupied. Exception: if a
child restraint system with transponder is
installed correctly. The PASSENGER AIRBAG
ON indicator lamp lights up for 60 seconds
when the ignition is switched on. The
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp on
the centre console does not light up
(Y page 63).
If a child restraint system is fitted to the frontpassenger seat and the PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF indicator lamp is not on:
Ra
child restraint system without a transponder for automatic child seat recognition
has been fitted or
Ra child restraint system with a transponder
has been fitted incorrectly
Sidebags
Driver's airbag : deploys in front of the
steering wheel; front-passenger front airbag ; deploys in front of and above the glove
compartment.
The front airbags increase protection for the
driver's and front-passenger's head and
chest.
They are deployed:
Rat the start of an accident with a high rate of
vehicle acceleration or deceleration in a
longitudinal direction
Rif the system determines that airbag
deployment can offer additional protection
to that provided by the seat belt
Rindependently of other airbags in the vehicle
The time within which the front airbag is
deployed is dependent on whether or not a
seat belt is worn.
If the vehicle overturns, the front airbags are
generally not deployed.
Vehicles with automatic child seat recognition in the front-passenger seat: frontpassenger front airbag ; is only enabled if
G WARNING
Unsuitable seat covers may obstruct or even
prevent deployment of the airbags integrated
into the seats. The airbags may then fail to
protect the vehicle occupants as intended.
Operation of the automatic child seat recognition may also be impaired. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Use only seat covers which have been specifically approved for the respective seat by
Mercedes-Benz.
G WARNING
Sensors to control the airbags are located in
the doors. Modifications or work not performed correctly to the doors or door panelling, as well as damaged doors, can lead to the
function of the sensors being impaired. The
airbags might therefore not function properly
any more. Consequently, the airbags cannot
protect vehicle occupants as they are
designed to do. This poses an increased risk
of injury.
Never modify the doors or parts of the doors.
Always have work on the doors or door pan-
Occupant safety
You should only use seat covers that have
been approved for your vehicle by MercedesBenz. The seat covers must have a special
tear seam for sidebags. Otherwise, the sidebags cannot deploy correctly and therefore
cannot provide the intended protection in the
event of an accident.
offer additional protection to that provided by
the seat belts.
Headbags
Safety
elling carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Example: headbag on the front-passenger side
Example: sidebag on the driver's side
Sidebags : deploy next to the outer seat
cushions of the seat backrest.
When deployed, the sidebags offer additional
thorax protection for vehicle occupants on
the side of the vehicle on which the impact
occurs. However, they do not protect the:
Rhead
Rneck
Rarms
The sidebags are deployed:
Ron
the side on which an impact occurs
Rat the start of an accident with a high rate of
lateral vehicle deceleration or acceleration,
e.g. in a side impact
Rindependently of the use of the seat belt
Rindependently of the front airbags
Rindependently of the belt tensioners
If the vehicle overturns, the sidebags are generally not deployed. Sidebags are deployed if
the system detects high vehicle deceleration
or acceleration in a lateral direction and
determines that sidebag deployment can
55
Headbags : deploy in the area of the front
side windows. Headbags enhance the level of
protection for the head, but not chest or arms,
of the vehicle occupants on the side of the
vehicle on which the impact occurs.
The headbags are deployed:
Rat the start of an accident with a high rate of
lateral vehicle deceleration or acceleration,
e.g. in a side impact
Ron the side on which an impact occurs
Ron the driver's and the front-passenger's
side if the vehicle overturns and the system
determines that deployment can offer additional protection to that provided by the
seat belt
Rindependently of the use of the seat belt
Rregardless of whether the front-passenger
seat is occupied
Rindependently of the front airbags
Roll bars
G DANGER
If the roll bar has developed a fault, it may not
function, e.g. in the event of an accident. The
roll bars may then not protect the vehicle
occupants as intended. This poses an
increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Z
56
Occupant safety
Have roll bars checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
Safety
G WARNING
If you place objects or clothing on the roll bar
covers, these could impair roll bar extension.
The roll bars may then not protect the vehicle
occupants as intended. In addition, objects
could endanger the vehicle occupants when
the roll bar is extending. This poses an
increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Ensure that the movement area of the roll bar
covers is kept clear. Always stow all objects in
the vehicle correctly.
Important safety notes
! Make sure that there are no objects in the
footwell or behind the seats when moving
the seat back. There is a risk that the seats
and/or the objects could be damaged.
Although your vehicle is equipped with a PRESAFE® system, the possibility of injury in the
event of an accident cannot be ruled out.
Always adapt your driving style to suit the
prevailing road and weather conditions and
maintain a safe distance from the vehicle in
front. Drive carefully.
Function
PRE-SAFE® intervenes:
Rin emergency braking situations, e.g. when
BAS is activated
Rin critical driving situations, e.g. when phys-
The roll bars are located in the rear area of the
vehicle under the two outer rear compartment trim covers.
The roll bars are extended automatically if
systems detect that the vehicle is in danger of
overturning. The two rear compartment trim
covers are opened and the roll bars are extended within fractions of a second.
Once the roll bars are extended, you can no
longer lower them. An open roof can no longer be closed. In this case, visit the nearest
qualified specialist workshop.
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant
protection)
Introduction
PRE-SAFE® takes pre-emptive measures to
protect occupants in certain hazardous situations.
ical limits are exceeded and the vehicle
understeers or oversteers severely
Ron vehicles with DISTRONIC PLUS: if
BAS PLUS brakes hard or the radar sensor
system detects an imminent danger of collision in certain situations
PRE-SAFE® takes the following measures
depending on the hazardous situation detected:
Rthe
seat belts are pre-tensioned.
the vehicle skids, the side windows are
closed so that only a small gap remains.
Rthe front-passenger seat is adjusted if it is
in an unfavourable position.
RVehicles with a multicontour seat or
active multicontour seat: the air pressure in the side bolsters of the backrest is
increased.
If the hazardous situation passes without
resulting in an accident, PRE-SAFE® slackens
the belt pre-tensioning. All settings made by
PRE-SAFE® can then be reversed.
Rif
Occupant safety
X
Move the backrest or seat back slightly, but
only when the vehicle is stationary.
Seat belt pre-tensioning is reduced and the
locking mechanism is released.
qualified specialist workshop after a rear-end
collision.
Resetting triggered NECK-PRO head
restraints
Safety
If the seat belts are not released:
The seat-belt adjustment is an integral part of
the PRE-SAFE® convenience function. More
information about seat-belt adjustment can
be found under "Seat-belt adjustment"
(Y page 59).
NECK-PRO head restraints
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Only use head restraint covers which have
been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz
for your vehicle model.
The use of non-approved head restraint covers may prevent NECK-PRO head restraints
from triggering properly. Consequently, the
NECK-PRO head restraints cannot provide the
intended level of protection.
Consult a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
regarding availability.
NECK-PRO head restraints reduce the likelihood of head and chest injuries. The NECKPRO head restraints on the driver's and frontpassenger seats are moved forwards and
upwards in the event of a rear-end collision of
a certain severity. This provides better head
support.
If the NECK-PRO head restraints have been
triggered in an accident, reset the NECK-PRO
head restraints on the driver’s and frontpassenger seat (Y page 57). Otherwise, the
additional protection will not be available in
the event of another rear-end collision. You
can recognise when NECK-PRO head
restraints have been triggered by the fact that
they have moved forwards and can no longer
be adjusted.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the NECK-PRO head restraints checked at a
57
Tilt the top of the NECK-PRO head restraint
cushion forwards in the direction of
arrow :.
X Push the NECK-PRO head restraint cushion
down in the direction of arrow ; as far as
it will go.
X Firmly push the NECK-PRO head restraint
cushion back in the direction of arrow =
until the cushion engages.
X Repeat this procedure for the second
NECK-PRO head restraint.
i Resetting the NECK-PRO head restraints
requires a lot of strength. If you have difficulty resetting the NECK-PRO head
restraints, have this work carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
X
Seat belts
Important safety notes
G WARNING
A seat belt which is not worn correctly, or
which has not been engaged in the seat belt
buckle correctly, cannot provide the intended
level of protection. Under certain circumstances, this could cause severe or even fatal injuries in the event of an accident.
Z
Safety
58
Occupant safety
Make sure that all occupants – in particular,
pregnant women – wear their seat belt correctly at all times.
Rthe seat belt must fit snugly on your body
and must not be twisted. Therefore, avoid
wearing bulky clothing, e.g. a winter coat.
The shoulder belt section must be routed
across the centre of your shoulder – on no
account across your neck or under your
arm – and pulled tight against your upper
body. The lap belt must always pass across
your lap as low down as possible, i.e. over
your hip joints – not across your abdomen.
If necessary, push down the belt strap
slightly and then retighten it in the roll-up
direction.
Rseat belts must not be twisted within the
belt loop on the seat.
Rdo not route the belt strap across sharp
edges or fragile objects. This is especially
the case if these are located on or in your
clothing, e.g. spectacles, pens, keys, etc.
The seat belt strap could be damaged and
tear in an accident, and you or other vehicle
occupants could be injured.
Ronly one person should use each seat belt
at any one time. Children must never travel
sitting on the lap of other occupants. It
would not be possible to restrain the child
in the event of a sudden change in direction, braking or an accident. This could
result in severe or even fatal injuries to the
child and other occupants.
Rpersons less than 1.50 m tall cannot wear
the seat belts correctly. For this reason,
secure persons less than 1.50 m tall in specially designed, suitable restraint systems.
Rchildren less than 1.50 m tall and under
twelve years of age cannot wear the seat
belts correctly. Therefore, they should
always be secured in a suitable child
restraint system on the front-passenger
seat. You can find more information under
"Children in the vehicle" in the "Safety" section of the Owner's Manual. Follow the
manufacturer's installation instructions
when fitting a child restraint system.
RDo not secure any objects with a seat belt if
the seat belt is also being used by one of the
vehicle's occupants.
G WARNING
The seat belt does not offer the intended level
of protection if the backrest is not in the
upright position. When braking or in the event
of an accident, you could slide underneath the
seat belt and sustain abdomen or neck injuries, for example. This poses an increased risk
of injury or even fatal injury.
Adjust the seat properly before beginning
your journey. Always make sure that the seat
is in the upright position.
G WARNING
Seat belts cannot perform their intended protective function if:
Rthey
are damaged, modified, bleached or
coloured, or are very dirty
Rthe seat belt buckle is damaged or very
dirty
Rmodifications have been made to the seat
belt tensioners or belt anchorages
In the event of an accident, seat belts can
sustain damage that is not visible to the naked
eye, e. g. due to glass splinters. Modified or
damaged seat belts could tear or fail in the
event of an accident, for example. Modified
belt tensioners could deploy unexpectedly or
fail. There is an increased risk of serious or
even fatal injuries.
Never make modifications to seat belts, belt
tensioners, belt anchorages or seat belt
retractors. Make sure that the seat belts are
undamaged, are not worn and are clean.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only
use seat belts that have been approved specifically for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz.
Seat belts are the most effective means of
restraining the movement of vehicle occupants in the event of an accident. This
Occupant safety
Fastening seat belts
Adjust the seat and move the backrest to
an almost vertical position (Y page 112).
X Pull the seat belt smoothly through seat
belt guide :.
X Without twisting it, guide the shoulder section of the seat belt across the middle of
your shoulder and the lap section across
your pelvis.
X Engage belt tongue ; in buckle =.
Seat belt adjustment: if necessary, the driver's and front-passenger seat belts automatically adjust to the upper body
(Y page 59).
X If necessary, pull upwards on the shoulder
section of the seat belt to tighten the belt
across your body.
X
The belt strap is tightened slightly when:
Ryou
engage the belt tongue in the belt
buckle and you then turn the key to position
2 in the ignition lock.
Rthe key is in position 2 in the ignition lock
and you then engage the belt tongue in the
buckle.
The seat-belt adjustment will apply a certain
tightening force if any slack is detected
between the occupant and the seat belt. Do
not hold on to the seat belt tightly while it is
adjusting. You can switch the belt adjustment
on and off using the on-board computer
(Y page 243).
The seat belt adjustment is a convenience
function integrated in PRE-SAFE® (preventative occupant protection). More information
on PRE-SAFE®(Y page 56).
Releasing the seat belts
! Make sure that the seat belt is fully rolled
up. Otherwise, the seat belt or belt tongue
will be trapped in the door or in the seat
mechanism. This could damage the door,
the door trim panel and the seat belt. Damaged seat belts can no longer fulfil their
protective function and must be replaced.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Information about releasing the seat belt with
release button ?(Y page 59).
Seat belt adjustment
The seat-belt adjustment function adjusts the
driver's and front-passenger seat belt to the
upper body of the occupants.
Z
Safety
reduces the risk of vehicle occupants coming
into contact with parts of the vehicle interior.
59
Occupant safety
60
X
Safety
X
Press release button ? on belt buckle =.
Guide belt tongue ; back to seat belt
guide :.
Belt warning for the driver and front
passenger
The ü seat belt warning lamp in the instrument cluster is a reminder for all occupants to
fasten their seat belts. It may light up continuously or flash. In addition, a warning tone
may sound.
The ü seat belt warning lamp goes out and
the warning tone ceases when the driver and
the front passenger have fastened their seat
belt.
Only for certain countries: the ü seat belt
warning lamp lights up for six seconds after
every engine start. This happens regardless of
whether the driver's and front-passenger seat
belts have already been fastened. It then goes
out if the driver and the front passenger have
fastened their seat belts.
i For more information on the ü seat
belt warning lamp, see "Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster, seat
belt" (Y page 274).
Belt tensioners, belt force limiters
G WARNING
Pyrotechnic seat belt tensioners that have
been deployed are no longer operational and
are unable to perform their intended protective function. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
Therefore, have pyrotechnic belt tensioners
which have been triggered immediately
replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
! If the co-driver's seat is not occupied, do
not engage the seat belt tongue in the
buckle on the co-driver's seat. Otherwise,
the belt tensioner could be triggered in the
event of an accident and would have to be
replaced.
i Vehicles with PRE-SAFE®: an electric
motor is used by PRE-SAFE® to trigger the
tightening of the seat belt in hazardous situations. This procedure is reversible.
The seat belts are fitted with belt tensioners.
The belt tensioners tighten the seat belts in an
accident, pulling them close against the body.
Belt tensioners do not correct incorrect seat
positions or incorrectly fastened seat belts.
Belt tensioners do not pull vehicle occupants
back towards the backrest.
The belt tensioners can only be activated
when:
Rthe
ignition is switched on
Rthe restraint systems are operational; see "
SRS warning lamp" (Y page 51)
Rthe belt tongue is engaged in the buckle on
each of the three-point seat belts
The belt tensioners are triggered depending
on the accident type and severity:
Rin
the event of a head-on or rear-end collision if the vehicle decelerates or accelerates rapidly in a longitudinal direction during the initial stages of the impact
Rin the event of a side impact if the vehicle
decelerates or accelerates rapidly in a lateral direction on the side opposite to the
impact
Rin certain situations where the vehicle overturns and the system determines that it can
provide additional protection
If the airbags are deployed, you will hear a
bang, and a small amount of powder may also
be released. Only in rare cases will the bang
affect your hearing. The powder that is
released generally does not constitute a
health hazard and does not indicate that there
is a fire in the vehicle. The powder may cause
short-term breathing difficulties to persons
suffering from asthma or other pulmonary
conditions. In order to prevent potential
breathing difficulties, you should leave the
vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so. You can
also open the window to allow fresh air to
enter the vehicle interior. The 6 SRS warning lamp lights up.
If the seat belt is also fitted with a belt force
limiter and this is triggered, the force exerted
by the seat belt on the vehicle occupant is
reduced.
The belt force limiters are synchronised with
the front airbags. They take on a part of the
deceleration force, resulting in the force exerted on the occupant being distributed over a
greater area.
Child restraint systems
Important safety notes
G WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious or even fatal
injury to the child in the event of a sudden
change in direction, braking or an accident:
Rchildren
less than 1.50 m tall and under
twelve years of age must always be secured
in special child restraint systems on the
front-passenger seat. This is necessary
because the seat belts are not designed for
children.
Rif you secure a forward-facing child
restraint system to the front-passenger
seat, you must move the front-passenger
seat as far back as possible. When doing so,
ensure that the shoulder belt strap from the
belt outlet on the vehicle is routed towards
the front to the shoulder belt guide on the
child restraint system.
Rchildren must never travel sitting on the lap
of another occupant. Due to the forces
which occur in the event of a sudden
change of direction, heavy braking or an
accident, it would not be possible to
restrain the child. The child could be thrown
against parts of the vehicle interior and be
seriously or even fatally injured.
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is incorrectly fitted on the seat position suitable for this pur-
pose, it cannot perform its intended protective function. In the event of an accident,
sharp braking or a sudden change in direction,
the child may not be held securely. There is an
increased risk of serious or even fatal injuries.
Observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions and the correct use for the child
restraint system. Make sure that the entire
surface of the child restraint system is resting
on the seat surface. Never place objects
under or behind the child restraint system,
e.g. cushions. Only use child restraint systems with the original cover designed for
them. Only replace damaged covers with genuine covers.
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is fitted incorrectly or is not secured, it can come loose in
the event of an accident, heavy braking or a
sudden change in direction. The child
restraint system could be thrown about, striking vehicle occupants. There is an increased
risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Always fit child restraint systems properly,
even if they are not being used. Make sure
that you observe the child restraint system
manufacturer's installation instructions.
G WARNING
Child restraint systems or their securing systems that have been damaged or subjected to
a load in an accident cannot perform their
intended protective function. In the event of
an accident, sharp braking or a sudden
change in direction, the child may not be held
securely. There is an increased risk of serious
or even fatal injuries.
Immediately replace child restraint systems
that have been damaged or subjected to a
load in an accident. Have the child restraint
securing systems checked in a qualified specialist workshop before fitting a child restraint
system again.
Z
61
Safety
Child restraint systems
62
Child restraint systems
road users
out and be injured by the traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and, for example, trap themselves.
Children could also set the vehicle in motion,
for example by:
is appropriate to the age, weight and size of
the child. In order to correctly secure the child
in the child restraint system, always comply
with the child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions. Make sure that
the child is secured for the trip.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use
the listed child restraint systems
(Y page 67). You can obtain further information about the correct child restraint system from any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Rreleasing
i It is advisable to use Mercedes-Benz care
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they can:
Safety
Ropen doors and endanger other persons or
Rclimb
the parking brake
the automatic transmission out of
park position P
Rstarting the engine.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle. Always
keep the key out of reach of children.
Rshifting
G WARNING
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is placed in direct
sunlight, the parts could become very hot.
Children could be suffer burns by touching
these parts, in particular on the metallic parts
of the child restraint system. There is a risk of
injury.
If you and your child leave the vehicle, always
make sure that the child restraint system is
not in direct sunlight. Cover it with a blanket,
for example. If the child restraint system has
been exposed to direct sunlight, leave it to
cool down before securing the child in it.
Never leave children unattended in the vehicle.
If a child is travelling in your vehicle, secure
the child using a child restraint system which
products to clean child restraint systems.
You can obtain information about this from
any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat
G WARNING
If the front-passenger front airbag is not disabled:
Ra
child secured in a child restraint system
on the front-passenger seat could be seriously or even fatally injured by the frontpassenger airbag deploying. This is especially a risk if the child is in the immediate
vicinity of the front-passenger front airbag
when it deploys.
Rnever secure a child on the front-passenger
seat in a rearward-facing child restraint system.
Rmove the front-passenger seat as far back
as possible. When doing so, ensure that the
shoulder belt strap from the belt outlet on
the vehicle is routed towards the front to
the shoulder belt guide on the child
restraint system.
The front-passenger front airbag is not disabled:
Ron
vehicles without automatic child seat
recognition on the front-passenger seat.
Ron vehicles with automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat,
Child restraint systems
Warning notice on the front-passenger sun visor
NEVER use a rearward-facing child restraint
on a seat protected by an ACTIVE AIRBAG in
front of it; DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY to the
CHILD can occur.
Automatic child seat recognition on
the front-passenger seat
G WARNING
If the 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp does not light up when the child
restraint system is fitted, the front-passenger
front airbag has not been disabled. If the frontpassenger front airbag deploys, the child
could be seriously or even fatally injured.
Proceed as follows:
Rdo not use a rearward-facing child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat.
or
Ronly
use a forward-facing child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat. Move
the front-passenger seat as far back as possible. When doing so, ensure that the shoulder belt strap from the belt outlet on the
vehicle is routed towards the front to the
shoulder belt guide on the child restraint
system.
Rhave the automatic child seat recognition
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
To ensure that the automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat functions/communicates correctly, never place
objects, e.g. a cushion, under the child
restraint system. The entire base of the child
restraint system must always rest on the seat
cushion. An incorrectly fitted child restraint
system cannot perform its intended protective function in the event of an accident, and
could lead to injuries.
Warning symbol for a rearward-facing child
restraint system
Z
Safety
unless a child restraint system with transponders for automatic child seat recognition is fitted to the front-passenger seat. In
order to make use of the automatic child
seat recognition, a Mercedes-Benz
approved child seat with a transponder is
necessary.
Ron vehicles with automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat, if the
_ PASSENGER AIRBAG ON indicator
lamp lights up for 60 seconds after the ignition is switched on and the 4
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp
does not light up.
To make you aware of this danger, a corresponding warning sticker has been affixed to
the side of the dashboard and on both sides of
the sun visor on the front-passenger side.
Information about recommended child
restraint systems is available at any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
63
64
Child restraint systems
Safety
G WARNING
Electronic devices on the front-passenger
seat can affect the function of the automatic
child seat recognition, for example:
Rlaptop
Rmobile
phone
cards such as ski passes or
access passes
The front-passenger front airbag could deploy
unintentionally or not function as intended
during an accident. This poses an increased
risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Do not place any of the devices mentioned
above or similar devices on the frontpassenger seat.
Rtransponder
: PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp
; PASSENGER AIRBAG ON indicator lamp
The automatic child seat recognition sensor
system on the front-passenger seat detects
whether a special Mercedes-Benz child seat
has been fitted there. The Mercedes-Benz
child seat is equipped with transponders for
automatic child seat recognition so that it can
be detected by the sensor system. In this
case, PASSENGER AIRBAG ON indicator
lamp ; lights up briefly when the ignition is
switched on. PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp : remains lit. The frontpassenger front airbag is disabled.
i If the front-passenger front airbag is dis-
abled by the automatic child seat recognition, the following remain enabled on the
front-passenger side:
Rthe
sidebag
headbag
Rthe belt tensioner
Rthe
ISOFIX child seat securing system
G WARNING
ISOFIX child restraint systems do not offer
sufficient protective effect for children whose
weight is greater than 22 kg who are secured
using the safety belt integrated in the child
restraint system. The child could, for example,
not be restrained correctly in the event of an
accident. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
If the child weighs more than 22 kg, only use
ISOFIX child restraint systems with which the
child is also secured with the vehicle seat belt.
Also secure the child restraint system with the
Top Tether belt, if available.
When installing a child restraint system, be
sure to observe the manufacturer's installation instructions and the instructions for correct use of the child restraint system.
G WARNING
If the child restraint system has not been fitted correctly, it cannot perform its intended
protective function. The child cannot be
restrained in the event of an accident, heavy
braking or sudden changes of direction. The
child could be seriously or even fatally injured.
For this reason, when securing a child
restraint system, always observe the manufacturer's fitting instructions and the correct
application range of the child restraint system.
For safety reasons, only use child restraint
systems with an ISOFIX child seat securing
system which have been tested and approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
An incorrectly fitted child restraint system
could come loose and seriously or even fatally
injure the child or other vehicle occupants.
When fitting the child restraint system, always
make sure that it is engaged correctly in the
ISOFIX securing loops on both sides.
X
Install the ISOFIX child restraint system on
both ISOFIX securing loops :. Comply
with the child restraint system manufacturer's instructions when installing the ISOFIX
child restraint system.
ISOFIX is a standardised securing system for
specially designed child restraint systems.
ISOFIX retaining loops : for an ISOFIX child
restraint system are fitted to the frontpassenger seat.
Suitable positioning of the child
restraint systems
Only child restraint systems which are
approved in accordance with the ECE standard ECE R44 are permitted for use in the vehicle.
Installing a child restraint system on the
front-passenger seat
X
Move the seat to its highest and rearmost
position.
If you secure a child in a forward-facing
child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat, ensure that the shoulder
belt strap from the belt outlet on the vehicle
is routed towards the front to the shoulder
belt guide on the child restraint system.
X Move the backrest to a vertical position.
When doing so, ensure that the complete
surface of the child restraint system rests
against the backrest of the front-passenger
seat and that the child restraint system
does not touch the roof. To do so, you may
have to adjust the backrest down a little.
X Move the seat cushion angle to the highest,
most vertical position.
X Move the belt height adjustment to the lowest position.
Rearward-facing child restraint systems without a transponder for automatic child seat
recognition may not be installed on the frontpassenger seat.
Suitability of the front-passenger seat for
attaching belted child restraint systems
Key to the letters used in the following table:
X
Seat which is unsuitable for children in
this weight category.
U Suitable for child restraint systems in the
"Universal" category that are approved
for use in this weight category.
UF Suitable for forward-facing child restraint
systems that belong to the "Universal"
category and are approved for use in this
weight category.
L Suitable for child restraint systems as
recommended; see the following table of
"Recommended child restraint systems"
(Y page 67). Suitable for semi-universal
child restraint systems if the vehicle and
the seat are listed in the child restraint
system manufacturer's vehicle model
list.
Z
65
Safety
Child restraint systems
Safety
66
Child restraint systems
Weight categories
Frontpassenger
front airbag is not
disabled
Frontpassenger
front airbag is disabled
Category 0:
up to 10 kg
X
U, L
Category
0+: up to
13 kg
X
U, L
Category I:
9 to 18 kg
UF, L
U, L
Category II: UF, L
15 to 25 kg
U, L
Category
III: 22 to
36 kg
U, L
UF, L
or IUF in accordance with the "Suitability of
the front passenger seat for attaching belted
child restraint systems" or "Suitability of the
front-passenger seat for attaching an ISOFIX
child restraint system".
Semi-universal child restraint systems are
indicated by the text "semi-universal" on the
approval label. These can be used if the vehicle and the seat are listed in the child restraint
system manufacturer's vehicle model list. For
more information, contact the child restraint
system manufacturer or visit their website.
Suitability of the front-passenger seat for
fitting an ISOFIX child restraint system:
Key to the letters used in the following table:
X
Vehicles with automatic child seat recognition in the front-passenger seat: a "Universal" category child restraint system with a
transponder for automatic child seat recognition must be fitted when the frontpassenger front airbag is disabled. The
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp
must be lit.
ISOFIX position that is not suitable for
ISOFIX child restraint systems in this
weight category and/or size category.
IUF Suitable for forward-facing ISOFIX child
restraint systems that belong to the
"Universal" category which are approved
for use in this weight category.
IL Suitable for ISOFIX child restraint systems as recommended; see the following table of "Recommended child
restraint systems" (Y page 67).
Carry-cot weight category
Size category
Equipment
Frontpassenger
seat
F
ISO/L1
X
G
ISO/L2
X
Weight category 0: up to 10 kg up to
approximately 6 months
Example: approval label on the child restraint system
"Universal" category child restraint systems
can be recognised by their orange approval
label and the text "Universal".
"Universal" category child restraint systems
can be used on the seats indicated with U, UF
Size category
Equipment
Frontpassenger
seat
E
ISO/R1
X
Weight category 0+: up to 13 kg up to
approximately 15 months
Size category
Equipment
Frontpassenger
seat
E
ISO/R1
X
D
ISO/R2
X
C
ISO/R3
X
Weight category I: 9 to 18 kg approximately 9 months to 4 years
Size category
Equipment
Frontpassenger
seat
D
ISO/R2
X
C
ISO/R3
X
B
ISO/F2
IUF
B1
ISO/F2X
IUF
A
ISO/F3
IUF
Recommended child restraint systems
Installing a child restraint system on the
front-passenger seat:
Move the seat to its highest and rearmost
position.
If you secure a child in a forward-facing
child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat, ensure that the shoulder
belt strap from the belt outlet on the vehicle
is routed towards the front to the shoulder
belt guide on the child restraint system.
X Move the backrest to a vertical position.
When doing so, ensure that the complete
surface of the child restraint system rests
against the backrest of the front-passenger
seat and that the child restraint system
does not touch the roof. To do so, you may
have to adjust the backrest down a little.
X
For certain child restraint systems, this can
mean that the area of use is restricted, as
the maximum size setting of the child
restraint system is not possible due to possible contact with the roof.
X Move the seat cushion angle to the highest,
most vertical position.
X Move the belt height adjustment to the lowest position.
Weight category 0: up to 10 kg; up to
approximately 6 months
Manufacturer
Britax Römer Britax Römer
Type
BABY SAFE
plus
BABY SAFE
plus II
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
03 301146
04 301146
04 301146
Order number
(A 000 ...)
970 10 00
970 20 00
Automatic
child seat
recognition
Yes
Yes
Weight category 0+: up to 13 kg; up to
approximately 15 months
Manufacturer
Britax Römer Britax Römer
Type
BABY SAFE
plus
BABY SAFE
plus II
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
03 301146
04 301146
04 301146
Order number
(A 000 ...)
970 10 00
970 20 00
Automatic
child seat
recognition
Yes
Yes
Z
67
Safety
Child restraint systems
68
Child restraint systems
Safety
Weight category I: 9 to 18 kg; approximately 9 months to 4 years
Weight category II/III: 15 to 36 kg;
approximately 4 to 12 years
Manufacturer
Britax Römer Britax Römer
Manufacturer
Britax Römer Britax Römer
Type
DUO plus
DUO plus
Type
KIDFIX
KIDFIX
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
03 301133
04 301133
03 301133
04 301133
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
04 301198
04 301198
Order number
(A 000 ...)
970 11 00
970 16 00
Order number
(A 000 ...)
970 18 00
970 19 00
Automatic
child seat
recognition
Yes
No
Automatic
child seat
recognition
Yes
No
Manufacturer
Britax Römer
Manufacturer
Britax Römer
Type
DUO plus
Type
KIDFIX
Approval number
(E1 ...)
04 301133
Approval number
(E1 ...)
04 301198
Order number
(A 000 ...)
970 21 00
Order number
(A 000 ...)
970 22 00
Automatic child
seat recognition
Yes
Automatic child
seat recognition
Yes
Weight category II/III: 15 to 36 kg;
approximately 4 to 12 years
Manufacturer
Britax Römer Britax Römer
Type
KID
KID
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
03 301148
04 301148
03 301148
04 301148
Order number
(A 000 ...)
970 12 00
970 17 00
Automatic
child seat
recognition
Yes
No
Suggested "Universal"/"Semi-Universal" category ISOFIX child restraint systems:
Category I: 9 to 18 kg
Size category
B1
Manufacturer
Britax Römer Britax Römer
Type
DUO plus
DUO plus
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
03 301133
04 301133
03 301133
04 301133
B1
Order number
A 000 970
11 00
A 000 970
16 00
Automatic
child seat
recognition
Yes
No
Size category
B1
Manufacturer
Britax Römer
Type
DUO plus
Approval number
(E1 ...)
04 301133
Order number
A 000 970 21 00
Automatic child
seat recognition
Yes
69
Safety
Child restraint systems
Z
70
Driving safety systems
Safety
Problems with automatic child seat recognition
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp on the centre console is lit.
A special Mercedes-Benz child seat with a transponder for automatic child seat recognition has been fitted to the front-passenger
seat. The front-passenger front airbag has therefore been disabled
as desired.
G WARNING
There is no child seat fitted to the front-passenger seat. Automatic
child seat recognition is malfunctioning.
When you switch on the ignition, it is also possible that:
Rthe
6 SRS warning lamp lights up.
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp does not light up
briefly.
Rthe PASSENGER AIRBAG ON indicator lamp does not light up, or
lights up and does not go out after 60 seconds.
There is a risk of injury.
X Remove electronic equipment from the front-passenger seat,
e.g.:
Rlaptop
Rmobile phone
Rcards with transponders, such as ski passes or access cards
Rthe
If the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp is still lit:
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Driving safety systems
Driving safety systems overview
In this section, you will find information about
the following driving safety systems:
RABS
(Anti-lock Braking System)
(Y page 71)
RBAS (Brake Assist System) (Y page 71)
RBAS PLUS (Brake Assist System PLUS)
(Y page 72)
RAdaptive brake lamps (Y page 73)
RESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
(Y page 73)
REBD (electronic brake force distribution)
(Y page 76)
RADAPTIVE
BRAKE (Y page 77)
Brake (Y page 77)
RSTEER CONTROL (Y page 78)
RPRE-SAFE®
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style or if you
are inattentive, the driving safety systems can
neither reduce the risk of an accident nor
override the laws of physics. Driving safety
systems are merely aids designed to assist
driving. You are responsible for the distance
to the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed and
for braking in good time. Always adapt your
driving style to suit the prevailing road and
weather conditions and maintain a safe dis-
tance from the vehicle in front. Drive carefully.
i The driving safety systems described only
work as effectively as possible when there
is adequate contact between the tyres and
the road surface. Please pay special attention to the notes on tyres, recommended
minimum tyre tread depths etc.
(Y page 596).
In wintry driving conditions, always use
winter tyres (M+S tyres) and, if necessary,
snow chains. Only in this way will the driving safety systems described in this section
work as effectively as possible.
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
General notes
ABS regulates brake pressure in such a way
that the wheels do not lock when you brake.
This allows you to continue steering the vehicle when braking.
The yellow ! ABS warning lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up when the ignition
is switched on. It goes out when the engine is
running.
display messages which may be shown in the
instrument cluster (Y page 248).
ABS works from a speed of about
8 km/hupwards, regardless of road-surface
conditions. ABS works on slippery surfaces,
even when you only brake gently.
Brakes
If ABS intervenes: continue to depress the
brake pedal with force until the braking situation is over.
X To make a full brake application:
depress the brake pedal with full force.
X
If ABS intervenes when braking, you will feel a
pulsing in the brake pedal.
The pulsating brake pedal can be an indication of hazardous road conditions, and functions as a reminder to take extra care while
driving.
BAS (Brake Assist System)
General notes
Important safety notes
BAS operates in emergency braking situations. If you depress the brake pedal quickly,
BAS automatically boosts the braking force,
thus shortening the stopping distance.
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
Important safety notes
tion (Y page 70).
G WARNING
If ABS is faulty, the wheels could lock when
braking. The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely impaired. Additionally, further driving safety systems are deactivated. There is an increased danger of skidding and accidents.
Drive on carefully. Have ABS checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 70).
G WARNING
If BAS is malfunctioning, the braking distance
in an emergency braking situation is
increased. There is a risk of accident.
In an emergency braking situation, depress
the brake pedal with full force. ABS prevents
the wheels from locking.
If ABS is malfunctioning, other systems,
including driving safety systems, will also
become inoperative. Observe the information
on the ABS warning lamp (Y page 275) and
Z
71
Safety
Driving safety systems
Driving safety systems
72
Brakes
Safety
X
Keep the brake pedal depressed firmly until
the emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will function as usual once you
release the brake pedal. BAS is deactivated.
BAS PLUS (Brake Assist System Plus)
General notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 70).
BAS PLUS is only available on vehicles with
DISTRONIC PLUS.
For BAS PLUS to assist you, the radar sensor
system must be operational.
With the aid of the radar sensor system, BAS
PLUS can detect obstacles that are in the
path of your vehicle for an extended period of
time.
If the radar sensor system is malfunctioning,
BAS PLUS will not be available. The brake
system is still available with complete brake
boosting effect and BAS.
BAS PLUS can help you to minimise the risk of
a collision with a vehicle or reduce the effects
of such a collision. If BAS PLUS detects a
danger of collision, you are assisted when
braking.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
BAS PLUS cannot always clearly identify
objects and complex traffic situations.
In such cases, BAS PLUS may:
Rintervene
unnecessarily
Rnot intervene
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake. Terminate the
intervention in a non-critical driving situation.
G WARNING
BAS PLUS does not react:
Rto
people or animals
oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rwhen cornering
As a result, BAS PLUS may not intervene in all
critical situations. There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Rto
In the event of snowfall or heavy rain, detection can be impaired.
Detection by the radar sensor system is also
impaired in the event of:
Rdirt
on the sensors or obscured sensors
by other radar sources
Rstrong radar reflections, for example, in
multi-storey car parks
Ra narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorcycle
Ra vehicle travelling in front on a different
line
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle, have the radar sensor settings and operation checked at a qualified specialist workshop. This also applies to collisions at slow
speeds where there is no visible damage to
the front of the vehicle.
Rinterference
Function
To avoid a collision, BAS PLUS calculates the
brake force necessary if:
Ryou
approach an obstacle and
PLUS has detected a risk of collision
When driving at a speed under 30 km/h: if
you depress the brake pedal, BAS PLUS is
activated. Braking assistance from BAS PLUS
is carried out at the last possible moment.
When driving at a speed above 30 km/h: if
you depress the brake pedal sharply, BAS
RBAS
Driving safety systems
i If BAS PLUS demands particularly high
braking force, preventative passenger protection measures (PRE-SAFE®) are activated simultaneously.
X
Keep the brake pedal depressed until the
emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
BAS PLUS is deactivated and the brakes function as usual again, if:
Ryou
release the brake pedal
Rthere is no longer a risk of collision
Rno obstacle is detected in front of your
vehicle
Ryou depress the accelerator pedal
Ryou activate kickdown
Adaptive brake lamps
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 70).
If you brake sharply from a speed of more
than 50 km/h or if braking is assisted by BAS
or BAS PLUS, the brake lamps flash rapidly. In
this way, traffic travelling behind you is
warned in an even more noticeable manner.
If you brake sharply from a speed of more
than 70 km/h to a standstill, the hazard warning lamps are activated automatically. If the
brakes are applied again, the brake lamps
light up continuously. The hazard warning
lamps switch off automatically if you travel
faster than 10 km/h. You can also switch off
the hazard warning lamps using the hazard
warning button (Y page 130).
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
General notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 70).
ESP® monitors driving stability and traction,
i.e. power transmission between the tyres
and the road surface.
If ESP® detects that the vehicle is deviating
from the direction desired by the driver, one
or more wheels are braked to stabilise the
vehicle. The engine output is also modified to
keep the vehicle on the desired course within
physical limits. ESP® assists the driver when
pulling away on wet or slippery roads. ESP®
can also stabilise the vehicle during braking.
ETS (Electronic Traction System)
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 70).
ETS traction control is part of ESP®.
ETS brakes the drive wheels individually if
they spin. This enables you to pull away and
accelerate on slippery surfaces, for example
if the road surface is slippery on one side. In
addition, more drive torque is transferred to
the wheel or wheels with traction.
ETS remains active when you deactivate
ESP®.
i AMG vehicles: your vehicle may be
equipped with 20-inch tyres on the rear
axle. If replaced with a 19-inch tyre, ETS
may intervene noticeably sooner for the
first few kilometres. After approximately
10 km ETS will function as usual again.
Information on the dimensions and types of
wheels and tyres for your vehicle can be
found under "Wheel/tyre combinations"
(Y page 610).
Z
Safety
PLUS automatically increases the brake pressure to a degree suited to the traffic situation.
BAS PLUS provides braking assistance in hazardous situations with vehicles in front within
a speed range between 7 km/h and
250 km/h.
At speeds of up to approximately 70 km/h,
BAS PLUS can also detect stationary objects.
Examples of stationary objects are stopped or
parked vehicles.
73
74
Driving safety systems
Important safety notes
Safety
G WARNING
If ESP® is malfunctioning, ESP® is unable to
stabilise the vehicle. In addition, other driving
safety systems are switched off. This increases the risk of skidding and an accident.
Drive on carefully. Have ESP® checked at a
qualified specialist workshop.
! When testing the electric parking brake
on a braking dynamometer, switch off the
ignition. Application of the brakes by ESP®
may otherwise destroy the brake system.
When towing your vehicle with the rear axle
raised, observe the notes on
ESP®(Y page 590).
ESP® is deactivated if the å warning lamp
in the instrument cluster lights up continuously when the engine is running.
If the ÷ warning lamp and the å warning lamp are lit continuously, ESP® is not
available due to a malfunction.
Observe the information on warning lamps
(Y page 277) and display messages which
may be shown in the instrument cluster
(Y page 248).
i Only use wheels with the recommended
tyre sizes. Only then will ESP® function
properly.
Characteristics of ESP®
General notes
If the ÷ ESP warning lamp goes out before
beginning the journey, ESP® is automatically
active.
If ESP® intervenes, the ÷ ESP® warning
lamp flashes in the instrument cluster.
If ESP® intervenes:
Do not deactivate ESP® under any circumstances.
X When pulling away, only depress the accelerator pedal as far as is necessary.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing road and weather conditions.
X
ECO start/stop function
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle stops
moving. When pulling away again, the engine
starts automatically. ESP® remains in its previously selected status. Example: if ESP®
was deactivated before the engine was
switched off, ESP® remains deactivated when
the engine is switched on again.
Deactivating/activating ESP® (except
AMG vehicles)
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 70).
You can select between the following states
of ESP®:
RESP®
RESP®
is activated
is deactivated
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Rin
i Activate ESP® as soon as the situations
described above no longer apply. ESP® will
otherwise not be able to stabilise the vehi-
Driving safety systems
Deactivating/activating ESP®
You can select between the following states
of ESP®:
RESP®
is activated.
handling mode is activated.
RESP® is deactivated.
RSPORT
G WARNING
When SPORT handling mode is activated,
there is a greater risk of skidding and accidents.
Only activate SPORT handling mode in the situations described in the following.
G WARNING
X
To switch off: press button :.
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
X
To switch on: press button :.
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
Characteristics when ESP® is deactivated
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in
the instrument cluster flashes. In such situations, ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle.
If you deactivate ESP®:
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability
torque is no longer limited and the
drive wheels are able to spin
The spinning of the wheels results in a cutting action for better traction on loose surfaces.
Rtraction control is still activated
RESP® still provides support when you
brake.
Rengine
In the following situations, it may be better to
activate SPORT handling mode or deactivate
ESP®:
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Ron specially designated roads when the
vehicle's own oversteering and understeering characteristics are desired
Driving in SPORT handling mode or without
ESP® requires an extremely qualified and
experienced driver.
Rin
i Activate ESP® as soon as the situations
described above no longer apply. ESP® will
otherwise not be able to stabilise the vehicle if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel
starts to spin.
Deactivating/activating ESP® (AMG
vehicles)
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 70).
Z
Safety
cle if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel
starts to spin.
75
Driving safety systems
76
Safety
Deactivating/activating ESP®
spin. The spinning of the wheels results in a
cutting action, which provides better grip.
RETS is still active.
RESP® still provides support when you
brake.
Characteristics when ESP® is deactivated
To activate SPORT handling mode:
briefly press button :.
The M handling mode warning lamp in
the instrument cluster lights up. The
SPORT handling mode message appears
in the multifunction display.
X To deactivate SPORT handling mode:
briefly press button :.
The M handling mode warning lamp in
the instrument cluster goes out.
X
To deactivate ESP®: press button : until
the å ESP® OFF warning lamp lights up
in the instrument cluster.
The ÷ OFF message appears in the multifunction display.
X To activate ESP®: briefly press button :.
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out. The ÷
ESP® ON message appears in the multifunction display.
X
Characteristics of activated SPORT handling mode
If SPORT handling mode is activated and one
or more wheels start to spin, the ÷ ESP®
warning lamp in the instrument cluster
flashes. ESP® only stabilises the vehicle to a
limited degree.
When SPORT handling mode is activated:
RESP®
only improves driving stability to a
limited degree.
Rthe engine's torque is restricted to a limited
degree and the drive wheels are able to
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in
the instrument cluster does not flash. In such
situations, ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle.
If you deactivate ESP®:
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability.
torque is no longer limited and the
drive wheels are able to spin.
The spinning of the wheels results in a cutting action for better traction on loose surfaces.
Rtraction control is still activated.
RPRE-SAFE® is no longer available; nor is it
activated if you brake firmly with assistance from ESP®.
RPRE-SAFE® Brake is no longer available; it
is also not activated if you brake firmly with
assistance from ESP®.
RESP® still provides support when you
brake.
Rengine
EBD (electronic brake force distribution)
General notes
EBD monitors and controls the brake pressure on the rear wheels to improve driving
stability while braking.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section for driving safety systems (Y page 70).
Driving safety systems
If EBD has malfunctioned, the rear wheels can
still lock, e.g. under full braking. This increases the risk of skidding and an accident.
You should therefore adapt your driving style
to the different handling characteristics. Have
the brake system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Observe information regarding indicator and
warning lamps (Y page 275) as well as display messages (Y page 250).
ADAPTIVE BRAKE
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 70).
ADAPTIVE BRAKE enhances braking safety
and offers increased braking comfort. In addition to the braking function, ADAPTIVE BRAKE
also has the HOLD function (Y page 196) and
hill start assist (Y page 158).
PRE-SAFE® Brake
General notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 70).
PRE-SAFE® Brake is only available on vehicles
with DISTRONIC PLUS.
For PRE-SAFE® Brake to assist you when driving, the radar sensor system must be operational.
With the help of the radar sensor system,
PRE-SAFE® Brake can detect obstacles that
are in front of your vehicle for an extended
period of time.
PRE-SAFE® Brake can help you to minimise
the risk of a collision with a vehicle ahead, and
reduce the effects of such a collision. If PRESAFE® Brake has detected a risk of collision,
you will be warned visually and acoustically as
well as by automatic braking. PRE-SAFE®
Brake cannot prevent a collision without your
intervention.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
PRE-SAFE® Brake will initially brake your vehicle by a partial application of the brakes if a
danger of collision is detected. There may be
a collision unless you also brake. Automatic
emergency braking cannot prevent a collision. There is a risk of an accident.
Always apply the brakes yourself and try to
take evasive action.
G WARNING
PRE-SAFE® Brake cannot always clearly identify objects and complex traffic conditions.
In these cases, PRE-SAFE® Brake may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning and then
brake the vehicle
Rneither give a warning nor intervene
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay particular attention to the traffic
situation and be ready to brake, especially if
PRE-SAFE® Brake warns you. Terminate the
intervention in a non-critical driving situation.
In order to maintain the appropriate distance
to the vehicle in front and thus prevent a collision, you must apply the brakes yourself.
G WARNING
PRE-SAFE® Brake does not react:
Rto
people or animals
oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rwhen cornering
Rto
As a result, PRE-SAFE® Brake may neither
give warnings nor intervene in all critical situations. There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Z
Safety
G WARNING
77
Driving safety systems
78
Safety
In the event of snowfall or heavy rain, detection can be impaired.
Detection by the radar sensor system is also
impaired in the event of:
Rdirt
on the sensors or obscured sensors
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rstrong radar reflections, for example, in
multi-storey car parks
Ra narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorcycle
Ra vehicle travelling in front on a different
line
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle, have the radar sensor settings and operation checked at a qualified specialist workshop. This also applies to collisions at slow
speeds where there is no visible damage to
the front of the vehicle.
Function
X
To activate/deactivate: activate or deactivate PRE-SAFE® Brake in the on-board
computer (Y page 238).
When PRE-SAFE® Brake is deactivated, the
æ symbol appears in the assistance
graphic in the multifunction display.
This function will issue a warning if:
Rat a speed of around 30 km/h or more, the
distance maintained to the vehicle travelling in front is insufficient for several seconds.
The · distance warning lamp then lights
up in the instrument cluster.
Rat a speed of approximately 7 km/h or
more, you rapidly approach a vehicle in
front.
An intermittent warning tone will then
sound and the · distance warning lamp
will light up in the instrument cluster.
X Brake immediately to defuse the situation.
or
X Take evasive action provided it is safe to do
so.
The PRE-SAFE® Brake function can also brake
the vehicle automatically under the following
conditions:
Rthe
driver and front-passenger have their
seat belts fastened
and
Rthe vehicle speed is between approximately 7 km/h and 200 km/h
At speeds of up to approximately 70 km/h,
PRE-SAFE® Brake can also detect stationary
objects. Examples of stationary objects are
stopped or parked vehicles.
i If there is an increased risk of collision,
preventive passenger protection measures
(PRE-SAFE®) are activated.
If the risk of collision with the vehicle in front
remains and you do not brake, take evasive
action or accelerate significantly, the vehicle
may perform automatic emergency braking,
up to the point of full brake application. Automatic emergency braking is not performed
until immediately prior to an imminent accident.
You can prevent the intervention of the PRESAFE® Brake at any time by:
Rdepressing
the accelerator pedal further
Ractivating kickdown
Rreleasing the brake pedal
The braking action of PRE-SAFE® Brake is
ended automatically if:
Ryou
manoeuvre to avoid the obstacle
is no longer any danger of a collision
Rthere is no longer an obstacle detected in
front of your vehicle
Rthere
STEER CONTROL
General notes
STEER CONTROL helps you by transmitting a
noticeable steering force to the steering
wheel in the direction required for vehicle
stabilisation.
Anti-theft systems
This steering support is provided in particular
if:
79
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Rboth right wheels or both left wheels are on
Safety
a wet or slippery road surface when you
brake.
Rthe vehicle starts to skid.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 70).
No steering support is provided from STEER
CONTROL, if:
RESP®
is malfunctioning.
steering is faulty.
Power steering will, however, continue to
function.
Rthe
Anti-theft systems
Immobiliser
To activate with the key: remove the key
from the ignition lock.
X To activate with KEYLESS-GO: switch the
ignition off and open the driver's door.
X To deactivate: switch on the ignition.
X
The immobiliser prevents your vehicle from
being started without the correct key.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the
SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. The
engine can be started by anyone with a valid
key that is left inside the vehicle.
i The immobiliser is always deactivated
when you start the engine.
To prime: lock the vehicle with the key or
KEYLESS-GO.
Indicator lamp : flashes. The alarm system is primed after approximately
15 seconds.
X To switch off: unlock the vehicle with the
key or KEYLESS-GO.
X
A visual and audible alarm is triggered if the
alarm system is primed and you open:
Ra
door
vehicle with the emergency key element
Rthe boot lid
Rthe bonnet
Rthe glove compartment
Rthe stowage space under the armrest
Ra stowage compartment in the rear
X To turn the alarm off with the key: press
the % or & button on the key.
The alarm is switched off.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
The alarm is switched off.
X To stop the alarm using KEYLESS-GO:
grasp the outside door handle. The key
must be outside the vehicle.
The alarm is switched off.
or
X Press the Start/Stop button on the dashboard. The key must be inside the vehicle.
The alarm is switched off.
Rthe
Z
Anti-theft systems
80
Safety
The alarm is not switched off, even if you
close the open door that has triggered it, for
example.
Tow-away protection
Function
An audible and visual alarm is triggered if your
vehicle's angle of inclination is altered while
tow-away protection is primed. This can occur
if the vehicle is jacked up on one side, for
example.
Activating
Make sure that:
Rthe doors are closed
Rthe boot lid is closed
Only then is the tow-away protection
primed.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
Tow-away protection is primed after
approximately 30 seconds.
X
Deactivating
X
To switch off: unlock the vehicle with the
key or KEYLESS-GO.
Tow-away protection is switched off automatically.
Deactivating
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up briefly.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
Tow-away protection is deactivated.
X
X
Tow-away protection remains deactivated
until:
Rthe
vehicle is unlocked again
door is opened and closed again
Rthe vehicle is locked again
To prevent a false alarm, deactivate the towaway protection if you lock your vehicle and it:
Ra
Ris
being transported
being loaded onto a ferry or car transporter, for example
Ris parked on a movable surface, e.g. in a
split-level garage
Ris
Interior motion sensor
Function
When the interior motion sensor is primed, a
visual and audible alarm is triggered if movement is detected in the vehicle interior. This
can occur if someone reaches into the vehicle
interior, for example.
Activating
Make sure that:
Rthe side windows are closed
Rthe stowage compartment under the
armrest is closed
This will prevent false alarms.
X Make sure that:
X
Anti-theft systems
roof is closed
doors are closed
Rthe boot lid is closed
Only then is the interior motion sensor
primed.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
The interior motion sensor is primed after
approximately 30 seconds.
i Only for the Netherlands and Belgium:
the interior motion sensor is primed even
when the roof is open. However, the roof
should be closed so as to prevent a false
alarm.
Deactivating
X
The interior motion sensor remains deactivated until:
Rthe
vehicle is unlocked again
door is opened and closed again
Rthe vehicle is locked again
Ra
i UK only: your vehicle is equipped with a
double lock function. The doors cannot be
opened from the inside if the vehicle has
been locked with the key or with KEYLESSGO. Deactivate the interior motion sensor
before you lock the vehicle. The doors can
then be opened from the inside after the
vehicle has been locked from the outside.
Observe the "Important safety notes"
(Y page 90).
Unlock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESS-GO.
The interior motion sensor is automatically
deactivated.
Deactivating
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
X Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; flashes briefly.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
The interior motion sensor is deactivated.
X
To prevent a false alarm, deactivate the interior motion sensor if you lock your vehicle
and:
Rpeople
Rthe
or animals remain in the vehicle
side windows remain open
Z
Safety
Rthe
Rthe
81
82
83
Useful information .............................. 84
Key ....................................................... 84
Doors .................................................... 90
Boot ...................................................... 94
Side windows ...................................... 99
Opening and closing
Roof .................................................... 103
84
Key
Useful information
Opening and closing
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 34).
Key
Important safety notes
United Kingdom only:
G WARNING
When the double locks are activated, the
doors can no longer be opened from the
inside. People in the vehicle can no longer get
out, e.g. in hazardous situations. There is a
risk of injury.
Therefore, do not leave any people unsupervised in the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people in need of special assistance. Do not activate the double lock when
people are in the vehicle.
If the vehicle has been locked from the outside, the double lock function is activated as
standard. It is then not possible to open the
doors from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate the double-lock function by deactivating the interior motion sensor (Y page 80).
The doors can then be opened from the inside
after the vehicle has been locked from the
outside. The anti-theft alarm system is triggered if the door is opened from the inside.
Switch off the alarm (Y page 79).
All countries:
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they can:
Ropen doors and endanger other persons or
road users
out and be injured by the traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and, for example, trap themselves.
Children could also set the vehicle in motion,
for example by:
Rclimb
Rreleasing
the parking brake
the automatic transmission out of
park position P
Rstarting the engine.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle. Always
keep the key out of reach of children.
Rshifting
G WARNING
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If you attach heavy or large objects to the key,
the key could be unintentionally turned in the
ignition lock. This could cause the engine to
be switched off. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not attach any heavy or large objects to the
key. Remove any bulky keyrings before inserting the key into the ignition lock.
! Keep the key away from strong magnetic
fields. Otherwise, the remote control function could be affected.
Strong magnetic fields can occur in the
vicinity of powerful electrical installations.
Key
Rwith
electronic devices, e.g. a mobile
phone or another key
Rwith metallic objects, e.g. coins or metal
film
Rinside metallic objects, e.g. a metal case
This can affect the key's functionality.
Key functions
You can also set an audible signal to confirm
that the vehicle has been locked. The audible
signal can be activated and deactivated using
the on-board computer (Y page 242).
When it is dark, the surround lighting also
comes on if it is activated in the on-board
computer (Y page 241).
KEYLESS-GO
General notes
Bear in mind that the engine can be started by
any of the vehicle occupants if there is a KEYLESS-GO key in the vehicle.
Locking and unlocking centrally
: & To lock the vehicle
; F To unlock the boot lid
= % To unlock the vehicle
X
To unlock centrally: press the % button.
If you do not open the vehicle within
approximately 40 seconds of unlocking:
Rthe
Rthe
X
vehicle is locked again
anti-theft system is primed again
To lock centrally: press the & button.
The key centrally locks/unlocks:
Rthe
doors
boot lid
Rthe glove compartment
Rthe stowage compartment under the armrest
Rthe stowage compartment in the rear compartment
Rthe fuel filler flap
When unlocking, the turn signals flash once.
When locking, they flash three times.
Rthe
You can start, lock or unlock the vehicle using
KEYLESS-GO. To do this, you only need carry
the key with you. You can combine the KEYLESS-GO functions with the functions of a
conventional key. Unlock the vehicle by using
KEYLESS-GO, for instance, and lock it using
the & button on the key.
When locking or unlocking with KEYLESS-GO,
the distance between the key and the corresponding door handle must not be greater
than 1 m.
A check which periodically establishes a radio
connection between the vehicle and the key
determines whether a valid key is in the vehicle. This occurs, for example:
Rwhen
the external door handles are
touched
Rwhen starting the engine
Rwhile the vehicle is in motion
Z
Opening and closing
Do not keep the key:
85
Key
86
The key now functions as follows:
To unlock the driver's door: press the
% button once.
X To unlock centrally: press the % button twice.
X To lock centrally: press the & button.
Opening and closing
X
The KEYLESS-GO function is changed as follows:
To unlock the driver's door: touch the
inner surface of the door handle on the
driver's door.
X To unlock centrally: touch the inner surface of the front-passenger door handle.
X To lock centrally: touch the outer sensor
surface on one of the door handles.
X
To unlock the vehicle: touch the inner
surface of the door handle.
X To lock the vehicle: touch sensor surface :.
X Convenience closing feature: touch
recessed sensor surface ; for an extended period.
Further information on the convenience
closing feature (Y page 101).
X To unlock the boot lid: pull the boot lid
handle.
The vehicle only unlocks the boot lid.
X
X
To restore the factory settings: press
and hold down the % and & buttons
simultaneously for approximately six seconds until the battery check lamp flashes
twice (Y page 87).
Emergency key element
Changing the settings of the locking
system
You can change the settings of the locking
system. This means only the driver's door, the
lockable stowage compartments in the vehicle interior and the fuel filler flap are unlocked
when the vehicle is unlocked. This is useful if
you frequently travel on your own.
X To change the setting: press and hold
down the % and & buttons simultaneously for approximately six seconds until
the battery check lamp flashes twice
(Y page 87).
i If the setting of the locking system is
changed within the signal range of the vehicle, pressing the & or % button:
Rlocks
or
Runlocks
General notes
If the vehicle can no longer be locked or
unlocked with the key, use the emergency
key element.
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the driver's door or the boot
lid, the anti-theft alarm system will be triggered (Y page 79).
There are several ways to deactivate the
alarm:
X
or
X
Insert the key into the ignition lock.
or
X
the vehicle
To deactivate the alarm with the key:
press the % or & button on the key.
To deactivate the alarm with KEYLESSGO: press the Start/Stop button in the ignition lock. The key must be in the vehicle.
Key
Lock or unlock the vehicle using KEYLESSGO. The key must be outside the vehicle.
If you unlock the vehicle using the emergency
key element, the fuel filler flap will not automatically be unlocked.
X
To unlock the fuel filler flap: insert the
key into the ignition lock.
severe health problems. There is a risk of fatal
injury.
Keep batteries out of the reach of children. If
a battery is swallowed, seek medical attention
immediately.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
Removing the emergency key element
X
Push release catch : in the direction of
the arrow and at the same time, remove
emergency key element ; from the key.
For further information about:
Runlocking
the driver's door (Y page 93)
Runlocking the boot (Y page 99)
Rlocking the vehicle (Y page 93)
Opening and closing
or
X
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the batteries replaced at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Checking the battery
Inserting the emergency key element
X
Push emergency key element ; completely into the key until it engages and
release catch : is back in its basic position.
Battery of the key
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Batteries contain toxic and corrosive substances. If batteries are swallowed, it can result in
87
Press the & or % button.
The battery is working properly if battery
check lamp : lights up briefly.
The battery is discharged if battery check
lamp : does not light up briefly.
X Replace the battery (Y page 88).
X
Z
Key
88
i If the key battery is checked within the
signal reception range of the vehicle, pressing the & or % button:
Rlocks
or
Runlocks
the vehicle
Opening and closing
i You can obtain a battery from any qualified specialist workshop.
Replacing the battery
You require a CR 2025 3 V cell battery.
X Remove the emergency key element from
the key (Y page 86).
Press emergency key element ; into the
opening in the key in the direction of the
arrow until battery compartment cover :
opens. When doing so, do not hold battery
compartment cover : shut.
X Remove battery compartment cover :.
X
Repeatedly tap the key against your palm
until battery = falls out.
X Insert the new battery with the positive terminal facing upwards. Use a lint-free cloth
to do so.
X Make sure that the surface of the battery is
free of lint, grease and other contamination.
X
X
Insert the front tabs of battery compartment cover : into the housing and then
press to close it.
Insert emergency key element ; into the
key (Y page 86).
X Check the function of all key buttons on the
vehicle.
X
Key
89
Problems with the key
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
If this does not work:
X Lock (Y page 93) or unlock (Y page 93) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
The key is faulty.
Lock (Y page 93) or unlock (Y page 93) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X Have the key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
You can no longer lock There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
or unlock the vehicle
X Lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of
using KEYLESS-GO.
the key. To do this, hold the key as close as possible to the
vehicle and press the % or & button.
If the vehicle can also not be locked/unlocked using the remote
control function:
X Lock (Y page 93) or unlock (Y page 93) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
There is a fault with KEYLESS-GO.
Lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of
the key.
X Have KEYLESS-GO checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
If the vehicle can also not be locked/unlocked using the remote
control function:
X Lock (Y page 93) or unlock (Y page 93) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X Have KEYLESS-GO checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
You have lost a key.
Have the key deactivated at a qualified specialist workshop.
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
X If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
X
X
You have lost the emergency key element.
X
X
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
Z
Opening and closing
You can no longer lock The key battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
or unlock the vehicle
X Check the key battery (Y page 87) and replace it if necessary
using the key.
(Y page 88).
90
Doors
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Opening and closing
The engine can no lon- The on-board voltage is too low.
ger be started using the X Switch off non-essential consumers, e.g. seat heating or interior
key.
lighting, and try to start the engine again.
If this does not work:
Check the starter battery and charge it if necessary
(Y page 584).
or
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 586).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The engine can no longer be started using
KEYLESS-GO. The key
is in the vehicle.
The vehicle is locked.
Unlock the vehicle and try to start the vehicle again.
X
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
X Start your vehicle with the key in the ignition lock.
Doors
Important safety notes
United Kingdom only:
G WARNING
When the double locks are activated, the
doors can no longer be opened from the
inside. People in the vehicle can no longer get
out, e.g. in hazardous situations. There is a
risk of injury.
Therefore, do not leave any people unsupervised in the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people in need of special assistance. Do not activate the double lock when
people are in the vehicle.
If the vehicle has been locked from the outside, the double-lock function is activated as
standard. It is then not possible to open the
doors from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate the double-lock function by deactivating the interior motion sensor (Y page 80).
The doors can then be opened from the inside
after the vehicle has been locked from the
outside. The anti-theft alarm system is trig-
gered if the door is opened from the inside.
Switch off the alarm (Y page 79).
All countries:
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen doors, thereby endangering other per-
sons or road users
Rget out and be struck by oncoming traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example, if they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children and animals unattended in the vehicle. Keep the keys out of the reach of children.
Doors
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they can:
91
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
Ropen doors and endanger other persons or
Rreleasing
the parking brake
the automatic transmission out of
park position P
Rstarting the engine.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle. Always
keep the key out of reach of children.
Rshifting
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they can:
Ropen doors and endanger other persons or
road users
Rclimb out and be injured by the traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and, for example, trap themselves.
Children could also set the vehicle in motion,
for example by:
Unlocking and opening the doors
from the inside
! The side windows will not open/close if
the battery is discharged or if the side windows have iced up. It will then not be possible to close the door. Do not attempt to
force the door to close. You could otherwise damage the door or the side window.
For all countries except the United Kingdom: you can open a door from inside the
vehicle even if it has been locked.
If the vehicle has previously been locked with
the key or with KEYLESS-GO, opening a door
from the inside will trigger the anti-theft alarm
system. Switch off the alarm (Y page 79).
United Kingdom only: if the vehicle has
been locked with the key from the outside,
the double-lock function is activated as
standard. It is then not possible to open the
doors from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate the double lock function by deactivating the interior motion sensor (Y page 80).
The doors can then be opened from the inside
after the vehicle has been locked from the
outside. The anti-theft alarm system is triggered if the door is opened from the inside.
Switch off the alarm (Y page 79).
Rreleasing
the parking brake
Rshifting the automatic transmission out of
park position P
Rstarting the engine.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle. Always
keep the key out of reach of children.
G WARNING
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
Z
Opening and closing
road users
out and be injured by the traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and, for example, trap themselves.
Children could also set the vehicle in motion,
for example by:
Rclimb
Doors
92
X
Pull door handle ;.
If the door is locked, locking knob : pops
up. The door is unlocked and can be
opened.
i When a door is opened, the side window
Opening and closing
on that side opens slightly. When the door
is closed, the side window is raised again.
Centrally locking and unlocking the
vehicle from the inside
You can centrally lock or unlock the vehicle
from the inside. For example, you can unlock
the front-passenger door from the inside or
lock the vehicle before you pull away.
double lock function by deactivating the interior motion sensor (Y page 80). The doors can
then be opened from the inside after the vehicle has been locked from the outside. The
anti-theft alarm system is triggered if the door
is opened from the inside. Switch off the
alarm (Y page 79).
If a locked door is opened from the inside, the
previous unlock status of the vehicle will be
taken into consideration if:
Rthe
vehicle was locked using the locking
button for the central locking, or
Rif the vehicle was locked automatically
The vehicle will be fully unlocked if it had previously been fully unlocked. If only the driver's
door had been previously unlocked, only the
door which has been opened from the inside
is unlocked.
Automatic locking feature
X
X
To unlock: press button :.
To lock: press button ;.
If the front-passenger door is closed, the
vehicle locks.
The central locking/unlocking button does
not lock or unlock the fuel filler flap or the
stowage compartments, such as the glove
compartment.
You cannot unlock the vehicle centrally from
the inside if the vehicle has been locked with
the key or KEYLESS-GO.
For all countries except the United Kingdom: you can open a door from inside the
vehicle even if it has been locked.
United Kingdom only: if the vehicle has
been locked from the outside, the doublelock function is activated as standard. It is
then not possible to open the doors from
inside the vehicle. You can deactivate the
: To deactivate
; To activate
To deactivate: press and hold button :
for about five seconds until a tone sounds.
X To activate: press and hold button ; for
about five seconds until a tone sounds.
X
i If you press one of the two buttons and do
not hear a tone, the relevant setting has
already been selected.
The vehicle is locked automatically when the
ignition is switched on and the wheels are
turning.
Doors
93
You could therefore be locked out if:
Rthe
vehicle is being pushed.
vehicle is being towed.
Rthe vehicle is being tested on a dynamometer.
You can also switch the automatic locking
function on and off using the on-board computer (Y page 242).
Power closing
Power closing pulls the doors and boot lid into
their locks automatically even if they are only
partly closed.
X Power closing feature (doors): push the
door past the first detent position into the
lock.
Power closing will pull the door fully closed.
X To power close the boot lid: lightly push
the boot lid closed.
The power closing function pulls the boot
lid closed.
Unlocking the driver's door (emergency key element)
If the vehicle can no longer be unlocked with
the key, use the emergency key element.
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the driver's door, the antitheft alarm system will be triggered
(Y page 79).
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 86).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
Turn the emergency key element anticlockwise as far as it will go to position 1.
The door is unlocked.
i On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the
emergency key element clockwise.
X
Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Insert emergency key element into the key
(Y page 86).
X
Locking the vehicle (emergency key
element)
If the vehicle can no longer be locked with the
key, use the emergency key element.
X Open the driver's door.
X Close the front-passenger door and the
boot lid.
X Press the locking button (Y page 92).
X Check whether the locking knob on the
front-passenger door is still visible. Press
down the locking knob by hand, if necessary.
X Close the driver's door.
X Remove the emergency key element from
the key (Y page 86).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
Z
Opening and closing
Rthe
Boot
94
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
! The boot lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
Opening and closing
! Only close the boot once the roof is lowered completely. Otherwise, you could
damage the roof.
1 To lock
Turn the emergency key element clockwise
as far as it will go to position 1.
i On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the
emergency key element anti-clockwise.
X
Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Make sure that the doors and the boot lid
are locked.
X Insert emergency key element into the key
(Y page 86).
X
i If you lock the vehicle as described above,
the fuel filler flap is not locked. The antitheft alarm system is not primed.
Boot
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If objects, luggage or loads are not secured or
not secured sufficiently, they could slip, tip
over or be flung around and thereby hit vehicle
occupants. There is a risk of injury, especially
when braking or abruptly changing directions.
Always store objects so that they cannot be
flung around. Secure objects, luggage or
loads against slipping or tipping before the
journey.
G WARNING
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
i Opening dimensions of the boot lid
(Y page 629).
i When the soft top is open, you can use
loading aid (Y page 546) to raise the folded
soft top when loading it into the boot. For
this purpose, you can also open the boot
separator.
The boot separator must be closed again
after loading. Otherwise, the soft top can
no longer be closed.
You can unlock the boot lid when the vehicle
is stationary and the roof is fully opened or
closed.
Do not leave the key in the boot. You could
otherwise lock yourself out.
The boot lid can be:
Ropened
and closed from outside
Ropened and closed automatically from out-
side (vehicles with boot lid remote closing
feature)
Ropened and closed automatically from
inside (vehicles with boot lid remote closing
feature)
Ropened, closed or stopped during operation without the use of your hands (vehicles
with KEYLESS-GO and HANDS-FREE
ACCESS)
Rlocked separately
Runlocked with the emergency key element
Boot lid reversing feature
The boot lid is equipped with an automatic
reversing feature. It reacts if a solid object
obstructs or restricts the boot lid during the
Boot
closing procedure. The boot lid opens again
automatically. The automatic reversing function is only an aid and is not a substitute for
your attentiveness to the boot lid while it is
closing.
The reversing function does not react:
this purpose, you can also open the boot
separator.
The boot separator must be closed again
after loading. Otherwise, the roof can no
longer be closed.
Closing
Opening and closing
G WARNING
Rto soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small fin-
gers
Rover
the last 8 mm of the closing path
This means that the reversing feature cannot
prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area.
If someone is trapped:
Rpress
the F button on the key, or
the remote operating switch on the
driver's door, or
Rpress the closing or locking button on the
boot lid, or
Rpull the boot lid handle
Rpress
Opening/closing from the outside
Opening
X
X
Pull the boot lid down using recess :.
Lock the vehicle if necessary with the &
button on the key or with KEYLESS-GO.
i If a KEYLESS-GO key is detected in the
boot, the boot lid cannot be locked. It then
opens again.
Opening/closing automatically from
the outside
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Press the % button on the key.
Pull handle :.
X Raise the boot lid.
i When the soft top is open, you can use
loading aid (Y page 546) to raise the folded
soft top when loading it into the boot. For
X
X
95
Parts of the body could become trapped during automatic closing of the tailgate. Moreover, people, e.g. children, may be standing in
the closing area or may enter the closing area
during the closing process. There is a risk of
injury.
Make sure that nobody is in the vicinity of the
closing area during the closing process.
Use one of the following options to stop the
closing process:
Rpress
the F button on the key.
the remote operating switch on the
driver's door.
Rpress
Z
Boot
96
Rpress
the closing or locking button on the
tailgate.
Rpull the handle on the tailgate.
! The boot lid swings upwards when
Opening and closing
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
i Opening dimensions of the boot lid
(Y page 629).
Vehicles with boot lid remote closing feature
and KEYLESS-GO: you can simultaneously
close the boot lid and lock the vehicle.
Press locking button ; in the boot lid.
If a KEYLESS-GO key is detected outside
the vehicle, the boot lid closes and the vehicle locks.
i If a key with KEYLESS-GO is detected in
the boot, the boot lid opens again after it is
closed. It does not lock.
X
Opening
You can automatically open the boot lid using
the handle in the boot lid.
X
If the boot is unlocked, pull the boot lid
handle and release it again immediately.
Vehicles with the boot lid remote closing feature: the boot lid can also be opened automatically with the key.
X
Press and hold the F button on the key
until the boot lid opens.
Closing
HANDS-FREE ACCESS
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The vehicle exhaust system can become very
hot. If you use HANDS-FREE ACCESS, you
could burn yourself by touching the exhaust
system. There is a risk of injury. Always
ensure that you only make a leg movement
within the detection range of sensors.
! If the key is within the rear detection
range of KEYLESS-GO, the following situations, for example, could lead to the unintentional opening of the boot:
Rusing
a car wash
a high-pressure cleaner
Make sure that the key is at least 2 m away
from the vehicle.
Rusing
General notes
: Closing button
; Locking button
X
To close: press closing button : in the
boot lid.
With KEYLESS-GO and HANDS-FREE
ACCESS, you can open or close the boot lid or
stop the procedure without using your hands.
This is useful if you have your hands full. To do
this, make a kicking movement under the
bumper with your foot.
Observe the following points:
RCarry
your KEYLESS-GO key about your
person. The KEYLESS-GO key must be in
the rear detection range of the vehicle.
RWhen making the kicking movement, make
sure that you are standing firmly on the
Boot
Operation
X
RAlways ensure that you only make a kicking
movement within the detection range of
sensors :.
RStand at least 30 cm away from the rear
area while doing so.
RDo not come into contact with the bumper
while making the kicking movement. Otherwise, the sensors may not function correctly.
RHANDS-FREE ACCESS does not function
when the engine is started.
RIf a KEYLESS-GO key is within the rear
detection range of KEYLESS-GO, HANDSFREE ACCESS could be triggered. The boot
lid could thus be opened or closed unintentionally, for example, if you:
- set something down or lift something
behind the vehicle
- polish the rear of the vehicle
Do not carry the KEYLESS-GO key about
your person in such situations. This will
prevent the unintentional opening/closing
of the boot.
RDirt caused by road salt around sensors :
may restrict functionality.
RUsing HANDS-FREE ACCESS with a prosthetic leg may restrict functionality.
To open/close: kick into sensor detection
range : under the bumper with your leg.
You will hear a warning tone while the boot
lid is opening or closing.
If the boot lid does not open after several attempts: wait at least ten seconds
then move your leg under the bumper once
again.
i If you hold your foot under the bumper for
too long, the boot lid does not open or
close. Repeat the leg movement more
quickly if this occurs.
To stop the opening or closing procedure:
X
Rmove
your foot in sensor detection
range : under the bumper, or
Rpull the handle on the outside of the boot lid
or
Rpress the closing button in the boot lid or
Rpress the F button on the key
If the boot lid closing procedure has been
stopped:
Rmove your foot under the bumper again and
the boot lid will open.
If the boot lid opening procedure has been
stopped:
Rmove your foot under the bumper again and
the boot lid will close.
Z
Opening and closing
ground and that there is sufficient clearance to the rear of the vehicle. You could
otherwise lose your balance, e.g. on ice.
97
98
Boot
Opening/closing automatically from
the inside
Opening and closing
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Parts of the body could become trapped during automatic closing of the tailgate. In addition, people may be standing in the closing
area or may enter the closing area, e.g. children, during the closing procedure. There is a
risk of injury.
Make sure that nobody is in the vicinity of the
closing area during the closing process.
Release the remote operating switch immediately if somebody becomes trapped. To reopen the tailgate pull on the remote operating
switch.
G WARNING
To open: pull remote operating switch for
boot lid : until the boot lid opens.
X To close: press remote operating switch
for boot lid : until the boot lid is closed.
X
You can open and close the boot lid from the
driver's seat when the vehicle is stationary
and unlocked.
Locking the boot separately
The separate boot locking function is only
available in certain countries.
You can lock the boot separately. If you then
unlock the vehicle centrally, the boot remains
locked and cannot be opened.
X Close the boot lid.
X Remove the emergency key element from
the key (Y page 86).
The boot lid can be automatically opened or
closed even if the key is not in the vehicle. If
children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could activate the functions. There is a
risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
! The boot lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
i Opening dimensions of the boot lid
(Y page 629).
Opening and closing
1 Basic position
2 To lock
Insert the emergency key element into the
boot lid lock as far as the stop.
X Turn the emergency key element clockwise
from position 1 to position 2.
X Pull out the emergency key element.
X Insert emergency key element into the key
(Y page 86).
X
Side windows
! The boot lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
If the boot cannot be unlocked with the key or
KEYLESS-GO, use the emergency key element.
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the boot lid, the anti-theft
alarm system will be triggered (Y page 79).
X Remove the emergency key element from
the key (Y page 86).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
boot lid lock as far as the stop.
1 Basic position
2 To unlock
Turn the emergency key element anticlockwise from position 1 as far as it will
go to position 2.
X Pull the boot lid handle.
The boot is unlocked.
X Turn the emergency key element back to
position 1 and remove it.
X Insert emergency key element into the key
(Y page 86).
Side windows
Important safety notes
G WARNING
While opening the side windows, body parts
could become trapped between the side window and the door frame as the side window
moves. There is a risk of injury.
Make sure that nobody touches the side window during the opening procedure. If somebody becomes trapped, release the switch or
pull the switch to close the side window again.
G WARNING
While closing the side windows, body parts in
the closing area could become trapped. There
is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area. If somebody
becomes trapped, release the switch or press
the switch to open the side window again.
G WARNING
Children could become trapped if they operate the side windows, particularly when unattended. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
X
i When you lock the vehicle (Y page 93),
the boot is also locked.
Side window reversing feature
The front side windows are equipped with an
automatic reversing feature. If a solid object
blocks or restricts the upward movement of
one of the front side windows during the automatic closing process, the side window opens
again automatically. During the manual closing process, the side window only opens
again automatically after the corresponding
switch is released. However, the automatic
reversing feature is only an aid, not a substitute for your attention when closing the side
window.
Z
Opening and closing
Unlocking the boot (emergency key
element)
99
Side windows
100
G WARNING
The reversing function does not react:
Rto soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small fin-
gers
Opening and closing
Rwhile
resetting
This means that the reversing feature cannot
prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of injury.
When closing, make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area. If someone
becomes trapped, press the switch to open
the side window again.
Opening and closing the side windows
Opening and closing the side windows
in the front
The switches for the side windows are located
on the driver's door. There is also a switch for
the front-passenger side window on the frontpassenger door.
The switches on the driver's door take precedence.
To close manually: pull the corresponding
button and hold it.
X To close fully: pull the button beyond the
point of resistance and release it.
Automatic closing is started.
X To interrupt automatic operation: press
or pull the corresponding switch again.
X
i You can continue to operate the side win-
dows after you switch off the engine. This
function remains active for five minutes or
until the driver's or front-passenger door is
opened.
Opening/closing the rear side windows
To open: open the front side window on the
corresponding side (Y page 100).
X Press the corresponding switch again and
release.
The corresponding rear side window opens
fully.
X To stop the rear side windows: briefly
pull the corresponding switch up and
release.
X To close: close the front side window on
the corresponding side (Y page 100).
X Pull the respective switch and hold it.
The corresponding rear side window will
continue to close until you release the
switch.
X
Opening and closing all side windows
Using the switch on the centre console
: Left
; Right
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To open manually: press and hold the corresponding button.
X To open fully: press the button beyond the
point of resistance and release it.
Automatic closing is started.
X
Using the switch on the centre console, you
can close all side windows simultaneously.
X Open the cover on the lower centre console.
The switch for all side windows is under the
cover.
Side windows
101
You can use the key to open or close all side
windows simultaneously.
Close the roof (Y page 104).
Open the boot separator (Y page 105).
X Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: point the
tip of the key at the door handle on the
driver's door.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: the key must
be within 2 m of the vehicle.
X To open all side windows: press the %
button on the key until the side windows
are fully opened.
X To interrupt the opening procedure:
release the % button.
X To close all side windows: press the &
button on the key until the side windows
are fully closed.
X To interrupt the closing procedure:
release the & button.
X
To open all side windows: press
switch : to the point of resistance.
X To open all side windows fully: press
switch : beyond the point of resistance.
All side windows open simultaneously.
i If, after opening the windows, you close
one side window using the button in the
door control panel:
X
Rthe
front side window closes first and
Rthen the corresponding rear side window
closes
To close all side windows: pull switch :.
All side windows begin the closing procedure simultaneously. The rear side windows close after the front side windows.
X Make sure that all the side windows are
fully closed.
X
Using the key
G WARNING
When using convenience closing, you could
become trapped within the sweep of the closing window. There is a risk of injury.
Monitor the entire closing procedure when
using convenience closing. When closing,
make sure that no one has any parts of the
body within the closing area.
If someone is trapped:
X
X
Convenience closing with KEYLESS-GO
G WARNING
When using convenience closing, you could
become trapped within the sweep of the closing window. There is a risk of injury.
Monitor the entire closing procedure when
using convenience closing. When closing,
make sure that no one has any parts of the
body within the closing area.
If someone is trapped:
Release the recessed sensor surface on the
door handle immediately.
X Pull the door handle immediately and hold
it until the side windows open again.
X
With KEYLESS-GO you can close all side windows simultaneously. The KEYLESS-GO key
must be outside the vehicle. All the doors
must be closed.
Release the & button immediately.
Press and hold the % button until the
side windows open again.
Z
Opening and closing
X
Side windows
Opening and closing
102
Touch recessed sensor surface : on the
door handle until the side windows are fully
closed.
i Make sure you only touch recessed sensor surface :.
X
Make sure that all the side windows are
closed.
X To interrupt convenience closing:
release recessed sensor surface : on the
door handle.
X
Resetting the side windows
If a side window can no longer be closed fully,
you must reset it.
X Close all doors.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Pull the corresponding switch on the door
control panel until the side window is completely closed. (Y page 100)
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
If the side window opens again slightly:
immediately pull the corresponding switch
on the door control panel until the side window is completely closed (Y page 100).
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
X If the corresponding side window remains
closed after the button has been released,
the side window has been reset correctly. If
this is not the case, repeat the steps above
again.
X
Roof
103
Problems with the side windows
If you close a side window again immediately after it has been blocked or reset, the side window
closes with increased or maximum force. The reversing function is then not active. Parts of the
body could be trapped in the closing area in the process. This poses an increased risk of injury or
even fatal injury.
Make sure that no parts of the body are in the closing area. To stop the closing process, release
the switch or push the switch again to reopen the side window.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
A side window cannot
be closed because it is
blocked by objects, e.g.
leaves in the window
guide.
Remove the objects.
X Close the side window.
X
A side window cannot If a side window is obstructed during closing and reopens again
be closed and you can- slightly:
not see the cause.
X Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding
switch again until the side window has closed.
The side window is closed with increased force.
If a side window is obstructed again during closing and reopens
again slightly:
X
Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding
switch again until the side window has closed.
The side window is closed without the anti-entrapment feature.
Roof
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you do not fully open/close the soft top, the
soft-top hydraulics depressurise after a short
time. This causes the soft top to lower unexpectedly and may cause you or others to be
trapped. There is a risk of injury.
Always open or close the soft top completely.
G WARNING
Closing the roof manually is a complex, technically challenging procedure that requires
considerable effort during certain phases.
You or others could be trapped while performing this task. There is a risk of injury.
Only have the soft top closed manually at a
qualified specialist workshop.
! Never sit on the rear compartment trim or
stow heavy objects there. You will otherwise damage the roof and rear compartment trim of the vehicle.
! Do not forget that the weather can
change abruptly. Make certain that the roof
is closed when you leave the vehicle. The
vehicle electronics can be damaged if
water enters the vehicle interior.
Z
Opening and closing
G WARNING
104
Roof
Opening and closing
! When opening and closing the roof, make
sure that:
Rthere is sufficient upward clearance, as
the roof swings upwards.
Rthere is sufficient clearance behind the
vehicle, as the boot lid swings backwards
beyond the bumper.
Rthe boot is only loaded to below the boot
separator.
Rthe boot separator is not pushed up by
the load.
Rthe boot separator is closed.
Rthe boot lid is closed.
Rthe outside temperature is above Ò15 †.
You could otherwise damage the roof, boot
and other parts of the vehicle.
i Vehicle dimensions when opening/closing the roof (Y page 629).
i Make sure that the roof and rear window
are dry and clean before opening the roof.
Otherwise, water or dirt could enter the
vehicle interior or boot.
Opening and closing using the roof
switch
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When opening or closing the roof, body parts
could be trapped by, for example, the roof
mechanism, boot lid or side windows. There is
a risk of injury.
When raising or lowering the roof, make sure
that no body parts are in the vicinity of moving
components. If someone becomes trapped,
release the button.
Opening and closing
Secure the vehicle against rolling away
(Y page 175).
X Close the boot separator (Y page 106).
X Close the boot lid.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Open the cover on the lower centre console.
Roof switch : is located under the cover.
X To open: pull soft-top switch : until the
entire soft top is stowed away in the boot.
You see the Vario-roof in operation
message in the multifunction display. As
soon as the opening procedure has ended,
the message disappears and you hear a
tone.
The front side windows close. The rear side
windows open.
X To close: press and hold soft-top switch :
until the soft top is fully closed.
You see the Vario-roof in operation
message in the multifunction display. As
soon as the closing procedure has ended,
the message disappears and you hear a
tone.
All of the side windows close.
X Make sure that all the side windows are
fully closed.
X
Roof
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When opening or closing the roof, body parts
could be trapped by, for example, the roof
mechanism, boot lid or side windows. There is
a risk of injury.
When raising or lowering the roof, make sure
that no body parts are in the vicinity of moving
components. If someone becomes trapped,
release the button.
Opening and closing
Close the boot separator (Y page 105).
X Close the boot lid (Y page 94).
X Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: point the
tip of the key at the door handle on the
driver's door.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: the key must
be within 2 m of the vehicle.
X To open: press and hold the % button
on the key until the roof is fully opened.
The roof and the rear side windows open.
The front side windows close.
X To interrupt the opening procedure:
release the % button.
X To open the front side windows: press
and hold the % button on the key again.
X To close: press and hold the & button
on the key until the roof is fully closed.
The roof and the side windows close.
X To interrupt the closing procedure:
release the & button.
i The key cannot be used to open the roof if
the roof is closed and the boot separator is
open. Instead, all of the side windows open
or close simultaneously (Y page 100).
X
Locking the roof again
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you do not fully open/close the soft top, the
soft-top hydraulics depressurise after a short
time. This causes the soft top to lower unexpectedly and may cause you or others to be
trapped. There is a risk of injury.
Always open or close the soft top completely.
The roof is not locked if:
Rthe K symbol and the Vario-roof
in
operation message appears in the multifunction display
Rthe K symbol and the Open/close
vario-roof completely message
appear and you hear a warning tone.
Ryou hear a warning tone for up to 10 seconds when pulling away or while driving.
Locking
You can lock the roof again if it is not locked
fully.
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon
as possible, paying attention to road and
traffic conditions.
X Make sure the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X Press the roof switch (Y page 104).
X
Boot separator
General notes
! To avoid damaging the roof or luggage
when folding back the roof, you should:
Ronly load the boot to below the boot separator
Rnot place any objects on or in front of the
boot separator
Z
Opening and closing
Opening and closing with the key
105
Roof
106
Rnot
place any objects on the cover
behind the roll bars
Rnot allow the load to push up the boot
separator
Removing and fitting
! Make sure that the boot separator is fully
Opening and closing
closed. Otherwise, the roof could be
blocked when opening or closing.
The boot separator can be used to cover luggage and loads in the boot.
Opening and closing
Closed boot separator
: Boot separator
; Net
= Eyelets
? Handle
To remove: unhook net ; from the holder
on the left and right-hand sides and guide it
to the rear until it is completely rolled up.
X Remove boot separator : from fastening
eyelets = in the side panels.
X Push boot separator : against the direction of the arrow by handle ?.
X
Closed boot separator
: Boot separator
; Eyelets
= Handle
To close: pull boot separator : in the
direction of the arrow by handle =.
X Hook boot separator : into fastening eyelets ; in the side panels.
X To open: remove boot separator : from
fastening eyelets ; in the side panels.
X Push boot separator : against the direction of the arrow by handle =.
X
Opened boot separator
: Boot separator
A Catch lever (example: driver's side)
Turn driver's side catch lever A in the
direction of the arrow.
X Repeat the same process on the catch lever
on the passenger side.
Boot separator : is unlocked.
X Pull out boot separator : in the direction
of the arrow.
X
Roof
107
other road users. There is a risk of an accident
and injury.
Fit the draught stop as described. Do not
place any objects on top of the fitted draught
stop.
the roof is open. You could otherwise damage the draught stop or the vehicle interior.
A Catch lever (example: driver's side)
B Guide
To install: insert guides B of boot separator : into the brackets.
X Slide in boot separator : as far as it will go.
X Turn driver's side catch lever A in the
direction of the arrow.
X Repeat the same process on the catch lever
on the passenger side.
Boot separator : is unlocked.
X
Pull boot separator : by handle ? in the
direction of the arrow.
X Hook boot separator : into fastening eyelets = in the side panels.
X Pull net ; forwards and hook the left and
right-hand sides into the holder.
X
The draught stop offers protection from the
wind when driving with the roof down.
The draught stop can be fitted or removed
from the driver's side or passenger side. We
recommend that a second person assists you
when doing this.
Perform operations involving the draught
stop preferably on the side facing away from
traffic, after you have stopped the vehicle,
paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
Fitting/removing
Draught stop
Manual draught stop
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you use the draught stop in darkness or in
other conditions offering poor visibility, your
view to the rear is further impaired. There is a
risk of an accident.
Only use the draught stop when visibility conditions are good.
Rear brackets for draught stop
: Bracket cover, front-passenger side
; Bracket cover, driver's side
To fit: open the roof (Y page 104).
Press the mark on cover : and push in the
direction of the arrow.
X Repeat the procedure with cover ;.
The rear brackets for draught stop = are
visible.
X
X
G WARNING
If the draught stop is incorrectly fitted, it could
detach itself during a journey and endanger
Z
Opening and closing
! Fit or remove the draught stop only when
Roof
108
X
Slide covers : and ; of the rear brackets
against the direction of the arrow until they
are fully closed.
Electrical draught stop
Opening and closing
Important safety notes
=
?
A
B
Draught stop
Pin
Front brackets for draught stop
Lock cover (example: front-passenger
side)
Make sure that draught stop = is folded
back.
X Push the upper half of cover B on draught
stop =.
X Repeat the procedure with the cover on the
driver's side.
Draught stop = is unlocked.
X
Hold draught stop = at an angle and insert
pins ? into the rear brackets.
Make sure that pins ? sit correctly in the
brackets.
X Insert draught stop = into front brackets
A.
X Check whether draught stop = is correctly
seated in all four brackets.
X Push the lower half of cover B on draught
stop =.
Draught stop = is locked.
X Fold draught stop = forward if necessary.
X
To remove: make sure that draught stop
= is folded back.
X Push the upper half of cover B on draught
stop =.
Draught stop = is unlocked.
X First remove draught stop = from front
brackets A.
X Hold draught stop = at an angle and then
remove from the rear brackets.
G WARNING
If you use the draught stop in darkness or in
other conditions offering poor visibility, your
view to the rear is further impaired. There is a
risk of an accident.
Only use the draught stop when visibility conditions are good.
! When extending or retracting the draught
stop, make sure there are no objects on the
rear compartment trim. Otherwise, the
objects could damage the draught stop.
The draught stop offers protection from the
wind when driving with the roof down. The
roof must be fully open before the draught
stop can be extended.
Extending and retracting
Open the roof (Y page 103).
X Open the cover on the lower centre console.
The switch for the electrical draught stop is
under the cover.
X
X
To extend: press button :.
X To retract: press button : again.
X
Roof
Sunblind for the glass roof
109
RNever remove the trim behind the overhead
control panel.
the trim is damaged, never touch the
electrical components behind it.
RAlways have work on the MAGIC SKY CONTROL carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
The roller sunblind protects you from excessive glare and heat caused by the sun shining
through the glass roof.
To close: using handle : slide the roller
blind in the direction of the arrow.
X To open: using handle : slide the roller
blind in the opposite direction to the arrow.
X
The electrical components of MAGIC SKY
CONTROL are protected by a covering behind
the overhead control panel.
The MAGIC SKY CONTROL control unit has a
yellow high-voltage warning sticker. The electric cables of the high-voltage section are coloured orange.
MAGIC SKY CONTROL operation
MAGIC SKY CONTROL
General notes
MAGIC SKY CONTROL is a glass roof, the
transparency of which can be changed by
applying electrical voltage.
MAGIC SKY CONTROL can be switched
between darkened and transparent states.
i MAGIC SKY CONTROL darkens automat-
ically when you turn the key to position 0 in
the ignition lock or remove the key.
Risk of electric shock
G DANGER
MAGIC SKY CONTROL operates using high
voltage. If the trim behind the overhead control panel is damaged or removed, electrical
components will be exposed. If you touch
these components, you could get an electric
shock. There is a risk of fatal injury.
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
MAGIC SKY CONTROL switches to the status it was set to before the engine was
switched off.
X To change the degree of transparency:
press button :.
X
i At sub-zero temperatures, the change is
slower and uneven. The entire process may
take some time.
Z
Opening and closing
RIf
110
Roof
Problems with the roof
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Opening and closing
The roof will not open or The boot separator is not in place.
close.
X Close the boot separator (Y page 106).
The boot lid is open.
X Close the boot lid (Y page 95).
The on-board voltage is too low.
X Leave the engine running.
The roof has been opened and closed several times in a row. The
roof drive has been automatically deactivated.
You can open and close the roof again after approximately ten
minutes.
X Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
X Repeat the opening or closing procedure.
The automatic roof mechanism is faulty.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
111
Useful information ............................ 112
Correct driver's seat position .......... 112
Seats .................................................. 113
steering wheel .................................. 118
Mirrors ............................................... 120
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Memory function .............................. 123
Correct driver's seat position
112
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 34).
Correct driver's seat position
Ryou
have set the seat angle so that your
thighs are gently supported.
Ryou can depress the pedals properly.
X Check whether the head restraint is adjusted properly.
When doing so, make sure that you have
adjusted the head restraint so that the back
of your head is supported at eye level by the
centre of the head restraint.
X Observe the safety guidelines on steering
wheel adjustment (Y page 118).
X Make sure that steering wheel : is adjusted properly.
Adjusting the steering wheel electrically
(Y page 118)
When adjusting the steering wheel, make
sure that:
Ryou
can hold the steering wheel with your
arms slightly bent.
Ryou can move your legs freely.
Ryou can see all the displays in the instrument cluster clearly.
X Observe the safety guidelines for seat belts
(Y page 57).
X Check whether you have fastened seat
belt ; properly (Y page 59).
The seat belt should:
Rfit
snugly across your body
routed across the middle of your shoulder
Rbe routed in your pelvic area across the hip
joints
X Before starting off, adjust the rear-view mirror and the exterior mirrors (Y page 120) in
such a way that you have a good view of
road and traffic conditions.
X Store the seat, steering wheel and exterior
mirror settings using the memory function
(Y page 123).
Rbe
Observe the safety guidelines on seat
adjustment (Y page 113).
X Make sure that seat = is adjusted properly.
Electrical seat adjustment (Y page 114)
When adjusting the seat, make sure that:
X
Ryou are as far away from the driver's airbag
as possible.
Ryou are sitting in a normal upright position.
Ryou
can fasten the seat belt properly.
have moved the backrest to an almost
vertical position.
Ryou
Seats
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children adjust the seats, they could
become trapped, especially if they are unattended. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If the driver's seat is not engaged, it can move
unexpectedly while the vehicle is in motion.
This could cause you to lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Always make sure that the driver's seat is
engaged before starting the engine.
G WARNING
If you adjust the seat height carelessly, you or
other vehicle occupants could be trapped and
thereby injured. Children in particular could
accidentally press the electrical seat adjustment buttons and become trapped. There is a
risk of injury.
While moving the seats, make sure that your
hands or other body parts do not get under the
lever assembly of the seat adjustment system.
G WARNING
When adjusting a seat, you or another vehicle
occupant could become trapped by the guide
rail of the seat, for instance. There is a risk of
injury.
Make sure that no one has any part of their
body within the sweep of the seat when
adjusting it.
of injury to the head and neck in the event of
an accident or sudden braking, for example.
Always drive with the head restraints fitted.
Ensure that the centre of the head restraints
support the back of each vehicle occupant's
head at eye level before driving off.
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirror
Rfasten the seat belt.
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirror and fasten the seat belt before starting
the engine.
! To avoid damage to the seats and the seat
heating, observe the following information:
Rdo
not spill any liquids on the seats. If
liquid is spilled on the seats, dry them as
soon as possible.
Rif the seat covers are damp or wet, do not
switch on the seat heating. The seat
heating should also not be used to dry
the seats.
Rclean the seat covers as recommended;
see the "Interior care" section.
Rdo not transport heavy loads on the
seats. Do not place sharp objects on the
seat cushions, e.g. knives, nails or tools.
The seats should only be occupied by
passengers, if possible.
Rwhen the seat heating is in operation, do
not cover the seats with insulating materials, e.g. blankets, coats, bags, seat covers, child seats or booster seats.
G WARNING
The head restraints cannot provide the intended protection unless they are fitted and
adjusted correctly. There is an increased risk
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Seats
113
114
Seats
! To avoid damage to the seats and the seat
heating, observe the following information:
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Rdo
not spill any liquids on the seats. If
liquid is spilled on the seats, dry them as
soon as possible.
Rif the seat covers are damp or wet, do not
switch on the seat heating. The seat
heating should also not be used to dry
the seats.
Rclean the seat covers as recommended;
see "Interior care".
Rdo not transport heavy loads on the
seats. Do not place sharp objects on the
seat cushions, e.g. knives, nails or tools.
The seats should only be occupied by
passengers, if possible.
Rwhen the seat heating is in operation, do
not cover the seats with insulating materials, e.g. blankets, coats, bags, seat covers, child seats or booster seats.
! Make sure that there are no objects in the
footwell or behind the seats when moving
the seat back. There is a risk that the seats
and/or the objects could be damaged.
i The head restraints cannot be removed.
For more information, contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
A Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
B Backrest angle
i Further related subjects:
RYou can store the seat settings using the
memory function (Y page 123).
PRE-SAFE® is triggered, the frontpassenger seat will be moved to a better
position if it was previously in an unfavourable position (Y page 56).
RIf
Adjusting the front-passenger seat
from the driver's seat
G WARNING
If the front seats are positioned too closely to
the dashboard or steering wheel, the front
airbags could cause additional injuries to
vehicle occupants in the front. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Always adjust the front seats so that they are
as far away as possible from the front airbags.
In addition, observe the instructions on how to
adjust the seats correctly.
! Do not move the front-passenger seat
fully forwards if there are objects in the
luggage net in the front-passenger footwell.
The objects could otherwise be damaged.
Adjusting the seats electrically
:
;
=
?
Head restraint height
Seat height
Seat cushion angle
Seat cushion length
You can use the seat switches on the driver's
side to adjust the front-passenger seat.
Seats
To activate/deactivate: press button :.
If the indicator lamp in button : is lit, you can
access the following functions for the frontpassenger seat:
X
115
Adjusting the head restraints
Adjusting the head restraints electrically
Rcall
adjustment
up the memory function
Removing the seat belt from the seat
belt guide
G WARNING
When driving off-road, your body is subject to
forces from all directions due to the uneven
surface. You could be thrown from your seat,
for instance. There is a danger of injury.
Always wear a seat belt, even when driving offroad.
:
;
=
?
A
B
X
Head restraint height
Seat height
Seat cushion angle
Seat cushion length
Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
Backrest angle
To adjust the head restraint height: slide
the switch for the head restraint adjustment : up or down in the direction of the
arrow.
Sliding the seats forward/back
Both the driver's seat belt and the frontpassenger seat belt can be removed from the
seat belt guide. This makes it easier to move
the seats forward.
Before you drive off, the seat belt must be
inserted into the seat belt guide.
Observe the safety guidelines for seat belts
(Y page 57).
X To remove: open up magnetic head ; and
fold the tab up in the direction of the arrow.
X Take the seat belt out of seat belt guide :.
X To insert: fold the tab up in the direction of
the arrow.
X Insert the seat belt back into the seat belt
guide and fold the tab back down.
G WARNING
When adjusting a seat, you or another vehicle
occupant could become trapped by the guide
rail of the seat, for instance. There is a risk of
injury.
Make sure that no one has any part of their
body within the sweep of the seat when
adjusting it.
! Make sure that there are no containers in
the cup holder and no objects in the footwell or behind the seats when adjusting the
seats. Otherwise, you could damage the
seats and the objects.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Rseat
116
Seats
Switching the seat heating on/off
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Switching on/off
You can move the seat forwards, in order to
gain better access to the rear compartment,
e.g. to reach the stowage compartment in the
rear (Y page 546).
X Remove the seat belt from the seat belt
guide (Y page 115).
X To move the seat forwards: press :
on switch :.
The seat moves automatically to the foremost position.
X To move the seat backwards: press 9
on switch :.
The seat moves back to the previous position.
X To stop seat movement: press : or
9 in the opposite direction.
Adjusting the multicontour seat
You can set the multicontour seat using
COMAND Online(Y page 319).
Adjusting the active multicontour
seat
You can set the active multicontour seat
using COMAND Online (Y page 319).
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support
You can adjust the 4-way lumbar support with
COMAND Online (Y page 319).
G WARNING
If you repeatedly switch on seat heating, the
seat cushion and backrest padding may
become very hot. The health of vehicle occupants with limited temperature sensitivity or a
limited ability to react to excessively high
temperatures may be affected or they may
even suffer burn-like injuries. There is a risk of
injury.
Therefore, do not switch on the seat heating
repeatedly.
Driver's and front-passenger seat
The three red indicator lamps in the button
indicate the heating level you have selected.
The system automatically switches from level
3 to level 2 after approximately eight
minutes.
The system automatically switches from level
2 to level 1 after approximately ten minutes.
The system automatically switches off
approximately 20 minutes after it is set to
level 1.
You can set the distribution of the heated
sections of the seat cushion and backrest
using COMAND Online (Y page 320).
Seats
Make sure that the key is in position 1 or 2
in the ignition lock.
X To switch on: press button : repeatedly
until the desired heating level is set.
X To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
Make sure that the key is in position 1 or 2
in the ignition lock.
X To switch on: press button : repeatedly
until the desired ventilation level is set.
X To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat
i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat
heating may switch off.
Problems with the seat heating
The seat heating has switched off prematurely or cannot be switched on. The vehicle's
electrical system voltage is too low because
too many electrical consumers are switched
on.
Switch off electrical consumers that you do
not need, such as the rear window heating
or interior lighting.
X Once the battery is sufficiently charged,
switch the seat heating on again.
X
Switching the seat ventilation on/off
Switching on/off
X
ventilation may switch off.
i If you open the roof with the key
(Y page 105), the seat ventilation of the
driver's seat switches on automatically and
the side windows open.
Problems with the seat ventilation
The seat ventilation has switched off prematurely or cannot be switched on. The vehicle's
electrical system voltage is too low because
too many electrical consumers are switched
on.
X
Switch off electrical consumers that you do
not need, such as the rear window heating
or interior lighting.
AIRSCARF
Activating/deactivating
G WARNING
When AIRSCARF is switched on, very hot air
can flow from the vents in the head restraints.
This could result in burns in the immediate
vicinity of the air vents. There is a risk of injury.
Reduce the heater output before it becomes
too hot.
The three blue indicator lamps in the buttons
indicate the ventilation level you have selected.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
X
117
118
steering wheel
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
G WARNING
If the steering wheel lock is engaged, the vehicle can no longer be steered. There is a risk of
an accident.
Always switch on the ignition when towing
with a tow rope or a towing bar.
The AIRSCARF function warms the head and
neck area of vehicle occupants with warm air.
The warm air flows out of the holes in the head
restraints.
The three red indicator lamps in the button
indicate the heating level you have selected.
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X To switch on: press button :.
Three red indicator lamps in the button light
up. The blower starts up after a preheating
phase of seven seconds.
X Press button : repeatedly until the
desired heating level is set.
X To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
i The blower continues running for seven
seconds to cool down the heating elements.
i If the battery voltage is too low, AIRSCARF
may switch off.
steering wheel
Important safety notes
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjusting the steering wheel electrically
: To adjust the steering wheel height
; To adjust the steering wheel position
(fore-and-aft adjustment)
i Further related subjects:
REASY-ENTRY/EXIT
feature
(Y page 118)
Rstoring settings (Y page 123)
EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you drive off while the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT
feature is making adjustments, you could lose
control of the vehicle. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always wait until the adjustment process is
complete before driving off.
steering wheel
Rpress
one of the memory function position
buttons, or
Rmove the switch for steering wheel adjustment in the opposite direction to that in
which the steering wheel is moving.
The adjustment process is stopped.
G WARNING
When the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature adjusts
the steering wheel and the driver's seat, you
and other vehicle occupants – particularly
children – could become trapped. There is a
risk of injury.
While the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature is making adjustments, make sure that no one has
any body parts in the sweep of the seat and
the steering wheel.
If someone is trapped:
Rpress
one of the memory function position
buttons, or
Rpress one of the memory function memory
buttons, or
Rmove the switch for steering wheel adjustment in the opposite direction to that in
which the steering wheel is moving.
The adjustment process is stopped.
G WARNING
If you use openings in the bodywork or
detachable parts as steps, you could:
Rslip
and/or fall
Rdamage the vehicle and cause yourself to
fall.
There is a danger of injury.
Always use secure climbing aids, e.g. a suitable ladder.
The EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature makes getting
in and out of your vehicle easier.
You can activate and deactivate the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature in the on-board computer (Y page 243).
Position of the steering wheel when the
EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature is active
The steering wheel tilts upwards if you:
Rremove
the key from the ignition lock
the driver's door and KEYLESS-GO is
in position 1
Ropen the driver's door and the key is in
position 0 or 1 in the ignition lock
Ropen
i The steering wheel only moves upwards if
it has not already reached the upper end
stop.
Position of the steering wheel for driving
The steering wheel is moved to the previously
set position if:
Rthe
Ryou
driver's door is closed and
insert the key into the ignition lock
or
Ryou
press the Start/Stop button once on
vehicles with KEYLESS-GO
If you close the driver's door with the key
inserted in the ignition lock, the steering
wheel is automatically moved to the previously set position.
The last position of the steering wheel is
stored when you switch off the ignition or
when you store the setting with the memory
function (Y page 123).
Crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature
If the crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature is
triggered in an accident, the steering column
will move upwards when the driver's door is
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
G WARNING
When the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature adjusts
the steering wheel, you and other vehicle
occupants – particularly children – could
become trapped. There is a risk of injury.
While the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature is making adjustments, make sure that no one has
any body parts in the sweep of the steering
wheel.
If someone is trapped:
119
Mirrors
120
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
opened. This occurs irrespective of the position of the key in the ignition lock. This makes
it easier to exit the vehicle and rescue the
occupants.
The crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature is
only operational if the EASY-EXIT/ENTRY feature is activated in the on-board computer
(Y page 243).
This means that you could misjudge the distance from road users travelling behind, e.g.
when changing lane. There is a risk of an accident.
For this reason, always make sure of the
actual distance from the road users travelling
behind by glancing over your shoulder.
Mirrors
Rear-view mirror
Make sure that the key is in position 1 or 2
in the ignition lock.
X Press button : for the left-hand exterior
mirror or button ; for the right-hand exterior mirror.
The indicator lamp in the corresponding
button lights up in red.
The indicator lamp goes out again after
some time. You can adjust the selected
mirror using adjustment button = as long
as the indicator lamp is lit.
X Press adjustment button = up, down, to
the right or to the left.
The exterior mirror must be set to a position
that provides you with a good overview of
traffic conditions.
X
X
Anti-dazzle mode: flick anti-dazzle
switch : forwards or back.
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting the exterior mirrors
G WARNING
The exterior mirrors reduce the size of the
image. Objects visible in the mirrors are
closer than they appear. You could misjudge
the distance from road users driving behind
you when changing lanes, for instance. There
is a risk of an accident.
You should therefore always look over your
shoulder to determine the actual distance
from road users driving behind you.
G WARNING
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side reduces the size of the image. Visible
objects are actually closer than they appear.
The convex exterior mirrors provide a larger
field of vision.
After the engine has been started, the exterior mirrors are automatically heated if the
rear window heating is switched on and the
outside temperature is low. Heating takes a
maximum of 10 minutes.
i The exterior mirrors can also be heated
manually by switching on the rear window
heating.
Mirrors
Folding the exterior mirrors in/out electrically
121
i The exterior mirrors do not fold out if they
have been folded in manually.
Make sure that the key is in position 1 or 2
in the ignition lock.
X Briefly press button :.
Both exterior mirrors fold in or out.
X
If an exterior mirror has been pushed out of
position, proceed as follows:
X Vehicles without electrically folding
exterior mirrors: move the exterior mirror
into the correct position manually.
X Vehicles with electrically folding exterior mirrors: press and hold mirror-folding
button : until you hear a click and the
mirror engages audibly into position
(Y page 121).
The mirror housing is engaged again and
you can adjust the exterior mirrors as usual
(Y page 120).
i Make sure that the exterior mirrors are
always folded out fully while driving. They
could otherwise vibrate.
Setting the exterior mirrors
If the battery has been disconnected or completely discharged, the exterior mirrors must
be reset. The exterior mirrors will otherwise
not fold in when you select the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function in the on-board
computer (Y page 243).
X Make sure that the key is in position 1 in the
ignition lock.
X Briefly press button :.
Automatic anti-dazzle mirrors
The rear-view mirror and the exterior mirror
on the driver's side automatically go into antidazzle mode if the following conditions are
met simultaneously:
Rthe
ignition is switched on and
Rincident light from headlamps strikes the
sensor in the rear-view mirror
The mirrors do not dip if reverse gear is
engaged or if the interior lighting is switched
on.
Folding the exterior mirrors in/out
automatically
If the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function
is activated in the on-board computer
(Y page 243):
Rthe exterior mirrors fold in automatically as
soon as you lock the vehicle from the outside
Rthe exterior mirrors fold out again automatically as soon as you unlock the vehicle and
then open the driver's or front-passenger
door
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Exterior mirror pushed out of position
122
Mirrors
Parking position of the exterior mirror
on the front-passenger side
Using the memory button
Setting and storing the parking position
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Using reverse gear
: Button for the exterior mirror on the driv-
: Button for the exterior mirror on the driv-
er's side
; Button for the exterior mirror on the front-
passenger side
= Adjustment button
? Memory button M
You can set the front-passenger side exterior
mirror so that you can see the rear wheel on
that side as soon as you engage reverse gear.
You can store this position.
X Make sure that the vehicle is stationary and
that the key is in position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press button ; for the exterior mirror on
the front-passenger side.
X Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the preset parking position.
X Use adjustment button = to adjust the
exterior mirror to a position that allows you
to see the rear wheel and the kerb.
The parking position is stored.
i If you shift the transmission to another
position, the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side returns to the driving position.
er's side
; Button for the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side
= Adjustment button
? Memory button M
You can set the front-passenger side exterior
mirror so that you can see the rear wheel on
that side as soon as you engage reverse gear.
This setting can be stored using memory button M ?.
Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X With the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side activated, use adjustment
button = to adjust the exterior mirror. In
the exterior mirror, the rear wheel and the
kerb should be visible.
X Press memory button M ? and one of the
arrows on adjustment button = within
three seconds.
The parking position is stored if the exterior
mirror does not move.
X If the mirror moves out of position, repeat
the steps.
X
Calling up a stored parking position setting
: Button for the exterior mirror on the driv-
er's side
; Button for the exterior mirror on the front-
passenger side
= Adjustment button
? Memory button M
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Adjust the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side using button ;.
X Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the stored parking position.
X
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves back to its original position:
Ras
soon as you exceed a speed of
15 km/h
Rif you press button : for the exterior mirror on the driver's side
G WARNING
When the memory function adjusts the seat or
steering wheel, you and other vehicle occupants – particularly children – could become
trapped. There is a risk of injury.
While the memory function is making adjustments, make sure that no one has any body
parts in the sweep of the seat or steering
wheel. If somebody becomes trapped, immediately release the memory function position
button. The adjustment process is stopped.
G WARNING
If the memory function adjusts the seat, you
and other vehicle occupants – particularly
children – could become trapped. There is a
risk of injury.
While the memory function is making adjustments, make sure that no one has any part of
their body within the sweep of the seat. If
someone becomes trapped, immediately
release the memory function position button.
The adjustment is stopped.
G WARNING
If children activate the memory function, they
could become trapped, especially if they are
unattended. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
Memory function
Storing settings
G WARNING
If you use the memory function on the driver's
side while driving, the adjustments could
cause you to lose control of the vehicle. There
is a risk of an accident.
Only use the memory function on the driver's
side while the vehicle is stationary.
Z
123
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Memory function
Memory function
124
Adjust the seat electrically (Y page 114).
On the driver's side, adjust the steering
wheel (Y page 118) and the exterior mirrors
(Y page 120).
X Press memory button M and then press
storage position button 1, 2 or 3 within
three seconds.
The settings are stored in the selected preset position. A tone sounds when the settings have been completed.
X
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
X
Calling up a stored setting
Press and hold the relevant storage position button 1, 2 or 3 until the seat, steering
wheel and exterior mirrors are in the stored
position.
i The setting procedure is interrupted as
soon as you release the storage position
button.
X
125
Useful information ............................ 126
Exterior lighting ................................ 126
Interior lighting ................................. 134
Replacing bulbs ................................. 135
Lights and windscreen wipers
Windscreen wipers ........................... 135
126
Exterior lighting
Useful information
"extended range foglamps" functions (Intelligent Light System) are not available.
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified special-
Lights and windscreen wipers
ist workshops: (Y page 34).
Setting the exterior lighting
Setting options
Exterior lighting can be set by:
Rusing
the light switch
the combination switch
(Y page 129)
Rusing the on-board computer
(Y page 239)
Rusing
Exterior lighting
Light switch
General notes
Operation
For reasons of safety, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you drive with the lights switched
on even during the daytime. In some countries, operation of the headlamps varies due
to legal requirements and self-imposed obligations.
Driving abroad
Symmetrical dipped-beam headlamps
If your journey takes you to countries where
vehicles are driven on the opposite side of the
road to the country in which the vehicle is
registered, your headlamps must be switched
to symmetrical dipped beam. This prevents
oncoming traffic from being dazzled. Symmetrical lights do not illuminate as large an
area of the edge of the carriageway.
Convert the headlamps as close to the border
as possible before driving in these countries
(Y page 240).
1 W Left-hand parking lamps
2 X Right-hand parking lamps
3 T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
Asymmetrical dipped-beam headlamps
X
Convert the headlamps back to asymmetrical
dipped beam as soon as possible after crossing the border (Y page 240).
If the headlamps are converted to symmetrical dipped beam, the "motorway mode" and
ment cluster lighting
4 Ã Automatic headlamp mode, control-
led by the light sensor
5 L Dipped-beam/main-beam head-
lamps
B R Rear foglamp
If you hear a warning tone when you leave the
vehicle, the lights may still be switched on.
Turn the light switch to Ã.
Exterior lighting
Rremove
the key from the ignition lock
the driver's door with the key in position 0
Ropen
Automatic headlamp mode
G WARNING
When the light switch is set to Ã, the
dipped-beam headlamps may not be switched
on automatically if there is fog, snow or other
causes of poor visibility due to the weather
conditions such as spray. There is a risk of an
accident.
In such situations, turn the light switch to
L.
The automatic headlamp feature is only an
aid. The driver is responsible for the vehicle
lighting at all times.
à is the preferred light switch setting. The
light setting is automatically selected according to the brightness of the ambient light
(exception: poor visibility due to weather conditions such as fog, snow or spray):
RKey
in position 1 in the ignition lock: the
side lamps are switched on or off automatically depending on the brightness of the
ambient light.
RWith the engine running: if you have
switched on the daytime driving lights function in the on-board computer, the daytime
driving lights or the side lamps and dippedbeam headlamps are switched on or off
automatically depending on the brightness
of the ambient light.
X To switch on automatic headlamp
mode: turn the light switch to Ã.
The daytime driving lights improve the detectability of your vehicle during the day. Here,
the daytime driving lights function must be
switched on via the on-board computer
(Y page 239).
When the dipped-beam headlamps are
switched on, the green L indicator lamp in
the instrument cluster lights up and the daytime driving lights are switched off or dimmed.
Dipped-beam headlamps
G WARNING
1 W Left-hand parking lamps
2 X Right-hand parking lamps
3 T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
ment cluster lighting
4 Ã Automatic headlamp mode, control-
led by the light sensor
5 L Dipped-beam/main-beam head-
lamps
When the light switch is set to Ã, the
dipped-beam headlamps may not be switched
on automatically if there is fog, snow or other
causes of poor visibility due to the weather
conditions such as spray. There is a risk of an
accident.
In such situations, turn the light switch to
L.
B R Rear foglamp
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
The exterior lighting (except the side lamps/
parking lamps) switches off automatically if
you:
127
128
Exterior lighting
Lights and windscreen wipers
Rear foglamp
1 W Left-hand parking lamps
2 X Right-hand parking lamps
3 T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
ment cluster lighting
4 Ã Automatic headlamp mode, control-
led by the light sensor
5 L Dipped-beam/main-beam headlamps
B R Rear foglamp
When the ignition is switched on and the light
switch is in position L, the side lamps and
dipped-beam headlamps are switched on
even if the light sensor does not sense dark
ambient light conditions. This is advantageous when there is fog or rain.
X To switch on the dipped-beam headlamps: turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2 or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L.
The green L indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
1 W Left-hand parking lamps
2 X Right-hand parking lamps
3 T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
ment cluster lighting
4 Ã Automatic headlamp mode, control-
led by the light sensor
5 L Dipped-beam/main-beam head-
lamps
B R Rear foglamp
The rear foglamp improves the visibility of
your vehicle in heavy fog for the following
traffic. Please observe the country-specific
laws on the use of rear foglamps.
X To switch on the rear foglamp: turn the
key in the ignition lock to position 2 or start
the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or Ã.
X Press the R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X To switch off the rear foglamp: press the
R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
Side lamps
! If the battery has been excessively discharged, the side lamps or parking lamps
are automatically switched off to enable
the next engine start. Always park your
vehicle safely and sufficiently lit according
to legal standards. Avoid the continuous
use of the T side lamps for several
Exterior lighting
hours. If possible, switch on the X right
or the W left parking lamp.
129
5 L Dipped-beam/main-beam head-
lamps
1 W Left-hand parking lamps
2 X Right-hand parking lamps
3 T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
ment cluster lighting
4 Ã Automatic headlamp mode, controlled by the light sensor
5 L Dipped-beam/main-beam headlamps
B R Rear foglamp
X
Switching on the parking lamps ensures that
the corresponding side of the vehicle is illuminated.
X To switch on the parking lamps: the key
is not in the ignition lock or it is in position 0.
X Turn the light switch to W (left-hand side
of the vehicle) or X (right-hand side of
the vehicle).
Combination switch
Turn signals
To switch on: turn the light switch to T.
The green T indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
Parking lamps
:
;
=
?
Main-beam headlamps
Turn signal, right
Headlamp flasher
Turn signal, left
To indicate briefly: press the combination
switch briefly to the pressure point in the
direction of arrow ; or ?.
The corresponding turn signal flashes three
times.
X To indicate: press the combination switch
beyond the pressure point in the direction
of arrow ; or ?.
X
1 W Left-hand parking lamps
2 X Right-hand parking lamps
3 T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
ment cluster lighting
4 Ã Automatic headlamp mode, control-
led by the light sensor
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
B R Rear foglamp
Exterior lighting
130
Lights and windscreen wipers
Main-beam headlamps
:
;
=
?
Main-beam headlamps
Turn signal, right
Headlamp flasher
Turn signal, left
To switch on the main-beam headlamps: turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2 or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or Ã.
X Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of arrow :.
In the à position, the main-beam headlamps are only switched on when it is dark
and the engine is running.
The K indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the main-beam headlamps are switched on.
X To switch off the main-beam headlamps: move the combination switch back
to its normal position.
The K indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
X
Headlamp flasher
:
;
=
?
Main-beam headlamps
Turn signal, right
Headlamp flasher
Turn signal, left
To switch on: turn the key in the ignition
lock to position 1 or 2 or start the engine.
X Pull the combination switch in the direction
of arrow =.
X
Hazard warning lamps
To switch on the hazard warning lamps:
press button :.
All turn signals flash. If you now switch on a
turn signal using the combination switch,
only the turn signal lamp on the corresponding side of the vehicle will flash.
X To switch off the hazard warning lamps:
press button :.
X
Exterior lighting
The hazard warning lamps switch on automatically if:
131
Active light function
Ran
airbag is deployed or
vehicle decelerates rapidly from a
speed of above 70 km/h and comes to a
standstill
The hazard warning lamps switch off automatically if the vehicle reaches a speed of
above 10 km/h again after a full brake application.
Rthe
operate even if the ignition is switched off.
Headlamp cleaning system
The headlamps are cleaned automatically if
the "Wipe with washer fluid" function is operated five times (Y page 135) while the lights
are on and the engine is running. When you
switch off the ignition, the automatic headlamp cleaning system is reset and counting is
resumed from 0.
The active light function is a system that
moves the headlamps according to the steering movements of the front wheels. In this
way, relevant areas remain illuminated while
driving. This allows you to recognise pedestrians, cyclists and animals.
Active: when the lights are switched on
Cornering light function
Intelligent Light System
General notes
The Intelligent Light System is a system that
adjusts the headlamps automatically to suit
the prevailing driving and weather conditions.
It offers advanced functions for improved illumination of the road surface, e.g. depending
on the vehicle speed or weather conditions.
The system includes the active light function,
cornering light function, motorway mode and
extended range foglamps. The system is only
active when it is dark.
You can activate or deactivate the "Intelligent
Light System" using the on-board computer
(Y page 240).
The cornering light function improves the illumination of the road over a wide angle in the
direction you are turning, enabling better visibility in tight bends, for example. The cornering light function can only be activated when
the dipped-beam headlamps are switched on.
Active:
Rif you are driving at speeds below 40 km/h
and switch on the turn signal or turn the
steering wheel
Rif you are driving at speeds between
40 km/h and 70 km/h and turn the steering wheel
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
i The hazard warning lamps continue to
132
Exterior lighting
Not active: if you are driving at speeds above
40 km/h or switch off the turn signal or turn
the steering wheel to the straight-ahead position
The cornering lamp may remain lit for a short
time, but is automatically switched off after
no more than three minutes.
Motorway mode
the illumination of the edge of the carriageway.
Active: if you are driving at speeds below
70 km/h and you switch on the rear foglamp
Not active: if, following activation, you are
driving at speeds above 100 km/h or if you
switch off the rear foglamp
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
Lights and windscreen wipers
General notes
Motorway mode increases the range of the
beam.
Active:
Rif
you are driving at speeds above
110 km/h and do not make any large steering movements for at least 1,000 m
Rif you are driving at speeds above
130 km/h
Not active: if you are driving at speeds below
80 km/h following activation
Extended range foglamps
The extended range foglamps reduce the
glare experienced by the driver and improve
You can use this function to set the headlamps to change between dipped beam and
main beam automatically. The system recognises vehicles with their lights on, either
approaching from the opposite direction or
travelling in front of your vehicle, and consequently switches the headlamps from main
beam to dipped beam.
The system automatically adapts the dippedbeam headlamp range depending on the distance to the other vehicle. Once the system
no longer detects any other vehicles, it
switches on the main-beam headlamps again.
The system's optical sensor is located behind
the windscreen near the overhead control
panel.
Exterior lighting
G WARNING
Adaptive Highbeam Assist does not recognise
road users:
Rwho
have no lights, e.g. pedestrians
have poor lighting, e.g. cyclists
Rwhose lighting is blocked, e.g. by a barrier
In very rare cases, Adaptive Highbeam Assist
recognises road users too late or not at all. In
this, or in similar situations, the automatic
main-beam headlamps will not be deactivated
or activated regardless. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always carefully observe the traffic conditions
and switch off the main-beam headlamps in
good time.
Rwho
Adaptive Highbeam Assist cannot take into
account road, weather or traffic conditions.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is only an aid. You
are responsible for adjusting the vehicle's
lighting to the prevailing light, visibility and
traffic conditions.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be restricted if there is:
Rpoor visibility, e.g. due to fog, heavy rain or
snow
on the sensors or if the sensors are
obscured
Rdirt
Switching Adaptive Highbeam Assist
on/off
= Headlamp flasher
? Turn signal, left
To switch on: turn the light switch to Ã.
Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of arrow :.
The _ indicator lamp in the multifunction display lights up when it is dark and the
light sensor activates the dipped-beam
headlamps.
If you are driving at speeds above 25 km/h:
The headlamp range is set automatically
depending on the distance between the
vehicle and other road users.
If you are driving at speeds above approximately 30 km/h and no other road users
are recognised:
The main-beam headlamps are switched on
automatically. The K indicator lamp in
the instrument cluster also lights up.
If you are driving at speeds below 25 km/h
or other road users are recognised or the
roads are adequately lit:
The main-beam headlamps are switched off
automatically. The K indicator lamp in
the instrument cluster goes out. The _
indicator lamp in the multifunction display
remains lit.
X To switch off: move the combination
switch back to its normal position or move
the light switch to another position.
The _ indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
X
X
Headlamps misted up on the inside
Certain climatic and physical conditions may
cause moisture to form in the headlamp. This
moisture does not affect the functionality of
the headlamp.
: Main-beam headlamps
; Turn signal, right
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Important safety notes
133
134
Interior lighting
Interior lighting
Automatic interior lighting control
Lights and windscreen wipers
Overview of interior lighting
Overhead control panel
: p Switches the left-hand reading lamp
on/off
; c Switches the interior lighting on
= | Switches the interior lighting/auto-
matic interior lighting control off
? p Switches the right-hand reading
lamp on/off
A To switch the automatic interior lighting
control on
Interior lighting control
General notes
In order to prevent the vehicle's battery from
discharging, the interior lighting functions are
automatically deactivated after some time
except for when the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
Overhead control panel
: p To switch the left-hand reading lamp
on/off
; c To switch the interior lighting on
= | To switch the interior lighting/auto-
matic interior lighting control off
? p To switch the right-hand reading
lamp on/off
A To switch the automatic interior lighting
control on
To switch on: set the switch to centre
position A.
X To switch off: set the switch to the |
position.
X
The interior lighting automatically switches
on if you:
Runlock
the vehicle
a door
Rremove the key from the ignition lock
The interior lighting is activated for a short
time when the key is removed from the ignition lock. You can activate this delayed
switch-off using the on-board computer
(Y page 241).
Ropen
Windscreen wipers
Manual interior lighting control
Windscreen wipers
To switch the interior lighting on: set the
switch to the c position.
X To switch the interior lighting off: set the
switch to the | or (if the door is closed)
to the centre position.
X To switch the reading lamps on/off:
press the p button.
Switching the windscreen wipers on/
off
Crash-responsive emergency lighting
The interior lighting is activated automatically
if the vehicle is involved in an accident.
X
To switch off the crash-responsive
emergency lighting: press the hazard
warning lamp button.
or
X
Lock and then unlock the vehicle using the
key.
Replacing bulbs
G DANGER
Xenon bulbs are under high voltage. You can
get an electric shock if you remove the cover
of the xenon bulb and touch the electrical
contacts. There is a risk of fatal injury.
Never touch the parts or the electrical contacts of the xenon bulb. Always have work on
the xenon bulbs carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
The front and rear lamps of your vehicle are
equipped with either xenon or LED bulbs. Do
not replace the bulbs yourself. Contact a
qualified specialist workshop which has the
necessary specialist knowledge and tools to
carry out the work required.
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times.
Have the headlamp setting checked regularly.
! Do not operate the windscreen wipers
when the windscreen is dry, as this could
damage the wiper blades. Moreover, dust
that has collected on the windscreen can
scratch the glass if wiping takes place when
the windscreen is dry.
If it is necessary to switch on the windscreen wipers in dry weather conditions,
always operate them using washer fluid.
! If the windscreen wipers leave smears on
the windscreen after the vehicle has been
washed in an automatic car wash, this may
be due to wax or other residue. Clean the
windscreen with washer fluid after an automatic car wash.
! Intermittent wiping with rain sensor: due
to optical influences and the windscreen
becoming dirty in dry weather conditions,
the windscreen wipers may be activated
inadvertently. This could damage the windscreen wiper blades or scratch the windscreen.
For this reason, you should always switch
off the windscreen wipers in dry weather.
Combination switch
1 $ Windscreen wipers off
2 Ä Intermittent wipe, low (rain sensor
set to low sensitivity)
3 Å Intermittent wipe, high (rain sensor
set to high sensitivity)
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
135
Windscreen wipers
136
Never fold a windscreen wiper arm without
a wiper blade back onto the windscreen.
Hold the windscreen wiper arm firmly when
you change the wiper blade. If you release
the windscreen wiper arm without a wiper
blade and it falls onto the windscreen, the
windscreen may be damaged by the force
of the impact.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the wiper blades changed at a qualified
specialist workshop.
4 ° Continuous wipe, slow
5 ¯ Continuous wipe, fast
B í Single wipe/î to wipe the wind-
screen using washer fluid
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 155).
X Turn the combination switch to the corresponding position.
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
In the Ä or Å position, the appropriate
wiping frequency is set automatically according to the intensity of the rain. In the Å
position, the rain sensor is more sensitive
than in the Ä position, causing the windscreen wipers to wipe more frequently.
If the wiper blades are worn, the windscreen
will no longer be wiped properly. This could
prevent you from observing the traffic conditions, thereby causing an accident.
i The vehicle is equipped with the MAGIC
VISION CONTROL wipe/wash system. The
washer fluid is fed through the wiper blades
and when the screen is wiped with washer
fluid î, the water is emitted directly
from the blades.
Replacing the wiper blades
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers begin to move while
you are changing the wiper blades, you can be
trapped by the wiper arm. There is a risk of
injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
ignition before changing the wiper blades.
! To avoid damaging the windscreen wiper
blades, make sure that you touch only the
wiper arm of the windscreen wiper.
! Never open the bonnet if a windscreen
wiper arm has been folded away from the
windscreen.
! Always position the windscreen wiper
arms vertically before folding them away
from the windscreen. By doing so, you will
avoid damage to the bonnet.
Replacing the windscreen wiper blades
Moving the wiper blades to a vertical position
On vehicles without KEYLESS-GO:
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Set the windscreen wipers to position °.
X When the wiper arms have reached a vertical position, turn the key to position 0 and
remove it from the ignition lock.
X Fold the wiper arm away from the windscreen until it engages.
X
On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO:
Switch off the engine.
Remove your foot from the brake pedal.
X Set the windscreen wipers to position °.
X Press the Start/Stop button repeatedly
until the windscreen wipers start.
X When the wiper arms have reached a vertical position, press the Start/Stop button.
X Fold the wiper arm away from the windscreen until it engages.
X
X
Windscreen wipers
Removing the wiper blades
137
Make sure that wiper blade is seated correctly.
X Fold the wiper arm back onto the windscreen.
X
To bring the wiper blade into position to
be removed: hold the wiper arm firmly with
one hand. With the other hand, turn the
wiper blade in the direction of arrow =
beyond the point of resistance.
The wiper blade engages in the removal
position with an audible click.
X To remove a wiper blade: firmly press
release knob ; and pull the wiper blade
upwards :.
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
Fitting the wiper blades
Push the new wiper blade in the direction of
arrow : onto the wiper arm until lug ;
engages.
X Push the wiper blade out of the removal
position in the direction of arrow = beyond
the point of resistance.
The wiper blade disengages with an audible
click and is freely movable again.
X
Z
138
Windscreen wipers
Problems with the windscreen wipers
Lights and windscreen wipers
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The windscreen wipers Leaves or snow, for example, may be obstructing the windscreen
are jammed.
wiper movement. The wiper motor has been deactivated.
X For safety reasons, you should remove the key from the ignition
lock.
or
X Switch off the engine using the Start/Stop button and open the
driver's door.
X Remove the cause of the obstruction.
X Switch the windscreen wipers back on.
The windscreen wipers The windscreen wiper drive is malfunctioning.
fail completely.
X Select another wiper speed on the combination switch.
X Have the windscreen wipers checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
139
Useful information ............................ 140
Overview of climate control systems ................................................... 140
Operating the climate control system ..................................................... 142
Climate control
Adjusting the air vents ..................... 150
140
Overview of climate control systems
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all models, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified special-
Climate control
ist workshops: (Y page 34).
Overview of climate control systems
Important safety notes
Observe the settings recommended on the
following pages. The windows could otherwise mist up.
To prevent the windows from misting up:
Rswitch
Rswitch
briefly
off climate control only briefly
on air-recirculation mode only
Rswitch
on the cooling with air dehumidification function
Rswitch on the "demist windscreen" function
briefly, if required
Climate control regulates the temperature
and the humidity in the vehicle interior and
filters undesirable substances out of the air.
Climate control is only operational when the
engine is running. Optimum operation is only
achieved when the side windows and the roof
are closed.
The residual heat function can only be activated or deactivated with the ignition
switched off (Y page 149).
i Ventilate the vehicle for a brief period
during warm weather. This will speed up the
cooling process, and the desired vehicle
interior temperature will be reached more
quickly.
i An hour after the key has been removed,
it is possible that the residual heat function
may be activated automatically in order to
dry the air-conditioning system. The vehicle
is then ventilated for 30 minutes to dry the
air-conditioning system.
Overview of climate control systems
141
:
;
=
?
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
To set the temperature, left (Y page 145)
To set climate control to automatic mode (Y page 144)
To demist the windscreen (Y page 146)
To activate/deactivate the residual heat function (Y page 149)
To activate/deactivate cooling with air dehumidification (Y page 142)
To switch the rear window heating on/off (Y page 147)
To switch the ZONE function on/off (Y page 146)
To set the temperature, right (Y page 145)
To switch climate control on/off (Y page 142)
To set the air distribution (Y page 145)
To set the airflow (Y page 146)
To adjust the airflow (Y page 144)
To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode (Y page 148)
Information about using
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
Automatic climate control
The following contains instructions and recommendations to enable you to get the most
out of your THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control.
RActivate climate control using the à and
¿ buttons on the control panel of the
climate control. The indicator lamps in
the à and ¿ buttons light up.
RIn automatic mode, the ñ button on the
climate control panel may be used to additionally adjust the airflow (FOCUS/
MEDIUM/DIFFUSE). The MEDIUM level is
recommended.
RSet the temperature to 22 †.
ROnly use the "Windscreen demisting" function briefly until the windscreen is clear
again.
ROnly use air-recirculation mode briefly, e.g.
if there are unpleasant outside odours or
Climate control
Control panel for THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control (2-zone)
Climate control
142
Operating the climate control system
when in a tunnel. The windows could otherwise mist up, as no fresh air is drawn into
the vehicle in air-recirculation mode.
RUse the ZONE function to adopt the temperature settings on the driver's side for
the front-passenger side as well. The indicator lamp in the á button goes out.
RUse the residual heat function if you want to
heat or ventilate the vehicle interior when
the ignition is switched off. The residual
heat function can only be activated or deactivated with the ignition switched off.
RVehicles with COMAND Online: if you
change the settings of the climate control
system, the climate status display appears
for three seconds at the bottom of the
screen in the COMAND display. See also
the separate COMAND Online operating
instructions. You will see the current settings of the various climate control functions.
ECO start/stop function
During automatic engine switch-off, the climate control only operates at a reduced capacity. If you require full climate control capacity, the ECO start/stop function can be
deactivated by pressing the ECO button
(Y page 160).
Operating the climate control system
Switching climate control on/off
General notes
When the climate control is switched off, the
air supply and air circulation are also
switched off. The windows could mist up.
Therefore, only switch off climate control
briefly.
i Activate climate control primarily using
the à button (Y page 144).
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 155).
X To switch on: press the à button on
the control panel for the climate control.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
or
X Press the ^ button on the control panel
for the climate control.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button goes
out. The previous settings are reactivated.
X To switch off: press the ^ button.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button lights
up.
X
Activating/deactivating the cooling
with air dehumidification function
General notes
If you deactivate the "Cooling with air-dehumidification" function, the air inside the vehicle will not be cooled. The air inside the vehicle will also not be dehumidified. The windows can mist up more quickly. Therefore,
only switch off cooling with air dehumidification for a short period.
The "Cooling with air dehumidification" function is only available when the engine is running. The air inside the vehicle is cooled and
dehumidified according to the temperature
selected.
Condensation may drip from the underside of
the vehicle when cooling mode is active. This
is normal and not a sign that there is a malfunction.
Operating the climate control system
143
Activating/deactivating
Example: ¿ button
To switch on: press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button lights
up.
X To deactivate: press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button goes
out. The "Cooling with air dehumidification"
function has a delayed switch-off feature.
Climate control
X
144
Operating the climate control system
Problems with the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The indicator lamp in
the ¿ button
flashes three times or
goes out. The cooling
with air dehumidification system cannot be
switched on.
Cooling with air dehumidification has been deactivated due to a
malfunction.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Climate control
Setting climate control to automatic
mode
General notes
In automatic mode, the set temperature is
maintained automatically at a constant level.
The system automatically regulates the temperature of the dispensed air, the airflow and
the air distribution.
The automatic mode functions optimally
when the "Cooling with air dehumidification"
function is activated. If desired, cooling with
air dehumidification can be deactivated.
If you deactivate the "Cooling with air-dehumidification" function, the air inside the vehicle will not be cooled. The air inside the vehicle will also not be dehumidified. The windows can mist up more quickly. Therefore,
only switch off cooling with air dehumidification for a short period.
Activating/switching
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 155).
X Set the desired temperature.
X To activate: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Automatic air distribution and airflow
are activated.
i When automatic mode is enabled the airflow can be selected (Y page 144).
X
X
To switch to manual mode: press the
_ button.
or
X
Press the I or K button.
The indicator lamp in the à button goes
out.
Setting the airflow
In automatic mode you can select the following airflow settings:
FOCUS
high airflow that is set slightly
cooler
MEDIUM medium airflow, standard setting
DIFFUSE low airflow that is set slightly
warmer and with less of a draught
Operating the climate control system
145
cally, depending on the outside temperature.
Setting the air distribution
Activating/deactivating
Example: ñ button
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 155).
X Press the à button.
X Press the ñ button repeatedly until the
required airflow setting appears in the display.
Setting the temperature
Switching on/off
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 155).
X Press the _ button repeatedly until the
desired symbol appears in the display.
X
Air distribution settings
The air distribution can be set to the following
positions:
Different temperatures can be set for the
driver's and front-passenger sides.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 155).
X Turn controls : or D clockwise or anticlockwise (Y page 141).
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
i If you turn controls : and D anti-clockwise to the lowest temperature setting, airrecirculation mode may activate automati-
P Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents
O Directs the airflow through the footwell air vents
S Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents as well as the footwell air vents
¯ Directs the airflow through the demister vents
b Directs the airflow through the demister, centre and side air vents
a Directs the airflow through the footwell and demister vents
_ Directs the airflow through the demister vents, the centre and side air vents
as well as the footwell air vents
i Regardless of the air distribution setting,
airflow is always directed through the side
Climate control
X
Operating the climate control system
146
air vents. The side air vents can only be
closed when the controls on the side air
vents are turned downwards.
Setting the airflow
Climate control
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 155).
X To increase: press the K button.
X To reduce: press the I button.
X
Switching the ZONE function on/off
er's side is adopted for the front-passenger
side.
Demisting the windscreen
General notes
Example: ¬ button
You can use this function to defrost the windscreen or to demist the inside of the windscreen and the side windows.
Switch off the "Windscreen demisting" function as soon as the windscreen is clear again.
Switching the "Demisting windscreen"
on/off
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 155).
X To activate: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button lights
up.
The climate control system switches to the
following functions:
X
Rhigh
To switch on: press the á button.
The indicator lamp in the á button lights
up. The temperature setting for the driver's
side is not adopted for the front-passenger
side.
X To switch off: press the á button.
The indicator lamp in the á button goes
out. The temperature setting for the driv-
airflow
Rhigh temperature
Rair distribution to the windscreen and
front side windows
Rair-recirculation mode off
X
X
To deactivate: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. The previous settings are reactivated.
Operating the climate control system
Air-recirculation mode remains deactivated.
or
X
147
Rear window heating
General notes
Press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
or
Turn the temperature controls on the left or
the right on the climate control panel clockwise or anti-clockwise.
Turn temperature controls : or D clockwise or anti-clockwise (Y page 141).
or
X
Press the K or I button.
Demisting the windows
Windows misted up on the inside
Activate the ¿ cooling with air dehumidification function.
X Activate the à mode button.
X If the windows continue to mist up, activate
the ¬ "Windscreen demisting" function.
i You should only select this setting until
the windscreen is clear again.
X
Windows misted up on the outside
Activate the windscreen wipers.
Press the _ button repeatedly until the
P or O symbol appears in the display.
i You should only select this setting until
the windscreen is clear again.
X
X
The rear window heating has a high current
draw. You should therefore switch it off as
soon as the window is clear. It otherwise
switches off automatically after several
minutes.
If the battery voltage is too low, the rear window heating may switch off.
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 155).
X Press button ¤.
The indicator lamp in the ¤ button lights
up or goes out.
X
Climate control
X
Operating the climate control system
148
Problems with the rear window heating
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The rear window heating has switched off
prematurely or cannot
be activated.
The on-board voltage is too low because too many electrical consumers are switched on.
X Switch off any consumers that are not required, e.g. reading
lamps, interior lighting or the seat heating.
When the battery is sufficiently charged, the rear window heating can be activated again.
lit. Outside air is added after about
30 minutes.
Climate control
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode
General notes
If you switch on air-recirculation mode, the
windows can mist up more quickly, in particular at low temperatures. Only use air-recirculation mode briefly to prevent the windows
misting up.
Activating/deactivating
To deactivate: press the g button.
The indicator lamp in the g button goes
out.
i Air-recirculation mode is deactivated
automatically:
X
Rafter around five minutes at outside tem-
peratures below approximately 5 †
approximately five minutes if cooling with air dehumidification is deactivated
Rafter around 30 minutes at outside temperatures above approximately 5 † if the
"Cooling with air dehumidification" function is activated
Rafter
Convenience opening/closing using
the air-recirculation button
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 155).
X To activate: press the g button.
The indicator lamp in the g button lights
up.
i Air-recirculation mode is automatically
activated at high levels of pollution or at
high outside temperatures. When air-recirculation mode is activated automatically,
the indicator lamp in the g button is not
X
G WARNING
When using convenience closing, you could
become trapped within the sweep of the closing window. There is a risk of injury.
Monitor the entire closing procedure when
using convenience closing. When closing,
make sure that no one has any parts of the
body within the closing area.
G WARNING
During convenience opening parts of the body
could be drawn in or become trapped
Operating the climate control system
X
Convenience closing feature: press and
hold the g button until the side windows are closed.
The indicator lamp in the g button lights
up. Air-recirculation mode is activated.
If parts of the body are in the closing area
during convenience closing, proceed as follows:
Press the W button for opening/closing
the side windows.
The side window stops.
X To then open the side window, press the
W button again.
i Notes on the reversing feature for the side
windows (Y page 99).
X Convenience opening feature: press and
hold the g button until the side windows are opened. The side windows move
back to their original positions.
The indicator lamp in the g button goes
out. Air-recirculation mode is deactivated.
i If you open the side windows manually
after closing them with the convenience
closing feature, they will remain in this posiX
tion when opened using the convenience
opening feature.
Activating/deactivating the residual
heat function
General notes
It is possible to make use of the residual heat
of the engine to continue heating the stationary vehicle for up to 30 minutesafter the
engine has been switched off. The heating
time depends on the temperature that has
been set for the vehicle interior.
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock or remove it (Y page 155).
X To activate: press the Ì button.
The indicator lamp in the Ì button lights
up.
i The blower will run at a low speed regardless of the airflow setting.
X
i If you activate the residual heat function
at high temperatures, only the ventilation
will be activated. The blower runs at
medium speed.
X
To deactivate: press the Ì button.
The indicator lamp in the Ì button goes
out.
Z
Climate control
between the side window and window frame.
There is a risk of injury.
When opening, make sure that nobody is
touching the side window. If someone
becomes trapped, press the W switch
immediately to open/close the side window
in the door. The side window stops. To continue closing the side window, pull on the
W switch.
149
150
Adjusting the air vents
Residual heat is deactivated automatically:
Setting the centre air vents
Rafter
approximately 30 minutes
Rwhen the ignition is switched on
Rif the battery voltage drops
Adjusting the air vents
Climate control
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Very hot or very cold air can flow from the air
vents. This could result in burns or frostbite in
the immediate vicinity of the air vents. There
is a risk of injury.
Make sure that all vehicle occupants always
maintain a sufficient distance to the air outlets. If necessary, redirect the airflow to
another area of the vehicle interior.
G WARNING
When AIRSCARF is switched on, very hot air
can flow from the vents in the head restraints.
This could result in burns in the immediate
vicinity of the air vents. There is a risk of injury.
Reduce the heater output before it becomes
too hot.
To open the centre air vent: turn the
adjuster in one of centre air vents : anticlockwise.
X To close the centre air vent: turn the
adjuster in one of centre air vents : clockwise until it engages.
X
Adjusting the side air vents
In order to ensure the direct flow of fresh air
through the air vents into the vehicle interior,
please observe the following notes:
Rkeep the air inlet grille on the bonnet and in
the engine compartment on the frontpassenger side free of blockages, such as
ice, snow or leaves.
Rnever cover the vents or ventilation grilles
in the vehicle interior.
i You can move the adjusters for the air
vents vertically or horizontally to set the
direction of the airflow.
i Optimal climate control function is ach-
ieved by opening the air vents fully and setting the adjusters to the middle position.
: Side window demister vent
; Side air vent
To open a side air vent: turn the adjuster
in side air vent ; anti-clockwise.
X To close a side air vent: turn the adjuster
in side air vent ; clockwise until it
engages.
X
Adjusting the glove compartment air
vent
! Close the air vent when heating the vehicle.
Adjusting the air vents
: Air vent thumbwheel
; Air vent
Reduce the heater output before it becomes
too hot.
You can adjust the blower output of AIRSCARF vents : using the AIRSCARF button
(Y page 117).
When automatic climate control is activated,
the glove compartment can be ventilated, for
instance to cool its contents. The level of airflow depends on the airflow and air distribution settings.
X To open/close: turn thumbwheel :
clockwise or anti-clockwise.
Setting the blower output of the AIRSCARF vents
G WARNING
Very hot or very cold air can flow from the air
vents. This could result in burns or frostbite in
the immediate vicinity of the air vents. There
is a risk of injury.
Make sure that all vehicle occupants always
maintain a sufficient distance to the air outlets. If necessary, redirect the airflow to
another area of the vehicle interior.
G WARNING
When AIRSCARF is switched on, very hot air
can flow from the vents in the head restraints.
This could result in burns in the immediate
vicinity of the air vents. There is a risk of injury.
Z
Climate control
At high outside temperatures, open the air
vent and activate the "cooling with air dehumidification" function. Otherwise, temperature-sensitive items stored in the glove
compartment could be damaged.
151
152
153
Useful information ............................ 154
Running-in notes ............................... 154
Automatic transmission ................... 163
Refuelling ........................................... 173
Parking ............................................... 175
Driving tips ........................................ 178
Driving systems ................................ 182
Driving and parking
Driving ............................................... 154
154
Driving
Useful information
Driving and parking
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 34).
Running-in notes
Important safety notes
In certain driving and driving safety systems,
the sensors adjust automatically while a certain distance is being driven after the vehicle
has been delivered or after repairs. Full system effectiveness is not reached until the end
of this teach-in procedure.
Brake pads/linings and discs that are either
new or have been replaced only achieve optimum braking effect after several hundred kilometres of driving. Compensate for the
reduced braking effect by applying greater
force to the brake pedal.
The first 1,500 km
If you treat the engine with sufficient care
from the very start, you will be rewarded with
excellent performance for the remainder of
the engine's life.
RDrive
at varying vehicle speeds and engine
speeds for the first 1,500 km.
RAvoid overstraining the vehicle during this
period, e.g. driving at full throttle.
RChange gear in good time, before the rev
counter needle is Ô of the way to the red
area of the rev counter.
RDo
not shift down a gear manually in order
to brake.
RTry to avoid depressing the accelerator
pedal beyond the point of resistance (kickdown).
After 1,500 km, you may gradually bring the
vehicle up to full road and engine speeds.
Additional running-in notes for AMG vehicles:
RDo not drive at speeds above 140 km/h for
the first 1,500 km.
briefly allow the engine to reach a
maximum engine speed of 4,500 rpm.
RIt is advisable to select drive program C for
Controlled Efficiency.
ROnly
i You should also observe these notes on
running-in if the engine or parts of the drive
train on your vehicle have been replaced.
AMG vehicles with self-locking rear
axle differential
Your vehicle is equipped with a self-locking
differential on the rear axle. Change the oil
after a running-in period of 3,000 km to
improve protection of the rear axle differential. This oil change prolongs the service life of
the differential. Have the oil change carried
out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Driving
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the operating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as prescribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
Driving
G WARNING
Unsuitable footwear can hinder correct usage
of the pedals, e.g.:
Rshoes
with thick soles
Rshoes with high heels
Rslippers
There is a risk of an accident.
Wear suitable footwear to ensure correct
usage of the pedals.
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
G WARNING
If the parking brake has not been fully
released when driving, the parking brake can:
Roverheat
and cause a fire
Rlose its hold function.
There is a risk of fire and an accident. Release
the parking brake fully before driving off.
! Warm up the engine quickly. Do not use
the engine's full performance until it has
reached operating temperature.
Only set the automatic transmission to the
respective drive positions when the vehicle
is stationary.
Where possible, avoid spinning the drive
wheels when pulling away on slippery
roads. Otherwise, you could damage the
drive train.
! AMG vehicles: at low engine oil temperatures (below +20 †), the maximum
engine speed is restricted in order to pro-
tect the engine. To protect the engine and
maintain smooth engine operation, avoid
driving at full throttle when the engine is
cold.
Driving and parking
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
155
Key positions
Key
g To remove the key
1 Power supply for some consumers, such
as the windscreen wipers
2 Ignition (power supply for all consumers)
and drive position
3 To start the engine
i If the key does not belong to the vehicle, it
can still be turned in the ignition lock. However, the ignition will not be switched on.
The engine cannot be started.
KEYLESS-GO
General notes
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO are equipped with
a key featuring an integrated KEYLESS-GO
start function and a detachable Start/Stop
button.
You can switch the engine on and off with the
Start/Stop button. The Start/Stop button
must be inserted in the ignition lock and the
key must be in the vehicle.
Pressing the Start/Stop button several times
in succession corresponds to the different
key positions in the ignition lock. This is only
Z
Driving
Driving and parking
156
the case if you are not depressing the brake
pedal.
If you depress the brake pedal and press the
Start/Stop button, the engine starts immediately.
The Start/Stop button can be removed from
the ignition lock. The key can then be inserted
into the ignition lock.
i You do not have to remove the Start/Stop
button from the ignition lock when you
leave the vehicle. You should, however,
always take the key with you when leaving
the vehicle. As long as the key is in the
vehicle:
Rthe vehicle can be started using the
Start/Stop button and
Relectrically powered equipment can be
operated
i The engine can be switched off while the
vehicle is in motion by pressing and holding
the Start/Stop button for three seconds.
This function operates independently of the
ECO start/stop automatic engine switchoff function.
Key positions with KEYLESS-GO
If Start/Stop button : has not yet been
pressed, this corresponds to the key being
removed from the ignition.
X To switch on the power supply: press
Start/Stop button : once.
The power supply is switched on. You can
now activate the windscreen wipers, for
example.
i The power supply is switched off if you
press Start/Stop button : twice when in
this position and the driver's door is open.
X To switch on the ignition: press Start/
Stop button : twice.
The ignition is switched on.
i The power supply is switched off if you
press Start/Stop button : twice when in
this position and the driver's door is open.
When you switch on the ignition, all of the
indicator lamps in the instrument cluster light
up. If an indicator lamp does not go out after
the engine is started or if a one lights up while
you are driving, there may be a technical
problem (Y page 275).
Removing the Start/Stop button
Insert Start/Stop button : into ignition
lock ;.
i When you insert Start/Stop button :
into ignition lock ;, the system needs
approximately two seconds' recognition
time. You can then use Start/Stop button :.
X
You can remove the Start/Stop button from
the ignition lock and start the vehicle as normal using the key.
X Remove Start/Stop button : from ignition
lock ;.
i You do not have to remove the Start/Stop
button from the ignition lock when you
leave the vehicle.
ignite if in contact with the exhaust system or
parts of the engine that heat up. There is a risk
of fire.
Carry out regular checks to make sure that
there are no flammable foreign materials in
the engine compartment or in the exhaust
system.
! Do not depress the accelerator pedal
when starting the engine.
Starting the engine
i The catalytic converter is preheated for
up to 30 seconds after a cold start. The
sound of the engine may change during this
time.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they can:
Ropen doors and endanger other persons or
road users
out and be injured by the traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and, for example, trap themselves.
Children could also set the vehicle in motion,
for example by:
Rclimb
Rreleasing
the parking brake
Rshifting the automatic transmission out of
park position P
Rstarting the engine.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle. Always
keep the key out of reach of children.
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Inhaling
these exhaust gases leads to poisoning. There
is a risk of fatal injury. Therefore never leave
the engine running in enclosed spaces without sufficient ventilation.
G WARNING
Flammable materials introduced through
environmental influence or by animals can
Starting procedure with the key
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
The transmission position indicator in the
multifunction display shows P.
i You can also start the engine when the
transmission is in position N.
X
X
Turn the key to position 3 in the ignition
lock (Y page 155) and release it as soon as
the engine is running.
Using KEYLESS-GO to start the engine
The Start/Stop button can be used to start
the vehicle without inserting the key into the
ignition lock. The key must be in the vehicle
and the Start/Stop button must be inserted
in the ignition lock.
X Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
The transmission position indicator in the
multifunction display shows P.
i You can also start the engine when the
transmission is in position N.
X
Press the Start/Stop button once
(Y page 155).
The engine starts.
Z
157
Driving and parking
Driving
Driving
158
Pulling away
Driving and parking
Automatic transmission
G WARNING
If the engine speed is above the idling speed
and you engage transmission position D or R,
the vehicle could pull away suddenly. There is
a risk of an accident.
When engaging transmission position D or R,
always firmly depress the brake pedal and do
not simultaneously accelerate.
i It is only possible to shift the transmission
from position P to the desired position if
you depress the brake pedal. Only then is
the shift lock released.
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R.
X Release the electric parking brake
(Y page 176).
X Release the brake pedal.
X Carefully depress the accelerator pedal.
X
i The vehicle locks centrally once you have
pulled away. The locking knobs in the doors
drop down.
You can open the doors from the inside at
any time.
You can also deactivate the automatic locking feature (Y page 242).
i Upshifts take place at higher engine
speeds after a cold start. This helps the
catalytic converter to reach its operating
temperature more quickly.
Hill start assist
Hill start assist helps you when pulling away
forwards or in reverse on an uphill gradient. It
holds the vehicle for a short time after you
have removed your foot from the brake pedal.
This gives you enough time to move your foot
from the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal
and depress it before the vehicle begins to
roll.
G WARNING
After a short time, hill start assist will no longer brake your vehicle and it could roll away.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
Therefore, quickly move your foot from the
brake pedal to the accelerator pedal. Never
leave the vehicle when it is held by hill start
assist.
Remove your foot from the brake pedal.
The vehicle is then held for about a second.
X Pull away.
X
Hill start assist is not active if:
Ryou
are pulling away on a level road or a
downhill gradient.
Rthe transmission is in position N.
Rthe electric parking brake is applied.
RESP® is malfunctioning.
ECO start/stop function
Introduction
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle is stopped under certain conditions.
When pulling away again, the engine starts
automatically. The ECO start/stop function
thereby helps you to reduce the fuel consumption and emissions of your vehicle.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the engine is switched off automatically and
you exit the vehicle, the engine is restarted
automatically. The vehicle may begin moving.
There is a risk of accident and injury.
If you wish to exit the vehicle, always turn off
the ignition and secure the vehicle against
rolling away.
Driving
: ECO start/stop display
If the ¤ symbol is shown in green in the
multifunction display, the ECO start/stop
function switches the engine off automatically if the vehicle stops moving.
The ECO start/stop function is activated
whenever you switch on the engine using the
key or the Start/Stop button.
If the ECO start/stop function has been manually deactivated (Y page 160) or a malfunction has caused the system to be deactivated,
the ¤ symbol is not displayed.
AMG vehicles: the ECO start/stop function
is only available in drive program C.
For further information on automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 159) and automatic
engine start (Y page 159).
Automatic engine switch-off
If the vehicle is braked to a standstill in D or N,
the ECO start/stop function switches off the
engine automatically.
The ECO start/stop function is operational
and the ¤ symbol is lit green in the multifunction display if:
Rthe
indicator lamp in the ECO button is lit
green
Rthe outside temperature is within the range
that is suitable for the system
Rthe engine is at normal operating temperature
Rthe set temperature for the vehicle interior
has been reached
Rthe battery is sufficiently charged
Rthe
system detects that the windscreen is
not misted up when the air-conditioning
system is switched on
Rthe bonnet is closed
Rthe driver's door is closed and the driver's
seat belt is fastened
If the conditions for automatic engine switchoff are not all fulfilled, the ¤ symbol is lit
yellow.
i All of the vehicle's systems remain active
when the engine is switched off automatically.
i All vehicles (except AMG vehicles):
automatic engine switch-off can take place
a maximum of four times consecutively (initial stop, then three subsequent stops). The
¤ symbol is lit yellow in the multifunction display after the engine has been started automatically for the fourth time. When
the ¤ symbol is lit green in the multifunction display, automatic engine switchoff is again possible.
i AMG vehicles: the number of consecutive automatic engine stops is unlimited.
i The HOLD function can be activated if the
engine has been switched off automatically. It is then not necessary to continue
applying the brakes during the automatic
stop phase. When you depress the accelerator pedal, the engine starts automatically and the braking effect of the HOLD
function is deactivated.
Automatic engine start
The engine is started automatically if:
Ryou
switch off the ECO start/stop function
by pressing the ECO button
Rin transmission position D or N, the brake
pedal is released and the HOLD function is
not active
Ryou depress the accelerator pedal
Ryou engage reverse gear R
Z
Driving and parking
General notes
159
Driving
160
Driving and parking
Ryou
move the transmission out of position
P
Ryou switch to drive program S, S+ or M
(AMG vehicles)
Ryou unfasten your seat belt or open the
driver's door
Rthe vehicle starts to roll
Rthe brake system requires this
Rthe temperature in the vehicle interior deviates from the set range
Rthe system detects moisture on the windscreen when the air-conditioning system is
switched on
Rthe battery's charge status is too low
(Y page 159) are met, the ¤ symbol is lit
green in the multifunction display.
If not all conditions for automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 159) are met, the ¤
symbol is lit yellow in the multifunction display. If this is the case, the ECO start/stop
function is not available.
i If indicator lamp ; is off, the ECO start/
stop function has been deactivated manually or as the result of a malfunction. The
engine will then not be switched off automatically when the vehicle stops.
i Shifting the transmission to position P
does not start the engine.
i If you shift the transmission from R to D,
the ECO start/stop function is available
again once the ¤ symbol reappears in
green in the multifunction display.
Deactivating/activating the ECO start/
stop function
ECO button in AMG vehicles
Deactivating (AMG vehicles)
X
Press button : in drive program C.
or
X
Switch to drive program S, S+ or M
(Y page 168).
Indicator lamp ; and the ¤ symbol in
the multifunction display go out.
Activating (AMG vehicles)
X
ECO button
Deactivating (except for AMG vehicles)
X
Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; and the ¤ symbol in
the multifunction display go out.
Activating (except for AMG vehicles)
X
Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. If all conditions
for automatic engine switch-off
Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up.
If drive program S, S+ or M is active, the
automatic transmission switches to drive
program C.
If all conditions for automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 159) are met, the ¤
symbol is lit green in the multifunction display.
If not all conditions for automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 159) are met, the ¤
symbol is shown in yellow in the multifunc-
Driving
161
tion display. If this is the case, the ECO
start/stop function is not available.
i If indicator lamp ; is off, the ECO start/
Driving and parking
stop function has been deactivated manually or as the result of a malfunction. The
engine will then not be switched off automatically when the vehicle stops.
Z
162
Driving
Driving and parking
Problems with the engine
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine does not
start.
The HOLD function is activated.
X Deactivate the HOLD function (Y page 196).
X Try to start the engine again.
The engine does not
start. The starter motor
can be heard.
is a malfunction in the engine electronics.
is a malfunction in the fuel supply.
X Turn the key back to position 0 in the ignition lock before
attempting to start the engine again.
or
X Press the Start/Stop button repeatedly until all indicator lamps
in the instrument cluster go out.
X Try to start the engine again (Y page 157). Avoid excessively
long and frequent attempts to start the engine, as this will drain
the battery.
RThere
RThere
If the engine does not start after several attempts:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The engine does not
start. You cannot hear
the starter motor.
The on-board voltage is too low because the battery is too weak or
discharged.
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 586).
If the engine does not start despite attempts to jump-start it:
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The starter motor was exposed to a thermal load that was too high.
X Allow the starter motor to cool down for approximately two
minutes.
X Try to start the engine again.
If the engine still does not start:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The engine is not running smoothly and is
misfiring.
There is a malfunction in the engine electronics or in a mechanical
component of the engine management system.
X Only depress the accelerator pedal slightly.
Otherwise, non-combusted fuel may get into the catalytic converter and damage it.
X Have the cause rectified immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Automatic transmission
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The coolant temperaThe coolant level is too low. The coolant is too hot and the engine
ture display is showing is no longer being cooled sufficiently.
more than 120 †. The X Stop as soon as possible and allow the engine and the coolant to
coolant warning lamp
cool down.
may also be on and a
X Check the coolant level (Y page 565). Observe the warning
warning tone may
notes as you do so and top up the coolant if necessary.
sound.
If the coolant level is correct, the engine radiator fan may be faulty.
The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled
sufficiently.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in
mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
Automatic transmission
Selector lever
Important safety notes
Overview of transmission positions
G WARNING
If the engine speed is above the idling speed
and you engage transmission position D or R,
the vehicle could pull away suddenly. There is
a risk of an accident.
When engaging transmission position D or R,
always firmly depress the brake pedal and do
not simultaneously accelerate.
! If the engine speed is too high or if the
G WARNING
The automatic transmission switches to neutral position N when you switch off the engine.
The vehicle may roll away. There is a risk of an
accident.
After switching off the engine, always switch
to parking position P. Prevent the parked vehicle from rolling away by applying the parking
brake.
vehicle is rolling, do not shift the transmission directly from D to R, from R to D or
directly to P.
Do not open the driver's door while the
vehicle is in motion. At low speeds in transmission position D or R, park position P is
otherwise engaged automatically.
The transmission could be damaged.
Selector lever
j Park position
k Reverse gear
Z
Driving and parking
Problem
163
Automatic transmission
164
Driving and parking
i Neutral
h Drive
When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal.
X Push the selector lever forwards past the
first point of resistance.
X
When you select a transmission position, the
selector lever subsequently returns to its
original position.
The current transmission position P, R, N or D
appears in the transmission position display
in the multifunction display.
i When reverse gear is engaged and the
Engaging park position P
Shifting to neutral N
When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal.
X Press the P button in the centre console.
When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal.
X Push the selector lever forwards or back to
the first point of resistance.
X
i Park position P is released if you:
Rdepress
the brake pedal and
Rpush the selector lever forwards or back
to the first point of resistance
The transmission shifts to neutral N.
Park position P is engaged automatically and
the electric parking brake applied:
Rif you remove the key from the ignition lock
Rif you switch off the engine using the Start/
Stop button and open the driver's or frontpassenger door
Rif you open the driver's door while travelling
at low speed in transmission position D or
R
Rwhen HOLD (Y page 196) or DISTRONIC
PLUS (Y page 185) brakes your vehicle
until it is stationary and at least one of the
following conditions is fulfilled:
- the engine is switched off
- the driver's door is open and the seat belt
is not fastened
- there is a system malfunction
- the power supply is insufficient
Engaging reverse gear R
! Only shift the automatic transmission to R
when the vehicle is stationary.
ECO start/stop function is switched on, the
engine starts up automatically
(Y page 159).
X
i If the vehicle is braked to a standstill when
in neutral N and the brake pedal is kept
depressed, the ECO start/stop function
switches the engine off automatically
(Y page 159).
Staying in neutral (N)
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they can:
Ropen doors and endanger other persons or
road users
out and be injured by the traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and, for example, trap themselves.
Children could also set the vehicle in motion,
for example by:
Rclimb
Rreleasing
the parking brake
the automatic transmission out of
park position P
Rstarting the engine.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle. Always
keep the key out of reach of children.
Rshifting
Automatic transmission
Rmake
sure the ignition is switched on.
Rwhen the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal and keep it depressed.
Rselect neutral N.
Rrelease the brake pedal.
Rif the electric parking brake is applied,
release it.
Rswitch off the ignition and leave the key in
the ignition lock.
With KEYLESS-GO:
Rmake
sure the ignition is switched on.
Rwhen the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal and keep it depressed.
Rengage park position P.
Rrelease the brake pedal.
Rremove the Start/Stop button from the
ignition lock.
Rinsert the key into the ignition lock.
Rswitch on the ignition.
Rdepress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
Rselect neutral N.
Rrelease the brake pedal.
Rif the electric parking brake is applied,
release it.
Rswitch off the ignition and leave the key in
the ignition lock.
Shifting to transmission position D
When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal.
X Push the selector lever back past the first
point of resistance.
X
Transmission position and drive program display
Display in transmission positions P, R
and N
: Transmission position: currently selected
transmission position will be highlighted
; Drive program (E/S/M)
In addition to drive program ; being shown
in the multifunction display, the currently
selected drive program is indicated in red on
the program selector button.
Display when in transmission position D
: Transmission position
; Gear
= Drive program (E/S)
When you have selected drive program E or S,
the transmission position is displayed in position :. The selected gear is displayed in
position ;.
i If the vehicle is braked to a standstill when
in transmission position D (Y page 159) and
the brake pedal is kept depressed, the ECO
start/stop function switches the engine off
automatically.
Z
Driving and parking
With the key:
165
166
Automatic transmission
Driving and parking
Display when in transmission position D
and drive program M
Transmission positions
B
: Gear
; Drive program (M)
Park position
This prevents the vehicle from rolling away when stopped. Do not
shift the transmission into position
P (Y page 163) unless the vehicle is
stationary. The parking lock should
not be used as a brake when parking. In order to secure the vehicle,
always engage the electric parking
brake in addition to the parking
lock.
If the key is removed from the ignition lock, the transmission is
locked.
The automatic transmission shifts
into P automatically:
Rwhen
the key is removed from
the ignition lock.
Rwhen the engine is switched off
with the transmission in position
R or D and one of the doors is
opened.
In the event of a malfunction of the
vehicle's electronics, the transmission may lock in position P.
Have the vehicle electronics
checked immediately at a qualified
specialist workshop.
C
Reverse gear
Only shift the transmission to R
when the vehicle is stationary.
Automatic transmission
! Rolling in neutral N can lead to
damage to the transmission.
Drive
The automatic transmission
changes gear automatically. All
forward gears are available.
7
Double-clutch function
When shifting down, the double-clutch function is active regardless of the currently selected drive program. The double-clutch function
reduces load change reactions and is conducive to a sporty driving style. The sound generated by the double-clutch function depends
on the drive program selected.
Kickdown
Use kickdown for maximum acceleration.
Depress the accelerator pedal beyond the
pressure point.
The transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on the engine speed.
X Ease off the accelerator pedal once the
desired speed is reached.
The automatic transmission shifts back up.
X
Program selector button
Selecting drive programs
Changing gear
The automatic transmission shifts to the individual gears automatically when it is in transmission position D. Gearshifting is determined by:
Rthe
selected drive program (Y page 167)
position of the accelerator pedal
Rthe road speed
Rthe
Driving tips
Accelerator pedal position
Your style of driving influences how the automatic transmission shifts gear:
Rlittle
throttle: early upshifts
throttle: late upshifts
Rmore
Program selector button
Program selector button : allows you to
choose between different driving characteristics.
X Press program selector button : repeatedly until the letter for the desired gearshift
program appears in the speedometer multifunction display.
Z
Driving and parking
Neutral
Do not shift the transmission to N
while driving. Otherwise, the automatic transmission could be damaged.
No power is transmitted from the
engine to the drive wheels.
Releasing the brakes will allow you
to move the vehicle freely, e.g. to
push it or tow it.
If ESP® is deactivated or faulty:
only shift the transmission to position N if the vehicle is in danger of
skidding, e.g. on icy roads.
A
167
168
Automatic transmission
Economy: comfortable, economical
driving
RS Sport: sporty driving style
RM Manual: manual gearshifting
Driving and parking
RE
RM
Manual: manual gearshifting
RRS driving mode RACE START: optimum
acceleration dynamics from a standstill (SL
63 AMG only)
i Further information about permanent
i Further information about permanent
i The automatic transmission switches to
i The automatic transmission switches to
i For further information on the "Automatic
i RS cannot be selected during normal driv-
drive program M (Y page 170).
In addition to permanent drive program M,
you can also activate temporary drive program M (Y page 169).
automatic drive program E each time the
engine is started.
drive program M (Y page 170).
In addition to permanent drive program M,
you can also activate temporary drive program M (Y page 169).
automatic drive program C each time the
engine is started.
ing. For further information on RACE
START, see (Y page 198).
drive program", see (Y page 169).
Drive program for AMG vehicles
AMG button (SETUP)
You can save and call up the following presettings with the AMG button:
RDrive
program (Y page 168)
settings
RSuspension
You can use the drive program selector
switch to choose from a range of different
transmission settings or select the RACE
START drive mode.
X Turn drive program selector : until the
desired drive program appears in the multifunction display.
The drive program indicator on the drive
program selector lights up red.
RC Controlled Efficiency: comfortable
engine and transmission design that provides for optimum fuel consumption
RS Sport: sporty engine and transmission
settings
RS+ SportPlus: extremely sporty engine and
transmission settings
To store: press and hold AMG button :
until you hear a tone.
X To call up: press AMG button :.
The stored drive program is selected.
X To display: briefly press AMG button :.
The multifunction display shows SETUP in
the AMG menu (Y page 244).
X
Automatic transmission
Rincreased sensitivity. This improves driving
stability on slippery road surfaces, for
example.
Rthe automatic transmission shifting up
sooner. This results in the vehicle being
driven at lower engine speeds and the
wheels being less likely to spin.
Drive program S is characterised by the following:
Rsporty
engine and transmission settings
vehicle pulling away in first gear
Rthe automatic transmission shifting up
later
Ras a result of the later automatic transmission shift points, the fuel consumption possibly being higher
Rthe
: Left-hand steering wheel gearshift paddle
; Right-hand steering wheel gearshift pad-
dle
In the manual drive program, you can change
gear yourself by using the steering wheel
gearshift paddles (Y page 169).
Further information about permanent drive
program M(Y page 170).
Further information about temporary drive
program M(Y page 169).
i The full range of functions of the steering
wheel gearshift paddles is available only
once the operating temperature is reached.
i You can only change gear with the steer-
ing wheel gearshift paddles when the transmission is in position D.
Manual drive program M
General notes
In this drive program, you can briefly change
gear yourself by using the steering wheel
gearshift paddles. The transmission must be
in position D.
You can activate manual drive program M in
the E and S automatic drive programs.
i In addition to temporary drive program M,
you can also activate permanent drive program M (Y page 167).
Further information about permanent drive
program M (Y page 170).
Automatic drive program
Automatic drive programs E and S
Drive program E is characterised by the following:
Rcomfort-orientated
engine and transmission settings
Roptimal fuel consumption resulting from
the automatic transmission shifting up
sooner
Rthe vehicle pulling away more gently in
forward and reverse gears unless the accelerator pedal is depressed fully
Activating
Shift the transmission to position D.
X Pull the left or right steering wheel gearshift
paddle (Y page 169).
Manual drive program M is temporarily activated. The selected gear and M appear in
the multifunction display.
X
Shifting gears
If you pull on the left or right steering wheel
gearshift paddle, the automatic transmission
switches to manual drive program M for a
limited amount of time. Depending on which
Z
Driving and parking
Steering wheel gearshift paddles
169
Automatic transmission
Driving and parking
170
gearshift paddle is pulled, the automatic
transmission immediately shifts into the next
gear up or down, if permitted.
X To shift up: pull the right-hand steering
wheel gearshift paddle (Y page 169).
The automatic transmission shifts up to the
next gear.
i If the maximum engine speed on the currently engaged gear is reached and you
continue to accelerate, the automatic
transmission automatically shifts up in
order to prevent engine damage.
To shift down: pull on the left-hand steering wheel gearshift paddle (Y page 169).
The automatic transmission shifts down to
the next gear.
i If the engine exceeds the maximum
engine speed when shifting down, the automatic transmission protects against engine
damage by not shifting down.
X
i Automatic downshifting occurs when
coasting.
Gearshift recommendation
lateral acceleration, during an overrun phase
or when driving on steep terrain.
If manual drive program M has been deactivated, the automatic transmission shifts into
the automatic drive program that was last
selected, i.e. E or S.
You can also deactivate manual drive program M yourself:
X
Pull on the right-hand steering wheel gearshift paddle and hold it in place
(Y page 169).
or
X
Use the lever to switch the transmission
position.
or
X
Use the program selector button to change
the drive program (Y page 167).
Manual drive program M is deactivated.
The automatic transmission switches into
the automatic drive program that was last
selected, i.e. E or S.
Manual drive program
General notes
In this drive program, you can permanently
change gear yourself by using the steering
wheel gearshift paddles. The transmission
must be in position D.
The gearshift recommendations assist you in
adopting an economical driving style. The recommended gear is shown in the multifunction
display.
X Shift to recommended gear ; according
to gearshift recommendation : when
shown in the multifunction display of the
instrument cluster.
Deactivating
If you have activated manual drive program
M, it will remain active for a certain amount of
time. Under certain conditions the minimum
amount of time is extended, e.g. in the case of
i In addition to permanent drive program
M, you can also activate temporary drive
program M (Y page 169).
Activating the manual drive program
Manual drive program M differs from drive
program S with regard to spontaneity,
responsiveness and the smoothness of the
gear changes.
You can select manual drive program M with
the program selector button or the drive program selector (AMG vehicles). In manual
drive program M, you can change gear yourself using the steering wheel gearshift pad-
Automatic transmission
AMG vehicles: turn the drive program
selector until M appears in the multifunction display (Y page 168).
Shifting up
X
Pull the right-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle (Y page 169).
The automatic transmission shifts up to the
next gear.
Before the engine speed reaches the red
area, an upshift indicator will be shown in
the multifunction display.
Gearshift recommendation
: Gear indicator
; Upshift indicator
Before the engine speed reaches the red area,
an upshift indicator will be shown in the multifunction display.
X If the colour in the speedometer multifunction display changes to red and the UP display message is shown, shift up a gear.
Downshifting
X
Pull the left-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle (Y page 169).
The automatic transmission shifts down to
the next gear.
Maximum acceleration
X
The gearshift recommendations assist you in
adopting an economical driving style. The recommended gear is shown in the multifunction
display.
X Shift to recommended gear ; according
to gearshift recommendation : when
shown in the multifunction display of the
instrument cluster.
AMG vehicles
! In manual gearshift program M, the auto-
matic transmission does not shift up automatically even when the engine limiting
speed for the current gear is reached.
When the engine limiting speed is reached,
the fuel supply is cut to prevent the engine
from overrevving. You must make sure that
Pull the left-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle until the transmission selects the
optimum gear for the current speed.
i If you brake the vehicle or stop without
shifting down, the automatic transmission
will shift down to a gear that will allow the
vehicle to accelerate or pull away again.
Kickdown
You can also use kickdown for maximum
acceleration in manual drive program M.
X
Depress the accelerator pedal beyond the
pressure point.
The transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on the engine speed.
i AMG vehicles: it is not possible to use
kickdown in manual drive program M.
Z
Driving and parking
the engine speed does not reach the red
area of the rev counter. Otherwise, there is
a risk of engine damage.
dles if the transmission is in position D. The
selected gear appears in the multifunction
display.
X Press the program selector button until M
(Y page 167) appears in the multifunction
display.
X
171
Automatic transmission
172
Deactivating the manual drive program
Press the program selector button
(Y page 167) until E or S appears in the
multifunction display.
X AMG vehicles: turn the drive program
selector until C, S or S+ appears in the multifunction display (Y page 168).
Driving and parking
X
Refuelling
173
Problems with the transmission
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The transmission has
The transmission is losing oil.
problems shifting gear. X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
The acceleration ability The transmission is in emergency mode.
is deteriorating.
It is only possible to shift into second gear and reverse gear.
The transmission no
X Stop.
longer changes gear.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Switch off the engine.
X Wait at least ten seconds before restarting the engine.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R.
If D is selected, the transmission shifts into second gear; if R is
selected, the transmission shifts into reverse gear.
X Have the transmission checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Refuelling
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you or others come into contact with fuel,
observe the following:
RWash the fuel off any affected areas of skin
with water and soap immediately.
Fuel is highly flammable. If you handle fuel
incorrectly, there is a risk of fire and explosion.
You must avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Switch off the engine
and, if applicable, the auxiliary heating before
refuelling.
RIf you get fuel in your eyes, rinse them thor-
G WARNING
G WARNING
Electrostatic charge can cause sparks and
thereby ignite fuel vapours. There is a risk of
fire and explosion.
Always touch the vehicle body before opening
the fuel filler flap or touching the fuel pump
nozzle. This discharges any electrostatic
charge that may have built up.
Fuels are poisonous and hazardous to health.
There is a danger of injury.
Do not swallow fuel or let it come into contact
with skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale fuel
vapours. Keep fuels out of the reach of children.
oughly with clean water immediately. Seek
immediate medical attention.
RIf fuel is swallowed, seek immediate medical attention. Do not induce vomiting.
RChange any clothing that has come into
contact with fuel immediately.
! Do not use diesel to refuel vehicles with a
petrol engine. Do not switch on the ignition
if you accidentally refuel with the wrong
Z
Driving and parking
Problem
Driving and parking
174
Refuelling
fuel. Otherwise, fuel can enter the fuel system. Even small amounts of the wrong fuel
could result in damage to the fuel system
and the engine. Notify a qualified specialist
workshop and have the fuel tank and fuel
lines drained completely.
Opening the fuel filler flap
! Overfilling the fuel tank could damage the
fuel system.
! Take care not to spill any fuel on painted
surfaces. You could otherwise damage the
paintwork.
To open the fuel filler flap
To insert the fuel filler cap
Tyre pressure table
Fuel type to be refuelled
! Use a filter when adding fuel from a fuel
:
;
=
?
Do not get into the vehicle again during the
refuelling process. Otherwise, electrostatic
charge could build up again.
If you overfill the fuel tank, some fuel may
spray out when you remove the fuel pump
nozzle.
Further information on fuel and fuel quality
(Y page 623).
Switch off the engine.
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
X Press the fuel filler flap in the direction of
arrow :.
The fuel filler flap swings up.
X Turn the fuel filler cap anti-clockwise and
remove it.
X Insert the fuel filler cap into the holder
bracket on the inside of fuel filler flap ;.
X Completely insert the filler neck of the fuel
pump nozzle into the tank, hook in place
and refuel.
X Only fill the tank until the pump nozzle
switches off.
i Do not add any more fuel after the pump
stops filling for the first time. Otherwise,
fuel may leak out.
can. The fuel lines and/or the diesel injection system could otherwise be blocked by
particles from the fuel can.
Refuelling
General notes
The fuel filler flap is unlocked or locked automatically when you open or close the vehicle
with the key or using KEYLESS-GO.
The position of the 8 fuel filler cap is displayed in the instrument cluster. The arrow
next to the filling pump indicates the side of
the vehicle.
X
X
Closing the fuel filler flap
Place fuel filler cap on the fuel filler neck
and turn clockwise until it engages.
X Close the fuel filler flap.
X
i Close the fuel filler flap before locking the
vehicle.
Parking
175
Problems with the fuel and fuel tank
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Fuel is leaking from the The fuel line or the fuel tank is faulty.
vehicle.
G WARNING
There is a risk of fire or explosion.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition lock immediately and
remove it (Y page 155).
X Do not restart the engine under any circumstances.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Parking
G WARNING
Important safety notes
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
G WARNING
Flammable material such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact with
hot parts of the exhaust system or exhaust
gas flow. There is a risk of fire.
Park the vehicle so that no flammable material can come into contact with hot vehicle
components. In particular, do not park on dry
grassland or harvested grain fields.
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P
the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
Rstart
! Always secure the vehicle correctly
against rolling away. Otherwise, the vehicle
or its drivetrain could be damaged.
To ensure that the vehicle is secured against
rolling away unintentionally:
Rthe electric parking brake must be applied.
Rthe
transmission must be in position P and
the key must be removed from the ignition
lock.
Rthe front wheels must be turned towards
the kerb on steep uphill or downhill gradients.
Z
Driving and parking
This section provides descriptions of and solutions to safety-relevant problems. Descriptions
of and solutions to further problems can be found in the Digital Owner's Manual.
Parking
176
Switching off the engine
Driving and parking
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The automatic transmission switches to neutral position N when you switch off the engine.
The vehicle may roll away. There is a risk of an
accident.
After switching off the engine, always switch
to parking position P. Prevent the parked vehicle from rolling away by applying the parking
brake.
Vehicles with automatic transmission
Vehicles with a key: move the transmission to position P.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock and remove it.
The immobiliser is activated.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: press the
Start/Stop button (Y page 155).
The engine stops and all the indicator
lamps in the instrument cluster go out.
When the driver's door is closed, this corresponds to key position 1. When the driver's door is open, this corresponds to key
position 0 (Y page 155).
X
i The engine can be switched off while the
vehicle is in motion by pressing and holding
the Start/Stop button for about three seconds. This function operates independently
of the ECO start/stop automatic engine
switch-off function.
Electric parking brake
General notes
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P
the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
Rstart
The function of the electric parking brake is
dependent on the on-board voltage. If the onboard voltage is low or if there is a malfunction in the system, it may not be possible to
apply the released parking brake.
If this is the case, only park the vehicle on
level ground and secure it to prevent it rolling away.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position P.
X
It may not be possible to release an applied
parking brake, if the on-board voltage is low
or if there is a malfunction in the system.
Contact a qualified specialist workshop.
i The electric parking brake carries out a
function check at regular intervals when
the engine is switched off. Noises that
occur are normal.
Parking
Applying and releasing manually
177
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up.
ically applied if the engine is switched off by
the ECO start/stop function.
Releasing automatically
The electric parking brake is released automatically when all of the following conditions
are fulfilled:
To apply: push handle :.
When the electric parking brake is applied,
the red ! indicator lamp lights up in the
instrument cluster.
i The electric parking brake can also be
applied when the key is removed.
X To release: pull handle :.
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
i The electric parking brake can only be
released:
Rwhen the key is in position 1 in the ignition lock or
Rthe ignition was switched on using the
Start/Stop button
X
Applying automatically
The electric parking brake is applied automatically:
Rif
DISTRONIC PLUS brings the vehicle to a
standstill or
Rif the HOLD function is keeping the vehicle
stationary
In addition, at least one of the following conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is auto-
matically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function.
Rthe driver's seat belt is not inserted in the
belt buckle and the driver's door is open.
Rthe vehicle is stationary for a lengthy
period.
Rthe
engine is running.
transmission is in position D or R.
Rthe driver's seat belt is fastened.
Ryou depress the accelerator pedal.
If the transmission is in position R, the boot lid
must be closed.
If your seat belt is not fastened, the following
conditions must be fulfilled to automatically
release the electric parking brake:
Rthe
Rthe
driver's door is closed.
Ryou have shifted out of P or you have previously driven faster than 3 km/h.
Ensure that you do not depress the accelerator pedal unintentionally. Otherwise the
parking brake will be released and the vehicle
will start to move.
Emergency braking
The vehicle can also be braked during an
emergency by using the electric parking
brake.
X While driving, push handle : of the electric
parking brake.
i The vehicle is braked for as long as the
handle of the electric parking brake is
pressed. The longer the electric parking
brake handle is depressed, the greater the
braking force.
Z
Driving and parking
i The electric parking brake is not automat-
178
Driving tips
During braking:
Drive sensibly – save fuel
Ra
Observe the following tips to save fuel:
warning tone sounds
Release parking brake message
appears
Rthe red ! indicator lamp in the instrument cluster flashes
When the vehicle has been braked to a standstill, the electric parking brake is engaged.
Driving and parking
Rthe
Parking up the vehicle
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer
than four weeks, the battery may be damaged
by exhaustive discharging.
X Disconnect the battery or connect it to a
trickle charger.
i You can obtain information about trickle
chargers from a qualified specialist workshop.
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer
than six weeks, the vehicle may suffer damage as a result of lack of use.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop and
seek advice.
Driving tips
General notes
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
RThe
tyres should always be inflated to the
recommended tyre pressure.
RRemove unnecessary loads.
RWarm up the engine at low engine speeds.
RAvoid frequent acceleration or braking.
RObserve the service intervals in the Service
Booklet or in the service interval display.
Have all the maintenance work carried out
in accordance with Daimler AG regulations.
Fuel consumption also increases when driving in cold weather, in stop-start traffic, on
short journeys and in hilly terrain.
ECO display
Example: ECO display
The ECO display provides feedback on how
economical your driving characteristics are.
The ECO display assists you in achieving the
most economical driving style for the selected settings and prevailing conditions. Consumption can be significantly influenced by
your driving style.
The ECO display consists of three bars:
RAcceleration
RConstant
RCoasting
The percentage count is the mean value of the
three bar values. The three bars and the mean
value begin at the value of 50%. A higher percentage count indicates a more economical
driving style.
The ECO display does not indicate the actual
fuel consumption. A fixed percentage count
in the ECO display does not indicate a fixed
consumption.
In addition to driving style, the consumption is
affected by many other factors, such as:
Rload
Rtyre
pressure
Rcold start
Rchoice of route
Rthe use of electrical consumers
These factors are not included in the ECO display.
The evaluation of your driving style takes the
following three categories into consideration:
RAcceleration (evaluation of all acceleration processes):
- The bar fills up: moderate acceleration,
especially at higher speeds
- The bar empties: sporty acceleration
RConstant (assessment of driving behaviour at all times):
- The bar fills up: constant speed and
avoidance of unnecessary acceleration
and deceleration
- The bar empties: fluctuations in speed
RCoasting (assessment of all deceleration
processes):
- The bar fills up: anticipatory driving,
keeping your distance and early release
of the accelerator. The vehicle can coast
without use of the brakes
- The bar empties: frequent braking
i An economical driving style involves driv-
ing at a moderate engine speed.
To achieve a higher value in the categories
Acceleration and Constant
Constant:
Robserve the gearshift recommendation.
Rdrive the vehicle in drive program E.
i On long journeys at a constant speed, e.g.
on the motorway, only the bar for Constant
will change.
i The ECO display summarises the driving
characteristics from the start of the journey
to its completion. Therefore, there are
dynamic changes in the bars at the start of
a journey. During a prolonged driving time,
these changes are smaller. For more
dynamic changes, perform a manual reset.
For further information on the ECO display,
see (Y page 232).
Braking
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you shift down on a slippery road surface in
an attempt to increase the engine's braking
effect, the drive wheels could lose their grip.
This increases the risk of skidding and having
an accident.
Do not shift down for additional engine braking on a slippery road surface.
Downhill gradients
Change into a lower gear in good time on long
and steep downhill gradients. Take particular
note of this when driving a laden vehicle.
i This also applies if you have activated
cruise control, SPEEDTRONIC or DISTRONIC.
This will use the braking effect of the engine,
so less braking will be required to maintain
vehicle speed. This relieves the load on the
brake system and prevents the brakes from
overheating and wearing too quickly.
Heavy and light loads
G WARNING
The braking system can overheat if you leave
your foot on the brake pedal while driving.
This increases the braking distance and could
even cause the braking system to fail. There is
a risk of an accident.
Never use the brake pedal as a footrest. Do
not simultaneously depress both the brake
pedal and the accelerator pedal while driving.
Z
179
Driving and parking
Driving tips
180
Driving tips
! Depressing the brake pedal constantly
Driving and parking
results in excessive and premature wear to
the brake pads.
If the brakes have been subjected to a heavy
load, do not stop the vehicle immediately, but
drive on for a short while. This allows the airflow to cool the brakes more quickly.
If the brakes have been used only moderately,
you should occasionally test their effectiveness. To do this, brake more firmly from a
higher speed. This improves the grip of the
brakes.
Wet road surfaces
If you have driven for a long time in heavy rain
without braking, there may be a delayed reaction from the brakes when braking for the first
time.
This may also occur after the vehicle has been
washed.
You will have to depress the brake pedal more
firmly. Maintain a greater distance to the vehicle in front.
After driving on a wet road or having the vehicle washed, brake firmly while paying attention to the traffic conditions. This will warm up
the brake discs, thereby drying them more
quickly and protecting them against corrosion.
Limited braking performance on salttreated roads
If you drive on salt-treated roads, a layer of
salt may form on the brake discs and pads.
This can increase the braking distance considerably.
RBrake occasionally to remove any possible
salt residue. Ensure that you do not endanger other road users when doing so.
RCarefully depress the brake pedal at the
end of the journey and when starting the
next journey.
RMaintain a much greater distance to the
vehicle in front.
New brake pads/linings
New or replaced brake pads and discs only
reach their optimum braking effect after several hundred kilometres of driving. Compensate for the reduced braking effect by applying greater force to the brake pedal.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only have brake pads/linings
fitted to your vehicle which have been
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or
which correspond to an equivalent quality
standard. Brake pads/linings which have not
been approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or
which are not of an equivalent quality could
affect your vehicle's operating safety.
High-performance and ceramic brake
system for AMG vehicles
The AMG brake systems are designed for
heavy loads. This may lead to noise when
braking. This is dependent on:
Rspeed
Rbraking
force
conditions, e.g. temperature and
humidity
The wear of individual components of the
brake system, such as the brake pads/linings
or brake discs, depends on the individual driving style and operating conditions.
For this reason, it is impossible to state a
mileage (service life) that will be valid under
all circumstances. An aggressive driving style
will lead to high wear. You can obtain more
information on this from a qualified specialist
workshop.
New brake pads/brake pads and discs that
have been replaced only achieve optimum
braking effect after several hundred kilometres of driving. Compensate for the reduced
braking effect by applying greater force to the
brake pedal. Always be aware of this and
adapt your driving and braking accordingly
during the running-in period.
Excessive heavy braking results in correspondingly high brake wear. Observe the
Rambient
Driving tips
Driving on wet roads
Aquaplaning
If water has accumulated to a certain depth
on the road surface, there is a danger of aquaplaning occurring, even if:
Ryou
are driving at low speeds
tyres have adequate tread depth
For this reason, do not drive in tyre ruts, and
brake carefully.
Rthe
Do not shift down for additional engine braking on a slippery road surface.
G DANGER
If the exhaust pipe is blocked or adequate
ventilation is not possible, poisonous gases
such as carbon monoxide (CO) may enter the
vehicle. This is the case, e.g. if the vehicle
becomes trapped in snow. There is a risk of
fatal injury.
If you leave the engine or the auxiliary heating
running, make sure the exhaust pipe and area
around the vehicle are clear of snow. To
ensure an adequate supply of fresh air, open a
window on the side of the vehicle that is not
facing into the wind.
! Take care not to damage the sealing strip
and the moulding on the side of the rear
window when scraping ice off the rear window.
Driving on flooded roads
! Bear in mind that vehicles travelling in
front or in the opposite direction create
waves. This may cause the maximum permissible water depth to be exceeded.
These notes must be observed under all
circumstances. You could otherwise damage the engine, the electronics or the transmission.
If you have to drive on stretches of road on
which water has collected, please bear in
mind that:
Rthe
maximum permissible fording depth in
still water is 12 cm
Ryou should drive no faster than walking
pace
Winter driving
G WARNING
If you shift down on a slippery road surface in
an attempt to increase the engine's braking
effect, the drive wheels could lose their grip.
This increases the risk of skidding and having
an accident.
Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified
specialist workshop at the onset of winter.
You should drive particularly carefully on slippery road surfaces. Avoid sudden acceleration, steering and braking manoeuvres. Do
not use cruise control.
If the vehicle threatens to skid or cannot be
stopped when moving at low speed:
Move the transmission to position N.
X Try to bring the vehicle under control by
using corrective steering.
X
The outside temperature indicator is not
designed to serve as an ice-warning device
and is therefore unsuitable for that purpose.
Changes in the outside temperature are displayed after a short delay.
Indicated temperatures just above the freezing point do not guarantee that the road surface is free of ice. The road may still be icy,
especially in wooded areas or on bridges. The
vehicle could skid if you fail to adapt your
driving style. Always adapt your driving style
and drive at a speed to suit the prevailing
weather conditions.
Z
Driving and parking
brake system warning lamp in the instrument
cluster and note any brake status messages
in the multifunction display. If you regularly
drive at high speeds, it is particularly important to have the brake system checked and
maintained regularly.
181
Driving and parking
182
Driving systems
You should pay special attention to road conditions when temperatures are around the
freezing point.
For more information on driving with snow
chains, see (Y page 599).
For more information on driving with summer
tyres, see (Y page 598).
Observe the notes in the "Winter operation"
section (Y page 598).
Driving systems
Cruise control
Do not use cruise control:
Rin
road and traffic conditions which do not
allow you to maintain a constant speed, e.g.
heavy traffic or winding roads.
Ron slippery roads. Braking or accelerating
may cause the drive wheels to lose traction
and the vehicle could then skid.
Rwhen there is poor visibility, e.g. due to fog,
heavy rain or snow.
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the stored speed.
Cruise control lever
General notes
Cruise control maintains a constant road
speed for you. It brakes automatically in order
to avoid exceeding the set speed. On long and
steep downhill gradients, especially if the
vehicle is laden, you must select a lower gear
in good time. By doing so, you will make use of
the braking effect of the engine. This relieves
the load on the brake system and prevents
the brakes from overheating and wearing too
quickly.
Use cruise control only if road and traffic conditions make it appropriate to maintain a
steady speed for a prolonged period. You can
store any road speed above 30 km/h.
; LIM indicator lamp
= To store the current speed and to call up
Important safety notes
? To store the current speed or a lower
If you fail to adapt your driving style, cruise
control can neither reduce the risk of accident nor override the laws of physics. Cruise
control cannot take road, weather and traffic
conditions into account. Cruise control is only
an aid. You are responsible for the distance to
the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed, for
braking in good time and for maintaining lane.
Cruise control lever
: To store the current speed or a higher
speed
the last stored speed
speed
A To switch between cruise control and var-
iable SPEEDTRONIC
B To deactivate cruise control
You can operate cruise control and variable
SPEEDTRONIC with the cruise control lever.
LIM indicator lamp ; on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM
indicator lamp ; off: cruise control
is selected.
RLIM indicator lamp ; on: variable
SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
Driving systems
Selecting cruise control
Accelerate the vehicle to the desired
speed.
X Briefly press the cruise control lever up :
or down ;.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Cruise control is activated. The vehicle
automatically maintains the stored speed.
X
You can store the current speed if you are
driving faster than 30 km/h.
i Cruise control may be unable to maintain
the stored speed on uphill gradients. The
stored speed is resumed when the gradient
evens out. Cruise control maintains the
stored speed on downhill gradients by
automatically braking the vehicle.
Cruise control lever
X
Check whether LIM indicator lamp : is off.
If it is off, cruise control is already selected.
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow ;.
LIM indicator lamp : in the cruise control
lever goes out. Cruise control is selected.
Storing, maintaining and calling up a
speed
Storing and maintaining the speed
Cruise control lever
Storing or calling up the speed
G WARNING
If you call up a stored speed and this is different from the current speed, the vehicle
accelerates or brakes. If you do not know
what the stored speed is, the vehicle may
accelerate or brake unexpectedly. There is a
risk of an accident.
Take the traffic conditions into account
before calling up the stored speed. If you do
not know what the stored speed is, store the
desired speed again.
Cruise control lever
Z
Driving and parking
When you activate cruise control, the stored
speed is shown in the multifunction display
for five seconds. The speed is then permanently displayed in the status indicator
together with the ¯ symbol.
183
Driving systems
184
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you :.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
The first time cruise control is activated, it
stores the current speed or regulates the
speed of the vehicle to the previously
stored speed.
to the last speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
Driving and parking
X
Deactivating cruise control
Setting a speed
Cruise control lever
There are several ways to deactivate cruise
control:
X
Cruise control lever
Press the cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down ; for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until
the desired speed is reached.
X Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored.
X To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control
lever up : to the pressure point for a
higher speed or down ; for a lower speed.
The last speed stored is increased or
reduced.
X To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h
increments: briefly press the cruise control lever up : to the pressure point for a
higher speed or down ; for a lower speed.
The last speed stored is increased or
reduced.
X
i Cruise control is not deactivated if you
depress the accelerator pedal. For example, if you accelerate briefly to overtake,
cruise control adjusts the vehicle's speed
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards =.
or
X
Brake.
or
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow ;.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected. LIM
indicator lamp : in the cruise control lever
lights up.
Cruise control is automatically deactivated if:
Ryou
apply the electric parking brake
are driving at less than 30 km/h
RESP® intervenes or you deactivate ESP®
Ryou shift the transmission to position N
while driving
If cruise control is deactivated, you will hear a
warning tone. You will see the Cruise con‐
trol off message in the multifunction display for approximately five seconds.
Ryou
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
switch off the engine.
Driving systems
General notes
DISTRONIC PLUS regulates the speed and
automatically helps you maintain the distance to the vehicle detected in front. DISTRONIC PLUS brakes automatically so that
the set speed is not exceeded.
On long and steep downhill gradients, especially if the vehicle is laden, you must select a
lower gear in good time. By doing so, you will
make use of the braking effect of the engine.
This relieves the load on the brake system and
prevents the brakes from overheating and
wearing too quickly.
If a slower-moving vehicle is detected in front,
DISTRONIC PLUS brakes your vehicle. It
maintains the preset distance to the vehicle in
front.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that there is a risk
of a collision, you will be warned visually and
acoustically. Without your intervention, DISTRONIC PLUS cannot prevent a collision. An
intermittent warning tone will then sound and
the distance warning lamp will light up in the
instrument cluster. Brake immediately to
increase the distance to the vehicle driving in
front, or take evasive action, provided it is
safe to do so.
For DISTRONIC PLUS to assist you, the radar
sensor system must be operational.
If there is no vehicle in front, DISTRONIC
PLUS operates in the same way as cruise
control in the speed range between 30 km/h
and 200 km/h. If a vehicle is driving in front of
you, it operates in the speed range between
0 km/h and 200 km/h.
Do not use DISTRONIC PLUS while driving on
roads with steep gradients.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS does not react to:
Rpeople
or animals
Rstationary obstacles on the road, e.g. stop-
ped or parked vehicles
and crossing traffic
As a result, DISTRONIC PLUS may neither give
warnings nor intervene in such situations.
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Roncoming
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS cannot always clearly identify other road users and complex traffic situations.
In such cases, DISTRONIC PLUS may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning and then
brake the vehicle
Rneither give a warning nor intervene
Raccelerate unexpectedly
There is a risk of an accident.
Continue to drive carefully and be ready to
brake, in particular when warned to do so by
DISTRONIC PLUS.
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS brakes your vehicle with up
to 40% of the maximum braking force. If this
braking force is insufficient, DISTRONIC PLUS
warns you visually and audibly. There is a risk
of an accident.
In such cases, apply the brakes yourself and
try to take evasive action.
Z
Driving and parking
DISTRONIC PLUS
185
186
Driving systems
Driving and parking
! If DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD function
is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. To prevent damage to the vehicle, deactivate DISTRONIC
PLUS and the HOLD function in the following or other similar situations:
Rwhen
Rin
towing the vehicle
the car wash
If you fail to adapt your driving style, DISTRONIC PLUS can neither reduce the risk of
accident nor override the laws of physics.
DISTRONIC PLUS cannot take account of
road and weather conditions or traffic conditions. DISTRONIC PLUS is only an aid. You are
responsible for the distance to the vehicle in
front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good
time, and for staying correctly in lane.
Do not use DISTRONIC PLUS:
road and traffic conditions which do not
allow you to maintain a constant speed
(e.g. in heavy traffic or on winding roads).
Ron smooth or slippery roads. Braking or
accelerating can cause the drive wheels to
lose traction and the vehicle could then
skid.
Rwhen there is poor visibility, e.g. due to fog,
heavy rain or snow.
DISTRONIC PLUS may not detect narrow
vehicles driving in front, e.g. motorcycles, or
vehicles driving on a different line.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired if there is:
This speed can:
Rbe
too high for a filter lane or a slip road
so high in the right lane that you pass
vehicles driving on the left
Rbe so high in the left lane that you pass
vehicles driving on the right
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the speed stored.
Rbe
Cruise control lever
Rin
Rdirt
on the sensors or anything else covering the sensors
Rsnow or heavy rain
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rthe possibility of strong radar reflections,
for example, in multi-storey car parks
If DISTRONIC PLUS no longer detects a vehicle in front, it may unexpectedly accelerate to
the speed stored.
Cruise control lever
: To store the current speed or a higher
speed
; To set the specified minimum distance
= LIM indicator lamp
? To store the current speed and to call up
the last stored speed
A To store the current speed or a lower
speed
B To switch between DISTRONIC PLUS and
variable SPEEDTRONIC
C To deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS
You can operate DISTRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC with the cruise control
lever.
LIM indicator lamp = on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM
indicator lamp = off: DISTRONIC
PLUS is selected.
RLIM indicator lamp = on: variable
SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
Driving systems
Rthe
driver's door must be closed when you
shift from P to D or your seat belt must be
fastened.
Rthe front-passenger door must be closed.
Rthe vehicle must not be skidding.
Activating
Cruise control lever
X
Check whether LIM indicator lamp : is off.
If it is off, DISTRONIC PLUS is already selected.
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow ;.
LIM indicator lamp : in the cruise control
lever goes out. DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
Activating DISTRONIC PLUS; storing,
maintaining and calling up a speed
Important safety notes
! If DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD function
is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. To prevent damage to the vehicle, deactivate DISTRONIC
PLUS and the HOLD function in the following or other similar situations:
Rwhen
Rin
towing the vehicle
the car wash
To activate DISTRONIC PLUS, the following
conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe engine must be running. It may take up
to two minutes of driving before DISTRONIC PLUS is ready for use.
Ryour vehicle must not be secured by the
electric parking brake.
RESP® must be activated.
Rthe transmission must be in position D.
Rthe bonnet must be closed.
Cruise control lever
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ;, or press it up : or down = .
DISTRONIC PLUS is activated.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed up :
or down = until the desired speed has
been set.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Your vehicle adapts its speed to that of the
vehicle in front, but only up to the desired
stored speed.
X
If the vehicle in front has been detected and is
shown in the multifunction display, you can
also activate DISTRONIC PLUS when driving
at speeds below 30 km/h. If the vehicle in
front is no longer detected and displayed, for
example because it has changed lanes, DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated. You will hear a
warning tone if this is the case.
i If you do not fully release the accelerator
pedal, the DISTRONIC PLUS inactive
message appears in the multifunction display. The set distance to a slower-moving
vehicle in front will then not be maintained.
You will be driving at the speed you determine by the position of the accelerator
pedal.
Z
Driving and parking
Selecting DISTRONIC PLUS
187
188
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Pulling away and driving
Changing lanes
If you wish to move into the overtaking lane (in
countries where traffic drives on the right, the
passing lane is the left-hand lane), DISTRONIC PLUS assists you if:
Ryou
are driving faster than 60 km/h
PLUS is maintaining the distance to a vehicle in front
Ryou have switched on the corresponding
turn signal
RDISTRONIC PLUS does not detect a danger
of collision
If these conditions are met, your vehicle is
accelerated. Acceleration will be interrupted
if changing lanes takes too long or if the distance between your vehicle and the vehicle in
front becomes too small.
RDISTRONIC
Cruise control lever
DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated when you
depress the brake, except when the vehicle is
stationary.
X If the vehicle in front pulls away: remove
your foot from the brake pedal.
X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ;, or up : or down = .
or
X Accelerate briefly.
Your vehicle pulls away and adapts its
speed to that of the vehicle in front.
If there is no vehicle in front, DISTRONIC
PLUS operates in the same way as cruise
control.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that the vehicle in
front has slowed down, it brakes your vehicle.
It maintains the preset distance to the vehicle
in front.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that there is a risk
of a collision, you will be warned visually and
acoustically. Without your intervention, DISTRONIC PLUS cannot prevent a collision. An
intermittent warning tone will then sound and
the distance warning lamp will light up in the
instrument cluster. Brake immediately to
increase the distance to the vehicle driving in
front, or take evasive action, provided it is
safe to do so.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a faster-moving
vehicle in front, it increases the driving speed.
However, the vehicle is only accelerated up to
the speed you have stored.
Vehicles with COMAND Online
i The following function is not operational
in all countries.
DISTRONIC PLUS uses additional information
from your navigation system so that it can
react appropriately to certain traffic situations. This is the case if, while following a
vehicle, DISTRONIC PLUS is active and you:
Rapproach
or drive around a roundabout
a T-junction
Rturn off at a motorway exit
Even if the vehicle in front leaves the detection range, DISTRONIC PLUS temporarily
maintains the current driving speed and does
not accelerate. This is based on the current
map data in the navigation system.
Rapproach
Example: roundabout
The current speed is maintained:
Rapproximately
ten seconds before the
roundabout/T-junction and for approximately 1.5 seconds when driving on the
roundabout
Rapproximately twelve seconds before
reaching a motorway exit and approximately four seconds after the motorway
exit
Afterwards, the vehicle accelerates back to
the set speed you specified.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that the vehicle in
front is stopping, it brakes your vehicle until it
is stationary.
Once your vehicle is stationary, it remains
stationary and you do not need to depress the
brake. After a short period the vehicle is
secured by the electric parking brake, thus
relieving the service brake.
Depending on the specified minimum distance, your vehicle will come to a standstill at
a sufficient distance behind the vehicle in
front. The specified minimum distance is set
using the control on the cruise control lever.
The electric parking brake secures the vehicle
automatically if DISTRONIC PLUS is activated
and:
G WARNING
driver's door is open and the driver's
seat belt is unfastened
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is automatically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function
Ra system fault occurs
Rthe power supply is not sufficient
If a fault occurs, then the transmission may
also be shifted into position P automatically.
When leaving the vehicle, even if it is braked
only by DISTRONIC PLUS, it could roll away if:
Storing the current speed and calling up
the last stored speed
Stopping
Rthere
is a malfunction in the system or in
the voltage supply.
RDISTRONIC PLUS has been deactivated
with the cruise control lever, e.g. by a vehicle occupant or from outside the vehicle.
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses have
been tampered with.
Rthe battery is disconnected.
Rthe accelerator pedal has been depressed,
e.g. by a vehicle occupant.
There is a risk of an accident.
If you wish to exit the vehicle, always turn off
DISTRONIC PLUS and secure the vehicle
against rolling away.
Rthe
G WARNING
If you call up a stored speed and this is different from the current speed, the vehicle
accelerates or brakes. If you do not know
what the stored speed is, the vehicle may
accelerate or brake unexpectedly. There is a
risk of an accident.
Take the traffic conditions into account
before calling up the stored speed. If you do
not know what the stored speed is, store the
desired speed again.
Deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 192).
Z
189
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving systems
190
To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control
lever up : to the pressure point for a
higher speed, or down ; for a lower speed.
The last speed stored is increased or
reduced.
X To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h
increments: briefly press the cruise control lever up : past the pressure point for
a higher speed, or down ; for a lower
speed.
The last speed stored is increased or
reduced.
Driving and parking
X
Cruise control lever
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you :.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
DISTRONIC PLUS is activated. The first
time it is activated, the current speed is
stored. Otherwise, it sets the vehicle cruise
speed to the previously stored value.
X
Setting a speed
Setting the specified minimum distance
You can set the specified minimum distance
for DISTRONIC PLUS by varying the time span
between one and two seconds. With this function, you can set the minimum distance that
DISTRONIC PLUS maintains to the vehicle in
front, dependent on vehicle speed. You can
see this distance in the multifunction display
(Y page 191).
Make sure that you maintain a sufficient and
safe distance from the vehicle in front. Adjust
the distance to the vehicle in front if necessary.
Cruise control lever
Bear in mind that it may take a brief moment
until the vehicle has accelerated or braked to
the set speed.
X Press the cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down ; for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until
the desired speed is reached.
X Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored. DISTRONIC PLUS
is activated and adjusts the vehicle's speed
to the new speed stored.
Cruise control lever
Driving systems
DISTRONIC PLUS displays in the instrument cluster
Displays in the speedometer
Display when DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated
: Vehicle in front, if detected
; Distance indicator: current distance to
the vehicle in front
= Specified minimum distance to the vehi-
cle in front; adjustable
? Own vehicle
X
Select the Assistance graphic function
using the on-board computer
(Y page 237).
In the Assistance menu of the on-board computer, you can also activate or deactivate
PRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 238).
When DISTRONIC PLUS is activated, one or
two segments ; in the set speed range light
up.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a vehicle in front,
segments ; between speed of the vehicle in
front = and stored speed : light up.
Display when DISTRONIC PLUS is activated
i For design reasons, the speed displayed
in the speedometer may differ slightly from
the speed set for DISTRONIC PLUS.
: Vehicle in front, if detected
; Specified minimum distance to the vehi-
cle in front; adjustable
= Own vehicle
? DISTRONIC PLUS activated
Z
Driving and parking
To increase: turn control = in direction ;.
DISTRONIC PLUS then maintains a greater
distance between your vehicle and the
vehicle in front.
X To decrease: turn control = in direction :.
DISTRONIC PLUS then maintains a shorter
distance between your vehicle and the
vehicle in front.
X
191
Driving systems
192
Driving and parking
X
Select the Assistance graphic function
using the on-board computer
(Y page 237).
You will initially see the stored speed for
about five seconds when you activate DISTRONIC PLUS.
Deactivating DISTRONIC PLUS
Cruise control lever
There are several ways to deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards :.
or
X
Brake, unless the vehicle is stationary.
or
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow =.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected. LIM
indicator lamp ; in the cruise control lever
lights up.
DISTRONIC PLUS is automatically deactivated if:
Ryou apply the electric parking brake or if the
vehicle is automatically secured with the
electric parking brake
Ryou are driving slower than 25 km/h and
there is no vehicle in front, or if the vehicle
in front is no longer detected
RESP® intervenes or you deactivate ESP®
Rthe transmission is in the P, R or N position
Ryou pull the cruise control lever towards
you in order to pull away and the frontpassenger door is open
Rthe vehicle has skidded
If DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated, you will
hear a warning tone. You will see the DIS‐
TRONIC PLUS off message in the multifunction display for approximately five seconds.
Tips for driving with DISTRONIC PLUS
General notes
The following contains descriptions of certain
road and traffic conditions in which you must
be particularly attentive. In such situations,
brake if necessary. DISTRONIC PLUS is then
deactivated.
Cornering, going into and coming out of a
bend
When you deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS, you
will see the DISTRONIC PLUS off message in
the multifunction display for approximately
five seconds.
i The last speed stored remains stored until
you switch off the engine.
i DISTRONIC PLUS is not deactivated if you
depress the accelerator pedal. If you accelerate to overtake, DISTRONIC PLUS
adjusts the vehicle's speed to the last
speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
The ability of DISTRONIC PLUS to detect vehicles when cornering is limited. Your vehicle
may brake unexpectedly or late.
Driving systems
Vehicles which are not driving in the middle of their lane
DISTRONIC PLUS has not yet detected the
vehicle in front on the edge of the carriageway, because of its narrow width. The distance to the vehicle in front will be too short.
Other vehicles changing lane
Driving and parking
Obstructions and stationary vehicles
DISTRONIC PLUS may not detect vehicles
which are not driving in the middle of their
lane. The distance to the vehicle in front will
be too short.
DISTRONIC PLUS does not brake for obstacles or stationary vehicles. If, for example, the
detected vehicle turns a corner and reveals
an obstacle or stationary vehicle, DISTRONIC
PLUS will not brake for these.
Crossing vehicles
DISTRONIC PLUS has not detected the vehicle cutting in yet. The distance to this vehicle
will be too short.
Narrow vehicles
193
DISTRONIC PLUS may mistakenly detect
vehicles that are crossing your lane. Activating DISTRONIC PLUS at traffic lights with
crossing traffic, for example, could cause
your vehicle to pull away unintentionally.
SPEEDTRONIC
General notes
SPEEDTRONIC brakes automatically so that
you do not exceed the set speed. On long and
steep downhill gradients, especially if the
Z
Driving and parking
194
Driving systems
vehicle is laden, you must select a lower gear
in good time. By doing so, you will make use of
the braking effect of the engine. This relieves
the load on the brake system and prevents
the brakes from overheating and wearing too
quickly.
You can set a variable or permanent limit
speed:
Variable SPEEDTRONIC
Cruise control lever
Rvariable
for speed limits, e.g. in built-up
areas
Rpermanent for long-term speed restrictions, e.g. when driving with winter tyres
fitted (Y page 196)
i The speed indicated in the speedometer
may differ slightly from the limit speed
stored.
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style, SPEEDTRONIC can neither reduce the risk of accident nor override the laws of physics. SPEEDTRONIC cannot take into account road,
weather or traffic conditions. SPEEDTRONIC
is only an aid. You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed,
for braking in good time, and for staying correctly in lane.
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the speed stored.
Cruise control lever
: To store the current speed or a higher
speed
; LIM indicator lamp
= To store the current speed and to call up
the last stored speed
? To store the current speed or a lower
speed
A To switch between cruise control or DIS-
TRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC
B To deactivate variable SPEEDTRONIC
With the cruise control lever, you can operate
cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC.
LIM indicator lamp ; on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM
indicator lamp ; off: cruise control
or DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
RLIM indicator lamp ; on: variable
SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
You can use the cruise control lever to limit
the speed to any speed above 30 km/h while
the engine is running.
Driving systems
You can use the cruise control lever to limit
the speed to any speed above 30 km/h while
the engine is running.
Storing the current speed and calling up
the last stored speed
Cruise control lever
X
Check whether LIM indicator lamp : is on.
If it is on, variable SPEEDTRONIC is already
selected.
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow ;.
LIM indicator lamp : in the cruise control
lever lights up. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is
selected.
G WARNING
If you call up the stored speed and it is lower
than the current speed, the vehicle decelerates. If you do not know the stored speed, the
vehicle could decelerate unexpectedly. There
is a risk of an accident.
Pay attention to the road and traffic conditions before calling up the stored speed. If you
do not know the stored speed, store the
desired speed again.
Storing the current speed
Cruise control lever
X
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you :.
Setting a speed
Cruise control lever
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever up :
or down ;.
The current speed is stored. The multifunction display shows the stored speed, such
as Limit 100 km/h,
km/h for five seconds.
Vehicles with cruise control: the stored
speed is permanently displayed in the status indicator, e.g. LIM 100 km/h.
km/h
Vehicles with DISTRONIC PLUS: the segments from the start of the scale up to the
stored speed light up in the speedometer.
Cruise control lever
X
To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h
increments: briefly press the cruise conZ
Driving and parking
Selecting variable SPEEDTRONIC
195
Driving systems
196
trol lever up : past the pressure point for
a higher speed, or down ; for a lower
speed.
Driving and parking
or
X
Keep the cruise control lever pressed
beyond the pressure point until the desired
speed is set. Press the cruise control lever
up : for a higher speed or down ; for a
lower speed.
X
To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control
lever up : to the pressure point for a
higher speed, or down ; for a lower speed.
or
X
Keep the cruise control lever pressed to the
pressure point until the desired speed is
set. Press the cruise control lever up : for
a higher speed or down ; for a lower
speed.
Deactivating variable SPEEDTRONIC
If you depress the accelerator pedal beyond
the pressure point (kickdown), variable
SPEEDTRONIC is automatically deactivated,
but only if your current speed does not differ
by more than 20 km/h from the stored speed.
You will hear a warning tone if this is the case.
It is not possible to deactivate variable
SPEEDTRONIC by braking.
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
switch off the engine.
Permanent SPEEDTRONIC
You can use the on-board computer to limit
the speed permanently to a value between
160 km/h(e.g. for driving on winter tyres) and
the maximum speed (Y page 242).
Shortly before the stored speed is reached, it
appears in the multifunction display.
Permanent SPEEDTRONIC remains active,
even if variable SPEEDTRONIC is deactivated.
You cannot exceed the stored limit speed,
even if you depress the accelerator pedal
beyond the pressure point (kickdown).
HOLD function
General notes
The HOLD function can assist the driver in the
following situations:
Rwhen
Cruise control lever
There are several ways to deactivate variable
SPEEDTRONIC:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards :.
or
X
Briefly move the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow =.
LIM indicator lamp ; in the cruise control
lever goes out. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is
deactivated.
Cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
pulling away, especially on steep
slopes
Rwhen manoeuvring on steep slopes
Rwhen waiting in traffic
The vehicle is kept stationary without the
driver having to depress the brake pedal.
The braking effect is cancelled and the HOLD
function is deactivated when you depress the
accelerator pedal to pull away.
Driving systems
Activating the HOLD function
G WARNING
When leaving the vehicle, it can still roll away
despite being braked by the HOLD function if:
Rthere
is a malfunction in the system or in
the voltage supply
Rthe HOLD function is deactivated by the
accelerator pedal being depressed, e.g. by
a vehicle occupant
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses are tampered with
Rthe battery is disconnected
There is a risk of an accident.
Before leaving the vehicle, always deactivate
the HOLD function and secure the vehicle
from rolling away.
! If DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD function
is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. To prevent damage to the vehicle, deactivate DISTRONIC
PLUS and the HOLD function in the following or other similar situations:
Rwhen
towing the vehicle
Rin the car wash
Deactivate the HOLD function (Y page 197).
Activation conditions
You can activate the HOLD function if:
Rthe
vehicle is stationary
engine is running or if it has been automatically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function
Rthe driver's door is closed or if your seat
belt is fastened
Rthe electric parking brake is released
Rthe transmission is in position D, R or N
RDISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated
Rthe
Make sure that the activation conditions
are met.
X Depress the brake pedal.
X Quickly depress the brake pedal further
until : HOLD appears in the multifunction
display.
The HOLD function is activated. You can
release the brake pedal.
X
i If depressing the brake pedal the first
time does not activate the HOLD function,
wait briefly and then try again.
Deactivating the HOLD function
The HOLD function is deactivated automatically if:
Ryou
accelerate and the transmission is in
position D or R.
Ryou shift the transmission to position P.
Ryou apply the brakes again with a certain
amount of pressure until HOLD disappears
from the multifunction display.
Ryou secure the vehicle using the electric
parking brake.
Ryou activate DISTRONIC PLUS.
i After a short period the vehicle is secured
by the electric parking brake, thus relieving
the service brake.
The electric parking brake secures the vehicle
automatically if the HOLD function is activated and:
Rthe
driver's door is open and the driver's
seat belt is unfastened
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is automatically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function
Z
Driving and parking
Important safety notes
197
Driving systems
198
Ra
system fault occurs
power supply is not sufficient
If a fault occurs, then the transmission may
also be shifted into position P automatically.
Driving and parking
Rthe
i If the activation conditions are no longer
fulfilled, RACE START is cancelled. The multifunction display shows the RACE START
cancelled message.
X
RACE START
Important safety notes
i Observe the safety notes for the SPORT
handling mode (Y page 75).
Only activate RACE START on dedicated race
circuits.
RACE START enables optimum acceleration
from a standing start. The precondition for
this is a suitable high-grip road surface.
i RACE START is only available for the
SL 63 AMG model.
Activation conditions
You can activate RACE START if:
Rthe
doors are closed
Rthe engine is running and it has reached an
operating temperature of approximately
80 †. This is the case when the engine oil
temperature in the multifunction display
stops flashing.
RSPORT handling mode is activated
(Y page 75)
Rthe steering wheel is in the straight-ahead
position
Rthe vehicle is stationary and the brake
pedal is depressed (left foot)
Rthe transmission is in position D
Activating RACE START
Depress the brake pedal with your left foot
and keep it depressed.
X Turn the drive program selector clockwise
(Y page 168) until the RS lamp lights up.
The RACE START Confirm: Paddle UP
Cancel: Paddle DOWN message appears
in the multifunction display.
X
To cancel: pull the left steering wheel shift
paddle (Y page 169).
or
To confirm: pull the right steering wheel
shift paddle (Y page 169).
The RACE START available Depress
accelerator message appears in the multifunction display.
i If you do not depress the accelerator
pedal fully within two seconds, RACE
START is cancelled. The RACE START not
possible See Owner's Manual message
appears in the multifunction display.
X
Fully depress the accelerator pedal.
The engine speed increases to at least
3,500 rpm.
The RACE START Release brake to
start message appears in the multifunction display.
i If you do not release the brake pedal
within five seconds, RACE START is cancelled. The multifunction display shows the
RACE START cancelled message.
X
X
Take your foot off the brake, but keep the
accelerator pedal depressed.
The vehicle pulls away at maximum acceleration.
The RACE START active appears in the
multifunction display.
RACE START is deactivated when the vehicle
reaches a speed of approximately 50 km/h.
Drive program S+ is activated. SPORT handling mode remains activated.
RACE START is deactivated immediately if
you release the accelerator pedal during
RACE START or if any of the activation conditions are no longer fulfilled. The RACE START
not possible See Owner's Manual message appears in the multifunction display.
Driving systems
cession, RACE START will be unavailable
until a certain distance has been driven.
Selecting comfort tuning
Adaptive Damping System
General notes
The adjustable suspension system adapts to
the particular driving conditions. Adjustment
depends on your individual selection, i.e.
sporty or comfortable. Your selection
remains stored even if you remove the key
from the ignition lock.
Selecting sports tuning
Make sure that the engine is running or that
it has been switched off by the ECO start/
stop function.
X If indicator lamp ; is not lit: press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. You have selected the suspension for a comfortable driving style.
The message COMFORT appears in the multifunction display.
X
In comfort mode, the driving characteristics
of your vehicle are more comfortable. Select
this mode if you prefer a more comfortable
driving style.
Make sure that the engine is running or that
it has been switched off by the ECO start/
stop function.
X If indicator lamp ; is not lit: press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. You have selected the suspension for a sporty driving
style.
The message SPORT appears in the multifunction display.
X
The firmer setting of the suspension tuning in
sports mode ensures even better contact
with the road. Select this mode if you want to
experience direct contact with the road surface when employing a sporty driving style,
e.g. on winding country roads.
Active Body Control (except AMG
vehicles)
Vehicle level
General notes
In order to reduce fuel consumption and
improve the driving dynamics, the vehicle is
lowered as its speed increases. With the
SPORT suspension setting, it is lowered by up
to 13 mm, with COMFORT by up to 5 mm. As
the speed is reduced, the vehicle is raised to
the set vehicle height.
Select the "Normal" setting for normal road
surfaces and "Raised" for driving with snow
chains or on particularly poor road surfaces.
Your selection remains stored even if you
remove the key from the ignition lock.
Z
Driving and parking
i After using it several times in short suc-
199
Driving systems
200
Important safety notes
Driving and parking
G WARNING
The vehicle is slightly lowered if you:
Indicator lamp ; lights up. The vehicle
height is adjusted to raised level.
Setting the normal level
Rhave
selected the SPORT suspension tuning at normal level and
Rswitch off the engine
Persons in the vicinity of the wheel arch or the
underbody may thus become trapped. There
is a risk of injury.
Make sure that nobody is in the vicinity of the
wheel arch or the underbody when you switch
off the engine.
! When the engine is switched off, the vehi-
cle is lowered if SPORT suspension tuning
has been selected at the normal level. The
vehicle is automatically lowered by approximately 10 mm. Make sure when parking
that you position your vehicle so that it
does not make contact with the kerb as the
vehicle is lowered. Your vehicle could otherwise be damaged.
Setting the raised level
Make sure that the engine is running or that
it has been switched off by the ECO start/
stop function.
X If indicator lamp ; is lit: press button :.
Indicator lamp ; goes out. The vehicle is
adjusted to normal level.
X
The "Raised level" setting is cancelled if you:
Rare
driving faster than approximately
120 km/h.
Rdrive for approximately three minutes at a
speed over 80 km/h.
Suspension setting
Make sure that the engine is running or that
it has been switched off by the ECO start/
stop function.
X Make sure that a speed of 120 km/h is not
exceeded.
X If indicator lamp ; is not lit: press button :.
If the engine has been switched off by the
ECO start/stop function, it is now restarted.
X
General notes
The electronically controlled ABC suspension
system features improved driving dynamics
and ride comfort.
The ABC suspension system is tuned individually to each wheel and depends on:
Rthe
road surface condition, e.g. bumps
vehicle load
Ryour individual selection of the sporty or
comfortable button
Your selection remains stored even if you
remove the key from the ignition lock.
Rthe
Driving systems
Make sure that the engine is running or that
it has been switched off by the ECO start/
stop function.
X If indicator lamp ; is not lit: press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. You have selected the suspension setting for a sporty driving style.
The ABC Active Body Control SPORT
message appears in the multifunction display.
X
Make sure that the engine is running or that
it has been switched off by the ECO start/
stop function.
X If indicator lamp ; is not lit: press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. You have selected the suspension setting for a comfortable driving style.
The ABC Active Body Control COMFORT
message appears in the multifunction display.
X
In Comfort mode, the driving characteristics
of your vehicle are more comfortable. Select
this mode if you prefer a more comfortable
driving style.
Driving conditions menu in the
COMAND display
The firmer suspension setting in Sport mode
ensures even better contact with the road.
Select this mode if you prefer a firmer suspension setting.
Selecting comfort setting
You can display some driving systems and
additional information in the COMAND display.
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X Make sure COMAND Online is switched on
(Y page 298).
X Press button :.
The corresponding displays appear in the
COMAND display.
Z
Driving and parking
Selecting sporty tuning
201
202
Driving systems
Driving and parking
When lowering the vehicle, make sure no one
is underneath the vehicle or in the immediate
vicinity of the wheel arches.
! If you have selected the normal level and
Example: displays in the COMAND display
: Selection of raised level (Y page 199)
; Activity of ABC suspension struts for roll
switched the engine off, the vehicle is lowered. The vehicle is automatically lowered
by approximately 10 mm. Make sure when
parking that you position your vehicle so
that it does not make contact with the kerb
as the vehicle is lowered. Your vehicle
could otherwise be damaged.
Setting the raised level
and pitching support
= Selected suspension setting, i.e. sporty or
comfortable (Y page 200)
? G-FORCE (longitudinal and lateral accel-
eration)
A Current vehicle level
Active Body Control (AMG vehicles)
Vehicle level
General notes
In order to reduce fuel consumption and
improve the driving dynamics, the vehicle is
lowered as its speed increases. In the SPORT
suspension setting, it is lowered by up to
13 mm, with COMFORT by up to 5 mm. As the
speed is reduced, the vehicle is raised to the
set vehicle height.
Select the "Normal" setting for normal road
surfaces and "Raised" for driving with snow
chains or on particularly poor road surfaces.
Important safety notes
The vehicle is slightly lowered when the
engine is switched off.
G WARNING
People's limbs may become trapped if they
are located underneath the vehicle or
between the vehicle body and the tyres when
the vehicle is lowering. There is a danger of
injury.
Make sure that the engine is running or that
it has been switched off by the ECO start/
stop function.
X Make sure that a speed of 120 km/h is not
exceeded.
X If symbol ; is not shown: press =
or ; on the steering wheel to select the
Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Vehicle level.
level
X Press the a button.
The following message appears: Vehicle
level Raise with OK.
OK
X Press the a button.
If the engine has been switched off by the
ECO start/stop function, it is now restarted.
Symbol ; appears. The vehicle height is
adjusted to the raised level.
X
Setting the normal level
Selecting sporty tuning
Make sure that the engine is running or that
it has been switched off by the ECO start/
stop function.
X If symbol ; is shown: press =
or ; on the steering wheel to select the
Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Vehicle level.
level
X Press the a button.
The following message appears: Vehicle
level Lower with OK.
OK
X Press the a button.
Symbol ; is faded out. The vehicle is
adjusted to normal level.
Make sure that the engine is running or that
it has been switched off by the ECO start/
stop function.
X If indicator lamp ; is not lit: press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. You have selected the suspension setting for a sporty driving style.
The AMG Ride Control SPORT message
appears in the multifunction display.
The "Raised level" setting is cancelled if you:
Selecting comfort tuning
X
X
The firmer suspension setting in Sport mode
ensures even better contact with the road.
Select this mode if you prefer a firmer suspension setting.
Rare
driving faster than approximately
120 km/h.
Rdrive for approximately three minutes at a
speed over 80 km/h.
Suspension setting
General notes
The electronically controlled ABC suspension
system features improved driving dynamics
and ride comfort.
The ABC suspension system is tuned individually to each wheel and depends on:
Rthe
road surface condition, e.g. bumps
vehicle load
Ryour individual selection of the sporty or
comfortable button
Rthe
Z
203
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving systems
204
Make sure that the engine is running or that
it has been switched off by the ECO start/
stop function.
X If indicator lamp ; is lit: press button :.
Indicator lamp ; goes out. You have selected the suspension setting for a comfortable driving style.
The AMG Ride Control COMFORT message appears in the multifunction display.
Driving and parking
X
In Comfort mode, the driving characteristics
of your vehicle are more comfortable. Select
this mode if you prefer a more comfortable
driving style.
Driving conditions menu in the
COMAND display
You can display some driving systems and
additional information in the COMAND display.
X Call up the driving conditions menu in the
COMAND display (Y page 318).
The corresponding displays appear in the
COMAND display.
PARKTRONIC
Important safety notes
PARKTRONIC is an electronic parking aid with
ultrasonic sensors. It indicates visually and
audibly the distance between your vehicle
and an object.
PARKTRONIC is only an aid. It is not a substitute for your attention to the immediate surroundings. The responsibility for safe
manoeuvring and parking remains with you.
Make sure that there are no persons, animals
or objects in range while manoeuvring and
parking.
! When parking, pay particular attention to
objects above or below the sensors, such
as flower pots or trailer drawbars. PARKTRONIC does not detect such objects when
they are in the immediate vicinity of the
vehicle. You could damage the vehicle or
the objects.
The sensors may not detect snow and
objects which absorb ultrasonic sources.
Ultrasonic sources, such as an automatic
car wash, a lorry's compressed-air brakes
or a pneumatic drill, could cause PARKTRONIC to malfunction.
PARKTRONIC may not function correctly on
uneven terrain.
PARKTRONIC is activated automatically if
you:
Rswitch
on the ignition
the transmission to position D, R or N
Rrelease the electric parking brake
PARKTRONIC is deactivated at speeds above
18 km/h. It is reactivated at lower speeds.
PARKTRONIC monitors the area around your
vehicle using six sensors in the front bumper
and four sensors in the rear bumper.
Rshift
Example: displays in the COMAND display
: Selection of raised level (Y page 202)
; Activity of ABC suspension struts for roll
and pitching support
= Selected suspension setting, i.e. sporty or
comfortable (Y page 203)
? G-FORCE (longitudinal and lateral accel-
eration)
A Current vehicle level
Range of the sensors
General notes
PARKTRONIC does not take into account
obstacles located:
The sensors must be free of dirt, ice and
slush. Otherwise, they may not function correctly. Clean the sensors regularly, taking
care not to scratch or damage them
(Y page 571).
Rbelow
Front sensors
the detection range, e.g. persons,
animals or objects
Rabove the detection range, e.g. overhanging loads, tail sections or loading ramps of
goods vehicles
Centre
Approx. 100 cm
Corners
Approx. 60 cm
Rear sensors
Centre
Approx. 120 cm
Corners
Approx. 80 cm
Minimum distance
: Example: sensors in the front bumper,
left-hand side
Centre
Approx. 20 cm
Corners
Approx. 15 cm
If there is an obstacle within this range, the
relevant warning displays light up and a warning tone sounds. If the distance falls below
the minimum, the distance may no longer be
shown.
Warning displays
Side view
Warning display for the front area
: Segments on the left-hand side of the
vehicle
; Segments on the right-hand side of the
vehicle
= Segments showing operational readiness
Top view
The warning displays show the distance
between the sensors and the obstacle. The
Z
205
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving and parking
206
Driving systems
warning display for the front area is located
on the dashboard above the centre air vents.
The warning display for the rear area is located on the cover behind the seats in the rear
compartment.
The warning display for each side of the vehicle is divided into five yellow and two red segments. PARKTRONIC is operational if yellow
segments showing operational readiness =
light up.
The selected transmission position and the
direction in which the vehicle is rolling determine which warning display is active when the
engine is running.
Transmission
position
Warning display
D
Front area activated
R, N or the vehicle
is rolling backwards
Rear and front areas
activated
P
No areas activated
One or more segments light up as the vehicle
approaches an obstacle, depending on the
vehicle's distance from the obstacle.
RFront area: following the sixth segment,
you will hear an intermittent warning tone.
From the seventh segment, you will hear a
continuous warning tone for approximately
two seconds. This indicates that you have
now reached the minimum distance.
RRear area: from the first segment onwards,
you will hear an intermittent warning tone.
The interval gets shorter after each segment. At the seventh segment, you will hear
a continuous warning tone for approximately two seconds. This indicates that
you have now reached the minimum distance.
Deactivating/activating PARKTRONIC
: Indicator lamp
; To deactivate/activate PARKTRONIC
If indicator lamp : lights up, PARKTRONIC is
deactivated. Active Park Assist is then also
deactivated.
i PARKTRONIC is automatically activated
when you turn the key to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
Driving systems
207
Problems with PARKTRONIC
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Only the red segments PARKTRONIC has malfunctioned and has switched off.
in the PARKTRONIC
X If problems persist, have PARKTRONIC checked at a qualified
warning displays are lit.
specialist workshop.
You also hear a warning
tone for approximately
two seconds.
PARKTRONIC is deactivated after approximately five seconds,
and the indicator lamp
in the PARKTRONIC
button lights up.
Only the red segments The PARKTRONIC sensors are dirty or there is interference.
in the PARKTRONIC
X Clean the PARKTRONIC sensors (Y page 571).
warning displays are lit. X
Switch the ignition back on.
PARKTRONIC is deactivated after approxThe problem may be caused by an external source of radio or
imately five seconds.
ultrasound waves.
X See if PARKTRONIC functions in a different location.
Active Parking Assist
General notes
Active Parking Assist is an electronic parking
aid with ultrasound. Ultrasound is used to
measure the road on both sides of the vehicle.
A suitable parking space is indicated by the
parking symbol. Active steering intervention
can assist you during parking.
You may also use PARKTRONIC (Y page 204).
When PARKTRONIC is switched off, Active
Parking Assist is also unavailable.
Use Active Parking Assist for parking spaces:
Rthat
are parallel to the direction of travel
are on straight roads, not bends
Rthat are on the same level as the road, e.g.
not on the pavement
Rthat
Important safety notes
Active Parking Assist is only an aid. It is not a
substitute for your attention to the immediate
surroundings. The responsibility for safe
manoeuvring and parking remains with you.
Make sure that there are no persons, animals
or objects in range while manoeuvring and
parking.
G WARNING
The vehicle will veer out when parking and can
take you onto sections of the oncoming lane.
As a result, you may collide with other road
users. There is a risk of an accident.
When parking, pay attention to other road
users. Stop the vehicle if necessary or cancel
the Active Parking Assist parking procedure.
! If unavoidable, you should drive over
obstacles such as kerbs slowly and not at a
Z
Driving and parking
Problem
208
Driving systems
sharp angle. Otherwise, you may damage
the wheels or tyres.
Driving and parking
Active Parking Assist may also display spaces
not suitable for parking, e.g.:
Rparking
or stopping prohibitions
Rin front of driveways or entrances and exits
Runsuitable surfaces
Parking tips:
Ron
narrow roads, drive as closely as possible past the parking space.
Rparking spaces that are littered or overgrown might be identified or measured
incorrectly.
Rparking spaces that are partially occupied
by trailer drawbars might not be identified
as such or be measured incorrectly.
Rsnowfall or heavy rain may lead to a parking
space being measured inaccurately.
Rpay attention to the PARKTRONIC
(Y page 205) warning messages during the
parking procedure.
Rat any time, you can intervene in the steering procedure to correct it. Active Parking
Assist will then be cancelled.
Rwhen transporting a load which protrudes
from your vehicle, you should not use
Active Parking Assist.
Rnever use Active Parking Assist when snow
chains are fitted.
Rmake sure that the tyre pressures are
always correct. This has a direct influence
on the parking characteristics of the vehicle.
Parking
Important safety notes
Objects located above the height range of
Active Parking Assist will not be detected
when the parking space is measured. These
are not taken into account when the parking
procedure is calculated, e.g. overhanging
loads, tail sections or loading ramps of goods
vehicles. In some circumstances, Active Park-
ing Assist may therefore guide you into the
parking space too early.
G WARNING
If objects are located above the detection
range, Active Parking Assist may start to steer
into the parking space too soon. As a result,
you could cause a collision. There is a risk of
an accident.
If objects are located above the detection
range, stop the vehicle and switch Active
Parking Assist off.
G WARNING
Active Parking Assist merely aids you by intervening actively in the steering. There is a risk
of accident if you do not apply the brakes
yourself.
Always apply the brakes yourself when parking and manoeuvring.
Detecting parking spaces
Example: detected parking space
Active Parking Assist is activated automatically when driving forwards. The system is
operational at speeds of up to approximately
35 km/h. While in operation, the system independently locates and measures parking
spaces on both sides of the vehicle. When
driving at speeds below 30 km/h, you will see
parking symbol ; as a status indicator in the
instrument cluster. When a parking space has
been detected, an arrow towards the right =
or the left : also appears.
Active Parking Assist only displays parking
spaces on the front-passenger side as standard. Parking spaces on the driver's side are
displayed as soon as the turn signal on the
driver's side is activated. If you wish to park in
a space on the driver's side, the turn signal on
Driving systems
Rthat
are parallel to the direction of travel
Rthat are at least 1.5 m wide
Rthat are at least 1.0 m longer than your
vehicle
A parking space is displayed while you are
driving past it, and until you are approximately 15 m away from it.
Reversing into the parking space
X Stop the vehicle when the parking symbol
shows the desired parking space in the
instrument cluster.
X Shift the transmission to position R.
The Start Park Assist? Yes: OK No:
% message appears in the multifunction
display.
X To cancel the procedure: press the %
button on the multifunction steering wheel
or pull away.
or
X To park using Active Parking Assist:
press the a button on the multifunction
steering wheel.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
X Release the multifunction steering wheel.
X Reverse the vehicle, being ready to brake at
all times. Do not exceed a maximum speed
of approximately 10 km/h when reversing.
Otherwise, Active Parking Assist will be
cancelled.
i When parking in tight spaces, you will
achieve the best results by backing up as
far as possible. When doing so, also
observe the PARKTRONIC messages.
X
Stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
Additional manoeuvring may be required in
tight parking spaces.
The Park Assist active Select D
Observe surroundings message appears in
the multifunction display.
X Shift the transmission to position D while
the vehicle is stationary.
Active Parking Assist immediately steers in
the other direction.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
i You will achieve the best results by waiting for the steering procedure to complete
before pulling away.
Drive forwards and be ready to brake at all
times.
X Stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
X
The Park Assist active Select R
Observe surroundings message appears in
the multifunction display.
X Drive forwards and reverse according to
the information shown in the multifunction
display.
As soon as the parking procedure is complete, the Park Assist switched off message appears in the multifunction display.
PARKTRONIC continues to be available.
X Manoeuvre if necessary.
X Always observe the warning messages displayed by PARKTRONIC (Y page 205).
Parking tips:
ROn
narrow roads, drive as closely as possible past the parking space.
RParking spaces that are littered, overgrown
or partially occupied by trailer drawbars
might be identified incorrectly or not at all.
Z
Driving and parking
the driver's side must remain on. The turn
signal must remain switched on until you
acknowledge the use of Active Parking Assist
by pressing the a button on the multifunction steering wheel.
Active Parking Assist will only detect parking
spaces:
209
210
Driving systems
Driving and parking
RSnowfall or heavy rain may lead to a parking
space being measured inaccurately.
RThe way your vehicle is positioned in the
parking space after parking is dependent
on various factors. These include the position and shape of the vehicles parked in
front and behind it and the conditions of the
location. In some cases, Active Parking
Assist may guide you too far into a parking
space, or not far enough into it. In some
cases, it may also lead you across or onto
the kerb. If necessary, you should cancel
the parking procedure with Active Parking
Assist.
RYou can also engage forward gear prematurely. The vehicle redirects and does not
drive as far into the parking space. Should a
gear be changed too early, the parking procedure will be cancelled. A sensible parking
position can no longer be achieved from
this position.
Exiting a parking space
Active Parking Assist can only assist you with
exiting a parking space if you have parked the
vehicle using Active Parking Assist.
X Start the engine.
X Switch on the turn signal on the side facing
the street.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R.
The Start Park Assist? Yes: OK No:
% message appears in the multifunction
display.
X To cancel the procedure: press the %
button on the multifunction steering wheel
or pull away.
or
X To exit a parking space using Active
Parking Assist: press the a button on
the multifunction steering wheel.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
Release the multifunction steering wheel.
Reverse the vehicle or drive forwards, being
ready to brake at all times. Do not exceed a
maximum speed of approximately 10 km/h
when exiting a parking space. Otherwise,
Active Parking Assist will be cancelled.
X Stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R as
required while the vehicle is stationary.
Active Parking Assist immediately steers in
the other direction.
i You will achieve the best results by waiting for the steering procedure to complete
before pulling away.
If you reverse after activation, the steering
wheel is moved to the straight-ahead position.
X
X
Drive forwards or reverse the vehicle, being
ready to brake at all times.
X Stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
X Drive forwards and reverse as prompted by
the PARKTRONIC warning displays, several
times if necessary.
X
Once you have exited the parking space completely, the steering wheel is moved to the
straight-ahead position. You hear a tone and
the Park Assist switched off message
appears in the multifunction display. You will
then have to steer and merge into traffic on
your own. PARKTRONIC is still available.
Cancelling Active Parking Assist
You can cancel Active Parking Assist at any
time.
Driving systems
Stop the movement of the multifunction
steering wheel or steer yourself.
Active Parking Assist will be cancelled at
once. The Park Assist cancelled message appears in the multifunction display.
or
X
Press the PARKTRONIC button on the
centre console (Y page 206).
PARKTRONIC is switched off and Active
Parking Assist is immediately cancelled.
The Park Assist cancelled message
appears in the multifunction display.
Active Parking Assist is cancelled automatically if:
Rparking
using Active Parking Assist is no
longer possible
Ryou are driving faster than 10 km/h
Ra wheel spins and ESP® intervenes or fails.
The ÷ ESP® warning lamp lights up in
the instrument cluster.
A warning tone sounds. The parking symbol
goes out and the Park Assist cancelled
message appears in the multifunction display.
When Active Parking Assist is cancelled, you
must steer again yourself.
Reversing camera
General notes
behind your vehicle with guide lines in the
COMAND display.
The area behind the vehicle is displayed as a
mirror image, as in the rear-view mirror.
i The text of messages shown in the
COMAND display depends on the language
setting. The following are examples of
reversing camera messages in the
COMAND display.
Important safety notes
The reversing camera is only an aid. It is not a
substitute for your attention to the immediate
surroundings. The responsibility for safe
manoeuvring and parking remains with you.
Make sure that there are no persons, animals
or objects in range while manoeuvring and
parking.
Under the following circumstances, the
reversing camera will not function, or will
function in a limited manner:
Rif
the tailgate is open
heavy rain, snow or fog
Rat night or in very dark places
Rif the camera is exposed to very bright light
Rif the area is lit by fluorescent light or LED
lighting (the display may flicker)
Rif there is a sudden change in temperature,
e.g. when driving into a heated garage in
winter
Rif the camera lens is dirty or obstructed
Rif the rear of your vehicle is damaged. In this
case, have the camera position and setting
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
The field of vision and other functions of the
reversing camera may be restricted due to
additional accessories on the rear of the vehicle (e.g. licence plate holder, bicycle rack).
Rin
Reversing camera : is in the boot lid handle.
Reversing camera : is an optical parking
and manoeuvring aid. It shows the area
Z
Driving and parking
X
211
Driving systems
212
Activating/deactivating the reversing
camera
To activate: make sure that the key is in
position 2 in the ignition lock.
X Make sure that the function "show reversing camera display" is selected in COMAND
Online (Y page 322).
X Engage reverse gear.
The area behind the vehicle is shown with
guide lines in the COMAND display.
Driving and parking
X
To deactivate: the reversing camera deactivates if you shift the transmission to P or after
driving forwards a short distance.
Displays in the COMAND display
The reversing camera may show a distorted
view of obstacles or show them incorrectly or
not at all. Obstacles are not shown by the
reversing camera in the following locations:
Rvery
close to the rear bumper
the rear bumper
Rin the area immediately above the tailgate
handle
: White guide line without turning the steer-
ing wheel, vehicle width including the
exterior mirrors (static)
; Yellow guide line at a distance of approximately 4.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
= Red guide line for the vehicle width including the exterior mirrors, for current steering wheel angle (dynamic)
? Yellow lane marking the course the tyres
will take at the current steering wheel
angle (dynamic)
Runder
! Objects not at ground level may appear to
be further away than they actually are, e.g.:
Rthe
bumper of a parked vehicle
drawbar of a trailer
Rthe ball coupling of a trailer tow hitch
Rthe rear section of an HGV
Ra slanted post
Use the guidelines only for orientation.
Approach objects no further than the bottom-most guideline.
Rthe
A Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 1.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
B Vehicle centre axis (marker assistance)
C Bumper
D Red guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 0.25 m from the rear of the vehicle
The guide lines are shown when the transmission is in position R.
The distance specifications only apply to
objects that are at ground level.
Driving systems
213
= Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 1.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
? Red guide line at a distance of approx-
Make sure that the reversing camera is
switched on (Y page 212).
The lane and the guide lines are shown.
X With the help of white guide line :, check
whether the vehicle will fit into the parking
space.
X Using white guide line : as a guide, carefully reverse until you reach the end position.
Red guide line ? is then at the end of the
parking space. The vehicle is almost parallel in the parking space.
X
Additional display for vehicles with PARKTRONIC
: Front warning display
; Additional PARKTRONIC measurement
operational readiness indicator
= Rear warning display
Vehicles with PARKTRONIC: when PARKTRONIC is operational (Y page 205), additional measurement operational readiness
indicator ; appears in the COMAND display.
If the PARKTRONIC warning displays are
active or light up, warning displays : and =
are also active or light up correspondingly in
the COMAND display.
Reverse perpendicular parking with the
steering wheel at an angle
"Reverse parking" function
Reversing straight into a parking space
without turning the steering wheel
Turning the steering wheel
: Red guide line for the vehicle width includ-
ing the exterior mirrors, for current steering wheel angle (dynamic)
; Parking space marking
Make sure that the reversing camera is
switched on (Y page 212).
The lane and the guide lines are shown.
X Drive past the parking space and bring the
vehicle to a standstill.
X While the vehicle is at a standstill, turn the
steering wheel in the direction of the parkX
: White guide line without turning the steer-
ing wheel, vehicle width including the
exterior mirrors (static)
; Red guide line for the vehicle width including the exterior mirrors, for current steering wheel angle (dynamic)
Z
Driving and parking
imately 0.25 m from the rear of the vehicle
Driving systems
214
Driving and parking
ing space until red guide line : reaches
parking space marking ;.
X Keep the steering wheel in that position
and reverse carefully.
: End of parking space
; White guide line without turning the steer-
ing wheel
= Red guide line at a distance of approxReversing with the steering wheel turned
: Red guide line for the vehicle width includ-
ing the exterior mirrors, for current steering wheel angle (dynamic)
X
Stop the vehicle when it is almost exactly in
front of the parking space.
The white lane should be as close to parallel
with the parking space marking as possible.
imately 0.25 m from the rear of the vehicle
X
Reverse carefully until you have reached
the end position.
Red guide line = is then at end of parking
space :. The vehicle is almost parallel in
the parking space.
ATTENTION ASSIST
Important safety notes
Driving to the final position
: White guide line at current steering wheel
angle
; Parking space marking
X
Turn the steering wheel to the centre position while the vehicle is stationary.
ATTENTION ASSIST helps you during long,
monotonous journeys such as on motorways
and trunk roads. It is active in the 80 km/h to
180 km/h range.
If ATTENTION ASSIST detects typical indicators of fatigue or increasing lapses in concentration on the part of the driver, it suggests taking a break.
ATTENTION ASSIST assesses your level of
fatigue or lapses in concentration by taking
the following criteria into account:
Ryour
personal driving style, e.g. steering
characteristics
Rjourney-related parameters, e.g. time of
day, length of journey
The functionality of ATTENTION ASSIST is
restricted, and warnings may be delayed or
not occur at all:
ATTENTION ASSIST is reset and starts
assessing your tiredness again when you continue your journey if:
Rif
Ryou
the road condition is poor, e.g. if the surface is uneven or if there are potholes
Rif there is a strong side wind
Rif you have adopted a sporty driving style
with high cornering speeds or high rates of
acceleration
Rif you are predominantly driving slower
than 80 km/h or faster than 180 km/h
Rif you are currently using COMAND Online
or making a telephone call with it
Rif the time has been set incorrectly
Rin active driving situations, such as when
you change lanes or change your speed
ATTENTION ASSIST is only an aid. It may not
always detect fatigue or lapses in concentration until too late, or may not detect them at
all. The system is not a substitute for a wellrested and attentive driver.
switch off the engine
take off your seat belt and open the
driver's door, e.g. for a change of drivers or
to take a break
When ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated, the
é symbol appears in the multifunction
display in the assistance graphic display.
Ryou
Speed Limit Assist
General notes
Warning and display messages in the
multifunction display
Activate ATTENTION ASSIST using the onboard computer (Y page 238).
If ATTENTION ASSIST is active, you will be
warned no sooner than 20 minutes after
your journey has begun. You then hear an
intermittent warning tone twice and the
Attention Assist: Take a break!
message appears in the multifunction display.
X If necessary, take a break.
X Press the a or % button to confirm
the message.
X
On long journeys, take regular breaks in good
time to allow yourself to rest properly. If you
do not take a break and ATTENTION ASSIST
still detects increasing lapses in concentration, you will be warned again after
15 minutes at the earliest.
Speed Limit Assist detects the traffic signs
with camera : attached at the top of the
windscreen.
i Speed Limit Assist is not operational in all
countries.
Speed Limit Assist shows you detected speed
limits in the multifunction display. Data from
the navigation system is also used for this
purpose. The display appears if Speed Limit
Assist detects a traffic sign indicating a speed
limit or the end of a speed limit. If Speed Limit
Assist does not detect any traffic signs, the
speed limit from the digital road map is taken
and shown in the display.
Important safety notes
Speed Limit Assist is only an aid and does not
always detect traffic signs specifying the
maximum permissible speed. Traffic signs
Z
215
Driving and parking
Driving systems
216
Driving systems
Driving and parking
always have priority over the Speed Limit
Assist display.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
is poor visibility, e.g. due to snow,
rain, fog or spray
Rthere is glare, e.g. from the sun or from
oncoming traffic
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up or covered, for instance by a sticker, in the vicinity
of the camera
Rthe traffic signs are covered, for instance by
dirt, snow or trees
Rthe traffic signs are poorly illuminated
Rthere are ambiguous traffic signs, for
instance near roadworks or on multi-lane
roads
Permanently showing detected traffic
signs
Rthere
Information in the multifunction display
Briefly showing detected traffic signs
X Activate the Speed Limit Assist warning
function using the on-board computer
(Y page 237).
When you activate the Speed Limit Assist
warning function, a traffic sign indicating the
speed limit or end of speed limit zone may
appear in the multifunction display. The traffic
sign appears for approximately five seconds
as soon as it is detected. Any other information in the multifunction display is hidden for
this period.
: Maximum permissible speed (example)
; Maximum permissible speed for vehicles
subject to the restriction in the additional
sign (example)
= Additional character in fog
? Speed Limit Assist is available and
switched on
Display the assistance graphic using the
on-board computer (Y page 237).
A traffic sign indicating a speed limit or the
end of a speed limit appears in the multifunction display as soon as it is detected.
Traffic sign indicating a speed limit : is generally displayed until:
X
Ra traffic sign indicating the end of the speed
limit is detected
Ryou make a turn
Ryou leave or enter a town
Rthe road type changes (e.g. motorway,
country road)
Ryou have travelled a certain minimum distance without the traffic sign being repeated or detected again
i You can also activate Speed Limit Assist
using COMAND Online; see the separate
COMAND Online operating instructions.
The maximum permissible speed is shown
in the COMAND display.
Night View Assist Plus
General notes
good time. Drive carefully and always adapt
your driving style to suit the prevailing road
and traffic conditions.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
In addition to the illumination provided by the
normal headlamps, Night View Assist Plus
uses infrared light to illuminate the road.
Camera ; of Night View Assist Plus picks up
the infrared light and displays a black and
white image in COMAND. The image shown in
COMAND corresponds to a road lit up by
main-beam headlamps. This enables you to
see the road's course and any obstacles in
good time. When pedestrian recognition is
active, pedestrians recognised by the system
are visually highlighted in colour in the Night
View Assist Plus display with small frame corners.
i Infrared light is not visible to the human
eye and therefore does not dazzle. Night
View Assist Plus can therefore remain
switched on even if there is oncoming traffic.
In addition, thermal imaging camera : is
integrated in the radiator grille. The camera
helps detect pedestrians and animals.
Observe the notes on cleaning the thermal
imaging camera and cleaning the windscreen
(Y page 572).
Important safety notes
Night View Assist Plus is only an aid and is not
a substitute for attentive driving. Do not rely
on the Night View Assist Plus display. You are
responsible for the distance to the vehicle in
front, for vehicle speed and for braking in
is poor visibility, e.g. due to snow,
rain, fog or spray
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up or covered, for instance by a sticker, in the vicinity
of the camera
Rthe thermal imaging camera in the radiator
grille is dirty, misted up or covered
Ron bends, on hilltops or in dips
Rat high outside temperatures
Night View Assist Plus cannot display objects
directly in front of or beside the vehicle. The
actual distance to objects and pedestrians
cannot be gauged accurately by looking at a
screen.
It may be the case that other objects are
marked or highlighted as well as pedestrians
and animals.
Pedestrian and animal recognition
General notes
Pedestrian or animal recognition may be
impaired or inoperative if:
Rpedestrians
or animals are partially or
entirely obscured by other objects, e.g.
parked vehicles
Rthe silhouette of the pedestrian or of the
animal in the Night View Assist Plus display
is incomplete or interrupted, e.g. by powerful light reflections
Rpedestrians or animals do not contrast with
the surroundings
Rthe camera system no longer recognises
pedestrians as persons due to special
clothing or other objects
Rpedestrians are not in an upright position,
e.g. sitting, squatting or lying
Ranimals are not recognised by the system,
e.g. because of their size or shape
Z
217
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving and parking
218
Driving systems
Pedestrian and animal recognition is deactivated at temperatures above 32 †. The spotlight function and automatic activation are
then no longer active.
Night View Assist Plus can recognise larger
animals such as deer, cows or horses using
typical characteristics.
The system does not detect:
Pedestrian recognition
Rsmaller
animals, e.g. dogs and cats
Ranimals whose silhouette is not clearly rec-
ognisable
When detected, animals are marked with
small coloured frame corners. In contrast to
pedestrian recognition, there is no separate
standby symbol in the multifunction display.
Activating/deactivating Night View
Assist Plus
: Night View Assist Plus display in the
COMAND display
; Standby symbol for active pedestrian rec-
ognition
= Highlighting
? Pedestrian recognised
Night View Assist Plus can recognise pedestrians using typical characteristics, e.g. the
body contours and posture of a person standing upright.
Pedestrian recognition is then switched on
automatically if:
View Assist Plus is activated
are driving faster than approximately
10 km/h
Rit is dark
If pedestrian recognition is active, symbol ;
appears. Persons who are detected are highlighted by framing =. If the pedestrian recognition system has brought a pedestrian to
your attention, look through the windscreen
to evaluate the situation.
Activation conditions
You can only activate Night View Assist if all of
the following conditions have been fulfilled:
Rthe
ignition is switched on (Y page 155) or
the engine has been started
Rthe light switch is in the à or L position
Rreverse gear has not been engaged
Activating Night View Assist Plus
RNight
Ryou
Animal recognition
Animals can be recognised in the following
situations:
Rdarkness
Routside built-up areas
Rbelow an outside temperature of 32 †
X
Press button :.
The Night View Assist Plus display appears
in the COMAND display.
i The infrared headlamps only switch on in
the dark when the vehicle is being driven at
speeds of at least 10 km/h. This means
that you do not have the full visual range
while stationary and cannot check whether
Night View Assist Plus is working. The infra-
Driving systems
Automatic activation
You can use COMAND Online to select the
Night View Assist Automatic activa‐
tion option. The pedestrian and animal
search function remains active even when the
Night View image is not displayed. In the dark,
in unlit surroundings and at speeds of more
than 60 km/h, the Night View image is automatically displayed in the COMAND display as
soon as pedestrians or animals are detected.
X In COMAND Online, select automatic activation of Night View Assist Plus
(Y page 322).
Deactivating Night View Assist Plus
Rthe
driving speed is at least 60 km/h
"Adaptive Highbeam Assist"
(Y page 133) or "Adaptive Highbeam Assist
PLUS" function is activated
Rreverse gear has not been engaged
The spotlight function is not active or is active
only to a limited extent if:
Rthe
Ryou
are driving in city traffic
Rthere are pedestrians located in the area of
an oncoming vehicle or a vehicle in front
Activating the spotlight function
The pedestrian detection with spotlight function runs in the background. If the prerequisites are met, the spotlight function uses the
headlamps to flash four short pulses at a
pedestrian detected on or near to the road
surface.
X In the light menu, select the spotlight function of Night View Assist Plus
(Y page 240).
The spotlight function does not flash at animals.
Display in the assistance graphic
X
Press button :.
The Night View Assist Plus display goes off
in the COMAND display. Night View Assist
Plus is deactivated.
Spotlight function
General notes
i The function described below is not available in all countries.
Under certain conditions, the spotlight function uses the headlamps to flash at detected
pedestrians.
The spotlight function is only active if:
Rpedestrian
recognition is active
Rthe road surface is not lit
Pedestrian symbol : in the assistance
graphic indicates the status of the spotlight
function. If the symbol is displayed not filled
in, the function is switched on. If the symbol is
displayed filled in, the conditions for the spotlight function are met.
Showing the assistance graphic
X
In the Assist. menu, select Assistance
graphic (Y page 237).
Z
Driving and parking
red headlamps are deactivated at speeds
below 5 km/h. The Night View image continues to be displayed.
219
220
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Problems with Night View Assist Plus
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The picture quality of
Night View Assist Plus
has deteriorated.
The windscreen is misted up on the inside.
Fold down camera cover (Y page 572).
X Demist the windscreen (Y page 147).
X
The windscreen is iced up.
X De-ice the windscreen (Y page 146).
The windscreen wipers are smearing the windscreen.
Replace the wiper blades (Y page 136).
X
The windscreen is smeared after the vehicle has been cleaned in a
car wash.
X Clean the windscreen (Y page 570).
The windscreen has been damaged by stone impact in the camera's field of vision.
X Replace the windscreen.
The pedestrian and ani- The infrared camera in the radiator grille is dirty.
mal recognition is not X Use a soft cloth and water to clean the infrared camera.
available.
Active Driving Assistance package
General notes
The Active Driving Assistance package consists of DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 185), Active
Blind Spot Assist (Y page 220) and Active
Lane Keeping Assist (Y page 223).
Active Blind Spot Assist
General notes
Active Blind Spot Assist uses a radar sensor
system to monitor the area to the sides of
your vehicle which are behind the driver. A
warning display in the exterior mirrors draws
your attention to vehicles detected in the
monitored area. If you then switch on the corresponding turn signal to change lanes, you
will also receive an optical and audible collision warning. If a risk of side impact is detec-
ted, corrective braking may help you avoid a
collision. To support the course-correcting
brake application, Active Blind Spot Assist
also uses the forward-facing radar sensor system.
Active Blind Spot Assist supports you from a
speed of approximately 30 km/h.
For Active Blind Spot Assist to assist you
when driving, the radar sensor system must
be operational.
Important safety notes
Active Blind Spot Assist is only an aid. It may
fail to detect some vehicles and is no substitute for attentive driving.
Driving systems
221
G WARNING
Active Blind Spot Assist does not react to
vehicles:
too closely on the side, placing
them in the blind spot area
Rif the difference in the speed of approach
and overtaking is too great
As a result, Active Blind Spot Assist may neither give warnings nor intervene in such situations. There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and maintain a safe distance at the side
of the vehicle.
Radar sensors
The Active Blind Spot Assist radar sensors are
integrated into the front and rear bumpers
and behind a cover in the radiator grille. Make
sure that the bumpers and the cover in the
radiator grille are free of dirt, ice or slush. The
rear sensors must not be covered, e.g. by
bicycle racks or overhanging loads. Following
a severe impact or in the event of damage to
the bumpers, have the function of the radar
sensors checked at a qualified specialist
workshop. Active Blind Spot Assist may otherwise no longer function properly.
Monitoring range
G WARNING
Active Blind Spot Assist does not detect all
traffic situations and road users. There is a
risk of an accident.
Always make sure that there is sufficient distance to the side for other traffic or obstacles.
Driving and parking
Rovertaking
Active Blind Spot Assist monitors the area up
to 3.0 m behind your vehicle and directly next
to your vehicle, as shown in the diagram.
The detection of vehicles may be impaired in
the case of:
Rdirt
on the sensors or obscured sensors
visibility, e.g. due to rain, snow or
spray
Vehicles in the monitoring range will then be
indicated late or not at all.
Active Blind Spot Assist may not detect narrow vehicles, such as motorcycles or bicycles, or may only detect them too late.
If the lanes are narrow, vehicles driving in the
lane beyond the lane next to your vehicle may
be indicated, especially if the vehicles are not
driving in the middle of their lane. This may be
the case if there are vehicles at the edge of
their lane nearest your vehicle.
Due to the nature of the system:
Rpoor
Rwarnings may be issued in error when driv-
ing close to crash barriers or similar solid
lane borders.
Rwarnings may be interrupted when driving
alongside particularly long vehicles, for
example lorries, for a prolonged time.
Z
Driving and parking
222
Driving systems
Indicator and warning display
Visual and acoustic collision warning
: Yellow indicator lamp/red warning lamp
When you switch on the turn signals to
change lanes and a vehicle is detected in the
side monitoring range, you receive a visual
and acoustic collision warning. You then hear
a double warning tone and red warning
lamp : flashes. If the turn signal remains on,
detected vehicles are indicated by the flashing of red warning lamp :. There are no further warning tones.
Active Blind Spot Assist is not active at
speeds below approximately 30 km/h. Vehicles in the monitoring range are then not indicated.
If Active Blind Spot Assist is activated, indicator lamp : in the exterior mirrors lights up
yellow up to a speed of 30 km/h. At speeds
above 30 km/h, the indicator lamp goes out
and Active Blind Spot Assist is operational.
If a vehicle is detected within the monitoring
range of Blind Spot Assist at speeds above
30 km/h, warning lamp : on the corresponding side lights up red. A warning is
always issued when a vehicle enters the blind
spot monitoring range from behind or from
the side. When you overtake a vehicle, the
warning only occurs if the difference in speed
is less than 12 km/h.
The yellow indicator lamp goes out if reverse
gear is engaged. Active Blind Spot Assist is
then no longer active.
The brightness of the indicator/warning
lamps is adjusted automatically according to
the ambient light.
Course-correcting brake application
G WARNING
A course-correcting brake application cannot
always prevent a collision. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always steer, brake or accelerate yourself,
especially if Active Blind Spot Assist warns
you or makes a course-correcting brake application. Always maintain a safe distance at the
sides.
Driving systems
RESP®
223
is deactivated.
Ra loss of tyre pressure or a defective tyre is
detected
Driving and parking
Activating Active Blind Spot Assist
Make sure that the radar sensor system
(Y page 242) and Active Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 238) are activated in the on-board
computer.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
Warning lamps : in the exterior mirrors
light up red for approximately 1.5 seconds
and then turn yellow.
X
If a course-correcting brake application
occurs, red warning lamp : flashes in the
exterior mirror and a dual warning tone
sounds. In addition, display ; appears in the
multifunction display.
If Active Blind Spot Assist detects a risk of a
side impact in the monitoring range, a coursecorrecting brake application is carried out.
This is designed to help you avoid a collision.
The course-correcting brake application is
available in the speed range between
30 km/h and 200 km/h.
Either a very slight course-correcting brake
application, or none at all, may occur if:
are vehicles or obstacles, e.g. crash
barriers, on both sides of your vehicle
Ra vehicle approaches too closely on the
side
Ryou have adopted a sporty driving style with
high cornering speeds
Ryou clearly brake or accelerate
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP® or PRE-SAFE® Brake
Active Lane Keeping Assist
General notes
Rthere
Active Lane Keeping Assist monitors the area
in front of your vehicle by means of camera :
at the top of the windscreen. Active Lane
Keeping Assist detects lane markings on the
road and warns you before you leave your
lane unintentionally. If you do not react to the
warning, a lane-correcting application of the
Z
Driving and parking
224
Driving systems
brakes can bring the vehicle back into the
original lane.
If you select km in the Display unit
Speed-/odometer function on the on-board
computer (Y page 239), Active Lane Keeping
Assist is activated starting at a speed of
60 km/h. If the miles display unit is selected,
the assistance range begins at 40 mph.
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style, Active
Lane Keeping Assist can neither reduce the
risk of an accident nor override the laws of
physics. Lane Keeping Assist cannot take into
account road, weather or traffic conditions.
Lane Keeping Assist is only an aid. You are
responsible for the distance to the vehicle in
front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good
time, and for staying in lane.
Active Lane Keeping Assist cannot continuously keep your vehicle in its lane.
G WARNING
Active Lane Keeping Assist cannot always
clearly detect lane markings.
In such cases, Active Lane Keeping Assist
can:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning and then
make a course-correcting brake application
to the vehicle
Rneither give a warning nor intervene
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay particular attention to the traffic
situation and keep within the lane, especially
if Active Lane Keeping Assist alerts you. Terminate the intervention in a non-critical driving situation.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to insufficient illumination of the road, or due to
snow, rain, fog or spray
Rthere is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic,
the sun or reflection from other vehicles
(e.g. if the road surface is wet)
Rthe
windscreen is dirty, misted up, damaged or covered, for instance by a sticker,
in the vicinity of the camera
Rno, or several, unclear lane markings are
present for one lane, e.g. in a construction
area
Rthe lane markings are worn away, dark or
covered up, e.g. by dirt or snow
Rthe distance to the vehicle in front is too
small and the lane markings thus cannot be
detected
Rthe lane markings change quickly, e.g.
lanes branch off, cross one another or
merge
Rthe road is narrow and winding
Rthere are highly variable shade conditions
on the road
Warning vibration through the steering
wheel
A warning may be given if a front wheel
passes over a lane marking. It will warn you by
means of intermittent vibration in the steering wheel for up to 1.5 seconds.
In order that you are warned only when necessary and in good time if you cross the lane
marking, the system recognises certain conditions and warns you accordingly.
The warning vibration occurs earlier if:
Ryou
approach the outer lane marking on a
bend
Rthe road has very wide lanes, e.g. a motorway
Rthe system recognises solid lane markings
The warning vibration occurs later if:
Rthe
Ryou
road has narrow lanes
cut the corner on a bend
Lane-correcting brake application
G WARNING
A lane-correcting brake application cannot
always bring the vehicle back into the original
lane. There is a risk of an accident.
Always steer, brake or accelerate yourself,
especially if Active Lane Keeping Assist warns
you or makes a lane-correcting brake application.
G WARNING
Active Lane Keeping Assist does not detect
traffic conditions or road users. In very rare
cases, the system may make an inappropriate
brake application, e.g. after intentionally driving over a solid lane marking. There is a risk of
an accident.
An inappropriate brake application may be
interrupted at any time if you steer slightly in
the opposite direction. Always make sure that
there is sufficient distance to the side for
other traffic or obstacles.
In rare cases, Active Lane Keeping Assist can
recognise unclear markings or particular
structures on the roadway as solid lane markings. An inappropriate brake application may
be interrupted at any time if you steer slightly
in the opposite direction.
able lane marking. Before this, a warning
must have been issued by means of intermittent vibration through the steering wheel. In
addition, a lane with lane markings on both
sides must be recognised. The brake application also slightly reduces driving speed.
i A further lane-correcting brake applica-
tion can only occur after your vehicle has
returned to the original lane.
No lane-correcting brake application occurs
if:
Ryou
clearly and actively steer, brake or
accelerate
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend
Ryou have switched on the turn signals
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP®, PRE-SAFE® Brake or Active Blind
Spot Assist
Ryou have adopted a sporty driving style with
high cornering speeds or high rates of
acceleration
RESP® is deactivated
Rthe transmission is not in position D
Ra loss of tyre pressure or a defective tyre
has been detected and displayed
Active Lane Keeping Assist does not detect
road and traffic conditions. An inappropriate
brake application may be interrupted at any
time if:
Ryou
steer slightly in the opposite direction
switch on the turn signal
Ryou clearly brake or accelerate
A lane-correcting brake application is interrupted automatically if:
Ryou
If a lane-correcting brake application occurs,
display : appears in the multifunction display.
If you leave your lane under certain circumstances, the vehicle will brake briefly on one
side. This is intended to help you return the
vehicle to the original lane.
This function is available in the range between
60 km/h and 200 km/h.
A lane-correcting brake application can only
be made after driving over a solid, recognis-
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP®, PRE-SAFE® Brake or Active Blind
Spot Assist
Rlane markings are no longer be detected
Z
225
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving and parking
226
Driving systems
Activating Active Lane Keeping Assist
X Activate Active Lane Keeping Assist using
the on-board computer; to do so, select
Standard or Adaptive (Y page 238).
If you drive at speeds above 60 km/h and
lane markings are detected, the lines in the
assistance graphics display (Y page 237)
are shown in green. Lane Keeping Assist is
ready for use.
If Standard is selected, no warning vibration occurs if:
Ryou have switched on the turn signals. In
this case, the warnings are suppressed
for a certain period of time.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such
as ABS, BAS or ESP®.
When Adaptive is selected, no warning
vibration occurs if:
Ryou have switched on the turn signals In
this case, the warnings are suppressed
for a certain period of time
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such
as ABS, BAS or ESP®
Ryou accelerate hard, e.g. kickdown
Ryou brake hard
Ryou steer actively, e.g. swerve to avoid an
obstacle or change lane quickly
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend
Useful information ............................ 228
Important safety notes .................... 228
Displays and operation .................... 228
Menus and submenus ...................... 231
Display messages ............................. 247
Warning and indicator lamps .......... 274
On-board computer and displays
227
On-board computer and displays
228
Displays and operation
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 34).
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
G WARNING
If the instrument cluster has failed or malfunctioned, you may not recognise function
restrictions relevant to safety. The operating
safety of your vehicle may be impaired. There
is a risk of an accident.
Drive on carefully. Have the vehicle checked
at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
You must observe the legal requirements for
the country in which you are currently driving
when operating the on-board computer.
The on-board computer only shows messages
or warnings from certain systems in the multifunction display. You should therefore make
sure your vehicle is operating safely at all
times. Otherwise, a vehicle that is not operating safely may cause an accident.
For an overview, see the instrument panel
illustration (Y page 40).
Displays and operation
Instrument cluster lighting
The lighting in the instrument cluster, in the
displays and the controls in the vehicle interior can be adjusted using the brightness control knob.
The brightness control knob is on the bottom
left of the instrument cluster (Y page 40).
X Turn the brightness control knob anticlockwise or clockwise.
If the light switch is set to Ã, T or
L, the brightness is dependant upon
the brightness of the ambient light.
i The light sensor in the instrument cluster
automatically controls the brightness of
the multifunction display.
In daylight, the displays in the instrument
cluster are not lit.
Coolant temperature gauge
G WARNING
If you open the bonnet while the engine is
overheating or while there is a fire in the
engine compartment, you could come into
contact with hot gases or other leaking service products. There is a danger of injury.
Allow an overheating engine to cool down
before opening the bonnet. If there is a fire in
the engine compartment, leave the bonnet
closed and notify the fire brigade.
The coolant temperature gauge is in the
instrument cluster on the right-hand side
(Y page 40).
Under normal operating conditions and with
the specified coolant level, the coolant temperature may rise to 120 †.
Displays and operation
Operating the on-board computer
On-board computer and displays
At high outside temperatures and when driving uphill, the coolant temperature may rise
to the end of the scale.
Overview
Rev counter
! Do not drive in the overrevving range.
Doing so will damage the engine.
The red band in the rev counter indicates the
engine's overrevving range.
The fuel supply is interrupted to protect the
engine when the red band is reached.
Outside temperature display
You should pay special attention to road conditions when temperatures are around the
freezing point.
The outside temperature display is in the multifunction display (Y page 230).
Changes in the outside temperature are displayed after a short delay.
Speedometer with segments
The segments in the speedometer indicate
which speed range is available.
RCruise
control activated (Y page 182):
The segments light up from the stored
speed to the maximum speed.
RVariable SPEEDTRONIC activated
(Y page 193):
The segments light up from the start of the
scale to the selected limit speed.
RDISTRONIC PLUS activated (Y page 185):
One or two segments in the set speed
range light up.
RDISTRONIC PLUS detects a vehicle in front:
The segments between the speed of the
vehicle in front and the stored speed light
up.
: Multifunction display
; Switches on LINGUATRONIC; see the sep-
arate operating instructions
= Right control panel
? Left control panel
A Back button
X
229
To activate the on-board computer: turn
the key to position 1 in the ignition lock.
You can control the multifunction display and
the settings in the on-board computer using
the buttons on the multifunction steering
wheel.
Z
On-board computer and displays
230
Displays and operation
Left control panel
=
;
RCalls
9
:
Press briefly:
9
:
a
up the menu and menu bar
RScrolls
through lists
RSelects a submenu or function
RIn the Audio menu: selects a
stored station, an audio track or
a video scene
RIn the Tel (telephone) menu:
switches to the phone book and
selects a name or telephone
number
W
X
RAdjusts
8
RMute
Back button
%
the Audio menu: selects the
previous/next station or selects
an audio track or a video scene
using rapid scrolling
RIn the Tel (Telephone) menu:
starts rapid scrolling if the phone
book is open
Press briefly:
RBack
RSwitches
off LINGUATRONIC;
see the separate operating
instructions
RHides display messages/calls
up the last Trip menu function
used
RExits the telephone book/redial
memory
Press and hold:
RIn
the volume
%
Press and hold:
RCalls
up the standard display in
the Trip menu
Multifunction display
RConfirms selection/display mes-
sage
the Tel (Telephone) menu:
switches to the telephone book
and starts dialling the selected
number
RIn the Audio menu: stops the
station search function at the
desired station
RIn
Right control panel
~
RRejects
or ends a call
telephone book/redial
memory
RExits
6
RMakes
or accepts a call
to the redial memory
RSwitches
:
;
=
?
Transmission position (Y page 165)
Drive program (Y page 165)
Text field
Menu bar
A Time (Y page 312)
B Outside temperature or speed
(Y page 239)
Text field = shows the selected menu or
submenu as well as display messages.
X To show menu bar ?: press the =
or ; button on the steering wheel.
Menu bar ? disappears after a few seconds of inactivity.
RServ.
menu (service) (Y page 238)
menu (Y page 239)
RAMG menu in AMG vehicles (Y page 244)
RSettings
Trip menu
Standard display
The following messages may appear in the
multifunction display:
Z
Gearshift recommendation
(Y page 169)
XjY
Active Parking Assist
(Y page 207)
¯
Cruise control (Y page 182)
È
SPEEDTRONIC (Y page 193)
_
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
(Y page 133)
¤
ECO start/stop function
(Y page 158)
ë
HOLD function (Y page 196)
120 km/h! Maximum permissible speed
exceeded (only for certain countries)
Menus and submenus
Menu overview
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to call up the menu bar and select a
menu.
Operating the on-board computer
(Y page 229).
Depending on the equipment fitted in the
vehicle, you can call up the following menus:
RTrip
menu (Y page 231)
menu (navigation instructions)
(Y page 233)
RAudio menu (Y page 234)
RTel menu (telephone) (Y page 235)
RAssist. menu (assistance) (Y page 237)
RNavi
X
Press and hold the % button on the
steering wheel until the Trip menu with
trip meter : and total distance
recorder ; is shown.
Trip computer "From start" or "From
reset"
Example: "From start" trip computer
: Distance
; Time
= Average speed
? Average fuel consumption
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
From start or From reset.
reset
X
The values in the From start submenu are
calculated from the start of a journey whilst
the values in the From reset submenu are
calculated from the last time the submenu
was reset (Y page 232).
The From start trip computer is automatically reset when:
Z
231
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
232
Rthe ignition has been switched off for more
than four hours.
R999 hours have been exceeded.
R9,999 kilometres have been exceeded.
The From reset trip computer is automatically reset if the value exceeds 9,999 hours or
99,999 kilometres.
there is only a small amount of fuel left in the
fuel tank, the display shows a vehicle being
refuelled C instead of the range.
Digital speedometer
ECO display
: Gearshift recommendation (Y page 169)
; Digital speedometer
Example: ECO display
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
ECO DISPLAY.
DISPLAY
X
If the ignition remains switched off for longer
than four hours, the ECO display will be automatically reset.
Further information on the ECO display; see
(Y page 178).
Displaying the range and current fuel
consumption
Gearshift recommendation : is not given on
AMG vehicles.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
digital speedometer.
Resetting values
Example: resetting the trip computer "From start"
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
function that you wish to reset.
X Press the a button.
X Press the : button to select Yes and
press the a button to confirm.
X
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
current fuel consumption (not for AMG
vehicles) and the approximate range.
X
The approximate range that can be covered is
calculated according to your current driving
style and the amount of fuel in the tank. If
You can reset the values of the following functions:
Rtrip
meter
start" trip computer
R"From reset" trip computer
RECO display
R"From
i If you reset the values in the "ECO dis-
play", the values in the "From start" trip
computer are also reset. If you reset the
values in the "From start" trip computer,
the values in the "ECO display" are also
reset.
Change of direction announced without a
lane recommendation
Navigation menu
Displaying navigation instructions
: Road to which the change of direction
In the Navi menu, the multifunction display
shows navigation instructions. Further information on navigation (Y page 323).
X Switch on COMAND Online (Y page 298).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Navi menu.
; Distance to change of direction and visual
Route guidance not active
leads
distance display
= Change-of-direction symbol
When a change of direction is announced, you
will see symbol = for the change of direction
and distance graphic ;. This shortens
towards the top of the display as you
approach the point of the announced change
of direction.
Change of direction announced with a
lane recommendation
: Direction of travel
; Current road
Activating route guidance
No change of direction announced
: Road to which the change of direction
leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
distance display
= New lane during a change of direction
? Lane continues through change of direc-
tion
A Lane recommendation
B Change-of-direction symbol
:
;
=
?
Distance to the destination
Distance to the next change of direction
Current road
Symbol indicating "follow the road's
course"
On multilane roads, the system may display
lane recommendation = for the next change
of direction. During the change of direction,
additional lanes may be displayed.
Lane recommendations are only displayed if
the relevant data is available on the digital
map.
Z
233
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
234
Other status indicators of the navigation system
RO: you have reached the destination or an
intermediate destination.
RNew route... or Calculating route:
route
calculating a new route
ROff map or Off road:
road the vehicle position
is outside the area of the digital map (offmap position).
RNo route:
route no route could be calculated to
the selected destination.
Audio menu
Selecting a radio station
i DAB radio mode (Digital Audio Broadcasting) (Y page 462).
Audio player or audio media operation
Example: CD/DVD changer display
: Current track
Audio data from various audio devices or
media can be played, depending on the equipment fitted in the vehicle.
Switch on COMAND Online (Y page 298).
Select audio player or audio media
(Y page 472).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select the next/previous track:
briefly press the 9 or : button.
X To select a track from the track list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the 9
or : button until desired track ; has
been reached.
If you press and hold the 9 or :
button, the rapid scrolling speed is
increased. Not all audio devices or media
support this function.
X
X
: Waveband
; Channel frequency with memory position
i Station ; is displayed with the station
frequency or station name. The memory
position is only displayed along with station ; if this has been stored.
Switch on COMAND Online (Y page 298).
Select Radio (Y page 462).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select a stored station: briefly press
the 9 or : button.
X To select a station from the station list:
press and hold the 9 or : button.
If no station list is received:
X To select a station using the station
search: press and hold the 9 or :
button.
X
X
i Switching wavebands (Y page 464).
Storing stations (Y page 466).
If track information is stored on the audio
player or medium, the multifunction display
will show the number and title of the track.
The current track does not appear in audio
AUX mode (Auxiliary audio mode: external
audio source connected).
Video DVD operation
i Depending on the digital TV broadcaster,
radio stations can also be received. The
multifunction display shows TV (RADIO).
(RADIO)
Telephone menu
Introduction
Example: CD/DVD changer display
: Current scene
Switch on COMAND Online (Y page 298).
X Select video DVD (Y page 512).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select the next or previous scene:
briefly press the 9 or : button.
X To select a scene from the scene list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the 9
or : button until desired scene : has
been reached.
X
TV operation
: Channel frequency with memory position
i The memory position is only displayed
along with channel : if this has been
stored.
Switch on COMAND Online (Y page 298).
X Select TV (Y page 502).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select a stored channel: briefly press
the 9 or : button.
X To select a channel from the channel
list: press and briefly hold the 9
or : button.
X
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
When telephoning, you must observe the
legal requirements for the country in which
you are currently driving.
X Switch on the mobile phone, see the separate operating instructions.
X Switch on COMAND Online (Y page 298).
X Insert the mobile phone into the bracket
(Y page 551).
or
X Establish a Bluetooth® connection to
COMAND Online (Y page 389).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
You will see one of the following display messages in the multifunction display:
RPlease
enter PIN
PIN: the mobile phone has
been placed in the mobile phone bracket
and the PIN has not been entered.
When you enter your PIN via the mobile
phone, LINGUATRONIC, the audio system
i Storing a TV channel (Y page 505).
Z
235
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
236
or COMAND Online, the mobile phone
searches for a network.
RTelephone ready or the name of the network provider: the mobile phone has found
a network and is ready to receive.
RTelephone No service:
service there is no network available or the mobile phone is
searching for a network.
i You can obtain further information about
suitable mobile phones and connecting
mobile phones via Bluetooth®:
Rfrom
any Mercedes Benz Service Centre
the Internet at http://
www.mercedes-benz.com/connect
Ron
Accepting a call
Example: incoming call
X
Press the 6 button on the steering
wheel to accept an incoming call.
If someone calls you when you are in the Tel
menu, a display message appears in the multifunction display.
You can accept a call even if you are not in the
Tel menu.
Rejecting or ending a call
X
Press the ~ button on the steering
wheel.
You can end or reject a call even if you are not
in the Tel menu.
Dialling an entry from the phone book
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 9, : or a button to
switch to the phone book.
X
X
Press the 9 or : button to select the
desired name.
or
To begin rapid scrolling: press and hold
the 9 or : button for longer than
one second.
Rapid scrolling stops when you release the
button or reach the end of the list.
X If only one telephone number is stored
for a name: press the 6 or a button
to start dialling.
or
X If there is more than one number for a
particular name: press the 6 or a
button to display the numbers.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
number you want to dial.
X Press the 6 or a button to start dialling.
or
X To exit the telephone book: press the
~ or % button.
X
Redialling
The on-board computer saves the last names
or numbers dialled in the redial memory.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 6 button to switch to the
redial memory.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
desired name or number.
X Press the 6 or a button to start dialling.
or
X To exit the redial memory: press the
~ or % button.
X
Assistance menu
Introduction
The assistance graphic shows:
Rthe é symbol when ATTENTION ASSIST
(Y page 214) is deactivated.
lane markings as bright lines when
Active Lane Keeping Assist (Y page 223) is
activated.
Rthe Ä symbol when Speed Limit Assist
(Y page 215) is operational.
The assistance graphic can also display
traffic signs that are detected and indicate
speed limits.
Rthe æ symbol when PRE-SAFE® Brake
(Y page 77) is deactivated.
Rthe pedestrian symbol of the spotlight function when the spotlight function of Night
View Assist Plus (Y page 240) is activated.
Rthe
In the Assist. menu, you have the following
options:
RShowing the assistance graphic
(Y page 237)
RAMG vehicles only: setting the vehicle level
(Y page 202)
RActivating/deactivating the Speed Limit
Assist message function (Y page 237)
RActivating/deactivating PRE-SAFE® Brake
(Y page 238)
RActivating/deactivating ATTENTION
ASSIST (Y page 238)
RActivating/deactivating Active Blind Spot
Assist (Y page 238)
RActivating/deactivating Active Lane Keeping Assist (Y page 238)
Showing the assistance graphic
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Assistance
graphic.
graphic
X Press the a button.
The multifunction display shows the DISTRONIC PLUS distance display in the assistance graphic (Y page 191).
X
The assistance graphic can display the status
of and information from other driving systems
or driving safety systems.
Speed Limit Assist
Activating/deactivating the Speed Limit
Assist message function
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Speed Limit Assist.
Assist
X Press the a button.
The multifunction display shows Speed
Limit Assist.
X Press the : button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate or deactivate: press a.
When the Speed Limit Assist message
function is activated, the assistance
graphic shows the Ä symbol in the multifunction display.
If the Speed Limit Assist message function
is activated, a detected speed limit is automatically displayed for five seconds. Other
items in the multifunction display are not
shown during this time.
Z
237
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
238
Activating/deactivating PRE-SAFE®
Brake
PRE‑SAFE® Brake is only available in vehicles
with DISTRONIC PLUS.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
PRE-SAFE Brake.
Brake
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
When PRE-SAFE® Brake is deactivated, the
æ symbol appears in the assistance
graphic in the multifunction display.
X
For more information on PRE‑SAFE® Brake,
see (Y page 77).
Activating/deactivating ATTENTION
ASSIST
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
ATTENTION ASSIST.
ASSIST
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
When ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated,
the é symbol appears in the multifunction display in the assistance graphic display.
X
Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
X
For further information about Active Blind
Spot Assist, see (Y page 220).
Activating/deactivating Active Lane
Keeping Assist
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Lane Keep‐
ing Assist.
Assist
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to set Off
Off,
Standard or Adaptive
Adaptive.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
When Active Lane Keeping Assist is activated, the multifunction display shows the
lane markings as bright lines in the assistance graphic.
X
For further information about Active Lane
Keeping Assist; see (Y page 223).
Service menu
For further information about ATTENTION
ASSIST, see (Y page 214).
Activating/deactivating Active Blind
Spot Assist
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Blind Spot Assist.
Assist
X
In the Serv. menu, you have the following
options:
RCalling up display messages
(Y page 247)
RRestarting the tyre pressure loss warning
system (Y page 601)
RChecking
the tyre pressure electronically
(Y page 602)
RCalling up the service due date
(Y page 567)
Settings menu
Introduction
Press the : or 9 button to select the
Display unit Speed-/odometer function.
You will see the selected setting: km or
miles.
miles
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
The selected unit of measurement for distance applies to:
Rdigital
speedometer in the Trip menu
distance recorder and the trip meter
Rtrip computer
Rcurrent consumption and the range
Rnavigation instructions in the Navi menu
Rcruise control
RSPEEDTRONIC
RDISTRONIC PLUS
RASSYST PLUS service interval display
Rtotal
In the Settings menu, you have the following
options:
Rchanging the instrument cluster settings
(Y page 239)
Rchanging the light settings (Y page 239)
Rchanging the vehicle settings
(Y page 242)
Rchanging the convenience settings
(Y page 243)
Rrestoring the factory settings
(Y page 244)
Instrument cluster
Selecting the unit of measurement for distance
You can determine whether the multifunction
display shows some messages in miles or kilometres.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instrument cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X
Selecting the permanent display function
Vehicles for the United Kingdom: this function is unavailable.
You can determine whether the multifunction
display permanently shows your speed or the
outside temperature.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instrument cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Permanent display function.
You will see the selected setting outside
temperature or Dig. speedo [mph].
[mph]
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
i The speed is displayed in mph.
Lights
Setting the daytime driving lights
The Daytime driving lights function can
only be switched on with the engine turned
off.
Z
239
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
240
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Daytime driving lights function.
If the Daytime driving lights function
has been switched on, the cone of light and
the W symbol in the multifunction display are shown in orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Further information on daytime driving lights
(Y page 127).
Switching the Intelligent Light System
on/off
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Intell. Light System function.
If the Intell. Light System function has
been switched on, the cone of light and the
L symbol in the multifunction display
are shown in orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
When you activate the Intell. Light Sys‐
tem, you activate the following functions:
tem
RMotorway mode
RActive light function
RCornering light function
RExtended range foglamps
If you set the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the right/left, the multifunction
display shows the Intell. Light System:
system inoperative Inactive for
left-side traffic or Intell. Light
System: System inoperative Inactive
for right-side traffic display message
instead of the Intell. Light System function in the Lights submenu (Y page 240).
Further information on the Intelligent Light
System (Y page 131).
Setting the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the left/right
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Dipped beams Setting for: function.
You will see the selected setting: Rightside traffic or Left-side traffic.
traffic
X Press the a button to save the setting.
If you change the setting, conversion does
not take place until the next time the vehicle is stationary.
You can use this function to switch between
symmetrical and asymmetrical dipped beam
(Y page 126).
If you set the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the right/left, then motorway
mode and the extended range foglamps are
unavailable.
A qualified specialist workshop can set the
dipped-beam headlamps for driving on the
left/right.
Switching the spotlight function on or off
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 to select the Spot‐
light function.
When the spotlight function is activated,
the assistance graphic shows the pedestrian symbol.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Further information on the spotlight function
of Night View Assist Plus (Y page 219).
Setting the brightness of the ambient
lighting
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Amb. light +/- function.
You will see the selected setting.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to adjust the
brightness to a level from Off to Level 5
(bright).
X Press the a or % button to save the
setting.
Setting the ambient lighting colour
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Ambient light colour function.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to set the
colour to SOLAR
SOLAR, SOLAR orange or SOLAR
red.
red
X Press the a or % button to save the
setting.
X
Activating/deactivating the surround
lighting and exterior lighting delayed
switch-off
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Surround lighting function.
When the Surround lighting function is
activated, the light cone and the area
around the vehicle are displayed in orange
in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Deactivating delayed switch-off of the exterior lighting temporarily:
Before leaving the vehicle, turn the key to
position 0 in the ignition lock.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
The exterior lighting delayed switch-off is
deactivated.
X
Delayed switch-off of the exterior lighting is
reactivated the next time you start the
engine.
If you have activated the Surround light‐
ing function and the light switch is set to
Ã, the following functions are activated
when it is dark:
Rsurround lighting: the exterior lighting
remains lit for 40 seconds after unlocking
with the key. If you start the engine, the
surround lighting is switched off and automatic headlamp mode is activated
(Y page 127).
Rexterior lighting delayed switch-off: the
exterior lighting remains lit for 60 seconds
after the engine is switched off. If you close
all the doors and the boot lid, the exterior
lighting goes off after 15 seconds.
i Depending on your vehicle's equipment,
when the surround lighting and delayed
switch-off exterior lighting are on, the following light up:
Rside lamps
Rdipped-beam headlamps
Rdaytime driving lights
Rsurround lighting in the exterior mirrors
Activating/deactivating the interior lighting delayed switch-off
If you activate the Lighting delayed sw.off function, the interior lighting remains on
for 20 seconds after you remove the key from
the ignition lock.
Z
241
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
242
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lighting delayed sw.-off function.
If the Lighting delayed sw.-off function has been switched on, the vehicle interior is displayed in orange in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Vehicle
Setting permanent SPEEDTRONIC
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select the Limit
speed (winter tyres) function.
You will see the current setting.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to adjust
permanent SPEEDTRONIC in increments of
ten (240
240 km/h to 160 km/h).
km/h The Off setting switches permanent SPEEDTRONIC
off.
X Press the a button to store the entry.
For further information on permanent SPEEDTRONIC (Y page 196).
Switching the automatic locking feature
on/off
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Automatic door locks function.
When the Automatic door locks function is activated, the left-hand vehicle door
is displayed in orange in the multifunction
display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
If you activate the Automatic door locks
function, the vehicle is centrally locked above
a speed of around 15 km/h.
For further information on the automatic locking feature; see (Y page 92).
Activating/deactivating the acoustic
locking confirmation
If you activate the Acoustic Lock function,
an acoustic signal sounds when you lock the
vehicle.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Acoustic Lock function.
If the Acoustic Lock function is activated,
the & symbol in the multifunction display lights up orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Activating/deactivating the radar sensor
system
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Radar sensor (See Owner's Man.).
Man.)
You will see the selected setting: on or off
off.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
The following systems are switched off when
the radar sensor system is deactivated:
RDISTRONIC
PLUS (Y page 185)
PLUS (Y page 72)
RPRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 77)
RActive Blind Spot Assist (Y page 220)
RBAS
Comfort
Activating/deactivating the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature
G WARNING
When the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature adjusts
the steering wheel, you and other vehicle
occupants – particularly children – could
become trapped. There is a risk of injury.
While the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature is making adjustments, make sure that no one has
any body parts in the sweep of the steering
wheel.
If someone is trapped:
Rpress
one of the memory function position
buttons, or
Rmove the switch for steering wheel adjustment in the opposite direction to that in
which the steering wheel is moving.
The adjustment process is stopped.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Easy Entry/Exit function.
If the Easy Entry/Exit function is activated, the vehicle steering wheel is displayed
in orange in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Press the : or 9 button to select the
Belt adjustment function.
When the Belt adjustment function is
activated, the vehicle seat belt is displayed
in orange in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
For further information on belt adjustment,
see (Y page 59).
Switching the fold-in mirrors when locking function on/off
This function is only available on vehicles with
a memory function (Y page 123).
When you activate the Auto. fold-in mir‐
rors function, the exterior mirrors are folded
in when the vehicle is locked.
When you unlock the vehicle and then open a
door, the exterior mirrors fold out again.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Auto. fold-in mirrors function.
If the Auto. fold-in mirrors function is
activated, the vehicle's exterior mirror is
displayed in orange in the multifunction
display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Further information on the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT
feature (Y page 118).
Switching belt adjustment on/off
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
: Folds the exterior mirrors in or out
If you have switched on the Auto. fold-in
mirrors function and you fold the exterior
Z
243
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
244
mirrors in using button :, they will not fold
out automatically (Y page 121).
You can then only fold out the exterior mirrors
using button :.
If you have switched the function on and you
fold the exterior mirrors in using the button on
the door (Y page 121), they will not fold out
automatically. The exterior mirrors can then
only be folded out using the button on the
door.
Resetting to factory settings
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Factory setting submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
The Reset all settings? message
appears.
X Press the : or 9 button to select No
or Yes
Yes.
X Press the a button to confirm the selection.
If you have selected Yes
Yes, the multifunction
display shows a confirmation message.
X
For safety reasons, not all functions are reset:
the Limit speed (winter tyres) function
in permanent SPEEDTRONIC can only be set
in the Vehicle submenu. If you want to reset
the Daytime driving lights in the Lights
submenu, you must turn the key to position 1
in the ignition lock.
AMG menu in AMG vehicles
AMG displays
:
;
=
?
A
B
X
Digital speedometer
Gear indicator
Upshift indicator
Engine oil temperature
Coolant temperature
Transmission fluid temperature
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
Upshift indicator UP = indicates that the
engine has reached the overrevving range
when in the manual gearshift program.
Upshift indicator UP = fades out other
messages until you have shifted up.
If the engine oil temperature is below 80 †,
oil temperature ? is shown in blue. Avoid
using the full output of the engine during
this time.
If the transmission fluid temperature is
below 50 †, oil temperature B is shown in
blue. Avoid using the full output of the
engine during this time.
SETUP
: Drive program (C
C/SS+
SS+/MM)
; ESP® mode (ON
ON/OFF
OFF) or SPORT handling
mode (SPORT
SPORT)
= Suspension tuning (SPORT
SPORT/COMFORT
COMFORT)
SETUP shows the drive program, the ESP®
(Electronic Stability Program) mode, the
SPORT handling mode and the suspension
setting.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until
SETUP is displayed.
or
X Briefly press the AMG button on the centre
console (Y page 167).
RACETIMER
Displaying and starting the RACETIMER
The RACETIMER is only intended for use on a
closed race circuit. Do not use the function on
public roads.
Press the = or ; button to select
Interm. Time.
Time
X Press a to confirm.
The intermediate time is displayed for five
seconds.
X
Starting a new lap
: RACETIMER
; Fastest lap time (best lap)
= Lap
X
Press a to confirm New Lap.
Lap
i A maximum of 16 laps may be stored. The
16th lap can only be completed with Fin‐
ish Lap.
Lap
Stopping the RACETIMER
: Lap
; RACETIMER
You can start the RACETIMER when the
engine is running or if the key is in position 2
in the ignition lock.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
RACETIMER is shown.
X To start: press the a button to start the
RACETIMER.
X
Displaying the intermediate time
Press the % button on the steering
wheel.
X Press a to confirm Yes
Yes.
X
The RACETIMER interrupts timing if you stop
the vehicle and turn the key to position 1 in
the ignition lock. If you turn the key to position
2 or 3 and then press a to confirm Start
Start,
timing is continued.
Resetting the current lap
Stop the RACETIMER.
X Press the = or ; button to select
Reset Lap.
Lap
X Press a to reset the lap time to "0".
X
Z
245
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
246
Deleting all laps
Lap evaluation
If you switch off the engine, the RACETIMER is
reset to "0" after 30 seconds. All laps are
deleted.
You cannot delete individual stored laps. If
you have stopped 16 laps, the current lap
does not have to be reset.
X Reset the current lap.
X Press a to confirm Reset
Reset.
Reset Race Timer? appears in the multifunction display.
X Press the : button to select Yes and
press the a button to confirm.
All laps are deleted.
:
;
=
?
A
Overall evaluation
:
;
=
?
A
RACETIMER overall evaluation
Total time driven
Average speed
Distance covered
Maximum speed
This function is shown if you have stored at
least one lap and stopped the RACETIMER.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
overall evaluation is shown.
X
Lap
Lap time
Average lap speed
Lap length
Top speed during lap
This function is only available if you have
stored at least two laps and have stopped the
RACETIMER.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
lap evaluation is shown.
Each lap is shown in a separate submenu.
The fastest lap is indicated by flashing symbol :.
X Press the 9 or : button to select a
different lap evaluation.
X
Display messages
Introduction
General notes
Display messages appear in the multifunction display.
Display messages with graphic symbols are simplified in the Owner's Manual and may differ
from the symbols in the multifunction display.
Please respond in accordance with the display messages and follow the additional notes in this
Owner's Manual.
Certain display messages are accompanied by an audible warning tone or a continuous tone.
When you stop and park the vehicle, please observe the notes on:
RHOLD
function (Y page 196)
page 175)
RParking (Y
Hiding display messages
X
Press the a or % button on the steering wheel to hide the display message.
The display message is cleared.
The multifunction display shows high-priority display messages in red. Some high-priority display messages cannot be hidden.
The multifunction display shows these messages continuously until the causes for the messages have been remedied.
Message memory
The on-board computer saves certain display messages in the message memory. You can call
up the display messages:
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu.
If there are display messages, the multifunction display shows 2 messages,
messages for example.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the entry, e.g. 2 messages.
messages
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the 9 or : button to scroll through the display messages.
X
When the ignition is switched off, all display messages are deleted apart from some highpriority display messages. Once the causes of the high-priority display messages have been
rectified, the corresponding display messages are also deleted.
Z
247
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
248
Display messages
Safety systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!÷
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System), ESP® (Electronic Stability Program), BAS (Brake Assist), PRE‑SAFE®, the HOLD function and hill
start assist are temporarily unavailable.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE‑SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Possible causes:
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
Rself-diagnosis
Rthe
is not yet complete
on-board voltage may be insufficient
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
X
!÷
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
Drive on carefully.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
ABS, ESP®, BAS, PRE‑SAFE®, the HOLD function and hill start
assist are unavailable due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE‑SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the J, ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up
in the instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
÷
ESP®, BAS, PRE‑SAFE®, the HOLD function and hill start assist are
temporarily unavailable.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE‑SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the ÷ and å warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
The self-diagnosis function, for example, may not be complete.
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
X
Drive on carefully.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
249
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
250
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
÷
ESP®, BAS, PRE‑SAFE®, the HOLD function and hill start assist are
not available due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE‑SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the ÷ and å warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
T!
÷
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
EBD (electronic brake force distribution), ABS, ESP®, BAS, PRESAFE®, the HOLD function and hill start assist are not available due
to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE‑SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster and a warning tone sounds.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock, for example, if you brake hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and a warning tone sounds. A
condition for automatic release of the electric parking brake is not
fulfilled (Y page 176).
You are driving with the electric parking brake applied.
X Release the electric parking brake manually.
Release parking
brake
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and a warning tone sounds.
You are making an emergency stop using the electric parking
brake (Y page 176).
!
Parking brake See
Owner's Manual
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To apply:
Switch the ignition off.
X Press the electric parking brake handle for at least ten seconds.
X Move the transmission selector lever to P.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The yellow ! warning lamp and the red ! indicator lamp are
lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To release:
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
X Release the electric parking brake manually.
or
X Release the electric parking brake automatically (Y page 176).
X
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
X
X
Do not drive on.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
251
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
252
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and the yellow ! warning
lamp is lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To release:
X
X
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
Release the electric parking brake manually.
To apply:
X
X
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
Apply the electric parking brake manually.
If the red ! indicator lamp continues to flash:
Do not drive on.
Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 606).
X Move the transmission selector lever to P.
X Turn the front wheels towards the kerb.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
X
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. The red ! indicator
lamp flashes for about ten seconds after the electric parking brake
has been applied or released. It then goes out or remains lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
X Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 606).
If it is not possible to apply the electric parking brake:
Move the transmission selector lever to P.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
If it is not possible to release the electric parking brake:
X
Release the electric parking brake automatically (Y page 176).
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. If you manually apply or
release the electric parking brake, the red ! indicator lamp
flashes.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning. It is not possible to
apply the electric parking brake manually.
X Shift the transmission to P, as the electric parking brake is not
applied automatically.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. The red ! indicator
lamp flashes for about ten seconds after the electric parking brake
Parking brake inop‐ has been applied or released. It then goes out or remains lit.
erative
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning, e.g. because of overvoltage or undervoltage.
X Rectify the cause of the overvoltage or undervoltage, e.g. by
charging the battery or restarting the engine.
X Apply or release the electric parking brake.
If the electric parking brake still cannot be applied or released:
X
X
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
Apply or release the electric parking brake.
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and the yellow ! warning
lamp is lit.
It is not possible to apply the electric parking brake manually.
X Move the transmission selector lever to P.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
!
The red ! indicator lamp lights up.
You attempted to release the electric parking brake while the ignition was switched off.
X Key: turn the key to position 1 in the ignition lock.
X KEYLESS-GO: switch on the ignition.
J
There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
In addition, the red J warning lamp lights up in the instrument
cluster and a warning tone sounds.
Turn on the igni‐
tion to release
the parking brake
Check brake fluid
level
G WARNING
Braking efficiency may be impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 175).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Do not top up the brake fluid. This does not correct the fault.
Z
253
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
254
Display messages
Display messages
#
Check brake pad
wear
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The brake pads/linings have reached their wear limit.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
PRE-SAFE
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
Important functions of PRE-SAFE® have failed. All other occupant
safety systems, e.g. airbags, remain available.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
PRE-SAFE
Functions cur‐
rently limited See
Owner's Manual
PRE‑SAFE® Brake is deactivated or temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
Rthe
function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow
sensors in the radiator trim and in the bumpers are dirty
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation
RAMG vehicles: ESP® is deactivated
Rthe system is outside the operating temperature range
Rthe on-board voltage is too low
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
PRE‑SAFE® Brake is operational again.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 175).
X Clean the sensors in the radiator grille and the bumper
(Y page 571).
X Restart the engine.
X AMG vehicles: reactivate ESP® (Y page 75).
Rthe
PRE-SAFE
Functions limited
See Owner's Manual
PRE-SAFE® Brake is inoperative due to a fault. BAS PLUS or the
distance warning signal may also have failed.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
A
The roll bars are defective.
Malfunction Con‐
sult workshop
G WARNING
The roll bars will then possibly not be extended in the event of an
accident.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
6
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) is malfunctioning. The 6
warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
Restraint sys. mal‐
G WARNING
function Consult
workshop
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
For further information about the Supplemental Restraint System,
see (Y page 51).
6
SRS has malfunctioned at the front on the left or right. The 6
warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
6
There is a malfunction in the left-hand and/or right-hand headbag.
The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
Front left malfunc‐
G WARNING
tion Consult work‐
shoporFront
shop
Front right
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintenmalfunction Con‐
tionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
sult workshop
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Left windowbag mal‐
G WARNING
function Consult
workshoporRight
workshop
Right
The left or right headbag may either be triggered unintentionally or,
windowbag malfunc‐ in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
tion Consult work‐ This poses an increased risk of injury.
shop
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Lights
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left or right-hand cornering light is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand dipped-beam headlamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Left cornering
light or Right cor‐
nering light
Left dipped beam
or Right dipped
beam
Z
255
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
256
Display messages
Display messages
b
Rear left indica‐
tor or Rear right
indicator
b
Front left indica‐
tor or Front right
indicator
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The rear left-hand or rear right-hand turn signal is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The front left-hand or front right-hand turn signal is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
b
The turn signal in the left-hand or right-hand exterior mirror is
faulty.
Left mirror indica‐
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
tor or Right mir‐
ror indicator
b
The third brake lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand brake lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand tail lamp/brake lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Third brake lamp
Left brake
lamporRight
lamp
Right brake
lamp
Left-hand tail
lamp/brake lamp or
Right-hand tail
lamp/brake lamp
b
Left main
beamorRight
beam
Right main
beam
b
Number plate lamp
b
Rear foglamp
The left or right-hand main-beam headlamp is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The left or right-hand licence plate lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The rear foglamp is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The front left or front right parking lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Front left parking
lamp or Front
right parking lamp
b
Reversing light
b
Left daytime driv‐
ing lamporRight
lamp Right
daytime driving
lamp
The reversing lamp is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The left-hand or right-hand daytime driving lamp is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
b
The Intelligent Light System is faulty. The lights remain available
without the Intelligent Light System.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The exterior lighting is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The light sensor is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The lights are still switched on when you leave the vehicle. A
warning tone also sounds.
X Turn the light switch to Ã.
Adaptive Main-beam
Assist inoperative
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Adaptive Main-beam
Assist currently
unavailable See
Owner's Manual
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
Intell. Light Sys‐
tem inoperative
Malfunction See
Owner's Manual
AUTO lights inoper‐
ative
Switch off lights
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision
is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog
X Clean the windscreen.
Rvisibility
If the system detects that the camera is fully operational again, the
Adaptive Main-beam Assist available again message is
displayed.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is operational again.
Z
257
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
258
Display messages
Engine
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
+
The coolant level is too low.
Top up coolant See
Owner's Manual
! Avoid making long journeys with too little coolant in the engine
cooling system. The engine will otherwise be damaged.
Top up the coolant, observing the warning notes before doing so
(Y page 565).
X If the coolant needs topping up more often than usual, have the
engine coolant system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
?
The fan motor is faulty.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in
mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
?
The coolant is too hot.
A warning tone also sounds.
Coolant Stop vehi‐
cle Switch engine
off
G WARNING
Never drive with an overheated engine. Driving when your engine
is overheated can cause some fluids which may have leaked into
the engine compartment to catch fire.
In addition, steam from an overheated engine can cause serious
burns, which can occur just by opening the bonnet.
There is a risk of injury.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 175).
X Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until
the engine has cooled down.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by frozen slush.
X Do not start the engine again until the display message goes out
and the coolant temperature is below 120 †. The engine may
otherwise be damaged.
X Pay attention to the coolant temperature display.
X If the temperature increases again, visit a qualified specialist
workshop immediately.
Under normal operating conditions and with the specified coolant
level, the coolant temperature may rise to 120 †.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
The battery is not being charged.
A warning tone also sounds.
Possible causes:
Rfaulty
alternator
poly-V-belt
Ra malfunction in the electronics
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 175).
X Open the bonnet.
X Check whether the poly-V-belt is torn.
Rtorn
If the poly-V-belt is torn:
! Do not continue driving. The engine could otherwise overheat.
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the poly-V-belt is OK:
X
4
Check eng. oil
lev. when next
refuelling
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The engine oil level has dropped to the minimum level.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Check the oil level when next refuelling, at the latest
(Y page 564).
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 564).
X Have the engine checked at a qualified specialist workshop if the
engine oil needs topping up more often than usual.
! Avoid long journeys when there is too little coolant in the cooling system. Otherwise the engine will be damaged.
Information on approved engine oils can be obtained from any
qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at http://
bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
Z
259
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
260
Display messages
Display messages
4
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
AMG vehicles: the engine oil level is too low.
Check the oil level when next refuelling, at the latest
Add 1 litre engine
(Y page 564).
oil when next refu‐
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 564).
elling
X Have the engine checked at a qualified specialist workshop if the
engine oil needs topping up more often than usual.
X
! Avoid long journeys when there is too little coolant in the cooling system. Otherwise the engine will be damaged.
Information on approved engine oils can be obtained from any
qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at http://
bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
8
Reserve fuel level
C
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
There is very little fuel in the fuel tank.
Refuel at the nearest filling station without fail.
X
Driving systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ABC
Malfunction
The ABC function (Active Body Control) is restricted.
G WARNING
The vehicle's suspension settings may be affected.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Do not drive at speeds above 80 km/h.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
ABC
Malfunction Stop
vehicle
The vehicle level of the ABC is too low.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
After a few seconds, the vehicle level is adjusted and the display
message disappears.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The vehicle is leaking oil.
The display message is shown continuously.
G WARNING
The vehicle's suspension settings may be affected.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 175).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
ABC is malfunctioning.
The display message is shown continuously.
G WARNING
The suspension settings are thus affected.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Do not drive at speeds above 80 km/h.
X Make only slight steering movements. Otherwise, the front
wings or the tyres could be damaged if the steering movement
is too great.
X Listen for scraping sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
À
Attention Assist:
Take a break!
Based on certain criteria, ATTENTION ASSIST has detected fatigue
or a lack of concentration on the part of the driver. A warning tone
also sounds.
X If necessary, take a break.
During long journeys, take regular breaks in good time so that you
get enough rest.
À
Attention Assist
inoperative
ATTENTION ASSIST is inoperative.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
261
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
262
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Speed Limit Assist
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
Speed Limit Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision
Rvisibility is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog
X Clean the windscreen.
If the system detects that the camera is fully operational, the display message disappears.
Speed Limit Assist is operational again.
Speed Limit Assist
inoperative
Speed Limit Assist is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
ë
The HOLD function is deactivated. The vehicle is skidding.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Reactivate the HOLD function later (Y page 196).
Radar sensor deac‐
tivated See Own‐
er's Manual
The radar sensor system is deactivated.
X Switch on the radar sensor system (Y page 242).
Spotlight inopera‐
tive
Night View Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
Off
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision
camera in the radiator trim is dirty
Rvisibility is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog
Rthe outside temperature is too high
X Clean the windscreen.
X Clean the camera in the radiator trim.
Rthe
If the system has been switched off due to excessive outside temperatures, the system will switch back on automatically once it has
cooled down.
If the system detects that the camera is fully operational, the display message disappears.
Night View Assist is operational again.
Night View Assist Plus is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Active Lane Keep‐
ing Assist cur‐
rently unavailable
See Owner's Manual
Active Lane Keeping Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
Rthe windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision
Rvisibility is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog
Rthere are no lane markings for a longer period
Rthe lane markings are worn, dark or covered, e.g. by dirt or snow
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Active Lane Keeping Assist is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 175).
X Clean the windscreen.
X
Active Lane Keep‐
ing Assist inoper‐
ative
Active Lane Keeping Assist is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Active Blind Spot
Assist currently
unavailable See
Owner's Manual
Active Blind Spot Assist is temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
Rthe sensors are dirty
Rthe function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow
Rthe radar sensor system is outside the operating temperature
range
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Active Blind Spot Assist is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 175).
X Clean the sensors (Y page 571).
X Restart the engine.
X
Z
263
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
264
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Active Blind Spot
Assist inoperative
Active Blind Spot Assist is faulty.
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Park Assist cancel‐ The driver's door is open and the driver's seat belt has not been
fastened.
led
X Repeat the parking process with the seat belt fastened and the
driver's door closed.
You inadvertently touched the multifunction steering wheel while
steering intervention was active.
X While steering intervention is active, make sure not to touch the
multifunction steering wheel.
The vehicle has started to skid and ESP® has intervened.
X Use Active Parking Assist again later (Y page 207).
Park Assist inoper‐ You have just carried out a large number of turning or parking
manoeuvres.
ative
Active Parking Assist will become available again after approximately ten minutes (Y page 207).
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Switch off and restart the engine.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
PARKTRONIC is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Park Assist
switched off
The vehicle is parked. A warning tone also sounds.
The display message disappears automatically.
DISTRONIC PLUS off
DISTRONIC PLUS has been deactivated (Y page 185).
If it was deactivated automatically, a warning tone also sounds.
DISTRONIC PLUS
available again
DISTRONIC PLUS is operational again after having been temporarily unavailable. You can now reactivate DISTRONIC PLUS
(Y page 185).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
DISTRONIC PLUS cur‐ DISTRONIC PLUS is temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
rently unavailable Rthe function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow
See Owner's Manual
Rthe sensors in the radiator trim and in the bumpers are dirty
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation
Rthe system is outside the operating temperature range
Rthe on-board voltage is too low
A warning tone also sounds.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
DISTRONIC is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 175).
X Clean the sensors in the radiator grille and the bumper
(Y page 571).
X Restart the engine.
X
DISTRONIC PLUS
inoperative
DISTRONIC PLUS is faulty.
BAS PLUS and PRE‑SAFE® Brake may also have failed.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
DISTRONIC PLUS
inactive
You have depressed the accelerator pedal. DISTRONIC PLUS is no
longer controlling the speed of the vehicle.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.
DISTRONIC PLUS
- - - km/h
An activation condition for DISTRONIC PLUS is not fulfilled.
X Check the activation conditions for DISTRONIC PLUS
(Y page 185).
DISTRONIC PLUS and
SPEEDTRONIC inop‐
erative
DISTRONIC PLUS and SPEEDTRONIC are faulty. A warning tone
also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Cruise control and
SPEEDTRONIC inop‐
erative
SPEEDTRONIC and cruise control are malfunctioning.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
265
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
266
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Limit
--- km/h
While depressing the accelerator pedal beyond the pressure point
(kickdown), SPEEDTRONIC cannot be activated.
Cruise control
- - - km/h
A condition for activating cruise control has not been met.
You have tried to store a speed below 30 km/h, for example.
X If conditions permit, drive faster than 30 km/h and store the
speed.
X Check the activation conditions for cruise control (Y page 182).
120 km/h
Maximum speed
exceeded
Only for certain countries: the maximum speed has been exceeded.
In addition, the multifunction display shows 120 km/h!
X Drive more slowly.
Tyres
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Tyre pressure
Check tyres
The tyre pressure loss warning system has detected a significant
loss in pressure
A warning tone also sounds.
Possible causes:
Ryou have changed the wheels and tyres or fitted new wheels and
tyres
tyre pressure in one or more tyres is incorrect
Rthe
G WARNING
Tyre pressures which are too low, harbour the following hazards:
Rthe tyres may burst, especially as vehicle load and speed increa-
ses
Rthe
tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may
greatly impair tyre traction
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may
be greatly impaired
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 175).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tyre (Y page 578).
X Check the tyre pressures and, if necessary, correct the tyre
pressure.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system when the tyre
pressure is correct (Y page 601).
Check tyre pres‐
sures
then restart Run
Flat Indicator
The tyre pressure loss warning system generated a display message and has not been restarted since.
X Set the correct tyre pressure in all four tyres.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system (Y page 601).
Run Flat Indicator
inoperative
X
Rectify
tyre pressure
The tyre pressure loss warning system is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The tyre pressure is too low in at least one of the tyres, or the tyre
pressure difference between the wheels is too great.
X Check the tyre pressures at the next opportunity (Y page 602).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
X Restart the tyre pressure monitor (Y page 604).
Z
267
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
268
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Check
tyre(s)
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped significantly.
The wheel position is displayed in the multifunction display.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
Tyre pressures which are too low, harbour the following hazards:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may
greatly impair tyre traction
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may
be greatly impaired
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 175).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tyre (Y page 578).
X Check the tyre pressure (Y page 602).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
Warning
tyre defect
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped suddenly. The
wheel position is displayed in the multifunction display.
G WARNING
If you drive with a flat tyre, there is a risk of the following hazards:
Ra
flat tyre affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle
could lose control of the vehicle
Rcontinued driving with a flat tyre will cause excessive heat buildup and possibly a fire
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 175).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tyre (Y page 578).
Ryou
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Tyre press. monitor Due to a source of radio interference, no signals can be received
currently unavail‐ from the wheel sensors. The tyre pressure monitor is temporarily
malfunctioning.
able
X Drive on.
The tyre pressure monitor restarts automatically as soon as the
cause has been rectified.
Wheel sensor(s)
missing
There is no signal from the tyre pressure sensor of one or several
wheels. The pressure of the affected tyre is not displayed in the
multifunction display.
X Have the faulty tyre pressure sensor replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
Tyre press. moni‐
tor inoperative No
wheel sensors
The wheels fitted do not have suitable tyre pressure sensors. The
tyre pressure monitor is deactivated.
X Fit wheels with suitable tyre pressure sensors.
The tyre pressure monitor is activated automatically after driving for a few minutes.
Tyre pressure mon‐
itor
inoperative
The tyre pressure monitor is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicle
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
To start engine,
shift to either P
or N
You have attempted to start the engine with the transmission in
position R or D.
Apply brake to
deselect
Park (P) position
You have attempted to move the transmission selector lever to
position D, R or N without depressing the brake pedal.
Auxiliary battery
malfunction
The auxiliary battery for the automatic transmission is no longer
being charged.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop at the next opportunity.
X Until then, set the automatic transmission to position P before
you switch off the engine.
X Before leaving the vehicle, apply the electric parking brake.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 175).
X
X
Shift the transmission to position P or N.
Depress the brake pedal.
Z
269
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
270
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Risk of vehicle
rolling
Transmission not
in P
The driver's door is open and the transmission is in position R, N or
D.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 175).
Without changing
gear,
consult workshop
You cannot change the transmission position due to a malfunction.
A warning tone also sounds.
If transmission position D is selected:
X
Drive to a qualified specialist workshop without shifting the
transmission from position D.
If transmission position R, N or P is selected:
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Only select Park
(P)
when vehicle is
stationary
The vehicle is moving.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
N
The boot lid is open.
X Close the boot lid.
M
The bonnet is open.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
The open bonnet may then block your view when the vehicle is in
motion.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 175).
X Close the bonnet.
Active bonnet mal‐
function See Own‐
er's Manual
The active bonnet (pedestrian protection) is not active due to a
malfunction or because it has already been triggered.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
C
At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds.
X Close all doors.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Ð
The power steering assistance is faulty.
A warning tone also sounds.
J
The boot separator is open.
X Close the boot separator (Y page 106).
*
The stowage space under the armrest is open. The interior motion
sensor is not primed.
X Close the stowage space under the armrest (Y page 545).
Telephone No ser‐
vice
Your vehicle is outside the network provider's transmitter/
receiver range.
X Wait until the mobile phone operational readiness symbol
appears in the multifunction display.
K
You wanted to open the roof while the vehicle was in motion.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Open the roof (Y page 104).
K
The roof is not fully opened or closed. The hydraulics are depressurised.
X Fully open or close the roof (Y page 104).
K
The roof is not locked.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Push or pull the roof switch until the roof is fully open or closed
(Y page 104).
Power steering mal‐
G WARNING
function See Own‐
er's Manual
You will need to use more force to steer.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Check whether you are able to apply the extra force required.
X If you are able to steer safely: carefully drive on to a qualified
specialist workshop.
X If you are unable to steer safely: do not drive on. Contact the
nearest qualified specialist workshop.
Close boot separa‐
tor
Close centre com‐
partment
Decrease speed
Vario-roof lower‐
ing
Open/close varioroof completely
Z
271
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
272
Display messages
Display messages
K
Start engine See
Owner's Manual
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The on-board voltage is too low.
Start the engine.
X Repeat the opening/closing process after approximately ten
seconds (Y page 104).
X
The roof has been opened and closed several times in a row. The
roof drive has been switched off automatically for safety reasons.
You can open and close the roof again after approximately ten
minutes.
X Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
X Repeat the opening or closing procedure (Y page 104).
Close rear
side windows
You leave the vehicle and at least one of the rear side windows is
open.
X Close the rear side windows (Y page 100).
¥
The washer fluid level in the washer fluid reservoir has dropped
below the minimum.
Top up washer fluid
X Top up the washer fluid (Y page 566).
Wiper malfunction‐
ing
The windscreen wipers are defective.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Hazard warning
lamps malfunction‐
ing
The hazard warning lamps are faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Key
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Â
You have put the wrong key in the ignition lock.
X Use the correct key.
Key does not
belong to vehicle
Â
Replace key
Â
Change key batter‐
ies
The key needs to be replaced.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The batteries of the KEYLESS-GO key are discharged.
X Change the batteries (Y page 88).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Â
The KEYLESS-GO key is not in the vehicle.
A warning tone also sounds.
If the engine is switched off, you can no longer lock the vehicle
centrally or start the engine.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 175).
X Locate the KEYLESS-GO key.
Key not detected
(red display message)
The KEYLESS-GO key is not detected while the engine is running
because there is interference from a strong source of radio waves.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 175).
X Operate the vehicle with the key in the ignition lock if necessary.
Â
Key not detected
(white display message)
The KEYLESS-GO key cannot be detected at present.
X Change the location of the key with the KEYLESS-GO functions
in the vehicle.
If the KEYLESS-GO key is still not detected:
X
Â
Remove starting
button, then
insert key
Operate the vehicle with the key in the ignition lock if necessary.
The KEYLESS-GO key is not continually detected.
KEYLESS-GO is temporarily malfunctioning or is defective. A warning tone also sounds.
X Insert the key into the ignition lock and turn it to the desired
position.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
273
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
274
Warning and indicator lamps
Warning and indicator lamps
Safety
Seat belts
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ü
The seat belt warning lamp reminds the driver and front passenger
Only for certain coun- to fasten their seat belts.
tries: the red seat belt X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 59).
warning lamp lights up
for 6 seconds after the
engine starts.
ü
The driver's seat belt is not fastened.
Only for certain coun- X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 59).
tries: the red seat belt
The warning tone ceases.
warning lamp lights up
after the engine starts.
In addition, a warning
tone sounds for up to
6 seconds.
ü
The driver or passenger has not fastened their seat belt.
The red seat belt warn- X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 59).
ing lamp lights up after
The warning lamp goes out.
the engine starts, as
soon as the driver's or There are objects on the front-passenger seat.
the front-passenger
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow
door is closed.
them in a secure place.
The warning lamp goes out.
ü
The driver or passenger has not fastened their seat belt. At the
The red seat belt warn- same time, you are driving faster than 25 km/h or have briefly
ing lamp flashes and an driven faster than 25 km/h.
intermittent audible
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 59).
warning sounds.
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone
ceases.
There are objects on the front-passenger seat. At the same time,
you are driving faster than 25 km/h or have briefly driven faster
than 25 km/h.
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow
them in a secure place.
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone
ceases.
Safety systems
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
J
There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
The red brake system
G WARNING
warning lamp is lit while
the engine is running. A Braking efficiency may be impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
warning tone also
sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 175).
X Do not top up the brake fluid. Topping up will not rectify the fault.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
!
The yellow ABS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
ABS (Anti-lock Brake System) has been deactivated due to a fault.
For this reason, BAS (Brake Assist), BAS PLUS, ESP® (Electronic
Stability Program), PRE‑SAFE®, PRE‑SAFE® Brake, the HOLD function, hill start assist and the adaptive brake lights are also deactivated, for example.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
If the ABS control unit is faulty, there is also a possibility that other
systems, such as the navigation system or the automatic transmission, will be unavailable.
Z
275
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps
On-board computer and displays
276
Warning and indicator lamps
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The yellow ABS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
ABS is temporarily unavailable. Therefore, BAS, BAS PLUS, ESP®,
EBD (electronic brake force distribution), PRE‑SAFE®,
PRE‑SAFE® Brake, the HOLD function, hill start assist and the
adaptive brake lights, for example, are also deactivated.
Possible causes:
Rself-diagnosis
is not yet complete
on-board voltage may be insufficient
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Rthe
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock, for example, if you brake hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements at a speed above 20 km/h.
The functions mentioned above are available again when the
warning lamp goes out.
If the warning lamp is still on:
Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The yellow ABS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running. A
warning tone also
sounds.
EBD is unavailable due to a malfunction. Therefore, ABS, BAS, BAS
PLUS, ESP®, PRE‑SAFE®, PRE‑SAFE® Brake, the HOLD function,
hill start assist and the adaptive brake lights, for example, are also
unavailable.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock, for example, if you brake hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
J֌!
The red brake warning
lamp, the yellow ESP®
and ESP® OFF warning
lamps and the yellow
ABS warning lamp are
lit while the engine is
running.
ABS and ESP® are unavailable due to a fault. Therefore, BAS, BAS
PLUS, EBD, PRE‑SAFE®, PRE‑SAFE® Brake, the HOLD function, hill
start assist and the adaptive brake lights, for example, are also
unavailable.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock, for example, if you brake hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
277
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps
On-board computer and displays
278
Warning and indicator lamps
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
÷
ESP® or traction control has intervened because there is a risk of
The yellow ESP® warn- skidding or at least one wheel has started to spin.
ing lamp flashes while Cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated.
the vehicle is in motion. X Only depress the accelerator pedal as far as necessary when
pulling away.
X Accelerate more gently while the vehicle is in motion.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
X Do not deactivate ESP®.
For exceptions, see: (Y page 74).
å
ESP® is deactivated.
®
The yellow ESP OFF
G WARNING
warning lamp is lit while
®
®
the engine is running. If ESP is deactivated, ESP is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
Reactivate ESP®.
For exceptions, see: (Y page 74).
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
X
If ESP® cannot be activated:
X Drive on carefully.
X Have ESP® checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
M
AMG vehicles only:
The yellow SPORT handling mode warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
SPORT handling mode is activated.
G WARNING
When SPORT handling mode is switched on, ESP® is unable to
stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Only switch on SPORT handling mode in certain situations
(Y page 75).
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
֌
The yellow ESP® and
ESP® OFF warning
lamps are lit while the
engine is running.
ESP®, BAS, BAS PLUS, PRE‑SAFE®, PRE‑SAFE® Brake, the HOLD
function, hill start assist and the adaptive brake lights are unavailable due to a malfunction.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
֌
The yellow ESP® and
ESP® OFF warning
lamps are lit while the
engine is running.
ESP®, BAS, PRE‑SAFE®, the HOLD function and hill start assist are
temporarily unavailable.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE‑SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Self-diagnosis is not yet complete.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements at a speed above 20 km/h.
The functions mentioned above are available again when the
warning lamp goes out.
If the warning lamp is still on:
Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Z
279
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps
On-board computer and displays
280
Warning and indicator lamps
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The red indicator lamp
for the electric parking
brake flashes or is lit
and/or the yellow
warning lamp for the
electric parking brake
is lit.
X
6
The red SRS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) is malfunctioning.
Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
G WARNING
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Drive on carefully.
X Have SRS checked at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
For further information about the Supplemental Restraint System,
see (Y page 51).
Engine
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
;
There may be a fault, for example:
The yellow engine diag- Rin the engine management
nostics warning lamp
Rin the fuel injection system
lights up while the
Rin the exhaust system
engine is running.
Rin the ignition system
Rin the fuel system
The emission limit values may be exceeded and the engine may be
running in emergency mode.
X Have the vehicle checked as soon as possible at a qualified
specialist workshop.
8
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
The yellow reserve fuel X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
warning lamp is on
while the engine is running.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
?
The red coolant warning lamp lights up while
the engine is running
and the coolant temperature gauge is at the
start of the scale.
The temperature sensor for the coolant temperature gauge is
faulty.
The coolant temperature is no longer being monitored. There is a
risk of engine damage if the coolant temperature is too high.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 175).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
281
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps
On-board computer and displays
282
Warning and indicator lamps
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
?
The red coolant warning lamp comes on
while the engine is running.
The coolant level is too low.
If the coolant level is correct, the airflow to the engine radiator may
be blocked or the electric engine radiator fan may be malfunctioning.
The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled
sufficiently.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 175).
X Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until
the engine has cooled down.
X Check the coolant level and top up the coolant, observing the
warning notes (Y page 565).
X If you have to top up the coolant frequently, have the engine
cooling system checked.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by frozen slush.
X Do not start the engine again until the coolant temperature is
below 120 †. The engine may otherwise be damaged.
X Drive to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in
mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
?
The red coolant warning lamp comes on
while the engine is running. A warning tone
also sounds.
The coolant temperature has exceeded 120 †. The airflow to the
engine radiator may be blocked or the coolant level may be too
low.
G WARNING
The engine is not being cooled sufficiently and may be damaged.
Never drive with an overheated engine. Driving when your engine
is overheated can cause some fluids which may have leaked into
the engine compartment to catch fire.
In addition, steam from an overheated engine can cause serious
burns, which can occur just by opening the bonnet.
There is a risk of injury.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 175).
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
X Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until
the engine has cooled down.
X Check the coolant level and top up the coolant, observing the
warning notes (Y page 565).
X If you have to top up the coolant frequently, have the engine
cooling system checked.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by frozen slush.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in
mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
Driving systems
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
·
The distance to the vehicle in front is too small for the speed
The red distance warn- selected.
ing lamp lights up while X Increase the distance.
the vehicle is in motion.
·
You are approaching a vehicle or a stationary obstacle in your line
The red distance warn- of travel at too high a speed.
ing lamp lights up while X Be prepared to brake immediately.
the vehicle is in motion. X Pay careful attention to the traffic situation. You may have to
A warning tone also
brake or take evasive action.
sounds.
Further information on DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 185).
Further information on PRE‑SAFE® Brake (Y page 77).
Z
283
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps
On-board computer and displays
284
Warning and indicator lamps
Tyres
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
h
The yellow tyre pressure monitor warning
lamp (pressure loss/
malfunction) is lit.
The tyre pressure monitor has detected a loss of pressure in at
least one of the tyres.
G WARNING
With tyre pressures which are too low, there is a risk of the following hazards:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase.
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may
greatly impair tyre traction.
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may
be greatly impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 175).
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tyre (Y page 578).
X Check the tyre pressure (Y page 602).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
h
The yellow tyre pressure monitor warning
lamp (pressure loss/
malfunction) flashes for
approximately one
minute and then
remains lit.
The tyre pressure monitor is faulty.
G WARNING
The system may not be able to recognise or register low tyre pressure.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
285
Useful information ............................ 286
Operating safety ............................... 286
At a glance ......................................... 288
System settings ................................ 310
Vehicle functions .............................. 316
Navigation ......................................... 323
Telephone .......................................... 387
Online and Internet functions .......... 432
Video .................................................. 501
Rear Seat Entertainment System .... 519
COMAND Online
Audio .................................................. 462
286
Operating safety
Useful information
i These Operating Instructions describe all
COMAND Online
the standard and optional equipment of
your COMAND Online system, as available
at the time of going to print. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note
that your COMAND Online system may not
be equipped with all the features described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 34).
diverted or the direction of a one-way street
may have changed.
For this reason, you must always observe
road and traffic rules and regulations during
your journey. Road and traffic rules and regulations always have priority over the system's driving recommendations.
Bear in mind that, at a speed of only 50 km/h,
your vehicle covers a distance of nearly 14 m
per second.
Declarations of conformity
Wireless vehicle components
Operating safety
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
You must observe the legal requirements for
the country in which you are currently driving
when operating COMAND Online.
COMAND Online calculates the route to the
destination without taking account of the following, for example:
Rtraffic
lights
and give way signs
Rparking or stopping restrictions
Rroad narrowing
Rother road and traffic rules and regulations
COMAND Online may give incorrect driving
recommendations if the data on the digital
map does not correspond to the actual conditions. For example, a route may have been
Rstop
The following information applies to all components of the vehicle and the COMAND
Online system which receive and/or transmit
radio waves:
The components of this vehicle which receive
and/or transmit radio waves are compliant
with the basic requirements and other relevant provisions of Directive 1999/5/EC. You
can obtain further information from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Electromagnetic compatibility
The electromagnetic compatibility of the vehicle components has been checked and certified according to the currently valid version of
Directive ECE-R 10.
Correct use
Observe the following information when using
COMAND Online:
Rthe
safety notes in this manual
rules and regulations
Rlaws and safety standards pertaining to
motor vehicles
Rtraffic
i Improper work on electronic components
or other systems (e.g. radio, DVD changer)
and their software may result in malfunction or failure. Even systems that have not
been modified could be affected because
Operating safety
i The functionality of a roof aerial (tele-
phone, GPS) may be impaired if roof carrier
systems are used.
Attaching metallised retrofit film to the
windscreen may affect radio reception and
have a negative impact on all other aerials
(e.g. emergency aerial) in the vehicle interior.
i Only have work or changes to electronic
components carried out at a qualified specialist workshop. This workshop should
have the necessary specialist knowledge
and tools to carry out the work required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use
a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre. In particular, work relevant to safety or on safetyrelated systems must be carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
i Protection against theft: this device is
equipped with technical provisions to protect it against theft. Further information on
protection against theft can be obtained
from a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Data stored in the vehicle
A wide range of electronic components in
your vehicle contain data memories.
These data memories temporarily or permanently store technical information about:
Rthe
vehicle's operating state
Revents
Rfaults
In general, this technical information documents the state of a component, a module, a
system or the surroundings.
These include, for example:
Roperating
conditions of system components, e.g. fluid levels
Rthe vehicle's status messages and those of
its individual components, e.g. number of
wheel revolutions/speed, deceleration in
movement, lateral acceleration, accelerator pedal position
Rmalfunctions and defects in important system components, e.g. lights, brakes
Rvehicle reactions and operating conditions
in special driving situations, e.g. airbag
deployment, intervention of stability control systems
Rambient conditions, e.g. outside temperature
This data is of an exclusively technical nature
and can be used to:
Rassist
in recognising and rectifying faults
and defects
Ranalyse vehicle functions, e.g. after an accident
Roptimise vehicle functions
The data cannot be used to trace the vehicle's
movements.
When your vehicle is serviced, technical information can be read from the event data memory and fault data memory.
Services include, for example:
Rrepair
services
processes
Rwarranty events
Rquality assurance
It is read by employees of the service network
(including manufacturers) using special diagnostic testers. More detailed information is
obtained from it, if required.
After a fault has been rectified, the information is deleted from the fault memory or is
continually overwritten.
When operating the vehicle, situations are
conceivable in which this technical data, in
connection with other information (if necesRservice
Z
COMAND Online
the electronic systems are connected.
Electronic malfunctions can seriously jeopardise the operational safety of your vehicle.
287
288
At a glance
sary, under consultation with an authorised
expert), could be traced to a person.
Examples include:
Raccident
reports
to the vehicle
Rwitness statements
Further additional functions that have been
contractually agreed upon with the customer
allow certain vehicle data to be conveyed by
the vehicle as well. The additional functions
include, for example, vehicle location in case
of an emergency.
COMAND Online
Rdamage
Qualified specialist workshop
Read the information on qualified specialist
workshops in the vehicle Owner's Manual.
Copyright information
General notes
You can find information on licences for free
and open-source software used in your vehicle and its electronic components on the following website: http://www.mercedesbenz.com/opensource.
Function restrictions
For safety reasons, some COMAND functions
are restricted or unavailable while the vehicle
is in motion. You will notice this, for example,
because either you will not be able to select
certain menu items or COMAND Online will
display a message to this effect.
At a glance
Features of your COMAND Online
This Supplement describes all the standard
and optional equipment for your COMAND
Online system, as available at the time of
going to print. Country-specific differences
are possible. Please note that your
COMAND Online system may not be equipped with all the features described.
COMAND Online operating system
Overview
Features of your COMAND Online
These operating instructions describe all
standard and optional equipment available
for your COMAND Online system at the time
of purchase. Country-specific differences are
possible. Please note that your
COMAND Online system may not be equipped with all the features described. This is
also the case for systems and functions relevant to safety. Therefore, the equipment on
your COMAND Online system may differ from
that in the descriptions and illustrations.
Should you have any questions concerning
equipment and operation, please consult a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
: COMAND display (Y page 289)
; COMAND control panel with a single DVD
drive or DVD changer
= COMAND controller (Y page 296)
At a glance
289
You can use COMAND Online to operate the
following main functions:
Rthe
navigation system
audio function
Rthe telephone function
Rthe video function
Rthe system settings
Ronline and Internet functions
Rthe Digital Owner's Manual
(availability depends on the vehicle model)
You can call up the main functions:
Rusing
COMAND Online
Rthe
the corresponding function buttons
Rusing the main function bar in the COMAND
display
the remote control
Rusing
COMAND display
General notes
! Do not use the space in front of the display for storage. Objects placed here could
damage the display or impair its function.
Avoid any direct contact with the display
surface. Pressure on the display surface
may result in impairments to the display,
which could be irreversible.
Wearing polarised sunglasses may impair
your ability to read the display.
The display has an automatic temperaturecontrolled switch-off feature. The brightness
is automatically reduced if the temperature is
too high. If necessary, the display may temporarily switch off completely.
Z
290
At a glance
COMAND Online
Display overview
Example display for radio
: Status bar
; Calls up the audio menu
= Main function bar
? Display/selection window
A Radio menu bar
Status bar : displays the time, the current mobile phone network provider and the signal
strength.
If the traffic announcement function is switched on, the . symbol appears and when the
sound is switched off, the , symbol is displayed.
The main functions – navigation, audio, telephone and video – feature additional menus. This
is indicated by triangle ;. The following table lists the available menu items.
Main function bar = allows you to call up the desired main function. When the main function
is activated, it is identifiable by the white lettering.
In the example, the radio mode is switched on within the audio main function, display/selection window ? is active.
Menu bar A allows you to operate the radio functions.
At a glance
291
Menu overview
Navi
Audio
Telephone
Video
System
Route settings
Radio
Telephone
TV
Calls up the Calls up the
system
Digital Ownmenu
er's Manual
(availability
depends on
the vehicle
model)
Map settings
Disc
Address
book
Video DVD
Calls up
COMAND
Online and
Internet
Personal POIs
Memory
card
AUX
Calls up the
MercedesBenz Mobile
website
Travel guide
MUSIC
REGISTER
Messages
(street name
announcements,
acoustic information during calls,
audio fadeout,
reserve fuel level)
USB memory
O Activates/
deactivates alternative routes
Media Interface
Avoids an area
Bluetooth®
audio
Shows the map ver- AUX
sion
Z
COMAND Online
Symbol ®
292
At a glance
COMAND Online
System menu overview
System
Time
SplitView
Consumption
Seat
Display off
Display settings
O
Switches
the automatic time
settings
on/off
Operates
COMAND
functions
from the
passenger
side
Calls up the
fuel consumption
display
Changes
the driver/
frontpassenger
seat settings
Switches
off the display
Sets the text
reader speed
Sets the
time zone
LINGUATRONIC
settings
Switches to
summer
time
Reversing camera
Manual
time setting
Sets the language
Setting the
time/date
format
Favourites button
O Activates/
deactivates Bluetooth®
Automatic volume
adjustment
Imports/exports
data
Resets COMAND
Online
If equipped with the reversing camera: when the function is activated and COMAND Online
is switched on, the image from the reversing camera is automatically shown in the COMAND
display when reverse gear is engaged.
System.
i If the 360° camera menu item is displayed, Display off can be called up under System
At a glance
293
Switching the COMAND display on/off
X Press the W function button.
or
X Select System in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
In both cases, the system menu appears.
To switch off: select Display off and
press W to confirm.
X To switch on: press one of the function
buttons, e.g. W, Ø or the % back
button.
COMAND Online
X
Cleaning instructions
! Do not touch the COMAND display. The
display has a very sensitive high-gloss surface; there is a risk of scratching. If you
have to clean the screen, however, use a
mild cleaning agent and a soft, lint-free
cloth.
The display must be switched off and have
cooled down before you start cleaning. Clean
the display screen, when necessary, with a
commercially available microfibre cloth and
cleaning agent for TFT/LCD displays. Do not
apply pressure to the display surface when
cleaning it, as this could cause irreversible
damage. Then dry the surface with a dry
microfibre cloth.
Avoid using alcoholic thinners, petrol or abrasive cleaning agents. These could damage the
display surface.
Z
294
At a glance
COMAND Online
COMAND control panel
Function
:
;
=
Switches to radio mode
Switches wavebands
Switches to DAB radio
mode
Switches to navigation
mode
Shows the menu system
Press h repeatedly
• Switches to the audio CD,
audio DVD and MP3 mode
• Switches to memory card
mode
• Switches to MUSIC REGISTER
• Switches to USB storage
device mode
• Switches to Media Interface or audio AUX mode
• Switches to Bluetooth®
audio mode
Page
462
464
Function
?
462
324
324
A
472
472
B
484
472
495
491
C
Calls up the telephone
basic menu:
• Telephony via the Bluetooth® interface
• Telephony via telephone
module with Bluetooth®
(SAP-profile)
Load/eject button
8 Single DVD drive
V DVD changer
Selects a station using the
station list (FM and DAB
radio mode)
Sets a station using the station search function
Rewinds
Selects the previous track
Disc slot
• Loads CDs/DVDs
• Ejects CDs/DVDs
• Updates the digital map
Page
394
421
469
469
464
465
476
475
469
470
382
At a glance
D
E
F
Selects a station using the
station list (FM and DAB
radio mode)
Sets a station using the station search function
Fast forward
Selects the next track
Delete button:
• Deletes characters
• Deletes an entry
Number keypad
• Selects stations via the
station presets
• Stores stations manually
• Authorises mobile phone
• Telephone number entry
• Sends DTMF tones
• Character entry
• Selects a location for the
weather forecast from the
memory
z Displays the current
track being played
g Selects stations by
entering the frequency
manually
g Selects a track
Page
Function
G
Switches COMAND Online
on/off
Adjusts the volume
298
299
H
SD memory card slot
472
I
Calls up the system menu
310
J
Accepts a call
Dials a number
Redials
Accepts a waiting call
396
397
397
399
K
Switches the sound on/off
Switches the hands-free
microphone on/off
Cancels the text message
read-aloud function
Switches off the traffic and
navigation announcements
298
Rejects a call
Ends an active call
Rejects a waiting call
396
400
399
464
465
476
475
307
307
465
466
391
397
398
305
447
Page
L
398
410
298
478
466
475
Z
COMAND Online
Function
295
296
At a glance
COMAND controller
Overview
Example of operation
In the instructions, operating sequences are
described as follows:
Press the $ button.
Radio mode is activated.
X Select Radio by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
X Confirm Station list by pressing W.
The station list appears.
COMAND Online
X
Buttons on the COMAND controller
: COMAND controller
Overview
You can use the COMAND controller to select
the menu items in the COMAND display.
You can:
Rcall
up menus or lists
within menus or lists and
Rexit menus or lists
Rscroll
Operation
:
;
=
?
Back button (Y page 296)
Delete button: (Y page 297)
Seat function button (Y page 318)
Favourites button (Y page 313)
i If your vehicle does not have the seat
function button, it will have two Favourites
buttons.
Example: operating the COMAND controller
The COMAND controller can be:
Rpressed
briefly or pressed and held W
clockwise or anti-clockwise cVd
Rslid left or right XVY
Rslid forwards or back ZVÆ
Rslid diagonally aVb
Rturned
i For AMG vehicles: the COMAND Controller is configured with the : and ; buttons.
Back button
You can use the % back button to exit a
menu or to call up the basic display of the
current operating mode.
At a glance
Delete button
X To delete individual characters: briefly
press the j button.
X To delete an entire entry: press and hold
the j button.
Seat function button
You can use button T to call up the following seat functions:
Rmulticontour
seat (with 4-way lumbar support)
Ractive multicontour seat (dynamic seat and
massage function)
Rbalance (seat heating distribution)
More information on the seat functions
(Y page 318).
Favourites button
You can assign predefined functions to the
favourites button ; and call them up by
pressing the button (Y page 313).
Operating COMAND Online
Selecting a main function
Address entry menu
: Main function bar
Situation: switching from navigation mode
(address entry menu) to the system settings.
X To switch on navigation mode: press the
Ø function button.
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X Select Destination by sliding V Æ and
turning c V d the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
X Select Address entry and press W to
confirm.
The address entry menu appears.
X
Slide Z V the COMAND controller and
switch to main function bar :.
X Select System in the main function bar by
turning c V d the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
The system menu appears.
X
Z
COMAND Online
To exit the menu: briefly press the %
back button.
COMAND Online changes to the next
higher menu level in the current operating
mode.
X To call up the basic display: press and
hold the % back button.
COMAND Online changes to the basic display of the current operating mode.
X
297
At a glance
298
COMAND Online
Selecting the menu of a main function
Selecting a menu item
X
Select the station by turning c V d the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The station is set.
Basic functions of COMAND Online
Switching COMAND Online on/off
X
Example display for audio CD mode and audio
menu (below)
: To call up the audio menu
If one of the navigation, audio, telephone or
video main functions is switched on, triangle : appears next to the entry in the main
function bar. You can now select an associated menu.
The example shows how to call up the audio
menu from audio CD mode (an audio CD is
playing).
X Select Audio in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
The Audio menu appears.
The # dot indicates the currently selected
audio mode.
X
Select another audio mode, e.g. Radio
Radio, by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
Radio mode is activated.
Press the q control knob.
When you switch on COMAND Online, a
warning message will appear.
COMAND Online calls up the previously
selected menu.
If you switch off COMAND Online, playback
of the current audio or video source will
also be switched off.
Switching the sound on/off
Audio/video source sound
X Press the 8 button on the COMAND
controller or the multifunction steering
wheel.
The sound from the respective audio or
video source is switched on or muted.
i When the sound is switched off, you will
see the , symbol in the status bar. If you
change the audio or video source or change
the volume, the sound is automatically
switched on.
i Even if the sound is switched off, you will
still hear traffic and navigation system
announcements.
At a glance
Adjusting the volume for traffic
announcements and navigation
announcements
You can adjust the volume of traffic and navigation announcements independently, relative to the volume of the audio or video
source.
During traffic or navigation announcements:
X
Turn the q control knob.
or
X
Press the W or X button on the multifunction steering wheel.
X
To switch navigation announcements
off: press and hold the 8 button during
an announcement.
Adjusting the volume for phone calls
You can adjust the volume for hands-free
mode during a telephone call.
X
To switch navigation announcements
on again: switch COMAND Online off and
then on again (Y page 298).
or
or
X
Start a new route calculation (Y page 329).
or
X
To have the announcement repeated while
the navigation menu is shown, select +
and press W to confirm (Y page 355).
X
X
Turn the q control knob.
Press the W or X button on the multifunction steering wheel.
Adjusting the sound settings
Calling up the sound menu
Adjusting the volume
Adjusting the volume for the audio or
video source
X Turn the q control knob
or
X Press the W or X button on the multifunction steering wheel.
The volume of the currently selected audio
or video source changes.
You can also adjust the volume for the following:
Rtraffic
announcements
announcements
Rphone calls
RLINGUATRONIC voice control (see the separate operating instructions)
Rnavigation
You can make various sound settings for the
different audio and video sources. This means
that it is possible to set more bass for radio
mode than for audio CD mode, for example.
You can call up the respective sound menu
from the menu of the desired mode.
The example describes how to call up the
sound menu in radio mode.
Z
COMAND Online
Switching Traffic Programme and navigation announcements off and back on
again
X To switch Traffic Programme off: press
and hold the 8 button until the . display disappears from the status bar of the
display.
A confirmation tone sounds.
X To switch the Traffic Programme on
again: press and hold down the 8 button until the . display in the status bar
appears.
A confirmation tone sounds.
299
At a glance
300
X
Press the $ button.
The radio display appears. You will hear the
last station played on the last waveband
selected.
X
Select Sound by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
You can now set the treble, bass and balance for radio mode.
COMAND Online
Setting treble and bass
The balance function is used to control
whether the sound is louder on the driver's or
on the front-passenger side.
The fader function is used to control whether
the sound is louder in the front or in the rear of
the vehicle.
You can adjust the fader depending on the
vehicle model.
Equipped with Bang & Olufsen sound system: for the best sound focus, choose the
setting 0.
X Select Bal/Fad (balance/fader) in the
sound menu by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select a balance setting by sliding XVY the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Surround sound
Setting the bass
X
Select Treble or Bass in the sound menu
by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
An adjustment scale appears.
X
Select a setting by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The setting is saved.
Setting balance and fader
General notes
If your vehicle is equipped with surround
sound, you can use one of two sound systems:
Rharman/kardon® Logic 7® Surround
Sound system
The harman/kardon® Logic 7® Surround
Sound system allows you to set the optimum surround sound in the vehicle interior
(Y page 301).
RBang & Olufsen sound system
(Y page 302)
Both sound systems are available for the following operating modes:
Rradio
(FM only)
radio
Raudio CD
Raudio DVD (MLP, dts, PCM and Dolby Digital audio formats)
RMP3 (including SD memory card and USB
storage device)
RMedia Interface
Roperation with Bluetooth® audio
RDAB
Setting the balance
At a glance
Rvideo
DVD (PCM, dts and Dolby Digital
audio formats)
RAUX
Because many DVDs contain both stereo and
multichannel audio formats, it may be necessary to set the audio format (Y page 515).
Discs which support the audio formats mentioned have the following logos:
harman/kardon® Logic 7® Surround
Sound system
COMAND Online
RTV
301
The example describes how to set the surround sound for radio mode.
X
To switch surround sound on/off: press
the $ button.
The radio display appears. You will hear the
last station played on the last waveband
selected.
Select Sound by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
X Select Surround and press W to confirm.
X
Select Logic7® on or Logic7® off by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
Depending on your selection, surround
sound is switched on or off and the menu is
exited.
X To exit the menu without saving: press
the % back button or slide XVY the
COMAND controller.
X
Z
302
At a glance
COMAND Online
i Please note the following: for the opti-
mum audio experience for all passengers
when Logic7® is switched on, the balance
should be set to the centre of the vehicle
interior.
You will achieve the best sound results by
playing high-quality audio and video DVDs.
MP3 tracks should have a bit rate of at least
128 kbit/s.
Surround-sound playback does not function for mono signal sources, such as the
medium wave range (MW) in radio mode.
If radio reception is poor, e.g. in a tunnel,
you should switch off Logic 7®, as it may
otherwise switch between stereo and
mono and cause temporary sound distortions.
On some stereo recordings, the sound
characteristics may differ from conventional stereo playback.
i The Logic7® on function creates a sur-
round sound experience for every
passenger when playing stereo recordings,
for example. It enables optimum playback
of music and films on CD, audio DVD or
video DVD with multichannel audio formats, such as MLP, dts or Dolby Digital.
This results in sound characteristics as the
sound engineer intended when the original
was recorded.
off, the sound sysi If you select Logic7® off
tem plays the tracks as stored on the
medium. Due to the design of the
passenger compartment, an optimum
audio experience cannot be guaranteed for
all passengers.
Bang & Olufsen sound system
You can optimise the sound in the vehicle with
the Bang & Olufsen sound system and the
True Image
Image™ sound technology. The Sound
Mode function enables you to focus the selected sound setting within the vehicle.
The example describes how to set the optimum sound for radio mode.
Selecting the sound setting for True
Image™
Press a number key, such as $.
X Select Sound by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
X Select Bang&Olufsen and press W to confirm.
A menu appears. A # dot marks the current
setting for True Image™.
X
X
Select reference or surround and press
W to confirm.
Rreference
This setting provides a crisp, clear, luxury
high-end sound setting for a studio atmosphere in your vehicle.
Rsurround
This setting enables a wide-ranging sound
experience for playing music and videos.
At a glance
303
When playing back music from an iPod®,
the bit rate should also be at least
224 kbit/s.
For optimum playback quality:
: Current position of the sound setting
For the optimum musical enjoyment, you can
focus the sound image precisely on one seat.
This means you are right at the centre of the
listening experience, with all system parameters being precisely calculated for the selected position. The result is authentic music
reproduction inside the vehicle.
Focusing the sound setting
Deactivate the "EQ" setting on the
iPod®.
Surround-sound playback does not function for mono signal sources, such as the
medium wave range in radio mode.
On some stereo recordings, the sound
characteristics may differ from conventional stereo playback.
Character entry (telephony)
Example: entering characters
Press the $ button.
X Select Sound by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
X Select Bang&Olufsen and press W to confirm.
A menu appears. A # dot marks the current
setting for Sound Mode.
X
Depending on the vehicle model series
X
Select left
left, all or rear and press W to
confirm.
or
X
X
Select left
left, all or right and press W to
confirm.
To exit the menu: press the % back
button or slide XVY the COMAND controller.
i Please note the following: you will achieve
the best sound results on your Bang & Olufsen sound system by playing high-quality
audio DVDs and CDs.
MP3 tracks should have a bit rate of at least
224 kbit/s.
: * Switches the character bar to upper-
case/lower-case letters
; p Switches the character bar from
upper/lower-case letters to digits
= B Changes the language of the char?F
acter bar
Deletes a character/entry
The example describes how to enter the surname "Schulz".
X Call up the input menu with data fields
(Y page 404).
X Select S and confirm W with the COMAND
controller.
S appears in the data field.
Z
COMAND Online
X
At a glance
304
Select c and confirm W with the COMAND
controller.
The letter c is added to S in the data field.
X Repeat the process until the name has
been entered in full.
Other input menu functions:
Option 2
RDeleting
a character/entry (Y page 305)
between upper/lower-case letters (Y page 304)
RChanging the character set (Y page 305)
RMoving the cursor to the next data field
(Y page 305)
X To enter a phone number: select the digits one by one in the corresponding data
field by turning c V d and sliding Z V Æ the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Saving an entry
Switching data fields
Changing the language of the character
bar
X
COMAND Online
RSwitching
: Cursor in the next data field
; Saves an entry
= 4 and 5 symbols to select a data field
In the input menu, if you want to enter a first
name after you have entered a surname, for
example, proceed as follows to switch
between the data fields:
Option 1
X
Select 4 or 5 in the character bar and
press W to confirm.
The input menu shows the data field selected.
Slide Z V the COMAND controller repeatedly until the character bar disappears.
X Select the data field by sliding ZVÆ and
press W to confirm.
X
X
After making an entry in the input
menu, to create a new entry, for example (Y page 404): select the ¬ symbol
in the character bar by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The entry is stored in the address book.
Further functions available in the character bar
While making an entry in the input menu
(Y page 404):
X Select B and press W to confirm.
X
Select the language by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Switching the character bar to letters
While making an entry in the input menu, to
create a new entry, for example
(Y page 404):
X Select the * (upper case) or E
(lower case) symbol and press W to confirm.
At a glance
Moving the cursor to the next data field
X
To delete an entry: press and hold the
$ button on the control panel until the
entire entry has been deleted.
or
X
Select the F symbol and press and hold W
the COMAND controller until the entire
entry has been deleted.
or
X
Press and hold the j button next to the
COMAND controller until the entire entry is
deleted.
Character entry (navigation)
General notes
: Cursor (repositioned)
; 2 and 3 symbol to reposition the cur-
sor
While making an entry in the input menu
(Y page 404):
X Select the 2 or 3 symbol and press W to
confirm.
Deleting a character/entry
While making an entry in the input menu
(Y page 404):
X To delete characters: press the $ button on the control panel.
or
X Select the F symbol by sliding VÆ and
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
or
X Press the j button next to the
COMAND controller.
The following paragraphs describe how to
enter characters using town input for BERLIN
as an example.
If you want to use the address entry menu to
enter a town, a street or a house number, for
example, COMAND Online offers you:
Ra
list with a character bar (option 1)
Ra selection list (option 2)
You can enter the characters using either the
character bar or the number keypad. In the
selection list, you select an entry to copy it to
the address entry menu.
Option 1: list of towns/streets with
character bar
Town list with character bar
Z
COMAND Online
Changing the character set
While making an entry in the input menu
(Y page 404):
X Select the p symbol and press W to
confirm.
RABC (upper/lower case)
R123 (digits)
ROther (special characters such as @, €,
etc.)
305
At a glance
306
COMAND Online
X
Call up the town list with the character bar
(Y page 327).
The alphabetically sorted town list shows
the first available entries.
Character bar E shows the letters still
available for selection in black D. These
can be selected. In the example, the letter A
is highlighted G. The characters available
depend on the entry made by the user so far
and the data contained in the digital map.
Characters that are no longer available are
shown in grey C.
: Character entered by the user B
; Characters automatically added by
COMAND Online AABE
= List entry that most closely resembles the
current entry by the user
X
? To switch to the selection list
A To delete an entry
B To change the character set (Latin/CyrilC
D
E
F
G
H
lic)
Characters not currently available
Characters currently available
Character bar
To cancel an entry
Currently selected character
List
Entering characters using the character
bar
X
Select E, R, L, I, N in succession, confirming
each by pressing W.
Select B by turning c V d the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
List H shows all available town names
beginning with a B. The list entry most
closely resembling current entry by user =
is always highlighted at the top of the list
(BAABE
BAABE in the example).
All of the characters that have been
entered so far are shown in black (letter
B : in the example). Letters added by
COMAND Online are shown in grey ;
(AABE
AABE in the example).
Entering characters using the number
keypad
X
To enter the letter B: press the l number key twice in quick succession.
The character appears at the bottom of the
display when the key is pressed. The first
available letter is highlighted.
You see which characters you can enter
with that key. Each time the key is pressed,
the next character is selected.
At a glance
X
Rpress
once = A
twice = B
Rpress three times = C
Rpress
X
X
Wait until the character display goes out.
The entries matching your input are shown
in the list.
Enter E, R, L, I, N using the corresponding
keys.
Calling up the list as a selection list
It is also possible to switch from the town list
with character bar to the town selection list at
any time during character input.
X
Further functions in the list with character bar
X
To delete characters: press the $ button on the control panel.
or
X
X
Press the j button next to the
COMAND controller.
X
Select the F symbol in the character bar
by sliding VÆ and turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
To delete an entry: press and hold the
$ button on the control panel.
Slide ZV the COMAND controller repeatedly until the town list appears as a selection list.
Select the desired town from the selection
list.
or
X
or
To accept the first list entry: press and
hold W the COMAND controller until the
address entry menu appears.
The accepted list entry is shown there.
Select¬in the character bar by turning
c V d the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
If there are several entries for a town or if
several towns of the same name are stored,
then ¬ is highlighted in the character bar.
X
Press W the COMAND controller.
Option 2: town list as selection list
or
X
Press and hold the j button next to the
COMAND controller until the entire entry is
deleted.
or
X
Select the F symbol in the character bar
and press and hold W the COMAND controller until the entire entry is deleted.
X
To switch the character set: select the
B symbol and press W to confirm.
This will switch the character set from Latin
to Cyrillic and back.
X
To cancel an entry: select the & symbol
in the bottom left of the character bar and
press W to confirm.
or
X
Press the % back button.
The address entry menu appears.
COMAND Online either shows the selection
list automatically or you can call up the selection list from the list with the character bar.
The example shows the selection list after the
town BERLIN has been entered. The entry is
highlighted automatically.
X Confirm BERLIN G by pressing W the
COMAND controller.
You see the available entries.
Z
COMAND Online
Example: key l:
307
At a glance
308
COMAND Online
RDifferent
X
Confirm BERLIN(1XXXX) by pressing W
the COMAND controller.
The address entry menu appears.
Observe the information relating to destination entry (Y page 326).
SPLITVIEW
Operation
SPLITVIEW allows you to simultaneously use
different COMAND Online functions on the
front-passenger side and on the driver's side.
Different content is seen depending on your
perspective when viewing the display.
The "Navi" function, for example, can be used
from the driver's side while a video is watched
from the front-passenger side.
SPLITVIEW is operated with the remote control from the front-passenger side.
To do so, use the cordless headphones. Using
the headphones on the correct sides ensures
an optimal sound.
You can connect your own headphones to a
special headphones jack. You can use the
remote control to operate them.
media can be used on the driver
and front-passenger sides as long as they
use different media sources. Example: if a
medium from the DVD changer is being
played on the driver's side, then another
medium that is also played from the DVD
changer cannot be played separately on
the front-passenger side. However, other
media can be used at the same time on the
front-passenger side, including radio,
memory card, MUSIC REGISTER, Media
Interface, USB or AUX.
RIf you use the same medium on both sides,
you can both carry out the respective settings.
RInternet use is only available at any one
time to the driver or the front passenger.
A corresponding message appears on the
display.
RInternet can only be used, if it is set and
connected via a telephone on the driver's
side.
RThe multifunction steering wheel can only
be used for functions which relate to the
driver's side.
Switching SPLITVIEW on/off
Points to remember
Switching on SPLITVIEW
RYou
Select System in the main function bar by
turning c V d the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
X Select ; in the menu bar and confirm.
SPLITVIEW symbol : appears in the display, and display ; switches to off
off.
can only adjust the volume for the
headphones supplied, directly on the headphones.
ROnly entertainment functions, i.e. audio,
TV, video and Internet, for example, may be
used with SPLITVIEW.
X
At a glance
309
The front passenger sees the display of the
function last activated. If the switch-on
time was longer than 30 minutes previously, the display from the driver's side is
shown.
The front passenger can now call up the
COMAND Online functions with the remote
control.
X
Select ; in the menu bar by turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
SPLITVIEW symbol : disappears from the
display. Display ; switches to on
on.
i If COMAND Online has already been
switched on, you can also use the remote
control to switch SPLITVIEW on and off.
Make sure that the SPLITVIEW symbol is
set on the remote control thumbwheel
(Y page 520).
The SPLITVIEW display remains on for approximately 30 minutes after the key has been
turned to position 0 in the ignition lock. After
this time or after the key has been removed,
the settings on the front-passenger side are
saved for approximately 30 minutes longer.
After this period, reactivation on the frontpassenger side means that the settings from
the driver's side will be used.
Transferring the driver's website
To switch on SPLITVIEW: select Settings
from the main function bar by turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X Select ; in the menu bar and confirm.
SPLITVIEW symbol : appears in the display, and display ; switches to off
off.
X
X
Select ® in the main function bar with the
remote control.
A menu appears with the following options:
ROwner's
Manual
URL
RInternet Favourites
RMercedes-Benz Apps
RInternet Radio
RMercedes Mobile website
RTransfer Driver's Website
X Select Transfer Driver's Website with
the remote control.
You see the last website called up by the
driver.
REnter
Transferring a destination to the driver
Using SPLITVIEW you can select a destination
from the front-passenger side and transfer
this to the driver's side.
X To switch on SPLITVIEW: select System
from the main function bar by turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X Select ; in the menu bar and confirm.
SPLITVIEW symbol : appears in the display, and display ; switches to off
off.
X Select ® in the main function bar with the
remote control.
A menu appears.
X Select Mercedes-Benz Apps with the
remote control.
You see the selection of Mercedes-Benz
Apps.
Z
COMAND Online
Switching off SPLITVIEW
System settings
310
Select Google Local Search with the
remote control.
Using a menu you can select a category for
the destination.
X Select At current position,
position for example.
Using a menu you can determine the type
of search enquiry.
X Select Enter search term:
term:, for example.
An input field appears.
X Enter the destination with the remote control and confirm the entry with b.
You see the results list from Google.
X Select the exact destination with the
remote control.
An additional menu appears.
X Select Navigate to.
to
X A window appears on the driver's side with
the message: Accept the navigation
data from Mercedes-Benz Apps?
COMAND Online
X
Press W.
Select System by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Display and press W to confirm.
X Select Brightness and press W to confirm.
X Adjust the brightness by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
X
System settings
Display design
Features of your COMAND Online
Your COMAND Online display features optimised designs for operation during daytime
and night-time hours. You can customise the
design by manually selecting day or night
design, or opt for an automatic setting.
X Press W.
X Select System by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Display and press W to confirm.
X Select Day design,
design Night design or
Automatic by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
A dot indicates the current setting.
This Supplement describes all the standard
and optional equipment for your COMAND
Online system, as available at the time of
going to print. Country-specific differences
are possible. Please note that your
COMAND Online system may not be equipped with all the features described.
Display settings
Setting the brightness
The brightness detected by the display light
sensor affects the setting options for this
function.
Design
Explanation
Day design
The display is set permanently to day design.
Night design
The display is set permanently to night design.
Automatic
If the Automatic setting
is selected, COMAND
Online evaluates the
readings from the automatic vehicle light sensor and automatically
switches between the
display designs.
Time settings
General notes
If COMAND Online is equipped with a navigation system and has GPS reception, COMAND
Online automatically sets the time and date.
You can change the time in minute increments. The date can also be changed.
i If you adjust the time in minute incre-
ments, any time zone settings and settings
for changing between summer and standard time are lost. Switching between summer and standard time (Y page 311).
i The following navigation system functions
require the time, time zone and summer/
standard time to be set correctly in order to
work properly:
Rroute
guidance on routes with timedependent traffic guidance
Rcalculation of expected time of arrival
i Use this function to set the time for all
displays in the vehicle.
Setting the time/date format
X
Press the W button.
X
Select Time by turning c V d the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Format and press W to confirm.
The # symbols show the current settings.
X
Set the format by turning c V d the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Abbreviation
Meaning
DD . MM . YY
Day . Month . Year
(date format, two digits)
MM / DD / YYYY
Month/Day/Year
date format, year (all
four digits)
YY / MM / DD
Year/Month/Day
date format, year (two
digits)
HH : MM
(24 hrs)
Hours : Minutes
(24 hour time format)
HH : MM (AM/PM) Hours : Minutes
(AM/PM time format)
Adjusting the time zone and switching
to summer time
X
Press W.
X
Select Time by turning c V d the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
Select Time zone and press W to confirm.
A list of countries or time zones appears.
The # dot indicates the current setting.
X Select the country or time zone by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
A time zone list may also be displayed,
depending on the country selected.
X Select the time zone and press W to confirm.
The entry for the Automatic time set‐
tings is accepted.
X
Subsequent operation depends on whether
the automatic changeover function to summer time is available.
Z
311
COMAND Online
System settings
System settings
312
X
To change manually: select ON or OFF and
press W to confirm.
X
To change to automatic time: select
Automatic and press W to confirm.
The entry for the Automatic time set‐
tings is accepted.
To switch the automatic time setting
off/on: press the W button.
X Select Time by turning c V d the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X Press W to confirm the Automatic time
settings.
settings
Switch the automatic time setting off ª or
on again O.
To switch on: the menu item is switched
on as the default setting. If the Automatic
time settings is switched off and you
switch it on again, the last settings for the
time zone and summer time changeover
are selected.
To switch off: the time zone is deselected
and the summer time is switched off. If
Automatic is set for the summer time
changeover, a prompt will appear asking
whether this should be maintained.
X Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
COMAND Online
X
Setting the time manually
X
X
Press the W button.
Select Time by turning c V d the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
Select Set time manually and press W
to confirm.
X Set the time by turning c V d the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
The time is accepted.
X
Text reader settings
X
Press the W button.
X
Select System by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Text reader speed and press W
to confirm.
A list appears. The # dot indicates the current setting.
X
Select a setting by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
LINGUATRONIC settings
Opening/closing the help window
The help window provides information in addition to the audible instructions during individualisation and during the subsequent voice
control.
X Press W.
X Select System by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Linguatronic and press W to confirm.
X
Select Help window and press W to confirm.
You have switched the help window on O
or off ª.
Individualisation
Using individualisation, you can fine-tune LINGUATRONIC to your own voice and thus
System settings
Bluetooth® settings
ported by LINGUATRONIC, English will be
selected.
X Press the W button.
X
Select System by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Language and press W to confirm.
The list of languages appears. The # dot
indicates the current setting.
X
Select the language by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
COMAND loads the selected language and
sets it.
General information about Bluetooth®
Bluetooth® technology is a standard for
short-range wireless data transmissions up to
approximately 10 metres. Bluetooth® allows,
for example, the exchange of vCards.
i If you are using Arabic map data, the text
information can also be shown in Arabic on
the navigation map. To do this, select Eng‐
lish (Arabic map) as the language from
the list of languages. Navigation announcements are then made in Arabic.
Bluetooth® is a registered trademark of Bluetooth Special Interest Group (SIG) Inc.
Activating/deactivating Bluetooth®
X
Press the W button.
The system menu appears.
X
Select System by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Activate Bluetooth and press W
to confirm.
This switches Bluetooth® on O or off ª.
Setting the system language
This function allows you to determine the language for the menu displays and the navigation announcements. The selected language
affects the characters available for entry.
The navigation announcements are not available in all languages. If a language is not available, the navigation announcements will be in
English.
If you change the system language, the language for LINGUATRONIC will also be
changed. If the selected language is not sup-
Assigning a favourites button
To assign a favourites button: press the
W button.
X Select System by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Assign as favourite and press
W to confirm.
The list of predefined functions appears.
The dot # indicates the currently selected
function.
X Select the function by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The favourites button is assigned the selected function.
X Example: to call up a favourite: press the
g favourites button.
This calls up the predefined function.
X
Z
COMAND Online
improve voice recognition. See the separate
operating instructions.
313
314
System settings
You can select the following predefined functions in a menu:
COMAND Online
RSplitView
on/off: you can switch the
on/off
screen view for the front passenger on or
off.
RDisplay off/on:
off/on you can switch the display off or on.
RFull screen: 'Clock':
'Clock' you can call up
the full screen with the clock.
R® Menu
Menu: you can call up the COMAND
Online and Internet functions.
R360° camera
camera: you can call up the picture of
the 360° camera.
RFull screen: 'Map':
'Map' you can call up the
full screen with the map.
RSpoken driving tip:
tip you can call up the
current driving recommendation.
RDisplay traffic messages
messages: you can call
up traffic reports.
RNavigate to 'Home address':
address' you can
start route guidance to your home address
if you have already entered and saved the
address (Y page 330).
RDetour menu:
menu you can call up the Detour
menu and then block a section of the route
and recalculate the route (Y page 357).
RCompass screen
screen: you can call up the compass.
Importing/exporting data
General notes
! When data is being copied to the USB
stick or the memory card, the stick or the
card must not be removed under any circumstances. Doing so runs the risk of data
loss.
Using this function, you can:
Rtransfer
your personal COMAND data from
one system/vehicle to another
Rmake a backup copy of your personal data
(export data) and load it again (import
data).
Rprotect your data from unwanted export by
activating a pin prompt (presetting: deactivated ª).
You can either use an SD memory card or a
USB storage device (e.g. a USB stick) as temporary storage.
Activating/deactivating PIN protection
X
Press the W button.
The system menu appears.
X
Select System by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Select Import/export data and press W
to confirm.
X Select Activate PIN protection and
press W to confirm.
Activate O or deactivate ª PIN protection. When activating PIN protection, you
will be prompted to enter a PIN.
X
System settings
315
Importing/exporting data
Enter a 4-digit PIN, select¬and press W
to confirm.
You will be prompted to enter the PIN
again.
X Re-enter the PIN, select ¬ and press W
to confirm.
The PIN prompt now protects your personal
data from unwanted export.
COMAND Online
X
i If you deactivate your PIN protection, you
will first be prompted to enter your PIN. If
you have forgotten your PIN, a MercedesBenz service station can deactivate your
PIN protection for you. Alternatively, you
can deactivate PIN protection by resetting
your personal COMAND data
(Y page 316).
X
Insert the SD memory card (Y page 472).
or
Connect a USB device (e.g. a USB memory
stick) (Y page 472).
X Press the W button.
The system menu appears.
X
X
Select System by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Select Import/export data and press W
to confirm.
X Select Import data or Export data and
press W to confirm.
X
Z
Vehicle functions
316
COMAND Online
mended before handing over or selling the
vehicle, for example.
Data on the internal hard drive, e.g. music
files in the MUSIC REGISTER, will be deleted.
You can also delete music files from the
MUSIC REGISTER using the "Delete all music
files" function (Y page 486).
X Press the W function button.
If PIN protection is activated, a PIN prompt
appears when you select Export data.
data
X Enter the PIN, select¬and press W to
confirm.
You can now proceed in the same way as if
PIN protection was deactivated.
X To select a preset: select Memory card or
USB storage and press W to confirm.
X
Select All data and press W to confirm.
This function exports all the data to the
selected disc.
or
X
X
Select the data type and press W to confirm.
Depending on the previous entry, select the
data type for the export O or not ª.
Select Continue and press W to confirm.
i Personal music files in the MUSIC REGISTER cannot be saved and imported again
using this function.
Reset function
You can completely reset COMAND Online to
the factory settings. Amongst other things,
this will delete all personal COMAND Online
data. This includes the station presets,
entries in the destination memory and in the
list of previous destinations in the navigation
system and address book entries. In addition,
any activated PIN protection, which you have
used to prevent unauthorised export of your
data, will be deactivated. Resetting is recom-
X
Select System by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Reset and press W to confirm.
A warning message and prompt appear
asking whether you wish to reset.
Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, a prompt will appear again
asking whether you really wish to reset to
the factory settings.
X Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, a message will be shown.
COMAND Online is reset and restarted.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
X
Vehicle functions
Features of your COMAND Online
This Supplement describes all the standard
and optional equipment for your COMAND
Online system, as available at the time of
going to print. Country-specific differences
are possible. Please note that your
COMAND Online system may not be equipped with all the features described.
Vehicle functions
i Calling up the climate status display is
dependent on the climate control system in
your vehicle.
Example settings for the defrost function (top) and
for the climate mode in automatic mode
Example: the climate control status display in the
COMAND display
If you change the settings of the climate control system, the climate status display
appears for three seconds at the bottom of
the screen in the COMAND display. You will
see the current settings of the various climate
control functions.
Overview of climate control systems, see separate vehicle operating instructions.
The climate control status display appears
when:
X
You turn the temperature control and set
the temperature.
or
X
You turn the control to set the airflow.
or
X
You press one of the following buttons:
K Increases air flow
I Decreases air flow
¿ Switches climate control on/off
á Switches the ZONE function on/off
à Controls the air conditioning automatically
ñ Sets the climate control style in automatic mode (FOCUS/MEDIUM/DIFFUSE)
_ Sets the air distribution
M, P or O Sets the air distribution
¬ Turns on the defrost function
X
To hide the display: turn or press the
COMAND controller.
or
X
Press one of the buttons on
COMAND Online.
Fuel consumption indicator
Overview
Depending on the vehicle equipment and the
installed engine variant, fuel consumption
can be displayed in the COMAND display.
If your vehicle is a hybrid vehicle and the
installed engine variant supports it, you can
call up other displays (see the separate operating instructions).
Calling up/exiting the display
Z
COMAND Online
Climate control status display
317
Vehicle functions
318
To call up the full-screen display: press
the W button.
X In the system menu, slide ZV the
COMAND controller up until the Full
screen option is selected.
X Press W the COMAND controller.
The system display is shown as full screen
(without system menu).
X Slide XVY the COMAND controller repeatedly until the fuel consumption indicator
appears.
The COMAND display shows the fuel consumption for the last 15 minutes of the
journey.
X To exit the full-screen display: press W
the COMAND controller.
The system menu appears.
COMAND Online
X
Every bar of the graph displays the average
value for one minute.
The fuel consumption display may differ from
the display in the FROM START trip computer
in the Trip menu; see the vehicle Owner's
Manual.
Driving conditions menu (Active Body
Control)
General notes
On vehicles with Active Body Control (ABC),
you can display some driving systems and
additional information in the COMAND display.
Calling up drive status regulator (ABC)
Press W.
In the system menu, slide ZV the
COMAND controller up until the display/
selection window is selected.
X Slide XVY the COMAND controller repeatedly until the drive status regulator (ABC)
appears.
The corresponding displays appear in the
COMAND display.
X
X
Details on the displays:
Rfor
vehicles except AMG vehicles; see the
separate vehicle Owner's Manual
Rfor AMG vehicles; see the separate vehicle
Owner's Manual
Exiting the display
X
Slide XVY the COMAND controller until
the desired display (clock or fuel consumption) is shown.
Seat functions
Overview
Using the T button next to the COMAND
controller or the Seat menu item in the system menu, you can call up different setting
functions: The following settings depend on
the type of seat and the vehicle model series:
Rseat
cushion length
Rbackrest side bolsters
Rlumbar
Rbalance
Rcushion side bolsters
Rdriving dynamics
Rmassage
i You also can save and recall the current
settings of a seat function using the memory button and the corresponding memory
position switch; see the separate vehicle
Owner's Manual.
The massage function cannot be started or
stopped using the memory button.
Vehicle functions
Selecting the seat
319
Slide cVd or turn ZVÆ the COMAND Controller and press W to confirm.
X To exit the menu: press the % back
button.
X
First select the seat which you wish to adjust.
This function is not available for all vehicles.
X Press the T or W button.
X Select Seat and press W to confirm.
X To switch to the lower line, for both options
slide VÆ the COMAND controller.
X Select Driver's seat or Front-pass.
seat by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Adjustment functions
Adjusting the seat cushion length
The availability of this function depends on
the type of seat and the vehicle model series.
This function allows you to adjust the height
of the seat cushion.
X Select the seat (Y page 319).
X Select Seat surface by turning cVd the
COMAND Controller and press W to confirm.
A scale appears.
COMAND Online
Adjusting the seat contour in the lumbar
region of the seat backrest
The availability of this function depends on
the type of seat and the vehicle model series.
This function allows you to adjust the air
cushions in the lumbar region of the backrest
(4-way lumbar support).
X Select the seat (Y page 319).
X Select Lumbar by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
A crosshair appears. You can make two
settings:
RVertical: to move the point of greatest
lumbar support up or down
RHorizontal: to adjust the amount of support
X Slide ZVÆ or XVY the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
X To exit the menu: press the % back
button.
Adjusting the sides of the seat backrest
(backrest side bolsters)
The availability of this function depends on
the type of seat and the vehicle model series.
Z
Vehicle functions
320
Select the seat (Y page 319).
Select Seat sides by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
A scale appears.
X Slide cVd or turn ZVÆ the COMAND Controller and press W to confirm.
X To exit the menu: press the % back
button.
X
COMAND Online
X
Select the seat (Y page 319).
X Select Backr. sides by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
A scale appears.
X Turn cVd or slide ZVÆ the COMAND Controller and press W to confirm.
X To exit the menu: press the % back
button.
X
Balance
The availability of this function depends on
the vehicle model series.
i For vehicle model series with a dynamic
multicontour seat: if the driving dynamics
are activated and respond to a change of
direction (e.g. when cornering), the backrest side bolsters cannot be temporarily
adjusted.
Adjusting the seat side bolsters
The availability of this function depends on
the type of seat and the vehicle model series.
This function allows you to adjust the air
cushions in the seat side bolsters.
The balance function controls the distribution
of heat on the seat backrest and cushion.
The balance function influences the currently
set heating level of the seat heating; see the
separate vehicle Owner's Manual.
X Select the seat (Y page 319).
X Select Balance by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
A scale appears and shows the current setting. Positive values indicate the heat output for the seat backrest, negative values
indicate the heat output for the seat cushion. The intensity is indicated by an orange
bar in the stylised seat above the scale.
Vehicle functions
R0 - backrest and seat cushion are heated
equally to the maximum level
to 3 - the heat output to the seat cushion is reduced in one-third increments
R-1 to -3 - the heat output to the backrest
is reduced in one-third increments
X Slide cVd or turn XVY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X To exit the menu: press the % back
button.
R1
Slide cVd or turn ZVÆ the COMAND Controller and press W to confirm.
The massage function runs for approximately 15 to 25 minutes, depending on the
setting.
X To exit the menu: press the % back
button.
X
Setting the driving dynamics
This function is available on vehicle model
series with a dynamic multicontour seat.
COMAND Online
The values stand for:
Massage function
The availability of this function depends on
the type of seat and the vehicle model series.
Select the seat (Y page 319).
X Select Dynamic seat by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
A scale appears.
You can select:
X
Example display (M-Class or GL-Class)
X
X
Select the seat (Y page 319).
Select Massage by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
A list appears.
You can select different types of massage
function:
R0:
Off
Slow
R2: Slow
R3: Fast
R4: Fast
R1:
and
and
and
and
321
R 0:
Off
level 1 (medium setting)
R2: level 2 (high setting)
X Slide cVd or turn ZVÆ the COMAND Controller and press W to confirm.
X To exit the menu: press the % back
button.
R 1:
gentle
vigorous
gentle
vigorous
Z
Vehicle functions
322
COMAND Online
Resetting all adjustments
Select the seat (Y page 319).
X Select Reset all by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
A query appears.
X Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
After you select Yes
Yes, all seat adjustments
are reset to the default values (factory setting).
X
Reversing camera
The reversing camera is only an aid. It is not a
substitute for your attention to the immediate
surroundings. The responsibility for safe
manoeuvring and parking remains with you.
Make sure that there are no persons, animals
or objects in range while manoeuvring and
parking.
The image from the reversing camera is
shown in the COMAND display when reverse
gear is engaged if:
Ryour
vehicle is equipped with a reversing
camera
RCOMAND Online is switched on
Rthe Activation by R gear function is
activated.
If the function is activated, the COMAND display will automatically switch back to the previously selected display as soon as you shift
out of reverse gear.
i For further information on the reversing
camera, see separate vehicle Owner's
Manual.
X
Press the W function button.
The system menu appears.
X
Select Settings by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Rear view camera and press W to
confirm.
X
Select Activation by R gear and press
W to confirm.
The function is switched on O or off ª,
depending on the previous status.
Night View Assist Plus
On vehicles with Night View Assist Plus you
can have the image from Night View Assist
Plus shown on the COMAND display.
X Switch on COMAND Online (Y page 298).
X Activate Night View Assist Plus; see the
separate operating instructions.
The image from Night View Assist Plus
appears in the COMAND display.
To adjust the brightness: select Bright‐
ness by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Turn cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
X
X
Switching automatic activation on/off:
select Night View Assist auto. acti‐
vation and press W to confirm.
Switch the option on O or off ª.
Option switched on: while using other functions e.g. the navigation system, Night View
Assist Plus is active in the background. In
the dark, in unlit surroundings and at
speeds in excess of 60 km/h, the Night
View image is automatically displayed as
soon as pedestrians or animals are detected.
Navigation
To switch off the display: select Back and
press W to confirm or press the % button.
Navigation
Features of your COMAND Online
This Supplement describes all the standard
and optional equipment for your COMAND
Online system, as available at the time of
going to print. Country-specific differences
are possible. Please note that your
COMAND Online system may not be equipped with all the features described.
Introduction
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
You must observe the legal requirements for
the country in which you are currently driving
when operating COMAND Online.
COMAND Online calculates the route to the
destination without taking account of the following, for example:
Rtraffic
lights
Rstop and give way signs
Rparking or stopping restrictions
Rroad narrowing
Rother road and traffic rules and regulations
COMAND Online may give incorrect driving
recommendations if the data on the digital
map does not correspond to the actual conditions. For example, a route may have been
diverted or the direction of a one-way street
may have changed.
For this reason, you must always observe
road and traffic rules and regulations during
your journey. Road and traffic rules and regulations always have priority over the system's driving recommendations.
General notes
Operational readiness of the navigation
system
In vehicles for certain countries, the navigation system is not operational immediately
after delivery. The digital map is not preinstalled.
If this is the case, the following message
appears in the display after you switch to navigation mode:
Please insert the map DVD to acti‐
vate navigation.
navigation
X To install the digital map: (Y page 382).
The navigation system must determine the
position of the vehicle before first use or
whenever operational status is restored.
Therefore, you may have to drive for a while
before precise route guidance is possible.
GPS reception
Correct functioning of the navigation system
depends, amongst other things, on GPS
reception. In certain situations, GPS reception may be impaired, there may be interference or there may be no reception at all, e.g.
in tunnels or multi-storey car parks.
i The functionality of a roof aerial (tele-
phone, GPS) may be impaired if roof carriers are used.
Entry restriction
On vehicles for certain countries, there is a
restriction on entering data.
The restriction is active above a vehicle speed
of approximately 5 km/h. The restriction is
Z
COMAND Online
X
323
Navigation
324
deactivated as soon as the vehicle speed
drops below approximately 3 km/h.
When the restriction is active, certain entries
cannot be made. This will be indicated by the
fact that certain menu items are greyed out
and cannot be selected.
The following entries are not possible, for
example:
Rentering
the destination town and street
a destination via the map
Rentering POIs in the vicinity of a town or via
a name search
Rediting entries
Rdirect entry using the number keypad
Other entries are possible, however, such as
entering POIs in the vicinity of the destination
or current position.
COMAND Online
Rentering
Map without the menu; route guidance inactive
: Current vehicle position
; Map orientation selected
= Map scale selected
i Route guidance active means that you
have entered a destination and that
COMAND Online has calculated the route.
The display shows the route, changes of
direction and lane recommendations. Navigation announcements guide you to your
destination.
Route guidance inactive means that no
destination has been entered and no route
has been calculated yet.
Switching to navigation mode
Showing/hiding the menu
You can show or hide the menu on the map.
To hide the menu: slide ZV the COMAND
controller and, when the Full screen
menu item is shown, press W to confirm.
or
X Press the % back button.
The map can be seen in the full-screen display.
X
Map showing the menu; route guidance inactive
: Status bar
; Main function bar
= Current vehicle position
? Navigation menu bar
Press the Ø function button.
The map is displayed with the menu either
shown or hidden.
or
X Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
The map is displayed with the menu shown.
X
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller when the map is shown in fullscreen display.
Navigation
Setting route type and route options
Route settings menu (start of menu)
: To select the route type
; To set route options
Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Route Settings and press W to
confirm.
The route settings menu appears.
X Select a route type and press W to confirm.
A filled circle indicates the current setting.
X
X
Select the route option(s) and press W to
confirm.
The route options are switched on O or off
ª, depending on the previous status.
i If you change the route type and/or the
route options while route guidance is
active, COMAND Online will calculate a
new route.
If you change the route type and/or the
route options while route guidance is inactive, COMAND Online uses the new setting
for the next route guidance.
Route guidance active: a destination has
been entered and the route has been calculated.
Route guidance inactive: no destination
has been entered yet and no route has been
calculated yet.
You can select the following route types:
RFast
route: COMAND Online calculates a
route
route with the shortest (minimised) journey
time.
RDynamic route:
route is the same route type as
Fast route.
route In addition, COMAND Online
takes into account any live traffic information or RDS-TMC traffic reports that it
receives during route guidance. The navigation system can help you avoid a traffic
jam, for example. If a faster route is determined due to a received RDS-TMC traffic
announcement, the navigation system
changes the route. If possible, it will bypass
blocked roads.
REco route:
route the Eco route (economical
route) is a variant of the Fast route type.
COMAND Online will attempt to minimise
the journey distance at the expense of a
slightly increased journey time.
RShort route:
route COMAND Online calculates
a route with the shortest possible (minimised) route distance.
i RDS-TMC is not available in all countries.
i The route calculated may, for example,
include ferry connections, even if the
Avoid ferries route option is switched
on.
In some cases, e.g. when calculating particularly long routes, COMAND Online may
not be able to take all the selected route
options into account.
i To avoid toll roads: route calculation is
performed excluding sections (e.g. tunnels,
stretches of motorway, inner cities) which
require you to pay a fee (toll).
To avoid routes requiring a special toll
sticker: route calculation is performed
excluding route networks (e.g. a country's
motorway network) which require you to
pay a fee (vignette). A vignette allows temporary use of the route network. Example
time limits are 10 days, 2 months or 1 year.
Z
COMAND Online
Basic settings
325
Navigation
326
X
To exit the menu: slide XVY the COMAND
controller.
Destination entry
COMAND Online
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
i You can only enter those towns, streets,
postcodes etc. that are stored in the digital
map. This means that for some countries,
you cannot enter postcodes, for example.
This step-by-step example of how to enter an
address uses the following example data:
Germany
Berlin
Unstrutstraße 1
You can of course enter any country, town,
street and house number desired and enter,
for example your home address (My address).
Calling up the address entry menu
You must observe the legal requirements for
the country in which you are currently driving
when operating COMAND Online.
Entering a destination by address
Introduction
Options for destination entry:
Renter
the country, town/postcode, street
and house number
Renter the country, town/postcode and
street
Renter the country, town/postcode and
centre
Renter the country, town/postcode, street
and junction
Renter the country and town
Country and town are sufficient to start navigating. You can enter either a town or a postcode. By entering further address data such
as the street and house number, you can
specify the destination more precisely.
i You can only enter a street, house num-
ber, junction or centre once you have
entered a country and a town or postcode.
Address entry menu
Calling up the address entry menu
Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Destination in the lower menu bar
by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
X
X
Select Address entry and press W to
confirm.
The address entry menu appears. If you
have previously entered a destination, this
will be shown in the display.
Depending on the sequence in which you
enter the address and on the data status of
the digital map, some menu items may not be
available at all or may not yet be available.
Example: after country selection the Street
Street,
No., Centr. (centre), Junct. (junction), POI
No.
POI,
Save and Start menu items are not yet avail-
Navigation
Entering the country, city, street, house
number
by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
or
X
Slide ZV the COMAND controller once or
twice.
X
Select GERMANY by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The address entry menu appears again.
GERMANY has now been entered.
Entering a town
Call up the address entry menu
(Y page 326).
X Select Town in the address entry menu by
turning cVd and sliding ZVÆ the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
You will see the town list either with the
character bar (option 1) or as a selection
list (option 2).
X
Country list with character bar
Enter country
Call up the address entry menu
(Y page 326).
X Select Country in the address entry menu
by turning cVd and sliding ZVÆ the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
You see the list of countries with the character bar.
Entering characters using town input as an
example (Y page 305).
X
Town list with character bar
Option 1: town list with character bar
X
Enter BERLIN
BERLIN. Entering characters using
town input as an example (Y page 305).
Country list as selection list
X
To switch to the country list as a selection list: select ¬ in the character bar
Z
COMAND Online
able. The Postcode menu item will not be
available unless the digital map contains
postcodes.
327
Navigation
COMAND Online
328
List of towns as selection list
Option 2: town list as selection list
X
Select BERLIN by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Entries with the G: icon cannot be
uniquely assigned. Another selection list is
shown.
Street list with character bar
Option 1: street list with character bar
X
Enter UNSTRUTSTRASSE
UNSTRUTSTRASSE. Entering characters using town input as an example
(Y page 305).
Street list as selection list
Option 2: street list as selection list
X
Select BERLIN(1XXXX) by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The address entry menu appears again.
BERLIN(1XXXX) has now been entered.
X
Select UNSTRUTSTRASSE by turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X
Irrespective of the option, press W to confirm your selection.
The address entry menu appears again.
UNSTRUTSTRASSE has now been entered.
Entering a street
Call up the address entry menu
(Y page 326).
X Select Street in the address entry menu
by turning cVd and sliding ZVÆ the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
You will see the street list either with the
character bar (option 1) or as a selection
list (option 2).
X
Entering a house number
Call up the address entry menu
(Y page 326).
X Select No. in the address entry menu by
turning cVd and sliding ZVÆ the
X
Navigation
Starting route calculation
Address entry menu with destination address
: Destination address
; To start route calculation
House number list with character bar
Option 1: house number list with character
bar
X
Enter 1. Entering characters using town
input as an example (Y page 305).
House number list as selection list
Option 2: house number list as selection list
X
Select 1 by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Irrespective of the option, press W to confirm your selection.
The address entry menu appears again. 1
has now been entered.
You can now have COMAND Online calculate
a route to the destination address you have
entered, or you can save it.
X Call up the address entry menu
(Y page 326).
X In the address entry menu, confirm Start
by pressing W.
If no other route has been calculated, route
calculation starts immediately (option 1). If
another route has already been calculated
(route guidance is active), a prompt
appears (option 2).
Option 1 – no route guidance active: route
calculation starts. While route calculation is in
progress, an arrow will indicate the direction
to your destination. Below this, you will see a
message, e.g. Calculating fast
route....
route...
Once the route has been calculated, route
guidance begins. If the vehicle is travelling on
a non-digitised road, the system displays the
linear distance to the destination, the direction of the destination and the Off road
message. In this case, the display will be
greyed out.
Option 2 – route guidance is already
active: if route guidance is already active, a
prompt will appear asking whether you wish
to terminate the currently active route guidance.
Z
COMAND Online
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
You will see the house number list either
with the character bar (option 1) or as a
selection list (option 2).
329
Navigation
330
X
Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, COMAND Online will stop
route guidance and start route calculation
for the new destination.
If you select No
No, COMAND Online will continue with the active route guidance.
COMAND Online
i Route calculation takes a certain amount
of time. The time depends on the distance
from the destination, for example.
COMAND Online calculates the route using
the digital map data.
The calculated route may differ from the
ideal route, e.g. due to roadworks or incomplete map data. Please also refer to the
notes about the digital map (Y page 382).
Entering and storing your home address
You can either enter your home address for
the first time (option 1) or edit a previously
stored home address (option 2).
X Option 1: enter the address, e.g. a town,
street and house number (Y page 326).
X Call up the address entry menu
(Y page 326).
X Select Save in the address entry menu by
turning cVd and sliding ZVÆ the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Save as "My address" and press
W to confirm.
COMAND Online stores your home address
as My address in the destination memory.
X
Option 2: proceed as described under
"Option 1".
A prompt appears asking whether the current home address should be overwritten.
X
Select Yes and press W to confirm.
After selecting Yes
Yes, the Saving proce‐
dure successful message appears.
Entering a postcode, centre and junction
Entering a postcode
Entering a postcode will delete a previously
entered town.
Call up the address entry menu
(Y page 326).
X Select Postcode in the address entry menu
by turning cVd and sliding ZVÆ the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
You will see the postcode list either with the
character bar (option 1) or as a selection
list (option 2).
X
List of postcodes with character bar
Option 1: postcode list with character bar
X
Enter a postcode. Entering characters
using town input as an example
(Y page 305).
Postcode list as selection list
Option 2: postcode list as selection list
X
Select the desired postcode by turning
cVd the COMAND controller.
X
Irrespective of the option, press W to confirm your selection.
If COMAND Online can assign the postcode
to one town unambiguously (e.g. 74172 for
NECKARSULM), the address entry menu
Navigation
331
appears again. You can now complete the
address, e.g. by entering a street.
If COMAND Online cannot assign the postcode unambiguously to a specific address,
the address entry menu also appears again.
The postcode is automatically entered. You
can now enter the street for a more precise
location. Only streets in the area covered
by the entered postcode are available.
Start route calculation (Y page 329).
Entering a town centre
Entering a centre will, for example, delete a
previously entered street.
X Call up the address entry menu
(Y page 326).
X Select Centr. (centre) in the address entry
menu by turning cVd and sliding ZVÆ the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
You will see the centre list either with the
character bar (option 1) or as a selection
list (option 2).
Centre list as selection list
Option 2: centre list as a selection list
X
Select a centre by turning cVd the
COMAND controller.
For options 1 and 2:
Confirm your selection by pressing W.
The address entry menu appears again. The
centre selected has been entered.
X Start route calculation (Y page 329).
X
Entering a junction
Entering a junction will delete a previously
entered house number.
X Call up the address entry menu
(Y page 326).
X Select Junct. (junction) in the address
entry menu by turning cVd and sliding
ZVÆ the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
You will see the junction list either with the
character bar (option 1) or as a selection
list (option 2).
Town centre list with character bar
Option 1: centre list with character bar
Enter a centre. Entering characters using
town input as an example (Y page 305).
i In big cities, you can also enter the centres of districts.
X
Junction list with character bar
Z
COMAND Online
X
Navigation
332
Option 1: junction list with character bar
COMAND Online
X
Enter a junction. Entering characters using
town input as an example (Y page 305).
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select From memory and press W to confirm.
You will see the destination memory list
either with the character bar (option 1) or
as a selection list (option 2).
Junction list as selection list
Option 2: junction list as selection list
Select a junction by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Entries with the G: icon cannot be
uniquely assigned. Another selection list is
shown.
X Select an entry by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The address entry menu appears again. The
junction selected has been entered.
X
X
Destination memory list with character bar
Option 1: destination memory list with character bar
X
Enter a destination, e.g. "My address".
Enter characters (Y page 305).
Start route calculation (Y page 329).
Selecting a destination from the destination memory
An entry named "My address" can always be
found at the top of the destination memory.
You may wish to assign your home address to
this entry, for example, and select it for route
guidance. Further information on entering a
home address (Y page 330).
X To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Destination in the navigation system menu bar by turning cVd the
Destination memory list as selection list
Option 2: destination memory list as a selection list
X
Select My address by turning cVd the
COMAND controller.
X
Irrespective of the option, press W to confirm your selection.
The address entry menu appears again.
"My address" has been entered.
Navigation
X
333
To start route calculation: select Start
and press W to confirm.
Once the route has been calculated, route
guidance begins (Y page 329).
i Further information on the "Last destinations" memory (Y page 371).
Entering a destination using the map
X
Calling up the map
COMAND Online
: Starting route calculation
To start route calculation: select Start
and press W to confirm.
Entering a destination from the list of
last destinations
Map with crosshair
: Current vehicle position
; Crosshair
= Details of the crosshair position
? Map scale selected
X
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
Last destinations
X
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
X
Select Destination in the navigation system menu bar by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Select Destination in the navigation system menu bar by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Using map and press W to confirm.
The map with crosshair is shown.
X
Select From last destinations and
press W to confirm.
X
Select the desired destination by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The address entry menu appears again. The
destination address selected has been
entered.
Display = depends on the settings selected
in "Map information in the display"
(Y page 375). If the digital map contains the
necessary data, the current road is shown. If
the geo-coordinates display is switched on,
the geo-coordinates of the crosshair are
shown.
Z
Navigation
334
Moving the map and selecting the destination
X Call up the destination entry via the map
(Y page 333).
X To scroll the map: slide XVY, ZVÆ or
aVb the COMAND controller.
Entering a destination using geo-coordinates
To set the map scale: as soon as you turn
cVd the COMAND controller, the scale bar
appears.
X Turn cVd until the desired scale is set.
Turning clockwise zooms out from the map;
turning anti-clockwise zooms in.
COMAND Online
X
X
X
X
To select a destination: press W the
COMAND controller.
If the crosshair lies outside the digital map,
COMAND Online uses the nearest digitised
road for route calculation. The The cross‐
hair is outside the digitalised
area of the map message is shown. If the
crosshair is located over a body of water,
you will see the message: The destina‐
tion is located in a body of
water. Please select another des‐
tination.
Select OK and press W to confirm.
If the destination is within the limits of the
digital map, COMAND Online attempts to
assign the destination to the map.
If the destination can be assigned, you will
see the address entry menu with the
address of the destination. If not, you will
see the Destination from map entry.
To start route calculation: select Start
and press W to confirm.
Geo-coordinates input menu
X
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Destination in the navigation system menu bar by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Using geo-coordinates and
press W to confirm.
The geo-coordinates input menu is shown.
You can now enter the latitude and longitude
coordinates with the COMAND controller or
the number keypad (Y page 305).
X To change a value: turn cVd the
COMAND controller.
X To move the selection within the line:
slide XVY the COMAND controller.
X To move the selection between lines:
slide ZVÆ the COMAND controller.
X To confirm the value: press W the
COMAND controller.
i If the selected position is outside the digital map, COMAND Online uses the nearest
digitised road for route calculation. You will
see the The co-ordinates are out‐
side the map message. If the selected
position is located over a body of water, you
will see the The destination is loca‐
ted in a body of water. Please
Navigation
Entering a destination using MercedesBenz Apps
X
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Destination in the navigation system menu bar by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Mercedes-Benz Apps and press W
to confirm.
If an Internet connection is established, you
will see the message Do you want to
accept the navigation data sent
via Mercedes-Benz Apps?
Street View
X
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X Select Destination in the lower menu bar
by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
X Select Address entry and press W to
confirm.
X
Select icon : in the address entry menu
and press W to confirm.
If an Internet connection is established, you
will see the Street View basic display.
X To explore the view of the street: turn
cVd or slide XVY, ZVÆ the COMAND
controller.
X To return to the navigation system:
press the % button.
X
Entering waypoints
Introduction
You can map the route yourself by entering up
to four waypoints. The sequence of the waypoints can be changed at any time.
COMAND Online provides a selection of predefined destinations in eight categories for
this purpose, e.g. FILLING STATION or COF‐
FEE SHOP.
SHOP You can also use the destination
entry options to enter waypoints.
Creating waypoints
Waypoint menu (with destination, without waypoint)
X
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Destination in the navigation system menu bar by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Z
COMAND Online
select another destination. message.
335
Navigation
336
X
COMAND Online
X
Select Way points and press W to confirm.
The destination is entered into the waypoints menu. The waypoints are not yet
entered.
Selection
Step
From last desti‐
nations
X
Select a destination from the list
of last destinations
(Y page 333).
From POIs
X
Select a POI
(Y page 338).
From personal
POIs
X
Enter a destination from the personal POIs
(Y page 347).
Using map
X
Enter a destination using the map
(Y page 333).
Using geo-coor‐
dinates
X
Enter a destination using the geocoordinates
(Y page 334).
Confirm Add: by pressing W the COMAND
controller.
Select the category or Other by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
After selecting a category, the POIs which
are available along the route and in the
vicinity are displayed.
COMAND Online first searches for destinations along the route. If there are no destinations available there, it then continues
searching for destinations within a radius of
approximately 100 km of the vehicle position.
X After selecting Other
Other, select one of the
destination entry options from the list.
X
Selection
Step
Address entry
X
Enter a destination by address
(Y page 326).
From memory
X
Select a destination from the destination memory
(Y page 332).
X
Select POI and press W to confirm.
After selecting a POI or entering a destination, the address of the waypoint is displayed.
After entering a destination using the map,
the address entry menu is displayed. OK is
highlighted.
X
X
To accept the waypoint: confirm OK by
pressing W.
When you have accepted the waypoint, it is
entered in the waypoint menu.
To display the details: select Details by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
To make a call: select Call with the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm. COMAND Online switches to telephone mode (Y page 397).
i This menu item is available if the waypoint
has a telephone number and a mobile
phone is connected to COMAND Online
(Y page 390).
X To call up the map: select Map with the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X You can move the map and select the destination.
X
X
To store the waypoint in the destination
memory: select Presets with the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm (Y page 370).
Waypoint menu with two waypoint entries
Editing waypoints
You can:
Rchange
waypoints
Rchange the sequence in the waypoint menu
Rdeleted
To change the sequence, at least one waypoint and the destination must be entered.
X
Select a waypoint in the waypoint menu by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
A menu appears.
Z
337
COMAND Online
Navigation
Navigation
338
To change a waypoint: select Edit from
the menu and press W to confirm.
X Change the address, e.g. the town and
street, and confirm with OK
OK.
The waypoint menu appears and displays
the modified waypoint.
COMAND Online
X
You can change the sequence of the waypoints and the destination.
X To change the sequence: from the menu,
select Move by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X Turn cVd the COMAND controller and
move the waypoint or destination to the
desired position, then press W to confirm.
X
To delete waypoints: from the menu,
select Delete and press W to confirm.
Accepting waypoints for the route
X Select Start in the waypoint menu by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
The route is calculated with the entered
waypoints.
i Continue is displayed instead of Start
when Calculate alternative routes
is activated in the navigation menu
(Y page 357).
Searching for a filling station when the
fuel level is low
If the reserve fuel warning is displayed, you
will see the message: Fuel tank reserve
level. Do you want to start the
search for filling stations?.
stations?
X Select Yes or No
No.
If you select Yes
Yes, the filling station search
starts. When the search is complete, a list
of the filling stations available along the
route or in the vicinity is displayed.
If you select No
No, the search is cancelled.
X Select a filling station and press W to confirm.
The address of the filling station is displayed.
X Confirm Start by pressing W.
The selected filling station is entered into
position 1 of the waypoints menu. Route
guidance begins.
If the waypoints menu already contains
four waypoints, a prompt will be displayed,
asking you whether you wish to enter the
filling station into position 1. If you select
Yes, the filling station is transferred into the
Yes
list and waypoint 4 is deleted.
Entering a POI
Calling up the POI menu
i If a waypoint has been passed during
route guidance, the waypoint will be displayed in the waypoint menu with a green
arrow. Once the route has been recalculated, the waypoint is deleted from the waypoint menu.
Example: POI menu
POIs are predefined destinations within categories, e.g. a filling station in the AUTOMO‐
TIVE category.
X
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Destination in the navigation system menu bar by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select From POIs and press W to confirm.
A menu appears.
X
Choose one of the options and press W to
confirm.
Further steps are arranged in a table
according to the option selected
(Y page 340).
339
COMAND Online
Navigation
Z
340
Navigation
COMAND Online
Defining the position for the POI search
Selection
Characteristic
Instructions
Near destina‐
tion
Entry is only possible
when route guidance is
active.
X
Current posi‐
tion
The system looks for a
POI in the vicinity of the
current vehicle position.
Select Current position in the POI
menu and press W to confirm.
X Select a POI category (Y page 341).
Other town
Option 1
After entering a town,
the system looks for the X Select Other town in the POI menu and
POI within the town.
press W to confirm.
X Select the country, if desired
(Y page 327).
X Enter the town. Proceed as described in
the "Entering a town" section
(Y page 327).
X Select a POI category (Y page 341).
Select Near destination from the POI
menu and press W to confirm.
X Select a POI category (Y page 341).
X
Option 2
X
Enter a town in the address entry menu
(Y page 326).
X
Select POI and press W to confirm.
Select a POI category (Y page 326).
X
Search by name
You can call up all the
POIs in the digital map or
focus your search on the
three previously selected positions.
X
Search by phone
number
This function gives you
access to all POIs that
have a phone number.
Select Search by phone number and
press W to confirm.
You will see a list of phone numbers.
X Proceed as described in the "POI list with
character bar" section (Y page 342).
Select Search by name in the POI menu
and press W to confirm.
X Select All POIs or one of the three previously selected positions.
The POI list with character bar appears.
X Proceed as described in the "POI list with
character bar" section (Y page 342).
X
Navigation
341
Example: POI search near the current position
POI category list
Calling up the POI menu (Y page 338).
After entering a town, the POI category list
appears after choosing the menu item
Near destination,
destination Current position
or Other town.
town
X Select a POI category by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm. The G arrow behind an entry shows
that other categories are available.
X
The POI search is cancelled when 50 POIs
have been found.
COMAND Online searches within a radius of
approximately 100 km.
Once the search is completed, the POI list is
displayed.
If COMAND Online does not find any POIs
within this radius, it extends its search range
to approximately 200 km.
If COMAND Online finds one POI within this
radius, it finishes the search.
POI list
Introduction
FILLING STATION category selected
X
Select an entry and press W to confirm.
The search for POIs begins in the vicinity of
the selected position.
Example: POI list
The POI list displays the search results for the
category in the vicinity of the selected position.
Z
COMAND Online
Searching by POI category
342
Navigation
The search results display the following information:
arrow that shows the linear direction to
the POI
Rthe linear distance to the POI
Rthe name of the POI
X
Ran
COMAND Online
i The arrow and linear distance to the des-
tination are not visible if you have entered a
POI after entering another town.
The arrow is also not shown when searching for a POI in the vicinity of the destination.
Depending on the POI selected,
COMAND Online uses different reference
points in determining the linear distance to
the destination:
Rvicinity of current position: the linear dis-
tance is the distance from the current
vehicle position to the POI.
Rvicinity of destination: the linear distance
is the distance of the POI from the destination entered.
Selecting a POI
Select the POI in the POI list by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The full address of the POI selected
appears.
To start route calculation: select
Start; and press W to confirm.
Start
X To store an address in the destination
memory: select Save = and press W to
confirm. You can now select storing
options (Y page 370).
X To show the detailed view: select
Details ? and press W to confirm.
X To make a call: select Call
CallA and press
W to confirm. COMAND Online switches to
telephone mode (Y page 396).
i This menu item is available if the POI has
a telephone number and a mobile phone is
connected to COMAND Online
(Y page 390).
X To call up the map: select Map B and
press W to confirm.
X You can move the map and select the destination (Y page 333).
X
POI list with character bar
: POI with address
; To start route calculation
= To store an address in the destination
memory
? To display details
A To make a call (when available)
B To display a POI's position on the map
Further information on searching via POI categories (Y page 341).
Example: search by name in the vicinity of the destination
If you have selected Search by name in the
POI menu and then defined the position for
the search (Y page 340), the POI list with
character bar appears.
Navigation
X
To start route calculation: select Start
and press W to confirm.
If there are POIs, you will see a message to
this effect.
i You also see this message if you have
selected the No symbols menu item under
"Map display" (Y page 374).
X To confirm the message: press W the
COMAND controller.
X
To select a POI: select Next or Previous
and press W to confirm.
X
To show details for the selection: select
Details and press W to confirm.
X
To change to the map: slide ZV the
COMAND controller.
You can move the map and select the map
section.
X
To start route calculation: select Start
and press W to confirm.
A prompt appears asking whether the POI
should be used as the destination.
X
Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
Selecting a POI using the map
i Continue is displayed instead of Start
POI on the map
You can select POIs that are available in the
selected (visible) section of the map. The POI
is highlighted on the map, you will see further
information on the upper edge of the display.
X To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
Select Guide in the navigation system
menu bar by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
If POIs are available:
Depending on the map scale selected, POI
icons appear on the map. The scale at
which the icons are displayed on the map
varies according to the icon. You can select
the icons that you want COMAND Online to
display.
when Calculate alternative routes is
activated in the navigation menu
(Y page 357).
Personal POIs
General notes
i The use of personal POIs to display traffic
monitoring installations is not permitted in
all countries. Please observe the countryspecific regulations and always drive at a
suitable speed.
Z
COMAND Online
Depending on your selection, you can select
all available POIs on the digital map or the
POIs in the vicinity of the selected position.
X Proceed as described in "Searching for a
phone book entry" (Y page 402).
If COMAND Online can assign the characters entered to one entry unambiguously,
the address entry appears automatically.
343
Navigation
344
Settings
Selection
Calling up the "Personal POIs" menu
ª Not Clas‐ Standard entry for personal POIs
sified
COMAND Online
ª COMAND
Online
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
X
Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Personal POIs and press W to
confirm.
Displaying personal POIs on the map
Explanation
Personal POIs (destinations, routes) that you
have imported via the
online function
(Y page 446).
If you have created your own categories (e.g.
"Café", "Top 10"), they are also displayed
(Y page 345).
If you have created your own categories (such
as "Taiwan"), they are also displayed
(Y page 345).
X Select a category and press W to confirm.
The icon display is switched on O or off ª,
depending on the previous status.
i The icons are shown in these map scales:
R20
m
m
R100 m
R200 m
R500 m
R50
Visual information for personal POIs
The personal POIs are shown on the map with
an icon according to their category.
X Call up the "Personal POIs" menu
(Y page 344).
X Select Display personal POIs on map
in the menu and press W to confirm.
You can select different categories.
If the vehicle is approaching a personal POI,
this is highlighted on the map. The display for
the corresponding category must be activated for this.
Navigation
345
Call up the "Personal POIs" menu
(Y page 344).
X In the "Personal POIs" menu, select Vis‐
ual warning for personal POIs and
press W to confirm.
The menu displays the available categories.
X
Select a category and press W to confirm.
This will switch the visual warning for all
personal POIs of this category on O or off
ª, depending on the previous setting.
Acoustic notification for personal POIs
A gong sounds when the vehicle is approaching a personal POI. The function for the corresponding category must be activated for
this.
X Call up the "Personal POIs" menu
(Y page 344).
X In the "Personal POIs" menu, select Acous‐
tic notification for personal POIs
and press W to confirm.
The menu displays the available categories.
X
Select a category and press W to confirm.
This will switch the acoustic notification for
all personal POIs of this category on O or
off ª, depending on the previous setting.
Managing categories for personal POIs
To create a new category: select New and
press W to confirm.
X Enter the name of the category. Character
entry (Y page 303).
X Select the ¬ symbol and press W to
confirm.
A list with symbols appears. You can assign
a symbol to the category.
X
X
Select an icon by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
You have created a new category with a
name and icon. This category appears
when selecting the display on the map or
when selecting the destination.
To rename a category, to change an
icon: select Rename or Change icon and
press W to confirm.
X Proceed as described under "To create a
new category".
X
To delete a category: select Delete and
press W to confirm.
A prompt appears asking whether the category should be deleted.
i If you delete a category, all POIs of this
category are also deleted.
X Select Yes and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, the category will be
deleted.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
X
Call up the "Personal POIs" menu
(Y page 344).
X In the "Personal POIs" menu, select Man‐
age categories for personal POIs
and press W to confirm.
X
Z
COMAND Online
X
Navigation
COMAND Online
346
Managing personal POIs
X Call up the "Personal POIs" menu
(Y page 344).
X Select Manage personal POIs in the
menu and press W to confirm.
X Select Not classified,
classified COMAND Online
or your own category and press W to confirm.
X Select a personal POI and press W to confirm.
The personal POI is displayed.
Observe the additional information on managing personal POI categories (Y page 347):
RRenaming
RChanging the category
RDeleting
Saving personal POIs
There are three ways of saving personal POIs.
You must insert an SD memory card to do so.
The No memory card message otherwise
appears.
Personal POIs and routes are saved on the
memory card in the same data format in
which the geographical data is stored. This
format is based on the open GPX (GPS
Exchange) format.
Option 1
Insert the SD memory card (Y page 472).
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X Hide the menu to show the map in full
screen mode (Y page 324).
X Press W the COMAND controller for longer
than two seconds.
The current position of the vehicle is saved
as a personal POI on the SD memory card in
the Not classified category.
i The crosshair position is saved in the
scrolling map function (Y page 373).
X
X
Option 2
Insert the SD memory card (Y page 472).
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X Select Position in the navigation system
menu bar by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X
X
Select Save position as personal POI
or Save crosshair pos. as personal
POI ("Move map" function active) and press
W to confirm.
The list of personal categories appears.
X Select a category and press W to confirm.
X Enter the name for the personal POI. Character entry (Y page 303).
X
Option 3
Insert the SD memory card (Y page 472).
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X Call up the address entry menu
(Y page 326).
X Select Save from the address entry menu
and press W to confirm.
X Select Save as personal POI and press
W to confirm.
X Select a category.
X Enter the name.
The current address is saved as a personal
POI on the SD memory card.
X
X
Importing personal POIs via the online
function
You can import personal POIs (destinations,
routes) via the online function (Y page 446).
When importing, you can choose whether to
write files to the SD memory card or to file
them in the address book. The imported personal POIs have their own icon and are filed in
the COMAND Online category.
Navigation
347
X
X
Insert the SD memory card (Y page 472).
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Destination in the navigation system menu bar by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select From personal POIs and press W
to confirm.
The categories of personal POIs appear.
Selection
Explanation
Not classi‐
fied
Standard entry for personal POIs.
COMAND
Online
Personal POIs which you
have imported via the
online function
(Y page 446).
Coffee shop
Icon and category that
you have created yourself
(Y page 345).
In the example, the COMAND Online category
is selected.
The personal POIs received are displayed.
X
Select a personal POI and press W to confirm.
X
To rename a personal POI: select Rename
and press W to confirm.
X
To change the category: select Change
category and press W to confirm.
To change to the map: select Map and
press W to confirm.
The position of the personal POI is shown in
the map.
i An icon is displayed according to the "Displaying personal POIs on the map" setting
(Y page 344).
X To start route calculation: select Start
and press W to confirm.
If route guidance has been activated, a
prompt will appear asking whether you
wish to accept the personal POI as the destination.
X
Z
COMAND Online
Selecting as the destination
Navigation
348
If route guidance has not been activated,
route calculation for the personal POI will
start immediately.
X Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, the personal POI is accepted as the destination.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
To make a call: select Call and press W to
confirm. COMAND Online switches to telephone mode (Y page 398).
i Call is available if the personal POI has a
telephone number and a mobile phone is
connected to COMAND Online
(Y page 390).
X To delete a personal POI: select Delete
and press W to confirm.
A prompt appears asking whether you wish
to delete the POI.
X Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, the personal POI is
deleted.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
COMAND Online
X
You can download available updates from the
Mercedes-Benz webshop.
i You can also subsequently obtain travel
guide data from the Mercedes-Benz Accessory webshop.
The travel guide offers you tourist destinations and routes:
Rin the vicinity of the current vehicle position
Ralong
the calculated route
the vicinity of the destination
Rthrough selection on the map
Ron a specific topic, for example, Paris, the
Alps or German wine routes
You can select:
Rin
Rwhich
travel guide data on the map can be
shown and selected (e.g. restaurants and
tourist routes)
Rwhether information on tourist destinations is read out as you approach them
Activating/deactivating travel guide
data
ViaMichelin travel guide
Overview
Categories for the display of travel guide data on
the map
If COMAND Online offers the ViaMichelin
travel guide in navigation mode, you can
select tourist destinations, including routes.
In this case, the travel guide data is on a SD
memory card. First place the SD memory card
in the SD card slot (Y page 472).
Travel guide data is stored in categories, such
as e.g. restaurants or tourist routes. In the
menu, you can select which travel guide categories are shown on the map, and therefore
which can be selected. You can also determine whether available information on the
tourist destination of a particular category is
acoustically provided as you approach it.
Navigation
Select Destination in the navigation system menu bar by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
X Select Travel guide and press W to confirm.
X No destination has been entered yet:
select Current position,
position Using map or
Topics.
Topics
X A route has already been entered: you
can also select Along the route and
Near destination.
destination
X
Using the guide
Calling up the travel guide
Using destination entry
Selecting search position for travel guide (using
guide)
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X To show the menu bar: press W the
COMAND controller.
X Select Guide in the navigation system
menu bar by sliding VÆ and turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X
Selecting search position for travel guide (using
destination entry)
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X To show the menu bar: press W the
COMAND controller.
X
Z
COMAND Online
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X To show the menu bar: press W the
COMAND controller.
X Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Travel guide and press W to confirm.
X Select Map icons or Acoustic
announcement and press W to confirm.
The menu displays the available categories.
X Select a category and press W to confirm.
Switch the category on O or off ª.
If you selected Map icons and switched on
a category, you can select the available
tourist destinations of that category on the
map.
If you selected Acoustic announcement
and switched on a category, you hear information as you approach a tourist destination. The information must be available as
an audio file for this destination.
X
349
Navigation
350
Select Travel guide and press W to confirm.
X No destination has been entered yet:
select Current position,
position Using map or
Topics.
Topics
X A route has already been entered: you
can also select Along the route and
Near destination.
destination
X
COMAND Online
Selecting topics
You can choose from a variety of topics. Topics can be listed based on places (e.g.countryside) or on content (e.g. wine guide).
X Call up the travel guide (Y page 349).
X Select Topics
Topics.
A list appears.
X Select a topic and press W to confirm.
The system selects a map view that allows
the tourist destinations and routes for the
topic to be displayed.
X Select a tourist destination or route on the
map and press W to confirm.
Selecting a destination or a route on the
map
Menu item
Explanation
Settings
In the settings, you can
select which selectable
travel guide data is shown
on the map.
Prev. (previous) or Next
Highlights the previous or
next symbol on the map.
Details
Shows detailed information about the destination
or route. You may also
use further functions, e.g.
calling the hotel or listening to an audio file about
the place of interest (if
available).
Map
Switches to the map with
the crosshair. You can
slide the crosshair and
change the map scale.
Start
Begins route calculation
for the selected destination.
Exploring the destination or route
Before the route calculation, you can call up
useful information on the selected destination.
i Not every tourist destination or route has
images, texts or audio files available.
To select tourist destinations/routes, first
select the search position and then the corresponding symbol on the map.
X Call up the travel guide (Y page 349).
X Select a search position, e.g. Using map.
map
The map appears.
X Select a menu item and press W to confirm
(see table).
Destination address is displayed (example)
Navigation
X
Rplaying
X
Rcalling
To display images: select Images and
press W to confirm.
One or more photos of the tourist destination are shown.
X To display text information: select Info
and press W to confirm.
A short text provides interesting details
about the tourist destination.
X To play an audio file: select M and press
W to confirm.
You hear useful information about the tourist destination.
X To stop playback, select ¯ and press W to
confirm.
X To call the destination: select Call and
press W to confirm.
If a mobile phone is connected to COMAND
Online, the telephone function is activated
and the call is connected (Y page 398).
X
an audio file
up the destination
X To start route calculation: select Start
and press W to confirm.
Route guidance
Important notes
COMAND Online calculates the route to the
destination without taking account of the following, for example:
If you have selected a tourist route, the map
shows an overview of the route.
Above, the following functions are described:
lights
and give way signs
Rparking or stopping restrictions
Rroad narrowing
Rother road and traffic rules and regulations
COMAND Online may give differing driving
recommendations if the data on the digital
map does not correspond to the actual conditions, such as if the road layout has
changed.
For this reason, you must always observe
road and traffic rules and regulations during
your journey. Road and traffic rules and regulations always have priority over system
driving recommendations.
Route guidance begins once a route has been
calculated (Y page 329).
COMAND Online guides you to your destination by means of navigation commands in the
form of audible navigation announcements
and route guidance displays.
The route guidance displays can be seen if the
display is switched to navigation mode.
If you do not follow the navigation announcements or if you leave the calculated route,
COMAND Online automatically calculates a
new route to the destination.
If the digital map contains the corresponding
information, the following applies:
Rdisplaying
Rduring
X
To start route calculation: select Start
and press W to confirm.
Example: tourist route is displayed
Rshowing
pictures
text information
Rtraffic
Rstop
route guidance, COMAND Online
tries to avoid roads with restricted access.
Z
COMAND Online
Call up the travel guide (Y page 349).
Select a search position, e.g. Using map.
map
The map appears.
X Select Details and press W to confirm.
The destination address is shown.
351
352
Navigation
Those roads, for example, that are closed to
through-traffic.
Rroads that have time restrictions (e.g.
closed on Sundays and public holidays) are
considered for route guidance on days
when they are open. For this purpose, the
relevant times must be correctly stored in
the database.
COMAND Online
Displaying during route guidance
Changing direction
Changes of direction have three phases:
RPreparation
phase
phase
RChange-of-direction phase
Example: announcement phase
: Next road
; Point at which the change of direction
RAnnouncement
=
?
A
B
takes place (light blue dot, shown in both
the left and right half of the display)
Graphic representation of the distance to
the next change of direction
Change of direction (turn right here)
Distance to the next change of direction
Route (blue line, shown in both the left
and right half of the display)
i The filled-in section of visual display for
distance = gets shorter the nearer you get
to the announced change of direction.
Example: preparation phase
: Point at which the change of direction
takes place (light blue dot)
; Next road
= Current vehicle position (the tip of the tri-
angle indicates the vehicle’s direction of
travel)
? Current road
Display ? depends on the setting selected
under "Map information in the display"
(Y page 375).
COMAND Online prepares you for the upcoming change of direction. Based on the example display below, the change of direction is
announced by the Prepare to turn right
message. You see the full-screen map.
COMAND Online announces the imminent
change of direction. Based on the example
display below, the change of direction is
announced beforehand by the message: In
400 metres turn right onto the A81 .
The display is now split into two sectors. In
the left half, you see the normal map view.
The right-hand half shows:
Ran
enlarged section of the area around the
junction (crossing zoom) or
Ra 3D image of the road's course with the
route indicating the next change of direction
Navigation
353
Example of a display without a change of
direction
angle indicates the vehicle’s direction of
travel)
; Graphic representation of the distance to
the next change of direction
= Distance to the next change of direction
COMAND Online announces the imminent
change of direction.
Based on the example display below, the
change of direction is announced 40 metres
before the change of direction with the Now
turn right message.
The display is split into two halves, as in the
announcement phase.
Once the change of direction is completed,
COMAND Online automatically switches back
to full-screen display.
:
;
=
?
A
COMAND Online
Example: change-of-direction phase
: Current vehicle position (the tip of the tri-
Route (highlighted in blue)
Current vehicle position
Current road
Map orientation selected
Map scale selected
Lane recommendations
Example: lane recommendations
: Point of the next change of direction
; Point of the change of direction after next
= Direction display, number of junction and
of motorway
? Graphic representation of the distance to
the next change of direction
Example display: roundabout
A Distance to the next change of direction
B Recommended lane (dark blue)
C Next change of direction (in this case, exit
to the right)
D Possible lanes (light blue)
Z
354
Navigation
E Non-recommended lanes (light brown or
light grey)
F Current vehicle position (the tip of the tri-
COMAND Online
angle indicates the vehicle’s direction of
travel)
On multi-lane roads, COMAND Online can display lane recommendations for the next
change of direction. The corresponding data
must be available on the digital map.
COMAND Online displays lane recommendation B based on the next two changes of
direction. The number of lanes applies to the
point at which the next change of direction is
required.
i The multifunction display also shows lane
recommendations.
Only the recommended lanes are displayed
here; see separate vehicle Owner's Manual.
Display and description of lane recommendations
Lane
Day
design
Night
design
Recommended lane Dark
In this lane, you will blue
be able to complete
the next two
changes of direction
without changing
lane.
Light
blue
Possible lane
Light
In this lane, you will blue
only be able to complete the next
change of direction
without changing
lane.
Dark
blue
Non-recommended
lane
In this lane, you will
not be able to complete the next
change of direction
without changing
lane.
Light
Grey
brown or
light grey
i The colours used in the lane recommen-
dation display vary depending on whether
day or night design is switched on.
: New lane (dark blue)
Navigation
Example: day design
: The displayed lane recommendations
Navigation announcements
Repeating navigation announcements
Navigation messages should guide you during
the journey without distracting you from traffic conditions or driving. Always use this function as a guide instead of the map display. The
symbols or the map display could distract you
from traffic conditions and driving.
If you have missed an announcement, you can
call up the current announcement at any
time.
X To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
apply to this position (light blue circle)
Select + in the navigation system menu
bar by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Switching navigation announcements
off/on
X To switch off: press the 8 button during an announcement.
You will briefly see the message: The
guidance instructions have been
muted.
X
Example: night design
To switch on: press W the COMAND controller.
Select + in the navigation system menu
bar by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
i COMAND Online automatically switches
the navigation announcements back on
when:
X
Rit receives traffic reports using live traffic
Example: lane recommendations at a motorway
junction
Observe the route guidance information
shown in the multifunction display, see the
separate vehicle Owner's Manual.
information or RDS-TMC during dynamic
route guidance and recalculates the
route accordingly (Y page 363)
Ryou calculate a new route
Ryou switch COMAND Online on again or
start the engine
Z
COMAND Online
During the change of direction, additional
lanes may appear. These are displayed differently.
355
Navigation
356
COMAND Online
Switching announcements and audio
fadeout on/off
X Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Announcements and press W to
confirm.
A menu appears.
You can activate/deactivate the following
functions:
street names
Street names are announced during
route guidance.
RAudible info during a phone call
During a phone call, navigation
announcements and traffic reports are
audible in the background.
RAudio fadeout
The volume of an active audio or video
source is automatically reduced during a
navigation announcement.
RReserve fuel level
Once you have reached reserve fuel
level, you will see a query asking whether
you wish to start the search for a filling
station (Y page 338).
X Select the function and press W to confirm.
Switch the function on O or off ª.
X
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
X
Select Announce street names and press
W to confirm.
The function is switched on O or off ª,
depending on the previous status.
RAnnounce
Setting the volume manually
Adjust the volume using the q control
knob during a navigation announcement.
or
X Select + in the map view with the menu
shown and adjust the volume using the q
control knob.
X
Announcing street names
If this function is switched on, the name of the
street into which you should turn is
announced.
Announcements are not made in the chosen
language in all countries. They are made when
relevant street names for the selected language are available in the database.
Street names may be announced in the following languages:
RDanish
RGerman
REnglish
RFrench
RDutch
RPortuguese
RSwedish
Ending route guidance
Cancelling or continuing route guidance
X To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X Select Dest. in the navigation system
menu bar by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X
To cancel route guidance: select Cancel
route guidance and press W to confirm.
or
X
To continue route guidance: select Con‐
tinue route guidance and press W to
confirm.
COMAND Online calculates the route.
Navigation
i The total length of the section that can be
blocked is defined by the digital map. The
menu items are available accordingly.
X To start route calculation: select Start
and press W to confirm.
X
Influencing route guidance
Avoiding a section of the route blocked by
a traffic jam
: Length of the blocked route section
; Name of route section
= Blocked route section
This function blocks a section of the route
ahead of you. You can set the length of the
blocked route section. If possible, COMAND
Online calculates a detour around the
blocked section of the route.
X To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
Select Route in the navigation system
menu bar by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Detour and press W to confirm.
X To block a section of the route: select
Longer or Shorter repeatedly and press
W to confirm until the desired section has
been selected.
X
To delete the blocked section: select
Delete while the message is shown and
press W to confirm.
COMAND Online calculates the route without the block.
Selecting an alternative route
With the "Alternative route" function, routes
other than the original one can be calculated.
Routes 1 to 3 are calculated with the current
settings for the route type and route options
and are shown with a dark blue line
(Y page 325).
Route 4 is the economic route (eco route) and
is shown with a green line.
On the right-hand side, you will see information on the currently selected alternative
route, e.g. distance, estimated remaining
driving time and estimated time of arrival.
Route sections used (e.g. motorways, tunnels) are displayed as symbols.
Option 1
X
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Route in the navigation system
menu bar by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Alternative route and press W
to confirm.
Z
COMAND Online
Destination or area of destination
reached
When you reach your destination, COMAND
Online displays a chequered flag and route
guidance is automatically ended.
If the destination is not in close proximity to a
digitised street, the Area of destination
reached message appears when the destination is reached.
357
Navigation
358
X
To start route guidance using the selected alternative route: select Start and
press W to confirm.
COMAND Online begins route guidance on
the selected alternative route.
Route information
COMAND Online
Displaying destination information
Example: destination information
Examples for route 1 (above) and route 4 (eco
route)
Option 2
X
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
X
Select Calculate alternative route
and press W to confirm.
The function is switched on O or off ª,
depending on the previous status.
Function activated: alternative routes are
calculated directly after the destination is
entered.
Menu functions
X
To select the next or previous alternative route: select Next or Previous and
press W to confirm.
The example shows information on distance,
estimated time of arrival and estimated
remaining driving time to the O destination
and two way points.
X To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Route in the navigation system
menu bar by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Destination information and
press W to confirm.
Destination information is displayed.
X
To call up further destination information: turn cVd the COMAND controller.
X
To close the destination information:
slide XVY the COMAND controller or press
the % back button.
i You can display destination information
for the destination, for both way points and
the intermediate stop, if they are part of the
route.
Navigation
Route overview
You can use the route overview to move along
the active route section by section and view
information and details about each section of
the route.
You can see information relevant to the section of the route, such as the length of the
road section you will be driving along and the
road name. The highlighted route section is
marked in white with a red border on the map.
X To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Route in the navigation system
menu bar by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Route browser and press W to
confirm.
X
To close the route overview: select Back
and press W to confirm.
Route demonstration
You can see the route before starting your
journey. This function is only available when
the vehicle is stationary.
X To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Route in the navigation system
menu bar by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Route demonstration and press
W to confirm.
The map with the crosshair appears.
X
To get to the destination: press W to
confirm the highlighted symbol.
X
To stop the route demonstration: confirm the Ë symbol by pressing W.
To view the next or previous route section: select Next or Previous and press W
to confirm.
i If the first or last route section is highlighted, you cannot select Previous or
Next.
Next
X To zoom in or out of the map: select N or
M and press W to confirm.
X
Z
COMAND Online
If a mobile phone is connected to COMAND
Online and a phone number is included in
the destination information, you can call it
(Y page 390).
359
Navigation
360
This is often the case with routes which are
drawn up using other map data and imported
via the online function, e.g.:
Rroutes
from the Google™ Local Search
(Y page 442)
Rroutes from the destination/route download (Y page 446)
COMAND Online
Calling up the Routes menu
Example: route demonstration stopped
: Display of street name and city when
route demonstration is paused
; Distance of the crosshair from current
vehicle position
X
To get to the current vehicle position:
press W to confirm the symbol for the current vehicle position.
To change the map scale: select Scale
and press W to confirm.
The scale bar appears.
X Turn cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
X
Recording the route
X
X
Notes
If you have activated COMAND Online and the
SD memory card has been inserted, you
should not take it out of the slot.
You can store up to 100 routes.
When you record a route, COMAND Online
uses so-called support points and displays
the route as a series of lines. If the route is
then calculated, COMAND Online attempts to
align the recorded route with the digital map.
The support points of the route may not be on
a digitised road.
X
X
Insert the SD memory card (Y page 472).
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
Select Destination in the navigation system menu bar by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Routes
Routes.
Starting/ending recording
: Recording (REC is red)
Navigation
X
X
Call up the Routes menu (Y page 360).
To start recording : select Start
recording in the Routes menu by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The route is recorded and entered in a list.
# REC is displayed in red :.
To view a demonstration of the route on
the map: select Demo by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The map with the crosshair appears.
X Proceed as described in the "Route demonstration" section (Y page 359).
To end recording: select Stop recording
in the Routes menu by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
X
Displaying and editing the recorded route
Insert the SD memory card (Y page 472).
X Call up the Routes menu (Y page 360).
X Select List in the Routes menu by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
Previously recorded routes are displayed.
X
X
Select a route and press W to confirm.
The map appears with a menu. The recorded route is shown on the map with a blue
dotted line.
To begin route calculation: select Start
in the menu by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
COMAND Online attempts to align the
recorded route with the digital map.
Changing route names and icons
X
Select Edit in the menu by turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
To change the route name: select Rename
and press W to confirm.
i The name cannot be changed while the
vehicle is in motion.
X To change the icon: select Change Icon
and press W to confirm.
X
Please see further information on managing
categories for personal POIs (Y page 345).
To change direction for route calculation:
you can set the icon for the route to the starting point or to the destination, thereby changing the direction for route calculation.
During route calculation, one-way streets or
turn restrictions, for example, are taken into
account. Therefore, the outward and return
routes may differ from each other.
Z
COMAND Online
X
361
Navigation
362
X
Select Swap in the menu by turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
Route guidance to a destination that is not
on a digitised road
To delete a route: select Delete in the
menu by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
A prompt appears asking whether the route
should be deleted.
X Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, the route will be deleted.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
COMAND Online
X
Scanning the memory
The SD memory card is inserted.
X Call up the Routes menu (Y page 360).
X Select Memory Info in the Routes menu by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
A message such as Off-road route mem‐
ory 90% full. is displayed.
Off-road and off-map
Notes
The navigation system may guide you to offroad routes that your vehicle cannot drive on
without causing damage to the tyres or
wheels or the vehicle itself. The driver alone is
responsible for determining the suitability of
the route. The condition of the off-road routes
may vary, and their drivability may be affected
by different factors such as time of day, season and current weather conditions, which
the navigation system cannot judge or take
into account.
Example: route guidance to an off-road destination
: Off-road destination
; Off-road route section (dashed blue)
= Current vehicle position (the tip of the tri-
angle indicates the vehicle’s direction of
travel)
COMAND Online can guide you to destinations which are within the area of the digital
map, but which are not themselves recorded
on the map.
These destinations are known as off-road
destinations, which you can enter using the
map, for example. In these cases, COMAND
Online guides you for as long as possible with
navigation announcements and displays on
roads known to the system.
Shortly before you reach the last known point
on the map, you will hear the "Area of destination reached" announcement. The display
shows a direction arrow with the linear distance to the destination.
Route guidance from an off-road location
to a destination
If the vehicle position is within the area covered by the digital map, but the map does not
contain any information about that location,
the vehicle is in an off-road location.
COMAND Online is also able to guide you to a
destination even from an off-road location.
At the start of route guidance, you will see the
Off road message, an arrow and the dis-
Navigation
Route guidance from an off-map location
to a destination
If the vehicle position is outside the area covered by the digital map, then the vehicle is in
an off-map location. COMAND Online is also
able to guide you to a destination even from
an off-map location.
At the start of route guidance, you will see the
Off road message, an arrow and the distance to the destination. The direction arrow
shows the compass heading to the destination.
The route is highlighted blue from the nearest
road known to the system.
As soon as the vehicle is back on a road
known to the system, route guidance continues in the usual way.
Off-road during route guidance
Due to roadworks, for example, there may be
differences between the data on the digital
map and the actual course of the road.
In such cases, the system will temporarily be
unable to locate the vehicle position on the
digital map. The vehicle is therefore in an offroad position.
In the display, you will see the Off road
message, an arrow and the distance to the
destination. The direction arrow shows the
compass heading to the destination.
As soon as the system can assign the vehicle
position to the map again, route guidance
continues in the usual way.
Dynamic route guidance
Traffic report services
You can receive traffic reports from Live Traffic Information or RDS-TMC and take them
into consideration for dynamic route guidance. The simultaneous use of both services
is not possible.
Traffic reports from Live Traffic Information
Conditions:
Requipped
with COMAND Online
module with activated,
integrated SIM card
This service can be used to receive up-to-date
and accurate traffic information via the Internet connection available in the vehicle. Data
roaming is also available in selected European countries.
Advantages of Live Traffic Information
Rcommunication
Rgenerates
and transmits a large number of
traffic reports
Rtraffic data is available shortly after starting
the vehicle
Rtraffic situation is updated every two to
three minutes
Raccurate information ensures optimum
route guidance and reliably predicted
arrival times
Live Traffic Information is a subscription service. If your vehicle is equipped with
COMAND Online, this service is available for
free for the first three years from the date of
manufacture on selected European markets.
The Live Traffic Information logo will appear in
the top right of the display if your subscription
is valid and a server connection is available.
To call up the subscription status, see the
description below. The communication module automatically connects to the Internet
once the ignition has been switched on.
i No traffic data can be received unless
wireless network coverage is available.
Z
COMAND Online
tance to the destination. The arrow shows the
compass heading to the actual destination.
The route is highlighted blue, starting from
the last recognised street the vehicle was on
before it left the map.
As soon as the vehicle is back on a road
known to the system, route guidance continues in the usual way.
363
Navigation
COMAND Online
364
The traffic information is provided by a traffic
data supplier and is based on various sources
and data. It is necessary to regularly transmit
information on your vehicle's position to
Daimler AG if you wish to use Live Traffic
Information. This data is then made anonymous and forwarded to the traffic data suppliers. This anonymous data is used to transmit all traffic reports to the vehicle that are
relevant for the current vehicle position. On
the other hand, as the vehicle acts as a traffic
flow sensor, the quality of the traffic reports is
enhanced (source for Floating Car Data). The
anonymous data is not stored permanently.
i If you do not wish to send your vehicle's
positions, contact a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre. Please note that by switching
off this function, Live Traffic Service will
also be automatically deactivated.
Calling up subscription information
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X Select Traffic in the navigation bar by
turning the cVd COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
X Confirm Subscription information by
pressing the W COMAND controller.
The displayed messages depend on the
subscription status.
Subscription is valid: Your subscrip‐
tion is valid until:
No subscription available: You have no
valid subscription. Please refer
to the Owner's Manual for further
information.
X To confirm with OK
OK: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Extending or entering a subscription
X
X
Call up the online shop (App Store).
Enter data.
Traffic reports via FM RDS-TMC
An RDS-TMC radio station transmits RDSTMC traffic reports in addition to the radio
programme. COMAND Online can receive
RDS-TMC traffic reports and take them into
consideration for dynamic (traffic-dependent) route guidance. This means the navigation system can guide you around a traffic
jam, for example.
There may also be differences between the
traffic reports received and the actual road
and traffic conditions.
The respective traffic data being received
appears on the top right of the display with
the symbol "TMC". If there is no reception, no
symbol is displayed.
i FM RDS-TMC is not available in all countries.
Switching dynamic route guidance
on/off
If Dynamic route or Eco route is selected
as the route type, traffic reports are taken into
account for route guidance.
The Fast route and Short route route
types do not take traffic reports into account
for route guidance.
Selecting route type (Y page 325).
i COMAND Online calculates a new route if
you change the route type setting with
route guidance active. If you change the
route type setting when route guidance is
inactive, COMAND Online uses the new
setting for the next route guidance.
Navigation
Traffic reports on the map
X
365
To set the map scale: turn cVd the
COMAND controller until the desired map
scale is set.
Turning clockwise zooms out from the map;
turning anti-clockwise zooms in.
Displaying traffic reports
Calling up traffic reports
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
Example: traffic reports on the map
RDS-TMC symbols
: Traffic jam on the route
; Slow-moving traffic on the route
= Road blocked
? Road blocked
A Slow-moving traffic (yellow vehicles along
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Traffic in the navigation system
menu by turning the
cVd COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
If network coverage is not available for Live
Traffic Information or FM RDS-TMC, or
there are no traffic reports, you will see a
message to this effect.
X
To close the message: confirm OK by pressing W the COMAND controller.
Traffic symbol information
the affected route)
B Traffic jam (red vehicles along the affec-
ted route)
i The display shows the entire affected
route section with the corresponding symbols, regardless of how long the incident
actually is. The symbols are placed on the
side of the carriageway affected by the incident.
COMAND Online can show certain traffic incidents on the map. The displays can be shown
in map scales of 50 m to 20 km.
Example display
: Affected section of motorway
; Symbol for incident (traffic jam in the
example shown)
= Symbol display for the section of route
affected
X
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
Z
COMAND Online
X
Navigation
366
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
Select Traffic in the navigation system
menu by turning the
c COMAND controller Vd and press W to
confirm.
X Select Traffic symbol information
and press W to confirm.
X
To show the next/previous incident:
select Next or Previous (if available) and
press W to confirm.
X To show the detailed view: select
Details and press W to confirm.
X To scroll the map: select Map and press W
to confirm.
You can move the map to enable further
traffic reports to be displayed
(Y page 373).
COMAND Online
X
:
;
=
?
A
Traffic jam
Slow-moving traffic
Warning message
Road blocked
Construction site
X
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
Displaying reports on the route
Select Traffic in the navigation system
menu by turning the
cVd COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X Select Messages on the route and press
W to confirm.
The traffic report is displayed. If there is
more than one traffic report for a section of
the route, this is indicated by 1/2, for
example.
X
: Country designation, road number, direc-
tion and number/total number of reports
for the affected road (1/2)
; Section of the road to which the traffic
report applies
= Traffic report
? Type of traffic report (warning)
X
To scroll within a report or to access the
next report: turn c Vd the COMAND controller.
X
To exit the report: slide XVY the
COMAND controller once or several times.
Navigation
Displaying all traffic reports
367
You can select from the following text reader
properties:
Rlanguage (Y
page 313)
reader speed (Y page 312)
X To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
Example: list showing all currently available traffic
reports
X
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Traffic in the navigation system
menu by turning the
cVd COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X
Select Display all messages and press
W to confirm.
A list is shown containing all roads, areas or
regions affected by traffic reports. Roads,
areas or regions not on the route also
appear in the list.
X
To show a traffic report: select a road, an
area or a region and press W to confirm.
The traffic report is displayed. If there is
more than one traffic report for a section of
the route, this is indicated by 1/2, for
example.
You can find an example of a traffic report
here: (Y page 366).
X
To exit the report: slide XVY the
COMAND controller once or several times.
Reading out traffic reports on the route
Calling up traffic reports
The text reader function is only available
when route guidance is active.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Traffic in the navigation system
menu by turning the cVd COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Select Read out all messages on
route and press W to confirm.
COMAND Online reads out the messages in
sequence.
i The Read out all messages on route
menu item has no function if there are no
reports relating to the route.
X To cancel the read-aloud function: select
Cancel read-aloud function and press
W to confirm.
The current traffic report is read out to the
end and then the function is deactivated.
or
X Briefly press the 8 button.
The function is deactivated immediately.
i COMAND Online interrupts the readaloud function automatically as it recalculates the route following a new RDS-TMC
traffic report.
X
Automatic read-aloud function
You can have TMC traffic reports on your
route read aloud automatically. Announcements are made as you approach traffic incidents.
X To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X To switch the automatic read-aloud
function on/off: select Traffic in the
navigation system menu bar by turning the
Z
COMAND Online
Rtext
Navigation
368
cVd COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X
Option 1: destination memory list with
character bar
Select Read traffic messages auto‐
matically and press W to confirm.
The function is switched on O or off ª,
depending on the previous status.
Destination memory
COMAND Online
Home address (My address)
Entering the home address via address
entry
X Proceed as described under "Adopting an
address book entry as a home address"
(Y page 368). Confirm My Address by
pressing W.
X To enter the home address for the first
time: confirm New entry by pressing W.
X To change the home address: select
Change in the menu showing the home
address by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Confirm New entry by pressing W.
X In both cases, enter the home address as a
destination, e.g. as a town, street and
house number (Y page 327). Then, save the
home address (Y page 330).
Adopting an address book entry as a
home address
X To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Destination in the navigation system menu bar by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select From memory and press W to confirm.
You will see the destination memory list
either with the character bar (option 1) or
as a selection list (option 2).
: Entry containing data that can be used for
navigation
; To call up options
X
Slide ZV the COMAND controller repeatedly until the destination memory list
appears as a selection list.
Option 2: destination memory list as a
selection list
The My Address entry is listed as the first
entry in the destination memory.
X Select My Address by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
i If you have not yet entered any characters, My Address is automatically highlighted in the selection list.
If no home address has been stored yet, you
can now assign an address book entry. If a
home address already exists, it is displayed
and you can alter it.
Navigation
offered the option of entering the home
address for the first time. You can then
save the home address without having to
start route guidance.
X To enter the home address for the first
time: select Assign to address book
entry and press W to confirm.
X
Select Home
Home, Work or Not classified and
press W to confirm.
To change the home address: select
Change and press W to confirm.
X Select Assign to address book entry
and press W to confirm.
entry you are also
i If you select New entry,
offered the option of changing the home
address by entering an address. You can
then save the home address without having
to start route guidance.
X
X
Select Home
Home, Work or Not classified and
press W to confirm.
In both cases, you will see the address book
either with the character bar or as a selection list.
Select the address book entry
(Y page 413).
X To select: press W the COMAND controller.
If there is no existing home address,
COMAND Online saves the entry. You will
see a message and then the address menu
with the selected address. Start is highlighted automatically.
If a home address has already been stored,
you will see a prompt asking you whether
the My Address entry should be overwritten.
X
X
Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, COMAND Online overwrites the destination. You will see a message and then the address menu with the
selected address. Start is highlighted
automatically.
If you select No
No, the list will appear again.
Selecting the home address for route
guidance
X Proceed as described under "Selecting a
destination from the destination memory"
(Y page 332).
Saving a destination
General notes
This function also stores the destination in
the address book.
When the address book is full, no destinations
can be saved in the destination memory. You
must first delete address book entries
(Y page 413).
After destination entry
The destination has been entered and is
shown in the address entry menu
(Y page 326).
X Select Save by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
You can now select storing options
(Y page 370).
X
During route guidance
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
X
Select Destination in the navigation system menu bar by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Save destination and press W to
confirm.
You can now select storing options
(Y page 370).
From the list of previous destinations
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
X
Select Destination in the navigation system menu bar by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Z
COMAND Online
entry you are also
i If you select New entry,
369
Navigation
COMAND Online
370
X
Select From last Destinations and
press W to confirm.
The list of previous destinations appears.
X
Select a destination by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The destination address is shown.
X
Select Save and press W to confirm.
You can now select storing options
(Y page 370).
Selecting storage options
Once you have chosen one of the following
options for storing a destination, you can
specify storage options:
destination entry (Y page 369)
route guidance (Y page 369)
Rfrom the list of previous destinations
(Y page 333)
Example: saving a destination with a name
: Selected data field with cursor
; Character bar
X
To save the destination with a name:
select Save with name and press W to
confirm.
X
Select a category, e.g. Home
Home, and press W
to confirm.
The input menu appears with data fields
and the character bar.
Rafter
Rduring
Proceed as described under "Character
entry (navigation)" (Y page 305).
X Then select ¬ and press W to confirm.
COMAND Online stores the destination
under the name entered.
X
Storage options
X
To save the destination without a name:
select Save without name and press W to
confirm.
COMAND Online stores the destination in
the destination memory and uses the
address as the destination name.
An address with complete address data that
is suitable for navigation can be assigned to a
pre-existing address book entry.
X To assign an address to an address
book entry: select Assign to address
book entry and press W to confirm.
X
Select a category, e.g. Home
Home, and press W
to confirm.
You will see the address book either with
the character bar or as a selection list.
X
Select the address book entry
(Y page 413).
COMAND Online stores the data if the
address book entry selected does not yet
contain navigable address data.
If the selected address book entry already
contains navigable address data, a prompt
will appear asking whether you wish to
overwrite the existing data.
X
Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, COMAND Online stores
the data.
You can now start route guidance to this
address directly from the address book
(Y page 415).
To save the destination as My address:
select Save as "My Address" and press
W to confirm.
COMAND Online stores the destination in
the destination memory as My Address.
Address If
the selected address book entry already
contains address data that can be used for
navigation (L icon), a prompt will appear
asking whether you wish to overwrite the
existing data.
X Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, the entry is overwritten. If
you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
X
To save the destination as a personal
POI: insert the SD memory card
(Y page 472).
X Select Save as personal POI and press
W to confirm.
X Select a category.
X Enter the name.
The current address is saved as a personal
POI on the SD memory card.
X
Deleting a destination or the home
address
X
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Destination in the navigation system menu bar by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select From memory and press W to confirm.
You will see the destination memory list
either with the character bar (option 1) or
as a selection list (option 2).
X
Option 1: destination memory list with
character bar: enter characters using the
character bar (Y page 305).
X
Option 2: destination memory list as
selection list: select a destination by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
You see the address data of the selected
entry.
X
Select Delete and press W to confirm.
A prompt appears asking whether you wish
to delete the destination.
Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, COMAND Online deletes
the destination. You will see a message to
this effect.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
i If the navigable address data for the destination being deleted is also assigned to an
address book entry, COMAND Online will
also delete this data from there. If the corresponding address book entry does not
contain any further data, such as telephone
numbers, COMAND Online deletes the
entire address book entry.
X
Last destinations
Introduction
COMAND Online automatically stores the
previous destinations for which route calculation has been started. If the memory is full,
COMAND Online deletes the oldest destination. You can also save a destination from the
list of previous destinations in the destination
memory. It will be stored there permanently.
Z
371
COMAND Online
Navigation
Navigation
372
Storing a destination permanently in
the destination memory
X
Proceed as described in the "From the list
of previous destinations" section
(Y page 333).
Storing the vehicle position in the list of
previous destinations
To switch on navigation mode: press the
Ø function button.
X To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X Select Position in the navigation system
menu bar by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Save vehicle position and press
W to confirm.
COMAND Online stores the current vehicle
position as a destination in the list of previous destinations.
COMAND Online
X
Storing the crosshair position in the list
of previous destinations
A crosshair appears on the map if you have
moved the map manually (Y page 373). You
can store the crosshair position as a destination in the list of previous destinations.
X To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X Select Position in the navigation system
menu bar by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Save crosshair position and
press W to confirm.
Deleting a previous destination
To switch on navigation mode: press the
Ø function button.
X To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X Select Destination in the navigation system menu bar by turning cVd the
X
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select From last destinations and
press W to confirm.
The list of previous destinations appears.
X Select the desired destination and press W
to confirm.
The destination address appears.
X Select Delete and press W to confirm.
A prompt appears asking whether the entry
should be deleted.
X Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, the entry is deleted.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
Map operation and map settings
General notes
Company logos displayed on the map are
trademarks of the respective companies and
used solely for the purpose of indicating the
locations of these companies. The use of such
logos on the map does not indicate approval
of, support of or advertising by these companies for the navigation system itself.
Setting the map scale
: Currently set map scale expressed as a
number with unit, in this case 500 m
; Currently set map scale as indicated by
the needle on the scale bar
= New map scale
? Scale bar
Unit of measurement : in the COMAND display depends on the selection made in the
Navigation
instrument cluster; see the separate vehicle
Owner's Manual.
X To hide the menu: slide ZV the COMAND
controller and, when the Full screen
menu item is shown, press W.
Hiding the crosshair and centring the map
on the vehicle position or destination
X Press the % back button twice.
The crosshair disappears and the map is
set to the vehicle position.
To call up the scale bar: as soon as you
turn cVd the COMAND controller, scale
bar ? appears.
X Turn cVd until the desired scale is set.
X
Centring the map on the vehicle's position
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Position in the navigation system
menu bar by sliding VÆ and turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X
Select Vehicle position map and press
W to confirm or, if the crosshair is shown,
press the % back button.
This hides the crosshair.
Moving the map
Showing the crosshair
Map with crosshair
: Current vehicle position
; Crosshair
= Details of the crosshair position
? Map scale selected
X
X
To hide the menu: slide ZV the COMAND
controller and, when the Full screen
menu item is shown, press W.
To scroll the map: slide XVY, ZVÆ or
aVb the COMAND controller.
A crosshair appears on the map. If you slide
it again, the map moves in the corresponding direction under the crosshair.
Display = may be the name of a street, for
example, provided the digital map contains
the necessary data. It shows the geo-coordinate position of the crosshair if the Geocoordinates display is switched on
(Y page 375).
Centring the map on the destination position
This function requires that a route to a destination has been calculated. If the route has
way points and an intermediate stop, the map
can also be set to these positions.
X To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Position in the navigation system
menu bar by sliding VÆ and turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X
Select Destination position map and
press W to confirm.
The crosshair is centred on the corresponding destination.
Map settings
Calling up the map settings menu
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
X
Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
Z
COMAND Online
X
373
Navigation
374
X
Select Map settings and press W to confirm.
The map settings menu appears.
Map orientation
Setting the map orientation
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Map settings and press W to confirm.
The map settings menu appears.
Select Map orientation and press W to
confirm.
X Select North up,
up Heading up,
up Bird'seye view or 3-D map by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
A # dot indicates the new setting.
COMAND Online
X
Example: map orientation
: Current map orientation (0 or ¤)
Possible map orientations:
R0
North orientation (the map view is displayed so that north is always up)
R¤ Heading orientation (the map view is
aligned to the direction of travel. The direction of travel is always at the top, the
orange-coloured tip of the symbol points
north.)
R¤ Bird's-eye view (the map view is aligned
to the direction of travel. The map projection reproduces the curvature of the earth's
surface, the orange-coloured tip of the
symbol points north.)
R¤ 3D map (the map view is aligned to the
direction of travel. At a scale of 1 km the
map displays elevation, the orange-coloured tip of the symbol points north.)
Map orientation menu
Selecting POI symbols
Setting the POI symbol display
You can set the POIs you wish to have displayed as symbols on the map. POIs are, for
example, filling stations, hotels, cinemas and
restaurants.
X To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Map settings and press W to confirm.
The map settings menu appears.
Navigation
RStandard
symbols
Symbol display determined by the factory
settings.
RPersonal symbols
You can determine the symbols yourself.
RNo symbols
The map does not show any symbols.
X
Select Standard symbols,
symbols Personal
symbols or No symbols.
symbols
If you select Personal symbols,
symbols the POI
list appears.
To switch the symbol display on/off:
select a POI by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
Depending on the previous state of the
symbols, they will either be shown O or
hidden ª. You can switch on the icon displays for more than one POI.
X To switch all personal symbols on/off:
select All and press W to confirm.
Depending on the previous status of the
symbols, they will either be shown O or
hidden ª.
If the function is switched on O, the individual POIs are greyed out and the previously selected settings remain unchanged.
If the function is switched off ª, you can
reselect the individual POIs. This displays
the previous settings.
i The list shows all symbols that are contained on the digital map across all counX
tries. However, not all POIs are available in
all countries. As a result, certain POI symbols may not be displayed on the map, even
if the symbol display is switched on.
X To exit the menu: press the % back
button.
Selecting map information
Map information in the display
During route guidance, you can have map
information displayed at the bottom edge of
the display.
X To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Map settings and press W to confirm.
The map settings menu appears.
X Select Text information on map and
press W to confirm.
A # dot indicates the current setting.
Select Current street,
street Geo-coordi‐
nates or None and press W to confirm.
X To exit the menu: slide XVY the COMAND
controller.
X
Road display
: Road name or designation
Z
COMAND Online
Select POI symbols on map and press W
to confirm.
The following settings are possible:
X
375
376
Navigation
Compass view on the map
Geo-coordinate display
: Current height above average sea level
(rounded to the nearest 10 m)
COMAND Online
; Current vehicle position: latitude coordi-
nates
= Current vehicle position: longitude coor-
dinates
? Number of GPS satellites currently being
used
There must be sufficient GPS reception for all
displays to be shown. If this is not the case,
the display will be greyed out. Height display : may vary from the actual value,
because the navigation system uses the GPS
signals for the calculation.
During the "Move map" function, you will see
the geo-coordinates of the crosshair position.
Height display : and number of satellites
used ? are not displayed.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Map settings and press W to confirm.
The map settings menu appears.
X
Select Compass on map and press W to
confirm.
A menu appears.
X
Select Never
Never, When off-road or When
route guidance inactive and press W
to confirm.
The selected setting is accepted.
Switching additional information on/off
Display switched off
: Current map orientation
While moving the map, you will see additional
data depending on the crosshair position if
the digital map supports this data. A street
name, for example, can be shown here
(Y page 373).
Example: topographic map
Switching the topographic map on/off
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Map settings and press W to confirm.
The map settings menu appears.
X
Select Topographic map and press W to
confirm.
Depending on the previous status, switch
the option on O or off ª.
The topographic map uses different colours
to depict elevation. The colour key generally
reflects the topography's dominant vegetation or the ground's perceived colour when
seen from the air, for example:
X
To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Map settings and press W to confirm.
The map settings menu appears.
X
Select Motorway information and press
W to confirm.
Depending on the previous status, switch
the option on O or off ª.
Rgreen
(grass) for lowland
brown (woodland) for hills
Rgrey (stone) and white (snow) for mountains
Ryellow,
Example: city model
Example: motorway information
Switching motorway information on/off
Switching town view on/off
When the city model is switched on, the map
shows buildings as 3D models.
X To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
When driving on the motorway, you can see
the following information on the right of the
display:
X
Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
Rthe
X
Select Map settings and press W to confirm.
The map settings menu appears.
X
Select City (3D) and press W to confirm.
Depending on the previous status, switch
the option on O or off ª.
nearest filling stations
nearest rest areas, etc
Rand their distance from the current vehicle
position
The entries show the number of the motorway and the motorway exits as well as their
distance from the current vehicle position.
The name of the motorway exit continues
to be displayed.
Rthe
i The city model is only shown in the bird'seye view and 3D maps.
Z
377
COMAND Online
Navigation
Navigation
378
It is available for the 50 m and 100 m map
scales.
The data required for displaying buildings is
not available for all towns.
Speed Limit Assist
Information and requirements
If COMAND Online supports Speed Limit
Assist and the function is switched on in
COMAND Online, it can show the permissible
speed limit in the COMAND display.
i The display appears if Speed Limit Assist
COMAND Online
detects traffic signs stating the maximum
permissible speed.
Speed Limit Assist detects these traffic
signs using a camera; see the separate
vehicle Owner's Manual.
Restricted speed limits may also be displayed.
Restrictions include:
RWhen
wet – applies only if the road is wet
icy – applies only if the road is slippery (due to cold)
RIn fog – applies only in foggy weather
RTemporary – applies only at certain times
RLimited – COMAND Online cannot identify
the type of restriction
If the corresponding data is available, you see
the information at the bottom left of the
COMAND display. You might see "120" or "80
when wet", for example, directly above the
map scale indicator.
The displays also appear in the multifunction
display in the Assistance menu; see the separate vehicle Owner's Manual.
RWhen
Example: intersecting roads on city routes/motorways
Showing/hiding intersecting roads
If route guidance is not active, intersecting
roads can be displayed at the upper edge of
the display.
X To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
X
X
i The speed limits displayed may be incorrect if:
Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
Select Map settings and press W to confirm.
The map settings menu appears.
Select Next intersecting street and
press W to confirm.
Depending on the previous status, switch
the option on O or off ª.
Rthe
data is outdated.
camera has failed to identify a traffic
sign correctly.
Rthe
Switching Speed Limit Assist on/off
X To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
Navigation
Select Speed Limit Assist and press W
to confirm.
Depending on the previous status, switch
the option on O or off ª.
Additional settings
Avoiding an area
General notes
COMAND Online enables you to avoid areas
you do not wish to drive through.
If you activate or deactivate a route block
while route guidance is active,
COMAND Online will calculate a new route. If
you activate or deactivate a route block while
route guidance is inactive, COMAND Online
will use the new setting for the next route
guidance.
Select Using map,
map From memory or From
personal POIs and press W to confirm.
If you select Using map,
map the map with the
crosshair appears.
If you select From memory or From per‐
sonal POIs,
POIs either the destination memory or the list of categories for POIs
appears.
RDestination memory (Y page 332)
RList of categories for personal POIs
(Y page 347)
X Select the desired destination or personal
POI and press W to confirm.
X When the destination address is displayed,
select Continue and press W to confirm.
The map appears.
X
i Motorways within blocked areas are
always included in the route calculation.
Defining an area for the first time
X To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Avoid area and press W to confirm.
If you have not previously blocked an area,
a menu appears.
The crosshair marks the centre of the area
that is to be avoided.
X To scroll the map: slide XVY, ZVÆ or
aVb the COMAND controller.
X
To set the map scale: as soon as you turn
cVd the COMAND controller, the scale bar
appears. Turning clockwise zooms out from
the map; turning anti-clockwise zooms in.
X
Turn cVd until the desired scale is set.
X
To apply a block: press W the COMAND
controller.
A red square appears on the map.
Z
COMAND Online
X
379
Navigation
380
i Available positions in the list are named
Empty and are shown in grey.
COMAND Online
X
X
To adjust the size of the square: turn
cVd the COMAND controller.
The square is enlarged or reduced.
X
To confirm the settings: press W.
The list appears. The previously selected
area to be avoided has been added and
activated.
You can define additional areas that you
would like to avoid (Y page 380).
Defining further areas
X To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Avoid area and press W to confirm.
If you have already selected one or more
areas to avoid, a list of areas appears.
Example: list of areas
Select Avoid new area by turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
A menu appears.
Select Using map,
map From memory or From
personal POIs and press W to confirm.
If you select Using map,
map the map with the
crosshair appears.
If you select From memory or From per‐
sonal POIs,
POIs either the destination memory or the list of categories for POIs
appears.
RDestination memory (Y page 332)
RList of categories for personal POIs
(Y page 347)
X Select the desired destination or personal
POI and press W to confirm.
X When the destination address is displayed,
select Continue and press W to confirm.
The map appears.
X
Navigation
X
381
To confirm the change: press W the
COMAND controller.
The list appears and the change is entered.
Deleting a set area
Call up the area list (Y page 380).
X Select an entry in the list by turning cVd
the COMAND controller.
X Slide VY the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
X Select Delete and press W to confirm.
A query appears asking whether the entry
should be deleted.
: New area to be avoided, the size of which
can still be adjusted
; Area currently being avoided
X
To avoid a new area: call up the area menu
again (Y page 379).
The illustration shows an example with two
areas that are to be avoided.
Switching an avoided area on/off
Call up the area list (Y page 380).
X Select an entry in the list by turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
The avoided area is switched on O or off
ª depending on the previous status.
X
Displaying and changing an avoided area
X Call up the area list (Y page 380).
X Select an entry in the list by turning cVd
the COMAND controller.
X Slide VY the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
X
Select Display / Change and press W to
confirm.
The area to be avoided is indicated on the
map.
X
To change the location of the area: slide
XVY, ZVÆ or aVb the COMAND controller.
The area is moved on the map.
X
To adjust the size of the area: turn cVd
the COMAND controller.
The area is enlarged or reduced.
X
Select Yes or No
No.
If you select Yes
Yes, the entry is deleted.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
Compass function
In the compass view, you can see the current
direction of travel, the current height above
sea level and the co-ordinates of the vehicle
position, for example.
X To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
X
Select Position in the navigation system
menu bar by sliding VÆ and turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X
Select Compass and press W to confirm.
Z
COMAND Online
X
Navigation
382
X
Select Position in the navigation system
menu bar by sliding VÆ and turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
Select Country information and press
W to confirm.
When the connection has been made, the
available country information appears.
X To return to navigation: press the %
button.
COMAND Online
X
Example: compass
: Current direction of travel
; Current elevation above average sea
Showing the map data version
level, rounded
= Current vehicle position: longitude coor-
dinates
? Number of GPS satellites currently being
used
A Current vehicle position: latitude coordi-
nates
B Currently set steering angle of the front
wheels
i To display current elevation ;, the sys-
tem must be able to receive at least four
satellites. Steering angle B can be a maximum of 35° in both directions.
X
To show the map data menu: press W
the COMAND controller.
X
Select Navi in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Map version and press W to confirm.
The map data version number is shown.
Information about new versions of the digital map can be obtained from a MercedesBenz Service Centre.
To exit the display: confirm Back by pressing W or press the % back button.
Country-specific information
You can call up information on the traffic conditions in the country you are currently driving
in via the COMAND Online Internet and online function.
The availability of information is countrydependent. Information can include maximum speeds, driving with dipped-beam headlamps or legal alcohol limits, for example.
X To switch to navigation mode: press the
Ø button.
X
X
To show the menu: press W the COMAND
controller.
Updating the digital map
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Inhaling
these exhaust gases leads to poisoning. There
is a risk of fatal injury. Therefore never leave
the engine running in enclosed spaces without sufficient ventilation.
ware updates for your vehicle are available at
your Mercedes-Benz partner.
Introduction
The digital maps generated by the map software become outdated in the same way as
conventional road maps. Optimal route guidance can only be provided by the navigation
system in conjunction with the most up-todate map software.
Information about new versions of the digital
map can be obtained from a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre. You can have the digital map
updated there with a DVD, or you can update
it yourself.
In some countries, it is possible to update the
map data for COMAND Online free of charge
for a period of 3 years. Information on the
availability of this service for your vehicle can
be obtained from your Mercedes-Benz Service Centre. If the free update is not available
in your country, please read the "Updating
process" section.
Updating at the Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre
If an update for your map software is available, you will receive it free of charge at your
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre during your
vehicle's annual service. You can arrange a
separate appointment for this at your
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre on request.
The update is performed only by a MercedesBenz Service Centre for European map data.
The map software is not provided on a data
medium.
Entitlement to the free update
For the first three years after your vehicle is
registered, you are entitled to all available
updates to the map software for
COMAND Online. They are usually installed
during a regular vehicle service. After this
period, you can purchase further updates
from your Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
The free updates relate to the vehicle and not
to an individual. If there is a change of ownership within 3 years of first registration, the
new owner is entitled to the map software
updates.
Availability of free updates
Enter your e-mail address at http://
www.mercedes-benz-accessories.com/
comand-infomail. You will receive a one-off email containing information on how to update
the map software. Please also visit http://
www.mercedes-benz-accessories.com/
navigation-updates to find out if map soft-
Carrying out the update yourself
i The update process may take some time
(over an hour), depending on the size of the
digital map. During this time, you will only
be able to switch on radio mode and to
accept incoming calls. The update will be
completed more quickly if the vehicle is
stationary.
If you start the update with the engine
switched off and the starter battery has
insufficient power, COMAND Online may
automatically switch off. This preserves the
battery. If this occurs, restart the update
with the engine running.
Insert the DVD:
Rin the single DVD drive (Y page 469)
Rin the DVD changer (Y page 469)
COMAND Online checks whether the digital map on the DVD is compatible with the
navigation system and system software.
A prompt then appears asking if you want
to install the database. Versions of the
database currently installed and the database that is to be installed are displayed.
X Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
After selecting Yes
Yes, an activation code
must be entered when installing a database
for the first time. You will receive the activation code when you buy the navigation
DVD.
X
Z
383
COMAND Online
Navigation
Navigation
COMAND Online
384
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
X Enter the activation code.
After entering the activation code correctly, COMAND Online starts updating the
digital map. Once the update is finished,
you will see a message.
X To confirm the message: press W the
COMAND controller.
X Take the DVD out of the slot.
While the update is running, you will see a
message to this effect and a progress bar.
The navigation system is not operational
until the update is complete.
i You cannot eject the DVD during the
update. If you switch off COMAND Online
during the update, the update is interrupted. It then continues from where it was
interrupted when the system is restarted.
COMAND Online may prompt you to change
the DVD during the update.
X Press the V (for DVD changer) or 8
(for single DVD drive) load/eject button.
X
Take the DVD out of the slot.
X
Insert the requested DVD.
Once the update has been successfully
completed, you will see a message to this
effect.
X
To confirm the message: press W the
COMAND controller.
X
Take the DVD out of the slot.
The update is complete.
If the update is not successfully completed,
you will see a message that the map update
is not possible.
X
To confirm the message: press W the
COMAND controller.
X
Take the DVD out of the slot.
Navigation
385
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
COMAND Online is
unable to continue
route guidance after
the journey has been
interrupted.
Route guidance is cancelled if you interrupt the journey for more
than two hours.
"Interrupting the journey" refers to stopping the vehicle.
"Continuing route guidance" refers to switching COMAND Online
back on and driving on.
X Continue route guidance (Y page 356).
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
COMAND Online is
unable to determine
the vehicle's position.
COMAND Online has to redetermine the position of the vehicle if
the vehicle has been transported.
Examples:
Rafter
transporting the vehicle by ferry
transporting the vehicle by motorail
Rafter the vehicle has been towed
X Start the vehicle and pull away.
COMAND Online determines the vehicle's position. Depending
on the driving situation, this may take some time.
Route guidance may be restricted during the determination of
the vehicle's position.
When positioning is complete, route guidance is resumed with
navigation announcements and route guidance displays.
Rafter
Z
COMAND Online
Problems with the navigation system
386
Navigation
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
COMAND Online has an integrated hard drive on which the digital
The Navigation
unavailable message map is stored.
appears.
To protect the integrated hard drive against damage,
COMAND Online deactivates it at very high and low temperatures.
The navigation system will then be temporarily unavailable.
X Let the vehicle and COMAND Online cool down.
X To hide the message: switch COMAND Online off and then on
again.
COMAND Online
If an area of the hard disk has a fault, COMAND Online can no
longer access the map data in this area. This may occur when
calculating a route, for example.
X To hide the message: switch COMAND Online off and then on
again.
The navigation system will be operational again until it has to
access the faulty area of the hard drive once more. The message
will then reappear.
X Consult a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
You see a message
The DVD containing the digital map cannot be used for the update.
informing you that the X To confirm the message: press W the COMAND controller.
DVD containing the digital map is incompatible X Eject the DVD.
X Have the system database checked at a Mercedes-Benz Service
with the system softCentre.
ware.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The map software
update has failed.
The DVD is dirty.
X Clean the DVD.
X
Restart the update.
The DVD is scratched.
X Consult a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Telephone
Problem
387
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
There is overheating due to excessive temperatures in the vehicle
interior.
X Wait until the vehicle interior has cooled down.
X
Restart the update.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
COMAND Online asks The digital map is secured with an activation code.
for an activation code X Consult a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
during the map update.
Telephone
Features of your COMAND Online
This Supplement describes all the standard
and optional equipment for your COMAND
Online system, as available at the time of
going to print. Country-specific differences
are possible. Please note that your
COMAND Online system may not be equipped with all the features described.
General notes
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating communications equipment integrated into the vehicle while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could
then lose control of the vehicle. There is a risk
of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
G WARNING
If you use the RF transmitter in the vehicle in
an improper way, its electromagnetic radiation can disrupt vehicle electronics, e.g. if:
Rthe
RF transmitter is not connected to an
exterior aerial
Rthe exterior aerial is fitted incorrectly or is
not a low-reflection aerial
This can jeopardise the operating safety of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Have the low-reflection exterior aerial fitted at
a qualified specialist workshop. When operating in the vehicle, always connect the RF
transmitter to the low-reflection exterior aerial.
You must observe the legal requirements for
the country in which you are currently driving
when operating mobile communications
equipment in the vehicle.
Excessive levels of electromagnetic radiation
may cause damage to your health and to the
health of others.
There is scientific discussion surrounding the
possible health risks posed by electromagnetic fields. You can reduce this risk by using
an exterior aerial.
Z
COMAND Online
COMAND Online's integrated hard disk is defective.
X Consult a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
COMAND Online
388
Telephone
Therefore, only use mobile communication
equipment if it is connected to the exterior
aerial of the vehicle.
Call disconnected while the vehicle is in
motion
Introduction
Rthere is insufficient GSM network coverage
COMAND Online allows you to use two different modes of telephony:
Rtelephony via the Bluetooth® interface
(standard equipment):
Rpermanently installed/SAP telephony (only
in conjunction with a data-enabled MB
SAP module)
In telephony via Bluetooth® interface
mode, the mobile phone is connected directly
to COMAND Online via Bluetooth®.
Enhancing this operating mode with the
optional mobile phone bracket allows you to:
Rconnect
the mobile phone to the exterior
aerial on the vehicle
Rcharge the mobile phone
In the permanently installed/SAP telephony mode, the optional data-enabled MB
SAP module is inserted into the fitting in the
armrest designed for housing the mobile
phone bracket.
When connecting Bluetooth®-capable mobile
phones with PBAP (Phone Book Access
Profile), the contacts are automatically downloaded to COMAND Online.
If your mobile phone supports the MAP Bluetooth® profile (Message Access Profile),
COMAND Online can receive and display text
messages.
Further information on the following topics
can be obtained from your Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre or on the Internet at http://
www.mercedes-benz.com/connect:
Rsuitable
mobile phones
Ravailable mobile phone brackets
Rconnecting Bluetooth®-capable mobile
phones to COMAND Online
Roverview of the functions for the operating
modes
A call may be disconnected if:
in certain areas
move from one GSM or UMTS transmitter/receiver area (GSM/UMTS cell) into
another and no channels are free
Ryou use a SIM card that is not compatible
with the network available
Ryou are using a mobile phone with "Twincard" and the mobile phone with the second SIM card is logged into the network at
the same time
Ryou
Operating options
You can operate the telephone:
Rusing
the COMAND controller:
turn c V d
slide XVY or ZVÆ
press W
Rby using the 6 or ~ button and the
telephone keypad on COMAND Online
Rby using the 6 or ~ button on the
multifunction steering wheel
Rby using LINGUATRONIC (see the separate
LINGUATRONIC operating instructions)
Unless stated otherwise, the descriptions and
illustrations in this section refer to
COMAND Online.
Function restrictions
You will not be able to use the telephone, will
no longer be able to use the telephone, or you
may have to wait before using it in the following situations:
Rif
the mobile phone is switched off
Rif the Bluetooth® function is switched off in
COMAND Online
Telephone
the mobile phone while you are using Bluetooth® interface telephony
Rif the mobile phone is not logged into a
mobile phone network
i The telephone automatically tries to log
on to a network. If no network is available,
you may not be able to make a 999 or 112
emergency call. If you attempt to make an
outgoing call, the No service message will
appear for a short while.
If you switch COMAND Online off during a call
in hands-free mode, the call will be terminated. You can prevent this as follows:
X Switch the mobile phone to private mode
before switching off COMAND Online (see
the mobile phone operating instructions).
999 or 112 emergency call
The following conditions must be fulfilled in
order to make a 999 or 112 emergency call:
Rthe
mobile phone must be switched on
network must be available
Ra valid and operational SIM card must be
inserted in the mobile phone
Rthe PIN must have been entered
If you are unable to make an emergency call,
you must arrange rescue measures yourself.
Ra
i The 999 or 112 emergency call number is
a public service. Any misuse is punishable
by law.
Telephony via the Bluetooth® interface
Conditions
For telephony via COMAND Online's Bluetooth® interface, a Bluetooth®-capable
mobile phone is required.
On COMAND Online
X
Activate the Bluetooth® function in
COMAND Online (Y page 313).
On the mobile phone
Switch on the mobile phone and enter the
PIN when prompted to do so (see the
mobile phone operating instructions).
X Activate Bluetooth® functions and, if necessary, Bluetooth® visibility on the mobile
phone (see the mobile phone operating
instructions).
X
The battery of the mobile phone should
always be kept sufficiently charged in order to
prevent malfunctions.
In preparation for telephoning via the Bluetooth® interface, you should check the following items on your mobile phone (see the
mobile phone operating instructions):
RHands-Free
Profile
The mobile phone must support HandsFree Profile 1.0 or above.
RBluetooth® visibility
On certain mobile phones, the device itself
must be made "visible" to other devices, as
well as activating the Bluetooth® function
(see the mobile phone operating instructions).
This visibility is for restricted periods of
time on some mobile phones.
RBluetooth® device name
Every Bluetooth® device has a Bluetooth®
device name. This device name is freely
definable, but can be identical for all devices from the same manufacturer. It is
therefore recommended that you change
this name so that you can easily recognise
your mobile phone (see the mobile phone
operating instructions).
i Not all mobile phones available on the
market are equally suitable. Further information on suitable mobile phones and
mobile phone brackets can be obtained at
your Mercedes-Benz Service Centre or on
Z
COMAND Online
Rif the Bluetooth® function is switched off on
389
390
Telephone
the Internet at http://www.mercedesbenz.com/connect.
Searching for a mobile phone
i Some displays (e.g. the signal strength)
depend on the supported version of the
Hands-Free Profile.
COMAND Online
Connecting a mobile phone
General notes
Before using your mobile phone with
COMAND Online for the first time, you will
need to:
Rsearch
for it (Y page 390) and then
Rauthorise (register) it (Y page 391).
Device-specific information on authorising
and connecting Bluetooth®-capable mobile
phones can be found on the Internet at
http://www.mercedes-benz.com/
connect.
When you authorise a new mobile phone, it is
connected automatically.
You can authorise up to 15 mobile phones.
If the mobile phone supports PBAP (Phone
Book Access Profile) and MAP (Message
Access Profile), the following contacts and
messages are downloaded into COMAND
Online when connecting:
Empty Bluetooth® telephones list
Conditions for searching
Rthe
phone book
call lists
Rtext messages (SMS)
Further information on the conditions for connecting (Y page 389).
Rthe
Bluetooth® telephones list after the search has finished
Press the % function button on
COMAND Online.
X Select Connect device from the telephone basic menu by sliding V Æ and turning c V d the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
X
Telephone
external authorisation may be necessary
(Y page 392).
X
i When you call up the phone list again, deauthorised devices will be removed from
the list. In this case, start a new search to
update the Bluetooth® telephone list.
Authorising (registering) a mobile phone
COMAND Online
Select Search for phones and press the
W button to confirm.
A message appears.
X Select Start search and press the W
button to confirm.
The Searching for Bluetooth
phones... message appears. COMAND
Online looks for Bluetooth® telephones
within range and adds them to the Bluetooth® telephones list.
If a new phone is found, it appears in the list
with the Ï symbol.
The duration of the search depends on the
number of Bluetooth® telephones within
range and their characteristics.
Symbols in the Bluetooth® phone list
Symbol
Explanation
Ï
New mobile phone in range, but
not yet authorised
Y
Authorised mobile phone
#
Currently connected mobile
phone
Ñ
Mobile phone in range and
authorised
Ñ
(grey)
Mobile phone not in range, but
already authorised
Passkey entry
The Bluetooth® phone list shows all mobile
phones within range and all previously
authorised mobile phones, whether or not
they are in range.
i Mobile phones that are connected to the
optional data-enabled MB SAP module are
shown in a separate phone list. You can call
this up using the MB SAP module entry
(Y page 421).
i If the Bluetooth® telephones list is already
full, you will be requested to de-authorise a
mobile phone (Y page 393). If COMAND
Online does not find your mobile phone,
391
Telephone basic menu
Option 1: using the passkey (access number)
X
Select the mobile phone with the Ï
symbol from the Bluetooth® telephones list
by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
The input menu for the passkey appears.
The passkey is any one to sixteen-digit number combination which you can choose yourself. You must enter the same number combination in COMAND Online and in the Bluetooth®-capable mobile phone (see the mobile
phone operating instructions).
Z
Telephone
392
i Some mobile phones require a passkey
with four or more digits.
i If you want to re-authorise a mobile phone
following de-authorisation, you can select a
different passkey.
If the COMAND Online display shows the
Authorisation failed message, you
may have exceeded the prescribed time
period. Repeat the procedure.
i Mercedes-Benz recommends de-authorisation in COMAND Online and on the
mobile phone (Y page 393). Subsequent
authorisation may otherwise fail.
COMAND Online
X
To enter a passkey in COMAND Online:
press the number keys in turn.
or
X
X
Select the digits in the digit bar one by one
by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and pressing W to confirm.
¬is highlighted after the first number
has been entered.
In both cases, select ¬ and press W to
confirm.
To enter the passkey on the mobile
phone: if the Bluetooth® connection is successful, you will be requested to enter the
passkey (access code, passkey; see the
mobile phone operating instructions).
X Enter the same passkey in the mobile
phone as the one already entered in
COMAND Online.
The Connecting Bluetooth pro‐
files... message appears.
The Authorisation successful message appears once authorisation is completed.
X
Option 2: using Secure Simple Pairing
To connect via Secure Simple Pairing, the
mobile phone (or Bluetooth® audio equipment) must support Bluetooth® Version 2.1.
COMAND Online creates a six-digit code,
which is displayed on both devices that are to
be connected.
X If the code is the same on both devices,
confirm Yes by pressing W.
If you select Yes
Yes, authorisation is continued
and the mobile phone is connected.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
X Confirm the message on the mobile phone.
External authorisation
The mobile phone is authorised and connected to COMAND Online. You can now make
phone calls using the COMAND Online handsfree system.
i After entering the passkey, you may also
need to enter a confirmation in your mobile
phone in order to make calls. Please check
your mobile phone display. On some mobile
phones, this confirmation can be saved. In
this case, you do not need to enter it again.
If COMAND Online does not detect your
mobile phone, this may be due to particular
security settings on your mobile phone. In this
case, you can test if your mobile phone can
Telephone
Start the Bluetooth® search on the mobile
phone; see the mobile phone operating
instructions.
X Select COMAND Online (MB
MB Bluetooth)
Bluetooth
on the mobile phone.
X Option 1: when requested to do so, enter
the passkey first on the mobile phone and
then in COMAND Online.
X Option 2: confirm the displayed codes on
the mobile phone and in COMAND Online
(Secure Simple Pairing).
With both options, you see the prompt Do
you want to authorise ? on the COMAND display.
X If you select Yes
Yes, the mobile phone will be
authorised. The messages Waiting for
to be con‐
nected... and Connecting Bluetooth
profiles... are displayed. If the connection is successful, you see the telephone
basic menu and the connected mobile
phone is entered.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
X
Reconnecting automatically
COMAND Online always searches for the last
connected mobile phone.
If no connection can be made to the most
recently connected mobile phone, the system
searches for the mobile phone that was connected before that one.
Switching between mobile phones
If you have authorised more than one mobile
phone, you can switch between the individual
phones.
X Select the mobile phone from the Bluetooth® phone list by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The selected mobile phone is searched for
and connected if it is within Bluetooth®
range and if Bluetooth® is activated.
Only one mobile phone can be connected
at any one time. The currently connected
mobile phone is indicated by the # dot in
the Bluetooth® phone list.
i You can only switch to another authorised
mobile phone if you are not currently making a call.
De-authorising (de-registering) a mobile
phone
Mercedes-Benz recommends de-authorisation in COMAND Online and on the mobile
phone. Subsequent authorisation may otherwise fail.
X Press the % function button on
COMAND Online.
X Select Connect device from the telephone basic menu by sliding V Æ and turning c V d the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
The Bluetooth® telephones list
appears(Y page 390).
X Select the desired mobile phone in the
Bluetooth® phone list.
Z
COMAND Online
find COMAND Online. The Bluetooth® device
name of COMAND Online is "MB
MB Bluetooth
Bluetooth".
Please note the following: some mobile
phones require that you establish the connection to COMAND Online again once you
have entered the passkey (see the mobile
phone operating instructions). The mobile
phone cannot otherwise be authorised.
X Press the % function button on
COMAND Online.
X Select Connect device from the telephone basic menu by sliding V Æ and turning c V d the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
The Bluetooth® phone list appears.
X Select Search via telephone and press
W to confirm.
The message on the left appears.
393
Telephone
394
Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select De-authorise and press W to confirm.
A prompt appears, asking whether you
really wish to de-authorise this device.
X Select Yes or No
No.
If you select Yes
Yes, the device will be deleted
from the Bluetooth® telephones list.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
COMAND Online
X
Telephone basic menu (Bluetooth®
interface)
Basic menu display
i Before re-authorising the mobile phone,
you should also delete the device name MB
Bluetooth from your mobile phone's Bluetooth® list.
Displaying connection details
Press the % function button on
COMAND Online.
X Select Connect device from the telephone basic menu by sliding V Æ and turning c V d the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
The Bluetooth® phone list appears.
X Select the desired mobile phone in the
Bluetooth® phone list.
X
Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Details and press W to confirm.
The following information concerning the
selected mobile phone is shown:
RBluetooth® name
RBluetooth® address
Ravailability status (shown after a new
search)
Rauthorisation status
X To close the detailed view: turn cVd or
slide XVY the COMAND controller.
X
Telephone basic menu (Bluetooth® interface)
: Network provider's name (depends on the
connected phone)
; Signal strength of mobile phone network
Ä
Receiver icon ¢ or ¡
To display call lists
Character bar
Bluetooth® name of the currently connected mobile phone
C To display the COMAND phone book
=
?
A
B
Press the % function button.
The telephone basic menu appears when
the connected mobile phone is ready for
use.
i Displays : and ; are shown, depending
on the mobile phone connected.
Bars ; show the current signal strength of
the mobile phone network. If all bars are
filled, you have optimum reception.
If there are no bars, there is very poor
reception or none at all.
The receiver symbol shows whether a call is
active/being connected ¡ or not ¢.
X
Displaying text messages in the telephone basic menu
The SMS menu item is only available if the
Bluetooth® phone supports the MAP Bluetooth® profile (Message Access Profile). The
downloading of text messages from the Bluetooth® phone must have been completed.
The menu item is otherwise greyed out. Further information on text messages
(Y page 409).
If you have an unread text message, the 1
mail symbol is displayed. The symbol disappears once you have read the text message.
The ú mail symbol is displayed as soon as
the text message memory is full. The symbol
disappears once you delete at least one text
message.
Switching on and changing telephony
operating modes
Overview
If your vehicle is equipped with convenience
telephony, COMAND Online starts the telephony mode depending on whether a telephone
module with Bluetooth® (SAP profile) is inserted in the fitting or not.
If neither a telephone module with Bluetooth®
(SAP profile) nor a mobile phone bracket is
inserted, COMAND Online immediately starts
the telephony via the Bluetooth® interface.
message appears. Approximately two
minutes after switching on COMAND Online,
a prompt will appear asking whether you wish
to switch to Bluetooth® telephony.
If you confirm by selecting Yes
Yes, the Ready
for Bluetooth telephony... message
will appear. COMAND Online will search for
the two mobile phones last connected via the
Bluetooth® interface. If one of the two mobile
phones is found, the telephone basic menu
for Bluetooth® telephony appears
(Y page 394). If neither of the mobile phones
is found, the Ready for Bluetooth tel‐
ephony... message remains in the display.
You can now connect your mobile phone
(Y page 390).
If you choose No
No, the Ready for SAP con‐
nectivity... message reappears.
Activating without a telephone module
with Bluetooth® (SAP profile)
If a telephone module with Bluetooth® (SAP
profile) is inserted, COMAND Online starts
the SAP telephony.
Bluetooth® telephony is started
COMAND Online starts telephony via the
Bluetooth® interface and searches for the last
two mobile phones to have been connected
via the Bluetooth® interface. If one of the two
mobile phones is found, the telephone basic
menu for Bluetooth® telephony appears
(Y page 394). If neither of the mobile phones
is found, the Ready for Bluetooth tel‐
ephony... message remains in the display.
You now have to connect your mobile phone
(Y page 390).
i If no telephone module with Bluetooth®
i If you do not connect another mobile
Activating with inserted telephone
module with Bluetooth® (SAP profile)
(SAP profile) is inserted, COMAND Online
checks whether a mobile phone bracket is
inserted and, if so, which type.
i You must set up your »telephone module
with Bluetooth® (SAP profile)« before first
use so it is recognised by COMAND Online
(Y page 420).
If no mobile phone is connected to the telephone module with Bluetooth® (SAP profile),
the Ready for Bluetooth telephony...
phone via the phone list, the Bluetooth®
connection with the mobile phone remains
active until the next time COMAND Online
is switched off. While the Bluetooth® connection is active, only the Bluetooth® interface functions are available to you.
Switching between modes of telephony
If your vehicle is equipped with an optional
data-enabled telephone module with BlueZ
395
COMAND Online
Telephone
Telephone
396
tooth® (SAP profile), you can switch the telephony mode.
You can change the mode of telephony in the
Bluetooth® phone list by selecting either a
Bluetooth® telephone or an SAP telephone.
X Call up the phone list (Y page 390).
X To select the mobile phone with the controller: turn and press the controller.
COMAND Online
i SAP telephony: mobile phones which are
connected to an optional data-enabled
telephone module with Bluetooth® (SAP
profile) are shown in the telephone list
under the title Telephones of the SAP
module. By selecting an SAP telephone,
module
you change to SAP telephony.
Reception and transmission volume
Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Reception volume or Transmis‐
sion volume and press W to confirm.
X Select a volume setting by turning cVd the
COMAND controller.
X To close the setting scale: press W or
slide X V Y.
X
i Incorrect settings may have an impact on
the quality of calls.
Telephone operation
Incoming calls
Accepting a call
Once the mobile phone has been authorised,
you can optimise the transmission and reception volume settings. To find out about the
best possible settings for your mobile phone,
contact a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre or
visit http://www.mercedes-benz.com/
connect.
Example: incoming call
X
To accept: confirm Accept by pressing W.
or
Press the 6 button on COMAND Online
or on the multifunction steering wheel.
i You can also accept the call by voice command using LINGUATRONIC (see the separate operating instructions).
Once you have accepted the call, you can use
hands-free mode.
The call volume can be adjusted
(Y page 299).
Other functions during a call (Y page 398)
If the phone number of the caller is transferred, it appears in the display.
X
Press the % function button.
Select Connect device in the telephone
basic menu by sliding V Æ and turning
c V d the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
X Select an authorised mobile phone from
the list by turning cVd.
X
X
Telephone
i You can also accept a call as described
above when another main function is
switched on in COMAND. Once you have
accepted the call, the display switches to
telephone mode. After the call is finished,
you see the display of the previous main
function again.
The display does not switch to the telephone display if you:
Rpress
the % back button next to the
COMAND controller and then
Raccept the call using the 6 button on
the multifunction steering wheel
Rejecting a call
X To reject: select Reject by turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
or
X Press the ~ button on COMAND Online
or on the multifunction steering wheel.
Making a call
Using the number keypad
X Call up the telephone basic menu
(Y page 394).
X Enter the digits using the number keypad.
X
To connect the call: press the 6 button on COMAND Online or on the multifunction steering wheel.
Using the telephone basic menu
Call up the telephone basic menu
(Y page 394).
X Select the digits one by one by turning cVd
and sliding ZVÆ the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
X
X
To make a call: select ° in the character
bar and press W to confirm.
or
X
Press the 6 button on COMAND Online
or on the multifunction steering wheel.
Redialling
X Call up the telephone basic menu
(Y page 394).
X Select ° in the character bar and press W
to confirm.
or
X If the telephone basic menu is displayed,
press the 6 button on COMAND Online.
In both cases, the calls dialled list appears.
The most recently dialled number is at the
top.
To select a call: turn cVd the COMAND
controller.
X To connect the call: press W the
COMAND controller.
X
For redialling using the multifunction steering
wheel, see the separate vehicle Owner's Manual.
Using the call list or COMAND phone book
Open a call list and select an entry
(Y page 405).
or
X Call up the COMAND phone book and
select an entry (Y page 402).
X
X
To make a call: press W the COMAND
controller or the 6 button.
Select and place a call using the multifunction
steering wheel, see the separate vehicle Owner's Manual.
Using speed dial presets to make a call
The speed dial list contains stored entries
from the phone book (Y page 407).
Z
COMAND Online
If there is an entry for the caller in the phone
book, you will also see the name.
If the phone number is not transferred or the
"Hide data" function is activated, Unknown
appears in the display.
397
Telephone
398
Option 1:
X
Press one of the number keys for longer
than two seconds.
The telephone basic menu displays the
selected entry. This initiates dialling.
Option 2:
Call up the telephone basic menu
(Y page 394).
X Select Call lists by sliding VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
A menu appears.
X Select Speed dial preset list by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
The speed dial list appears.
X Select the preset and press W to confirm.
The telephone basic menu displays the
selected entry. This initiates dialling.
COMAND Online
X
Switching the hands-free microphone on/
off
This function is also available during an active
phone call.
X Call up the telephone basic menu
(Y page 394).
To switch off: select Mike off and press
W to confirm.
If the microphone is switched off, the display shows the Q icon, and the The
microphone is off message appears for
a short period.
X To switch on: select Mike on and press W
to confirm.
The Q symbol disappears. You will briefly
see the The microphone is on message.
X
Sending DTMF tones
Functions available during a call
Overview
Telephone operation with a single call
: Person you are calling
; Icon for active telephone connection
= Switches the hands-free microphone off/
on (Y page 398)
? Sends DTMF tones (not possible with all
mobile phones) (Y page 398)
A Ends the call
This function is not supported by all mobile
phones.
Answering machines or other devices can be
controlled by DTMF tones, e.g. for remote
query functions.
X If you would like to listen to the messages
on your answering machine, for example,
select the corresponding number.
X
To transmit individual characters: once
a connection has been established to the
answering machine, select the desired
Telephone
or
Press the corresponding key on the
COMAND Online number keypad.
Every character selected will be transmitted immediately.
X To send a phone book entry as a DTMF
sequence: select Name by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select the desired phone book entry and
press W to confirm.
The entry is sent as a DTMF character
string.
X
X
To return to the call display: select Back
and press W to confirm.
i DTMF tones can also be transmitted using
LINGUATRONIC; see the separate operating instructions.
Calls with several participants
Rejecting or accepting a waiting call
The mobile phone network provider must support and activate the call-waiting function.
Depending on the mobile phone used, the
system behaviour differs when accepting a
call.
If you have a call in progress and receive
another call, a new window appears in the
display. You also hear a tone. You can accept
or reject the call.
X To reject: select Reject and press W to
confirm.
or
X Press the ~ button on COMAND Online
or on the multifunction steering wheel.
X To accept: select Accept and press W to
confirm.
or
X Press the 6 button on COMAND Online
or on the multifunction steering wheel.
The system behaviour after accepting the
incoming call depends on your mobile phone.
RThe mobile phone supports the call waiting
function (via Bluetooth®) when:
the previously active call is held. You can
then switch back and forth between both
calls (call waiting) (Y page 400).
RThe mobile phone does not support the call
waiting function (via Bluetooth®) when:
the previously active call is ended.
This is also the case if you accept the waiting call using LINGUATRONIC (see the separate operating instructions).
Valid in both cases: if you accept the waiting
call using the mobile phone, the active call is
put on hold. You then have two calls. The call
you have just accepted is active.
The COMAND display changes. If you continue to operate functions on the mobile
phone, the COMAND Online display may differ from that of the mobile phone.
Making a second call
If the following requirements are met, you can
make another call while on the phone with
someone else:
RThe
mobile network must permit this function.
RThe mobile phone must allow you to make a
second call via Bluetooth®. This action puts
the previous call on hold if the mobile
phone supports this function.
RThe corresponding setting must be activated on the mobile phone.
Z
COMAND Online
characters in the character bar, pressing W
to confirm each of them.
399
Telephone
COMAND Online
400
: Symbol for making a second call
X
Select symbol : by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
or
X
Press the 6 button on COMAND Online.
X
Enter the phone number:
Rmanually (Y page 397)
Rusing the phone book (Y page 402)
Rusing the call lists (Y page 405)
Rusing speed dial (Y page 397)
Call waiting and conference calls
You can switch back and forth between two
calls with the call waiting function. The function is available if your mobile phone supports
the toggling function (via Bluetooth®).
You can interconnect various callers to create
a conference call with the Conference function.
You can use the function if you are answering
a second call or making a second call while
talking to someone else.
: Active call
; Call on hold
= Interconnects the call on hold and the
active call to create a conference call.
To switch between the active call and the call
on hold (call waiting):
X
Select call on hold ; and press W to confirm.
or
X
Press the 6 button on COMAND Online
or on the multifunction steering wheel.
The previous call on hold is activated.
X
To end the active call: select ¢ in the
telephone basic menu and press W to confirm.
or
X
Press the ~ button on COMAND Online
or on the multifunction steering wheel.
The call on hold is active.
Interconnecting the call on hold and the
active call to create a conference call:
X
Select Conference and press W to confirm.
Telephone
Calling other participants:
X
Select symbol : and press W to confirm.
You can now switch between the new participant and the conference call or add the
participant to the conference call.
401
In addition, MB Contact is listed as the first
entry. This allows you to place a call to the
Mercedes-Benz Service hotline (Y page 427).
The phone book of the mobile phone is automatically downloaded to COMAND Online
after connection.
In the telephone book, you can:
Rsave
phone numbers (Y page 404)
for entries (Y page 402)
Rdelete entries (Y page 403)
Rimport contacts (Y page 417)
Rdelete contacts (Y page 418)
Rreceive vCards (Y page 418)
i The stored phone book and the vCards
remain in COMAND Online even if you use
COMAND Online with another mobile
phone. The entries can be viewed without a
mobile phone. For this reason, you should
delete any phone book entries before handing over or selling the vehicle.
Switching between a new participant and the
conference call:
X
Select Conference call and press W to
confirm.
You will change to a conference call. The
new participant is placed on hold.
Adding a new participant to the conference
call:
X
Select Conference and press W to confirm.
Transferring a call
If you want to continue a call in private mode,
you will need to carry out the necessary steps
on the mobile phone.
See the mobile phone operating instructions
for further information.
Using the phone book
Calling up the phone book
Opening the phone book
Press the % function button.
X Select Name in the telephone basic menu by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
If the phone book contains entries, they will
be displayed in alphabetical order. The
character bar at the bottom of the display is
active.
The character bar is used for fast selection
of an entry.
Enter the character using the character bar
(Y page 303).
X
Introduction
The phone book displays the names and
phone numbers of all address book entries
saved in the COMAND address book. If an
address book entry does not have a telephone number, it does not appear in the
phone book.
Z
COMAND Online
Rsearch
Telephone
402
COMAND Online
Sym- Explanation
bol
Ã
Contact imported from a mobile
phone that supports PBAP
¯
Entry which has been imported
from the SD memory card or USB
device
®
Entry imported via the Bluetooth®
interface
i You can also call up the telephone book
with the multifunction steering wheel, see
the separate vehicle Owner's Manual.
Closing the phone book
X Select the & symbol in the main function
bar by sliding VÆ and turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
or
X Press the % button.
Searching for a phone book entry
Searching with the character bar
You determine the first letter of the entry you
are looking for with the first character you
enter.
X
Using the multifunction steering wheel
Use the = or ; button to select the
Tel menu.
X Use 9, : or 9 to call up the phone
book.
X
Symbol overview
Sym- Explanation
bol
Æ
Address book entry that has been
entered or changed via COMAND
Online
Imported contact that has been
saved in the phone or address book
\
Address book entry with voice tag
These entries have also been
assigned a voice tag. Voice tags are
available in vehicles with LINGUATRONIC (see the separate operating instructions).
Select a character by turning c V d the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The first entry in the list that starts with the
letter selected is highlighted. If there are
similar entries, the next different character
is shown. For example, with entries such as
Christel and Christine
Christine, the beginnings
of the names are similar. In this case, you
will be offered a choice between E and I.
Select the characters of the entry you are
searching for one by one and press W to
confirm.
When the selection is clear,
COMAND Online switches automatically to
the selection list.
X To complete the search: slide VZ the
COMAND controller repeatedly or press
and hold W until the character bar disappears.
The selection list appears.
X
Information about character entry
(Y page 303)
Telephone
Searching with the number keypad
You determine the first letter of the entry you
are looking for with the first character you
enter.
X
Press the corresponding number keys in
rapid succession.
X
More information on entering characters
using the number keypad (direct entry)
(Y page 305).
Directly from the list
You can switch to the list at any time during
character entry.
X Slide VZ the COMAND controller repeatedly or press and hold W until the character bar disappears.
or
X Select¬and press W to confirm.
X
To select an entry: turn c V d the
COMAND controller until the desired entry
is highlighted and press W to confirm.
To select a phone number: the G symbol
indicates that an entry contains more than
one phone number.
X
Select a phone book entry with the G
symbol and press W to confirm.
The sub-entries appear. The G symbol
changes to I.
Phone book entry with several entries
X
Select a sub-entry by turning cVd and
press W to confirm.
To return to the phone book using the
character bar: select & in the list and
press W to confirm.
or
Press the % button.
Using the multifunction steering wheel
X Dialling a number from the telephone book;
see the separate vehicle Owner's Manual.
Displaying the details of an entry
Select an entry in the selection list by turning c V d the COMAND controller.
X Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
X
Select Details and press W to confirm.
The detailed display appears.
X
To close the detailed display: slide XVY
repeatedly until the entry is highlighted
again.
or
X
Press the % back button.
Deleting an entry from the phone book
If the entry contains only phone numbers, it is
deleted from the phone book and address
book.
If it contains additional data, such as a navigable destination, the entry is deleted in the
phone book. However, the entry is retained in
the address book.
X Select an entry in the selection list by turning c V d the COMAND controller.
X Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Delete and press W to confirm.
A prompt appears asking whether the entry
should be deleted.
X
Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, the entry is deleted in
accordance with the rules described above.
Z
COMAND Online
X
403
Telephone
404
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The entry is created in the phone book and
in the address book.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
Creating a new entry in the phone book
COMAND Online
Adding to a phone book entry
Slide Z V the COMAND controller repeatedly in the phone book until the selection
list appears.
X Select the list symbol on the right in the
selection list by sliding VY the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X Select New entry and press W to confirm.
X Select a category for the number, e.g. Home
Home,
and press W to confirm.
X Select a category for the phone, e.g.
Mobile, and press W to confirm.
Mobile
X Select Continue and press W to confirm.
The input menu with data fields appears.
X
You can add telephone numbers to an existing phone book entry.
X Select an entry in the selection list by turning c V d the COMAND controller.
X Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Add telephone no. and press W
to confirm.
X Select a category for the number, e.g. Home
Home,
and press W to confirm.
X Select a category for the phone, e.g.
Mobile, and press W to confirm.
Mobile
X Select Continue and press W to confirm.
COMAND Online stores the data if there are
fewer than five numbers assigned to the
entry you are searching for in the selected
number category.
If five numbers are stored for the entry in
the selected number category, a prompt
will appear. You can then choose whether
to overwrite one of the existing numbers.
Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, a selection list will appear
containing the five existing numbers.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
X Select the number to be overwritten by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
An input menu appears. The data field for
entering the new phone number is highlighted.
X
: Selected data field with cursor
; Character bar
Character entry (Y page 303)
X To save an entry: select the¬symbol in
the character bar by turning c V d the
X
X
X
Character entry (Y page 303)
Save the entry (Y page 304)
Telephone
Introduction
While the telephone is being used,
COMAND Online stores individual lists for
both incoming and outgoing calls (including
missed calls). Call lists are not available
unless a mobile phone is connected to
COMAND Online.
COMAND Online supports the PBAP Bluetooth® profile. For this reason, note that the
system behaviour differs, especially when telephoning via the Bluetooth® interface:
with PBAP Bluetooth® profile
The call lists are downloaded automatically
from the mobile phone by COMAND Online
as soon as the mobile phone is connected
to COMAND Online.
RBluetooth® telephone without PBAP Bluetooth® profile:
The call lists are created and displayed by
COMAND Online.
Opening the call list and selecting an
entry
X
X
Press the % function button.
Select Call lists in the telephone basic
menu by sliding VÆ and turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
A menu appears.
COMAND Online
Using call lists
Rphone
i For Bluetooth® telephones without the
PBAP Bluetooth® profile, the call lists in
COMAND Online are not synchronised with
those on your mobile phone. These calls
may or may not be listed on your mobile
phone, depending on the model.
i If no mobile phone is connected, then the
Call lists menu item is greyed out and
cannot be selected. If you connect a mobile
phone other than the previous one to
COMAND Online, the previously available
call lists and their entries will be deleted
automatically. These are still available on
the mobile phone itself.
i You will only be able to select the respective menu items once calls have been
received or dialled from COMAND Online.
Displaying missed calls in the COMAND
display is not supported by all mobile
phones.
405
Example: list of selected phone numbers
: To close the list
; Date/time (if available), symbols (if
assigned) and telephone number of the
entry highlighted
= To call up options
X
Select Incoming calls or Calls dial‐
led by turning cVd and press W to confirm.
The corresponding list appears.
i You can also call up the list of dialled calls
by pressing the 6 button when the telephone basic menu is shown. In this case,
the list will only show phone numbers.
Select an entry by turning cVd the
COMAND controller.
X To dial a phone number: press W.
X
X
To close the list: select the & symbol
and press W to confirm.
or
X
Press the % back button.
Z
Telephone
406
COMAND Online
Displaying details from a list entry
COMAND Online can also show a shortened
list entry in full.
X Select a list entry by turning cVd the
COMAND controller.
X Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the controller and
press W to confirm.
X Select Details and press W to confirm.
The detailed display appears.
X To go back to the list: slide XVY repeatedly until the list is highlighted.
Storing a phone number
New address book entry
For incoming calls from a person who is not in
the address book, COMAND Online displays
the phone number in the call list. You can save
this entry.
X Open a call list and select an entry
(Y page 405).
X Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Save and press W to confirm.
X Select New entry and press W to confirm.
Select a category for the number, e.g. Home
Home,
and press W to confirm.
X Select a category for the phone, e.g.
Mobile, and press W to confirm.
Mobile
X
Number category
Display (phone
book and address
book)
Not classified
No symbol
Home
¸
Work
·
Phone category
Display (phone
book and address
book)
Not classified
;
Landline
¬
Mobile
Ï
Car
´
X
Select Save and press W to confirm.
An input menu with data fields is shown.
The data field for the telephone number is
filled in automatically.
: Data field with cursor
; Telephone number and symbol for the
phone category are automatically entered
= Character bar
Adding information to an address book
entry
For incoming calls from a person who is not in
the address book, COMAND Online displays
the phone number in the call list. You can save
this entry.
X Open a call list and select an entry
(Y page 405).
X Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Save and press W to confirm.
Telephone
entry has already been saved.
X
Select Add telephone no. and press W
to confirm.
Select a category for the number, e.g. Home
Home,
and press W to confirm.
X Select a category for the phone, e.g.
Mobile, and press W to confirm.
Mobile
X Select Save
Save.
The search menu for address book entries
appears.
X Search for the desired entry (Y page 402).
X
Press W when you have finished searching.
COMAND Online stores the data if there are
fewer than five numbers assigned to the
entry you are searching for in the selected
number category.
You will see a message to this effect.
If five numbers are stored for the entry you
are searching for, a prompt will appear asking whether you wish to overwrite one of
the existing numbers.
X Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, a selection list with the
five existing numbers is displayed.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
X Select the number to be overwritten in the
list by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
COMAND Online overwrites the selected
number with the new data.
Select Call lists in the telephone basic
menu by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Delete call lists and press W
to confirm.
A prompt appears asking whether you wish
to delete all call lists.
X Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, the call lists are deleted.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
X
i If you delete these call lists from the
mobile phone; see the separate mobile
phone operating instructions,
COMAND Online updates the call list display the next time it connects.
X
Deleting call lists
If you are using a Bluetooth® phone that does
not support the PBAP Bluetooth® profile, the
call lists are generated and managed by
COMAND Online. You can delete these call
lists in COMAND Online.
If you download call lists from a Bluetooth®
phone that supports the PBAP Bluetooth®
profile, you cannot delete them from
COMAND Online.
Using the speed dial list
Storing an entry
You can assign ten speed dial presets (0 to 9)
in the speed dial list. There are two options
available for this purpose.
Option 1:
Search for a phone book entry in the phone
book (Y page 402).
X If an entry has several phone numbers,
select the desired number by turning cVd
the COMAND controller.
X Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
A menu appears.
X Select Speed dial by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
A menu appears.
X
Z
COMAND Online
i Save is shown in grey if the selected list
407
Telephone
408
Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Assign speed dial preset and
press W to confirm.
The speed dial list appears. The selected
phone book entry appears at the top. The
next free speed dial preset is highlighted.
COMAND Online
X
Speed dial menu
X
Select Assign speed dial preset and
press W to confirm.
The speed dial list appears. The selected
phone book entry appears at the top. The
next free speed dial preset is highlighted.
X
Select the speed dial preset by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The phone book entry is saved in the speed
dial preset.
Using speed dial presets to make a call
X
Select the speed dial preset by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The phone book entry is saved in the speed
dial preset.
The speed dial list contains stored phone
book entries (Y page 407).
Option 1:
X
Option 2
Call up the telephone basic menu
(Y page 394).
X Select Call lists by sliding VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
X Select Speed dial preset list and
press W to confirm.
The speed dial list appears.
X
Press one of the number keys for longer
than two seconds.
The telephone basic menu displays the
selected entry. This initiates dialling.
Option 2:
Call up the telephone basic menu
(Y page 394).
X Select Call lists by sliding VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
The speed dial list appears.
X
Telephone
Deleting a speed dial preset
X
To delete a speed dial number: select
Delete speed dial preset in the
"Speed dial" menu by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The speed dial preset is deleted.
To delete all speed dial numbers: select
Delete all speed dial presets in the
"Speed dial" menu by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
You will be asked if you would like to continue.
X Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, all speed dial presets will
be deleted from the speed dial list.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
X
pears once you have read the text message.
The ú mail symbol is displayed if the text
message memory is full. The symbol is no
longer displayed once you delete at least one
text message.
i Telephony via a data-enabled MB SAP
module (Y page 421).
i COMAND Online may not load all of the
most recent text messages:
This may occur in exceptional cases, for
example when using certain mobile
phones/brackets and if the mobile phone
inbox holds a large number of text messages.
i You can obtain further information about
suitable mobile phones from your
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre or on the
Internet at http://www.mercedesbenz.com/connect.
Displaying the text message (SMS)
inbox
Calling up the inbox
Text messages
Information and requirements
In order to be able to use the text message
function, the mobile phone has to support
Bluetooth® Profile MAP (Message Access
Profile).
When the mobile phone is connected, the 30
most recent text messages that are currently
stored on the phone are loaded to the
COMAND Online text message inbox and displayed.
If the above conditions are met, new incoming
text messages appear in the COMAND Online
text message inbox. The / symbol
appears in the status bar. The symbol disap-
Text message (SMS) inbox
X
X
Press the % function button.
Select SMS in the telephone basic menu by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
The text message inbox appears.
Z
COMAND Online
Select Speed dial preset list by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
The speed dial list appears.
X Select the preset and press W to confirm.
The telephone basic menu displays the
selected entry. This initiates dialling.
X
409
Telephone
410
Reading a text message (SMS)
Call up the text message (SMS) inbox
(Y page 409)
X Select a text message in the text message
inbox by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The text message appears.
X To scroll through the display or select
phone numbers in a text message: turn
cVd the COMAND controller.
The display scrolls up or down line by line,
or skips to the next or previous telephone
number and automatically highlights it.
X To return to the list: select the & symbol and press W to confirm or press the
% back button.
COMAND Online
X
Text message read-aloud function
Settings for the read-aloud function:
RLanguage (Y
page 313)
page 312)
X Press W while a text message is being displayed, select Read aloud and press W to
confirm.
COMAND Online reads out the text message.
RSpeed (Y
X
To cancel the read-aloud function: press
the 8 button.
or
X
by sliding VY the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
X Select Display text and press W to confirm.
The view changes.
X To switch to the sender display: select
the list symbol to the right of the text message by sliding VY the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
X Select Display sender and press W to
confirm.
The view changes.
X
Displaying details and phone numbers
COMAND Online can also show a shortened
sender display in full.
X Select a text message in the text message
inbox by turning cVd the COMAND controller.
X Select the list symbol to the right of the text
message by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Details and press W to confirm.
The detailed display appears.
X To close the detailed display: slide XVY
the COMAND controller.
X
Press W, select Cancel read-aloud
function and press W to confirm.
Sender or text display
You can switch between displaying the text
message sender or the text message content.
The sender display shows the sender of the
text message. If the sender is stored in the
COMAND phone book, the name is displayed.
The text display shows the first few words of a
text message.
X Select a text message in the text message
inbox by turning cVd the COMAND controller.
X To switch to the text display: select the
list symbol to the right of the text message
To return to the telephone basic menu:
press the % button.
To return to the telephone basic menu:
press the % button.
Managing text messages (SMS)
Calling a text message (SMS) sender
X Press W the COMAND controller while the
text message is being displayed.
X Select Call sender and press W to confirm.
The telephone makes the call to the sender.
Telephone
: Usable numerical sequence
Numbers in text messages that are highlighted in red can be used.
X Select a usable number when the text message is displayed.
Press W the COMAND controller and
select Use
Use.
X Select Call
Call.
The telephone makes the call.
X
i It is possible that a highlighted numerical
sequence may not contain a telephone
number.
i You can use the "New entry" or "Add no."
functions to save this telephone number or
to add it to an existing entry.
Storing the sender of a text message in
the address book
This function is not available if the sender’s
telephone number is already stored in the
address book.
X Press W the COMAND controller while the
text message is being displayed.
X Select Save number and press W to confirm.
X Select New entry and press W to confirm.
X Store the phone number (Y page 406)
Adding the sender of a text message to an
address book entry
X Press W the COMAND controller while the
text message is being displayed.
X Select Save number and press W to confirm.
X Select Add telephone no. and press W
to confirm.
X Proceed from the step "Selecting a number
category" (Y page 404).
Deleting a text message (SMS)
Select a text message in the text message
inbox by turning cVd the COMAND controller.
X Select the list symbol to the right of the text
message by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Delete and press W to confirm.
A deletion prompt appears.
X Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, the text message is
deleted.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
X
i This delete function is not supported by all
mobile phones. The Delete failed message appears.
Using the address book
Introduction
The address book organises and stores
entries that are entered from different sources (mobile phone, memory card, USB device,
COMAND telephone book, navigation system).
You can use these entries to make telephone
calls and to navigate.
i Number of contacts in the address
book: the address book can store a total of
4,000 contacts.
Z
COMAND Online
Using phone numbers in the text
411
Telephone
412
1,500 entries each are reserved in the
address book for:
Rcontacts
from the mobile phone
that you create in
COMAND Online or import from other
sources
The remaining 1,000 entries are assigned
by COMAND Online as necessary.
Rcontacts
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Address book from the menu and
press W to confirm.
i Display of mobile phone contacts: con-
COMAND Online
tacts downloaded from the mobile phone
remain in the address book even if you disconnect the mobile phone from
COMAND Online. Contacts that have previously been available can be displayed as
soon as the mobile phone is reconnected.
COMAND Online downloads the contacts
again so that any new contacts that have
been added to the mobile phone can be
displayed.
As soon as you connect a new mobile
phone to COMAND Online all the contacts
from the previous mobile phone are
replaced by those from the new phone's
address book.
Address book entries remain stored if the
mobile phone is disconnected. For this reason, delete your personal data using the
reset function before selling your vehicle,
for example (Y page 316).
Calling up the address book
Using the function button:
Press the % function button.
You see either the telephone basic menu or
the address book, depending on which was
last active.
X If the telephone basic menu is displayed,
press the % function button again.
X
Using the telephone basic menu:
X
When the telephone basic menu is displayed, select Tel by sliding VZ the
Address book with ¥ address book entry and L
navigable data
To browse in the address book: turn
cVd the COMAND controller.
X To close the address book: press the
% button.
X
i An address book entry can contain the
following information:
Rname
Rfirst
name
Rcompany
Rtwo
addresses
Rgeo-coordinates
Rup
to five telephone numbers
Telephone
413
Search menu with character bar
: ¥ Address book entry
; L Complete address data from the nav-
igation system
= Character bar
? d Phone book entry on the mobile phone
A Entry with voice tag
For more symbols, see the symbol overview
(Y page 402)
X Find entry (Y page 402)
Creating a new entry in the address
book
You can enter address data directly into the
address book. If you store telephone numbers in the COMAND phone book, these are
also saved in the address book. If you store a
navigation destination, COMAND Online creates an address book entry which includes
the complete navigable address data.
X Call up the address book (Y page 412)
X
Input menu with data fields
: Selected data field with cursor
; Character bar
X
X
Enter characters (Y page 303)
Save the entry (Y page 304)
Deleting an address book entry
X
Option 1: select Delete by sliding VÆ and
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
Option 2: search for an address book entry
(Y page 402).
X Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Delete and press W to confirm.
Irrespective of the option chosen, a prompt
will appear.
X
X
Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, the entry will be deleted.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
Select New in the address book by sliding
VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
An input menu with data fields appears.
Z
COMAND Online
Searching for an address book entry
Telephone
414
Displaying details for an address book
entry
Selecting an entry
Showing the details of an address book
entry
X Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Details and press W to confirm.
The display is shown in full.
COMAND Online
X
To close the detailed display: press the
% back button.
Changing an address book entry
Option 1: search for an address book entry
(Y page 402).
X Make a selection from the selection list by
turning c V d the COMAND controller.
X Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
A menu appears.
X
Detailed display of address book
: Back to the previous menu
; \ Business details
= List symbol (to call up options)
Search for an address book entry
(Y page 402)
X Make a selection from the selection list by
turning c V d the COMAND controller.
or
X Call up the address book (Y page 412)
X Select an entry by turning cVd the
COMAND controller.
X Press W the COMAND controller.
The detailed display appears.
X
Starting route guidance to an address
Select the address data field by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The route to the destination address is calculated and route guidance starts
(Y page 329).
X
Calling a telephone number
X Select the phone number data field by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
This initiates dialling and you can then
make your call (Y page 398).
X
Select Edit and press W to confirm.
Option 2: call up the detailed view for an
address book entry (Y page 414).
X Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Edit and press W to confirm.
In both cases, the input menu containing
data fields appears.
X
Information about character entry
(Y page 303)
Telephone
Calling a number stored in an entry
Conditions
The mobile phone must be connected via the
Bluetooth® interface (Y page 390).
Dialling a number
X Display details for an address book entry
(Y page 414).
X Select the phone number data field by turning cVd the COMAND controller.
X Press W the COMAND controller to confirm.
or
X Select the list symbol to the right of the
data field by sliding VY the COMAND controller.
X Press W the COMAND controller to confirm.
X Select Call and press W to confirm.
The telephone makes the call. The display
switches to telephone mode.
Storing a phone number as a speed dial
number
Display details for an address book entry
(Y page 414).
X Select the phone number data field by turning cVd the COMAND controller.
X Select the list symbol to the right of the
data field by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Speed dial and press W to confirm.
You can now store the number in one of the
ten speed dial presets (Y page 407).
X
Starting route guidance to an entry
Address book entry with navigable data
This function is available as soon as you have
stored a destination in the destination memory (Y page 369).
X Search for an address book entry with the
L symbol and select it from the list
(Y page 413).
Display details for an address book entry
(Y page 414).
X Select the address data field by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
Route guidance begins.
or
X Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Navigate and press W to confirm.
Route guidance begins.
X
Address book entry without navigable
data
Route guidance can also be started for an
address book entry without the L symbol. If
the address data or designations do not
match the digital map, COMAND Online
prompts you to re-enter the address.
Z
COMAND Online
Changing the category of a telephone
number data field
X Display details for an address book entry
(Y page 414).
X Select the telephone number data field.
X Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Change category and press W to
confirm.
X Select a number category, e.g. Home
Home.
X Select a telephone category, e.g. Mobile
Mobile.
X If desired, select Preferred and press W
to confirm.
Depending on the previous status, switch
the option on O or off ª. The phone number is displayed as the first number in the
phone book and can be dialled immediately.
X Select Save and press W to confirm.
The new category is stored.
415
Telephone
416
Enter the destination address
(Y page 326)
X Start route guidance.
The navigable address is added to the
address book entry automatically.
X
COMAND Online
i This will provide you with an address book
entry that is suitable for navigation. Once
you have altered the address data in the
address entry menu, the altered address in
the navigation system will be used the next
time the system is started instead of the
postal address. Therefore always ensure
that the destination address is indeed the
required destination when navigation
starts from the address book.
Voice tags
Introduction
You can enter voice tags via LINGUATRONIC
(see the separate operating instructions).
Once you have assigned a voice tag to an
address book entry, you can vocally call up
this entry and dial a phone number, for example. You can add one voice tag per address
book entry.
Adding or changing a voice tag
X Search for an address book entry with or
without a voice tag (¦) (Y page 413).
X Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Voice tag and press W to confirm.
X Select Add or Change and press W to confirm.
Subsequent operation is voice-controlled.
LINGUATRONIC guides you through the
dialogues.
Deleting a voice tag
X Search for an address book entry with a
voice tag (Y page 413).
X Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Select Voice tag and press W to confirm.
X Select Delete and press W to confirm.
A deletion prompt appears.
X Select Yes or No and press the 9 button to
confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, COMAND Online deletes
the voice tag.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
X
Listening to a voice tag
X Search for an address book entry with a
voice tag (Y page 413).
X Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Voice tag and press W to confirm.
X Select Listen and press W to confirm.
You hear the voice tag.
Importing phone book entries
This function allows you to store phone book
entries from the mobile phone in the address
book.
Possible sources are:
Rthe
mobile phone
memory card
Rthe USB device
Rthe Bluetooth® interface
Imported phone book entries are indicated in
the phone book by different symbols
(Y page 402).
X Search for an entry in the phone book on
the mobile phone d (Y page 402).
X Select the list symbol to the right of the
entry by sliding VY the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Save entry and press W to confirm.
The Data saved message appears. The
phone book entry is now saved as an
address book entry.
Rthe
Telephone
Importing contacts
Information and requirements
You can import contacts (vCards) from the
memory card and from a USB device into the
address book, or receive vCards via Bluetooth®.
i Up to 2,500 entries can be imported into
the address book. A message notifies you
when the maximum number is reached.
You then have to delete existing entries in
order to import new entries (Y page 413).
Depending on the source of the contact data,
different requirements apply:
Source
The USB device is inserted
into the USB port
(Y page 472). It contains
importable contact details.
Requirements for receiving vCards via
Bluetooth®
You can receive vCards from devices (e.g.
from a PC) that support the sending of vCards
via Bluetooth®.
It is not necessary to authorise the device in
COMAND to do so.
Please bear the following in mind:
RBluetooth®
RvCards (vcf files) may be located in the main
directory or in folders. COMAND Online
allows you to select the relevant folders
directly.
RvCards must have the ".vcf" file extension.
i One vcf file may contain several vCards.
COMAND Online supports vCards in versions 2.1 and 3.0.
X
Select Address book in the address book
or, if the telephone basic menu is shown,
select Telephone by sliding VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
X
Select Import contacts and press W to
confirm.
A menu appears.
X
Select From the memory card or From
USB device in the menu by turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
Conditions
Memory card The SD memory card is
inserted (Y page 472). It
contains importable contact details.
USB device
Importing from the memory card or USB
device
Entries imported from the memory card or
from a USB device have the ¯ symbol.
The following conditions must be fulfilled in
order to import vCards:
must be activated in COMAND
and on the Bluetooth® device; see the operating instructions for the device.
Rthe Bluetooth® device must be able to send
vCards via Bluetooth® (see the operating
instructions for the device).
Rthe Bluetooth® device in the vehicle must
be switched on.
Select Add or Overwrite and press W to
confirm.
Add imports the entries from the memory
card or USB device into the address book.
Overwrite imports the entries from the
memory card or USB device and overwrites
all entries in the address book with the
¯ symbol. The previous entries are then
no longer available.
After the contact data has been imported
successfully, you will see a message to this
effect. The address book or the respective
telephone basic menu is displayed.
i You can select Overwrite if the address
book already contains corresponding
entries. A message notifies you if the
address book is full.
X
Z
COMAND Online
The d symbol is replaced by the ¥ symbol.
417
Telephone
418
COMAND Online
Receiving vCards via Bluetooth®
Select Address book in the address book
or, if the telephone basic menu is shown,
select Telephone by sliding VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
A menu appears.
X Select Import contacts and press W to
confirm.
X Select Receive business cards in the
menu by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
This interrupts the Bluetooth® connection
between COMAND Online and your active
mobile phone. COMAND Online is, however, ready to receive vCards from another
Bluetooth® device (PC, mobile phone).
X
Start the data transfer on the external Bluetooth® device (see the operating instructions for the device).
The number of vCards received is displayed.
X To end reception: press W or the %
back button.
COMAND Online then reconnects to the
mobile phone.
Deleting contacts
X Select Address book in the address book
or, if the telephone basic menu is shown,
select Telephone by sliding VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
A menu appears.
X Select Delete contacts and press W to
confirm.
X Select one of the following options:
RInternal contacts
RContacts from storage device
RReceived business cards
RDelete all
A prompt corresponding to your selection
appears.
X Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, the contacts are deleted
according to your selection.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
Switching import of contacts on/off
X
Received vCards are identified by the ®
symbol in the address book.
i If you switch to another main function,
e.g. navigation, while receiving vCards, the
reception of vCards will be terminated.
You can choose to have contacts downloaded
automatically when a mobile phone is connected with COMAND Online or to have this
function suppressed.
Connect the mobile phone (Y page 390)
Telephone
Proceed as follows if you do not want to have
sensitive contacts saved in the address book:
Connect the mobile phone with COMAND
Online.
The contacts are automatically downloaded to the address book.
X Delete the sensitive contacts in the
address book.
X Switch off the Import contacts from
function ª.
Then no contacts will be downloaded and
therefore no new ones will be added when
your mobile phone is reconnected with
COMAND Online.
X
Switching the display of contact details
on/off (privacy)
Using the Hide data setting, you can decide
whether the phone and address book data are
to be visible on the screen. You can therefore,
for example, prevent a passenger from seeing
the name of a caller.
Activating the function has the following
effects:
RPhone
book and address book data from
the mobile phone are hidden. Therefore,
you cannot use the data to make a call,
send text messages or navigate.
You still have access to the phone and
address book data saved in COMAND
Online.
RDuring incoming calls, the caller's name is
not displayed even if there is an address
book entry for the number that is calling.
RDuring outgoing calls where the number is
entered manually, the recipient's name is
not displayed, even if there is an address
book entry for the entered number.
RThe call list is hidden.
RRedialling is not possible.
RThe received text messages list is hidden.
There is still a notification for incoming text
messages. For this to be the case, the connected mobile phone must support the
MAP profile. However, it is not possible for
the passenger, for example, to view the
phone number or quickly access the data.
COMAND Online
Select Tel in the telephone basic menu by
sliding VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
A menu appears.
X Select Import contacts from and press W to confirm.
You can allow O or suppress ª the automatic download.
X
419
Connecting the mobile phone (Y page 390)
X Select Tel in the telephone basic menu by
sliding VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
A menu appears.
X
To hide details: select Hide data from
and press W to confirm.
You can allow ª or prevent O access to
address data.
Telephone module with Bluetooth®
(SAP profile)
Introduction
The module can be used as a permanently
installed telephone with its own SIM card
(Y page 421) or in conjunction with a mobile
phone (Y page 421). If you wish to use the
module in conjunction with your mobile telephone, the mobile phone must support the
Bluetooth® SAP profile (SIM Access Profile).
Z
Telephone
420
The following functions are available in
COMAND Online when the module is used:
Rhands-free
mode
modem mode (Y page 423)
Rsending and receiving text messages
(Y page 425)
Raccess to the phone book of the mobile
phone (if supported by the mobile phone)
(Y page 424)
Rloading a mobile phone via the mini USB
connection (Y page 426)
When the module is installed, the vehicle's
exterior aerial is used for reception. This
ensures optimal language quality and Internet
connectivity.
COMAND Online
Rdata
Installing the module
X
Slide module ; into bracket : until it
audibly engages.
Activating the module
COMAND Online: press the % repeatedly until the telephone basic menu
appears (Y page 394).
X Module: to install (Y page 420).
X Press and hold button ;.
X As soon as indicator lamp : starts flashing
yellow, release the button.
The indicator lamp continues to flash yellow.
X COMAND Online: slide V¬ the controller.
The menu bar is displayed.
X To select Connect device:
device turn the controller and press to confirm.
The device list appears.
X To select Connect MB SAP module:
module turn
the controller and then press it.
A message is displayed: To connect
your MB SAP module, please ensure
that it is connected and activated.
X To select Start search:
search press the controller.
The Searching for an active MB SAP
module... message appears.
If the module has been found and the connection made, the MB SAP module con‐
nection successful message appears.
The module is now connected.
A menu appears in which you can begin
with the authorisation of a mobile telephone for the module.
X If you wish to authorise a mobile phone,
select Start search and follow the
instructions from COMAND Online. Further
information on authorising mobile phones
(Y page 391).
or
X If you do not wish to authorise a mobile
telephone, select &.
The COMAND device list display is
shown.
X
i You can activate the telephone module
with Bluetooth® (SAP profile) on up to eight
vehicles that have COMAND Online. The
settings remain stored on the module. If
you wish to change the module, you have to
remove it first. The module does not need
to be deactivated to do this. Deactivation is
only useful if you do not intend to use the
module again with COMAND Online.
Telephone module with Bluetooth®
(SAP profile) in SIM card mode
Inserting a SIM card
mobile phone, the system searches for the
mobile phone that was connected before that
one.
You can authorise up to 15 mobile phones.
Only one mobile phone can be connected to
the module and COMAND Online at any one
time.
You can configure the mobile phone PIN to be
stored in the module (Y page 423). When
establishing a Bluetooth® connection, reentering the PIN is only necessary if the SIM
card PIN has been changed.
Conditions
You can authorise and connect your mobile
phone to the module, if:
Rthe
X
With the contact surface facing down,
insert SIM card : into the SIM card slot
until it engages.
After a SIM card is inserted in the module, a
Bluetooth® connection with another
mobile phone is no longer possible. Any
existing Bluetooth® connection is ended
upon SIM card insertion.
Removing a SIM card
X Press the SIM card and then release it.
The SIM card is pushed out slightly and can
then be removed.
Connect the mobile phone
General notes
When you use your mobile phone with the
module and COMAND Online for the first
time, you must search for and authorise it.
If your mobile phone has already been authorised, it will be connected automatically.
COMAND Online always searches for the last
connected mobile phone. If no connection
can be made to the most recently connected
module is installed (Y page 420) and
activated in COMAND Online
(Y page 420)
Rno SIM card is inserted in the module
Rthe mobile phone has no active Bluetooth®
connection to another device
Rthe mobile phone supports the Bluetooth®
SAP profile (SIM Access Profile)
Depending on the type of mobile phone, different settings must be changed on the
mobile phone (see the operating instructions
for the mobile phone).
RBluetooth® must be activated on the
mobile phone and must be made visible to
other devices.
RThe Bluetooth® SIM Access Profile of the
mobile phone must be activated.
RYou must know the Bluetooth® name of the
mobile phone.
A list of mobile phones which are compatible
with the telephone module with Bluetooth®
(SAP profile) can be found on the Internet at:
http://www.mercedes-benz.com/connect
Z
421
COMAND Online
Telephone
COMAND Online
422
Telephone
Searching for a mobile phone
X To call up the telephone basic menu in
COMAND Online: press the % button
one or more times.
X To switch to the menu bar: slide V¬ the
controller.
X To select Connect device:
device turn the controller and press to confirm.
The device list appears.
X Select Search for phones.
phones
You will see the prompt: Do you wish to
connect to a Bluetooth phone or an
SAP phone?
X Select SAP telephone.
telephone
You will see the message: Before start‐
ing the search, ensure that your
phone is switched on, Bluetooth is
activated, the SAP function is
activated and your device is visi‐
ble.
ble
X Select Start search.
search
The list of retrieved SAP telephones
appears.
You can now authorise and connect the
mobile phone.
Authorising and connecting a mobile
phone
X To select the mobile phone that is to be
authorised and connected in the COMAND
device list under Phones found on the
MB SAP module:
module turn and press the controller.
A prompt asking you to enter the 16-digit
PIN appears in the display.
X Enter any 16-digit PIN and confirm your
entry.
X When prompted to do so, enter the same
16-digit PIN on the mobile phone within
20 seconds and confirm.
X Depending on the mobile phone used, you
may have to confirm a module connection
request on the mobile phone (see the
mobile phone operating instructions).
X In COMAND Online, enter the PIN of the
SIM card and confirm, if necessary.
i Follow any prompts on your mobile
phone. If necessary you will be asked to
confirm further profile requests.
Switching between mobile phones
If you have authorised more than one mobile
phone on the module, you can switch
between the individual phones.
X To select the required mobile phone in the
COMAND device list under Phones
found on the MB SAP module:
module turn and
press the controller.
The selected mobile phone is searched for
and connected if it is within Bluetooth®
range and if Bluetooth® is activated.
X Confirm the module's connection request
on the mobile phone (see the operating
instructions for the mobile phone).
X In COMAND Online, enter the PIN of the
SIM card and confirm, if necessary.
Only one mobile phone can be connected at
any one time. The currently connected mobile
phone is indicated by the # dot in the Bluetooth® phone list.
i You can only switch to another authorised
mobile phone if you are not currently making a call.
Connecting manually
If the connection between the module and the
mobile phone has been terminated, you can
connect to an authorised mobile phone manually.
Telephone
To select Connect device in the basic
telephone menu: turn and press the controller.
X Select SAP telephones.
telephones
You will see the Bluetooth® names of
mobile phones that are already authorised.
X Select the desired mobile phone.
X To select the list symbol on the right-hand
side next to the message: slide VY and
press the controller.
X Enable (PIN is saved) or disable (PIN is not
saved) the Store PIN checkbox.
423
X
Briefly press button ; on the module.
Indicator lamp : flashes blue. In the
COMAND Online display, a message
appears which informs the user that the
telephone is being activated.
COMAND Online always searches for the
last connected mobile phone.
If no connection can be made to the most
recently connected mobile phone, the system searches for the mobile phone that
was connected before that one.
Data modem mode
X
Connect the mobile phone to the module
(Y page 421).
or
Insert the SIM card into the integrated SIM
card reader on the module (Y page 421).
X Before connecting for the first time, select
the network provider in COMAND Online
(Y page 434).
Use as a data modem is automatically activated.
X To activate/deactivate data roaming
(Y page 424).
X
Settings
Storing/deleting the SIM card PIN
If you store the SIM card PIN in the module, it
is not necessary to enter it when logging in
again.
Setting the ringtone
Incoming calls are indicated on the module by
an audible signal. You can select one of ten
ringtones.
X To select Connect device in the basic
telephone menu: turn and press the controller.
X Select the MB SAP module phones menu.
X Select the desired mobile phone.
X To select the list symbol to the right of the
mobile phone names: slide VY the controller and press to confirm.
X Select the Ringtones menu.
A menu appears.
X Select a ringtone.
The selected ringtone is played.
X Press the % button.
COMAND Online accepts the setting and
exits the menu.
Activating/deactivating phone number
transmission
Prerequisite: the module is connected with
the mobile telephone (Y page 421) or is being
used in SIM card mode (Y page 421).
If you activate phone number transmission,
the caller you are speaking with can see your
phone number.
In the standard setting, the system accepts
the settings used by the mobile phone network provider. These may vary and can be
Z
COMAND Online
X
Telephone
424
obtained from the mobile phone network provider.
Activating phone number transmission:
Enter the number "00031" in the telephone
basic menu.
X Press the 6 button.
The phone number will be transmitted in
future.
X
COMAND Online
Deactivating phone number transmission:
Enter the number "00030" in the telephone
basic menu.
X Press the 6 button.
The phone number will no longer be transmitted in future.
X
Activating/deactivating data roaming
Prerequisite: the module is connected with
the mobile telephone (Y page 421) or is being
used in SIM card mode (Y page 421).
If you activate data roaming, you can receive
and send data abroad via the module.
Data roaming is deactivated in the standard
setting.
To activate data roaming:
Enter the number "00061" in the telephone
basic menu.
X Press the 6 button.
Data roaming is activated.
X
To deactivate data roaming:
Enter the number "00060" in the telephone
basic menu.
X Press the 6 button.
Data roaming is deactivated.
X
Activating/deactivating network provider restriction
Prerequisite: the module is connected with
the mobile telephone (Y page 421) or is being
used in SIM card mode (Y page 421).
When you activate network provider restriction, the module will not log into foreign networks. You will then be unable to conduct
telephone calls or send and receive text messages when abroad.
Network provider restriction is deactivated in
the standard setting.
To deactivate network provider restriction:
Enter the number "00070" in the telephone
basic menu.
X Press the 6 button.
Network provider restriction is deactivated.
X
To activate network provider restriction:
Enter the number "00071" in the telephone
basic menu.
X Press the 6 button.
Network provider restriction is activated.
X
Adjusting the brightness of the indicator
lamp
Situation-related dimming:
Enter the number "00082" in the telephone
basic menu.
X Press the 6 button.
The LED is dimmed as long as the user does
not perform any actions (press a key etc.).
X
No change to brightness:
Enter the number "00083" in the telephone
basic menu.
X Press the 6 button.
The LED is always bright regardless of any
user actions.
X
Transferring the phone book
In order to use the phone book of the mobile
phone via COMAND Online, the phone book
must be transferred using the module.
The data transfer may take up to ten minutes.
Transmission occurs automatically after a
Bluetooth® connection is automatically
established.
i If the mobile phone supports the PBAP
(Phone Book Access Profile), the system
Telephone
A list of mobile phones which are compatible
with the telephone module with Bluetooth®
(SAP profile) can be found on the Internet at:
http://www.mercedes-benz.com/connect
Speed-dial keys
You can assign numbers as speed-dial numbers as desired (Y page 407).
Text messages
General notes
Special considerations for receiving text messages when using the telephone module with
Bluetooth® (SAP profile):
the Bluetooth® SAP profile, you only
have access to the text message memory
on the SIM card.
RIncoming text messages are stored on the
SIM card by the Bluetooth® SAP profile.
RDepending on the mobile phone, these text
messages are not directly visible. They
must first be selected (see the operating
instructions for the mobile phone).
RIf the mobile phone supports the Bluetooth® MAP profile (Message Access Profile), the module will download the telephone text messages. The text messages
are then transferred to COMAND Online.
On condition that the downloading function
for text messages has been activated.
RThe text messages stored on the SIM card
have the word "SIM:" in front of them.
RThe SIM card can only store a limited number of text messages. When the memory is
full, no more text messages can be
received. Deleting text messages stored on
the SIM card via COMAND Online
(Y page 411).
RWith
A list of mobile phones which are compatible
with the telephone module with Bluetooth®
(SAP profile) can be found on the Internet at:
http://www.mercedes-benz.com/connect
Conditions
The module is connected with the mobile
phone (Y page 421) or is being used in the
SIM card mode (Y page 421).
The mobile phone must support the MAP
Bluetooth® profile (Message Access Profile).
Activating/deactivating text message
downloading from the mobile phone
Downloading of text messages can be deactivated when the module is connected to a
mobile phone. Only text messages that are
saved on the SIM card will then be transferred.
Deactivating the downloading of telephone text messages
Enter the number "00080" in the telephone
basic menu.
X Press the 6 button.
Only text messages from the SIM card will
be downloaded.
X
Activating the downloading of telephone
text messages
Enter the number "00081" in the telephone
basic menu.
X Press the 6 button.
Text messages on the SIM card and from
the telephone memory will be downloaded.
X
Call lists
General notes
If you use the module to make calls, the calls
made are not entered in the mobile phone call
list. All telephone functions are transferred to
the module via the SAP profile.
If the connected mobile phone supports the
Bluetooth® PBAP profile (Phone Book Access
Profile), the module will download existing
call lists.
Z
COMAND Online
gives priority to loading phone book entries
from the phone memory. If there are no
entries in the phone memory, the phone
book entries from the SIM card are imported.
425
Telephone
426
COMAND Online
Deleting call lists
X Enter the number "0002" in the telephone
basic menu.
X Press the 6 button.
The call lists stored in the module are reset
and will no longer appear starting with the
next phone book transfer.
The call lists of the connected mobile phone
are not deleted. Deleting the call lists of the
mobile phone (see the operating instructions
for the mobile phone).
Deleting call lists from COMAND Online
(Y page 407).
i In SIM card mode, the Delete call
lists menu item is available in COMAND
Online.
Terminating the connection between
the mobile phone and the module
Automatic disconnection
Once outside the receiving range, the Bluetooth® connection between the mobile phone
and the module is automatically terminated.
Charging a mobile phone
Slide cover ; on the module in the direction of the arrow and remove it.
X Connect the mobile phone with a mini USB
data cable to USB socket :.
X
Resetting the module
The module can be reset to its factory settings. This way, all stored information for
authorisation of mobile phones, as well as the
stored phone book, will be deleted.
Manual disconnection
X
Terminate the Bluetooth® connection on
the mobile phone (see the operating
instructions for the mobile phone).
Re-establishing a connection
X
You can re-establish the Bluetooth® connection after disconnecting manually
(Y page 421).
Press and hold button ; on the module
until indicator lamp : lights up orange.
X Release button ;.
Indicator lamp : flashes back and forth
between yellow and red.
X Press button ; again.
The module is reset to factory settings. All
settings are deleted.
X
Telephone
Deactivation makes sense if you do not intend
to use the telephone module with Bluetooth®
(SAP profile) again with COMAND Online.
X COMAND Online: press the % repeatedly until the telephone basic menu
appears (Y page 394).
X To switch to the menu bar: slide V¬ the
controller.
X To select Connect device:
device turn the controller and press to confirm.
The device list appears.
X
Select Disconnect MB SAP module.
module
Removing the module
All important vehicle data is sent via mobile
phone to ensure that you receive optimum
support. The mobile phone must be connected to COMAND Online via the Bluetooth®
interface.
The following data is transmitted:
Rthe
vehicle identification number
total distance recorder reading
Rthe vehicle position
Rthe telephone number
Rthe service code (only when required for
maintenance)
Rthe
i Please note that Mercedes-Benz Contact
is a Mercedes-Benz customer service. In
emergencies, always call the national
emergency services first, using the standard national emergency service telephone
numbers.
i Currently, this service is available for vehicles from the following European countries:
RBelgium
RGermany
RFrance
RUnited
Push release button : in the direction of
the arrow.
X Slide module ; in the direction of the
arrow and remove it.
X
Kingdom
RIreland
RItaly
RLuxembourg
RNetherlands
RAustria
RPoland
Mercedes-Benz Contact
Introduction
Mercedes-Benz Contact offers fast assistance at the touch of a button – around the
clock. For any queries about the vehicle,
Mercedes-Benz Contact offers a fast and easy
connecting call to the Mercedes-Benz Customer Centre. You can request an appointment, or call for help in the event of a breakdown.
RSwitzerland
RSlovakia
RSpain
RCzech
Republic
RHungary
Calling the Mercedes-Benz Customer
Centre
If you operate communication equipment
integrated in the vehicle when driving, you will
be distracted from the traffic situation. This
could also cause you to lose control of the
Z
COMAND Online
Deactivating the module
427
COMAND Online
428
Telephone
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident. Only
operate this equipment when the traffic situation permits. If you cannot be sure of this,
stop the vehicle paying attention to road and
traffic conditions and operate the equipment
with the vehicle stationary.
You must observe the legal requirements for
the country in which you are currently driving
when operating COMAND Online.
X Call up the COMAND phone book
(Y page 401).
X Select MB Contact by turning cVd the
COMAND controller.
There are two ways to contact the MercedesBenz Customer Centre:
X Press W the COMAND controller to confirm.
or
X Press the 6 button on COMAND Online.
This initiates a call. When the call is connected, a voice message prompts you to
confirm the data transmission by pressing
the stated number on the COMAND Online
keypad. After confirmation, COMAND
Online sends the required vehicle data.
i Alternatively, you can initiate a call using
the multifunction steering wheel (see the
vehicle Owner's Manual).
During data transmission, you will see a corresponding symbol in the display. This may
take a moment. Then, you can select the
desired service and be connected to a specialist from the Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
i Contact your Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre for further information on
Mercedes-Benz Contact, the range of services offered and on using the function.
Demand-actuated service message
To attain the optimal level of support in maintaining your vehicle, you can arrange a service
appointment directly with the Mercedes-Benz
Customer Centre. As well as a warning in the
instrument cluster, a window appears in the
COMAND display. Here, a message actively
indicates that a service is required and this
message enables you to contact the
Mercedes-Benz Customer Centre directly.
You will see the message:
is due soon. Would you like to make
a workshop appointment?
X To arrange a service appointment:
select Call Now by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
After your confirmation, the vehicle data is
sent via Mercedes-Benz Contact, and a
Customer Centre employee personally
deals with your appointment. The information is then sent to your desired service
outlet.
They will then contact with you within 24
hours to confirm the following details:
Rscope
Rlength
of service
of stay
Rprice
To arrange a service appointment later:
select Call Later and confirm with W.
The window is hidden, then reappears after
a certain amount of time.
X To not arrange a service appointment:
select No and confirm with W.
The window is hidden and does not show
this maintenance requirement again.
X
Mercedes-Benz Contact Accident Assistance
Mercedes-Benz emergency call system
active
Mercedes-Benz Contact Accident Assistance
is a supplement to the Mercedes-Benz emergency call system (Y page 429). If an emergency call to the Mercedes-Benz emergency
call centre has been triggered following an
accident, a voice connection with an operator
is established. Depending on the accident situation, the operator may then suggest that
you forward the call to Mercedes-Benz Contact Accident Assistance. This will enable you
Telephone
Mercedes-Benz emergency call system
Overview
The Mercedes-Benz emergency call system
can help to decisively reduce the time
between an accident and the arrival of emergency services at the site of the accident. It
can also help locate an accident site in places
that are difficult to see.
The emergency call can be made automatically or manually and is transmitted to the
Europe-wide private Mercedes-Benz emergency call number. The vehicle position data
is simultaneously transmitted by text message and DTMF to the Mercedes-Benz emergency call centre. The Mercedes-Benz emergency call centre transmits the vehicle position data to one of the Europe-wide public
emergency call centres. In almost all countries, the voice connection can be made in the
respective country's language. This allows
measures for rescue, recovery or towing to a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre to be initiated
quickly.
If the Mercedes-Benz emergency call system
function is operational, you see the SOS
READY display message in the basic telephone menu (Y page 432).
Information on service availability in Europe
(Y page 429).
i Note that manual emergency calls should
only be used if you or others are in need of
rescue, not e.g. in the event of a breakdown.
Operation costs (e.g. for rescue teams)
incurred by a falsely triggered manual
emergency call, must be paid for by the
vehicle owner.
Service availability in Europe
The Mercedes-Benz emergency call system is
available for your vehicle for 15 years after
the initial date of production, if:
Rit
is equipped with COMAND Online
Rit was originally produced for the European
market
You can find more information on the regional
availability of the Mercedes-Benz emergency
call system at http://www.mercedesbenz.com/connect_ecall.
Conditions
Equipment requirements
You need:
Bluetooth®-capable mobile phone which,
if possible, supports the MAP profile (Message Access Profile) for sending text messages, or
Rif the vehicle is equipped with permanently
installed/SAP telephony, a SIM card or a
suitable mobile phone
Functional requirements
The vehicle has GPS reception.
Check the following:
Ra
RCOMAND
Online is switched on
using the Bluetooth® interface, the
mobile phone must be authorised for and
connected with COMAND Online, and logged into a mobile phone network
Rwhen
Z
COMAND Online
to make arrangements to have the vehicle
towed to a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
X To forward the call: press the g key on
the number keypad.
The voice connection to the MercedesBenz emergency call centre is ended and
the call is automatically forwarded to
Mercedes-Benz Contact Accident Assistance.
After your confirmation, the vehicle data is
sent via Mercedes-Benz Contact. An
employee of Mercedes-Benz Contact Accident Assistance will then make the necessary arrangements with MB Service 24h to
have your vehicle towed to a MercedesBenz Service Centre.
429
COMAND Online
430
Telephone
Connecting the mobile phone
(Y page 390)
Reconnecting the mobile phone automatically (Y page 393)
If your vehicle is equipped with permanently
installed/SAP telephony, one of the following
conditions must be fulfilled:
i Before using this function, make sure that
Rin "telephone module with Bluetooth® (SAP
Automatic emergency call
profile)", a SIM card has been entered and
is logged into the mobile phone network.
SAP (SIM Access Profile)
Ra suitable SAP-capable mobile phone is
connected to "telephone module with Bluetooth® (SAP profile)" via the SAP profile and
is logged into the mobile phone network.
i Telephony via the telephone module with
Bluetooth® (SAP profile) (Y page 421).
i If your vehicle is equipped with a mobile
phone bracket, the bracket should be inserted and the mobile phone should be placed
in the bracket.
This provides you with the following advantages:
Rthe
mobile phone is protected from any
mechanical damage in the event of an
accident.
Rthe mobile phone remains charged.
Rin most cases, the transmitting and
receiving power of a mobile phone is better if the mobile phone is placed in its
bracket.
If the mobile phone is connected, you see the
SOS READY display message in the basic telephone menu in front of the name of the mobile
phone (Y page 432).
i Further information on suitable mobile
phones can be obtained from a MercedesBenz Service Centre or at http://
www.mercedes-benz.com/connect.
your mobile phone contract:
Rpermits
calls, text messages and roaming from both your country of residence
and from abroad, and
Rthat these functions have been activated
! If an emergency call has been made: pro-
vided the road and traffic conditions at the
accident site allow it, remain in the vehicle
until the voice connection with the operator
at the emergency call centre has been
established.
On the basis of the call, the operator can
decide whether it is necessary to deploy
rescue teams and/or the police to the accident site.
i Depending on the severity of the acci-
dent, it can take between one and three
minutes until the operator can speak with
you.
Requirement: the ignition is switched on.
If restraint systems have been triggered during an accident, the Mercedes-Benz emergency call system can automatically dial the
Europe-wide private Mercedes-Benz emergency call number. Restraint systems
include, for example, airbags or belt tensioners. The emergency call system can establish
a voice connection between the vehicle occupants and the Mercedes-Benz emergency call
centre.
The accident data is sent to the MercedesBenz emergency call centre by SMS and
DTMF while the voice connection is operating. The accident data contains metre-precise
GPS positioning data for the moment it is
sent, as well as the type of vehicle involved in
the accident.
i If your vehicle is equipped with an SOS
button in the overhead control unit, it
flashes until the emergency call has been
completed.
Telephone
emergency call.
i In the following cases, you see a corresponding message on the COMAND display:
i In the following cases, you see a corre-
Ra
connection to the Mercedes-Benz
emergency call centre could not be made
Rnor has a call been automatically forwarded to the public emergency call centre
In such circumstances, dial the emergency
number 112 on your mobile phone.
sponding message on the COMAND display:
Ra
connection to the Mercedes-Benz
emergency call centre could not be made
Rnor has a call been automatically forwarded to the public emergency call centre
In such circumstances, dial the emergency
number 112 on your mobile phone.
Manual emergency call
! If an emergency call has been made: provided the road and traffic conditions at the
accident site allow it, remain in the vehicle
until the voice connection with the operator
at the emergency call centre has been
established.
On the basis of the call, the operator can
decide whether it is necessary to deploy
rescue teams and/or the police to the accident site.
i Note that manual emergency calls should
only be used if you or others are in need of
rescue, not e.g. in the event of a breakdown.
Operation costs (e.g. for rescue teams)
incurred by a falsely triggered manual
emergency call, must be paid for by the
vehicle owner.
Vehicles equipped with an SOS button
If your vehicle is equipped with the SOS button in the overhead control unit:
X Press and hold the SOS button for at least
one second.
The manual emergency call is triggered.
The indicator lamp in the SOS button
flashes until the emergency call is concluded.
In the address book
Call up the address book (Y page 412).
The 1st entry, Mercedes-Benz emer‐
gency call,
call is highlighted.
X Press W the COMAND controller.
The emergency call to the Mercedes-Benz
emergency call centre is triggered.
X
i If you have accidentally made a manual
emergency call, you can end it in the following ways:
Rby
pressing the ~ button on
COMAND Online
Rby pressing the ~ button on the multifunction steering wheel
i In the following cases, you see a corresponding message on the COMAND display:
Ra
connection to the Mercedes-Benz
emergency call centre could not be made
Rnor has a call been automatically forwarded to the public emergency call centre
In such circumstances, dial the emergency
number 112 on your mobile phone.
Transmitted data
Depending on how the data is transmitted
(text message or DTMF), different data is
transmitted to the Mercedes-Benz emergency call centre.
Text messages transmit the following:
Rthe
vehicle's GPS position data
direction of travel
Rthe vehicle identification number
Rthe
Z
COMAND Online
i It is not possible to end an automatic
431
432
Online and Internet functions
Ra
Mercedes-Benz Contact coding
indication of whether the call was triggered automatically or manually
Ra time stamp
Rthe language settings on COMAND Online
DTMF sends a reduced data package that
does not contain the vehicle identification
number and time stamp.
Ran
COMAND Online
Displays in the COMAND display
: Mercedes-Benz emergency call system is
operational
If the Mercedes-Benz emergency call is available, you see the SOS READY display message
in the basic telephone menu.
If a Mercedes-Benz emergency call is triggered either automatically or manually, you
also see the Mercedes-Benz emergency
call active display message.
If position and vehicle data are sent to the
Mercedes-Benz emergency call centre, you
see the Mercedes-Benz emergency call
Sending data display message.
If the Mercedes-Benz emergency call connects with the Mercedes-Benz emergency
call centre, you see the Mercedes-Benz
Emergency Call Connected display message.
Online and Internet functions
Features of your COMAND Online
This Supplement describes all the standard
and optional equipment for your COMAND
Online system, as available at the time of
going to print. Country-specific differences
are possible. Please note that your
COMAND Online system may not be equipped with all the features described.
General notes
Conditions for access
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
You must observe the legal requirements for
the country in which you are currently driving
when operating COMAND Online.
The COMAND Online Mercedes-Benz Apps
and Internet access are available via the Bluetooth® interface or via the data-enabled MB
SAP module.
In order to use the functions, the following
conditions are necessary:
RThe
mobile phone supports the DUN Bluetooth® profile (Dial-Up Networking) and is
connected to COMAND Online via the Bluetooth® interface (Y page 390). The DUN
Bluetooth® profile enables the mobile
phone to establish a dial-up connection to
the Internet.
RYou need a valid mobile service contract
with a data option, which is used to calculate the associated connection costs.
RThe access data of the mobile phone network provider must be set on COMAND
Online for the connected mobile phone
(Y page 434).
Online and Internet functions
i If the connected mobile phone supports
Function restrictions
i You can obtain more detailed information
You will not be able to use the mobile phone,
will no longer be able to use the mobile phone,
or you may have to wait before using it, in the
following situations:
about suitable mobile phones on the Internet at http://www.mercedesbenz.com/connect or from your
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
i If you use incorrect access data, addi-
tional costs may be incurred. This can happen when you use details that are different
from the contract or details from another
contract/data package.
i The availability of individual MercedesBenz Apps may vary depending on the
country.
i The terms of use are shown when
COMAND Online is used for the first time
and then once a year thereafter. Only read
and accept the terms of use when the vehicle is stationary.
i Internet pages cannot be shown on the
driver's side while the vehicle is in motion.
Connection difficulties while the vehicle is in motion
The following could be the cause of call disconnection:
Rinsufficient
GSM/UMTS network coverage
Rthe vehicle has moved into a GSM cell with
no free channels
SIM card used is not compatible with
the network available
Ryou are using a mobile phone with "Twincard" and the mobile phone with the second SIM card is logged into the network at
the same time.
Rthe
Rif
the mobile phone is switched off
Rif the Bluetooth® function is switched off in
COMAND Online
Rif the Bluetooth® function is switched off on
the mobile phone while you are using Bluetooth® interface telephony
Rif the mobile phone is not logged into a
mobile phone network
Rif neither the mobile phone network nor the
mobile phone allow simultaneous use of a
phone and an Internet connection
i It is possible that you may not be able to
receive calls when an Internet connection
is active. This depends on the mobile phone
and the mobile phone network used.
Roaming
When you are driving your vehicle in a different country and using the COMAND Online
Internet and online functions, you may incur
additional costs (roaming fees). When you are
in a different country, your SIM card must be
enabled for data roaming. If your mobile
phone network provider does not have a data
roaming agreement with the roaming partner,
it may not be possible to establish an Internet
connection. Deactivate this function on your
mobile phone if you want to avoid data roaming when you are in a different country.
Setting access data
Introduction
To use online and Internet functions, you
need Internet access data for the connected
mobile phone. You can obtain this from your
mobile phone network provider.
Z
COMAND Online
the PAN Bluetooth profile (Personal Area
Network), you can use the automatic configuration function (Y page 435).
433
434
Online and Internet functions
A selected/manually set mobile phone network provider is only valid for the mobile
phone connected when the selection/setting
is made. The mobile phone network provider
is set automatically upon reconnection.
i When you are driving your vehicle in a dif-
ferent country and using the online and
Internet functions on COMAND Online, you
may incur additional costs (roaming fees).
COMAND Online
i While initialising the mobile phone for the
Internet connection, access data which is
already on the mobile phone may be overwritten. You should therefore check the
settings on the mobile phone (see the
mobile phone operating instructions).
i Adjust the access data settings when the
vehicle is stationary. You may otherwise be
distracted from the traffic conditions,
cause an accident and injure yourself and
others.
Selecting/setting Internet access data
X
Select Settings by sliding ÆV and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
When you connect the mobile phone to
COMAND Online for the first time, there is
no mobile phone network provider preset
(Y page 390). Provider: is followed by the
words not selected.
selected
If a mobile phone is connected and a mobile
phone network provider has been selected,
the name of the mobile phone network is
shown after Provider:
Provider:.
X
Press W the COMAND controller.
The list of mobile phone network providers
appears.
Calling up the list of mobile phone network providers
X Select the ® icon in the main function bar
by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
The carousel view appears.
Online and Internet functions
435
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
You will see a message informing you that
automatic configuration is possible.
X
Select Yes and press W to confirm.
X
List of mobile phone network providers (empty)
In order to set the access data of the mobile
phone network provider you can:
Rselect
the predefined access data of the
mobile phone network provider
(Y page 435)
Rfor automatic configuration – this option
only appears in the list of providers if the
connected mobile phone supports the
Bluetooth® PAN (Personal Area Network)
profile (Y page 435).
Rmanually set the access data of the mobile
phone network provider (Y page 437)
In the list of mobile phone network providers, select Autom. configuration
by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm (Y page 434).
The configuration data is transferred from
the mobile phone. If the configuration is
successful, a # dot appears in front of
Autom. configuration
.
Selecting access data of the mobile phone
network provider
Configuring access data automatically
Searching for providers
X
Requirement: your telephone must be connected to COMAND Online via Bluetooth®
and must support the Bluetooth® PAN profile.
Option 1 if your telephone is not yet configured for Internet access:
X
Select the ® icon in the main function bar
by sliding ZV and turning cV d the
Select Search for providers in the
mobile phone network providers list by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm (Y page 434).
A list of countries appears.
Select the country of your mobile phone
network provider, e.g. Germany
Germany, and press
W to confirm.
The list of available mobile phone network
providers appears.
i The access data for the mobile phone network provider is selected once for the
mobile phone connected and is loaded
X
Z
COMAND Online
Option 2:
Online and Internet functions
436
again each time the mobile phone is connected (Y page 434).
X
To edit the access data: proceed as
described for manually entering the access
data (Y page 437).
When you confirm the edited access data,
the list of mobile phone network providers
appears and displays the selected provider.
If, after selecting a mobile phone network
provider, several access settings are displayed:
COMAND Online
X
i You must set the access data of the
mobile phone network provider who provides the SIM card and the associated data
package (access settings) for the connected mobile phone. The access data remains
the same if you are in a different country
(roaming). The access data of another network is not selected.
There are mobile phone network providers
who offer multiple access data. This
depends on the data package used, for
example.
The mobile phone network provider only
has one access setting
X
Select the mobile phone network provider
by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
A menu appears.
To check preset access data: select Edit
and confirm with W.
The list of access data appears
(Y page 437).
X Check the access data.
X
If the access data is correct: press the
% reset button or the & symbol and
press W to confirm.
You can now accept the access data of the
mobile phone network provider.
X Select Save and press W to confirm.
The list of mobile phone network providers
appears; the access data of the provider
has been accepted.
X
Select the appropriate access setting by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
A menu appears.
To check access settings: select Edit
and press W to confirm.
The list of access data appears
(Y page 437).
X Check the access data.
X
If the access data is correct: press the
% reset button or the & symbol and
press W to confirm.
You can now accept the access data of the
mobile phone network provider.
X Select Save and press W to confirm.
The list of mobile phone network providers
appears; the access data of the provider
has been accepted.
X
X
To edit the access data: proceed as
described in "Manually setting the access
data of the mobile phone network provider"
(Y page 437).
When you confirm the edited access data,
the list of mobile phone network providers
appears and displays the selected provider.
Online and Internet functions
Manually setting the access data of the
mobile phone network provider
Explanation of the access data
Input field
Meaning
Provider:
Name of the provider to
be displayed in the list of
mobile phone network
providers. The name can
be freely selected.
The standard entry is
provider .
Ph. number:
Access number for establishing the connection.
i The access number
depends on the mobile
phone used. For GSM/
UMTS mobile phones,
*99***1# is used as a
standard.
Access
point:
APN network access point
(Access Point Name).
You can obtain this information from your mobile
phone network provider.
i Entry is not necessary
for all mobile phone
network providers and
mobile phones.
List of access data (new provider)
The user identification
can be obtained from your
mobile phone network
provider.
Calling up the list of access data
i Entry is not necessary
User ID:
X
Confirm Create new provider in the list
of mobile phone network providers by
pressing W the COMAND controller.
The list of access data appears. The standard name provider is automatically
entered into the Provider: field. You can
now make the entries.
i The access data of the mobile phone net-
work provider is set once for the connected
mobile phone.
for all mobile phone
network providers.
Password:
The password can be
obtained from your
mobile phone network
provider.
i Entry is not necessary
for all mobile phone
network providers.
Z
COMAND Online
The currently selected access settings (# dot
in front of the entry) are used for the connected mobile phone.
X To return to the carousel view: press the
% back button twice.
or
X Press W the COMAND controller and then
the % back button.
437
Online and Internet functions
438
Input field
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The input menu for the phone number
appears.
Meaning
DNS address: The DNS addresses
(Domain Name Service)
can be negotiated automatically or entered manually. The required information can be obtained
from your mobile phone
network provider.
COMAND Online
i Most mobile phone
network providers support the Automatic
function. If you selected
the Manual option, you
are usually required to
enter a DNS address.
DNS1:
DNS2:
Fields for entering the
DNS server addresses
manually. The address
can be obtained from your
mobile phone network
provider.
Entering access data
X
Enter the telephone number.
To enter the access data: in the list of
access data, select the Access point:
input field and confirm by pressing W.
X Enter the access data.
X
To enter the user ID: in the list of access
data, select the User ID: input field and
confirm by pressing W.
X Enter the user ID.
X
X
In the list of access data, confirm the Pro‐
vider: input field by pressing W
(Y page 437).
An input menu appears.
To enter the password: in the list of
access data, select the Password: input
field and confirm by pressing W.
X Enter the password.
X
Enter the provider (Y page 303).
X
X
To enter the phone number: in the list of
access data, select the Ph. number: input
field by sliding ÆV or turning cVd the
X
To set the DNS address: select Auto‐
matic or Manual with the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Automatic: the DNS address is set autoAutomatic
matically.
Online and Internet functions
Manual: uses the entries in DNS 1 and DNS
Manual
2.
439
Managing access data of the mobile
phone network provider
Overview
The access data of the mobile phone network
provider can be:
Redited
Rcopied, then edited and accepted for a new
provider name
i Changes that you make to the access
data of a mobile phone network provider
apply to all mobile phones that use this
access data.
Entering the DNS1
Entering the example DNS
After selecting Manual
Manual, select the DNS1
input field with the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
X Enter 172.28.4.81
172.28.4.81, for example.
X
Internet access data for other mobile
phones
If the access data is already available in the
list of mobile phone network providers, you
can use it for additional mobile phones.
The following prerequisites are required for
this:
additional mobile phone must be connected.
Rthe access data must apply to the mobile
phone contract of the currently connected
mobile phone.
X Select a provider from the list of mobile
phone network providers by turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm (Y page 435).
After you select the provider, the list of
mobile phone network providers is closed.
The selected provider is entered.
i When the Internet connection is active,
you cannot edit or delete the access data of
the currently set mobile phone network
provider.
Editing the access data
X Select a provider from the list of mobile
phone network providers by turning cVd
the COMAND controller (Y page 435).
X Select the symbol to the right of the entry
by sliding VY the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
Rthe
Confirm Edit by pressing W.
The access data is displayed.
X Edit the access data. A description of the
entry can be found under "Manually setting
the access data of the mobile phone network provider" (Y page 437).
X
Z
COMAND Online
Rdeleted
Online and Internet functions
440
Saving access data under a new provider
name
X Select a provider from the list of mobile
phone network providers by turning cVd
the COMAND controller (Y page 435).
X Select the symbol to the right of the entry
by sliding VY the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
been used, COMAND Online automatically
disconnects from the Internet.
X Select Settings in the carousel view by
sliding ÆV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Disconnect automatically
after: and press W to confirm.
The # dot indicates the current setting.
Confirm Copy provider entry by pressing W.
The access data is displayed.
X Edit the access data. A description of the
entry can be found under "Making entries"
in the "Manually setting the access data of
the mobile phone network provider" section (Y page 437).
X
COMAND Online
X
Deleting the access data of the mobile
phone network provider
X Select a provider from the list of mobile
phone network providers by turning cVd
the COMAND controller (Y page 435).
X Select the symbol to the right of the entry
by sliding VY the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
Confirm Delete by pressing W.
A prompt appears asking whether you wish
to delete the access data.
X Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
X
Selecting the length of time for automatic disconnection from the Internet
If a preset time has elapsed during which neither the online functions nor the Internet have
Select 5 min,
min 15 min or Off and press W
to confirm.
Off switches the function off.
An active Internet connection is identified by
the double arrows on the top right of the display.
Establishing/ending the connection
Establishing the connection
The conditions for establishing a connection
are described in "General notes"
(Y page 432).
X Option 1: select the ® icon in the main
function bar by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
The carousel view appears.
X Turn cVd or slide XVY the COMAND controller until the Mercedes-Benz Apps
panel or a favourite is brought to the front,
if these have been previously created
(Y page 459).
X
Option 2: enter a web address
(Y page 454).
Online and Internet functions
441
Ending the connection
X
Press the ~ button on COMAND Online
or on the multifunction steering wheel.
or
X
Select the scissors symbol on the bottom
right of the carousel view and press W to
confirm.
cancelled, COMAND Online tries to reconnect. You should therefore always close the
connection on COMAND Online or via the
multifunction steering wheel.
Google™ Local Search
Calling up the Local Search menu
X
For both options, press W the COMAND
controller.
The Internet connection is established. An
active Internet connection is identified with
symbol :. The example shows the menu in
the Google™ Local Search (Y page 442)
function.
X
To cancel the connection: while the connection is being established, confirm Can‐
cel by pressing W.
or
Press the ~ button on COMAND Online
or on the multifunction steering wheel.
i If a phone call is made at the same time as
the active Internet connection, the
¡ symbol is displayed in :. The Internet
connection remains active depending on
the mobile phone and mobile phone network used.
X
Select the ® icon in the main function bar
by turning c V d the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
A list with active Mercedes-Benz Apps
appears.
X Bring the Mercedes-Benz Apps panel to
the front by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
The Mercedes-Benz Apps menu appears.
X Press W to confirm the Google Local
Search entry.
The Google Local Search menu appears.
X To exit the menu: select Back by sliding
VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Z
COMAND Online
i If the mobile phone Internet connection is
Online and Internet functions
442
Searching
Selecting a search position
Entry restriction
It is only possible to enter a search term in the
input menu when the vehicle is stationary.
COMAND Online
Entering a search term
After a search term has been entered and
confirmed, a menu appears.
COMAND Online searches for available
POIs for the search term entered:
Rnear the current vehicle position
Ralong the calculated route
If a destination has previously been
entered, the function is available.
Rnear the destination
If a destination has previously been
entered, the function is available.
Rnear an address
X After selecting Near destination,
destination enter
an address and confirm.
The search results are displayed.
X
Input menu
X
Confirm Search in the Google Local Search
menu by pressing W.
The input menu appears.
To enter using the character bar: enter
the search term.
X To enter characters using the number
pad: press the number keys in rapid succession.
The character appears when the key is
pressed. The first available character is
highlighted.
X
Example: search results
X
After entering the search term, select ¬
by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
A menu appears. Here, you can select
where the destination search should begin.
X
Select an entry in the list of search results
by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
A menu appears.
X
To show the detailed view: confirm
Details by pressing W the COMAND controller.
The address of the selected entry is displayed.
To use a search result as the destination: select Navigate to by turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
You then switch to navigation mode and
can start route calculation (Y page 329).
You then switch to navigation mode and
can start route calculation.
i The search result is stored in the
"Last destinations" memory at the same
time (Y page 371). You can take the destination from this memory and save it permanently in the destination memory
(Y page 369).
X
443
To call up a destination: select Call with
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
You then switch to the telephone function
and make the call (Y page 397).
You then switch to the telephone function
and make the call.
i If there is no phone number available, the
menu item cannot be selected.
X To import a destination: select Import
with the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
You can choose whether you want to save
the POI as a personal POI on the SD memory card or in the address book.
i If there is no SD memory card in the slot,
the Save as personal POI menu item
cannot be selected.
X Insert the SD memory card (Y page 472).
COMAND Online
Using search results
Online and Internet functions
X
To save as a personal POI: confirm Save
as personal POI by pressing W the
COMAND controller.
The entry is saved as a personal POI on the
SD memory card.
i You can use a personal POI in navigation
mode for route calculation (Y page 347).
If the personal POI is saved on the SD memory, you can also use it for route calculation
in another vehicle.
X To save to the address book: select
Save to address book by turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
The entry is stored in the address book.
X
Z
Online and Internet functions
COMAND Online
444
Popular searches
Search history
This function allows you to search using predefined search criteria.
X Bring Popular searches in the local
search menu to the front by turning cVd
(the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
A menu displays the available search criteria.
This function offers you the previous search
queries.
X Bring Search history in the Local search
menu to the front by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The previous search queries are shown
with the most recent at the top.
Example: popular searches
Select the search criteria and press W to
confirm.
X Proceed as described in the "Selecting the
search position" section (Y page 442). If
the vehicle is stationary, the search results
can be supplemented manually, e.g. "Hotel
Adler".
Select the search criteria and press W to
confirm.
X Proceed as described in the "Selecting the
search position" section (Y page 442). If
the vehicle is stationary, the search results
can be supplemented manually, e.g. "Hotel
Adler".
X
X
Destination/route download
Introduction
You can send destinations and routes from
Google™ maps to the server and download
these via this function. You can use the des-
Online and Internet functions
445
Bring the Destination/route download
panel to the front and press W to confirm.
Exit, you quit the destination/route
i With Exit
download.
With Options
Options, you set the options for the
destination/route download (Y page 452).
X Confirm the Destination/route down‐
load panel by pressing W.
Available routes and destinations are
shown in the list.
COMAND Online
tinations and routes for route guidance and
save them for further use.
Sending destinations to the server
Call up the website for Google™ Maps on
the Internet.
X Enter a destination.
X Click "More" at the destination.
X Click on "Send".
X Click "Send to vehicle".
X Select Mercedes-Benz as the vehicle
brand.
X Enter the vehicle identification number.
X Click on "Send".
The destination is sent to the server.
i The vehicle identification number (VIN) is
preset at the factory as identification for
download. Instead of the vehicle ID, you
can also enter your e-mail address here.
The availability of the destination/route
download function is country-dependent.
In order to be able to use the download, you
first have to register COMAND Online. This
is done in the vehicle by entering your name
and e-mail address once and confirming
the general terms and conditions.
X
Downloading destinations from the
server
Proceed as follows to use destinations/
routes that have been sent to the server:
Select the ® symbol in the main function
bar by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The carousel view appears.
X Bring the Mercedes-Benz Apps panel to
the front by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
The Mercedes-Benz Apps menu appears.
X
X
You can save up to 20 routes and 50 destinations for your vehicle on the server and display these in the list. If you send further routes
or destinations to the server, the existing
entries are deleted from the list.
i The routes/destinations sent from Goo-
gle™ maps to the server are automatically
deleted from there after seven days.
Using destinations
Calling up a menu
X Select an entry in the list by turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
A menu appears.
Displaying details
Confirm Details in the menu by pressing
W the COMAND controller.
The route or destination is displayed.
X
Z
Online and Internet functions
446
To call up a POI: confirm the entry by
pressing W.
i You can use the function if:
X
Ra
mobile phone is connected
(Y page 390)
Rthe destination address contains a telephone number
Using as a destination
Select Navigate to in the menu by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
You then switch to navigation mode and
can start route calculation (Y page 329).
i A route can only be stored as a personal
POI on an SD memory card or taken directly
for route calculation (Y page 446).
COMAND Online
X
Placing a call at the destination
X Select Call in the menu by turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
You then switch to the telephone function
and make the call (Y page 397).
Importing a destination/route
When importing, you can choose whether you
want to save the destination as a personal POI
on an SD memory card or in the address book.
You can only save routes as personal POIs to
an SD memory card, but not in the address
book.
X Select Import in the menu with the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
i If there is no SD memory card in the slot,
the As personal POI menu item is greyed
out.
X Insert the SD memory card (Y page 472).
To save as a personal POI: confirm As
personal POI by pressing W the
COMAND controller.
The entry is saved as a personal POI on the
SD memory card.
i You can use a personal POI in navigation
mode for route calculation (Y page 347).
You can also use a personal POI in another
vehicle for route calculation.
X To save to the address book: select To
address book by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The entry is stored in the address book.
X
Deleting a destination/route from the
server
X Select an entry in the list by turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X Select Delete and press W to confirm.
A query appears asking whether the destination or the route should be deleted.
X Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
Weather
Introduction
COMAND can receive weather forecasts anywhere in the world via online connection and
display them in an information chart (current
day, 5-day forecast) or in the weather map.
The weather map can display the following
weather data with symbols:
Rhazard
icons (e.g. storms, slippery conditions)
Rprecipitation radar (e.g. rain, snow)
Rweather overview
Rtemperatures
Rcloud cover
Rwind direction and speeds
Online and Internet functions
To switch on: select the ® icon in the
main function bar by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The carousel view appears.
X Turn cVd the COMAND controller until
Mercedes-Benz Apps is brought to the
front and press W to confirm.
The Mercedes-Benz Apps carousel view
appears.
X
X
Turn cVd the COMAND controller until
Weather is brought to the front and press
W to confirm.
The information chart shows the current
weather at the current vehicle position (factory setting). You can change the default
view and the default location in the Options
menu (Y page 451).
You see the following information:
Rthe
time of the current weather report
Rthe current temperature
Rinformation on the weather (e.g. cloudy,
rain)
Rthe maximum daytime temperature
Rthe minimum daytime temperature
Rthe probability of rain
Rthe forecast for the current day (three time
intervals)
X To switch to a five-day forecast: confirm
5-day by pressing W.
The information chart displays the forecast
for the next five days in the currently selected location.
X To return to the current weather information: confirm Current by pressing W.
A menu appears.
X
To deactivate: press the % back button.
or
X
Select Back by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
Irrespective of the option chosen, the carousel view will appear.
Displaying additional information
In addition to the current temperatures, you
can also display information such as humidity
and air quality (if the information is available).
X Select Info in the information chart by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
The information chart displays information
for the selected location.
Selecting the location
Introduction
You can select the following options for the
weather forecast:
Rthe
current vehicle position
destination
Ra winter sports area
Ra location anywhere in the world
You can select the location in the information
chart (option 1) (Y page 447) or in the map
(option 2) (Y page 448). Weather information
is supplied by the nearest weather station.
Rthe
Option 1: selecting the location in the
information chart
X Select Position in the information chart
by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
A menu appears.
X
To select the current vehicle position:
confirm Current position by pressing
W.
X
To select the destination: select Near
destination by turning cVd the
Z
COMAND Online
Switching the weather display on/off
447
Online and Internet functions
448
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
i If a route has been calculated, you can
COMAND Online
select Near destination (Y page 329).
The menu item is otherwise greyed out.
X
To select a winter sports area: select In
winter sports areas in the menu and
press W to confirm.
A list of countries appears.
X
Select a country, e.g. ANDORRA
ANDORRA, and press
W to confirm.
The available winter sports areas are displayed.
X
X
X
Select a winter sports area from the menu
and press W to confirm.
The information chart shows information
on:
Rtype of skiing
Rsnow conditions
Rtemperatures
To select the location: select Other
location in the menu by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
An input menu appears.
Enter the search area. Character entry
(Y page 305).
The information chart with the weather
forecast appears when the search area has
been entered.
Entry
Example
Postcode
100621
City
Beijing
Address
Capital Airport
Option 2: selecting the location in the
weather map
X Call up the weather map and move to the
desired location (Y page 448).
X Press W the COMAND controller.
The menu bar is shown.
X Press W the COMAND controller again and
confirm Display weather.
weather
The information chart displays the current
weather for the selected location.
Weather map
Calling up the weather map
Select Map in the information chart by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
The map appears in a scale of 100 km.
X
To display the crosshair: slide ZV the
COMAND controller.
X To scroll the weather map: slide XVY,
ZVÆ or aVb the COMAND controller.
The weather map moves in the corresponding direction under the crosshair.
X
To change the map scale: as soon as you
turn cVd the COMAND controller, the
scale bar appears.
X Turn cVd until the desired scale is set.
X
i The data is downloaded again from the
server for these functions. This can delay
the display of the weather map.
Showing/hiding the menu in the weather
map
X To show: press W the COMAND controller
in the weather map.
X To hide: slide up ZV the COMAND controller.
Online and Internet functions
Weather characteristic
Display in the map
Hazard icons
Shows warnings
Weather
radar
Displays the rain radar as
a coloured area on the
map
Atmospheric
pressure
Shows the weather overview with information
islands
Temperatures
Displays the temperatures
Cloud cover
Displays the cloud cover
Winds
Displays wind direction
with an arrow and wind
speed with colouring
To switch back to the information chart:
display the menu on the weather map.
(Y page 448)
X Select Display weather and press W to
confirm.
X
Memory functions
Storing a location in the memory
You can save locations that are called up frequently in ten preset positions (0, 1 - 9).
X Select the location (Y page 447).
X
Press and hold a number key.
When the location is saved, the number of
the selected preset comes before the name
of the place in the caption.
Selecting a location from the memory
X Quick select: when the weather display
(COMAND Online) is switched on and an
entry is available, press a number key, e.g.
l.
The information chart appears and displays
the weather information.
From the weather memory: select Posi‐
tion in the information chart by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
X Select Presets and press W to confirm.
X Select a preset position that has an entry by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
The information chart appears and displays
the weather information.
X
i The hazard icon display is preset in the
factory. This presetting can be changed in
the Options menu (Y page 451).
X
Select a weather characteristic by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The # dot indicates which weather characteristic is currently displayed on the map.
You can select one weather characteristic
at a time.
Legend
Display the menu on the weather map
(Y page 448).
X Select View by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Legend and press W to confirm.
The legend is displayed in accordance with
the currently selected weather characteristic.
X
Options
Introduction
You can select options for the following
Mercedes-Benz Apps on COMAND Online:
RLocal
Search (Y page 450)
page 451)
RDestination download (Y page 452)
RWeather (Y
Z
COMAND Online
Switching to the weather information display in the map
X Display the menu on the weather map
(Y page 448).
X Select View by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
449
Online and Internet functions
450
You can reset the selected options to the
default settings (Y page 452).
X
Confirm the entry after Search radius:
by pressing W.
The # dot indicates the currently selected
search radius.
X
Select an entry by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The selected setting is accepted.
X
To exit the menu: select Back by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
Calling up the Options menu
Select the ® symbol in the main function
bar by turning c V d the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The carousel view appears.
X Bring the Mercedes-Benz Apps panel to
the front by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Options by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
COMAND Online
X
Selecting a service provider
Selecting options for the local search
Setting the search radius
X
Select Local Search in the Options menu
by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
The menu shows the current settings.
X
Select the entry after Service provider:
by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
The # dot indicates the currently selected
service provider.
i If the entry is greyed out, you cannot
select the service provider.
X
Select Local Search in the Options menu
by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
The menu shows the current settings.
X
Select an entry and press W to confirm.
The selected service provider is accepted.
X
To exit the menu: select Back by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
Deleting/saving search queries
Select the Delete all searches entry by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
A prompt appears, asking whether you
really wish to delete the search queries.
X
Select Weather in the options menu by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm (Y page 450).
The menu shows the current settings.
X
Select the entry after Default location:
by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
The # dot indicates the currently selected
default location.
X
Select an entry by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The selected location is accepted.
X
To exit the menu: select Back by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
X
X
Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
Selecting options for the weather display
Setting the default view
You can specify which view is called up after
activating the weather display (Y page 447).
You can make the following settings:
Rcurrent
weather
forecast
Rinfo view
Rlast view
X Select Weather in the options menu by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm (Y page 450).
The menu shows the current settings.
Rfive-day
X
Confirm the entry after Default view: by
pressing W.
The # dot indicates the currently selected
default view.
X
Select an entry by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The selected view is accepted.
X
To exit the menu: select Back by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
Setting the default location
You can make the following settings:
RCurrent
Rcurrent
RPresets
Selecting weather data for the map view
The weather map can display the following
weather data:
Rhazard
icons (e.g. storms, slippery conditions)
Rprecipitation radar (e.g. rain, snow)
Ratmospheric pressure
Rtemperatures
Rcloud cover
Rwind direction and speeds
You can select one feature each for the map
view.
The availability of weather information is
country-dependent.
X Select Weather in the options menu by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm (Y page 450).
The menu shows the current settings.
X
Select the entry after Default map view:
by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
The # dot indicates the currently selected
feature.
X
Select an entry and press W to confirm.
The selected feature is accepted.
position
destination
Z
451
COMAND Online
Online and Internet functions
Online and Internet functions
452
X
To exit the menu: select Back by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
COMAND Online
Setting options for destination/route
download
Specifying the ID for the download
You can replace the vehicle identification
number (ID) with your e-mail address. The
vehicle identification number is usually
entered.
X Select Destination/route download in
the Options menu by sliding ZVÆ the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm (Y page 450).
The menu shows the current settings.
X
Confirm the entry next to ID: by pressing
W.
An input menu appears.
Enter an e-mail address. Character entry
(Y page 303).
X After entry, select ¬ and press W to
confirm.
The e-mail address is entered in the menu.
An e-mail will be sent to your e-mail address
shortly afterwards. You must confirm it
within 48 hours. Otherwise, your previous
ID will continue to be used.
X To complete the settings, check your mailbox and follow the link in the e-mail.
X
X
To exit the menu: select Back by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
Setting the type of import
You can choose between manual and automatic importing.
X Select the entry after Import: by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The # dot indicates the current setting.
X
Select Manual or Automatic and press W
to confirm.
The setting is accepted.
X
To exit the menu: select Back by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
Deleting/keeping POIs after they have
been imported to the server
X Select the entry after Import & delete:
by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
The # dot indicates the current setting.
X
Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
The setting is accepted.
Yes deletes the POIs after importing to the
server.
No does not delete the POIs on the server.
X
To exit the menu: select Back by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
i Routes and destinations are automatically deleted on the server after seven
days.
Resetting the settings
The reset function resets all Mercedes-Benz
Apps settings to the factory settings. After
resetting, routes and destinations can only be
sent to the vehicle identification number (ID)
once you have activated your e-mail address
again (Y page 452).
X Select the ® symbol in the main function
bar by turning c V d the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The carousel view appears.
X Bring the Mercedes-Benz Apps panel to
the front by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Options by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
Online and Internet functions
Additional services
Mercedes-Benz Mobile Website
For individual Mercedes-Benz Apps, it may be
necessary to pay licence fees before using.
Use is then limited to a certain period of time.
Licence fees must be paid again for use
beyond this time period.
The COMAND Online functions contain the
Mercedes-Benz Mobile Website as a predefined favourite.
X Select the ® icon in the main function bar
by turning c V d the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
The carousel view appears.
X Bring the Mercedes-Benz Mobile Web‐
site panel to the front by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The Mercedes-Benz home page appears.
i You cannot delete the Mercedes-Benz
Mobile Website panel.
Further Mercedes-Benz Apps
You can call up additional Mercedes-Benz
Apps, such as Facebook, or Google™ services, such as Street View or Panoramio here.
The following examples show how to call up a
Mercedes-Benz App, for example Facebook,
and generally how to call up Google™ services.
Calling up Facebook:
Select the ® icon in the main function bar
by turning c V d the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
The carousel view appears.
X Bring the Mercedes-Benz Apps panel to
the front by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
The Mercedes-Benz Apps menu appears.
X Select Facebook by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The Facebook homepage appears.
X To call up Google™ services: this is done
through Google™ Local Search
(Y page 444).
i Facebook is a social networking website.
This App allows you to log in from your
vehicle and use Facebook's many functions.
Google™ Street View allows you to view
streets in 360-degree panoramas.
Google™ Panoramio expands Google Local
Search to include photos at the selected
position.
X
Internet radio
General notes
A good Internet connection is required to
transmit audio data efficiently. To ensure the
best-possible reception, your mobile phone
should be connected to the vehicle's exterior
aerial via the phone bracket (optional).
Bear in mind that a relatively large volume of
data can be transmitted when using the Internet radio. An average 128 kbit per second
data transfer rate can transfer 56MB of data
in one hour.
Z
COMAND Online
Select Reset and press W to confirm.
A prompt appears asking whether you
really wish to reset.
X Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
X
453
Online and Internet functions
454
The data transfer rate of a station is displayed
while receiving data.
Calling up the Internet radio
Manually re-establishing a connection:
X
Select ; (play) again in the Internet
radio menu and press W to confirm.
Ending data transfer:
X
Select É (stop) in the Internet radio
menu and press W to confirm.
or
COMAND Online
X
Change to another audio source, for example Disc
Disc.
If you change to a main function that is not an
audio source, e.g. navigation, the data connection remains on. You can continue listening to the set station.
Select the ® icon in the main function bar
by sliding ZV and turning cV d the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The carousel view appears.
X Bring the Internet radio panel to the
front by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The Internet radio menu appears.
X
Searching for stations
Select Search in the Internet radio menu.
A list with search criteria appears.
X Select criterion and press W to confirm.
X
i For example, as a search criterion you can
set an Internet radio station that is located
close to your navigation destination.
Connecting to a station
Search for a station (Y page 454).
X Select ; (play) in the Internet radio
menu and press W to confirm.
The connection is established.
X
If the data stream is interrupted, an automatic
attempt is made to re-establish the connection.
Internet
Display restriction
Internet pages cannot be shown while the
vehicle is in motion.
Calling up a website
Calling up the carousel view
X Select the ® symbol in the main function
bar by turning c V d the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The carousel view appears.
You can now enter a web address (option 1
(Y page 454)) or select it in the carousel view
(option 2 (Y page 455)).
To select in the carousel view, you must first
create favourites (Y page 459).
Option 1: entering the web address
You can enter the web address using either
the character bar or the number keypad
(Y page 305).
X Call up the carousel view (Y page 454).
X Select www by sliding VÆ and turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
An input menu appears.
X
X
To make entries using the character
bar: enter the web address in the input line.
Character entry (Y page 303).
As soon as the first letter has been entered
in the input line, a list appears below it. The
list shows web addresses that begin with
the letters you have entered and web
addresses that have already been called
up.
The list is empty the first time you call it up.
To enter characters using the number
pad: press the number keys in rapid succession.
The character appears when the key is
pressed. The first available letter is highlighted. Enter the character using the character bar (Y page 305).
X
After entering the web address, select the
¬ symbol by turning cVd or sliding
XVY the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The website is called up.
X
To select a web address in the list: slide
ZV the COMAND controller in the input
menu with character bar.
The list is activated.
Select the web address by turning cVd or
sliding ZVÆ the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
The web address is entered in the input line.
X Press W the COMAND controller.
The website is called up. The Establish‐
ing data connection to ... message appears.
X
Option 2: selecting favourites
You must create at least one favourite in the
carousel view for this function (Y page 459).
X Call up the carousel view (Y page 454).
X In the carousel view, bring a favourite to the
front by turning cVd or sliding XVY the
Z
455
COMAND Online
Online and Internet functions
456
Online and Internet functions
COMAND Online
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The website is called up.
Example: highlighting an item that can be
selected
X
Navigating the website
Overview
Step
Example: entering text
Activity
Turn cVd the
controller.
Navigates from one
item that can be
selected (e.g. link,
text field or selection list) to the next
and highlights the
respective element
on the website.
Sliding the controller:
Moves the pointer
on the page.
X
Turn cVd COMAND controller.
A button is highlighted in the example.
Left or right XVY
Up or down ZVÆ
X Diagonally aVb
X
X
X
Press W the controller.
Calls up the menu or
opens the selected
item.
X
Press the %
button.
Calls up the previous page.
X
Press the j
button.
Closes the Internet
browser. If several
windows are open,
the current window
is closed.
X
Select an input line by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The character bar appears.
Online and Internet functions
457
Enter the text using the character bar or the
number keypad. Character entry
(Y page 303).
X If the text has been entered, select
the¬symbol by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The text has now been entered.
X
Menu functions
COMAND Online
Calling up a menu
X
X
To call up the shortcut: highlight the
selectable item on the page by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
To call up the entire menu: when the
shortcut is displayed, slide VÆ the
COMAND controller downwards.
or
X
Select a free area on the website by sliding
ZVÆ, XVY or aVb the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Open
Opens the website to the selected item.
X Call up the menu (Y page 457).
X Confirm Open by pressing W the COMAND
controller.
Enter URL
Call up the menu (Y page 457).
X Select Enter URL by turning cVd or sliding ZVÆ the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
X Enter a web address (URL) (Y page 454).
X
Z
Online and Internet functions
458
Calling up the previous website
X Call up the menu (Y page 457).
X Select Previous by turning cVd or sliding
ZVÆ the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
COMAND Online
Calling up the next website
X Call up the menu (Y page 457).
X Select Next by turning cVd or sliding ZVÆ
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
View
You can use this function to:
Rposition
a selection window on websites
that are larger than the display
Rselect a window that is already open
X Call up the menu (Y page 457).
X Select View by turning cVd or sliding ZVÆ
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
or
X Press the z key on the number keypad.
i You cannot use the z key if a phone
call is being made.
X
To position the selection window: confirm Full-screen view of current
page by pressing W the COMAND controller.
A selection window appears on the website.
Slide XVY, ZVÆ or aVb the COMAND
controller and position the selection window on the website.
X Press W the COMAND controller.
The selected section is enlarged.
X
X
X
To display and select open windows:
select Display open windows by turning
cVd or sliding ZVÆ the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The carousel view appears.
Press W the COMAND controller.
The website is displayed.
Exiting the menu
Call up the menu (Y page 457).
X Select Exit by turning cVd or sliding ZVÆ
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
The Internet browser is closed. If other windows are opened in the background,
another prompt appears.
X
Other menu functions
Opening in a new window
You can open up to five windows simultaneously.
X Call up the menu (Y page 457).
X Select Open in new window by turning
cVd or sliding ZVÆ the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
To select a window: select View and press
W to confirm.
X Select the website in the carousel view by
turning cVd or sliding XVY the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X
Adding to favourites
Adds the current website to the favourites.
The website can then be called up using the
carousel view. You can save up to 20 favourites in the carousel view.
X Call up the menu (Y page 457).
X Select Add to favourites by turning
cVd or sliding ZVÆ the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The following message appears: The page
has been added as a favourite.
favourite
Display favourites
X
X
Call up the menu (Y page 457).
Select Display favourites by turning
cVd or sliding ZVÆ the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The favourites are shown in the carousel
view.
Further information on favourites
(Y page 459).
Online and Internet functions
Reloading a website
X
X
Call up the menu (Y page 457).
Select Reload by turning cVd or sliding
ZVÆ the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
Creating favourites
Creating favourites in the carousel view
X
Call up the carousel view (Y page 454).
X
Bring the Create new favourite panel to
the front by turning cVd or sliding XVY
the COMAND controller.
X
Press W the COMAND controller.
An input menu appears.
Closing the active window
X
X
Call up the menu (Y page 457).
Select Close active window by turning
cVd or sliding ZVÆ the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
COMAND Online
or
X
Press the 2 button to the right of the
COMAND controller.
i You cannot use the 2 button if a
phone call is being made.
Displaying the complete web address of the
selected link
Call up the menu (Y page 457).
Select Link details by turning cVd or
sliding ZVÆ the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
The URL appears.
X Press W the COMAND controller and close
the display.
X
X
Settings
The settings are described in a separate section (Y page 461).
Favourites
Introduction
Favourites are frequently visited websites.
You have the following options for creating a
favourite:
Rin
the carousel view (Y page 459)
Rvia the menu item Add to favourites
(Y page 458)
Before creating a favourite in the carousel
view, you must first terminate any active connections (Y page 441).
You can select and edit favourites that you
have created.
459
Enter the web address (URL) and name
using either the character bar or the number keypad. Entering characters
(Y page 303)
X Select the¬symbol and press W to confirm.
The favourite has been created.
X
Adding a favourite via the menu
When a website is displayed, call up the
menu.
X Select Add to favourites in the menu
and press W to confirm (Y page 458).
X
Selecting favourites
X Call up the carousel view (Y page 454).
X
Select the favourite in the carousel view by
turning cVd or sliding XVY the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
The favourite is opened.
Z
Online and Internet functions
460
Editing favourites
Editing favourites in the carousel view
Calling up details
Call up the carousel view (Y page 454).
X Select Edit by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
An input menu appears.
X
X
COMAND Online
X
X
Call up the Favourites menu (Y page 460).
Select Details by turning cVd or sliding
ZVÆ the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
or
X
Enter the web address (URL) and name
using either the character bar or the number keypad (Y page 303).
Press the z button on the number keypad (this function is not available if you are
using the telephone at the same time).
The detailed display appears.
Editing favourites in the Favourites menu
Exiting
Call up the menu (Y page 457).
X Select Display favourites by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The favourite is displayed.
X Press W the COMAND controller.
The Favourites menu appears.
Call up the Favourites menu (Y page 460).
X Select Exit by turning cVd or sliding ZVÆ
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
or
X Press the % back button on the left next
to the COMAND controller.
The Favourites menu closes.
X
X
Select Edit by turning cVd or sliding ZVÆ
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
or
X
Press the g button on the number keypad (this function is not available if you are
using the telephone at the same time).
An input menu appears.
X
Enter the web address (URL) and name
using either the character bar or the number keypad. Character entry (Y page 303).
Other functions in the Favourites menu
Opening current favourites
Call up the Favourites menu (Y page 460).
X Confirm Open by pressing W the COMAND
controller.
X
Opens the current favourites in a new window.
Opening in a new window
X
X
Call up the Favourites menu (Y page 460).
Select Open in new window by turning
cVd or sliding ZVÆ the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Deleting favourites
Deleting favourites in the carousel view
Call up the carousel view (Y page 454).
Select Delete by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
A query appears.
X Select Yes and press W to confirm.
The favourite is deleted.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
X
X
Deleting favourites in the Favourites
menu
X
Select Delete by turning cVd or sliding
ZVÆ the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
or
X
Press the 2 button to the right of the
COMAND controller.
The favourite is deleted.
Online and Internet functions
Settings menu
You can select a different character set
here, e.g. if the characters of a website
appear distorted.
RDeleting private data
Deletes data which has been saved by the
browser during Internet use.
Changing settings
X Select a setting by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Switch the setting on O or off ª.
Select Character size or Character
code by turning cVd or sliding ZVÆ the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select a setting using the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
X
X
Call up the menu (Y page 457).
Select Settings by turning cVd or sliding
ZVÆ the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
You can activate/deactivate the following
settings:
RDownload
images automatically
It may take some time to download the
contents of websites that contain a large
number of images. Therefore, it may be
useful to deactivate this option.
RBlock popups
Popups are windows (usually with advertisements) which are displayed automatically when you call up a website. You can
block these displays.
REnable Javascript
JavaScript makes it possible to display and
interact with dynamic content on the website.
REnable cookies
Some websites save information in small
text files (cookies) in COMAND Online. You
can determine whether cookies may be
stored.
RCharacter size
You can select the font size which is used
when displaying the website.
RCharacter code
i If you change the settings, the websites
may not be displayed correctly.
Deleting private data
X Select Delete private data and press
W to confirm.
A menu appears.
X
Select the setting by turning cVd or sliding
ZVÆ the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The # dot in front of an entry indicates
which setting is active.
or
X
Select Delete all data on exiting and
press W to confirm.
Switch the setting on O or off ª.
Z
COMAND Online
Settings
461
Audio
COMAND Online
462
Radio mode and DAB radio mode
Option
Function
All
Deletes all private
data.
Cache
Deletes data in the
temporary storage.
may seriously impair radio and DAB radio
reception.
Cookies
Deletes cookies that
are created by websites which you have
called up.
DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting) is an optimised digital transmission standard designed
for the mobile reception of radio transmissions. Several programmes are combined
into so-called ensembles and transmitted on
a single frequency. Digital radio stations can
be transmitted nationally, regionally or
locally.
Some stations only transmit programmes at
certain times. If you have selected a station
that has subsequently been removed from
the ensemble, it will no longer be received.
You will continue to receive the other programmes in the ensemble. You will then need
to select a different programme.
Websites visited Deletes all websites
visited (path).
ODelete
Delete all
data on exiting
If this function is
activated O, all private data is deleted
when you exit the
Internet browser.
i If you reset COMAND Online to the factory settings (reset function), these settings are deleted (Y page 316).
Calling up the carousel view and closing
the Internet browser
To call up the carousel view: press the
% back button for longer than two seconds.
X To close the Internet browser: press the
% back button again for longer than two
seconds.
X
Audio
Features of your COMAND Online
This Supplement describes all the standard
and optional equipment for your COMAND
Online system, as available at the time of
going to print. Country-specific differences
are possible. Please note that your
COMAND Online system may not be equipped with all the features described.
Introduction
i Portable electronic devices in the vehicle
i DAB cannot be received everywhere in
Europe.
Switching to radio mode and DAB radio
mode
Switching on with the function button
X Press the $ function button.
The radio or DAB radio display appears.
Radio mode: you will hear the last station
played on the last waveband selected.
DAB radio mode: you will hear the last station played from the last ensemble selected.
i Repeatedly pressing the $ function
button switches between the FM, MW, SW
and LW wavebands in that order. It then
calls up DAB radio mode. Pressing the button again takes you back to FM radio mode.
Switching on with the audio menu
X Select Audio in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
If radio mode or DAB radio mode was the
last mode selected, it will now be active.
If another audio mode is switched on, you
can now switch to radio mode in the audio
menu.
You can select DAB radio mode in the radio
display.
X Select Audio by sliding ZV the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
The audio menu appears.
FM radio display
: Waveband and frequency of the selected
station
; Station name or station frequency of the
selected station
= Memory position of a station
? Radio text plus display (if available)
A Radio mode menu bar
X
To switch on DAB radio mode: select FM
in the radio display by sliding VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
X
Select DAB and press W to confirm.
: Current audio operating mode
; Main function bar
= Audio menu
X
Select Radio by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
Z
463
COMAND Online
Audio
Audio
464
Ensembles
An ensemble consists of multiple radio programmes. Every ensemble is transmitted in a
certain area (national, regional or local) in the
same way as a traditional AM/FM radio station.
COMAND Online
Switching to an FM station automatically
DAB radio display
: Name of the ensemble to which the selec;
=
?
A
ted station belongs
Name of the selected station
Memory position of a station
Radio text plus display (if available)
DAB radio mode menu bar
i If reception is poor (e.g. in tunnels or
mountain valleys), affected stations are
shown in grey. Playback of the currently
selected station is interrupted. As soon as
the reception quality is adequate, displays
and playback return to normal.
Switching wavebands
Option 1
You can switch the radio between the FM,
MW, LW and SW wavebands.
X Press the $ function button repeatedly
until the desired waveband is selected.
Option 2
Select FM
FM, DAB
DAB, MW
MW, SW or LW in the radio
display by sliding VÆ and turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select a waveband and press W to confirm.
You will hear the last station played on the
selected waveband.
X
i In the MW, LW and SW wavebands,
COMAND Online shows the station frequency instead of the station name.
If the reception of a DAB radio station deteriorates, COMAND Online automatically
changes to the corresponding FM station. For
this to happen, the following conditions must
be met:
Rthe
FM station's frequency is available.
Station fix menu item (Y page 467)
is switched off.
Rthe
i If you want to use this function, do not
switch to FM radio mode.
If reception is not possible, the symbol of a
radio tower with a line through it appears in
the display.
Setting a station
Setting a station from the station list
The station list is available in the FM waveband and in DAB radio mode.
Radio mode: the station list contains all the
stations that can currently be received and is
sorted alphabetically. For stations without a
programme service, the list shows the frequency instead of the name.
DAB radio mode: the station list contains
stations from all ensembles that can currently
be received. It shows the current programme
and a programme preview if the station operator supports this function. The station list is
sorted alphabetically.
X Quick select: turn cVd or slide XVY the
COMAND controller while the display/
Audio
or
X
Press the E or F button.
The needle jumps to the left or right.
To make a selection in the station list:
select Radio by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
X Confirm Station list by pressing W.
The station list appears.
X
To call up the programme preview: slide
VY the COMAND controller.
The next programmes are shown for the
displayed DAB radio stations.
X Switch back by sliding XV.
X
To activate the alphabetical browser:
slide XV the COMAND controller.
X Select the initial letters of the desired station name by turning cVd the COMAND
controller.
The station list changes to the appropriate
station.
X Switch back by sliding VY.
X
X
Example: radio mode
: Currently selected station
; Memory slot in station presets
To select the station using the multifunction steering wheel, see the separate vehicle Owner's Manual.
Setting a station using the station search
function
In radio mode, the station search function is
only available for the MW, LW and SW wavebands.
X Press the E or F button.
Station search scans up or down and stops
at the next station.
X
To select the station using the multifunction steering wheel, see the separate vehicle Owner's Manual.
Setting stations via the station presets
X Quick setting: press a number key, e.g.
l.
X
Example: DAB radio mode
: Alphabetical browser
; DAB radio station
= Current programme
? Start and end times of the programme
X
Select the station by turning c V d the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Directly in the station presets: select
Presets by sliding VÆ and turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
or
X
Press W the COMAND controller when the
display/selection window is active.
The channel presets appear. The # dot
indicates under which preset the currently
selected station is stored.
Z
COMAND Online
selection window for the radio display is
active.
465
Audio
466
X
Select a station by turning cVd and press
W to confirm.
or
X
COMAND Online
X
Press a number key, such as l.
To select the station using the multifunction steering wheel, see the separate vehicle Owner's Manual.
Setting stations by entering the frequency manually
This function is available in radio mode.
X Option 1: press the l button.
X
Option 2: select Radio in the radio display
by sliding VÆ and turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Frequency entry and press W to
confirm.
Irrespective of the option chosen, an input
menu will appear.
X
Enter a frequency using the number keys.
COMAND Online sets the frequency
entered.
Waveband
Frequency
FM (VHF)
87.5 – 108.0 MHz
MW (medium wave)
531 – 1620 kHz
SW (short wave)
5800 – 6250 kHz
LW (long wave)
153 – 282 kHz
i You can only enter currently permitted
numbers.
i If you enter a frequency in the MW, SW or
LW wavebands that is outside the frequency range, COMAND Online sets the
next lower frequency.
Storing a station
Storing stations manually
There are 10 presets available for each waveband as well as for DAB radio mode.
X Quick save: press and hold a number key,
e.g. l, until you hear a tone.
The station is stored.
X
Directly in the station presets: press W
the COMAND controller when the display/
selection window is active.
or
X
Select Presets by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
In both cases, the station presets appear.
The # dot indicates under which preset
the currently selected station is stored.
Station presets in DAB radio mode
X
Select a preset by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press and hold W
until you hear a tone.
The station is stored under the preset.
Storing stations automatically
This function automatically stores stations
with adequate reception under the presets.
The search starts at the lowest frequency.
COMAND Online stores any stations found,
beginning with preset 1. The storing process
ends once the highest frequency has been
reached or once 10 stations have been found.
Any stations stored manually under the presets will be lost. COMAND Online may not
occupy all memory slots when storing.
Audio
Option 2: select Presets by sliding VÆ
and turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
X Select Autostore and press W to confirm.
In both cases, COMAND Online searches
for stations that can be received. You will
see a message to this effect. The available
stations are automatically stored in the preset positions.
X
X
To cancel storing: select Cancel and
press W to confirm.
Radio Data System (RDS)
General notes
The Radio Data System (RDS) provides inaudible additional information in the FM waveband. The system consists of a listening
receiver and a monitoring receiver.
The monitoring receiver permanently scans
the FM waveband and collects certain data
from all receivable stations. This includes, for
instance, reception quality and RDS data
such as programme names and alternative
frequencies. COMAND Online stores the data
and constantly updates the memory. The
audio receiver is therefore able to switch
automatically to an alternative frequency with
a better signal.
i RDS only functions for stations which
transmit RDS data.
Switching RDS on/off
You can use the Frequency fix (radio mode) or
Station fix (DAB mode) functions to prevent
COMAND Online from switching between the
alternative frequencies of a station. This is
useful, for example, when the same content is
broadcast with a time delay, or when there is
interference on one of the frequencies.
X Select Radio in the radio display by sliding
VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X
Select Frequency fix or Station fix by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
Depending on the previous status, switch
Frequency fix on O or off ª.
Traffic Programme
Note
Many FM stations transmit traffic announcements (TA). You can also hear these in DAB
radio mode.
Switching traffic announcements on/off
X Option 1: select Radio by sliding VÆ and
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
The tick next to TA indicates that traffic
announcement reception is switched on.
You see the TA symbol in the status bar.
X Select TA and press W to confirm.
TA is switched on or off, depending on the
previous status.
X Option 2: on COMAND Online or on the
multifunction steering wheel, press and
hold the 8 button until the TA icon lights
up or goes out in the status bar.
A warning tone sounds.
Once traffic announcements have been
switched on, COMAND Online selects an RDS
station.
Traffic Programme is retrieved from:
Rthe
currently selected FM station
RDS station from the network of the
currently selected FM station
Rthe RDS station with the best reception
quality
When traffic announcements are switched
on, a traffic announcement will interrupt the
Ran
Z
COMAND Online
Option 1: press W the COMAND controller
when the display/selection window is
active.
X Select Autostore in the presets by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
X
467
Audio
468
audio signal from the currently activated
audio or video source.
i Telephone conversations and navigation
announcements are not interrupted.
A display message appears in the display in all
audio operating modes.
Interrupting a traffic announcement
During a traffic announcement:
COMAND Online
X
To show/hide the artist and track:
select Radio in the radio display by sliding
VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Display artist and track and
press W to confirm.
Switch the display on O or off ª.
X
X
On COMAND Online or on the multifunction
steering wheel, briefly press the 8 button.
or
X
To display radio text: select Info in the
corresponding radio display by sliding VÆ
and turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
If the station supports radio text and information is available, the system displays it.
Press the 9, : or 9 button on the
multifunction steering wheel.
COMAND Online switches back to the
audio source that was selected before the
announcement. Any subsequent new
announcements will continue to interrupt
the audio source.
Radio text/radio text plus
Messages in the display
The function is available in FM mode and in
DAB radio mode.
Radio text/radio text plus consists of additionally transmitted data, e.g. information on
the current programme, which is displayed in
the COMAND display.
If the station supports radio text plus, the
artist and track are displayed.
Radio text plus (display: artist and track)
Radio text (display for additional information on
programme)
To return to the radio display: confirm
Info by pressing W.
X Slide ZV the COMAND controller up.
X
Audio CD/DVD and MP3 mode
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The CD/DVD drive is a class 1 laser product.
If you open the housing of the CD/DVD drive,
invisible laser beams may be released. These
laser beams may damage your retina. There is
a risk of injury.
You must not open the casing. Always have
maintenance work and repairs carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Audio
Handling discs while driving will distract you
from traffic conditions. You could then lose
control of the vehicle. There is a risk of an
accident.
Handle discs only when the vehicle is stationary.
Bear in mind that, at a speed of only 50 km/h,
your vehicle is already covering a distance of
14 m per second.
G WARNING
SD memory cards are small parts. They can be
swallowed and cause asphyxiation. This
poses an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
Keep SD memory cards out of the reach of
children. If an SD memory card is swallowed,
seek immediate medical attention.
Ejecting a disc from the single DVD drive
X Press the 8 button.
X Take the disc out of the slot.
If you do not take the disc out of the slot, it
is drawn in again automatically after a short
while and reloaded.
Inserting discs into the DVD changer
The DVD changer has a fixed magazine with
six trays.
X To insert a CD/DVD into the magazine
tray: press the V button.
A menu shows the current load status of
the magazine trays. The last tray selected is
identified by a red digit.
Inserting/ejecting CDs/DVDs
Notes
If the CD/DVD has a printed side, this must
face upwards when the CD/DVD is inserted.
If neither side is printed, the side to be played
should face downwards. CDs/DVDs with
copy protection may not be able to be played
by the system.
i If a medium contains other files in addi-
tion to music files, the loading time before
the first track starts to play may be longer.
Inserting a disc into the single DVD drive
Press the 8 button.
If there is a disc already inserted, it will be
ejected.
X Take the disc out of the slot.
X Insert a disc into the slot.
The disc is drawn in and playback starts if
the disc has been inserted correctly and it
is a permissible type.
X
X
Select a magazine tray to be filled by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
or
X
Press a number key, e.g. j.
The DVD changer switches to the selected
magazine tray. You see the Please
wait... message.
You then see the Please insert disc
message.
Z
COMAND Online
G WARNING
469
Audio
470
To load the empty magazine trays: press
the V button.
The magazine menu appears.
X Select Fill Empty Slots.
Slots
You see the Please wait... message.
COMAND Online switches to the next free
magazine tray. You then see the Please
insert disc message.
i Do not insert a disc into the magazine tray
until you have seen this prompt.
X Insert a disc into the disc slot with the printed side facing upwards.
You see the Please wait... message.
Once the disc is loaded, the DVD changer
switches to the next empty tray. You see
the Please insert disc message.
X Repeat this step until all trays are loaded.
The DVD changer plays the last disc you
loaded if it has been inserted correctly and
it is a permissible type.
COMAND Online
X
X
Insert a disc into the disc slot with the printed side facing upwards.
The DVD changer loads the disc into the
selected magazine tray. The Loading
disc ... message appears.
i It may take some time for the disc to be
loaded, depending on the type of disc. If no
disc is inserted for approximately 20 seconds, the display returns to the magazine
menu.
The DVD changer plays the disc if:
Rit
Rit
has been inserted correctly
is a permissible type of disc
: Full magazine tray (eject function is avail-
able)
; Empty magazine tray (disc can be inser-
ted)
X
To exit the menu: press the V or %
button again.
or
X
Select Back by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
To cancel the loading process: press the
V or % button again.
i If you cancel loading with the % back
button, the system loads and plays the last
CD you inserted.
X
Ejecting discs from the DVD changer
If you remove one disc while playing another
disc, the DVD changer interrupts playback.
Playback continues once the disc has been
ejected.
X To eject a single CD/DVD: press the V
button.
The magazine menu appears. The magazine
tray with the current disc is highlighted.
:
;
=
?
X
Eject possible
Data medium type
Disc name (only if stored on the disc)
Current disc
Select a magazine tray containing a disc by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
or
X
Press a number key, e.g. j.
You see the message: Ejecting disc
.... You then see the following mes...
sage.
X
To eject all CDs/DVDs: press the V
button.
The magazine menu appears.
Select Eject all by sliding ÆV and turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
The DVD changer ejects the last disc selected. You see the Ejecting disc ...
message.
X Take the disc out of the disc slot when you
see the Please remove disc . message.
The DVD changer switches to the next loaded magazine tray and ejects the disc.
X Repeat the last step until the magazine is
empty.
X
X
To exit the menu: press the V or %
button again.
or
X
X
Take the disc out of the slot.
If you do not take the disc out of the slot,
COMAND Online will draw it in automatically after a short while and load it again.
Select Back by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
Inserting and removing an SD memory
card
General notes
COMAND Online supports SD memory cards
(Secure Digital), SDHC memory cards
(Secure Digital High Capacity) and SDXC
memory cards (Secure Digital eXtended
Capacity.
Z
471
COMAND Online
Audio
472
Audio
The first 100 MP3 tracks are loaded. The
first MP3 track is then played. An hourglass
symbol indicates that further tracks are
being loaded in the background.
COMAND Online
i Not all memory cards available on the
market are designed for the temperatures
which may be reached in the vehicle.
If the SD memory card is no longer in use,
you should remove it from
COMAND Online. High temperatures can
damage the card.
Due to the wide range of SD memory cards
available on the market, playback cannot
be guaranteed for all brands of SD memory
card.
The readable storage capacity depends on
the memory card used. You can obtain further information at any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Inserting an SD memory card
X Insert the memory card into the slot on the
control panel until it engages in place. The
side with the contacts must face downwards and point towards the slot.
If no MP3 tracks can be found, you will see
a message to this effect.
The first 100 MP3 tracks are loaded. The
first MP3 track is then played. An hourglass
symbol indicates that further tracks are
being loaded in the background.
Ejecting an SD memory card
X Press the memory card.
The memory card is ejected.
X Remove the memory card from the slot.
Connecting a USB device
The USB port is located in the stowage compartment in the centre console.
Electrical consumption at this connection
must not exceed a continuous current of
500 mA. If the electrical consumption is
higher, use a separate source to provide
power for the USB device (e.g.
12 V power supply).
X Connect the USB device (e.g. USB stick) to
the USB port.
If no MP3 tracks can be found, you will see
a message to this effect.
i Due to the wide range of USB devices
available on the market, playback cannot
be guaranteed for all brands of USB device.
Information about suitable USB devices
can be obtained from a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
MP3 players must support Media Transfer
Protocol (MTP). The MTP mode must be
active.
Switching to audio CD/audio DVD or
MP3 mode
Inserting or connecting a data medium
Insert CDs/DVDs (Y page 469)
or
X Inserting an SD memory card
(Y page 472)
or
X Connect a USB device (Y page 472).
COMAND loads the medium inserted and
starts to play it.
X
Switching on using the button
X Press the h function button one or more
times.
By pressing the function button repeatedly,
you can change the operating mode in the
following order:
Raudio CD/DVD/video DVD/MP3 CD/MP3
DVD in the DVD changer or single DVD
drive (disc mode)
Rmemory card mode
RMUSIC REGISTER
RUSB memory
RMedia Interface or audio AUX mode
Roperation with Bluetooth® audio
X Select an audio medium from the media list
(Y page 474).
Audio
X
Select Audio by sliding Z V and turning
c V d the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The audio menu appears.
X
Select Disc
Disc, Memory card
card, Music Regis‐
ter, USB storage or Media Interface
ter
and press W to confirm.
This switches to the desired audio source.
X
Select an audio medium from the media list
(Y page 474).
Example display: audio DVD mode
Cover (if available)
Track time
Track number
Graphic time and track display
Disc type, disc position in the media list,
disc name (only if stored on the disc)
B Audio DVD mode menu
:
;
=
?
A
Example display: audio CD mode
Example display: MP3 mode
: CD cover (if available)
; Gracenote data found, then the elapsed
Cover (if available)
Track time
Track number and name
Graphic time and track display
Medium type, position of medium in the
media list, current folder or current album
B Artist (if available)
C MP3 mode menu
track time
= Track number and track name (if stored
?
A
B
C
on the disc as CD text or if Gracenote®
data is available)
Graphic time and track display
Disc type, disc position in the media list
and disc name (if stored on the disc as CD
text or if Gracenote® data is available)
Artist (if stored on the disc as CD text or if
Gracenote® data is available)
CD mode menu
:
;
=
?
A
i If no Media Interface is connected during
operation with a DVD changer, C displays
Changer instead of Media (Y page 494).
Z
COMAND Online
Switching on with the audio menu
X Select Audio in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
The last active audio source is now activated.
You can activate a different audio source
using the audio menu.
473
Audio
COMAND Online
474
Pause function
X
In CD/audio DVD and MP3 mode
X To pause playback: briefly press the 8
button.
The , symbol appears at the top left in
the status bar.
X To continue playback: briefly press the
8 button again.
The , symbol disappears.
Selecting CD/audio DVD/MP3 discs
Only in audio DVD mode
To pause playback: switch on audio DVD
mode (Y page 472).
X Select Ë by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The Ë symbol changes to Ì.
X To continue playback: select Ì and
press W to confirm.
Playback continues from the point where it
was interrupted. The Ì symbol changes
to Ë.
To restart playback: select Ì and
press W to confirm.
Playback starts at the beginning of the
DVD.
Selecting via the media list
X
Media list when equipped with a DVD changer
X
Stop function
This function is only available in audio DVD
mode.
Switch on audio DVD mode (Y page 472).
To interrupt playback: select É by
sliding VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
The Ë symbol changes to Ì. The
É symbol remains highlighted.
X To continue playback: select Ì and
press W to confirm.
Playback continues from the point where it
was interrupted.
X
X
X
To stop playback: while playback is interrupted, select É again and press W to
confirm.
or
X
Select É and confirm by pressing W
twice in rapid succession.
Ì is highlighted.
In CD/audio DVD and MP3 mode: select
Media or Changer by sliding VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
In CD/audio DVD and MP3 mode: select
Media by sliding VÆ or turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The media list appears. The # dot indicates
the current medium being played.
The media list shows the discs currently
available.
View in ::
RG
magazine tray not shown
RI magazine tray shown
To switch the display: select 1...6
Changer by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
Depending on the previous setting, the
magazine trays are shown or not shown.
i If a disc cannot be read, an entry appears
next to the corresponding magazine tray.
X
Audio
475
i If you select a video DVD, the system
switches to video DVD mode (Y page 511).
Selecting a track using the number keypad
X When the display/selection window is
active, press a number key, e.g. n.
The medium at the corresponding position
in the media list is loaded and then played.
X
Select the data medium by turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
The following tables list the selection options
in the media list for the respective equipment
variants.
For DVD changer
Magazine trays, positions 1 to 6: readable
data media are audio CDs, MP3 CDs or MP3
DVDs, audio DVDs and video DVDs
Memory card, position 7
MUSIC REGISTER, position 8
USB storage device, position 9
Media Interface, position 0
Bluetooth® audio
For a single DVD drive
DVD drive, position 1: readable data media
are audio CDs, MP3 CDs or MP3 DVDs,
audio DVDs and video DVDs
Memory card, position 2
MUSIC REGISTER, position 3
USB storage device, position 4
Media Interface, position 5
Bluetooth® audio, position 6
Selecting a track
Selecting by skipping to a track
To skip forwards or back to a track: turn
cVd the COMAND controller when the display/selection window is active.
or
X Press the E or F button.
The skip forward function skips to the next
track.
The skip back function skips to the beginning of the current track if the track has
been playing for more than 8 seconds. If the
track has been playing for less than 8 seconds, it skips to the start of the previous
track.
If the Random tracks or Random Folder
playback option has been selected, the
track order is random.
X
X
Make a selection on the multifunction
steering wheel and view in the multifunction display (see the separate vehicle Owner's Manual).
Selecting a track using the number keypad
X Press the ¯ key on the number keypad.
A numerical entry field appears. The number of positions offered corresponds to the
number of tracks on the CD/DVD. Only
numbers that correspond to a track number on the CD/DVD can be entered.
X Enter the desired track number using the
number keys.
Playback commences immediately after
the last possible track digit is entered.
Z
COMAND Online
Media list showing all magazine trays
Audio
476
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The category list appears.
i Pressing and holding a number key for
more than 2 seconds completes the entry
and the corresponding track is played.
COMAND Online
Selecting a track using music search
Example: current track list
X
Select Current tracklist,
tracklist Folder or a
category and press W to confirm.
Select music via categories (e.g. albums,
artists etc.) with the music search function.
If you select a category, COMAND Online
starts a search for track information if the following conditions are fulfilled:
Rthe data carriers are inserted or connected.
track information from these data carriers is not yet contained in the COMAND
music database.
COMAND Online imports track information
from the following data carriers:
X
Fast forward/rewind
X
Rthe
Rdisc
(audio CD/DVD/MP3)
card
RMUSIC REGISTER
RUSB memory
The Track information is complete
message appears once the search is completed. COMAND Online stores the music data in
its own database. You can now select the
available music data within the desired category.
You will find further information on searching
for music in the "Music search" section
(Y page 481).
X In audio CD/audio DVD mode/MP3 mode,
select Search by sliding VÆ and turning
Rmemory
Select the track by turning c V d the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The basic display appears and the track is
played.
While the display/selection window is
active, slide X V Y and hold the COMAND
controller until the desired position has
been reached.
or
X
Press and hold the E or F button
until the desired position is reached.
Gracenote Media Database
Introduction
This function is only available in audio CD
mode.
There is a version of Gracenote®music recognition technology on the COMAND Online
hard drive. You will recognise this by the logo
Audio
Database menu item is shown in grey and
cannot be selected.
X Select an entry by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Switching the Gracenote® data display
on/off
X Switch on audio CD mode (Y page 472).
X Select CD by sliding VÆ and turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X Select Gracenote Media Database by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
X
To switch off the display: select None and
press W to confirm.
In the basic display, Track 1,
1 Track 2 etc.
are shown instead of the Gracenote® data,
for example (Y page 473).
X
To switch on the display: select an entry
in the menu by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
Selecting Gracenote® data to be displayed
Switch on audio CD mode (Y page 472).
Select CD by sliding VÆ and turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X Select Gracenote Media Database by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
A menu appears.
The # dot indicates the current selection
for the display.
X
X
If several entries exist for the CD of a particular artist, you can select which of the entries
should be shown.
If the inserted CD does not contain any
Gracenote® data, the Gracenote Media
Updating Gracenote® music recognition
technology and the Gracenote Media
Database
Due to the release of new CDs, the digital data
on the Gracenote Media Database must be
updated. Optimum functionality can only be
attained with up-to-date Gracenote® music
recognition technology. Information about
new versions can be obtained from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
You can have your music recognition software updated there with a DVD, or you can
update it yourself.
i The Gracenote Media Database is upda-
ted in conjunction with the navigation system's digital map (Y page 382).
Z
COMAND Online
in the bottom right-hand corner of certain
audio displays.
Many audio CDs contain CD text.
COMAND Online uses the information contained therein to display the artist, album and
track name.
If the audio CD does not contain any CD text
information, COMAND Online can use the
Gracenote® Media Database to identify
unknown audio tracks when in audio CD
mode. This is only possible if the relevant
information is saved in the Gracenote Media
Database and if the Gracenote Media Database function is activated.
If this is the case, COMAND Online will display
the corresponding data such as artist, album
and track name in the relevant displays and
lists.
477
Audio
478
Displaying the track and album
X
Press the z button.
The current track and album are displayed
in a window.
COMAND Online
Displaying metadata (MP3 mode)
COMAND Online can also display the album
name and artist (metadata) during playback if
this information has been entered into the
system.
For all media that contain MP3 data (e.g. MP3
CD, SD memory card, MUSIC REGISTER), you
can determine whether:
Rthe
metadata contained in the tags of the
encoded music data should be displayed
Rthe file and directory names should be displayed during playback
X To display the album and artist name:
select MP3 or USB in the basic display by
sliding VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Display track Information and
press W to confirm.
Selecting a group (DVD audio)
The content of an audio DVD can be divided
into up to nine groups. The availability and
type of group depends on the respective DVD.
A group can contain music in different sound
qualities (stereo and multichannel formats,
for example), or bonus tracks.
Each group can contain up to 99 tracks.
If an audio DVD only contains one audio format, the Group menu item(s) cannot be selected.
X Switch on audio DVD mode (Y page 472).
X Select DVD-A by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
X Select Group by turning cVd and press W
to confirm.
The # dot indicates the group currently
selected.
Select the desired group by turning cVd
and press W to confirm.
X To exit the menu: slide XVY the COMAND
controller or press the % back button.
X
Selecting an active partition (USB mass
storage devices only)
You can select this function for USB mass
storage devices when the storage device is
partitioned. Up to 5 partitions (primary or logical, FAT, FAT32 and NTFS) are supported.
X Select MP3 in the basic display by sliding
VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Select active partition and
press W to confirm.
Playback options
To select options: switch on audio
CD/DVD or MP3 mode (Y page 472).
X Select CD
CD, DVD-A or MP3 by sliding VÆ and
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
The options list appears. The # dot indicates the option selected.
X Select an option by turning cVd and press
W to confirm.
The option is switched on. For all options
except Normal track sequence,
sequence you will
see a corresponding display in the display/
selection window.
The following options are available to you:
X
RNormal
track sequence
The tracks are played in the normal order
(e.g. track 1, 2, 3 etc.).
In MP3 mode, the track order is determined
by the order in which the tracks are written
to the MP3 data carrier when it is created.
Alphabetical order is the most common.
Once all the tracks in a folder have been
played, the tracks in the next folder are
played.
RRandom media
Audio
All the tracks on the medium are played in
random order (e.g. track 3, 8, 5 etc.).
RRandom track list (MP3 mode only)
You will hear the tracks in the current playlist or currently active folder (including all
subfolders) in random order.
The disc may contain no more than eight
directory levels. Files beyond the eighth level
will not be recognised by the system.
i The Normal track sequence option is
Track and file names
When you create a disc with compressed
music files, you can assign names to the
tracks and folders.
COMAND Online uses these names accordingly for the display. Folders that contain data
other than MP3 or WMA tracks are not displayed by COMAND Online.
If MP3 or WMA files are stored in the root
directory itself, the root directory will also be
treated as a folder. COMAND Online will then
show the name of the root directory as the
folder name.
You should observe the following when
assigning track names:
Notes on MP3 mode
General notes
Depending on the volume and format of the
MP3 data, the length of time required for
reading the data may increase.
Permissible data carriers
RCD-R and CD-RW
RDVD-R and DVD-RW
RDVD+R and DVD+RW
RSD memory card
RUSB storage device
Permissible file systems
RISO 9660/Joliet standard for CDs
RUDF for audio and video DVDs
RFAT16, FAT32 and NTFS for SD memory
card and USB storage media
Multi-session CDs
For multi-session CDs, the content of the first
session determines how COMAND Online will
process the CD. COMAND Online plays only
one session and gives priority to the audio CD
session.
If possible, only play CDs on COMAND Online
that have been written in one session.
File structure of a disc
When you create a disc with compressed
music files, the tracks can be organised in
folders. A folder may also contain subfolders.
i COMAND Online loads up to 15,000
tracks from the SD memory card or USB
storage medium.
Rtrack
names must have at least one character.
Rtrack names must have the extension
"mp3" or "wma".
Rthere must be a full stop between the track
name and the extension.
Example of a correct track name:
"Track1.mp3".
Permissible formats
COMAND supports the following formats:
RMPEG1
Audio Layer 3 (MP3)
RMicrosoft Windows Media Audio V8 and V9
(WMA) without copy protection
Microsoft Windows Media Audio V2, V7, V8
and V9 (WMA)
Radditional music files in AAC format with
the file extensions .aac, .mp4, .m4a
and .m4b, but not copy-protected iTunes
music files with the extension .m4p.
i If, in addition to MP3 files, there are other
music files in these audio formats stored on
Z
COMAND Online
automatically selected when you change
the disc you are currently listening to or
when you select a different medium. If an
option is selected, it remains selected after
COMAND Online is switched on or off.
479
480
Audio
the disc, the loading process may require a
longer time before the first track is played.
copyright holder has granted you permission,
these restrictions do not apply.
i The MP3 audio encoding method is under
Notes on CDs/DVDs
! COMAND Online is designed to play discs
which comply with the EN 60908 standard.
Therefore, you can only use discs with a
maximum thickness of 1.3 mm.
If you insert thicker discs, e.g. those that
contain data on both sides (DVD on one
side and audio data on the other), they cannot be ejected and can damage the device.
Only use round discs with a diameter of
12 cm. Do not use discs with a diameter of
8 cm, even with an adapter.
licence from Fraunhofer IIS (Institut Integrierte Schaltungen – Institute for Integrated
Circuits) and Thomson.
COMAND Online
Permissible bit and sampling rates
COMAND supports MP3 files of the following
types:
Rfixed
and variable bit rates from 32 kbit/s
to 320 kbit/s
Rsampling rates of 8 kHz to 48 kHz
COMAND Online supports WMA files of the
following types:
Rfixed
bit rates from 5 kbit/s to 384 kbit/s
Rsampling rates of 8 kHz to 48 kHz
COMAND Online does not support WMA files
of the following types:
RDRM
(Digital Rights Management) encrypted files
Rvariable bit rate
RWMA Pro
R5.1 Surround
i Only use tracks with a bit rate of at least
128 kbit/s and a sampling rate of at least
44.1 kHz. Lower rates may cause a noticeable deterioration in quality. This is especially the case if you have activated a surround sound function.
Notes on copyright
MP3 or WMA tracks that you create or play
back are generally subject to copyright protection in accordance with the applicable
international and national regulations.
In many countries, reproductions, even for
private use, are not permitted without the
prior consent of the copyright holder.
Make sure that you know about the applicable
copyright regulations and that you comply
with these.
If you own these rights yourself, e.g. for your
own compositions and recordings, or if the
Discs with copy protection are not compatible with the CD standard and therefore may
not be able to be played by COMAND Online.
You may encounter playback problems when
playing copied discs. There is a wide range of
data carriers, disc-writing software and writers available. This variety means that there is
no guarantee that the system will be able to
play discs that you have copied yourself.
There may be playback problems if you play
CDs that you have copied yourself with a storage capacity of more than 700 MB. CDs of
this type do not conform to the currently
applicable standards.
i On many DVD audio discs, the last track
does not contain any music. If
COMAND Online therefore switches to the
next disc, it is normal system behaviour and
does not mean that there is a malfunction.
i COMAND Online is able to play back
audio CDs in multichannel audio format.
Audio
481
Music search
X
Category list
Switch on an audio source and call up the
basic display, e.g. MP3 mode (Y page 472).
X Select Search by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The category list appears.
X
The categories are displayed according to the
data available. The categories Current
tracklist, Folder
tracklist
Folder, Playlists (if available)
and Photos (if available) are already
assigned. The other available categories are
filled by the music search.
Selecting a category
Starting a music search
Select music via categories (e.g. albums,
artists etc.) with the music search function.
If you select a category, COMAND Online
starts a music search under the following
conditions:
Select a category in the category list by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
The Reading data... message appears.
The search may take some time, depending
on the number of tracks available.
The Track information is complete
message appears once the search is completed. Playback then starts with the previously
active audio source.
X To cancel the music search: confirm
Cancel by pressing W.
Selecting artists
X Select Artists in the category list by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
The available artists are displayed alphabetically.
Selecting an album
Rthe data carriers are inserted or connected.
Rthe music tracks on these data carriers are
not yet in the COMAND music database.
COMAND Online reads music tracks from the
following data carriers:
Rdisc
(audio CD/DVD/MP3)
card
RMUSIC REGISTER
RUSB storage device
Rmemory
Z
COMAND Online
Calling up the category list
Audio
482
X
Select Albums in the category list by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
The available albums are displayed alphabetically. If there is a cover available for an
album, it is displayed in front of the album
name.
COMAND Online
Selecting a track
X
Select Tracks in the category list
(Y page 481) by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
The available tracks are displayed.
Selecting composers
X Select Composers in the category list by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
The available composers are displayed
alphabetically.
Selecting music genres
X Select Genres in the category list by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
The available music genres are displayed
alphabetically.
Selecting a cover
X Select Select by cover in the category
list (Y page 481) by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The available covers are displayed in alphabetical order of the artists.
Selecting a year of publication
X
Select Year in the category list
(Y page 481) by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X Select an entry and press W to confirm.
The genre list is displayed.
X Select a genre, e.g. pop, and press W to
confirm.
The track list is displayed.
X Select a track and press W to confirm.
Playback starts.
X
Select the desired cover by turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
The corresponding album is played.
Selecting via keyword search
X Select Keyword search in the category list
by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
An input menu appears.
X
To change the character set used in the
character bar: highlight Select by sliding
VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
A list of available character sets is shown.
X
Select an entry, e.g. Artists
Artists, and press W
to confirm.
The album and cover (if available) are displayed.
X
Confirm the album with W.
The tracks on the album are displayed.
X
Select a track and press W to confirm.
Playback starts and the basic display
appears.
Select the desired character set and press
W to confirm.
X Enter characters and confirm the entry.
Character entry (Y page 303).
Depending on the entry, the hits are shown
in a list.
X
X
Select an entry by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Z
483
COMAND Online
Audio
484
Audio
MUSIC REGISTER
General notes
! Retain the original music files in a secure
COMAND Online
location. An error in COMAND Online might
result in the loss of the music files stored in
the MUSIC REGISTER. Mercedes-Benz is
not liable for any loss of data.
You can store music files in a compressed
format in the MUSIC REGISTER (Y page 485).
The memory has a capacity of 10 GB.
Switching to the MUSIC REGISTER
MUSIC REGISTER basic display
Switching on with the function button
X Press the h function button repeatedly
until the MUSIC REGISTER is switched on.
By pressing the function button repeatedly,
you can change the operating mode in the
following order:
Raudio
CD/DVD/MP3 (disc)
card mode
RMUSIC REGISTER
RUSB memory
RMedia Interface or audio AUX mode
Roperation with Bluetooth® audio
If music files are available, playback begins at
the point last listened to.
If there are no music files, you will see a message to this effect.
X Confirm the message by pressing W the
COMAND controller and then copy the
music files to the MUSIC REGISTER
(Y page 485).
Rmemory
Switching on with the audio menu
Select Audio in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
If the MUSIC REGISTER was the last mode
selected, it is now switched on.
If another audio source is switched on, you
can now switch on the MUSIC REGISTER in
the audio menu.
X
Example: MUSIC REGISTER
: Cover (if available)
; Track time
= Track number and name
? Graphic time and track display
A Position of the medium in the media list
and name of the medium, followed by the
current playback option (no display for
Normal track sequence)
sequence
B Artist
C MUSIC REGISTER menu bar
X
Select Audio by sliding Z V and turning
c V d the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The audio menu appears.
X
Select Music Register and press W to
confirm.
Switching on using the number keys
X Make sure that neither radio nor disc is
activated.
X Press the r (for a DVD changer) or m
(for a single DVD drive) number key.
The MUSIC REGISTER is switched on.
Audio
485
Copying music data to the MUSIC REGISTER
Introduction
You can copy music files in the file formats
MP3, WMA and AAC (with the file extensions .m4p, .m4a, .m4b and .aac) from the
following media:
in a DVD changer or a single DVD
drive
RMemory card
RUSB memory
i While copying, several functions will not
be available. If this is the case, you will see
a message to this effect.
1. Selecting a data medium
X Switch to the MUSIC REGISTER
(Y page 484).
X Select Music Register by sliding VÆ and
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
X
Select Copy MP3 music files and press
W to confirm.
The media list appears. A data medium
from which files can be copied is selected
automatically.
2. Selecting music files
To select all music files: select All
tracks and press W the COMAND controller to confirm.
This function copies all music files on the
selected data carrier. The icon in front of
All tracks is filled in and all following
entries have a tick O beside them.
X
X
To select a folder: turn cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
A tick O next to the folder entry highlights
the selection.
3. Confirming your selection
X Select Continue by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The copying menu appears.
4. Starting the copying process
! Under no circumstances should you
remove the medium while you are copying
data from it (SD memory card, USB storage
device, CD/DVD). Doing so will generate
unusable data in the MUSIC REGISTER.
X
Select the data medium by turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
The data medium is loaded.
If the data carrier contains music files that
can be copied, you see a menu.
Z
COMAND Online
Rdiscs
Audio
486
In the example, music files are copied from
the memory card to the MUSIC REGISTER.
X To select a destination folder: select
Destination folder by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Folder and press W to confirm.
The folder is selected O.
X Select Continue and press W to confirm.
Confirm Start by pressing W.
Copying begins. The progress bar indicates
the status of the copying procedure.
i It may take some time for the copying
process to be completed, depending on the
amount of data. If there is not enough memory space, you will see a message to this
effect.
Once copying is complete, you hear the first
track of the copied album. The MUSIC REGISTER display appears. Now you can copy
more music files to the MUSIC REGISTER.
X To cancel the copying process: select
Cancel and press W to confirm.
Music files are stored in the MUSIC REGISTER up until the point of cancellation.
COMAND Online
X
Deleting all music files
! In order to prevent malfunctions, do not
use COMAND Online during this time.
This function deletes all music files from the
MUSIC REGISTER.
X Switch to the MUSIC REGISTER
(Y page 484).
X Select Music Register by sliding VÆ and
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
X
Select Delete all music files and
press W to confirm.
A query appears. No is highlighted.
If you select Yes
Yes, all music files are deleted.
You see the Please wait... message.
You will then see the Data deleted message.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
Calling up memory space information
Switch to the MUSIC REGISTER
(Y page 484).
X Select Music Register by sliding VÆ and
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
X Select Memory info and press W to confirm.
The following is displayed:
Rstorage capacity
Ravailable memory
Roccupied memory
Rcontent (folders, tracks)
X
Music search
Introduction
The music search finds tracks via all available
media. The search begins with the audio
source that is currently active.
The music search covers the following media:
Rdisc
(audio CD/DVD/MP3)
card
RMUSIC REGISTER
RUSB memory
X Switch to the MUSIC REGISTER
(Y page 484).
X Select Search by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The category list appears.
X Select a track in a category (Y page 481).
Rmemory
Example: opening a folder
X Select Folder in the category list by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
You see the contents of the current folder.
Audio
487
Select Options by sliding VY and press W
to confirm.
X Select Delete and press W to confirm.
A query appears. No is highlighted.
If you select Yes
Yes, the folders/tracks are
deleted. You see the Please wait...
message. You will then see the Data
deleted message.
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
The name of the current folder is at the top
and the track currently playing is indicated by
a # dot.
X To switch to the next folder up: press the
% back button or slide XV the
COMAND controller.
Changing the folder/track name
X Switch to the MUSIC REGISTER
(Y page 484).
X Select Music Register by sliding VÆ and
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
X Select Rename / delete files and press
W to confirm.
X Select a folder/track by turning cVd.
X Select Options by sliding VY and press W
to confirm.
X Select Change and press W to confirm.
X Enter a name for the folder/track
(Y page 303).
X To save the changes: select ¬ and
press W to confirm.
Deleting folders/tracks
Switch to the MUSIC REGISTER
(Y page 484).
X Select Music Register by sliding VÆ and
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
X Select Rename / delete files and press
W to confirm.
X Select a folder/track by turning cVd.
X
Playback options
The following options are available:
RNormal
track sequence
The tracks are played in the normal order
(e.g. track 1, 2, 3 etc.).
RRandom media
All the tracks on the medium are played in
random order.
RRandom track list (MP3 mode only)
The tracks in the currently active folder or
the current track list are played in a random
order.
X To select options: switch to the MUSIC
REGISTER (Y page 484).
X Select Music Register by sliding VÆ and
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
The options list appears. The # dot indicates the option selected.
X Select an option and press W to confirm.
The option is switched on. For all options
except Normal track sequence,
sequence you will
see a corresponding display in the display/
selection window.
i The Normal track sequence option is
automatically selected when you change
the disc you are currently listening to or
when you select a different medium. If an
option is selected, it remains selected after
COMAND Online is switched on or off.
Z
COMAND Online
X
488
Audio
Operation with Bluetooth® audio
COMAND Online
Preconditions for the Bluetooth® audio
device
Bluetooth® audio mode requires a Bluetooth®-capable audio device. Observe the
information in the Bluetooth® audio device's
operating instructions.
Before using Bluetooth® audio mode, you
should check your Bluetooth® audio device
for the following:
RBluetooth®
audio profile
The Bluetooth® audio device must support
the A2DP and AVRCP Bluetooth® audio
profiles.
RBluetooth® visibility
Certain Bluetooth® audio devices require
more than simply activating the Bluetooth®
function. In addition, your device must be
made "visible" to other devices.
RBluetooth® device name
This device name is predetermined but can
usually be changed. To make a clear selection of the Bluetooth® device possible,
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you customise the device name.
i A2DP (Advanced Audio Distribution
Profile): Bluetooth® audio profile for audio
data transmission
AVRCP (Audio Video Remote Control
Profile): Bluetooth® audio profile for audio
data playback
i Not all Bluetooth® audio devices available
on the market are equally suitable.
Information on suitable Bluetooth® audio
devices and on connecting Bluetooth®
audio devices to COMAND Online:
Ris
available from your Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre
Ror visit the website http://
www.mercedes-benz.com/connect
X
Activate Bluetooth® and Bluetooth® visibility on the Bluetooth® audio device.
Preconditions in COMAND Online
X
Activate the Bluetooth® function in
COMAND Online (Y page 313).
Connecting Bluetooth® audio devices
General notes
Before using your Bluetooth® audio device
with COMAND Online for the first time, you
will need to authorise it.
When you authorise a new Bluetooth® audio
device, it is connected automatically. Connection involves first searching for a Bluetooth® audio device and then authorising it.
You can authorise up to fifteen Bluetooth®
devices.
i If you authorise a mobile phone that supports Bluetooth® audio, the A2DP and
AVRCP Bluetooth® audio profiles are connected automatically.
The mobile phone is then entered:
the Bluetooth® telephone list
(Y page 391)
Rin the Bluetooth® device list
(Y page 489)
Mercedes-Benz recommends authorising a
mobile phone in Bluetooth® telephony
(Y page 391).
Rin
Audio
Example: Bluetooth® device list
: Newly detected mobile phone with Blue-
tooth® audio function in range
; Bluetooth® audio player not within range
but previously authorised (symbol
appears in grey)
The Bluetooth® device list displays all authorised devices, whether they are within range or
not. After a device search, devices which are
within range but not authorised are also displayed.
Switch on Bluetooth® audio mode
(Y page 491).
If you see the No Bluetooth audio
device authorised message, you will
need to authorise the Bluetooth® audio
device first.
X Select BT audio by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
X
Confirm Bluetooth audio device list
by pressing W the COMAND controller.
X To search: confirm Search for BT
audio devices by pressing the COMAND
controller W.
COMAND Online searches for Bluetooth®
audio devices within range and adds them
to the Bluetooth® device list. If Bluetooth®
audio devices support the Bluetooth®
audio profiles (A2DP, AVRCP), the devices
are detected.
The duration of the search depends on the
number of Bluetooth® audio devices within
range and their characteristics.
X
To authorise: select an unauthorised Bluetooth® audio device from the list (:
in the example) by turning cVd the
COMAND controller.
X Select the symbol to the right of the Bluetooth® audio device by sliding VY the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Authorise and press W to confirm.
Depending on the Bluetooth® audio device
used, you now have two options for continuing with authorisation.
X Option 1: enter the passkey (Y page 391).
After successful authorisation, the Bluetooth® audio device is connected and
starts playing.
X Option 2 (Secure Simple Pairing): if the
digit codes displayed in COMAND Online
and on the Bluetooth® audio device are the
same, confirm Yes by pressing W.
If you select Yes
Yes, authorisation continues
and the Bluetooth® audio device is connected. Playback starts.
If you select No
No, authorisation will be cancelled.
i The Bluetooth® audio device must support Bluetooth® version 2.1 for connection
via Secure Simple Pairing. COMAND Online
creates a six-digit code, which is simultaneously displayed on both devices that are
to be connected.
X
Z
COMAND Online
Searching for and authorising a Bluetooth® audio device
489
Audio
490
External authorisation
Reconnecting a Bluetooth® audio device
The Bluetooth® audio profiles are connected
automatically under the following circumstances:
COMAND Online
Rone
If COMAND Online does not find your Bluetooth® audio device, this may be due to particular security settings on your Bluetooth®
audio device. In this case, check whether your
Bluetooth® audio device can locate the
COMAND Online system. The Bluetooth®
device name of COMAND Online is MB Blue‐
tooth.
tooth
Switch on Bluetooth® audio mode
(Y page 491).
X Select BT audio by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
X Confirm Bluetooth audio device list
by pressing W the COMAND controller.
X To search: confirm Connect via BT
audio device by pressing the COMAND
controller W.
The duration of the search depends on the
number of Bluetooth® audio devices within
range and their characteristics.
X To authorise: start the authorisation on
the Bluetooth® audio device; see the operating instructions of the Bluetooth® audio
device.
After successful authorisation, the Bluetooth® audio device is connected and
starts playing.
X
i With some Bluetooth® audio devices,
playback must first be started on the device
itself so that COMAND Online can play the
audio files.
of the last two mobile phones to have
been connected has also been used as a
Bluetooth® audio player (if the function is
supported by the mobile phone).
Rthe mobile phone takes over the automatic
connection itself.
A Bluetooth® audio player without telephone
functions is not automatically reconnected,
even if it was the last device connected.
If the No Bluetooth audio device con‐
nected message appears, you have two
options to connect a Bluetooth® audio
device:
Connecting the last device
Confirm Connect last device in the
basic display by pressing W the COMAND
controller.
If COMAND Online can locate the Bluetooth® audio device, it will be connected
and will start playing.
i With some Bluetooth® audio devices,
playback must first be started on the device
itself so that COMAND Online can play the
audio files.
Connecting a device from a list
X
Select BT audio by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Confirm Bluetooth audio device list
by pressing W the COMAND controller.
X Select a Bluetooth® audio device by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
If COMAND Online can locate the Bluetooth® audio device, it will be connected
and will start playing.
i With some Bluetooth® audio devices,
playback must be initially started on the
device itself so that COMAND Online can
play the audio files.
X
Audio
Displaying details
Select a Bluetooth® audio device in the
Bluetooth® device list.
X Select the symbol to the right of the Bluetooth® audio device by sliding VY the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Details and press W to confirm.
The following information concerning the
selected mobile phone is shown:
RBluetooth® name
RBluetooth® address
Ravailability status (shown after an
update)
Rauthorisation status
X To close the detailed view: turn cVd or
slide XVY the COMAND controller.
X
De-authorising (de-registering) a Bluetooth® audio device
Select a Bluetooth® audio device in the
Bluetooth® device list.
X Select the symbol to the right of the Bluetooth® audio device by sliding VY the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select De-authorise and press W to confirm.
A prompt appears, asking whether you
really wish to de-authorise this device.
X Select Yes or No
No.
If you select Yes
Yes, the device will be deleted
from the Bluetooth® device list.
X
If you select No
No, the process will be cancelled.
i Before re-authorising the Bluetooth®
audio device, you should also delete the
device name MB Bluetooth from your
Bluetooth® audio device's Bluetooth® list.
See the Bluetooth® audio device's operating instructions.
Switching to Bluetooth® audio mode
The Bluetooth® audio basic display
COMAND Online
Bluetooth® audio device and simultaneous search for mobile phones
During the search for mobile phones, the connection with the Bluetooth® audio device is
terminated (Y page 390). In the Bluetooth®
audio basic display, you will see the No Blue‐
tooth audio device connected message
and the Connect last device menu item
cannot be selected.
491
Example: Bluetooth® audio basic display
: Track name
; Current playback settings (no symbol for
"Normal track sequence")
Album name
Sound settings
Media list
Artist
To stop É or start Ì playback
To connect a Bluetooth® audio device, to
switch traffic announcements on/off, to
increase the volume on COMAND Online
E Bluetooth® audio data carrier type
F Data carrier position in the media list
=
?
A
B
C
D
i If the Bluetooth® audio device connected
supports metadata and if the corresponding data is available, then the artist, track
and album name can be displayed.
Z
Audio
492
Using the Bluetooth® audio basic display
X
Bluetooth®
Connect
(Y page 488)
audio devices
or
COMAND Online
X
Reconnect the Bluetooth® audio device
(Y page 490).
COMAND Online activates the Bluetooth®
audio device. The basic display appears
and the device starts playing.
X
To continue playback: select Ì by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
A message appears. É is selected.
Restarting playback after stopping
Using the function button
Press the h function button one or more
times.
By pressing the function button repeatedly,
you can change the operating mode in the
following order:
X
Raudio
CD/DVD/MP3 (disc)
card mode
RMUSIC REGISTER
RUSB memory
RMedia Interface or audio AUX mode
Roperation with Bluetooth® audio
Rmemory
Using the media list
X Select Bluetooth audio in the media list
by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm (Y page 474).
COMAND Online activates the connected
device. You will see a message to this
effect. The basic display then appears.
Starting/stopping playback
X
To start playback: select Ì by sliding
VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Playback starts. É is selected.
X
To stop playback: select É by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
A message appears. Ì is selected.
During the search for mobile phones, the connection with the Bluetooth® audio device is
terminated (Y page 390). In the Bluetooth®
audio (Y page 491) basic display, you will see
the No Bluetooth audio device connec‐
ted message and the Connect last device
menu item cannot be selected.
When the search is finished, the Bluetooth®
audio device can be reconnected.
X Confirm Connect last device by pressing W.
Depending on the Bluetooth® audio device
used, playback starts immediately or you
need to start playback manually.
In this case, you will see the Bluetooth
audio device paused message.
Audio
To start playback: select Ì by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
Playback resumes from the beginning.
Selecting a track
The function is not supported by all Bluetooth® audio devices.
X To skip forwards or backwards to a
track: press the E or F button on
COMAND Online.
or
X Press the 9 or : button briefly on
the multifunction steering wheel.
X Rapid scroll: press and hold the 9
or : button on the multifunction steering wheel until the desired track is reached.
If you press and hold the 9 or :
button, the rapid scrolling speed increases
after a short time.
Select BT Audio by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The # dot indicates the option selected.
X Select the option by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
If you select Random tracks
tracks, you will see a
corresponding symbol in the display/
selection window.
X
Increasing the volume on COMAND
Online
COMAND Online
X
Selecting playback options
If the Bluetooth® audio device supports the
corresponding function, the following options
are available:
RNormal
track sequence
The tracks are played in the normal order
(e.g. track 1, 2, 3 etc.).
Audio data playback is determined by the
order in which the tracks are written to the
data carrier. Alphabetical order is the most
common. Once all the tracks in a folder
have been played, the tracks in the next
folder are played.
RRandom tracks
All the tracks on the medium are played in
random order (e.g. track 3, 8, 5 etc.).
493
Select BT Audio by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
X Select Volume and press W to confirm.
A menu appears. The # dot indicates the
current setting.
X Select Standard or Boost and press W to
confirm.
X
Information about sound settings
(Y page 299)
Information about Traffic Programme
(Y page 467)
You will find further information in the "Audio
AUX mode" section (Y page 500)
Z
494
Audio
Media Interface mode
COMAND Online
Connection options
Overview
You will find the connection sockets in the
centre console stowage compartment.
Device-specific adapter cables are required
to connect external devices to the Media
Interface. These are supplied in country-specific versions with the Media Interface
(Y page 494).
You can connect the following data carriers to
COMAND Online via the Media Interface:
Connecting an external device
Do not leave external devices in the vehicle.
At extreme temperatures, they cannot be
guaranteed to function correctly (see the
operating instructions of the device in question). Examples of extreme temperatures are
direct sunlight or very low outside temperatures. Mercedes-Benz accepts no liability for
damage to external devices.
i Never connect more than one device at a
time. You will otherwise not be able to play
back from the external device.
USB hubs (devices with several USB connections) are not supported.
RiPod®
RiPhone®
Rcertain
MP3 players
i Store individual parts in a safe place.
Only use genuine Mercedes-Benz connection cables.
i iPod® and iPhone® are registered trade-
marks of Apple Inc., Cupertino, California,
USA.
i MP3 players that support MTP (Media
Transfer Protocol) can be used.
This allows the MP3 player to be easily connected to the Media Interface and removed
after use. Audio data is played without
problems.
On some MP3 players, you have to activate
the relevant function; see the MP3 player
operating instructions.
Supported devices
For further details and a list of supported
devices, contact a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre or visit the website at http://
www.mercedes-benz-mobile.com/
connect. Then, follow the instructions in the
"Media Interface" section.
: 4-pin socket for 3.5 mm stereo jack, e.g.
for MP3 players (audio and video)
; iPod® plug, to connect an iPod®
= USB socket, to connect an MP3 player
? Example of device (iPod®)
X
Connect the external device with suitable
socket :, ; or =.
COMAND Online activates the device, a
display appears (when connecting an iPod®
plug or USB socket).
If you remove a device, the No device con‐
nected message appears.
i A connected iPod® or MP3 player should
not be simultaneously operated via the
Media Interface and the remote control
(e.g. Bluetooth® remote control) or directly
via the device itself. Doing so may cause
unforeseen technical difficulties.
Audio
i Connecting a fully discharged iPod® or
MP3 player can result in an extended initialisation period.
Error messages appear while the device is
being activated if:
Rthe
connected device is not supported
(External
External device unavailable message).
Rthe connected device consumes too much
power.
Rthe Media Interface connection is faulty.
Ra mass storage device (e.g. USB memory
stick or USB hard drive) is connected to the
Media Interface.
In this case the Please connect the
device to the other USB port message appears.
i The separate USB connection ensures
quick access and expanded media content
options.
i Information is available at any MercedesBenz Service Centre.
Disconnecting an iPod®
X
Press the release buttons on iPod® plug ;
and pull the iPod® cable from the iPod®,
see the separate cable kit instructions.
Switching on automatically
X Connect an external device (Y page 494).
COMAND Online activates the device (if
connected via the iPod® connector or USB
socket). The basic display then appears.
Switching on with the function button
The external device is connected to the Media
Interface.
X Press the h function button one or more
times.
By pressing the function button repeatedly,
you can change the operating mode in the
following order:
Raudio
CD/DVD/MP3 (disc)
card mode
RMUSIC REGISTER
RUSB memory
RMedia Interface or audio AUX mode
Roperation with Bluetooth® audio
Rmemory
Switching on using a number key
X Press the i number key (for a DVD
changer) or the o number key (for a
single DVD drive) number key.
This selects the connected external audio
device directly.
Switching on via the media list
Switching to Media Interface mode
General notes
In extreme cases, starting up individual functions can take up to several minutes; this
depends on the external device and its content (e.g. video podcasts).
Only use the original software to save files on
iPods® or MP3 players. Otherwise, some or all
functions may not be available.
Media Interface mode (iPod® mode) when equipped with a DVD changer
: Cover (if available) or representation of
device
; Track number
Z
COMAND Online
Applications (Apps) that are activated on
the connected device may lead to malfunctions.
495
Audio
496
COMAND Online
= Elapsed track time (also in format
?
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
X
00:00:00 for audio books)
Track name
Graphic time display
Track position in playlist
Album name (if available)
Artist (if available)
Music search
Position in the media list
Data medium type
Playback options
Select the entry under position 0 (DVD
changer) or position 5 (single DVD drive) in
the media list by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm
(Y page 474).
COMAND Online activates the connected
device. You will see a message to this
effect. The basic display then appears.
If no device is connected, you will see the
Media Interface entry instead of a
device name.
The type of device connected is indicated by
the corresponding symbol for iPod®
(iPhone®) or MP3 player.
The current playback option is shown with a
symbol behind album name (no display for
Normal track sequence)
sequence (Y page 499).
i If the device connected does not contain
any playable tracks, a message appears to
this effect.
Selecting music files
Note
COMAND Online displays the data stored on
the iPod®, iPhone® or MP3 player according
to the file structure used in the respective
medium.
Selecting by skipping to a track
X To skip forwards or back to a track: turn
cVd the COMAND controller when the display/selection window is active.
or
X Press the E or F button.
The skip forward function skips to the next
track. The skip back function skips to the
beginning of the current track if the track
has been playing for more than eight seconds. If the track has been playing for less
than eight seconds, it skips to the start of
the previous track. If you have selected a
playback option other than Normal track
sequence, the track sequence is random.
sequence
On the multifunction steering wheel:
switch to Media Interface mode in
COMAND Online (Y page 495).
X On the multifunction steering wheel, press
the = or ; button to select the
Audio menu.
X Press the 9 or : button briefly.
If you hold down the 9 or : button,
the system scrolls through the list more
quickly. Not all media players support this
function.
If track information is available on the
media player, the multifunction display
shows the number and name of the track.
X
Selecting using the number keypad
X To make an entry: press the l button.
An input menu appears. The number of
characters available for input depends on
the number of stored tracks.
To enter a track number: press a number
key, e.g. q.
The digit is entered in the first position in
the input line.
i COMAND Online will ignore and not display an invalid digit.
X
Audio
The Videos category is available for iPods®
and iPhones® (except for Hong Kong).
X
Fast forward/rewind
X While the display/selection window is
active, slide X V Y and hold the COMAND
controller until the desired position has
been reached.
or
X Press and hold the E or F button
until the desired position is reached.
i On an iPod® or iPhone®, fast rewind only
functions within the current track.
i The functions are available as soon as the
entire media content has been read and
analysed. For certain functions, such as
keyword search and selection by cover, this
can take several minutes, depending on the
scope of media and the connected device.
If the same device is reconnected with
unchanged media content, these functions
are available much more quickly.
However, if you change the media content,
it has to be read and analysed again.
Calling up the category list
Selecting a category/playlist/folder
Overview
For an iPod®, iPhone® or certain MP3 players,
you can select tracks using categories or folders.
Depending on the device connected, the following categories may be available, for example:
RCurrent
tracklist
by cover
RKeyword search
RPlaylists (e.g. All
All)
RArtists
RAlbums
RTracks
RPodcasts
RGenres
RComposers
RAudiobooks
RVideos (except for Hong Kong)
RSelect
i Some playback categories contain the
entry All
All. If this entry has been selected,
the entire content of the category selected
will be played.
Example: category list
X
Select Search in the basic display by sliding VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
The category list appears.
i Search is not available until the device
has been activated.
Z
COMAND Online
Enter more numbers if desired.
The track plays after the last possible number is entered.
i Pressing and holding a number key for
more than 2 seconds completes the entry,
and the corresponding track is played.
497
Audio
498
i Reading: if the media content of the con-
COMAND Online
nected device is being read, this is indicated on the upper right by a symbol. When
reading has ended, the categories Select
by cover and Keyword Search are available.
Depending on the connected device and
the size of the media content, reading may
take several minutes. When the device is
next started or reconnected, the advanced
functions will be quickly available.
However, if you change the media content
on your iPod®/iPhone®, it has to be read
and analysed again.
Playing back the contents of a category or
folder
X Select the category or folder by turning
c V d the COMAND controller.
X Press W the COMAND controller for longer
than two seconds.
The content of the category or folder selected is played according to the playback
option selected (Y page 499).
Alphabetical track selection
iPod®, iPhone® and MP3 player
This function is available for alphabetically
sorted categories and folders. This function is
not available for albums or playlists, for example.
X Select a category, e.g. Artists
Artists, by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The available artists are displayed.
Press the corresponding number key once
or repeatedly to select the initial letter of
the desired artist. For example, to select an
artist whose name begins with C, press the
l number key three times.
The available letters are listed at the lower
edge of the display.
After a message, the first entry in the list
that matches the letter entered is highlighted.
i If no corresponding entry exists, the last
entry corresponding to an initial letter is
highlighted instead.
X
Example: current track list
: Symbol for next folder up
; Device symbol and device name
= Track symbol
? Current track
Select Current tracklist by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The content of the current track list
appears.
X Select the track by turning c V d the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The track is played.
X
X
To switch to the next folder up: slide XV
the COMAND controller.
or
X
Press the % back button.
i iPods and MP3 players: the quality of the
search results is highly dependent on the
version and language variant of the software used to populate the device. A wellknown example of such software is
iTunes®.
If different sorting rules are defined (e.g. in
iTunes®), the search is cancelled without
any result.
Audio
i For more information on Select by
cover and Keyword Search can be found
under "Music search, selecting category"
(Y page 497).
i For an iPod®/iPhone®, the available covers are added most efficiently if the entire
media content is in the current playlist. This
is the case if you have selected the playback option Title or Random media
(Y page 499).
Special feature in iPod®/iPhone® mode
i If the connected iPod®/iPhone® is not
functioning or paused, you can search for
tracks but cannot select them. After confirming a new track, the Function
unavailable message appears.
Playback options
X
To select a playback option: select
Media Interface in the basic display by
sliding V Æ and turning c V d the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The options list appears. The # dot indicates the option selected.
X
Select an option and press W to confirm.
The following options are available:
RNormal
track sequence
Normal track sequence: you hear the
tracks in their normal order (e.g. numerical
or alphabetical).
RRandom media
All the tracks on the medium are played in
random order.
RRandom track list
The tracks in the currently active category
or folder, including any subfolders, are
played in random order.
i If the connected iPod®/iPhone® is not
functioning or paused, the playback
options are inactive. The display of options
is greyed out.
MP3 player instructions
General information
Up to 30,000 tracks per medium are supported.
You can speed up some functions and
improve the search results by:
Rmaking
sure the names of tracks, albums
and artists, for example, are written the
same way
Rlabelling albums featuring various artists as
"compilations"
i Multiple entries of tracks in playlists are
filtered out for some players.
Data formats
MP3 and WMA are supported as data formats
with fixed and variable bit rates (up to
320 kbit/s).
Z
COMAND Online
Additional selection functions
RSelect by cover
Albums can be chosen by cover using the
menu item.
The first time the Select by cover function is used, additional data must be loaded
from the iPod®/iPhone®. The current
music playback is interrupted to allow
access to this data. The process may take a
few minutes and should not be cancelled.
Otherwise it will start again from the beginning the next time Select by cover is
selected. Covers are initially searched for in
the Gracenote Media Database and are
then added to during playback from the
connected device (Y page 476). The availability depends on the use and the tracks
already selected.
RKeyword search
Selecting keyword search allows you to
search through all categories on the connected device for keywords.
499
500
Audio
Special considerations when using MP3
players
Up to 8 directory levels with up to 1,000
tracks per directory are supported.
Do not use USB extension leads or adapters.
They can impair functionality.
i DRM (Digital Rights Management) protec-
COMAND Online
ted files are not supported by the Media
Interface.
Audio AUX mode
Notes on audio AUX mode
The varying volumes of external audio sources can mean that system messages (e.g.
traffic and navigation announcements) are
played at a noticeably increased volume. If
necessary, deactivate the system messages
or adjust their volume manually.
You can connect an external audio source
(AUX) to COMAND Online.
Depending on the vehicle model series the
connection is made via a jack in the storage
compartment in the centre console or via the
USB port (Y page 472).
If COMAND Online is equipped with a Media
Interface, external audio sources are connected using the cable set provided. The cable
set then replaces the audio AUX socket. The
connections for the Media Interface are located in the stowage compartment in the centre
console.
By pressing the function button repeatedly,
you can change the operating mode in the
following order:
Raudio
CD/DVD/MP3 (disc)
card mode
RMUSIC REGISTER
RUSB memory
RMedia Interface or audio AUX mode
Roperation with Bluetooth® audio
Rmemory
Switching on with the audio menu
When you connect an external audio source,
audio AUX is not selected automatically.
X Select Audio in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
If AUX mode was the last mode selected, it
will now be active.
If another audio source is switched on, you
can now switch to audio AUX mode in the
audio menu.
X Select Audio using ZV and press W to
confirm.
The audio menu appears.
X
Select Aux by turning cVd and press W to
confirm.
The audio AUX menu appears. The medium
in the external audio source is played if the
source is connected and playback selected.
i You can find more information on the
Internet at http://www.mercedesbenz.com/connect and in the "Media
Interface mode" section (Y page 494).
Switching to audio AUX mode
Switching on with the function button
The external device is connected to the audio
AUX input.
X Press the h function button one or more
times.
Please see the respective operating instructions for how to operate the external audio
source.
Video
Information on:
Rvolume
Rsound
settings (Y page 299)
settings (Y page 299)
Increasing the volume on COMAND
Online
501
going to print. Country-specific differences
are possible. Please note that your
COMAND Online system may not be equipped with all the features described.
General notes
If the vehicle is travelling faster than approximately 5 km/h, the picture for the driver
automatically switches off in the following
modes:
RTV
mode (with teletext)
DVD mode
SPLITVIEW allows the front passenger to view
the TV and video image (Y page 308).
The following message appears in the display:
In order not to distract you from
the traffic situation, the picture
is faded out while the vehicle is in
motion.
As soon as the vehicle speed drops below
about 5 km/h, the picture switches back on
again.
RVideo
X
Select Volume in the AUX display by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
A menu appears. The # dot indicates the
current setting.
X
Select Standard or Boost and press W to
confirm.
Standard: the volume of the external audio
Standard
source is adjusted to a standard value.
Boost: the volume of the external audio
Boost
source is raised by approximately 10 dB.
A device which is connected as an external
audio source may seem quieter or louder in
the vehicle, or the usual maximum volume
cannot be reached. On some devices, it is
possible to adjust the volume separately. In
this case, start at a medium volume and
increase it gradually. This enables you to
determine whether the system is able to play
the music at high volume without distorting it.
Video
Features of your COMAND Online
This Supplement describes all the standard
and optional equipment for your COMAND
Online system, as available at the time of
Background video mode
If another main function is active, e.g. navigation, you can perform the following operations in TV and video DVD mode. A window
shows information about the selected function.
Using the E or F button, you can:
Rselect
Rselect
a TV channel
a scene or chapter (video DVD
mode)
forward or rewind (video DVD mode)
Where operating steps can be carried out in
the active main function using the number
keys, the following functions are not possible:
Rfast
Rselecting
TV channels from the channel
presets
Rstoring TV channels in the channel presets
Z
COMAND Online
Automatic picture shutoff
Video
502
Basic settings
COMAND Online
Adjusting the brightness, contrast or
colour
The following describes the TV, video DVD
and video AUX modes.
X In TV or video DVD mode, press W the
COMAND controller.
The menu is shown.
X Select TV
TV, DVD-V or Aux by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
A menu appears.
Select Brightness
Brightness, Contrast or Colour
by turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
X Set the value between - 5 and + 5 and press
W to confirm.
X
The TV tuner is designed to receive digital TV
channels compliant with the DVB-T standard.
If the reception deteriorates, the TV receiver
automatically switches to an alternative digital frequency transmitting the same programme content with better reception.
i In some countries, DVB-T may not be
available, or may not be available in all
areas.
The constantly changing reception conditions
while the vehicle is in motion can interrupt the
signal. If the reception is too poor,
COMAND Online can mute the sound and
freeze or hide the picture. To indicate this, an
icon of a radio tower with a line through it
appears in the display.
Switching to TV mode
Changing the picture format
The following describes the TV, video DVD
and video AUX modes.
X In TV or video DVD mode, press W the
COMAND controller.
The menu is shown.
X Select TV
TV, DVD-V or Aux by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
A menu appears.
X
Select Automatic
Automatic, 16:9 optimised,
optimised 4:3
or Widescreen and press W to confirm.
The dot in front of the entry indicates the
currently selected format.
X
Select a setting by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
TV mode
Reception quality
Portable electronic devices in the vehicle may
seriously impair TV reception.
Video menu
Select Video in the main function bar by
sliding XVY or turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
If TV mode was the last mode selected, it
will now be active.
If another mode is switched on, you can
now switch to TV mode in the video menu.
X Select TV and press W to confirm.
If the TV channel that was previously selected is still receivable, it will be displayed.
X
Showing/hiding the control menu
Showing/hiding the TV menu
Preset position of the selected TV channel
Selected TV channel/number
Current programme
Next TV channel in the channel list (channel name or number)
A Shows the TV menu
B Previous TV channel in the channel list
(channel name or number)
:
;
=
?
A
To show the control menu: slide ZVÆ the
COMAND controller while in full-screen
mode.
i Full-screen mode means that the control
menu is hidden and you see the television
picture.
or
:
;
=
?
X
i If you turn cVd the COMAND controller,
the next/previous channel is selected at
the same time.
X To hide the control menu: slide ZVÆ the
COMAND controller.
or
X Wait for approximately eight seconds.
X
TV options
Channel preset list
Information about the current programme
To switch on teletext
Sound settings
To show the TV menu: press W the
COMAND controller while in full-screen
mode.
Select Menu while the control menu is
shown and press W to confirm.
X To hide the TV menu: slide ZV the
COMAND controller and confirm Full
screen by pressing W.
X
i Information about current programme =
and teletext ? are not supported by all TV
standards or TV channels in all countries.
Selecting TV channels
Selecting channels using the control
menu
X Turn cVd the COMAND controller.
or
X Slide XVY the COMAND controller.
or
X Press the E or F button.
The TV tuner selects the previous or next
channel from the alphabetical channel list.
Z
503
COMAND Online
Video
Video
504
Setting a channel from the channel list
After starting the vehicle or switching on
COMAND Online, all receivable TV and radio
stations are listed by the reception function.
The respective channel list contains the following information, if it is transmitted and can
be received:
Rthe
COMAND Online
names of the channels/stations with
adequate reception
Rfor each channel: the titles of the current
and upcoming programmes via the electronic programme guide (EPG)
The TV tuner requires a certain amount of
time to update this information.
The information can be displayed if:
Setting channels via the channel presets
Rchannels
are transmitting this information
and
Rthe reception conditions are adequate
The order of the channel list is country-specific.
X To set a channel using COMAND Online:
press W the COMAND controller while in
full-screen mode.
The menu is shown.
X Select TV by sliding XVY or turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X Select Channel list (TV) or Station
list (Radio) and press W to confirm.
The channel list appears. A dot # indicates
the currently selected channel. A number
shows the memory position in the station
memory.
X
Select the channel and press W to confirm.
To set a channel using the multifunction steering wheel: switch on TV mode in
COMAND Online (Y page 502).
X Press the = or ; button to select the
Audio menu.
X Press and hold the 9 or : button.
X
Channel presets
Option 1: press W the COMAND controller
while in full-screen mode.
The TV menu is shown.
X Select Preset by sliding XVY or turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The channel presets appear. A dot # indicates the currently selected channel. A
number shows the memory position in the
station memory.
X Select and confirm a channel by turning
cVd or sliding ZVÆ the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
or
X Option 2: briefly press one or two number
keys.
To select a channel from a single-digit preset, briefly press the s number key, for
example.
To select a channel from a double-digit
memory position, briefly press the l
and m number keys, for example.
If a channel was saved, the storage number
and channel name appear and COMAND
Online sets the channel.
Saving a TV channel automatically or manually (Y page 505).
X
Selecting channels by entering the channel and programme number
Several programmes can be transmitted on
one channel with digital TV. You can therefore
Video
X
Step 2: to enter a channel/programme
number: press the corresponding number
keys.
As soon as you have entered the channel/
programme number, COMAND Online sets
the channel/station.
If you only enter the first two or three digits
of the channel/programme number, the
first receivable programme will be set
within the programme series.
If you have not entered a programme number, the first programme with adequate
reception will be set.
If you enter channels that are either not intended for or not allowed in your country, the
Invalid channel number message
appears.
X Press W the COMAND controller and confirm the message.
i You can enter channel numbers or pro-
grammes available in your country even if
the reception is currently not adequate.
Information on channel numbers available
in your country can be found on the websites of the private or public broadcasters,
for example.
Storing TV channels
Storing channels manually
You can manually store up to 40 TV channels
in preset positions.
X Option 1: press one or two number keys
while a TV programme is playing, until a
tone can be heard.
To save a channel to a single-digit memory
position, briefly press the s number
key, for example.
To save a channel to a double-digit memory
position, briefly press the l number
key, for example. Then within three seconds, press and hold m, for example.
The current channel is stored. The TV picture then reappears.
or
X Option 2: press W the COMAND controller
while in full-screen mode.
The TV menu is shown.
X Select Preset by sliding XVY or turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The channel presets appear. A dot # indicates the currently selected channel.
X Turn cVd the COMAND controller to select
the desired preset position.
X To store a channel, press and hold W the
COMAND controller until you hear a tone.
The previously saved channel is overwritten.
Storing channels automatically
TV channels are automatically stored on the
first 20 of the 40 preset positions in total.
Receivable channels are stored in order of
reception quality. The current preset channels in positions 1 – 20 are manually overwritten.
Z
COMAND Online
enter a channel and the desired programme
on this channel.
X Step 1: to call up the input line for the
channel number: press l during TV
playback.
or
X Press W the COMAND controller while in
full-screen mode.
The TV menu is shown.
X Select TV by sliding XVY or turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X Select Channel entry and press W to
confirm.
With both options, the input line for the
four-digit channel number appears.
505
Video
506
Press W the COMAND controller while in
full-screen mode.
The TV menu is shown.
X Select Preset by sliding XVY or turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
X Select Autostore and press W to confirm.
COMAND Online searches for channels
with adequate reception. The available stations are automatically stored in the preset
positions.
channels or digital radio stations which
have adequate reception. A dot # indicates
the currently selected channel.
COMAND Online
X
Information about the current programme
Press W the COMAND controller while in
full-screen mode.
The TV menu is shown.
X Select Info by sliding XVY or turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
You will see the information if it is provided
by the selected TV channel or radio station.
The information field otherwise remains
empty.
X To display multi-page information, turn
cVd or slide ZVÆ the COMAND controller.
X
i It may take a few seconds for the information to appear.
Displaying the current programme or
programme preview
This function is available if the selected TV
channel or radio station transmits the necessary information.
X Press W the COMAND controller while in
full-screen mode.
The TV menu is shown.
X Select TV by sliding XVY or turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X Select Channel list (TV) or Station
list (Radio).
(Radio)
The selected channel list appears. It shows
the current programme on the digital TV
Alphabetical browser
Channel name
To display the programme preview
Visual display of the elapsed programme
time (if this information is broadcast)
A Title of the current programme
B Current channel
:
;
=
?
To activate the alphabetical browser:
slide XV the COMAND controller to the
left.
The browser is highlighted.
X Select the initial letter of the desired channel name by sliding ZVÆ or turning cVd
the COMAND controller.
or
X To select the letter B, for example, press the
l number key twice in quick succession.
The programme display changes to the
appropriate channel.
i Entering characters using the number
keypad (Y page 305).
X
X
Switch back by sliding VY.
X
To display the programme preview: slide
VY the COMAND controller to the right.
The channel list shows the channel's next
programme.
Video
507
The function is switched on O or off ª,
depending on the previous status. When
the function is switched on, FIX appears in
the display window.
X To exit the menu: slide XVY the COMAND
controller or press the % back button.
i The setting is only valid for the currently
selected channel.
:
;
=
?
A
To display the current programme
Channel name
Beginning and end of the programme
Title of the next programme
Current channel
To display the current programme: slide
XV the COMAND controller to the left.
X To close the display: press the % back
button.
The browser cannot be activated in the programme preview.
X
i The programme preview is also referred
to as the electronic programme guide
(EPG).
Basic TV settings
Fixing the frequency
Depending on reception levels, country or TV
standard, the TV tuner automatically switches
to an alternative channel with better reception if it is broadcasting the same programme
content. You can use the Channel fix function to prevent this channel switching. This is
useful e.g. if there is a disruptive time delay
between the channels or if you do not wish
the tuner to switch channels automatically.
X Press W the COMAND controller.
The TV menu is shown.
X Select TV by sliding XVY or turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X Select Channel fix and confirm with W.
Setting the TV standard
COMAND Online is already set to the correct
TV standard. If you are driving your vehicle in
a different country or region with a different
TV standard, you should reset the TV standard. If the TV standard is not set correctly,
channels may not be found or characters may
be incorrectly displayed, for example. A
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre can help you
to select the correct TV standard.
X Press W the COMAND controller while in
full-screen mode.
The TV menu is shown.
X Select TV by sliding XVY or turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X Select TV standard and press W to confirm.
A list appears showing the reception
regions. The # dot in front of a list entry
indicates the currently selected reception
area or country.
X Select the reception area and press W to
confirm.
A message appears to inform you that if the
wrong country is set, correct reception will
not be possible.
X Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, COMAND Online will
switch to the country setting you have
selected.
If you select No
No, the country list will appear
again.
Z
COMAND Online
X
Video
508
COMAND Online
Teletext
Introduction
Teletext and data service functions are not
supported by all TV standards in all countries.
Teletext can only be received if there is no
interference in the picture reception. The teletext or data service functions receive and
save all teletext pages for the currently selected channel in the system memory. This
excludes any subpages. If you set a different
channel, the memory is cleared and refilled.
X
To select a subpage: slide
XVY the COMAND controller.
Digital teletext (MHEG-5)
Switching teletext on/off
Press W the COMAND controller while in
full-screen mode.
The TV menu is shown.
X To switch on: select Teletext by sliding
XVY and turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X To switch off: press the % back button.
The TV picture appears.
X
Selecting a teletext page
X To access a page directly: press the corresponding number keys.
X To access the previous/next page: turn
cVd or slide ZVÆ the COMAND controller.
i You can only enter pages that are permissible for teletext between 100 and 899.
Dynamic teletext page
A dynamic teletext page may be available.
This page consists of multiple sub-pages that
are displayed at the bottom of the display via
1, 2, 3, 4, etc.
In addition to TV and radio programmes, you
can also use interactive multimedia applications such as weather forecasts, news
reports and sports results.
Digital teletext is only available in some countries, e.g. the UK and New Zealand.
X Press W the COMAND controller while in
full-screen mode.
The TV menu is shown.
X To switch on: select Teletext by sliding
XVY and turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
When the data contents are displayed, turn
cVd the COMAND controller.
The menu bar appears at the bottom of the
picture.
X To select a colour: select Red
Red, Green
Green,
Yellow or Blue by turning cVd the
COMAND controller.
X Press W to confirm.
The contents of the selected colour are displayed.
X To navigate to the page: when the menu
bar is displayed, slide ZVÆ the COMAND
controller.
The menu bar disappears.
X Slide ZVÆ the COMAND controller and
select contents from the page.
X Press W to confirm.
X
Video
To return to the TV programme: turn
cVd the COMAND controller.
X Select TV by turning cVd the COMAND
controller.
or
X Press and hold the % back button on the
left next to the COMAND controller.
X
509
Rselect
a country-specific character set
channel list settings
Rreset the settings
Rperform
"TV - further options" menu
Press W the COMAND controller while in
full-screen mode.
The TV menu is shown.
X Select TV by sliding XVY or turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X Select Further options by sliding ZVÆ
or turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
X To exit the menu: select Exit and press
W to confirm.
X
If a multilingual broadcast is received, you can
select the audio channel you would like to
hear. With Audio 1 you can select the main
channel, with Audio 2 you can choose an
additional audio track.
X Press W the COMAND controller while in
full-screen mode.
The TV menu is shown.
X Select TV by sliding XVY or turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X Select Audio 1 or Audio 2 by sliding ZVÆ
the COMAND controller.
The # dot indicates the selected setting.
The audio channel switches over, e.g. to
another language.
Selecting language and subtitles
Further options
Overview
You can use this function to:
Rselect
audio languages
subtitles on/off and select the subtitle language
Rswitch
Audio language: when the Prefer COMAND
language function is switched on, it gives
preference to the COMAND system language
currently set. For programmes broadcast in
multiple languages, the listener can select
between several audio languages. A symbol
Z
COMAND Online
Selecting audio
COMAND Online
510
Video
for programme transmission may appear in
front of the audio language: with audio
explanations (for the visually impaired) in
stereo or for the hearing impaired. If a symbol
does not appear, the programme is either
broadcast in mono or the transmission properties are unknown.
Subtitles: when this function is activated,
shows subtitles in the selected language for
the programme currently broadcast (if available).
X In the "Tuner - Further Options" menu, confirm Language & Subtitles by pressing
W the COMAND controller (Y page 509).
A menu appears.
X To select the language: confirm Audio
Language by pressing W the COMAND
controller.
X Select Prefer COMAND language or one
of the available audio languages.
Switch the setting on O or off ª or select
an available audio language.
If you select one of the available audio languages, e.g. English, this setting is used for
the current program only.
X To select subtitles: select Subtitles by
sliding ZVÆ or turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Subtitles and press W to confirm.
Switch the subtitles on O or off ª.
X Select Prefer COMAND language or one
of the available languages for subtitles.
Switch the setting on O or off ª or select
an available language for subtitles.
If you select one of the available languages
for subtitles, e.g. English, this setting is
used for the current programme.
X To exit the menu: select Back and press
W to confirm.
Settings
In the "Tuner - Further Options" menu, confirm Settings by pressing W the
COMAND controller (Y page 509).
A menu appears.
X To set a country-specific character set:
select 1. country-specific charac‐
ter set and press W to confirm.
Switch the setting on O or off ª.
Function deactivated: the character set
broadcast by the TV channels is used for
the display.
Function activated: a country-specific character set is used for the display.
X To perform station list settings: select
2. Station List Settings by sliding
ZVÆ or turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select Display free-to-air TV Sta‐
tions, Display free-to-air Radio
tions
Stations or Display data-serviceonly Stations.
Stations
Switch the display of free-to-air TV channels or radio stations and data-only services in the channel list on O or off ª.
X To reset the settings: select Reset
Reset.
A prompt appears asking whether you wish
to reset.
X Select Yes or No and press W to confirm.
After selecting Yes
Yes, the reception device
settings are reset to the factory settings. No
cancels the procedure.
X To exit the menu: select 0. Back and
press W to confirm.
X
Video
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The CD/DVD drive is a class 1 laser product.
If you open the housing of the CD/DVD drive,
invisible laser beams may be released. These
laser beams may damage your retina. There is
a risk of injury.
You must not open the casing. Always have
maintenance work and repairs carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Handling discs while driving will distract you
from traffic conditions. You could then lose
control of the vehicle. There is a risk of an
accident.
Handle discs only when the vehicle is stationary.
Bear in mind that, at a speed of only 50 km/h,
your vehicle is already covering a distance of
14 m per second.
software and writers available. This variety
means that there is no guarantee that the
system will be able to play discs that you have
copied yourself.
DVD playback requirements
There are video DVDs available on the market
that do not conform to the current standards.
Such DVDs may have picture, sound or other
playback problems.
COMAND Online is capable of playing back
video DVDs produced according to the following standards:
RRegion code 2 (for Europe) or region code 0
(no region code)
or NTSC standard
You will generally find the relevant details
either on the DVD itself or on the DVD case.
RPAL
i If you insert a video DVD with a different
region code, you will see a message to this
effect.
i COMAND Online is set to region code 2 at
the factory. This setting can be changed at
a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre. This will
allow you to play video DVDs with a different region code, provided that they are produced in accordance with the PAL or NTSC
standard. The region code can be changed
a maximum of five times.
Notes on discs
! Do not affix stickers or labels to the discs.
They could peel off and damage
COMAND Online. Stickers can cause the
disc to bend, which can result in read errors
and disc recognition problems.
! COMAND Online is designed to play discs
which comply with the EN 60908 standard.
Therefore, you can only use discs with a
maximum thickness of 1.3 mm.
If you insert thicker discs, e.g. those that
contain data on both sides (DVD on one
side and audio data on the other), they cannot be ejected and can damage the device.
Only use round discs with a diameter of
12 cm. Do not use discs with a diameter of
8 cm, even with an adapter.
Function restrictions
Depending on the DVD, it is possible that certain functions or actions will be temporarily
blocked or may not function at all. As soon as
you try to activate these functions or actions,
you will see the K symbol in the display.
Inserting and removing DVDs
X
Proceed as described in the "Inserting and
ejecting CDs and DVDs" section
(Y page 469).
You may encounter playback problems when
playing copied discs. There are a large variety
of discs, DVD authoring software, writing
Z
COMAND Online
Video DVD mode
511
Video
512
Switching to video DVD mode
Switching on automatically
X Single DVD drive: insert a video DVD.
COMAND loads the medium inserted and
starts to play it.
X
X
DVD changer: insert a video DVD.
Press h.
COMAND Online
Select Video by sliding ZV the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
The video menu appears.
X Select DVD-V and press W to confirm.
X
Showing/hiding the control menu
or
X
If another video source is switched on, you
can now switch to video DVD mode in the
video menu.
Press the % back button.
COMAND Online loads the medium inserted and starts to play it.
Switching on with the function button
X Press the h function button.
COMAND Online switches to the disc operating mode previously set.
By pressing the function button repeatedly,
you can change the operating mode in the
following order:
CD/DVD/video DVD/MP3 in the
DVD changer or single DVD drive (disc
mode)
Rmemory card mode
RMUSIC REGISTER
RUSB memory
RMedia Interface or audio AUX mode
Roperation with Bluetooth® audio
X DVD changer: select Media by sliding VÆ
and turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
Single DVD drive: select Media by sliding
VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select a ý video DVD from the media list
(Y page 514).
X
To show: in video DVD mode, slide ZVÆ
the COMAND controller.
X
To hide: slide ZVÆ the COMAND controller.
or
X
Wait for approximately eight seconds.
Raudio
Switching on with the video menu
X Select Video in the main function bar by
sliding ZV and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
If video DVD mode was the last mode selected, it will now be active.
Control menu displayed
: Data medium type
; Current track
= Current scene
? Track time
A To show the menu
i This function is not available while the
DVD menu is being displayed.
Showing/hiding the menu
X
To show: in full-screen video DVD mode,
press W the COMAND controller.
or
X
Select Menu while the control menu is
shown and press W to confirm.
Video
X
To hide: slide the ZV COMAND controller
and confirm Full screen by pressing W.
X
513
To stop playback: while playback is interrupted, select É again and press W to
confirm.
During playback, confirm É by pressing
W twice in rapid succession.
Ì is selected.
X
To restart playback: confirm Ì by
pressing W.
Playback restarts from the beginning.
Pause function
Menu shown
: Video DVD options
; Pause function
= Stop function
? Media media selection
A Sound settings
i This function is not available while the
DVD menu is being displayed.
Fast forward/rewind
X
In full-screen video DVD mode, slide XVY
and hold the COMAND controller until the
desired position is reached.
or
X
Press and hold the E or F button
until the desired position is reached.
You see the control menu.
Stop function
Show the menu (Y page 512).
X To interrupt playback: select É by
turning cVd the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
The Ë display changes to Ì. The
video image is hidden.
X To continue playback: select Ì and
press W to confirm.
Playback continues from the point where it
was interrupted.
X
Show the menu (Y page 512).
To pause playback: select Ë by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
The Ë display changes to Ì.
X To continue playback: select Ì and
press W to confirm.
The menu is hidden.
X
X
Selecting a scene/chapter
If the film is divided into scenes or chapters,
you can select them directly while the film is
running, or skip forwards step by step. Some
DVDs do not permit this at certain points (e.g.
during the opening credits).
It may also be possible to select the scene/
chapter from within the menu stored on the
DVD.
X To skip forwards or back: in full-screen
mode, turn cVd the COMAND controller.
or
X Slide XVY the COMAND controller.
or
X Press the E or F button on the control panel.
The control menu (Y page 512) appears for
approximately eight seconds.
Z
COMAND Online
or
X
Video
514
On the multifunction steering wheel:
switch to video DVD mode in
COMAND Online (Y page 512).
X Use the = or ; button to select the
Audio menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select a
scene/chapter.
If you press and hold the 9 or :
button for an extended period, rapid scrolling begins.
COMAND Online
X
Selecting a video DVD from the media
list
X
X
X
Selecting a film/title
Show the menu (Y page 512).
Select Media by sliding VÆ and turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
The media list appears. The # dot indicates
the medium currently being played. Video
DVDs are indicated by the ý icon.
If equipped with a single DVD drive:
press W the COMAND controller.
COMAND Online loads the video DVD and
begins playing it.
If equipped with a DVD changer: press
W the COMAND controller to display all
magazine trays.
X Select the video DVD by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
COMAND Online loads the video DVD and
begins playing it.
X
DVD function menu
This function is only available if the DVD is
divided into several films/titles. If the DVD
contains several films, these can be selected
directly. A film can be selected either when
the DVD is being played back or when it is
stopped.
The film can also be selected from the menu
on the DVD itself.
X Show the menu (Y page 512).
X Select DVD-Video by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
X Select DVD functions and press W to
confirm.
A menu appears.
X Select Title selection by turning cVd
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
X Select a film/title and press W to confirm.
i If you select a CD, an audio DVD or an
MP3 medium, you switch to the respective
audio mode.
For further information about the media
list; see (Y page 474).
DVD menu
Calling up the DVD menu
The DVD menu is the menu stored on the DVD
itself. It is structured in various ways according to the individual DVD and permits certain
actions and settings.
In the case of multi-language DVDs, for example, you can change the DVD language in the
DVD menu.
X Show the menu (Y page 512).
X Select DVD-Video in the menu by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
Video
Selecting menu items in the DVD menu
Moving up one level in the DVD menu
Show the DVD menu (Y page 514).
X Select the corresponding menu item in the
DVD menu and press W the COMAND controller to confirm.
or
X Select any menu item in the DVD menu and
press W the COMAND controller to confirm.
X Select Go up and press W to confirm.
X
Going back to the film
Press the k button repeatedly until you
see the movie.
or
X Select the corresponding menu item from
the DVD menu.
X
X
X
Show the DVD menu (Y page 514).
Select a menu item by sliding ZVÆ the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
or
X
Select a menu item by sliding XVY the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
The menu appears.
To reconfirm your selection: confirm
Select by pressing W.
COMAND Online carries out the action.
Make a selection from the further options,
if necessary.
COMAND Online then switches back to the
DVD menu.
i Menu items that cannot be selected are
shown in grey.
X
i Depending on the DVD, the menu items:
Back (to the movie)
movie), Play
Play, Stop
Stop, K,
L or Go up may either not function at all
or may not function at certain points in the
DVD menu. To indicate this, the K symbol
appears in the display.
X
Select the Back (to the movie) menu
item in the menu and press W to confirm.
Setting the language and audio format
This function is not available on all DVDs. If it
is available, you can set the DVD menu language, the audio language or the audio format. The number of settings is dependent on
the DVD content. It may also be possible to
access the settings from the DVD menu
(Y page 514).
X Show the DVD menu (Y page 514).
X In full-screen mode, press W the COMAND
controller to show the menu.
X Select DVD-Video in the menu by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
X Select DVD functions and press W to
confirm.
X Select Menu language or Audio lan‐
guage and press W to confirm.
In both cases, a menu appears after a few
seconds. The # dot in front of an entry indicates the currently selected language.
X Select a setting by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
Z
COMAND Online
Select DVD functions and press W to
confirm.
X Select Menu and press W to confirm.
The DVD menu appears.
X
515
516
Video
COMAND Online
Subtitles and camera angle
These functions are not available on all DVDs.
The number of subtitle languages and camera
angles available depends on the content of
the DVD. It may also be possible to access the
settings from the DVD menu.
X Show the DVD menu (Y page 514).
X Select DVD-Video in the menu by turning
cVd the COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
X Select DVD functions and press W to
confirm.
X Select Subtitles or Camera angle and
press W to confirm.
In both cases, a menu appears. The # dot in
front of an entry indicates the current setting.
X Select a setting by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
If your vehicle is equipped with the Media
Interface, you can connect an external video
source.
You require an additional audio/video cable
set to connect an external video source to the
Media Interface.
For more details, please contact a MercedesBenz Service Centre or visit http://
www.mercedes-benz.com/connect. Then,
follow the instructions in the "Media Interface" section.
You will find the connection sockets in the
centre console stowage compartment.
Interactive content
DVDs may contain interactive content (e.g. a
video game). In a video game, for example,
you may be able to influence events by selecting and triggering actions. The type and number of actions depend on the DVD.
X Select an action by sliding ZVÆ or XVY the
COMAND controller and press W to execute it.
A menu appears and the first entry, Select
Select,
is highlighted.
X Press W the COMAND controller.
Video AUX operation
Connecting external video sources
External video sources may have different
volumes, which can mean that system messages such as traffic announcements and
navigation system announcements are much
louder. If necessary, deactivate the system
messages or adjust their volume manually.
Audio/video sockets
: Video port (V) (yellow)
; Audio port (L) (white)
= Audio port (R) (red)
i For correct playback, a suitable video
standard must be set at the external video
source.
X
Connect the external device to the corresponding port.
Video
Switching to video AUX mode
517
louder in the vehicle, or the usual maximum
volume cannot be achieved. On some devices, it is possible to adjust the volume separately. In this case, start at a medium volume and increase it gradually. This enables
you to determine whether the system is
able to play the sound at high volume without distorting it.
Video AUX mode
X
Press the h function button repeatedly
until Media Interface mode is selected.
X
X
or
Select Video in the main function bar by
turning c V d the COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
If video AUX mode was the last mode selected, it will now be active.
If another video source is switched on, you
can now switch to video AUX mode in the
video menu.
X Select Video and press W to confirm.
X Select Aux and press W to confirm.
The video AUX menu appears. You will hear
and see the content of the external video
source if it is connected and switched to
playback.
X
Showing/hiding the menu
X
Show the video AUX menu (Y page 517).
Select Volume by turning cVd the
COMAND controller and press W to confirm.
A menu appears. The # dot indicates the
current setting.
Select Standard or Boost and press W to
confirm.
Standard: the volume of the external video
Standard
source is adjusted to a standard value.
Boost: the volume of the external video
Boost
source is raised by approximately 10 dB.
Picture viewer
Introduction
If there are pictures on the active data
medium, you can view them. You can display
pictures with a resolution of up to 20 megapixels.
To show: in video AUX mode, press W the
COMAND controller.
X To hide: slide ZV the COMAND controller
and confirm Full screen by pressing W.
Data medium
Supported picture
formats
CD/DVD with picture files
bmp, jpeg, jpg, png
Volume and sound settings
USB devices (sticks, bmp, jpeg, jpg, png
hard drives)
SD memory card
X
Information on:
Rvolume
Rsound
settings (Y page 299)
settings (Y page 299)
i A device which is connected as an external video source may seem quieter or
Calling up the category list
X
Select a data medium with pictures (e.g. a
memory card):
Z
COMAND Online
Increasing the volume on COMAND
Online
Video
518
Rin
Rin
X
the Audio menu (Y page 462)
the media list (Y page 474)
Changing the picture view
Select Search in the basic display by sliding VÆ and turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
The category list appears (Y page 481).
Displaying pictures
COMAND Online
X
X
Select Photos from the category list
(Y page 481) by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
A folder directory appears.
Select a folder with photos and press W to
confirm.
The folder displays the existing picture files
(example).
X
While viewing a picture (Y page 518), press
W the COMAND controller.
A menu appears.
X
To turn the picture clockwise: confirm
Turn clockwise by pressing W the
COMAND controller.
X
To turn the picture anti-clockwise:
select Turn anticlockwise by turning the
cVd COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
To zoom into a picture: select Zoom by
turning the cVd COMAND controller and
press W to confirm.
After you have zoomed into the picture, you
can move the section of the picture.
X Slide ZVÆ or XVY the COMAND controller.
X
X
Select a photo and press W to confirm.
The photo is displayed and the music is
stopped.
X
To revert to the original size: press W the
COMAND controller.
or
X
Press the % back button.
Exiting the picture viewer
X
Select Back to menu in the menu by turning cVd the COMAND controller and press
W to confirm.
Rear Seat Entertainment System
519
Always stow these items or similar objects
carefully so that they cannot be flung around,
for example in a lockable vehicle stowage
compartment.
Components
The Rear Seat Entertainment System
includes:
Rear Seat Entertainment System
Features of your COMAND Online
This Supplement describes all the standard
and optional equipment for your COMAND
Online system, as available at the time of
going to print. Country-specific differences
are possible. Please note that your
COMAND Online system may not be equipped with all the features described.
screens for the rear behind the frontseat head restraints
Ra remote control
Ra CD/DVD drive
RAUX jacks on both screens (AUX display)
and on the CD/DVD drive (AUX drive)
Rtwo sets of cordless headphones
Overview
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The CD/DVD drive is a class 1 laser product.
If you open the housing of the CD/DVD drive,
invisible laser beams may be released. These
laser beams may damage your retina. There is
a risk of injury.
You must not open the casing. Always have
maintenance work and repairs carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If objects such as headphones/headsets or
external audio/video sources are not secured
in the passenger compartment, they can be
flung around and hit vehicle occupants. There
is a risk of injury, for example in the event of
sudden braking or a sudden change in direction.
Z
COMAND Online
Rtwo
520
Rear Seat Entertainment System
COMAND Online
Rear-compartment screens
: AUX jacks, detailed view in the "CD/DVD drive and AUX jacks" section (Y page 521)
; Display
Remote control
Overview
:
;
=
?
A
B
C
D
E
F
Switches the screen on/off
Switches the button lighting on/off
Selects the screen for the remote control
Selects a menu or menu item
Confirms a selection or setting
Switches the sound on/off
Adjusts the volume
Skips, fast-forward/fast-rewind
Selects a track; to enter track directly
Exits a menu (back)
Selecting the screen for the remote control
The remote control can be used to operate
one of the two rear-compartment screens or
SPLITVIEW for the front passenger. To do so,
you must switch the remote control to the
desired screen (Y page 520).
X To select the left-hand screen: turn thumbwheel = until "L REAR" is highlighted in the
window.
X To select the right-hand screen: turn
thumbwheel = until "R REAR" is highlighted in the window.
X To select SPLITVIEW: turn thumbwheel =
until "SPLITVIEW" is highlighted in the window.
Switching the screen on/off
If the key is in position 0 or 1 in the ignition
lock (see the vehicle Owner's Manual), or if
the key is not inserted, the screens in the rear
will switch off after 30 minutes. Before the
screens switch off, they show a message to
this effect.
You can switch the screens back on. However, this will discharge the starter battery.
X
CD/DVD drive and AUX jacks
Switching the button lighting on/off
X Press button ; on the remote control
(Y page 520).
Depending on the previous status, the button lighting is switched on or off.
: CD/DVD slot
; AUX, right-hand (R) jack for audio signal
Point the remote control at the rear-compartment screen that has been selected for
remote operation.
X Press button : on the remote control
(Y page 520).
The respective rear screen switches on or
off.
i You can only switch the screens on using
the remote control if the ignition is
switched on.
i If you do not use the remote control for
about 15 seconds, the button lighting
switches off automatically.
Switching the sound on/off
X Press button B on the remote control
(Y page 520).
The sound is switched on/off.
(red)
= AUX, left-hand (L) jack for audio signal
(white)
? AUX, video (V) jack (yellow)
A CD/DVD eject button
The AUX jacks shown are for the AUX drive.
Identical connections can be found on the
right-hand side of the rear-compartment
screens (display AUX)(Y page 520).
Selecting a menu/menu item and confirming your selection
X Select a menu/menu item using the
=;9: buttons on the
remote control and press the 9 button to
confirm.
Z
521
COMAND Online
Rear Seat Entertainment System
Rear Seat Entertainment System
522
Cordless headphones
COMAND Online
Overview
:
;
=
?
A
X
Volume control
Selects a screen for the headphones
Battery compartment cover
Switches the cordless headphones on/off
Indicator lamp with various displays (Y page 523)
Open both sides of the headphones and adjust the fit of the headphones by pulling the
headphone band in the direction of the arrow.
Switching the cordless headphones
on/off
X
Press button :.
Depending on the previous status, the
headphones are switched on or off. To preserve the batteries, the headphones automatically switch off if they have not
received an audio signal for approximately
three minutes.
Rear Seat Entertainment System
Indicator lamp displays
The colour of the indicator lamp shows
whether the headphones are switched on or
off and indicates the charge level of the batteries inserted.
LED display
Status
Green
The batteries are fine.
Red
The batteries are almost discharged.
Lit continu- The headphones are switched
ously
on and connected to a screen.
Turn volume control : until the desired
volume has been set.
i If you have connected cordless headphones to a rear-compartment screen, you
can adjust the volume using the remote
control (Y page 520).
Flashing
The headphones are searching for the connection to a
screen.
Off (dark)
The headphones are switched
off or the batteries are discharged.
X
Selecting a screen for the headphones
Connecting additional headphones
You can connect one additional set of corded
headphones to each of the two rear-compartment screens (Y page 520). The socket is
designed for headphones with a 3.5 mm
stereo jack plug and an impedance of
32 ohms.
Replacing batteries
Notes
X
Move push slider : to L (left-hand screen)
or R (right-hand screen).
G WARNING
Batteries contain toxic and corrosive substances. If batteries are swallowed, it can result in
severe health problems. There is a risk of fatal
injury.
Keep batteries out of the reach of children. If
a battery is swallowed, seek medical attention
immediately.
H Environmental note
Dispose of used batteries in an environmentally responsible manner.
Z
COMAND Online
Adjusting the volume of the headphones
523
524
Rear Seat Entertainment System
COMAND Online
Batteries are required for the remote control
and for the two sets of cordless headphones.
The batteries can be replaced (Y page 523).
Only valid for South Africa
On the remote control
Remove discharged batteries A from the
tray.
X Insert the new batteries. Observe the polarity markings on the batteries and battery
compartment when doing so.
Left-hand battery: the positive pole (+)
must face upwards.
Right-hand battery: the positive pole (+)
must face downwards.
X To close the battery compartment:
insert battery compartment cover = starting with retaining lugs ? into the battery
compartment and allow catch tab ; to
engage in place.
X
On the cordless headphones
: Battery compartment cover
:
;
=
?
A
Battery compartment
Catch tab
Battery compartment cover
Retaining lugs
Batteries
The remote control contains 2 type AAA, 1.5 V
batteries.
X To open the battery compartment:
remove battery compartment cover = on
the back of the remote control.
X To do so, press down retaining lug ; and
take off battery compartment cover =.
The cordless headphones contain two type
AAA, 1.5 V batteries.
X To open the battery compartment: flip
battery compartment cover : upwards.
As you do so, hold the left-hand side of the
headphones as shown to prevent the batteries from falling out.
X Remove the discharged batteries from the
tray.
X Insert the new batteries. Observe the polarity markings on the batteries and battery
compartment when doing so.
Left-hand battery: the positive pole (+)
must face upwards.
Rear Seat Entertainment System
i The operating duration of the headphones
with a set of batteries is up to 40 hours.
Basic functions
Selecting sound settings
You can select the sound settings in the audio
CD/DVD/MP3, TV, video DVD and AUX
modes.
X Switch on an operating mode (e.g. audio
CD mode) (Y page 527).
X Select Treble or Bass using
the :=; buttons on the remote
control and press the 9 button to confirm.
An adjustment scale appears.
X Select a setting using the 9: buttons and press the 9 button to confirm.
Using headphones
Multiple users
You can use the cordless headphones supplied and/or up to two sets of corded headphones connected to the corresponding jack
of the rear-compartment screens
(Y page 520).
Information on the cordless headphones
(Y page 522).
Simultaneous use of the rear-compartment disc drive
The two rear-compartment screens can be
operated almost entirely independently from
one another. However, there can be a conflict
in some menus if the two screens are used
simultaneously.
If the rear-compartment disc drive is being
used for both screens simultaneously, selecting certain menus or settings on one of the
screens also affects the other screen.
The following functions affect both screens:
Using the main loudspeakers
This function is available in conjunction with
COMAND Online.
You can use the vehicle loudspeakers to listen to a disc inserted in the rear-compartment
drive. To do so, at least one of the rear-compartment screens must be set to disc mode.
X To set on COMAND Online: press the
$ function button to switch on an audio
mode.
X Select Audio by sliding ZV the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
The Audio menu appears.
X Select Rear by turning cVd the COMAND
controller and press W to confirm.
i The headphones' volume setting does not
affect the main loudspeakers.
Rchanging
playback options
Rselecting a track (from a track list or folder)
Rusing
the play, pause and stop functions
forwarding/rewinding or scrolling
Rcalling up the DVD menu and navigating
within it
Rsetting the language, subtitles and camera
angle
Rcalling up interactive DVD content
The following functions affect only one
screen:
Rfast
Raudio and video functions as well as picture
settings
Rswitching
menu
between full screen and the
Z
COMAND Online
Right-hand battery: the positive pole (+)
must face downwards.
X To close the battery compartment:
press the battery compartment cover
downwards until it engages into place.
If the batteries have been inserted correctly, the indicator lamp will light up green
when the headphones are switched on.
525
Rear Seat Entertainment System
526
Switching between operating modes
When you exit an operating mode (e.g. audio
CD mode), the current setting is saved. If you
call up this operating mode again later, there
are two possibilities:
COMAND Online
Rthe
operating mode has been changed on
the other screen.
Rthe operating mode has not been changed.
In the first case, the operating mode appears
as it is on the other screen.
In the second case, the setting appears on the
screen as it was when you last exited the
operating mode.
Picture settings
Overview
You can select the picture settings in TV,
video DVD and AUX mode (Y page 541).
Adjusting the brightness, contrast and
colour
X
In both cases, select TV or DVD-V using
the :=; buttons and press the
9 button to confirm.
Select Brightness
Brightness, Contrast or Colour
using the 9: buttons and press the
9 button to confirm.
An adjustment scale appears.
X Select a setting using the 9: buttons and press the 9 button to confirm.
X
Changing the picture format
X
To show the menu: press the 9 button on
the remote control.
or
Select Menu while the control menu is
shown (Y page 512) and press the 9 button to confirm.
X Select TV or DVD-V using
the :=; buttons and press the
9 button to confirm.
The dot in front of one of the menu items
16:9 optimised
optimised, 4:3 or Widescreen indicates the format currently selected.
X Select a format using the 9: buttons and press the 9 button to confirm.
X
System settings
Note
Example: TV mode
: Brightness, contrast and colour
; Picture formats
Switch on TV mode (Y page 531) or video
DVD mode (Y page 535).
X To show the menu: press the 9 button on
the remote control.
or
X Select Menu while the control menu is
shown (Y page 512) and press the 9 button to confirm.
X
You can adjust almost all system settings
individually for each screen without affecting
the other screen. You make these settings
using the remote control(Y page 520).
Selecting the display language
X
Select System using the 9=;
buttons on the remote control and press 9
to confirm.
You see the system menu on the selected
rear screen.
Rear Seat Entertainment System
X
Select a language using the 9: buttons and press the 9 button to confirm.
The Rear Seat Entertainment System activates the selected language.
X
Hiding/showing the picture
X
To hide the picture: select Display off
in the system menu using the :;
buttons on the remote control and press
the 9 button to confirm.
The picture is hidden.
X
To display the picture: press the 9 button.
Changing the display design
Select Settings in the system menu using
the : button on the remote control and
press the 9 button to confirm.
X Select Day design,
design Night design or
Automatic using the 9: buttons
and press the 9 button to confirm.
The dot indicates the current setting.
X
Design
Explanation
Day design
The display is set permanently to day
design.
Night design
The display is set permanently to night
design.
Automatic
The display design
changes depending on
the vehicle instrument
cluster illumination.
Setting the brightness
Select Settings in the system menu using
the : button on the remote control and
press the 9 button to confirm.
X Select Brightness using the 9:
buttons and press the 9 button to confirm.
A scale appears.
X
Adjust the brightness using the 9:
buttons and press the 9 button to confirm.
The brightness bar moves up or down. The
picture becomes lighter or darker in
accordance with the scale.
Audio CD/DVD and MP3 mode
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The CD/DVD drive is a class 1 laser product.
If you open the housing of the CD/DVD drive,
invisible laser beams may be released. These
laser beams may damage your retina. There is
a risk of injury.
You must not open the casing. Always have
maintenance work and repairs carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
General notes
You will find information on the following topics in the Audio section:
RNotes
on CDs/DVDs (Y page 480)
on MP3 mode (Y page 479)
RNotes on copyright (Y page 480)
RNotes
Z
COMAND Online
Select Settings using the : button
and press the 9 button to confirm.
X Select Language using the 9: buttons and press the 9 button to confirm.
The list of languages appears. A #dot indicates the current setting.
X
527
Rear Seat Entertainment System
528
Inserting a CD/DVD
Switching to audio CD, audio DVD or
MP3 mode
Insert a CD/DVD (Y page 528).
The Rear Seat Entertainment System loads
the inserted disc.
X Select Disc in the menu using the
9=; buttons on the remote
control and confirm by pressing the 9
button.
The corresponding mode is switched on.
The Rear Seat Entertainment System plays
the disc.
COMAND Online
X
: Disc slot
; Disc eject button
i Variable bit rates in MP3 tracks can result
in the elapsed time shown being different
to the actual elapsed time.
Depending on the vehicle model and equipment level, the CD/DVD drive is found:
Rbehind the centre console in a folding com-
partment, or
Runder the rear bench seat, or
Rin the stowage box between the rear seats.
The CD/DVD drive is a single disc drive. If
there is already a disc inserted, this must be
ejected before another is inserted.
X
Insert a disc into the disc slot.
The printed side of the disc must face
upwards. If neither side of the disc is printed, the side you wish to play must face
downwards.
The CD/DVD drive draws in the disc.
The CD/DVD drive plays the disc:
Rif
it has been inserted correctly and is a
permissible disc, and
Rafter you have switched on disc mode
(audio CD/audio DVD/MP3 mode)
(Y page 528).
Data on an MP3 CD first needs to be loaded by
the drive. Loading may take some time,
depending on the number of folders and
tracks.
Selecting a track
Selecting by skipping to a track
To skip forwards or backwards to a
track: press the = or ; button on
the remote control.
or
X Press the E or F button.
The skip forward function skips to the next
track.
If the elapsed track time has passed 8 seconds, the function skips back to the beginning of the track. If the elapsed time is
shorter, it will skip to the start of the previous track.
If the Random tracks or Random folder
playback option has been selected, the
track order is random.
X
Selecting by track list
In audio CD mode, the track list contains all
tracks on the disc currently playing.
In audio DVD mode, the track list contains all
tracks in the currently active group; see "Setting the audio format" (Y page 478).
In MP3 mode, the track list shows all tracks in
the currently active folder as well as the folder
structure, allowing you to select any track on
the MP3 CD.
Rear Seat Entertainment System
Select Track list (audio CD/DVD mode)
or Folder (MP3 mode) using
the :=; buttons on the remote
control, and confirm by pressing the 9
button.
or
X
Press the 9 button when the display/
selection window is active.
The track list appears. The # dot indicates
the current track.
X
Select a track using the 9: buttons
and press the 9 button to confirm.
Selecting a folder
This function is only available in MP3 mode.
Select Folder in MP3 mode using
the :=; buttons on the remote
control and press the 9 button to confirm.
or
X Press the 9 button when the display/
selection window is active.
The folder content appears.
X
COMAND Online
X
Making a selection by entering the track
number directly
X Press the h button on the remote control.
The track entry display appears.
Example: track 2
X
Press number button 2.
Example: track 12
X
Press the corresponding number keys in
rapid succession.
Wait for approximately three seconds after
making the entry.
You will hear the track that has been
entered. The corresponding basic menu
then reappears.
i It is not possible to enter numbers that
exceed the number of tracks on the CD or in
the currently active folder.
X
: Folder selection symbol
; Current folder name
= Track symbol
X
To switch to the superordinate folder:
select symbol : using the 9: buttons on the remote control and press the
9 button to confirm.
The display shows the next folder up.
Fast forward/rewind
X
With the display/selection window active,
press the = or ; button on the
remote control repeatedly until you reach
the desired position.
or
X
Press and hold the E or F button
until the desired position is reached.
529
: Folder selection symbol
; Folder symbol
Z
Rear Seat Entertainment System
530
X
Setting the audio format
Pause function
Further information on audio formats is available in the "Audio" section (Y page 478).
X Select DVD-A using the :=;
buttons on the remote control and press 9
to confirm.
X Select Group using the 9: buttons
and press the 9 button to confirm.
The list of available audio formats appears.
The # dot indicates the format currently
selected.
X Select an audio format using the 9:
buttons and press the 9 button to confirm.
X To exit the menu: press the = or ;
button.
COMAND Online
Select a folder using the 9: buttons
and press the 9 button to confirm.
You will see the tracks in the folder.
X Select a track using the 9: buttons
and press the 9 button to confirm.
The track is played and the corresponding
folder is now the active folder.
This function is only available in audio DVD
mode.
X To pause playback: select Ë using
the :=; buttons on the remote
control and press the 9 button to confirm.
The Ë display changes to Ì.
X
To continue playback: select Ì and
press the 9 button to confirm.
The Ì display changes to Ë.
Stop function
This function is only available in audio DVD
mode.
X To interrupt playback: select É using
the :=; buttons on the remote
control and press the 9 button to confirm.
The Ë display changes to Ì.
X To continue playback: select Ì and
press the 9 button to confirm.
Playback continues from the point where it
was interrupted.
X To stop playback: while playback is interrupted, select É again and press the 9
button to confirm.
Playback stops and returns to the beginning of the DVD. Ì is highlighted.
X
To restart playback: select Ì and
press the 9 button to confirm.
Playback starts from the beginning of the
DVD.
Playback options
Further information on playback options is
available in the "Audio" section (Y page 478).
X Select CD
CD, DVD-A or MP3 using
the :=; buttons on the remote
control and press the 9 button to confirm.
The options list appears. The # dot indicates the option currently selected.
Select Normal track sequence
sequence, Random
tracks or Random folder using the
9: buttons and press the 9 button
to confirm.
The option is switched on. For all options
except Normal track sequence,
sequence you will
see a corresponding display in the display/
selection window.
i If you switch the data carrier which you
are currently listening to, the Normal
track sequence option is activated automatically. If an option is selected, it
remains selected after the Rear Seat Entertainment System is switched on or off.
X
Switching track information on/off
(MP3 mode only)
If the function is switched on, folder and track
names are displayed.
Rear Seat Entertainment System
If the function is switched off, disc and file
names are displayed.
X Select MP3 using the :=; buttons on the remote control and press the
9 button to confirm.
X
Select Display track information
using the 9: buttons and press the
9 button to confirm.
The function is switched on O or off ª,
depending on the previous status.
A To show the menu
B Previous TV channel in the channel list
(channel name or number)
To show: press the 9 or : button on
the remote control.
X To hide: press the 9 or : button.
or
X After approximately eight seconds, the
menu is automatically hidden.
X
COMAND Online
Showing/hiding the menu
TV mode
General notes
Further information on channel reception
quality can be found in the "Video" section
(Y page 502).
Switching to TV mode
X
Select TV using the 9=; buttons on the remote control and press the
9 button to confirm.
You see the last TV channel selected, provided it can still be received.
Showing/hiding the control menu
531
Example: menu shown
: TV options
; Channel preset list
= Information about the current programme
? To switch on teletext
A Sound settings
X
To show: press the 9 button on the
remote control.
or
Select Menu while the control menu is
shown and press the 9 button to confirm.
X To hide: press the 9 button, select
Full screen and press the 9 button to
confirm.
X
Control menu displayed
: Preset position of the selected TV channel
; Selected TV channel/number
= Current programme
? Next TV channel in the channel list (chan-
nel name or number)
Z
Rear Seat Entertainment System
532
Selecting TV channels
COMAND Online
Selecting channels using the control
menu
X Press the = or ; button on the
remote control while the display window is
active.
or
X Press the E or F button.
The TV tuner selects the previous or next
channel from the alphabetical channel list.
Setting channels via the channel presets
X
or
X
X
To show the menu: press the 9 button on
the remote control.
or
X
Select Menu while the control menu is
shown and press the 9 button to confirm.
X
Select Presets using the =; buttons and press the 9 button to confirm.
The channel presets appear. The # dot
indicates where the selected channel is
currently stored.
X
Select a channel using the 9: buttons and press the 9 button to confirm.
or
X
Press a number button.
Setting a channel from the channel list
Notes on the channel list can be found in the
"Video" section (Y page 503). Information
regarding COMAND Online also applies to the
Rear Seat Entertainment System.
Select Menu while the control menu is
shown and press the 9 button to confirm.
Select TV using the =; buttons and
press the 9 button to confirm.
X Select Station list and press the 9
button to confirm.
The channel list appears. The # dot in
front of a list entry indicates the currently
selected channel. A number before the list
entry shows the memory slot in the channel
presets.
X
X
Example: station memory
To show the menu: press the 9 button on
the remote control.
Select a channel using the 9: buttons and press the 9 button to confirm.
Selecting channels by entering the channel and programme number
Several programmes can be transmitted on
one channel with digital TV. You can therefore
enter a channel and the desired programme
on this channel.
Only one programme can be transmitted on a
channel with analogue TV. The programme
entry function therefore has no effect.
X To show the menu: press the 9 button on
the remote control.
or
X Select Menu while the control menu is
shown and press the 9 button to confirm.
X
Option 1: select TV using the =;
buttons and press the 9 button to confirm.
X
Select Channel entry and press the 9
button to confirm.
X
Option 2: press the h button while the
TV is playing.
Irrespective of the option, an input bar
appears at the top of the screen.
Rear Seat Entertainment System
To set a channel: enter the channel number using the number keys and press the 9
button to confirm.
or
X
Press and hold the number key until the
entry line is hidden.
The channel is set.
i If you have not entered a programme
number, the first programme with adequate reception will be set for a digital
channel.
i You can enter channels or programmes
available in your country even if the reception is currently not adequate.
If you enter channels that are either not
intended for or not allowed in your country,
the Invalid channel number message
appears.
Storing TV channels
Storing channels manually
There are ten preset positions available.
X To show the menu: press the 9 button on
the remote control or confirm Menu by
pressing the 9 button while the control
menu is shown.
X
X
Select Presets using the =; buttons and press the 9 button to confirm.
The channel presets appear. The # dot
indicates under which preset the currently
selected channel is stored.
To store a channel: select a preset using
the 9: buttons and press and hold
the 9 button until you hear a tone.
or
X
Press and hold a number button until you
hear a tone.
The TV picture then reappears.
reception quality. Any channels stored manually in the preset memory will be lost.
X To show the menu: press the 9 button on
the remote control or confirm Menu by
pressing the 9 button while the control
menu is shown.
Select Presets using the =; buttons and press the 9 button to confirm.
X Select Autostore and press the 9 button
to confirm.
The Rear Seat Entertainment System
searches for channels it can receive. The
available channels are automatically stored
in the preset positions.
X
Information about the current programme
This function is only available on digital TV
channels. If you are watching an analogue TV
channel, this menu cannot be selected.
X To show the menu: press the 9 button on
the remote control or confirm Menu by
pressing the 9 button while the control
menu is shown.
X
Select Info using the =; buttons
and press the 9 button to confirm.
If the current TV channel provides the corresponding information, this will be displayed.
i It can take a few seconds for the information to be displayed.
Displaying the current programme or
programme preview
This function is only available on digital TV
channels. The programme preview is also
referred to as the electronic programme
guide (EPG).
Storing channels automatically
This function automatically stores channels
with adequate reception in order of their
Z
COMAND Online
X
533
Rear Seat Entertainment System
534
= Beginning and end of the programme
? Title of the next programme
A Current channel
To show the programme preview: select
Display programme preview and press
the 9 button to confirm.
The channel list shows the channel's next
programme.
X To show the current programme: select
Display current programme and press
the 9 button to confirm.
X To close the display: press the % button.
COMAND Online
X
Example: current programme
: Alphabetical browser
; Channel name
= To display the programme preview
? Visual display of the elapsed programme
time (if this information is broadcast)
A Title of the current programme
B Current channel
X
To show the menu: press the 9 button on
the remote control or confirm Menu by
pressing the 9 button while the control
menu is shown.
Select TV using the =; buttons and
press the 9 button to confirm.
X Select Station list and press the 9
button to confirm.
The channel list appears. It shows the current programme on the digital TV channels
with adequate reception. The # dot in
front of a list entry indicates the currently
selected channel.
X
Basic TV settings
Fixing the frequency
Further information on this function is available in the "Video" section (Y page 507).
X To show the menu: press the 9 button on
the remote control or confirm Menu by
pressing the 9 button while the control
menu is shown.
Select TV using the =; buttons and
press the 9 button to confirm.
X Select Channel fix and press the 9 button to confirm.
The function is switched on O or off ª,
depending on the previous status. When
the function is switched on, FIX appears in
the display window.
X To exit the menu: press the = or ;
button.
X
Setting the reception region
Further information on this function is available in the "Video" section (Y page 507).
X To show the menu: press the 9 button on
the remote control or confirm Menu by
pressing the 9 button while the control
menu is shown.
Example: programme preview
: To display the current programme
; Channel name
Rear Seat Entertainment System
Teletext
Switching teletext on/off
X To show the menu: press the 9 button on
the remote control.
or
X Select Menu while the control menu is
shown and press the 9 button to confirm.
To switch on: select Text using the
=; buttons and press the 9 button
to confirm.
The first teletext page is displayed.
X To switch off: press the % back button.
X
Selecting a teletext page
X To select a page directly: press the corresponding number keys on the remote
control.
X To call up the previous/next page: press
the 9 or : button.
i You can only enter pages that are permissible for teletext between 100 and 899.
Dynamic teletext page
A dynamic teletext page consists of several
subpages. The display automatically changes
to the next page after a certain time.
Video DVD mode
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The CD/DVD drive is a class 1 laser product.
If you open the housing of the CD/DVD drive,
invisible laser beams may be released. These
laser beams may damage your retina. There is
a risk of injury.
You must not open the casing. Always have
maintenance work and repairs carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
General notes
DVD playback requirements
You may encounter playback problems when
playing copied discs. There are a large variety
of discs, DVD authoring software, writing
software and writers available. This variety
means that there is no guarantee that the
Rear Seat Entertainment System will be able
to play video DVDs that you have copied yourself.
Other information can be found under Video
(Y page 511). Information regarding
COMAND Online also applies to the Rear Seat
Entertainment System.
Function restrictions
Depending on the DVD, it is possible that certain functions or actions described in this
section will be temporarily blocked or may not
function at all. As soon as you try to activate
these functions or actions, you will see the K
symbol in the display.
Z
COMAND Online
Select TV using the =; buttons and
press the 9 button to confirm.
X Select TV standard and press the 9 button to confirm.
A list appears showing the reception
regions. The # dot in front of a list entry
indicates the currently selected reception
area or country.
X Select the reception area and press the 9
button to confirm.
A message appears to inform you that if the
wrong country is set, correct reception will
not be possible.
X Select Yes or No and press the 9 button to
confirm.
If you select Yes
Yes, the Rear Seat Entertainment System switches the country.
If you select No
No, the country list will appear
again.
X
535
Rear Seat Entertainment System
536
Switching to video DVD mode
Insert a video DVD (Y page 528).
The Rear Seat Entertainment System loads
the disc.
If disc mode was the last mode selected, it
will now be active.
If it was not, switch on video DVD mode as
described in the following instructions.
X Select Disc in the menu using the
9=; buttons on the remote
control and confirm by pressing the 9
button.
If the video DVD fulfils the playback criteria:
the film either starts automatically or the
menu saved on the DVD appears. If the
DVD menu appears, you must start the film
manually.
X Select the corresponding menu item in the
DVD menu.
Showing/hiding the menu
COMAND Online
X
Showing/hiding the control menu
Example: menu shown
: Video DVD options
; Pause function
= Stop function
? Media media selection
A Sound settings
X
To show: press the 9 button on the
remote control.
or
X
Select Menu while the control menu is
shown and press the 9 button to confirm.
X
To hide: press the 9 button, select
Full screen and press the 9 button to
confirm.
Fast forward/rewind
X
Control menu displayed
: Data medium type
; Current track
= Current scene
? Track time
A To show the menu
X
To show: press the 9 or : button on
the remote control.
X
To hide: press the 9 or : button.
or
X
Wait for approximately 8 seconds.
Press and hold the E or F button on
the remote control until the desired position has been reached.
You see the control menu.
Pause function
X
To show the menu: press the 9 button on
the remote control.
or
X
Select Menu while the control menu is
shown and press the 9 button to confirm.
X
To pause playback: select Ë and press
the 9 button to confirm.
The Ë display changes to Ì.
Rear Seat Entertainment System
To continue playback: select Ì and
press the 9 button to confirm.
The menu is hidden.
Stop function
X
To show the menu: press the 9 button on
the remote control.
or
X
Option 2: while the film is playing, press
the 9 button on the remote control and
show the menu.
X Select DVD-V and press the 9 button to
confirm.
X Select DVD functions and press the 9
button to confirm.
X Select Scene selection and press the 9
button to confirm.
X Select 5 using the 9 or : button and
press the 9 button to confirm.
In both cases, playback will begin from the
5th scene/chapter after a brief pause.
X
Select Menu while the control menu is
shown and press the 9 button to confirm.
To interrupt playback: select É and
press the 9 button to confirm.
The Ë display changes to Ì. The
video image is hidden.
X To continue playback: select Ì and
press the 9 button to confirm.
Playback continues from the point where it
was interrupted. The menu is hidden.
X To stop playback: while playback is interrupted, select É again and press the 9
button to confirm.
Playback stops and returns to the beginning of the DVD. Ì is highlighted.
X
X
Selecting a scene/chapter directly
The examples illustrate how to select scene/
chapter 5.
X Option 1: while the film is playing, press
the h button on the remote control.
X Press the corresponding number key, such
as 5.
To restart playback: select Ì and
press the 9 button to confirm.
Playback starts from the beginning of the
DVD.
Selecting a film/title
Option 1:
Press the 9 button on the remote control
and show the menu.
X Select DVD-V and press the 9 button on
the remote control to confirm.
X
Selecting a scene/chapter
General notes
Also observe the information on the video
DVD mode (Y page 513).
Skipping forwards/backwards
Press the = or ; button on the
remote control.
or
X Press the E or F button.
The control menu (Y page 512) appears for
approximately eight seconds.
X
Select DVD functions and press the 9
button to confirm.
X Select Title selection and press the 9
button to confirm.
X
Z
COMAND Online
X
537
Rear Seat Entertainment System
538
To call up the selection list: press the 9
button.
X Select a film/track.
remote control and press the 9 button to
confirm.
A menu appears.
X
Option 2:
Example: selecting film 2
X
Press button 2.
After a brief pause, the second film is
played.
COMAND Online
DVD menu
Calling up the DVD menu
The DVD menu is the menu stored on the DVD
itself. It is structured in various ways according to the individual DVD and permits certain
actions and settings.
In the case of multi-language DVDs, for example, you can change the DVD language in the
DVD menu.
X Press the 9 button on the remote control
and show the menu.
X Select DVD-V and press the 9 button on
the remote control to confirm.
X Select DVD functions and press the 9
button to confirm.
X Select Menu and press the 9 button to
confirm.
The DVD menu appears.
Selecting menu items in the DVD menu
X
Select a menu item using the
9:=; buttons on the
Confirm Select by pressing the 9 button.
The Rear Seat Entertainment System carries out the action or shows a submenu.
X If available, additional options can now be
selected.
The Rear Seat Entertainment System then
switches back to the DVD menu.
X
i Menu items that cannot be selected are
shown in grey.
i Depending on the DVD, the menu items:
Back (to the movie)
movie), Play
Play, Stop
Stop, E,
F or Go up may either not function at all
or may not function at certain points in the
DVD menu. To indicate this, the K symbol
appears in the display.
Stopping a film or skipping to the beginning or end of a scene
X Select any menu item from the DVD menu.
The menu appears.
X To stop the film: select the Stop menu
item and press the 9 button on the remote
control to confirm.
X To skip to the end of a scene: select the
F menu item and press the 9 button to
confirm.
X To skip to the beginning of a scene:
select the E menu item and press the
9 button to confirm.
Moving up one level in the DVD menu
X Show the DVD menu.
X Press the % back button on the remote
control or select the corresponding menu
item in the DVD menu.
or
X Select any menu item in the DVD menu and
press W the COMAND controller to confirm.
X Select Go up and press W to confirm.
Rear Seat Entertainment System
Select DVD functions and press the 9
button to confirm.
X Select Subtitles or Camera angle and
press the 9 button to confirm.
In both cases, a menu appears after a few
seconds. The # dot in front of an entry
indicates the current setting.
X Select a setting using the 9: buttons and press the 9 button to confirm.
X
X
Setting the audio format
This function is not available on all DVDs. If it
is available, you can set the audio language or
the audio format. The number of settings is
dependent on the DVD content. It may also be
possible to access the settings from the DVD
menu.
X Press the 9 button on the remote control
and show the menu.
X Select DVD-V and press the 9 button on
the remote control to confirm.
X Select DVD functions and press the 9
button to confirm.
X Select Audio language and press the 9
button to confirm.
A menu appears after a short while. The #
dot in front of an entry indicates the currently selected language.
X Select a language using the 9: buttons and press the 9 button to confirm.
X
To exit the menu: press the = or ;
button.
Subtitles and camera angle
These functions are not available on all DVDs.
The number of subtitle languages and camera
angles available depends on the content of
the DVD. It may also be possible to access the
settings from the DVD menu.
X Press the 9 button on the remote control
and show the menu.
X Select DVD-V and press the 9 button on
the remote control to confirm.
To exit the menu: press the = or ;
button.
Interactive content
DVDs may also contain interactive content
(e.g. a video game). In a video game, you may
be able to influence events, for example, by
selecting and triggering actions. The type and
number of actions depend on the DVD.
X Select an action using the
9;:= buttons on the
remote control and press the 9 button to
execute it.
A menu appears and the first entry, Select
Select,
is highlighted.
X Press the 9 button.
Active COMAND source mode
Switching the function on/off in
COMAND Online
You can transfer an audio or video source
selected in COMAND Online to the Rear Seat
Entertainment System. If you subsequently
switch modes in COMAND Online, the new
source will not be transmitted to the Rear
Seat Entertainment System.
X To switch on the function in COMAND
Online: switch to the desired audio mode in
COMAND Online, e.g. CD mode
(Y page 472), or show the menu in video
DVD mode (Y page 512).
X Select the menu item at the bottom left,
e.g. CD in audio CD mode, by sliding VÆ
Z
COMAND Online
Going back to the film
Press the % button repeatedly until you
see the movie.
or
X Select any menu item in the DVD menu and
press the 9 button to confirm.
X Select the Back (to the movie) menu
item in the menu and press the 9 button to
confirm.
X
539
Rear Seat Entertainment System
540
COMAND Online
and turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
X
Select Active audio/video source in
rear and press W to confirm.
In the status bar at the top, you will see the
headphones symbol and the _ symbol for
the source that has been switched on.
X To switch off the function in COMAND
Online: switch on the desired audio mode
in COMAND Online or show the menu in
video DVD mode.
X Select the menu item at the bottom left,
e.g. CD in audio CD mode, by sliding VÆ
and turning cVd the COMAND controller
and press W to confirm.
X
Select Rear audio/video off _ and
press W the COMAND controller to confirm.
Selecting an active COMAND source in
the rear-compartment screen
Loading the active COMAND source
X
Select COMAND using the 9=;
buttons on the remote control and press 9
to confirm.
The audio or video source selected in
COMAND Online is loaded in the Rear Seat
Entertainment System.
When the loading process is complete, the
audio or video source is set in the Rear Seat
Entertainment System.
If Rear audio/video off is activated in
COMAND, the COMAND is off or there
is no active COMAND source message
appears.
Audio CD mode
X To select by skipping to a track: press
the = or ; button.
or
X Press the E or F button.
The skip forward function skips to the next
track.
If the elapsed track time has exceeded 8
seconds, the function skips back to the
beginning of the track.
If the elapsed track time is less than 8 seconds, the function skips back to the beginning of the previous track.
Additional setting option:
RAdjusting
the sound settings (Y page 525)
Audio DVD mode
X To skip to the next/previous group:
press the : button on the remote control.
X To select K L: highlight using the
= or ; button and press 9.
Additional setting option:
RAdjusting
the sound settings (Y page 525)
i Information on groups can be found in the
"Setting the audio format" section
(Y page 478).
Rear Seat Entertainment System
To select a folder: press the : button
on the remote control.
X Highlight one of the two folder symbols
with the = or ; button and press 9
to confirm.
Depending on your selection, the previous
or next folder is selected and the first track
is played.
X
Additional setting option:
RAdjusting
the sound settings (Y page 525)
Video DVD mode
X To hide a menu: confirm Menu with the 9
button.
The video image is played in full screen
mode.
Additional setting options:
RAdjusting
the brightness, contrast and colour (Y page 526)
RChanging the picture format (Y page 526)
RAdjusting the sound settings (Y page 525)
AUX mode
Introduction
You can connect one external video source to
each of the displays of the Rear Seat Entertainment System (AUX display) and also one
external video source to the rear-compart-
ment drive (AUX drive) with a sound and video
signal.
Please see the corresponding operating
instructions for information on how to operate the external video source.
For further details about external video sources, please consult a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
Connecting AUX equipment
AUX drive
The AUX drive jacks are located on the
CD/DVD drive on the right next to the
CD/DVD eject button (Y page 521).
AUX display
The AUX display jacks are on the side of the
screen (Y page 520).
Audio and video connection
X Insert the audio plugs for the left and right
signals into the corresponding L and R
jacks.
X
Insert the video plug into the V jack.
Switching to AUX mode
AUX drive
X Select Aux in the menu using the
9=; buttons on the remote
control and press the 9 button to confirm.
The AUX menu appears.
Select Source from the AUX menu and
press the 9 button to confirm.
X Select Disc drive Aux and press the 9
button to confirm.
You will hear and see the content of the
external video source if it is connected to
the CD/DVD drive and switched to playback. If no video image is available from the
AUX source connected, you will see an
audio menu.
X
Z
COMAND Online
MP3 mode
X To select a track by skipping to a track:
press the = or ; button on the
remote control.
or
X Press the E or F button.
The skip forward function skips to the next
track.
If the elapsed track time has exceeded 8
seconds, the function skips back to the
beginning of the track.
If the elapsed track time is less than 8 seconds, the function skips back to the beginning of the previous track.
541
Rear Seat Entertainment System
COMAND Online
542
AUX display
X Select a screen using the thumbwheel on
the remote control (Y page 520) until "L
REAR" (left-hand screen) or "R REAR" (righthand screen) is highlighted in the window.
X Select Aux in the menu using the
9=; buttons on the remote
control and press the 9 button to confirm.
X Select Source from the AUX menu and
press the 9 button to confirm.
X Select Display Aux and press the 9 button to confirm.
You will see and hear the content of the
video source if it is switched to playback. If
no video image is available from the AUX
source connected, you will see an audio
menu.
Setting treble and bass
Select Treble or Bass in the AUX menu
and press the 9 button on the remote
control to confirm.
An adjustment scale appears.
X Select a setting using the 9 or :
button and press the 9 button to confirm.
X
Adjusting the brightness, contrast or
colour
Select Display Aux or Disc drive Aux in
the AUX menu and press the 9 button to
confirm.
X Select Brightness
Brightness, Contrast or Colour
and press the 9 button to confirm.
An adjustment scale appears.
X Select a setting using the 9 or :
button and press the 9 button to confirm.
X
Changing the picture format
Select Display Aux or Disc drive Aux in
the AUX menu and press the 9 button to
confirm.
X Select 16:9 optimised,
optimised 4:3 or Wide‐
screen using the 9: buttons and
press the 9 button to confirm.
The dot in front of a menu item indicates
the current setting.
X
543
Useful information ............................ 544
Stowage areas .................................. 544
Stowing and features
Features ............................................. 548
544
Stowage areas
Useful information
Glove compartment
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
Stowing and features
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 34).
Stowage areas
Stowage spaces
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you do not correctly store objects in the
vehicle interior, they can slip or be flung
around, thus striking vehicle occupants.
There is a risk of injury, especially when braking or abruptly changing directions.
RAlways store objects so that they cannot be
flung around in these or in similar situations.
RAlways make sure that objects do not protrude from stowage compartments, luggage nets or stowage nets.
RClose lockable stowage compartments
while driving.
RStow and secure objects that are heavy,
hard, pointy, sharp-edged, fragile or too
large in the boot.
To open: pull handle : and open glove
compartment flap ;.
X To close: fold glove compartment flap ;
upwards until it engages.
X
In the glove compartment, there is a coin
holder, a map holder and a pen holder.
i The glove compartment can be ventilated
(Y page 150).
The glove compartment can be locked and
unlocked using the emergency key element.
X To lock: insert the emergency key element
into the lock and turn it to position 2.
X To unlock: insert the emergency key element into the lock and turn it to position
1.
Stowage areas
X
To open: press button ;.
Armrest : opens.
In the stowage compartment, there are a
stowage tray and a mobile phone bracket.
i Depending on the vehicle equipment, a
12 V power socket, USB port or a Media
Interface is installed in the stowage compartment. Media Interface is a universal
interface for mobile audio equipment, e.g.
for an iPod® or MP3 player (Y page 494).
Spectacles compartment
Stowage compartment in the centre
console
To open: press the trim element on
cover :.
X To remove the rubber mat: grasp the tabs
on the rubber mat and pull up to remove.
X To insert the rubber mat: press the rubber mat into the housing.
X To close: swing cover : downwards until
it engages.
X
You can remove the rubber mat from the
stowage compartment to clean it. Clean it
with clean, lukewarm water only.
Depending on the vehicle's equipment, there
is a cup holder and an ashtray in the centre
console stowage compartment.
Umbrella holder
X
To open: press marking :.
Spectacles compartment ; opens.
Make sure that the spectacles compartment
is always closed while the vehicle is in motion.
Example: vehicle side, left
There are umbrella holders in the door stowage compartments on both sides of the vehicle. One compact umbrella can be stowed per
side.
Z
Stowing and features
Stowage compartment/telephone
compartment under the armrest
545
Stowage areas
546
To remove: grab strap ; and pull umbrella
holder : out of the stowage compartment
in the direction of the arrow.
X To insert: push umbrella holder : in the
opposite direction to the arrow, into the
stowage compartment until it engages.
X
Stowing and features
You can remove the umbrella holder to clean
it. Wash it with clean, lukewarm water only.
Stowage compartment in the rear
centre console
There is a stowage compartment in the rear
on the left-hand side only.
X Open the seat belt guide and remove the
seat belt (Y page 115).
X Move the left-hand front seat forwards
(Y page 115) and fold the backrest forwards.
X To open: press release button ;.
Cover : folds upwards.
X To close: fold down cover : and let it
engage.
X Fold the backrest of the left-hand front seat
back and move the seat backwards
(Y page 115).
X Route the seat belt back through the seat
belt guide.
Stowage net
X
To open: slide cover : in the direction of
the arrow.
On vehicles equipped with a fire extinguisher,
the fire extinguisher is fitted in the stowage
compartment (Y page 577).
On vehicles equipped with a bottle holder, the
bottle holder is located in the stowage compartment (Y page 549).
Stowage compartment in the rear compartment
There is a stowage net : in the frontpassenger footwell.
Loading aid in the boot
Raising/lowering the roof
G WARNING
Body parts can become trapped when the roof
is being raised or lowered. There is a risk of
injury.
When raising or lowering the roof, make sure
that no parts of the body are in the vicinity of
moving parts. Press the switch again if someone becomes trapped.
Stowage areas
547
! Only close the boot once the roof is low-
Stowing and features
ered completely. Otherwise, you could
damage the roof.
To make it easier to load your luggage, you
can raise the stowed roof after you have
opened the boot lid.
You can only raise roof ; if boot separator
= is closed and the boot lid is opened completely.
To raise the roof: press switch :.
The roof is raised slightly. Switch : lights
up brightly.
X Slide boot separator = back (Y page 106).
X
You can only lower roof ; if boot separator
= is closed and the boot lid is opened completely.
To lower the roof: close the boot separator (Y page 106).
X Press switch :.
The roof is lowered slightly. Switch :
lights up dimly.
X
Vehicles with boot lid remote closing feature: when the boot lid is opened, the loading
aid rises automatically. It lowers automatically when the boot lid is closed.
Z
Features
548
Problems with the loading aid
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
It is no longer possible
to lower the stowed
roof in the boot using
the loading aid.
You cannot close the boot any more.
X Call a qualified specialist workshop.
Stowing and features
Stowage well under the boot floor
To open: open boot separator
= (Y page 106).
X Swing boot floor ? up by loop ;.
X Pull hook with Velcro attachment : off the
underside of boot floor ?.
X Attach hook with Velcro attachment : to
boot separator = by its handle.
X
The TIREFIT kit, tyre-change tool kit, etc. are
located in the stowage compartment.
Features
Cup holders
Important safety notes
! Only use the cup holders for containers of
the right size and which have lids. The
drinks could otherwise spill.
Cup holder in the centre console
To open: open stowage compartment
=(Y page 545).
X To remove the insert: slide catches :
inwards in the direction of the arrow.
X Remove the cup holder insert upwards.
X To refit the insert: place the insert in stowage compartment =.
X Slide catches : outwards in the direction
of the arrow until they engage.
X
You can remove the rubber mat of the cup
holder to clean it. Wash it with clean, lukewarm water only.
Reducer ; can be removed. In this way, you
can place large and small containers in the
cup holder.
X To remove: grip reducer ; and pull out
upwards in the direction of the arrow.
X To insert: place reducer ; into the cup
holder and push it downwards against the
direction of the arrow to the stop.
Features
Bottle holders
Observe the "Important safety notes" in the
"Stowage compartments" section
(Y page 544).
549
? Vanity mirror
A Mirror cover
Vanity mirror in the sun visor
Mirror light : only functions if the sun visor
is clipped into retainer ; and mirror cover A
has been folded up.
To open: open the stowage compartment
(Y page 546).
X To remove the insert: slide catches :
inwards in the direction of the arrow.
X Lift bottle holder insert ; up and remove.
X To refit the insert: place insert ; in the
stowage compartment.
X Slide catches : outwards in the direction
of the arrow until they engage.
X
The bottle holder does not secure bottles; it
merely prevents them from tipping over.
Fold down sun visor :.
X Pull sun visor : out of retainer ;.
X Swing sun visor : to the side.
X Slide sun visor : horizontally as required.
X
Ashtray
Sun visors
Overview
: Mirror light
; Bracket
= Retaining strip, e.g. for a car park ticket
Z
Stowing and features
Glare from the side
Features
550
To open: open stowage compartment :
(Y page 545).
X To remove the insert: pull insert ; up in
the direction of the arrow, out of the cup
holder.
X To refit the insert: push insert ; on the
left-hand side into the cup holder.
X
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 155).
X To open: open stowage compartment :
under the armrest (Y page 545).
X Press in cigarette lighter ;.
Cigarette lighter ; will pop out automatically when the heating element is red-hot.
X
i Only refit insert ; on the left-hand side of
Stowing and features
the cup holder.
Cigarette lighter
12 V sockets
General notes
X
G WARNING
You can burn yourself if you touch the hot
heating element or the socket of the cigarette
lighter.
In addition, flammable materials can ignite if:
Rthe
hot cigarette lighter falls
child holds the hot cigarette lighter to
objects, for example
There is a risk of fire and injury.
Always hold the cigarette lighter by the knob.
Always make sure that the cigarette lighter is
out of reach of children. Never leave children
unattended in the vehicle.
Ra
Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 155).
The sockets can be used for accessories with
a maximum draw of 180 W (15 A). Accessories include such items as bulbs or chargers
for mobile phones.
If you use the sockets for long periods when
the engine is switched off, the battery may
discharge.
i An emergency cut-off ensures that the onboard voltage does not drop too low. If the
on-board voltage is too low, the power to
the sockets is automatically cut. This
ensures that there is sufficient power to
start the engine.
Socket in the front-passenger footwell
Your attention must always be focused on the
traffic conditions. Only use the cigarette
lighter when road and traffic conditions permit.
X
Lift up the cover of socket :.
Features
Open stowage compartment : under the
armrest (Y page 545).
X Lift up the cover of socket ;.
X
Socket in the boot
driving when operating mobile communications equipment in the vehicle.
If it is permitted by law to operate communications equipment while the vehicle is in
motion, you may only do so if the traffic situation permits. You may otherwise be distracted from the traffic conditions, cause
an accident and injure yourself and others.
Excessive levels of electromagnetic radiation
may cause damage to your health and to the
health of others. The use of an exterior aerial
takes into consideration the scientific discussion surrounding the possible health risk
posed by electromagnetic fields.
Mercedes-Benz recommends the use of an
approved exterior aerial. This ensures:
Roptimal
mobile phone reception quality in
the vehicle
Rthat mutual interference between the vehicle electronics and mobile phones is minimised
An exterior aerial has the following advantages:
Rit conducts the electromagnetic fields gen-
erated by a wireless device to the exterior
field strength in the vehicle interior is
lower than in a vehicle that does not have
an exterior aerial
Information on retrofitting two-way radios
and mobile phones (RF transmitters)
(Y page 620).
Rthe
X
Lift up the cover of socket :.
Mobile phone
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating mobile communications equipment while driving distracts you from paying
attention to traffic conditions. This could also
cause you to lose control of the vehicle. There
is a risk of an accident.
Use this device only when the vehicle is stationary.
General notes
There are various mobile phone brackets that
may be fitted in your vehicle; in some cases,
these are country-specific.
You can connect a Bluetooth®-capable
mobile phone with COMAND Online through
the Bluetooth® interface. This also applies if
your vehicle is equipped with convenience
telephony.
i You must observe the legal requirements
for the country in which you are currently
Z
Stowing and features
Socket under the armrest
551
552
Features
More information on suitable mobile phones,
mobile phone brackets and on connecting
Bluetooth®-capable mobile phones with
COMAND Online can be obtained:
Charge maintenance socket
Rat
your Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
the Internet at http://www.mercedesbenz.com/connect
Ron
i The functions and services available when
Stowing and features
you use the phone depend on your mobile
phone model and service provider.
Using a mobile phone
If the mobile phone is inserted in the mobile
phone bracket, the mobile phone will be
charged and connected with the exterior aerial.
X Open the telephone compartment
(Y page 545).
X Place the mobile phone bracket into the
pre-installed fitting; see the separate installation instructions for the mobile phone fitting.
X Insert the mobile phone into the mobile
phone bracket; see the separate installation instructions for the mobile phone fitting.
Operating the mobile phone
You can operate the telephone using the
6 and ~ buttons on the multifunction
steering wheel. You can operate other mobile
phone functions via the on-board computer
(Y page 235).
When you remove the key from the ignition
lock, the mobile phone is disconnected from
the hands-free system. Active calls will first
be transferred to the mobile phone directly.
The battery may drain if the vehicle is left stationary for long periods. In this case,
Mercedes-Benz recommends attaching the
trickle charger to charge maintenance
socket :.
Charge maintenance socket : is designed
solely for connecting a trickle charger. A
trickle charger can be obtained from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, for example.
X Switch the ignition off.
X Open the boot lid.
X Open the stowage well under the boot floor
(Y page 548).
X Remove the boot tub using the handle.
X Connect the trickle charger to charge maintenance socket :. Consult the manufacturer's operating instructions on how to do
so.
The boot lid can be closed, even if a trickle
charger is connected. Make sure that the
connector for both the connector cables is
outside of the vehicle.
The connector can then separate if the vehicle is moved, even if you forget to disconnect
the connector cables. This prevents damaging the cables and the trickle charger.
i A trickle charger connected to charge
maintenance socket only maintains the
current charge level of the vehicle's electrical system battery. If the vehicle's electrical system battery is discharged, it needs
to be charged with a battery charger. You
Features
Garage door opener
General notes
The HomeLink® garage door opener integrated in the rear-view mirror allows you to operate up to three different door and gate systems.
Once programmed, the integrated garage
door opener in the rear-view mirror will
assume the function of the garage door system's remote control. Please also read the
operating instructions for the garage door
system.
When programming a garage door opener,
park the vehicle outside the garage. Do not
run the engine while programming.
The garage door opener is only available for
certain countries. Observe the legal requirements for each individual country.
The HomeLink® garage door opener is compatible with most European garage and gate
opener drives. More information on HomeLink® and/or compatible products is available:
Rat a qualified specialised workshop
Rvia the HomeLink® Hotline
(0) 08000 466 354 65 or alternatively
+49 (0) 6838 907-277
Ron the Internet at
http://www.homelink.com
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When you operate or program the garage door
with the integrated garage door opener, persons in the range of movement of the garage
door can become trapped or struck by the
garage door. There is a risk of injury.
When using the integrated garage door
opener, always make sure that nobody is
within the range of movement of the garage
door.
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Inhaling
these exhaust gases leads to poisoning. There
is a risk of fatal injury. Therefore never leave
the engine running in enclosed spaces without sufficient ventilation.
Programming
Programming buttons
Pay attention to the "Important safety notes"
(Y page 553).
Integrated garage door opener in the rear-view mirror
Garage door remote control A is not included with the integrated garage door opener.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 155).
X Select one of buttons ; to ? to use to
control the garage door drive.
X To start programming mode: press and
hold one of buttons ; to ? of the integrated garage door opener.
The garage door opener is now in programming mode. After a short time, indicator
lamp : begins to light up yellow.
Indicator lamp : lights up yellow immediately the first time button ;, = or ? is
programmed. If the selected button has
already been programmed, indicator
Z
Stowing and features
will find further information on charging the
battery on (Y page 582).
553
Stowing and features
554
Features
lamp : lights up yellow after ten seconds
have elapsed.
X Release button ;, = or ?. Indicator
lamp : flashes yellow.
X To program the remote control: point
garage door remote control A towards
buttons ; to ? on the rear-view mirror at
a distance of 5 to 20 cm.
X Press and hold button B on remote control
A until indicator lamp : lights up green.
When indicator lamp : lights up green:
programming is finished.
When indicator lamp : flashes green: programming was successful. The next step is
to synchronise the rolling code.
X Release button B of remote control A of
the garage door drive.
If indicator lamp : lights up red: repeat the
programming process for the corresponding button on the rear-view mirror. When
doing so, vary the distance between remote
control A and the rear-view mirror.
The required distance between remote
control A and the integrated garage door
opener depends on the garage door drive
system. Several attempts may be required.
You should test every position for at least
25 seconds before trying another position.
Synchronising the rolling code
Pay attention to the "Important safety notes"
(Y page 553).
If the garage door system uses a rolling code,
you will also have to synchronise the garage
door system with the integrated garage door
opener in the rear-view mirror. To do this you
will need to use the programming button on
the door drive control panel. Depending on
the manufacturer, the location of the programming button may vary. It is usually located on the door drive unit on the garage ceiling.
Familiarise yourself with the garage door
drive operating instructions, e.g. under "Programming of additional remote controls",
before carrying out the following steps.
Your vehicle must be within range of the
garage door or exterior gate drive. Make sure
that neither your vehicle nor any persons/
objects are present within the sweep of the
door or gate.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 155).
X Get out of the vehicle.
X Press the programming button on the door
drive unit.
Usually, you now have 30 seconds to initiate the next step.
X Get into the vehicle.
X Press previously programmed button ;,
= or ? of the integrated garage door
opener until the door closes.
The rolling code synchronisation is then
complete.
Problems when programming
If you have problems when programming the
integrated garage door opener, please note
the following:
RCheck
the transmitter frequency used by
garage door drive remote control A and
whether it is supported. The transmitter
frequency can usually be found on the back
of the garage door drive remote control.
RReplace the batteries in garage door
remote control A. This increases the likelihood that garage door remote control A
will transmit a strong and precise signal to
the integrated garage door opener in the
rear-view mirror.
RWhen programming, hold remote control
A at varying distances and angles from the
button which you are programming. Try various angles at a distance between 5and
30 cm or at the same angle but at varying
distances.
RIf there is another remote control for the
same garage door drive, perform the programming steps again using this remote
control. Before performing these steps,
make sure that new batteries have been
Features
Frequencies
Europe
Country
AD (Andorra) 20 July 2005
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
AT (Austria)
Opening or closing the garage door
Once programmed, the integrated garage
door opener will assume the function of the
garage door system's remote control. Please
also read the operating instructions for the
garage door system.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 155).
X Press button ;, = or ? which you have
programmed to operate the garage door.
Garage door system with a fixed code: indicator lamp : lights up green.
Garage door system with a rolling code:
indicator lamp : flashes green.
The transmitter will transmit a signal for as
long as the button is pressed. The transmission is halted after a maximum of ten seconds
and indicator lamp : lights up yellow. Press
button ;, = or ? again if necessary.
Clearing the memory
Make sure that you clear the memory of the
integrated garage door opener before selling
the vehicle.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 155).
X Press and hold buttons ; and ?.
The indicator lamp first lights up yellow and
then green.
X Release buttons ; and ?.
The memory of the integrated garage door
opener in the rear-view mirror is cleared.
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
BE (Belgium) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
BG (Bulgaria)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 12 April
07
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
CH (Switzer- Article 6 of Directive
land)
1999/5/EC R&TTE 14357
27 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
CY (Cyprus)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 5 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
CZ (Czech
Republic)
General Licence GL-30/R/
2000 Reg No. 844 13 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433
DK (Denmark)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 20 April
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
DE (Germany)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
7519301 29 April 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
Z
Stowing and features
fitted in garage door drive remote control
A.
RNote that some remote controls transmit
only for a limited period (the indicator lamp
on the remote control goes out). Press button B on remote control A again before
transmission ends.
RAlign the aerial cable of the garage door
opener unit. This can improve signal reception/transmission.
555
Stowing and features
556
Features
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
EE (Estonia)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 11 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
IC (Canary
Islands)
ES (Spain)
000438/2005,
000439/2005,
000440/2005
000441/2005,
000445/2005,
000446/2005
000447/2005
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
000438/2005,
000439/2005
000440/2005,
000441/2005
000445/2005,
000446/2005
000447/2005, 3rd June
2005
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
IE (Ireland)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 10668
13 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
IS (Iceland)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 10668
13 May 05
27, 30, 40, 433, 868
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
IT (Italy)
DGPGSR/II/
347487/FOR/15347
DGPGSR/II/
347487/FOR/15348
DGPGSR/II/
347487/FOR/15350
DGPGSR/II/
347487/FOR/15357
DGPGSR/II/
347487/FOR/15358
DGPGSR/II/
347487/FOR/15359
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
FI (Finland)
FR (France)
GI (Gibraltar) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 10668
13 May 05 (UK)
MHz: 27, 40, 418, 433, 868
GR (Greece)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
11409/18/4/2005 18
May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
HR (Croatia)
SDR 224/06
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
HU (Hungary)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
LI (Liechten- Article 6 of Directive
stein)
1999/5/EC R&TTE 14357
27 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
LT (Lithuania)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
27.4-1B-1609 6 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
LU (Luxembourg)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
150405/9538 24 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
RU (Russian
Federation)
POCC DE.MJ05.H00015 13
May 05
MHz: 433
LV (Latvia)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
27.4-1B-1609 26 April 06
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
MC (Monaco)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 10668
13 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
MT (Malta)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
NL (Netherlands)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
NO (Norway) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
05/02424-SA644 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
PL (Poland)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 21 April
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
PT (Portugal) ANCOM-S08399/05
27, 40, 433, 868
RO (Romania)
Article 6.4 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
SE (Sweden) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
SI (Slovenia) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
500-1/2005-437 9 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
SK (Slovakia)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
Slovak
206/11/2005 4 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
UK (United
Kingdom)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 418, 433, 868
Africa
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
EG (Egypt)
W-KLE-17/08 Mar. 06
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 418, 433,
868
RE (Réunion) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 11 July
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
ZA (South
Africa)
11 October 2005
MHz: 27, 40, 433
Z
557
Stowing and features
Features
558
Features
Stowing and features
America
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
BB (Barbados)
Registration not required
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
CL (Chile)
38447/F-23 No.3.3634
MHz: 40, 433
3943/DFRS05165/F-50
MHz: 280 to 433
GF (French
Guyana)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 10668
13 May 05
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
GP (Guadeloupe)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 10668
13 May 05
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
MQ (Martini- Article 6 of Directive
que)
1999/5/EC R&TTE 11 July
05
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
MX (Mexico) MHz: 280 to 390
Asia
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
AE (United
Arab Emirates)
1623/5/10-2/26/76
MHz: 433
JO (Jordan)
TRC/LPD/2005/23
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
KW (Kuwait)
5 October 2005
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 418, 433,
868
SA (Saudi
Arabia)
11_02_05/5024-5-6
MHz: 418, 433
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
SY (Syria)
279/4/14 / 05 March 06
TR (Turkey)
National Certification 23
July 07
MHz: 433
Australia
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
AU (Australia)
28 June 2005
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
NZ (New
Zealand)
20 March 06
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433
Floormats
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the operating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as prescribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
Features
Slide the seat backwards.
To fit: lay the floormat in the footwell.
X Press studs : onto retainers ;.
X To remove: pull the floormat away from
retainers ;.
X Remove the floormats.
Stowing and features
X
559
X
Retrofitted anti-glare film
Retrofitted anti-glare film on the inside of the
windows can interfere with radio/mobile
telephone reception. This is particularly the
case for conductive or metallic-coated films.
You can obtain information about anti-glare
film from a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
560
561
Useful information ............................ 562
Engine compartment ........................ 562
ASSYST PLUS .................................... 566
Maintenance and care
Care .................................................... 568
562
Engine compartment
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified special-
Maintenance and care
ist workshops: (Y page 34).
Engine compartment
Bonnet
Important safety notes
G WARNING
An unlocked bonnet may open while driving
and block your view. There is a risk of an accident.
Never unlock the bonnet while driving.
G WARNING
When being opened and closed, the bonnet
may suddenly fall into the closed position.
There is a risk of injury to persons in the range
of movement of the bonnet.
Open and close the bonnet only when nobody
is in the range of movement.
G WARNING
If you open the bonnet while the engine is
overheating or while there is a fire in the
engine compartment, you could come into
contact with hot gases or other leaking service products. There is a danger of injury.
Allow an overheating engine to cool down
before opening the bonnet. If there is a fire in
the engine compartment, leave the bonnet
closed and notify the fire brigade.
G WARNING
There are moving components in the engine
compartment. Certain components may continue to move or suddenly move again even
after the ignition has been switched off, e.g.
the radiator fan. There is a risk of injury.
If you have to carry out work in the engine
compartment:
Rswitch
off the ignition
Rnever touch the dangerous areas surround-
ing moving components, e.g. the rotation
area of the fan
Rremove jewellery and watches
Rkeep items of clothing and hair, for example, away from moving parts.
Active bonnet (pedestrian protection)
Operating principle
! An active bonnet that had been triggered
must be repaired at a qualified specialist
workshop. The active bonnet function will
then be available again. The additional
pedestrian protection provided by the
active bonnet will then be restored.
The active bonnet is only available in certain
countries.
The active bonnet can reduce the risk of injury
to pedestrians in certain accident situations.
Raising the active bonnet increases the clearance to hard components, such as the engine.
If the active bonnet has been triggered, it is
raised at the rear in the area around the hinge
by approximately 85 mm. The active bonnet is
triggered by pyrotechnics.
For the drive to the workshop, reset the triggered active bonnet yourself. If the active
bonnet has been triggered, pedestrian protection may be limited.
Resetting
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
Engine compartment
563
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the following components.
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
switched off.
X Pull release lever : on the bonnet.
The bonnet is released.
X
With your hand flat, push down active bonnet : in the area around the hinges on
both sides (arrows) until you feel it engage.
If you can raise the active bonnet slightly in
the area around the hinges, it is not engaged
correctly. Repeat the step.
Opening the bonnet
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the following components.
G WARNING
When the bonnet is open, and the windscreen
wipers are set in motion, you can be injured by
the wiper linkage. There is a risk of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before opening the bonnet.
X
Reach into the gap, pull bonnet catch handle ; up and lift the bonnet.
If you lift the bonnet by approximately
40 cm, the bonnet is opened and held open
automatically by the gas-filled strut.
Closing the bonnet
Lower the bonnet and let it fall from a
height of approximately 20 cm.
X Check that the bonnet has engaged properly.
If the bonnet can be raised slightly, it is not
properly engaged. Open it again and close
it with a little more force.
X
! Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
not folded away from the windscreen. Otherwise, you could damage the windscreen
wipers or the bonnet.
Z
Maintenance and care
X
564
Engine compartment
Engine oil
Notes on oil level
Depending on your driving style, the vehicle
consumes up to 0.8 litres of oil per 1,000 km.
The oil consumption may be higher than this
when the vehicle is new or if you frequently
drive at high engine speeds.
Depending on the engine, the oil dipstick may
be installed at a different location.
When checking the oil level:
Maintenance and care
Rpark
the vehicle on a level surface.
Rthe engine should be switched off for
approximately five minutes if the engine is
at normal operating temperature.
Rif the engine is not at normal operating
temperature, e.g. if the engine was only
started briefly, wait approximately
30 minutes before carrying out the measurement.
Checking the oil level using the oil dipstick
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the following components.
Example
Pull oil dipstick : out of the dipstick tube.
Wipe off oil dipstick :.
X Slowly slide oil dipstick : into the guide
tube to the stop, and take it out again.
If the level is between MIN mark = and
MAX mark ;, the oil level is correct.
X If the oil level has dropped to MIN mark =
or below, top up with 1.0 l of engine oil.
X
X
Adding engine oil
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the following components.
G WARNING
If engine oil comes into contact with hot components in the engine compartment, it may
ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury.
Make sure that engine oil does not spill out
over the filler neck. Allow the engine to cool
down and thoroughly clean the components
that have come into contact with engine oil
before you start the engine.
Engine compartment
When topping up the oil, take care not to spill
any. If oil enters the soil or waterways, it is
harmful to the environment.
! Only use engine oils and oil filters that
have been approved for vehicles with a service system. You can obtain a list of the
engine oils and oil filters tested and
approved in accordance with the
Mercedes-Benz Specifications for Service
Products at any Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
Damage to the engine or exhaust system is
caused by the following:
Rusing
engine oils and oil filters that have
not been specifically approved for the
service system
Rchanging the engine oil and oil filter after
missing the change interval required by
the service system
Rusing engine oil additives
! Do not add too much oil. If the oil level is
above the "max" mark on the dipstick, too
much oil has been added. This can lead to
damage to the engine or the catalytic converter. Have excess oil siphoned off.
Replace cap : on the filler neck and turn
clockwise.
Make sure that the cap locks securely into
place.
X Check the oil level again with the oil dipstick (Y page 564).
X
For further information on engine oil, see
(Y page 626).
Checking and adding other service
products
Checking the coolant level
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the following components.
G WARNING
The engine cooling system is under pressure,
particularly if the engine is warm. You could
be scalded by hot coolant spraying out when
opening the cap. There is a danger of injury.
Allow the engine to cool before opening the
cap. Wear gloves and protective eyewear
when opening. Slowly turn the cap half a turn
to allow pressure to escape.
Example: engine oil filler cap
X
X
Turn cap : anti-clockwise and remove it.
Top up the engine oil.
If the oil level is at or below the MIN mark on
the oil dipstick, top up with 1.0 l of engine
oil.
Example
Z
Maintenance and care
H Environmental note
565
ASSYST PLUS
566
Park the vehicle on a level surface.
Only check the coolant level if the vehicle is
on a level surface and the engine has
cooled down.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 155).
On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the
Start/Stop button twice (Y page 155).
X Check the coolant temperature gauge in
the multifunction display.
The coolant temperature must be below
70 †.
X Turn the key to position 0 (Y page 155) in
the ignition lock.
X Slowly turn cap ; half a turn anti-clockwise to allow excess pressure to escape.
X Turn cap ; further anti-clockwise and
remove it.
If the coolant is at the level of marker bar =
in the filler neck when cold, there is enough
coolant in coolant expansion tank :.
If the coolant level is approximately 1.5 cm
above marker bar = in the filler neck when
warm, there is enough coolant in coolant
expansion tank :.
X If necessary, top up with coolant that has
been tested and approved by MercedesBenz.
X Replace cap ; and turn it clockwise as far
as it will go.
Maintenance and care
X
For further information on coolant, see
(Y page 627).
Windscreen washer system and headlamp cleaning system
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the following components.
G WARNING
Windscreen washer concentrate is highly
flammable. If it comes into contact with hot
engine components or the exhaust system it
could ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury.
Make sure that no windscreen washer concentrate is spilled next to the filler neck.
Example
To open: pull cap : upwards by the tab.
Top up with the premixed washer fluid.
X To close: press cap : onto the filler neck
until it engages.
X
X
The washer fluid reservoir is used for both the
windscreen washer system and the headlamp
cleaning system.
If the washer fluid level drops below the recommended minimum of 1 litre, a message
appears in the multifunction display prompting you to top up the washer fluid
(Y page 272).
Further information on windscreen washer
fluid/antifreeze (Y page 628).
ASSYST PLUS
Service messages
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
informs you of the next service due date.
Information on the type of service and service
intervals (see separate Service Booklet).
You can obtain further information from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
ASSYST PLUS
does not show any information on the
engine oil level. Observe the notes on the
engine oil level (Y page 564).
The multifunction display shows a service
message for a few seconds, e.g.:
RService
A in .. days
A due
RService A overdue by .. days
Depending on the operating conditions of the
vehicle, the remaining time or distance until
the next service due date is displayed.
The letter indicates which service is due. A
stands for a minor service and B for a major
service. A number or another letter may be
displayed after the letter.
Only for certain countries: the position after
the letter A or B indicates any necessary additional maintenance work to be performed. If
you notify a qualified specialist workshop of
this display, you will receive a statement on
the associated costs.
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
does not take into account any periods of
time during which the battery is disconnected.
Maintaining the time-dependent service
schedule:
RService
X
Note down the service due date displayed
in the multifunction display before disconnecting the battery.
or
X
After reconnecting the battery, subtract
the battery disconnection periods from the
service date shown on the display.
Hiding a service message
X
Press the a or % button on the steering wheel.
Displaying a service message
Switch the ignition on.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
ASSYST PLUS submenu and confirm by
pressing the a button.
The service due date appears in the multifunction display.
X
X
Information about Service
Resetting the ASSYST PLUS service
interval display
! If the ASSYST PLUS service interval dis-
play has been inadvertently reset, this setting can be corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.
Have service work carried out as described
in the Service Booklet. This may otherwise
lead to increased wear and damage to the
major assemblies or the vehicle.
A qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, will reset the
ASSYST PLUS service interval display after
the service work has been carried out. You
can also obtain further information on maintenance work, for example.
Special service requirements
The prescribed service interval is based on
normal operation of the vehicle. Service work
will need to be performed more often if the
vehicle is operated under arduous conditions
or increased loads, for example:
Rregular city driving with frequent intermedi-
ate stops
the vehicle is primarily used to travel
short distances
Rfor frequent operation in mountainous terrain or on poor road surfaces
Rif the engine is often left idling for long periods
Rif
Z
Maintenance and care
i The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
567
Maintenance and care
568
Care
In these or similar operating conditions, have
the air filter, engine oil and oil filter, for example, changed more frequently. The tyres must
be checked more frequently if the vehicle is
operated under increased loads. Further
information can be obtained at a qualified
specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Regular care of your vehicle is a condition for
retaining the quality in the long term.
Use care products and cleaning agents recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Driving abroad
Automatic car wash
An extensive Mercedes-Benz Service network
is also available in other countries. You can
obtain further information from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Care
Notes on care
H Environmental note
Dispose of empty packaging and cleaning
cloths in an environmentally responsible manner.
! For cleaning your vehicle, do not use any
of the following:
Rdry,
rough or hard cloths
Rabrasive cleaning agents
Rsolvents
Rcleaning agents containing solvents
Do not scrub.
Do not touch the surfaces or protective
films with hard objects, e.g. a ring or ice
scraper. You could otherwise scratch or
damage the surfaces and protective film.
! Do not park up the vehicle for an extended
period straight after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. For this reason, you
should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and the
brake pads/linings, thus drying them. The
vehicle can then be parked up.
Washing the vehicle and cleaning the
paintwork
G WARNING
Braking efficiency is reduced after the vehicle
has been washed. There is a risk of an accident.
After washing the vehicle, brake carefully
while paying attention to the traffic conditions
in order to restore full braking efficiency.
! If DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD function
is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. To prevent damage to the vehicle, deactivate DISTRONIC
PLUS and the HOLD function in the following or other similar situations:
Rwhen
towing the vehicle
Rin the car wash
! It is preferable to use car washes with
adjustable high-pressure pre-cleaning that
corresponds to the specification for the
Cabriolet programme. In car washes that
use high water pressures, there is a risk
that a small amount of water may leak into
the vehicle.
! Vehicles with HANDS-FREE ACCESS: if a
key with KEYLESS-GO is within the detection range of the KEYLESS-GO antenna, the
following situations could lead to the unintentional opening of the boot lid:
Rusing
a car wash
a high-pressure cleaner
Make sure that the key is at least 2 m away
from the vehicle.
Rusing
! Make sure that the automatic transmission is in position N when washing your
Care
! Make sure that:
Rthe
side windows and the roof are completely closed
Rthe climate control blower is switched off
Rthe windscreen wiper switch is at position 0
The vehicle could otherwise be damaged.
You can wash the vehicle in an automatic car
wash from the very start.
Wash off excess dirt before cleaning the vehicle in an automatic car wash.
After using an automatic car wash, wipe wax
off the windscreen and the wiper blades. This
will prevent smears and reduce wiping noises
caused by residue on the windscreen.
Washing by hand
In some countries, washing by hand is only
allowed at specially equipped washing bays.
Observe the legal requirements for each individual country.
X Do not use hot water and do not wash the
vehicle in direct sunlight.
X Use a soft sponge to clean.
X Use a mild cleaning agent, such as a car
shampoo approved by Mercedes-Benz.
X Thoroughly hose down the vehicle with a
gentle jet of water.
X Do not point the water jet directly towards
the air inlet.
X Use plenty of water and rinse out the
sponge frequently.
X Rinse the vehicle with clean water and dry
thoroughly with a chamois.
X Do not let the cleaning agent dry on the
paintwork.
When using the vehicle in winter, remove all
traces of road salt deposits carefully and as
soon as possible.
High-pressure cleaning equipment
G WARNING
The water jet of circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) can cause damage not visible from the
outside to tyres or chassis components. Components damaged in this way can unexpectedly fail. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles to clean the vehicle. Have damaged tyres or chassis components replaced
immediately.
! Always maintain a distance of at least
30 cm between the vehicle and the highpressure cleaner nozzle. Information about
the correct distance is available from the
equipment manufacturer.
Move the high-pressure cleaner nozzle
around when cleaning your vehicle.
Do not aim directly at any of the following:
Rtyres
Rdoor
gaps, roof gaps, joints etc.
components
Rbattery
Rconnectors
Rlights
Rseals
Rtrim elements
Rventilation slots
Damaged seals or electrical components
can lead to leaks or failures.
Relectrical
! Vehicles with HANDS-FREE ACCESS: if a
key with KEYLESS-GO is within the detection range of the KEYLESS-GO antenna, the
following situations could lead to the unintentional opening of the boot lid:
Rusing
a car wash
a high-pressure cleaner
Make sure that the key is at least 2 m away
from the vehicle.
Rusing
Z
Maintenance and care
vehicle in a tow-through car wash. Other
transmission positions may lead to damage
to the vehicle.
569
570
Care
Cleaning the paintwork
! Do not affix:
Rstickers
Rfilms
plates or similar items
to painted surfaces. You could otherwise
damage the paintwork.
Maintenance and care
Rmagnetic
Scratches, corrosive deposits, areas affected
by corrosion and damage caused by inadequate care cannot always be completely
repaired. In such cases, visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X Remove impurities immediately, where
possible, whilst avoiding rubbing too hard.
X Soak insect remains with insect remover
and rinse off the treated areas afterwards.
X Soak bird droppings with water and rinse
off the treated areas afterwards.
X Remove coolant, brake fluid, tree resin,
oils, fuels and greases by rubbing gently
with a cloth soaked in petroleum ether or
lighter fluid.
X Use tar remover to remove tar stains.
X Use silicone remover to remove wax.
Care and treatment of matt paintwork
! Never polish the vehicle or the light alloy
wheels. Polishing makes the paintwork
shiny.
! The following may cause the paint to
become shiny and thus reduce the matt
effect:
RVigorous
rubbing with unsuitable materials.
RFrequent use of car washes.
RWashing the vehicle in direct sunlight.
! Never use paint cleaner, buffing or pol-
ishing products, or gloss preserver, e.g.
wax. These products are only suitable for
high-gloss surfaces. Their use on vehicles
with matt finish leads to considerable surface damage (shiny, spotted areas).
Always have paintwork repairs carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
! Do not use wash programs with a hot wax
treatment under any circumstances.
Observe these notes if your vehicle has a
clear matt finish. This will help you to avoid
damage to the paintwork due to incorrect
treatment.
These notes also apply to light-alloy wheels
with a clear matt finish.
i The vehicle should preferably be washed
by hand using a soft sponge, car shampoo
and plenty of water.
i Use only insect remover and car shampoo
from the range of recommended and
approved Mercedes-Benz care products.
Cleaning vehicle parts
Cleaning the wheels
! Do not use acidic wheel cleaning products
to remove brake dust. This could damage
wheel bolts and brake components.
! Do not park up the vehicle for an extended
period straight after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. For this reason, you
should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and the
brake pads/linings, thus drying them. The
vehicle can then be parked up.
Cleaning the windows
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers are set in motion
when cleaning the windscreen or wiper
blades, you could become trapped. There is a
danger of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before cleaning the windscreen or
wiper blades.
Care
from the windscreen when vertical. Otherwise, you will damage the bonnet.
! Do not use dry cloths, abrasive products,
solvents or cleaning agents containing solvents to clean the inside of the windows. Do
not touch the insides of the windows with
hard objects, e.g. an ice scraper or ring.
There is otherwise a risk of damaging the
windows.
Fold the wiper arms away from the windscreen.
X Clean the wiper blades carefully using a
damp cloth.
X Fold the windscreen wipers back again
before switching on the ignition.
X
Cleaning the exterior lighting
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths that are suitable for plastic lenses.
Unsuitable cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths could scratch or damage the plastic
lenses of the exterior lighting.
! Clean the water drainage channels of the
X
windscreen and the rear window at regular
intervals. Deposits such as leaves, petals
and pollen may under certain circumstances prevent water from draining away. This
can lead to corrosion damage and damage
to electronic components.
X
Clean the inside and outside of the windows with a damp cloth and a cleaning
agent that is recommended and approved
by Mercedes-Benz.
Mirror turn signals
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths that are suitable for plastic lenses.
Unsuitable cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths could scratch or damage the plastic
lenses of the mirror turn signals.
Cleaning the wiper blades
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers are set in motion
when cleaning the windscreen or wiper
blades, you could become trapped. There is a
danger of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before cleaning the windscreen or
wiper blades.
! Do not pull on the wiper blade. Otherwise,
the wiper blade could be damaged.
! Do not clean wiper blades too often and
do not rub them too hard. Otherwise, the
graphite coating could be damaged. This
could cause wiper noise.
! Hold the wiper arm securely when folding
Clean the plastic lenses of the exterior
lighting using a wet sponge and a mild
cleaning agent, e.g. Mercedes-Benz car
shampoo or cleaning cloths.
X
Clean the plastic lenses of the mirror turn
signals in the exterior mirror housing using
a wet sponge and mild cleaning agent, e.g.
Mercedes-Benz car shampoo or cleaning
cloths.
Cleaning the sensors
! If you clean the sensors with a high-pres-
sure cleaner, make sure that you keep a
distance of at least 30 cm between the
vehicle and the high-pressure cleaner nozzle. Information about the correct distance
is available from the equipment manufacturer.
back. The windscreen could be damaged if
the wiper arm hits against it suddenly.
Z
Maintenance and care
! Only fold the windscreen wipers away
571
Care
572
Impurities combined with the effects of road
grit and corrosive environmental factors may
cause flash rust to form on the surface. You
can restore the original shine of the exhaust
pipe by cleaning it regularly, especially in winter and after washing.
Interior care
Cleaning the display
! For cleaning, do not use any of the fol-
Maintenance and care
lowing:
Ralcohol-based
thinner or petrol
cleaning agents
Rcommercially-available household cleaning agents
These may damage the display surface. Do
not put pressure on the display surface
when cleaning. This could lead to irreparable damage to the display.
Rabrasive
X
Clean sensors : of the driving systems
with water, car shampoo and a soft cloth.
Cleaning the reversing camera
! Do not clean the camera lens and the area
around the reversing camera with a highpressure cleaner.
Before cleaning the display, make sure that
it is switched off and has cooled down.
X Clean the display surface using a commercially available microfibre cloth and
TFT/LCD display cleaner.
X Dry the display surface using a dry microfibre cloth.
X
Cleaning Night View Assist Plus
! Never clean the camera lens. When cleanX
Use clear water and a soft cloth to clean
camera lens :.
Cleaning the exhaust pipe
! Do not clean the exhaust pipe with acidbased cleaning agents such as sanitary
cleansers or wheel cleaners.
X
Clean the exhaust pipe with a chrome care
product tested and approved by MercedesBenz.
ing the field of vision of the driving systems,
make sure that you do not spray glass
cleaner on the camera lens. If the camera
lens is dirty, visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Care
573
Wipe the plastic trim with a damp, lint-free
cloth, e.g. a microfibre cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning
products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
The surface may change colour temporarily. Wait until the surface is dry again.
X
Cleaning the windscreen on the inside
in front of the camera lens: fold down the
cover of camera ; using the recess.
X Use a soft cloth to clean the windscreen in
front of camera ;.
X
Cleaning the thermal imaging camera in
the radiator trim: thermal imaging camera : is cleaned at regular intervals when the
windscreen washer system is operated.
X
Use clear water and a soft cloth to clean
thermal imaging camera : when it is very
dirty.
Cleaning the plastic trim
G WARNING
Care products and cleaning agents containing
solvents can cause surfaces in the cockpit to
become porous. This could result in plastic
parts breaking away when the airbags are
deployed. There is a danger of injury.
Do not use care products and cleaning agents
containing solvents to clean the cockpit.
! Do not affix the following to plastic surfaces:
Rstickers
Rfilms
X
Thoroughly wipe with a damp cloth or use
leather care agents that have been recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Cleaning wooden trim and trim elements
! Do not use solvent-based cleaning agents
such as tar remover, wheel cleaners, polishes or waxes. There is otherwise a risk of
damaging the surface.
Wipe the wooden trim and trim elements
with a damp, lint-free cloth, e.g. a microfibre cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning
products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
X
Cleaning the seat covers
General notes
! Do not use microfibre cloths to clean genuine leather, artificial leather or DINAMICA
covers. If used often, these can damage the
cover.
i Note that regular care is essential to
make sure that the appearance and comfort of the covers are retained over time.
Rscented oil bottles or similar items
You could otherwise damage the plastic.
! Do not allow cosmetics, insect repellent
or sunscreen to come in contact with the
plastic trim. This maintains the high-quality
look of the surfaces.
Z
Maintenance and care
Cleaning the steering wheel and gear or
selector lever
574
Care
Genuine leather seat covers
! To retain the natural appearance of the
leather, observe the following cleaning
instructions:
Maintenance and care
RClean
genuine leather covers carefully
with a damp cloth and then wipe the covers down with a dry cloth.
RMake sure that the leather does not
become soaked. It may otherwise
become rough and cracked.
ROnly use leather care agents that have
been tested and approved by MercedesBenz. You can obtain these from a qualified specialist workshop.
Leather is a natural product.
It has natural surface properties, e.g.:
Runevenness in structure
Rmarks caused by growth and injury
Rsubtle colour differences
These are characteristics of leather and not
material faults.
Seat covers from other materials
! Observe the following when cleaning:
RClean artificial leather covers with a cloth
moistened with a solution containing 1%
detergent (e.g. washing-up liquid).
RClean cloth covers with a microfibre
cloth moistened with a solution containing 1% detergent (e.g. washing-up liquid).
Rub carefully, and always wipe entire
seat sections to avoid leaving visible
lines. Leave the seat to dry afterwards.
Cleaning results depend on the type of
dirt and how long it has been there.
RClean Alcantara® covers with a damp
cloth. Make sure that you wipe entire
seat sections to avoid leaving visible
lines.
Cleaning the seat belts
G WARNING
Seat belts may be severely weakened if
bleached or coloured. This may lead to the
seat belts, for example, tearing or failing in an
accident. There is an increased risk of injury,
possibly even fatal.
Never bleach or colour seat belts.
! Do not clean the seat belts using chemical
cleaning agents. Do not dry the seat belts at
temperatures above 80 † or in direct sunlight.
X
Use clean, lukewarm water and soap solution.
Cleaning the roof lining and carpets
Roof lining: if it is very dirty, use a soft
brush or dry shampoo.
X Carpets: use the carpet and textile cleaning agents recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
X
575
Useful information ............................ 576
Where will I find...? ........................... 576
Flat tyre ............................................. 578
Battery (vehicle) ................................ 582
Jump-starting .................................... 586
Towing and tow-starting .................. 588
Breakdown assistance
Electrical fuses ................................. 592
576
Where will I find...?
Useful information
Setting up the warning triangle
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 34).
Breakdown assistance
Where will I find...?
Warning triangle
Removing the warning triangle
Warning triangle : is located in a bracket on
the inside of the boot lid.
X Open the boot lid.
X Press catch ; in the direction of the
bracket and open the bracket in the direction of the arrow.
X Pull the clip of warning triangle : in the
centre of the bracket outward.
X Remove warning triangle : from the
bracket.
X
X
Fold feet = down and out to the side.
Pull side reflectors ; upwards to form a
triangle and lock them at the top using
upper press-stud :.
First-aid kit
First-aid kit : is located in the boot under the
boot floor.
X Open the boot lid.
X Open the boot separator (Y page 106).
X Lift the boot floor upwards (Y page 548).
X Remove first-aid kit :.
i Check the expiry date on the first-aid kit
at least once a year. Replace the contents if
necessary, and replace any missing items.
Where will I find...?
Fire extinguisher
G WARNING
When you brake heavily or change direction
suddenly, the fire extinguisher can be thrown
around the vehicle interior if the roller box is
left open. There is a risk of accident and injury
to you or the passenger. Keep the shutter of
the roller box closed whilst the vehicle is in
motion.
577
Check whether bracket = is properly
engaged.
X Close cover :.
X
i Have fire extinguisher ; refilled after
each use and checked every one to two
years. It may otherwise fail in an emergency.
Observe the legal requirements for each
individual country.
Vehicle tool kit
The towing eye is located in the boot in a
bracket below the boot lid lock. If the vehicle
is equipped with a TIREFIT kit, it is located in
the stowage compartment under the floor of
the boot.
:
;
=
?
Cover
Fire extinguisher
Retainer
Locking button
Fire extinguisher ; is in the roller box behind
the centre console, between the seats.
X To remove the fire extinguisher: open
cover :.
X Slide locking button ? in the direction of
the arrow.
X Lift and swing out bracket = from the side
on which locking button ? is located.
X Take fire extinguisher ; out of the roller
box.
X To insert the fire extinguisher: insert fire
extinguisher ; into the roller box.
X Insert bracket = into the roller box on the
side opposite locking button ?.
X Then, insert bracket = completely.
X Slide locking button ? in the opposite
direction to the arrow.
Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit
:
;
=
?
Towing eye
Tyre sealant filler bottle
Fuse allocation chart
Tyre inflation compressor
Open the boot lid.
Open the boot separator (Y page 106).
X Lift the boot floor upwards (Y page 548).
X Use the TIREFIT kit (Y page 579).
X
X
Z
Breakdown assistance
General notes
Flat tyre
578
Tyre-change tool kit
: Bag containing the tyre-changing tools
Open the boot lid.
Open the boot separator (Y page 106).
X Lift the boot floor upwards (Y page 548).
X
Breakdown assistance
X
i Depending on the vehicle equipment, not
all vehicles will have the tools that are
required for changing a wheel, such as a
jack. Tools approved for your vehicle are
available at a qualified specialist workshop.
Bag with tyre-changing tools : contains:
Rjack
Rwheel
wrench
pin
Rwheel chock
Rgloves
Rcentring
Flat tyre
Preparing the vehicle
Your vehicle may be equipped with:
RMOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat char-
acteristics) (Y page 578)
Vehicle preparation is not necessary on
vehicles with MOExtended tyres.
Ra TIREFIT kit (Y page 579)
Ran emergency spare wheel (only for certain
countries) (Y page 614)
Information on changing/fitting a wheel
(Y page 605).
Stop the vehicle on solid, non-slippery and
level ground, as far away from traffic as
possible.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away
(Y page 175).
X If possible, bring the front wheels into the
straight-ahead position.
X Switch off the engine.
X Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove
the key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: open the
driver's door.
The on-board electronics now have status
0. This is the same as the key having been
removed.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: remove the
Start/Stop button from the ignition lock
(Y page 155).
X All occupants must get out of the vehicle.
Make sure that they are not endangered as
they do so.
X Make sure that no one is near the danger
area while a wheel is being changed. Anyone who is not directly assisting in the
wheel change should, for example, stand
behind the barrier.
X Get out of the vehicle. Pay attention to traffic conditions when doing so.
X Close the driver's door.
X Place the warning triangle a suitable distance away (Y page 576). Observe legal
requirements.
X
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics)
General notes
With MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics), you can continue to drive
your vehicle even if there is a total loss of
pressure in one or more tyres. The affected
tyre must not show any clearly visible damage.
Flat tyre
You can recognise MOExtended tyres by the
MOExtended marking which appears on the
tyre wall. You will find this marking next to the
tyre size designation, the load-bearing capacity and the speed index.
MOExtended tyres may only be used in conjunction with an activated tyre pressure loss
warning system or tyre pressure monitor.
If the pressure loss warning message
appears in the multifunction display:
i Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
Robserve the instructions in the display mes-
G WARNING
When driving in emergency mode, the driving
characteristics deteriorate, e.g. when cornering, accelerating quickly and when braking.
There is a risk of accident.
Do not exceed the stated maximum speed.
Avoid abrupt steering and driving manoeuvres, and driving over obstacles (kerbs, potholes, off-road). This applies in particular to a
laden vehicle.
Stop driving in emergency mode if:
Rspeed
Rroad
condition
Routside temperature
The driving distance possible in run-flat mode
may be reduced by extreme driving conditions/manoeuvres, or it can be increased
through a moderate style of driving.
The maximum permissible distance which
can be driven in run-flat mode is counted from
the moment the tyre pressure loss warning
appears in the multifunction display.
You must not exceed a maximum speed of
80 km/h.
i When replacing one or all tyres, make
sure that you use only:
Rthe tyre size specified for the vehicle and
Rtyre(s) marked "MOExtended"
If a tyre has gone flat and cannot be
replaced with an MOExtended tyre, a
standard tyre may be used as a temporary
measure. Make sure that you use the
proper size and type (summer or winter
tyre).
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It
is therefore recommended that you additionally equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit
if you fit tyres that do not feature run-flat
characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT
kit is available, for example, from a qualified
specialist workshop.
Important safety notes
Ryou
hear banging noises.
vehicle starts to shake.
Ryou see smoke and smell rubber.
Rthe
RESP®
is intervening constantly.
are tears in the sidewalls of the tyre.
After driving in emergency mode, have the
wheel rims checked at a qualified specialist
workshop with regard to their further use. The
faulty tyre must be replaced.
Rthere
TIREFIT kit
Important safety notes
TIREFIT is a tyre sealant.
You can use TIREFIT to seal punctures of up to
4 mm, particularly those in the tyre tread. You
can use TIREFIT at outside temperatures
down to Ò20 †.
Z
Breakdown assistance
sages (Y page 267).
Rcheck the tyre for damage
Rif driving on, observe the following notes
The maximum driving distance is approximately 80 km when the vehicle is partially
laden and approximately 30 km when the
vehicle is fully laden.
In addition to the vehicle load, the driving distance possible depends upon:
579
580
Flat tyre
G WARNING
Using the TIREFIT kit
In the following situations, the tyre sealant is
unable to provide sufficient breakdown assistance, as it is unable to seal the tyre properly:
Rthere
are cuts or punctures in the tyre
larger than those mentioned above.
Rthe wheel rim is damaged.
Ryou have driven at very low tyre pressures
or on a flat tyre.
There is a risk of an accident.
Do not drive any further. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
Breakdown assistance
G WARNING
The tyre sealant is harmful and causes irritation. It must not come into contact with your
skin, eyes or clothing or be swallowed. Do not
inhale TIREFIT fumes. Keep tyre sealant away
from children. There is a risk of injury.
If you come into contact with the tyre sealant,
observe the following:
RRinse
off the tyre sealant from your skin
immediately with water.
RIf the tyre sealant comes into contact with
your eyes, immediately rinse them thoroughly with clean water.
RIf tyre sealant is swallowed, immediately
rinse your mouth out thoroughly and drink
plenty of water. Do not induce vomiting,
and seek medical attention immediately.
RImmediately change out of clothing which
has come into contact with tyre sealant.
RIf an allergic reaction occurs, seek medical
attention immediately.
! Do not operate the tyre inflation com-
pressor for longer than eight minutes at a
time without a break. It may otherwise
overheat.
The tyre inflation compressor can be operated again once it has cooled down.
Comply with the manufacturer’s safety
instructions on the sticker on the tyre inflation compressor.
TIREFIT sticker, 2-part
Do not remove any foreign objects which
have penetrated the tyre, e.g. screws or
nails.
X Remove the tyre sealant bottle, the accompanying TIREFIT sticker and the tyre inflation compressor from the stowage space
under the boot floor (Y page 577).
X Affix part : of the TIREFIT sticker within
the driver's field of vision.
X Affix part ; of the TIREFIT sticker near the
valve on the wheel with the defective tyre.
X
Pull plug ? with the cable and hose A out
of the housing.
X Screw hose A onto flange B of tyre sealant bottle :.
X Place tyre sealant bottle : head downwards into recess ; of the tyre inflation
compressor.
X
Flat tyre
581
If you get tyre sealant on your clothing,
have it cleaned as soon as possible with
perchloroethylene.
Tyre pressure not reached
If a pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi) has
not been attained after five minutes:
X
X
Insert plug ? into the socket of the cigarette lighter or into a 12 V power socket in
your vehicle.
Observe the notes on the cigarette lighter
(Y page 550). Observe the notes on sockets (Y page 550).
X Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 155).
X Press on/off switch = on the tyre inflation
compressor to I.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
on. The tyre is inflated.
i First, tyre sealant is pumped into the tyre.
The pressure may briefly rise to approximately 500 kPa (5.0 bar/73 psi).
Do not switch off the tyre inflation compressor during this phase.
X
X
Let the tyre inflation compressor run for
five minutes. The tyre should then have
attained a pressure of at least 180 kPa
(1.8 bar/26 psi).
If a tyre pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi)
has been attained after five minutes:
(Y page 581).
If a tyre pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi)
has not been attained after five minutes:
(Y page 581).
i If the tyre sealant leaks out, allow it to dry.
It can then be removed like a layer of film.
Very slowly drive forwards or reverse,
approximately 10 m.
X Pump up the tyre again.
After a maximum of five minutes, the tyre
pressure must be at least 180 kPa (1.8 bar/
26 psi).
X
G WARNING
If the required tyre pressure is not reached
after the specified time, the tyre is too badly
damaged. The tyre sealant cannot repair the
tyre in this instance. Damaged tyres and a tyre
pressure that is too low can significantly
impair the vehicle's braking and driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
Do not continue driving. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
Tyre pressure reached
G WARNING
A tyre temporarily sealed with tyre sealant
impairs the driving characteristics and is not
suitable for higher speeds. There is a risk of
accident.
You should therefore adapt your driving style
accordingly and drive carefully. Do not exceed
the specified maximum speed with a tyre that
has been repaired using tyre sealant.
! After use, excess tyre sealant may run out
of the filler hose. This could cause stains.
Therefore, place the filler hose in the plastic
bag which contained the TIREFIT kit.
Z
Breakdown assistance
Remove the cap from valve C on the faulty
tyre.
X Screw filler hose D onto the valve.
X
Switch off the tyre inflation compressor.
Unscrew the filler hose from the valve of
the faulty tyre.
Battery (vehicle)
582
H Environmental note
Have the used tyre sealant bottle disposed of
professionally, e.g. at a qualified specialist
workshop.
If a tyre pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi)
has been achieved after ten minutes:
Switch off the tyre inflation compressor.
Unscrew the filler hose from the valve of
the faulty tyre.
X Stow the tyre sealant bottle, the tyre inflation compressor and the warning triangle.
X
X
Pull away immediately.
The maximum speed for a tyre sealed with
tyre sealant is 80 km/h. The upper part of
the TIREFIT sticker must be affixed to the
instrument cluster where it will be easily
seen by the driver.
X Stop after driving for approximately ten
minutes and check the tyre pressure with
the tyre inflation compressor.
The tyre pressure must now be at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/19 psi).
Breakdown assistance
X
G WARNING
If the required tyre pressure is not reached
after driving for a short period, the tyre is too
badly damaged. The tyre sealant cannot
repair the tyre in this instance. Damaged tyres
and a tyre pressure that is too low can significantly impair the vehicle's braking and driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
Do not continue driving. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
i In your vehicle, you will find a sticker with
the Mercedes-Benz Service24h telephone
number, e.g. on the B-pillar on the driver's
side.
Correct the tyre pressure if it is still at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/19 psi) (see the fuel filler
flap for values).
X To increase the tyre pressure: switch on
the tyre inflation compressor.
X
To reduce the tyre pressure: depress
pressure release button : next to pressure gauge ;.
X When the tyre pressure is correct, unscrew
the filler hose from the valve of the sealed
tyre.
X Screw the valve cap onto the tyre valve of
the sealed tyre.
X
Pull the tyre sealant bottle out of the tyre
inflation compressor.
The filler hose stays on the tyre sealant
bottle.
X Stow the tyre sealant bottle, the tyre inflation compressor and the warning triangle.
X Drive to the nearest qualified specialist
workshop and have the tyre changed there.
X Have the tyre sealant bottle replaced as
soon as possible at a qualified specialist
workshop.
X Have the tyre sealant bottle replaced every
four years at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Battery (vehicle)
Important safety notes
Work on the battery, e.g. removing or fitting,
requires specialist knowledge and the use of
special tools. Therefore, always have work on
the battery carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
G WARNING
Work carried out incorrectly on the battery
may lead to a malfunction, e.g. a short circuit.
This, in turn, may restrict the functions of the
safety-relevant systems, e.g. the lighting system, ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) or ESP®
(Electronic Stability Program). The operating
safety of your vehicle may then be compromised. You could then lose control of the vehicle, e.g.:
Rwhen
braking
making sudden steering movements
and/or travelling at an inappropriate
speed.
There is a risk of an accident.
In the event of a short circuit or similar situation, inform a qualified specialist workshop
immediately. Do not drive any further. You
should have all work involving the battery carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Rwhen
Further information on ABS and ESP®
(Y page 71) and (Y page 73).
G WARNING
Electrostatic build-up can lead to the creation
of sparks, which could ignite the highly explosive gases of a battery. There is a risk of an
explosion.
Before handling the battery, touch the vehicle
body to remove any existing electrostatic
build-up.
The highly flammable gas mixture is created
while the battery is charging and when jumpstarting.
Always make sure that neither you nor the
battery is electrostatically charged. Electrostatic charge is created, for example:
Rby
wearing synthetic fibre clothing
to friction between clothing and the
seat
Rwhen you pull or push the battery across
carpet or other synthetic materials
Rwhen you rub the battery with a cloth
Rdue
G WARNING
During the charging process, a battery produces hydrogen gas. If a short circuit occurs or
sparks are created, the hydrogen gas can
ignite. There is a risk of an explosion.
RMake sure that the positive terminal of a
connected battery does not come into contact with vehicle parts.
RNever place metal objects or tools on a battery.
RIt is important that you observe the described order of the battery terminals when
connecting and disconnecting a battery.
RWhen jump-starting, make sure that the
battery poles with identical polarity are
connected.
RIt is particularly important to observe the
described order when connecting and disconnecting the jump leads.
RNever connect or disconnect the battery
terminals while the engine is running.
G WARNING
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Do not inhale any battery gases. Do not lean
over the battery. Keep children away from
batteries. Wash battery acid immediately with
water and seek medical attention.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
Z
583
Breakdown assistance
Battery (vehicle)
584
Battery (vehicle)
! Have the battery checked regularly at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Observe the service intervals in the Service
Booklet or contact a qualified specialist
workshop for more information.
Breakdown assistance
! You should have all work involving the
battery carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop. In the exceptional case that it is
necessary for you to disconnect the battery
yourself, make sure that:
Ryou switch off the engine and remove the
key. On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO,
ensure that the ignition is switched off.
Check that all the indicator lamps in the
instrument cluster are off. Otherwise,
electronic components, such as the
alternator, may be damaged.
Ryou first remove the negative terminal
clamp and then the positive terminal
clamp. Never swap the terminal clamps.
Otherwise, the vehicle's electronic system may be damaged.
Rthe transmission is locked in position P
after disconnecting the battery. The vehicle is secured against rolling away. You
can then no longer move the vehicle.
The battery and the cover of the positive
terminal clamp must be fitted securely during operation.
In order for the battery to achieve the maximum possible service life, it must always be
sufficiently charged.
Comply with safety precautions and take protective measures when handling batteries.
WARNING
Wear suitable protective clothing,
in particular gloves, an apron and a
face mask.
Immediately rinse acid splashes
off with clean water. Consult a doctor if necessary.
Wear eye protection.
Keep children away.
Observe this Owner's Manual.
The vehicle battery, like other batteries, can
discharge over time if you do not use the
vehicle. In such cases, have the battery disconnected at a qualified specialist workshop.
You can also charge the battery with a
charger recommended by Mercedes-Benz.
For more information, please contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Have the battery charge checked more frequently if you use the vehicle mainly for short
trips or if you leave it standing idle for a
lengthy period. Consult a qualified specialist
workshop if you wish to leave your vehicle
parked up for a long period of time.
i When you park the vehicle, remove the
key if you do not require any electrical consumers. The vehicle will then use very little
energy, thus conserving battery power.
Charging the battery
Fire, naked flames and smoking
are prohibited when handling the
battery. Avoid creating sparks.
Battery acid is caustic. Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
G WARNING
During charging and jump-starting, explosive
gases can escape from the battery. There is a
risk of an explosion.
Particularly avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Ensure there is sufficient
Battery (vehicle)
ventilation while charging and jump-starting.
Do not lean over a battery.
G WARNING
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Do not inhale any battery gases. Do not lean
over the battery. Keep children away from
batteries. Wash battery acid immediately with
water and seek medical attention.
X
X
585
Open the bonnet.
Connect the battery charger to the positive
terminal and earth point in the same order
as when connecting the donor battery in
the jump-starting procedure
(Y page 586).
Breakdown assistance
G WARNING
A discharged battery can freeze at temperatures below freezing point. When jump-starting the vehicle or charging the battery, gases
can escape from the battery. There is a risk of
an explosion.
Allow the frozen battery to thaw out before
charging it or jump-starting.
! Only charge the installed battery with a
battery charger which has been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. These battery
chargers allow the battery to be charged
while still installed in the vehicle.
! Only use battery chargers with a maximum charging voltage of 14.8 V.
! Only charge the battery using the jumpstart connection point.
The jump-starting connection point is in the
engine compartment.
If the indicator/warning lamps do not light up
at low temperatures, it is very likely that the
discharged battery has frozen. In this case
you may neither jump-start the vehicle nor
charge the battery. The service life of a battery that has been thawed may be reduced.
The starting characteristics may be impaired,
especially at low temperatures. Have the
thawed battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Read the battery charger's operating instructions before charging the battery.
Z
586
Jump-starting
Jump-starting
For the jump-starting procedure, use only the jump-starting connection point, consisting of a
positive terminal and an earth point, in the engine compartment.
G WARNING
Breakdown assistance
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale any battery gases. Do not lean over the
battery. Keep children away from batteries. Wash battery acid immediately with water and seek
medical attention.
G WARNING
During charging and jump-starting, explosive gases can escape from the battery. There is a risk
of an explosion.
Particularly avoid fire, naked flames, creating sparks and smoking. Ensure there is sufficient
ventilation while charging and jump-starting. Do not lean over a battery.
G WARNING
During the charging process, a battery produces hydrogen gas. If a short circuit occurs or sparks
are created, the hydrogen gas can ignite. There is a risk of an explosion.
RMake sure that the positive terminal of a connected battery does not come into contact with
vehicle parts.
RNever place metal objects or tools on a battery.
RIt is important that you observe the described order of the battery terminals when connecting
and disconnecting a battery.
RWhen jump-starting, make sure that the battery poles with identical polarity are connected.
RIt is particularly important to observe the described order when connecting and disconnecting
the jump leads.
RNever connect or disconnect the battery terminals while the engine is running.
G WARNING
A discharged battery can freeze at temperatures below freezing point. When jump-starting the
vehicle or charging the battery, gases can escape from the battery. There is a risk of an explosion.
Allow the frozen battery to thaw out before charging it or jump-starting.
! Avoid repeated and lengthy starting attempts. Otherwise, the catalytic converter could be
damaged by the non-combusted fuel.
If the indicator/warning lamps do not light up at low temperatures, it is very likely that the
discharged battery has frozen. In this case you may neither jump-start the vehicle nor charge
the battery. The service life of a battery that has been thawed may be reduced. The starting
characteristics may be impaired, especially at low temperatures. Have the thawed battery
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Jump-starting
587
Do not use a rapid charging device to start the vehicle. If your vehicle's battery is discharged,
the engine can be jump-started from another vehicle or from a second battery using jump
leads. Observe the following points:
RThe
battery is not accessible in all vehicles. If the other vehicle's battery is not accessible,
jump-start the vehicle using a second battery or a jump-starting device.
RYou may only jump-start the vehicle when the engine and exhaust system are cold.
RDo not start the engine if the battery is frozen. Let the battery thaw first.
RJump-starting may only be performed from batteries with a nominal voltage of 12 V.
ROnly use jump leads that have a sufficient cross-section and insulated terminal clamps.
RIf the battery is fully discharged, leave the battery that is being used to jump-start connected
for a few minutes before attempting to start. This charges the empty battery a little.
RMake sure that the two vehicles do not touch.
Make sure that:
jump leads are not damaged.
RNon-insulated parts of the terminal clamps do not come into contact with other metal parts
while the jump leads are connected to the battery.
jump leads cannot come into contact with parts which can move when the engine is
running, such as the V-belt pulley or the fan.
X Secure the vehicle by applying the electric parking brake.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition lock and remove it (Y page 155). On vehicles with
KEYLESS-GO, make sure the ignition is switched off (Y page 155). All indicator lamps in the
instrument cluster must be off.
X Switch off all electrical consumers, e.g. rear window heating, lighting etc.
X Open the bonnet.
RThe
Z
Breakdown assistance
RThe
Towing and tow-starting
588
Position number B identifies the charged battery of the other vehicle or an equivalent jumpstarting device.
Press cover : of positive terminal ; down (in the direction of the arrow) and turn it
clockwise. Cover : is held down in the lowered position, which exposes positive terminal ;.
X Connect positive terminal ; on your vehicle to positive terminal = of donor battery B
using the jump lead. Always begin with positive terminal ; on your own vehicle first.
X Start the engine of the donor vehicle and run it at idling speed.
X Connect negative terminal ? of donor battery B to earth point A of your vehicle using the
jump lead, connecting the jump lead to donor battery B first.
X Start the engine.
X Before disconnecting the jump leads, let the engines run for several minutes.
X First, remove the jump leads from earth point A and negative terminal ?, then from positive clamp ; and positive terminal =. Begin each time at the contacts on your own vehicle
first.
X After removing the jump leads, press down cover : of positive terminal ; and turn it anticlockwise. Cover : returns to its original position. Positive terminal ; is covered up and
thus insulated again.
X Have the battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Breakdown assistance
X
i Jump-starting is not considered to be a normal operating condition.
i Jump-starting cables and further information regarding jump starting can be obtained at
any qualified specialist workshop.
Towing and tow-starting
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the weight of the vehicle to be towed or towstarted is greater than the permissible gross
weight of your vehicle:
Rthe
towing eye could detach itself
Rthe vehicle/trailer combination could over-
turn.
There is a risk of an accident.
When towing or tow-starting another vehicle,
its weight should not be greater than the permissible gross weight of your vehicle.
! If DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD function
is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. To prevent damage to the vehicle, deactivate DISTRONIC
PLUS and the HOLD function in the following or other similar situations:
Rwhen
Rin
towing the vehicle
the car wash
! Only secure the tow rope or towing bar to
the towing eyes. The vehicle may otherwise
be damaged.
! Observe the following points when towing
with a tow rope:
Rsecure the tow rope on the same side on
both vehicles.
Rmake sure that the tow rope is not longer
than legally permitted. Mark the tow rope
in the middle, e.g. with a white cloth
(30 x 30 cm). This makes other road
Towing and tow-starting
! Do not use the towing eye for recovery,
this could damage the vehicle. If in doubt,
recover the vehicle with a crane.
! When towing, pull away slowly and
smoothly. If the tractive power is too high,
the vehicles could be damaged.
! To tow vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, use
the key instead of the Start/Stop button.
The automatic transmission may otherwise
switch to position P when you open the
driver's or front-passenger door which
could damage the transmission.
! Make sure that the electric parking brake
is released. If the electric parking brake is
faulty, visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The automatic transmission must be in position N when the vehicle is being towed.
The battery must be connected and charged.
Otherwise, you:
Rcannot
turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2
Rcannot shift the automatic transmission to
position N
i Deactivate the automatic locking feature
before the vehicle is towed (Y page 242).
You could otherwise be locked out when
pushing or towing the vehicle.
Deactivate tow-away protection before the
vehicle is towed (Y page 80).
Fitting/removing the towing eye
Fitting the towing eye
G WARNING
The exhaust tail pipe may be extremely hot.
There is a risk of burning when removing the
rear cover.
Do not touch the exhaust tail pipe. Use
extreme caution when removing the rear
cover.
! You may tow the vehicle for a maximum of
50km. A towing speed of 50 km/h must not
be exceeded.
For towing distances over 50 km, the entire
vehicle must be lifted up and transported.
! If you tow or tow-start another vehicle, its
weight must not exceed the maximum permissible gross vehicle weight of your vehicle.
i Information on your vehicle's gross vehi-
cle weight rating can be found on the vehicle identification plate (Y page 622).
Observe the legal requirements for the relevant countries when towing.
It is better to have the vehicle transported
than to have it towed.
Z
Breakdown assistance
users aware that a vehicle is being
towed.
Ronly secure the tow rope to the towing
eye.
Robserve the brake lamps of the towing
vehicle while driving. Always maintain a
distance so that the tow rope does not
sag.
Rdo not use steel cables or chains to tow
your vehicle. You could otherwise damage the vehicle.
589
590
Towing and tow-starting
Breakdown assistance
Removing the towing eye
Example: covers for towing eye mountings
: Front cover
; Rear cover
The mountings for the screw-in towing eyes
are located in the bumpers. They are at the
front and at the rear under the covers.
X Remove the towing eye from the vehicle
tool kit (Y page 577).
X Front bumper: insert a finger into the
recess on the bottom edge of cover :.
X Pull cover : out of the bumper towards
you in the direction of the arrow.
Cover : is attached by a strap in the aperture.
X Rear bumper: press the mark on cover ;
inwards in the direction of the arrow.
X Remove cover ; from the aperture.
X Screw the towing eye in clockwise to the
stop and tighten it.
Example: covers for towing eye mountings
: Front cover
; Rear cover
Loosen the towing eye and unscrew it.
Front bumper: position cover : on the
opening in the bumper, as shown.
X Twist cover : into the opening in the direction of the arrow.
Cover : is now attached at the upper edge
of the opening.
X To close, press the lower section of
cover :.
X Rear bumper: position cover ; on
bumper and press until it engages.
X Place the towing eye in the vehicle tool kit
(Y page 577).
X
X
Towing the vehicle with the rear axle
raised
! The ignition must be switched off if you
are towing the vehicle with the rear axle
raised. Intervention by ESP® could otherwise damage the brake system.
Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 130).
X Turn the key in the ignition lock to position
0 and remove the key from the ignition
lock.
X When leaving the vehicle, take the key or
the KEYLESS-GO key with you.
When towing your vehicle with the rear axle
raised, it is important that you observe the
safety instructions (Y page 588).
On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, use the key
instead of the Start/Stop button
(Y page 155).
X Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Leave the key in position 2 in the ignition
lock.
Towing the vehicle with both axles on
the ground
It is important that you observe the safety
instructions when towing away your vehicle
(Y page 588).
X
G WARNING
If the steering wheel lock is engaged, the vehicle can no longer be steered. There is a risk of
an accident.
Always switch on the ignition when towing
with a tow rope or a towing bar.
The automatic transmission automatically
shifts to position P when you open the driver's
or front-passenger door or when you remove
the key from the ignition lock.
In order to ensure that the automatic transmission stays in position N when towing the
vehicle, you must observe the following
points:
Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 130).
i In order to signal a change of direction
when towing the vehicle with the hazard
warning lamps switched on, use the combination switch as usual. In this case, only
the turn signals for the desired direction
flash. When the combination switch is
reset, the hazard warning lamps start flashing again.
X
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary and
that the key is in position 0 in the ignition
lock.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X
Transporting the vehicle
! You may only secure the vehicle by the
wheels, not by parts of the vehicle such as
axle or steering components. Otherwise,
the vehicle could be damaged.
The towing eye can be used to pull the vehicle
onto a trailer or transporter for transport purposes.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position N.
As soon as the vehicle is loaded:
Prevent the vehicle from rolling away by
applying the electric parking brake.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position P.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock and remove it.
X Secure the vehicle.
X
Tow-starting (emergency engine
starting)
! Do not tow-start vehicles with automatic
transmission. You could otherwise damage
the automatic transmission.
Z
591
Breakdown assistance
Towing and tow-starting
Electrical fuses
592
i You can find information on "Jump-starting" under (Y page 586).
Electrical fuses
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Breakdown assistance
If you manipulate, bridge or replace a faulty
fuse with a fuse of a higher amperage, the
electric cables could be overloaded. This may
result in a fire. There is a risk of an accident
and injury.
Always replace faulty fuses with specified new
fuses of the correct amperage.
! Only use fuses that have been approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and which
have the correct fuse rating for the system
concerned. Otherwise, components or systems could be damaged.
The fuses in your vehicle serve to disconnect
faulty circuits. If a fuse blows, all the components on the circuit and their functions will
fail.
Blown fuses must be replaced with fuses of
the same rating, which you can recognise by
the colour and fuse rating. The fuse ratings
are listed in the fuse allocation chart.
If the newly inserted fuse also blows, have the
cause traced and rectified at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
All indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
must be off.
The fuses are located in various fuse boxes:
Rfuse box in the engine compartment on the
right-hand side of the vehicle, when viewed
in the direction of travel
Rdashboard fuse box
Rfuse box in the rear compartment on the
right-hand side of the vehicle, when viewed
in the direction of travel
The fuse allocation chart is located in the
vehicle tool kit in the stowage compartment
under the boot floor (Y page 577).
Dashboard fuse box
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 592).
! Do not use a pointed object such as a
screwdriver to open the cover in the dashboard. You could damage the dashboard or
the cover.
! Make sure that no moisture can enter the
fuse box when the cover is open.
! When closing the cover, make sure that it
is lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture
seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair
the operation of the fuses.
Before replacing a fuse
Secure the vehicle against rolling away
(Y page 175).
X Switch off all electrical consumers.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock and remove it (Y page 155).
or
X On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, make sure
the ignition is switched off (Y page 155).
X
To open: pull cover : outwards in the
direction of the arrow and remove it.
X To close: clip in cover : on the front of the
dashboard.
X Fold cover : inwards until it engages.
X
Electrical fuses
Fuse box in the engine compartment
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 592).
G WARNING
When the bonnet is open, and the windscreen
wipers are set in motion, you can be injured by
the wiper linkage. There is a risk of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before opening the bonnet.
! Make sure that no moisture can enter the
593
To close: check whether the seal is lying
correctly in cover :.
X Insert both openings = at the rear of
cover : into the brackets on the fuse box.
The brackets on the fuse box must be completely visible in the two openings = on the
fuse box.
X Fold down cover :.
X Hook clamps ; into the fuse box and
close.
X
X
Close the bonnet.
fuse box when the cover is open.
X
Fuse box in the rear
is lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture
seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair
the operation of the fuses.
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
Open the bonnet.
! Make sure that no moisture can enter the
tion (Y page 592).
fuse box when the cover is open.
! When closing the cover, make sure that it
is lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture
seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair
the operation of the fuses.
Remove any existing moisture from the
fuse box using a dry cloth.
X To open: open clamps ;.
X Fold cover : of the fuse box up in the
direction of the arrow and remove it.
X
The fuse box in the rear is located on the right-hand
side when viewed in the direction of travel.
To open: open the seat belt guide on the
right-hand seat and remove the seat belt
(Y page 115).
X Move the right-hand seat as far forward as
possible (Y page 115).
X Insert your fingers at the bottom of front
cover : between the cover and floor covering.
X
Z
Breakdown assistance
! When closing the cover, make sure that it
Electrical fuses
594
Remove front cover : towards the front by
pulling it in the direction of the arrow.
X Lift off top cover ; by pulling it in the
direction of the arrow.
Breakdown assistance
X
Fuses = are accessible through the two
openings in the top of the fuse box.
To close: insert the securing tags underneath top cover ; in the recesses at the
top of the fuse box.
X Fold down top cover ; until it engages
audibly.
X Insert the securing tags underneath top
cover : in the recesses at the front of the
fuse box.
X Push front cover : towards the rear until it
engages audibly.
X Move the right-hand seat backwards
(Y page 115).
X Hook the seat belt into the seat belt guide
on the right-hand seat (Y page 115).
X
595
Useful information ............................ 596
Important safety notes .................... 596
Operation ........................................... 596
Winter operation ............................... 598
Tyre pressure .................................... 600
Changing a wheel ............................. 605
Wheel and tyre combinations .......... 610
Wheels and tyres
Emergency spare wheel ................... 614
596
Operation
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 34).
Tyres with run-flat characteristics:
Rpay
attention to the information and warning notices on MOExtended tyres (tyres
with run-flat characteristics).
Accessories that are not approved for your
vehicle by Mercedes-Benz or that are not
being used correctly can impair the operating
safety.
Before purchasing and using non-approved
accessories, visit a qualified specialist workshop and enquire about:
Rsuitability
Wheels and tyres
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If wheels and tyres of the wrong size are used,
the wheel brakes or suspension components
may be damaged. There is a risk of an accident.
Always replace wheels and tyres with those
that fulfil the specifications of the original
part.
When replacing wheels, make sure to fit the
correct:
Rdesignation
Rtype
When replacing tyres, make sure to fit the
correct:
Rdesignation
Rmanufacturer
Rtype
G WARNING
A flat tyre severely impairs the driving, steering and braking characteristics of the vehicle.
There is a risk of accident.
Tyres without run-flat characteristics:
Rdo
not drive with a flat tyre.
replace the flat tyre with your
emergency spare wheel or spare wheel, or
consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Rimmediately
Rlegal
stipulations
recommendations
Information on dimensions and types of
wheels and tyres for your vehicle can be
found (Y page 610).
Information on air pressure for the tyres on
your vehicle can be found:
Rfactory
Ron
the tyre pressure label on the fuel filler
flap (Y page 174)
Rin the "Tyre pressure" section
Modification work on the brake system and
wheels is not permitted. The use of wheel
spacers or brake dust shields is not permitted. This invalidates the general operating
permit for the vehicle.
i Further information on wheels and tyres
can be obtained at any qualified specialist
workshop.
Operation
Information on driving
Check the tyre pressures when the vehicle is
heavily laden and, if necessary, adjust.
While driving, pay attention to vibrations,
noises and unusual handling characteristics,
e.g. pulling to one side. This may indicate that
the wheels or tyres are damaged. If you suspect that a tyre is defective, reduce your
speed immediately. Stop the vehicle as soon
as possible to check the wheels and tyres for
Operation
Regularly check the pressure of all the tyres,
particularly prior to long trips. Adjust the tyre
pressure as necessary (Y page 600).
Observe the notes on the emergency spare
wheel (Y page 614).
The service life of tyres depends on various
factors, including the following:
Rdriving
style
pressure
Rmileage
Rtyre
Regular checking of wheels and tyres
Important safety notes on the tyre
tread
G WARNING
G WARNING
Damaged tyres can cause tyre inflation pressure loss. As a result, you could lose control of
your vehicle. There is a risk of accident.
Check the tyres regularly for signs of damage
and replace any damaged tyres immediately.
Regularly check the wheels and tyres of your
vehicle for damage at least once a month, as
well as after driving off-road or on rough
roads. Damaged wheels can cause a loss of
tyre pressure. Pay particular attention to
damage such as:
Rcuts
in the tyres
Rpunctures
Rtears
in the tyres
Rbulges on tyres
Rdeformation or severe corrosion on wheels
Regularly check the tyre tread depth and the
condition of the tread across the whole width
of the tyre (Y page 597). If necessary, turn
the front wheels to full lock in order to inspect
the inner side of the tyre surface.
All wheels must have a valve cap to protect
the valve against dirt and moisture. Do not fit
anything onto the valve other than the standard valve cap or other valve caps approved for
your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz. Do not fit any
other valve caps or systems, e.g. tyre pressure monitoring systems.
Insufficient tyre tread will reduce tyre traction. The tyre is no longer able to dissipate
water. This means that on wet road surfaces,
the risk of aquaplaning increases, in particular
where speed is not adapted to suit the driving
conditions. There is a risk of accident.
If the tyre pressure is too high or too low, tyres
may exhibit different levels of wear at different locations on the tyre tread. Thus, you
should regularly check the tread depth and
the condition of the tread across the entire
width of all tyres.
Minimum tyre tread depth for:
Rsummer
tyres: 3 mm
tyres: 4 mm
For safety reasons, replace the tyres before
the legally prescribed limit for the minimum
tyre tread depth is reached.
RM+S
Selecting, fitting and replacing tyres
G WARNING
Exceeding the stated tyre load-bearing capacity and the approved maximum speed could
lead to tyre damage or the tyre bursting. There
is a risk of accident.
Therefore, only use tyre types and sizes
approved for your vehicle model. Observe the
Z
Wheels and tyres
damage. Hidden tyre damage could also be
causing the unusual handling characteristics.
If you find no signs of damage, have the tyres
and wheels checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
When parking your vehicle, make sure that
the tyres do not get deformed by the kerb or
other obstacles. If it is necessary to drive over
kerbs, speed humps or similar elevations, try
to do so slowly and at an obtuse angle. Otherwise, the tyres, particularly the sidewalls,
may be damaged.
597
598
Winter operation
Wheels and tyres
tyre load rating and speed rating required for
your vehicle.
Pay special attention to country-specific
requirements for tyre approval. These
requirements can stipulate a specific tyre
type for your vehicle. Furthermore, the use of
certain tyre types in certain regions and areas
of operation can be highly beneficial. You can
find further information regarding tyres at
specialist tyre retailers, at qualified specialist
workshops or at any Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
ROnly fit tyres and wheels of the same type
and make.
Exception: it is permissible to fit a different
type or make in the event of a flat tyre.
Observe the "MOExtended tyres (tyres with
run-flat characteristics" section
(Y page 578).
ROnly fit tyres of the correct size onto the
wheels.
RRun in new tyres at moderate speeds for
the first 100 km. They only reach their full
performance after this distance.
RDo not drive with tyres which have too little
tread depth. This otherwise significantly
reduces the traction on wet roads (aquaplaning).
RReplace the tyres after six years at the latest, regardless of wear.
Observe the notes on the emergency spare
wheel (Y page 614).
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics)
With MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics), you can continue to drive
your vehicle even if there is a total loss of
pressure in one or more tyres.
Only use MOExtended tyres in conjunction
with an activated tyre pressure loss warning
system or tyre pressure monitoring system
and only on tyres specifically inspected by
Mercedes‑Benz.
Notes on driving with MOExtended tyres with
a flat tyre (Y page 578).
i Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It
is therefore recommended that you additionally equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit
if you fit tyres that do not feature run-flat
characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT
kit can be obtained from a qualified specialist workshop.
Winter operation
General notes
Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified
specialist workshop at the onset of winter.
Observe the notes in the "Changing a wheel"
section (Y page 605).
Driving with summer tyres
At temperatures below +7 †, summer tyres
lose elasticity and therefore traction and
braking power. Change the tyres on your vehicle to M+S tyres. Using summer tyres at very
cold temperatures could cause tears to form,
thereby damaging the tyres permanently.
Mercedes-Benz cannot accept responsibility
for this type of damage.
M+S tyres
G WARNING
M+S tyres with a tyre tread depth of less than
4 mm are not suitable for use in winter as they
do not provide sufficient traction. There is a
risk of accident.
M+S tyres with a tread depth of less than
4 mm must be replaced.
At temperatures below +7 †, use winter tyres
or all-season tyres. Both are marked with
M+S.
Winter operation
X
X
Check the tyre pressures (Y page 600).
Restart the tyre pressure monitor
(Y page 604).
For more information on driving with the
emergency spare wheel, see (Y page 614).
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use snow chains that
have been specifically approved for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz, or that are of a corresponding standard of quality.
If you intend to fit snow chains, please bear
the following points in mind:
Rsnow
chains cannot be fitted to all wheeltyre combinations. Permissible wheel-tyre
combinations (Y page 610).
Ronly use snow chains if the road surface is
completely snow-covered. Remove the
snow chains as soon as possible when you
come to a road that is not snow-covered.
Rlocal regulations may restrict the use of
snow chains. Observe the appropriate regulations if you wish to fit snow chains.
Rdo not exceed the maximum permissible
speed of 50 km/h.
Ron vehicles with Active Body Control (ABC),
you must drive at a raised vehicle level if
snow chains have been fitted (Y page 199).
i You may wish to deactivate ESP® when
pulling away with snow chains fitted
(Y page 74). This way you can allow the
wheels to spin in a controlled manner, achieving an increased driving force (cutting
action).
For more information on driving with the
emergency spare wheel, see (Y page 614).
Snow chains
G WARNING
If you have fitted snow chains to the front
wheels, they may scrape against the vehicle
body or chassis components. This could
cause damage to the vehicle or the tyres.
There is a risk of an accident.
To avoid hazardous situations:
Rnever
Rfit
fit snow chains on the front wheels
snow chains to the rear wheels in pairs.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Only winter tyres bearing the i snowflake
symbol in addition to the M+S marking provide the best possible grip in wintry road conditions.
Only these tyres will allow driving safety systems such as ABS and ESP® to function optimally in winter. These tyres have been developed specifically for driving in snow.
Use M+S tyres of the same make and tread on
all wheels to maintain safe handling characteristics.
Always observe the maximum permissible
speed specified for the M+S tyres you have
fitted.
If you fit M+S tyres that have a lower maximum permissible speed than that of the vehicle, affix a corresponding warning label in the
driver's field of vision. This can be obtained at
a qualified specialist workshop.
Under these circumstances, you should also
use permanent SPEEDTRONIC to restrict the
maximum speed of the vehicle so that it does
not exceed the maximum permissible speed
for the M+S tyres (Y page 196).
When you have fitted the M+S tyres:
599
600
Tyre pressure
Tyre pressure
Tyre pressure specifications
G WARNING
Underinflated or overinflated tyres pose the
following risks:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load
and vehicle speed increase.
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or
unevenly, which may greatly impair tyre
traction.
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be greatly impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
Observe the recommended tyre pressure and
check the tyre pressure of all the tyres including the spare wheel:
Rat
least every two weeks
the load changes
Rbefore embarking on a longer journey
Rfor changed operating conditions, e.g. offroad driving
If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
Wheels and tyres
Rwhen
G WARNING
If you fit unsuitable accessories onto tyre
valves, the tyre valves may be overloaded and
malfunction, which can cause tyre pressure
loss. Due to their design, retrofitted tyre pressure monitors keep the tyre valve open. This
can also result in tyre pressure loss. There is a
risk of accident.
Only screw standard valve caps or valve caps
specifically provided by Mercedes-Benz for
your vehicle onto the tyre valve.
G WARNING
If the tyre pressure drops repeatedly, the
wheel, valve or tyre may be damaged. Tyre
pressure that is too low may result in a tyre
blow-out. There is a risk of accident.
RCheck the tyre for foreign objects.
RCheck whether the wheel is losing air or the
valve is leaking.
If you are unable to rectify the damage, contact a qualified specialist workshop.
H Environmental note
Check the tyre pressure regularly, at least
every 14 days.
You will find a table of tyre pressures for various operating conditions on the inside of
your vehicle's fuel filler flap.
The table inside the fuel filler flap may state
tyre pressures for different load conditions.
These are defined in the table as different
numbers of passengers and amounts of luggage. The actual number of seats may vary;
for more information, please refer to the vehicle's registration documents.
If tyre sizes are not specified, the tyre pressures stated on the tyre pressure information
label apply for all tyres approved for this vehicle.
If a tyre size precedes a tyre pressure, the
following tyre pressure information is only
valid for that tyre size.
Use a suitable pressure gauge to check the
tyre pressure. The outer appearance of a tyre
does not permit any reliable conclusion about
the tyre pressure. On vehicles fitted with an
electronic tyre pressure monitor, the tyre
pressure can be checked using the on-board
computer.
If possible, only correct tyre pressures when
the tyres are cold.
Tyre pressure
Rif the vehicle has been parked with the tyres
out of direct sunlight for at least three
hours and
Rif the vehicle has not been driven further
than 1.6 km
Depending on the ambient temperature, the
speed at which you are driving and the load on
the tyres, the tyre temperature and thus the
tyre pressure changes by approximately
10 kPa (0.1 bar/1.5 psi) per 10 †. Take this
into account when checking the pressure of
warm tyres. Only correct the tyre pressure if it
is too low for the current operating conditions.
Driving with tyre pressure that is too high or
too low can:
Rshorten
the service life of the tyres
increased tyre damage
Rhave a negative effect on handling characteristics and thus driving safety (e.g. aquaplaning)
Rcause
i The tyre pressure values given for low
loads are minimum values which offer you
good ride comfort characteristics.
However, you can also use the values given
for higher loads. These are permissible and
will not adversely affect the running of the
vehicle.
Tyre pressure loss warning system
General notes
While the vehicle is in motion, the tyre pressure loss warning system monitors the set
tyre pressure using the rotational speed of
the wheels. This enables the system to detect
significant pressure loss in a tyre. If the speed
of rotation of a wheel changes as a result of a
loss of pressure, a corresponding warning
message will appear in the multifunction display.
You can recognise the tyre pressure loss
warning by the Run Flat Indicator
active Restart with OK message which
appears in the Serv. menu of the multifunction display. Information on the message display can be found in the "Restarting the tyre
pressure loss warning system" section
(Y page 601).
Important safety notes
The tyre pressure warning system does not
warn you of an incorrectly set tyre pressure.
Observe the notes on the recommended tyre
pressure (Y page 600).
The tyre pressure loss warning does not
replace the need to regularly check the tyre
pressures. An even loss of pressure on several tyres at the same time cannot be detected by the tyre pressure loss warning system.
The tyre pressure monitor is not able to warn
you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the
tyre is penetrated by a foreign object. In the
event of a sudden loss of pressure, bring the
vehicle to a halt by braking carefully. Avoid
abrupt steering manoeuvres.
The function of the tyre pressure loss warning
system is limited or delayed if:
Rsnow
chains are fitted to your vehicle's
tyres.
Rroad conditions are wintry.
Ryou are driving on sand or gravel.
Ryou adopt a very sporty driving style (cornering at high speeds or driving with high
rates of acceleration).
Ryou drive with a heavy load.
Restarting the tyre pressure loss warning system
Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system
if you have:
Rchanged
the tyre pressure
the wheels or tyres
Rfitted new wheels or tyres
X Before restarting, make sure that the tyre
pressures are set properly on all four tyres
for the respective operating conditions.
Rchanged
Z
Wheels and tyres
The tyres are cold:
601
Tyre pressure
602
Wheels and tyres
The recommended tyre pressures can be
found in the table on the fuel filler flap.
The tyre pressure loss warning system can
only give reliable warnings if you have set
the correct tyre pressure. If an incorrect
tyre pressure is set, these incorrect values
will be monitored.
X Observe the notes in the section on tyre
pressures (Y page 600).
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock (Y page 155).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
pressure
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator active
Restart with OK message appears in the
multifunction display.
Tyre pressure monitor
General notes
If a tyre pressure monitor system is fitted, the
vehicle's wheels have sensors fitted that
monitor the tyre pressures in all four tyres.
The tyre pressure monitor warns you if the
pressure drops in one or more of the tyres.
The tyre pressure monitor only functions if
the corresponding sensors are fitted to all
wheels.
Information on tyre pressures is shown in the
multifunction display. After a few minutes of
driving, the current tyre pressure of each tyre
is shown in the Serv. menu of the multifunction display.
If you wish to confirm the restart:
Press the a button.
The Tyre press. now OK? message
appears in the multifunction display.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Yes.
Yes
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator restarted
message appears in the multifunction display.
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure
loss warning system will monitor the set
tyre pressures of all four tyres.
X
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
Press the % button.
or
If the Tyre pressure now OK? message
appears, use the 9 or : button to
select Cancel
Cancel.
X Press the a button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
X
Example: current tyre pressure display
For further information on displaying this
message, refer to the "Checking the tyre pressure electronically" section (Y page 603).
Important safety notes
It is the driver's responsibility to set the tyre
pressure to the recommended cold tyre pressure suitable for the operating situation
(Y page 600). Note that the correct tyre pressure for the current operating situation must
first be taught-in to the tyre pressure monitor.
If there is a substantial loss of pressure, the
warning threshold for the warning message is
aligned to the reference values taught-in.
Restart the tyre pressure monitor after
adjusting to the cold tyre pressure
(Y page 604). The current pressures are
saved as new reference values. This will
ensure that a warning message will only
appear if the tyre pressure drops significantly.
The tyre pressure monitor does not warn you
of an incorrectly set tyre pressure. Observe
Tyre pressure
Rif
the warning lamp is lit continuously, the
tyre pressure on one or more tyres is significantly too low. The tyre pressure monitor is not malfunctioning.
Rif the warning lamp flashes for around a
minute and then remains lit constantly, the
tyre pressure monitor is malfunctioning.
i In addition to the warning lamp, a mes-
sage appears in the multifunction display.
Further information can be found on
(Y page 267).
If the tyre pressure monitor is malfunctioning,
it may take more than ten minutes for the tyre
pressure warning lamp to inform you of the
malfunction by flashing for approximately one
minute and then remaining lit. When the fault
has been rectified, the tyre pressure warning
lamp goes out after you have driven for a few
minutes.
The tyre pressure values indicated by the onboard computer may differ from those measured at a filling station using a pressure
gauge. The tyre pressures shown by the onboard computer refer to those measured at
sea level. At high altitudes, the tyre pressure
values indicated by a pressure gauge are
higher than those shown by the on-board
computer. In this case, do not reduce the tyre
pressures.
The operation of the tyre pressure monitor
can be affected by interference from radio
transmitting equipment (e.g. radio headphones, two-way radios) that may be being
operated in or near the vehicle.
Checking the tyre pressure electronically
Make sure that the key is in position 2
(Y page 155) in the ignition lock.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
pressure
X Press the a button.
The current tyre pressure for each wheel
will be shown in the multifunction display.
X
If the vehicle has been parked for over
20 minutes, the Tyre pressures will be
displayed after a few minutes of
driving message appears.
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure
monitor automatically recognises new
wheels or new sensors. As long as a clear
allocation of the tyre pressure values to the
individual wheels is not possible, the Tyre
pressure monitor active display message is shown instead of the tyre pressure
display. The tyre pressures are already being
monitored.
i If an emergency spare wheel is fitted, for
a few minutes the system may continue to
show the tyre pressure of the wheel that
has been removed. If this occurs, note that
the value displayed for the position where
the spare wheel is fitted is not the same as
the current tyre pressure of the emergency
spare wheel.
Z
Wheels and tyres
the notes on the recommended tyre pressure
(Y page 600).
The tyre pressure monitor is not able to warn
you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the
tyre is penetrated by a foreign object. In the
event of a sudden loss of pressure, bring the
vehicle to a halt by braking carefully. Avoid
abrupt steering manoeuvres.
The tyre pressure monitor has a yellow warning lamp in the instrument cluster for indicating a pressure loss or malfunction. Depending
on how the warning lamp flashes or lights up,
a tyre pressure that is too low or a malfunction in the tyre pressure monitor is indicated:
603
604
Tyre pressure
Warning messages of the tyre pressure
monitor
If the tyre pressure monitor detects a pressure loss in one or more tyres, a warning message is shown in the multifunction display and
the yellow tyre pressure monitor warning light
comes on.
Wheels and tyres
RIf
the Rectify tyre pressure message
appears in the multifunction display, the
tyre pressure in at least one tyre is too low
and must be corrected at the next opportunity.
RIf the Check tyre(s) message appears in
the multifunction display, the tyre pressure
in one or more tyres has dropped significantly and the tyres must be checked.
RIf the Warning tyre defect message
appears in the multifunction display, the
tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped suddenly and the tyres must be
checked.
Observe the instructions and safety notes in
the display messages in the "Tyres" section
(Y page 267).
i If the wheel positions on the vehicle are
Use the table on the inside of the fuel filler
flap to ensure that the tyre pressure is set
correctly in all four tyres for the current
operating conditions.
Also observe the notes in the section on
tyre pressures (Y page 600).
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
pressure
X Press the a button.
The multifunction display shows the current tyre pressure for the individual tyres or
the Tyre pressures will be dis‐
played after a few minutes of driv‐
ing message.
X Press the : button.
The Use current pressures as new
reference values message appears in
the multifunction display.
X
If you wish to confirm the restart:
X
interchanged, for a short time the tyre pressures may be displayed for the wrong positions. After a few minutes of driving, this is
rectified and the tyre pressures are displayed for the correct positions.
Restarting the tyre pressure monitor
When you restart the tyre pressure monitor,
all existing warning messages are deleted and
the warning lamps go out. The monitor uses
the currently set tyre pressures as the reference values for monitoring. In most cases, the
tyre pressure monitor will automatically
detect the new reference values after you
have changed the tyre pressure. However,
you can also define reference values manually as described here. The tyre pressure
monitor then monitors the new tyre pressure
values.
Press the a button.
The Tyre press. monitor restarted
message appears in the multifunction display.
After you have driven for a few minutes, the
system checks whether the current tyre
pressures are within the specified range.
The new tyre pressures are then accepted
as reference values and monitored.
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
Press the % button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
Changing a wheel
Country
Radio type approval number
Brazil
1489-10-4415
Model: MRXMERCTX1
Dubai
TRA, Registered-NO:
0016161/08
TRA, Registered NO
ER0076990/11
Dealer-NO: DA0047074/10
Morocco
MR5526 ANRT 2010/
27/04/2010
MR6706 ANRT 2011/
17/11/2011
Philippines
ESD-1105558C
Serbia
И 011 12
Singapore
Compliance with IDA Standard
N0140-09
South
Africa
TA-2008/1068
TA-2011/1370
Changing a wheel
Flat tyre
You can find information on what to do in the
event of a flat tyre in the "Breakdown assistance" section (Y page 578). Information on
driving with MOExtended tyres in the event of
a flat tyre can be found under "Breakdown
assistance" (Y page 578).
may also be damaged. There is a risk of accident.
Interchange front and rear wheels only if the
wheels and tyres are of the same dimensions.
! On vehicles fitted with a tyre pressure
monitor, electronic components are located in the wheel.
Tyre-fitting tools should not be applied in
the area of the valve, as this could damage
the electronic components.
Only have tyres changed at a qualified specialist workshop.
Interchanging front and rear wheels of differing dimensions can render the general operating permit invalid.
Always pay attention to the instructions and
safety notes when changing a wheel
(Y page 606).
The wear patterns on the front and rear tyres
differ, depending on the operating conditions.
Interchange the wheels before a clear wear
pattern has formed on the tyres. Front tyres
typically wear more on the shoulders and the
rear tyres in the centre.
On vehicles that have the same size front and
rear wheels, you can interchange the wheels
every 5,000 to 10,000 km depending on the
degree of tyre wear. Ensure the direction of
rotation is maintained.
Clean the contact surfaces of the wheel and
the brake disc thoroughly every time a wheel
is interchanged. Check the tyre pressure and,
if necessary, restart the tyre pressure loss
warning system or the tyre pressure monitor.
Direction of rotation
Interchanging the wheels
G WARNING
Interchanging the front and rear wheels may
severely impair the driving characteristics if
the wheels or tyres have different dimensions.
The wheel brakes or suspension components
Tyres with a specified direction of rotation
have additional benefits, e.g. if there is a risk
of aquaplaning. You will only gain these benefits if the correct direction of rotation is
observed.
An arrow on the sidewall of the tyre indicates
its correct direction of rotation.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Radio type approval for the tyre pressure monitor
605
Changing a wheel
606
Storing wheels
Store wheels that are not being used in a cool,
dry and preferably dark place. Protect the
tyres against oil, grease, petrol and diesel.
Cleaning the wheels
Wheels and tyres
G WARNING
The water jet of circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) can cause damage not visible from the
outside to tyres or chassis components. Components damaged in this way can unexpectedly fail. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles to clean the vehicle. Have damaged tyres or chassis components replaced
immediately.
Fitting a wheel
If included in the vehicle equipment,
remove the tyre-change tool kit from the
vehicle.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling
away.
X
i Apart from certain country-specific variations, vehicles are not equipped with a tyrechange tool kit. For information on which
tools are required to perform a wheel
change on your vehicle, consult a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Necessary wheel-changing tools may
include, for example:
Rjack
Rwheel
Rwheel
chock
wrench
Securing the vehicle against rolling
away
Preparing the vehicle
Stop the vehicle on solid, non-slippery and
level ground.
X Unload the vehicle. The jack can only be
used when the vehicle is unladen.
X Apply the electric parking brake manually.
X Move the front wheels to the straightahead position.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Switch off the engine.
X Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove
the key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: open the
driver's door.
The on-board electronics now have status
0. This is the same as the key having been
removed.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: remove the
Start/Stop button from the ignition lock
(Y page 155).
X
If your vehicle is equipped with a wheel chock,
it can be found in the tyre-change tool kit
(Y page 577).
The folding wheel chock is an additional
securing measure to prevent the vehicle from
rolling away, for example when changing a
wheel.
X Fold both plates upwards :.
X Fold out lower plate ;.
X Guide the lugs on the lower plate fully into
the openings in base plate =.
Changing a wheel
607
The following must be observed when raising
the vehicle:
Securing the vehicle on level ground
X
On level ground: place chocks or other
suitable items under the front and rear of
the wheel that is diagonally opposite the
wheel you wish to change.
Securing the vehicle on slight downhill gradients
X
On light downhill gradients: place
chocks or other suitable items in front of
the wheels of the front and rear axle.
Raising the vehicle
G WARNING
If you do not position the jack correctly at the
appropriate jacking point of the vehicle, the
jack could tip over with the vehicle raised.
There is a risk of injury.
Only position the jack at the appropriate jacking point of the vehicle. The base of the jack
must be positioned vertically, directly under
the jacking point of the vehicle.
raise the vehicle, only use the vehiclespecific jack that has been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. If the jack is
used incorrectly, it could tip over while the
vehicle is raised.
Rthe jack is designed only to raise and hold
the vehicle for a short time while a wheel
is being changed. It is not suitable for performing maintenance work under the vehicle.
Ravoid changing the wheel on uphill and
downhill slopes.
Rbefore raising the vehicle, secure it from
rolling away by applying the parking brake
and positioning wheel chocks. Never
release the parking brake while the vehicle
is raised.
Rthe jack must be placed on a firm, flat and
non-slip surface. On a loose surface, a
large, flat, load-bearing underlay must be
used. On a slippery surface, a non-slip
underlay must be used, e.g. a rubber mat.
Rdo not use wooden blocks or similar
objects as a jack underlay. Otherwise, the
jack will not be able to achieve its loadbearing capacity due to the restricted
height.
Rmake sure that the distance between the
underside of the tyres and the ground does
not exceed 3 cm.
Rnever place your hands or feet under the
raised vehicle.
Rdo not lie under the vehicle.
Rdo not start the engine when the vehicle is
raised.
Rdo not open or close a door or the boot lid
when the vehicle is raised.
Rmake sure that no persons are present in
the vehicle when the vehicle is raised.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Rto
Changing a wheel
608
Wheels and tyres
X
Using wheel wrench :, loosen the bolts on
the wheel you wish to change by about one
full turn. Do not unscrew the bolts completely.
The jacking points are located just behind the
front wheel arches and just in front of the rear
wheel arches (arrows).
X
AMG vehicles and vehicles with AMG
equipment: fold cover ; upwards.
X
Position jack ? at jacking point =.
Example
X
Make sure that the base of the jack is positioned vertically under the jacking point.
Turn crank A clockwise until jack ? sits
completely on jacking point = and the
base of the jack lies evenly on the ground.
X Turn crank A until the tyre is raised a maximum of 3 cm off the ground.
X
Removing a wheel
! AMG vehicles: during removal and repoCovers, front (example: vehicles with AMG equipment)
AMG vehicles and vehicles with AMG
equipment: to protect the vehicle body, the
vehicle has covers fitted next to the jacking
points on the outer sills.
sitioning of the wheel, the wheel rim can
strike the ceramic-brake disc and damage
it. Therefore, take precautions and get a
second person to assist you. Alternatively,
you can use a second centring pin.
! Do not place wheel bolts in sand or dirt.
The threads of the wheel bolts and wheel
Changing a wheel
hubs could otherwise be damaged when
the bolts are tightened.
609
sons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
only use wheel bolts which have been
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and the
respective wheel.
! AMG vehicles: during removal and repositioning of the wheel, the wheel rim can
strike the ceramic-brake disc and damage
it. Therefore, take precautions and get a
second person to assist you. Alternatively,
you can use a second centring pin.
Unscrew the uppermost wheel bolt completely.
X Screw centring pin : into the thread
instead of the wheel bolt.
X Unscrew the remaining wheel bolts fully.
X Remove the wheel.
Fitting a new wheel
G WARNING
Oiled or greased wheel bolts or damaged
wheel bolts/hub threads can cause the wheel
bolts to come loose. As a result, you could
lose a wheel while driving. There is a risk of
accident.
Never oil or grease wheel bolts. In the event of
damage to the threads, contact a qualified
specialist workshop immediately. Have the
damaged wheel bolts or hub threads
replaced/renewed. Do not continue driving.
G WARNING
If you tighten the wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is raised, the jack could tip
over. There is a risk of injury.
Only tighten the wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is on the ground.
Always pay attention to the instructions and
safety notices in "Changing a wheel"
(Y page 605).
Only use wheel bolts that have been designed
for the wheel and the vehicle. For safety rea-
Clean the wheel and wheel hub contact
surfaces.
X Slide the wheel to be mounted onto the
centring pin and push it on.
X Tighten the wheel bolts until they are finger-tight.
X Unscrew the centring pin.
X Tighten the last wheel bolt until it is fingertight.
X Vehicles with a collapsible emergency
spare wheel: inflate the collapsible emergency spare wheel (Y page 615). Only
then lower the vehicle.
X
Lowering the vehicle
G WARNING
The wheels could work loose if the wheel nuts
and bolts are not tightened to the specified
tightening torque. There is a risk of accident.
Have the tightening torque immediately
checked at a qualified specialist workshop
after a wheel is changed.
Z
Wheels and tyres
X
Wheel and tyre combinations
610
Wheel and tyre combinations
General notes
! For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz rec-
Turn the crank of the jack anti-clockwise
until the vehicle is once again standing
firmly on the ground.
X Place the jack to one side.
X Tighten the wheel bolts evenly in a crosswise pattern in the sequence indicated (:
to A). The specified tightening torque is
130 Nm.
X Turn the jack back to its initial position.
X Stow the jack and the rest of the vehicle
tools in the boot again.
X AMG vehicles and vehicles with AMG
equipment: insert the cover into the outer
sill.
X Check the air pressure of the newly fitted
wheel and adjust accordingly.
Observe the recommended tyre pressure
(Y page 600).
Wheels and tyres
X
i If you are driving with the collapsible
emergency spare wheel fitted, the tyre
pressure loss warning system or the tyre
pressure monitor cannot function reliably.
Do not restart the tyre pressure loss warning system/tyre pressure monitor until the
defective wheel has been replaced with a
new wheel.
Vehicles with a tyre pressure control
system: all fitted wheels must be equipped
with functioning sensors.
ommends that you only use tyres and
wheels which have been approved by
Mercedes-Benz specifically for your vehicle.
These are specially adapted to the control
systems, such as ABS or ESP® and are
marked as follows:
RMO
= Mercedes-Benz Original
RMOE = Mercedes-Benz Original Extended
(tyres featuring run-flat characteristics)
RMO1 = Mercedes-Benz Original (only cer-
tain AMG tyres)
Mercedes-Benz Original Extended tyres
may only be used on wheels that have been
specifically approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Only use tyres, wheels or accessories tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz. Certain characteristics, e.g. handling, vehicle
noise emissions or fuel consumption, may
otherwise be adversely affected. In addition, when driving with a load, tyre dimension variations could cause the tyres to
come into contact with the bodywork and
axle components. This could result in damage to the tyres or the vehicle.
Mercedes-Benz accepts no liability for
damage resulting from the use of tyres,
wheels or accessories other than those tested and approved.
Further information about wheels, tyres
and approved combinations can be
obtained from any qualified specialist
workshop.
! Retreaded tyres are neither tested nor
recommended by Mercedes-Benz, since
previous damage cannot always be detected on retreaded tyres. As a result,
Mercedes-Benz cannot guarantee vehicle
safety if retreaded tyres are fitted. Do not fit
used tyres if you have no information about
their previous usage.
Wheel and tyre combinations
611
! Large wheels: the lower the section width
for a certain wheel size, the lower the ride
comfort is on poor road surfaces. Roll comfort and suspension comfort are reduced
and the risk of damage to the wheels and
tyres as a result of driving over obstacles
increases.
Overview of abbreviations used in the following tyre tables:
RBA:
both axles
front axle
RRA: rear axle
You will find a table with recommended tyre
pressures for various operating conditions on
the inside of your vehicle's fuel filler flap. For
further information on tyre pressure, see
(Y page 600). Check tyre pressures regularly
and only when the tyres are cold.
Notes on the vehicle equipment – always fit
the vehicle:
Wheels and tyres
RFA:
Rwith
tyres of the same size on a given axle
(left/right)
Rwith the same type of tyres at a given time
(summer tyres, winter tyres, MOExtended
tyres)
Exception: it is permissible to fit a different
type or make in the event of a flat tyre.
Observe the "MOExtended tyres (tyres with
run-flat characteristics" section
(Y page 578).
Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It is
therefore recommended that you additionally
equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit if you fit
tyres that do not feature run-flat characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT kit can be
obtained from a qualified specialist workshop.
i Not all wheel/tyre combinations can be
fitted at the factory in all countries.
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
612
Tyres
SL 350
Summer tyres
R17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/45 R17 98 Y1
BA: 8.0 J x 17 H2 ET 30
R18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 95 Y1, 2
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 35.5
FA: 255/40 R18 95 Y2
RA: 285/35 R18 97 Y2, 3
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 35.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 47.5
Wheels and tyres
R19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL2, 4
RA: 285/30 R19 98 Y XL2, 3, 4
FA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 35.5
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 47.5
FA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL2, 4
RA: 285/30 R19 98 Y XL2, 3, 4
FA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 35.5
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 48
Winter tyres
R17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/45 R17 98 V M+S i1
BA: 8.0 J x 17 H2 ET 30
R18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 V XL M+S i2
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 35.5
Not in conjunction with Active Body Control (Code 487), Sports package (Code 950) or Edition 1 package
(Code P88).
2 Available as MOExtended tyres.
3 The use of snow chains is not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
4 Observe notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
1
Wheel and tyre combinations
613
SL 500
Summer tyres
R18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/40 R18 95 Y2
RA: 285/35 R18 97 Y2, 3
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 35.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 47.5
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL2, 4
RA: 285/30 R19 98 Y XL2, 3, 4
FA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 35.5
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 47.5
FA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL2, 4
RA: 285/30 R19 98 Y XL2, 3, 4
FA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 35.5
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 48
Winter tyres
R18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 V XL M+S i2
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 35.5
AMG vehicles
Summer tyres
i AMG vehicles with 20-inch wheels on the rear axle: if replaced with 19-inch wheels,
ETS may intervene noticeably earlier for the first few kilometres. After approximately 10 km
ETS will function as usual again. Information on ETS can be found under "ETS (Electronic
Traction System)" (Y page 73).
R19/R20
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 ZR19 (96 Y) XL4
RA: 285/30 ZR19 (98 Y) XL4
FA: 9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 27
RA: 10.0 J x 19 H2 ET 48
FA: 255/35 ZR19 (96 Y) XL4
RA: 285/30 ZR20 (99 Y) XL3, 4
FA: 9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 27
RA: 10.0 J x 20 H2 ET 48
Available as MOExtended tyres.
The use of snow chains is not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
4 Observe notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
2
3
Z
Wheels and tyres
R19
Emergency spare wheel
614
Winter tyres
R19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 R19 96 V XL M+S i4
RA: 285/30 R19 98 V XL M+S i4
FA: 9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 27
RA: 10.0 J x 19 H2 ET 48
Emergency spare wheel
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The wheel/tyre dimensions and the tyre type
of the spare wheel/emergency spare wheel
and the wheel to be replaced may differ. Fitting a spare wheel/emergency spare wheel
may severely impair the driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
To prevent hazardous situations:
your driving style accordingly and
drive carefully.
RNever fit more than one spare wheel/emergency spare wheel if the dimensions are
different to those of the wheel being
replaced.
ROnly use a spare wheel/emergency spare
wheel briefly if the dimensions are different
to those of the wheel being replaced.
Wheels and tyres
RAdapt
not switch off ESP®.
RHave the spare wheel/emergency spare
wheel in question replaced at the nearest
qualified specialist workshop. Make sure
that the wheel/tyre dimensions and tyre
type are correct.
RDo
When using an emergency spare wheel or
spare wheel of a different size, you must not
exceed the maximum speed of 80 km/h.
Snow chains must not be fitted to emergency
spare wheels.
4
General notes
You should regularly check the pressure of all
your tyres, including the emergency spare
wheel, particularly prior to long trips, and correct the pressure as necessary (Y page 600).
The applicable value is found on the wheel or
under "Technical data" (Y page 617).
An emergency spare wheel may also be fitted
against the direction of rotation. Observe the
time restriction on use as well as the speed
limitation specified on the emergency spare
wheel.
Replace the tyres after six years at the latest,
regardless of wear. This also applies to the
emergency spare wheel.
i If you are driving with the collapsible
emergency spare wheel fitted, the tyre
pressure loss warning system or the tyre
pressure monitor cannot function reliably.
Do not restart the tyre pressure loss warning system/tyre pressure monitor until the
defective wheel has been replaced with a
new wheel.
Vehicles with a tyre pressure monitor:
for a few minutes after an emergency spare
wheel is fitted, the system may still display
the tyre pressure of the removed wheel.
The value displayed for the mounted emergency spare wheel is not the same as the
current tyre pressure of the emergency
spare wheel.
Observe notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
Emergency spare wheel
Removing the emergency spare wheel
615
Observe the instructions and safety notes in
the "Fitting a wheel" section (Y page 606).
Inflating the collapsible emergency
spare wheel
! Inflate the collapsible emergency spare
wheel using the tyre inflation compressor
before lowering the vehicle. The wheel rim
could otherwise be damaged.
! Do not operate the tyre inflation comOpen the boot.
Open the boot separator (Y page 106).
X Remove the emergency spare wheel bag
with collapsible emergency spare
wheel :.
X
X
Mount the collapsible emergency spare
wheel as described (Y page 606).
The collapsible emergency spare wheel
must be mounted before it is inflated.
X Pull connector ? and the air hose out of
the housing.
X Remove the cap from the valve on the collapsible emergency spare wheel.
X Screw union nut : on the air hose onto the
valve.
X Make sure on/off switch A of the tyre
inflation compressor is set to 0.
X Insert plug ? into the socket of the cigarette lighter or into a 12 V of power socket
in your vehicle.
Observe the notes on the cigarette lighter
(Y page 550). Observe the notes on sockets (Y page 550).
X
Vehicles with an emergency spare wheel
The emergency spare wheel is packed in
emergency spare wheel bag : and secured
in the boot.
X Open the boot.
X Open the boot separator (Y page 106).
X Loosen tensioning strap ; on both sides
of emergency spare wheel bag :.
X Unhook retaining spring hooks = of tensioning strap ; from the retainers.
X Remove emergency spare wheel bag :
with the emergency spare wheel.
X Open emergency spare wheel bag : and
remove the emergency spare wheel.
Z
Wheels and tyres
pressor for longer than eight minutes at a
time without a break. It may otherwise
overheat.
The tyre inflation compressor can be operated again once it has cooled down.
Vehicles with a collapsible emergency spare wheel
Emergency spare wheel
616
Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 155).
X Press on/off switch A on the tyre inflation
compressor to I.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
on. The tyre is inflated. The tyre pressure is
shown on pressure gauge =.
X Pump the tyre to the specified tyre pressure.
The specified tyre pressure is printed on
the yellow label of the emergency spare
wheel.
X When the specified tyre pressure has been
reached, press on/off switch A on the
electric air pump to 0.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
off.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock.
X If the tyre pressure is higher than the specified pressure, press pressure release button ; until the correct tyre pressure has
been reached.
X Unscrew union nut : on the air hose from
the valve.
X Screw the valve cap onto the collapsible
emergency spare wheel valve again.
Wheels and tyres
X
Stow plug ? and the air hose in the lower
section of the compressor housing.
X Stow the tyre inflation compressor in the
vehicle.
X
Emergency spare wheel
617
Technical data
All models (except AMG vehicles)
Collapsible emergency spare wheel
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
175/55 - 18 95 P
Tyre pressure: 350 kPa (3.5 bar/51 psi)
6.0 B x 18 H2 ET 25
AMG vehicles
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
175/50 - 19 97 P
Tyre pressure: 350 kPa (3.5 bar/51 psi)
6.5 B x 19 H2 ET 14
Wheels and tyres
Collapsible emergency spare wheel
Z
618
619
Useful information ............................ 620
Information on technical data ......... 620
Vehicle electronics ........................... 620
Identification plates ......................... 622
Service products and capacities ..... 622
Technical data
Vehicle data ...................................... 629
620
Vehicle electronics
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 34).
Information on technical data
General notes
You can find current technical data on the
Internet on our Mercedes‑Benz homepage.
Technical data
i The technical data was determined in
accordance with EU Directives. All data
applies to the vehicle's standard equipment. The data may therefore differ for
vehicles with optional equipment. You can
obtain further information from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Vehicle electronics
Tampering with the engine electronics
! Only have work carried out on the engine
electronics and its associated parts, such
as control units, sensors and connector
leads, at a qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicle components may otherwise wear
more quickly and the vehicle's operating
permit may be invalidated.
Retrofitting two-way radios and
mobile phones (RF transmitters)
G WARNING
If RF transmitters are tampered with or not
properly retrofitted, the electromagnetic radiation they emit can interfere with the vehicle
electronics. This may jeopardise the operational safety of the vehicle. There is a risk of an
accident.
You should have all work on electrical and
electronic components carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If you use the RF transmitter in the vehicle in
an improper way, its electromagnetic radiation can disrupt vehicle electronics, e.g. if:
Rthe
RF transmitter is not connected to an
exterior aerial
Rthe exterior aerial is fitted incorrectly or is
not a low-reflection aerial
This can jeopardise the operating safety of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Have the low-reflection exterior aerial fitted at
a qualified specialist workshop. When operating in the vehicle, always connect the RF
transmitter to the low-reflection exterior aerial.
! The operating permit may be invalidated if
the instructions for installation and use of
RF transmitters are not observed.
In particular, the following conditions must
be complied with:
Ronly
approved wavebands may be used.
the maximum permissible output in these wavebands.
Ronly approved aerial positions may be
used.
Robserve
Excessive levels of electromagnetic radiation
may cause damage to your health and to the
health of others. The use of an exterior aerial
takes into consideration the scientific discus-
Vehicle electronics
Approved aerial positions
: Rear wing
i On the rear wing, it is recommended that
you position the aerial on the side of the
vehicle closest to the centre of the road.
Use Technical Specification ISO/TS 21609
(Road Vehicles – "EMC guidelines for fitting
aftermarket radio frequency transmitting
equipment") when retrofitting RF (radio frequency) transmitters. Comply with the legal
requirements for add-on parts.
If your vehicle has fittings for two-way radio
equipment, use the power supply or aerial
connections intended for use with the basic
wiring. Be sure to observe the manufacturer's
additional instructions when installing.
Deviations with respect to wavebands, maximum transmission outputs or aerial positions
must be approved by Mercedes-Benz.
The maximum transmission output (PEAK) at
the base of the aerial must not exceed the
following values:
Waveband
Maximum
transmission
output
Short wave
3 - 54 MHz
30 W
4 m waveband
74 - 78 MHz
15 W
2 m waveband
144 - 174 MHz
25 W
Trunked radio/Tetra
380 - 460 MHz
10 W
70 cm waveband
400 - 460 MHz
15 W
GSM/DCS/PCS
850/900/1800/1900
10 W
UMTS/LTE
10 W
The following can be used in the vehicle without restrictions:
RRF
transmitters with a maximum transmission output of up to 100 mW
RMobile phones (GSM/DCS/PCS/UMTS/
LTE)
There are no restrictions when positioning the
aerial on the outside of the vehicle for the following wavebands:
RTrunked
radio/Tetra
cm waveband
RGSM/DCS/PCS
RUMTS/LTE
R70
Z
Technical data
sion surrounding the possible health risk
posed by electromagnetic fields.
Observe the notes on operating mobile
phones (Y page 551).
The following aerial positions may be used for
the correct installation of RF transmitters:
621
Service products and capacities
622
Identification plates
VIN
Vehicle identification plate with vehicle identification number (VIN)
Move the front-passenger seat to its rearmost position.
X Fold up floor covering : in front of the
front-passenger seat.
VIN ; can be seen.
X
X
Open the right-hand door.
You will see vehicle identification plate :.
The VIN can also be found on the vehicle
identification plate (Y page 622).
Technical data
Engine number
The engine number is stamped into the crankcase. You can obtain further information from
any qualified specialist workshop.
Example: vehicle identification plate
: Vehicle identification plate
; Vehicle manufacturer (Daimler AG)
= EU type approval number (only for certain
?
A
B
C
D
countries)
VIN
Maximum permissible gross vehicle
weight (kg)
Maximum permissible front axle load (kg)
Maximum permissible rear axle load (kg)
Paint code
i The data shown on the vehicle identification plate is example data. This data is different for every vehicle and can deviate
from the data shown here. You can find the
data applicable to your vehicle on the vehicle's identification plate.
Service products and capacities
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Service product can be poisonous and hazardous to health. There is a risk of injury.
Observe the instructions on the respective
original container when using, storing and disposing off service products. Always store service products in the sealed original container.
Always keep service products out of the reach
of children.
H Environmental note
Dispose of service products in an environmentally-responsible manner.
Service products and capacities
Rfuels
Rlubricants (e.g. engine oil, transmission oil)
Rcoolant
Rbrake
fluid
Rwindscreen
washer fluid
control system refrigerant
When handling, storing and disposing of any
service products, please observe the relevant
regulations.
Components and service products must be
matched. Mercedes-Benz recommends that
you use products tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz. They are listed in this
Mercedes-Benz Owner's Manual in the appropriate section.
You can identify service products approved
by Mercedes-Benz by the following inscriptions on the container:
Rclimate
RMB-Freigabe
(e.g. MB-Freigabe 229.51)
RMB Approval (e.g. MB Approval 229.51)
Other designations or recommendations indicate a level of quality or a specification in
accordance with an MB Sheet Number (e.g.
MB 229.5). They have not necessarily been
approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Further information can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre or on the
Internet at http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
Fuel
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Fuel is highly flammable. If you handle fuel
incorrectly, there is a risk of fire and explosion.
You must avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Switch off the engine
and, if applicable, the auxiliary heating before
refuelling.
G WARNING
Fuels are poisonous and hazardous to health.
There is a danger of injury.
Do not swallow fuel or let it come into contact
with skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale fuel
vapours. Keep fuels out of the reach of children.
If you or others come into contact with fuel,
observe the following:
RWash the fuel off any affected areas of skin
with water and soap immediately.
RIf you get fuel in your eyes, rinse them thor-
oughly with clean water immediately. Seek
immediate medical attention.
RIf fuel is swallowed, seek immediate medical attention. Do not induce vomiting.
RChange any clothing that has come into
contact with fuel immediately.
Tank capacity
The total capacity of the fuel tank may vary,
depending on the vehicle equipment.
Model
Total capacity
AMG vehicles
75.0 l
All other models
65.0 l
or
75.0 l
Model
Of which
reserve fuel
AMG vehicles
Approx.
14.0 l
All other models
Approx.
8.0 l
or
9.0 l
Z
Technical data
Service products include the following:
623
624
Service products and capacities
Petrol (EN 228, E DIN 51626-1)
Fuel grade
! Do not use diesel to refuel vehicles with a
petrol engine. Do not switch on the ignition
if you accidentally refuel with the wrong
fuel. Otherwise, fuel can enter the fuel system. Even small amounts of the wrong fuel
could result in damage to the fuel system
and the engine. Notify a qualified specialist
workshop and have the fuel tank and fuel
lines drained completely.
! Only refuel using premium-grade unlea-
ded petrol with at least 95 ROZ/85 MOZ,
that conforms to European standard
EN 228 or E DIN 51626–1 or an equivalent
specification.
Fuel of this specification can contain up to
10 % ethanol.
Fuel that does not conform to EN 228 or
E DIN 51626–1 can lead to increased wear
and damage the engine and exhaust system.
Technical data
! Only use the fuel recommended. Operat-
ing the vehicle with other fuels can lead to
engine failure.
! Do not use the following:
RE85
(petrol with 85% ethanol)
RE100 (100% ethanol)
RM15 (petrol with 15% methanol)
RM30 (petrol with 30% methanol)
RM85 (petrol with 85% methanol)
RM100 (100% methanol)
RPetrol with additives containing metal
RDiesel
Do not mix such fuels with the fuel recommended for your vehicle. Do not use additives. This can otherwise lead to engine
damage. This does not include cleaning
additives for the removal and prevention of
residue build-up. Petrol must only be mixed
with additives recommended by MercedesBenz; see "Additives". You can obtain fur-
ther information from any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Usually you will find information about the
fuel grade on the pump. If you cannot find the
label on the petrol pump, ask the filling station staff.
i E10 fuel contains up to 10% bioethanol.
Your vehicle is suitable for use with E10
fuel. You can refuel your vehicle using E10
fuel.
As a temporary measure, if the recommended
fuel is not available, you may also use unleaded petrol with an octane rating of 91 RON/
82 MON. This may reduce engine performance and increase fuel consumption. Avoid
driving at full throttle and sudden acceleration. Never refuel using fuel with a lower
RON/MON.
i In some countries, the available petrol
may not be sufficiently low in sulphur. This
fuel can temporarily produce unpleasant
odours, especially on short journeys. As
soon as sulphur-free fuel (sulphur content
< 10 ppm) is used for refuelling, the odours
are reduced.
Information on refuelling (Y page 173).
AMG vehicles
! Only refuel using super unleaded petrol
with at least 98 RON/88 MON that conforms to European standard EN 228 or an
equivalent specification.
You can otherwise impair engine output or
damage the engine.
! Premium-grade unleaded petrol with an
octane rating of 95 RON/85 MON may be
used as a temporary measure if the recommended fuel is not available. This may
reduce engine performance and increase
fuel consumption. As much as possible,
avoid driving at full throttle.
! Regular unleaded petrol with an octane
rating of 91 RON/82.5 MON may also be
used as a temporary measure if the recommended fuel is not available.
Service products and capacities
i E10 fuel contains up to 10% bioethanol.
Your vehicle is suitable for use with E10
fuel. You may refuel your vehicle using E10
fuel.
SL 350
! Only refuel using premium-grade sulphurfree unleaded petrol with at least 95 RON/
85 MON that conforms to European standard EN 228 or an equivalent specification.
You could otherwise impair engine output
or damage the emission control system.
i In some countries, the available petrol
may not be sufficiently low in sulphur. This
fuel can temporarily produce unpleasant
odours, especially on short journeys. As
soon as sulphur-free fuel (sulphur content
< 10 ppm) is used for refuelling, the odours
are reduced.
Additives in petrol
! Operating the engine with fuel additives
added later can lead to engine failure. Do
not mix fuel additives with fuel. This does
not include additives for the removal and
prevention of residue build-up. Petrol must
only be mixed with additives recommended
by Mercedes-Benz. Observe the instructions for use in the product description.
More information about recommended
additives can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use
fuel brands that have additives.
The quality of the fuel available in some countries may not be sufficient. Residue could
build up in the injection system as a result. In
this case, in consultation with a MercedesBenz Service Centre, the petrol may be mixed
with the cleaning additive recommended by
Mercedes-Benz. Always observe the notes
and mixing ratios specified on the container.
Fuel consumption information
H Environmental note
CO2 (carbon dioxide) is the gas which scientists believe to be principally responsible for
global warming (the greenhouse effect). Your
vehicle's CO2 emissions are directly related to
fuel consumption and therefore depend on:
Refficient use of the fuel by the engine
Rdriving style
Rother non-technical factors, such as environmental influences, road conditions or
traffic flow
You can minimise your vehicle's CO2 emissions by driving carefully and having it serviced regularly.
The vehicle will use more fuel than usual in the
following situations:
Rat
very low outside temperatures
Rin urban traffic
Ron short journeys
Rin mountainous terrain
i Only for certain countries: you can find
the current consumption and emission values of your vehicle in the COC documents
(EU CERTIFICATE OF CONFORMITY). These
documents are delivered with your vehicle.
The consumption figures were, in each
case, based on the currently applicable version:
Rfor vehicles that comply with standards
up to and including the EURO 4 standard,
in accordance with EU Directive
80/1268/EEC
Rfor vehicles that comply with or exceed
the EURO 5 standard, in accordance with
Regulation (EC) No. 715/2007
Z
Technical data
Doing so results in noticeably higher fuel
consumption, and the engine power output
is noticeably reduced. Avoid driving at full
throttle.
If only regular unleaded petrol with an
octane rating of 91 RON/82.5 MON or
lower is available, you must have the vehicle adapted to this fuel at a qualified specialist workshop.
625
626
Service products and capacities
Deviations from these values may occur
under normal operating conditions.
Technical data
General notes
When handling engine oil, observe the important safety notes on service products
(Y page 622).
The quality of the engine oil is decisive for the
function and service life of an engine. After
extensive tests, Mercedes-Benz approves
engine oils that correspond to the current
technical standard.
Therefore, only Mercedes-Benz approved
engine oils may be used in Mercedes-Benz
engines.
Further information on tested and approved
engine oils can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre. MercedesBenz recommends that you have the oil
change carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop. Mercedes-Benz approval is indicated on the oil container by the inscription "MB
Approval" and the corresponding designation, e.g. MB Approval 229.51.
You can call up an overview of approved
engine oils on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com by entering the designation, e.g. 229.5.
The table shows which engine oils have been
approved for your vehicle.
In certain countries, different engine oils can
be used, provided that the maintenance intervals are reduced. For more information,
please contact a qualified specialist workshop.
All models
available, you may add the following engine
oils until the next oil change:
Rvehicles
Engine oil
Model
i If the engine oils listed in the table are not
MB Approval
229.5
Use only SAE 0W-40 or SAE 5W-40 engine oils
for AMG vehicles.
with a petrol engine: MB
Approval 229.1, 229.3 or ACEA A3
Rdiesel engines: MB Approval 229.1,
229.3, 229.5 or ACEA C3
This may only be added once and the
amount must not be greater than 1.0 l.
Capacities
The following values refer to an oil change,
including the oil filter.
Model
Replacement
amount
SL 350
6.5 l
SL 500
8.0 l
SL 63 AMG
Without external oil
cooler: 8.5 l
With external oil
cooler: 9.5 l
SL 65 AMG V12
Without external oil
cooler: 10.0 l
With external oil
cooler: 11.0 l
Additives
! Do not use any additives with the engine
oil. This could damage the engine.
Engine oil viscosity
Service products and capacities
Brake fluid
G WARNING
The brake fluid continuously absorbs moisture from the air. This results in the boiling
point of the brake fluid lowering. If the boiling
point of the brake fluid is too low, vapour
pockets may form when the brakes are subjected to a heavy load. This would impair braking efficiency. There is a risk of an accident.
Have the brake fluid renewed at the prescribed intervals.
When handling brake fluid, observe the
important safety notes on service products
(Y page 622).
The brake fluid change intervals can be found
in the Service Booklet.
Only use brake fluid approved by MercedesBenz according to MB Approval 331.0.
Information about approved brake fluid can
be obtained at any qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
i Have the brake fluid regularly replaced at
a qualified specialist workshop and the
replacement confirmed in the Service
Booklet.
Coolant
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If antifreeze comes into contact with hot components in the engine compartment, it may
ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury.
Let the engine cool down before you top up
the antifreeze. Make sure that antifreeze is
not spilled next to the filler neck. Thoroughly
clean the antifreeze from components before
starting the engine.
! Only add coolant that has been premixed
with the desired antifreeze protection. You
could otherwise damage the engine.
Further information on coolants can be
found in the Mercedes-Benz Specifications
for Service Products, MB Specifications for
Service Products 310.1, e.g. on the Internet at http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
Or contact a qualified specialist workshop.
! Always use a suitable coolant mixture,
even in countries where high temperatures
prevail.
Otherwise, the engine cooling system is not
sufficiently protected from corrosion and
overheating.
i Have the coolant regularly replaced at a
qualified specialist workshop and the
replacement confirmed in the Service
Booklet.
Comply with the important safety precautions
for service products when handling coolant
(Y page 622).
The coolant is a mixture of water and antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor. It is responsible
for the following:
Ranti-corrosion
protection
protection
Rraising the boiling point
If antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor is present in
the correct concentration, the boiling point of
Rantifreeze
Z
Technical data
Viscosity describes the flow characteristics
of a fluid. If an engine oil has a high viscosity
rating, it flows slowly; the lower the viscosity,
the faster it flows.
Engine oil selection is based on the respective
outside temperatures and in accordance with
the SAE classification (viscosity). The table
shows you which SAE classifications are to be
used. The low-temperature properties of
engine oils can be significantly impaired during operation due to, for example, ageing or
soot and fuel accretion. It is therefore
strongly recommended to observe regular oil
changes using an approved engine oil with the
appropriate SAE classification.
627
628
Service products and capacities
the coolant during operation will be approximately 130 †.
The antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor concentration in the engine cooling system should:
! Do not use distilled or de-ionised water in
Rbe at least 50%. This will protect the engine
WinterFit can be mixed. Otherwise, the
spraying nozzles could become blocked.
cooling system against freezing down to
approximately -37 †.
Rnot exceed 55% (antifreeze protection
down to -45 †). Heat will otherwise not be
dissipated as effectively.
If the vehicle has lost coolant, top it up with
equal amounts of water and antifreeze/
corrosion inhibitor.
Mercedes-Benz recommends an antifreeze/
corrosion inhibitor concentrate in accordance with MB Specifications for Service Products 310.1.
! Only the washer fluids SummerFit and
When handling washer fluid, observe the
important safety notes on service products
(Y page 622).
At temperatures above freezing:
Fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mixture
of water and washer fluid, e.g. MB SummerFit.
X Mix 1 part MB SummerFit to 100 parts
water.
X
At temperatures below freezing:
Fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mixture
of water and washer fluid, e.g. MB WinterFit.
i When the vehicle is first delivered, it is fil-
X
i The coolant is checked at every mainte-
Adapt the mixing ratio to the outside temperature.
led with a coolant mixture that ensures
adequate antifreeze and corrosion protection.
Technical data
the washer fluid reservoir. Otherwise, the
level sensor may be damaged.
nance interval at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Windscreen washer system and headlamp cleaning system
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Windscreen washer concentrate is highly
flammable. If it comes into contact with hot
engine components or the exhaust system it
could ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury.
Make sure that no windscreen washer concentrate is spilled next to the filler neck.
! Only use washer fluid that is suitable for
plastic lamp lenses, e.g. MB SummerFit or
MB WinterFit. Unsuitable washer fluid
could damage the plastic lenses of the
headlamps.
RDown to
Ò10 †: mix 1 part MB WinterFit to
2 parts water.
RDown to Ò20 †: mix 1 part MB WinterFit to
1 part water.
RDown to Ò29 †: mix 2 parts MB WinterFit to
1 part water.
i Add washer fluid concentrate, e.g. MB
SummerFit or MB WinterFit, to the washer
fluid all year round.
Vehicle data
Vehicle data
All models (except AMG
vehicles)
General notes
Please note that for the specified vehicle
data:
Rthe
629
heights specified may vary as a result
of:
- tyres
- load
- condition of the suspension
- optional equipment
Roptional equipment reduces the maximum
payload.
Rvehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 622).
Ronly for certain countries: you can find vehicle-specific vehicle data in the COC documents (CERTIFICATE OF CONFORMITY).
These documents are delivered with your
vehicle.
Vehicle length
4612 mm
Vehicle length when
opening/closing the roof
4798 mm
Vehicle width including
exterior mirrors
2099 mm
Vehicle width excluding
exterior mirrors
1877 mm
Wheelbase
2585 mm
Maximum boot load
100 kg
SL 350
Vehicle height
1314 mm
Vehicle height when
opening/closing the roof
1695 mm
Dimensions and weights
Vehicle height
1315 mm
Vehicle height when
opening/closing the roof
1696 mm
SL 63 AMG and SL 65 AMG
V12
Vehicle length
4633 mm
Vehicle length when
opening/closing the roof
4858 mm
: Opening height
Vehicle width including
exterior mirrors
2099 mm
AMG vehicles
1931 mm 1945 mm
Vehicle width excluding
exterior mirrors
1877 mm
All other models
1922 mm 1923 mm
Vehicle height
1300 mm 1308 mm
Vehicle height when
opening/closing the roof
1688 mm 1713 mm
Model
Z
Technical data
SL 500
630
Vehicle data
SL 63 AMG and SL 65 AMG
V12
Wheelbase
Technical data
Maximum boot load
2585 mm
100 kg
631
632